summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--31525-0.txt9617
-rw-r--r--31525-0.zipbin0 -> 212502 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h.zipbin0 -> 994760 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h/31525-h.htm11381
-rw-r--r--31525-h/images/109.jpgbin0 -> 59907 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h/images/139.jpgbin0 -> 29600 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h/images/156.jpgbin0 -> 62874 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h/images/159.jpgbin0 -> 76849 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h/images/179.jpgbin0 -> 191158 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h/images/245.jpgbin0 -> 52177 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h/images/54.jpgbin0 -> 256833 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h/images/frontispiece.jpgbin0 -> 17615 bytes
-rw-r--r--31525-h/images/sincerely.jpgbin0 -> 26796 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/31525.txt9641
17 files changed, 30655 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/31525-0.txt b/31525-0.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..294158b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-0.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,9617 @@
+The Project Gutenberg eBook of James Gilmour of Mongolia, by James Gilmour
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
+most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
+whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
+of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
+www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you
+will have to check the laws of the country where you are located before
+using this eBook.
+
+Title: James Gilmour of Mongolia
+ His diaries, letters, and reports
+
+Author: James Gilmour
+
+Editor: Richard Lovett
+
+Release Date: March 6, 2010 [eBook #31525]
+[Most recently updated: October 24, 2021]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: UTF-8
+
+Produced by: Peter Vickers, the Bookworm and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team
+
+*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA ***
+
+
+
+
+Transcriber's Note:
+
+Minor spelling and typographical errors have been corrected without
+note. Some illustrations have been slightly relocated for better flow.
+In some of the Chinese or Mongolian names, the character 'u' with a
+breve appears frequently. This appears in the text as [)u].
+
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA
+
+HIS DIARIES LETTERS AND REPORTS
+
+
+EDITED AND ARRANGED BY
+RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.
+AUTHOR OF 'NORWEGIAN PICTURES' ETC
+
+WITH A PORTRAIT, TWO MAPS AND
+FIVE ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+THIRD AND CHEAPER EDITION
+
+LONDON
+THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY
+56 Paternoster Row, 65 St Paul's Churchyard
+1895
+
+
+ O Christ, in Thee my soul hath found,
+ And found in Thee alone,
+ The peace, the joy I sought so long,
+ The bliss till now unknown.
+
+ I sighed for rest and happiness,
+ I yearned for them, not Thee;
+ But while I passed my Saviour by,
+ His love laid hold on me.
+
+ Now none but Christ can satisfy,
+ None other name for me;
+ There's love, and life, and lasting joy,
+ Lord Jesus, found in Thee.
+
+
+
+
+PREFACE
+
+
+This book in its more expensive forms has been before the public for
+nearly two years. It has been very widely read, and it has received
+extraordinary attention from many sections of the press. The author has
+received from all parts of the world most striking testimonies as to the
+way in which this record of James Gilmour's heroic self-sacrifice for
+the Lord Jesus and on behalf of his beloved Mongols for the Master's
+sake has touched the hearts of Christian workers. It has deepened their
+faith, strengthened their zeal, nerved them for whole-hearted
+consecration to the same Master, and cheered many a solitary and lonely
+heart.
+
+Many requests have been received for an edition at a price which will
+place the book within the reach of Sunday School teachers, of those
+Christian workers who have but little to spend upon books, and of the
+elder scholars in our schools. The Committee of the Religious Tract
+Society have gladly met this request at the earliest possible moment.
+
+In this new form their hope and prayer is that James Gilmour, being
+dead, may yet speak to many hearts, arousing them to diligent, and
+faithful, and self-denying service for Jesus Christ.
+
+The book, in this its newest form, is identical in all respects with the
+first and second editions, except that only one portrait is given and
+the appendices are left out.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+ CHAPTER PAGE
+
+ I. EARLY YEARS AND EDUCATION 15
+
+ II. BEGINNING WORK 46
+
+ III. MONGOLIAN APPRENTICESHIP 55
+
+ IV. THE FIRST CAMPAIGN IN MONGOLIA 88
+
+ V. MARRIAGE 98
+
+ VI. 'IN JOURNEYINGS OFTEN, IN PERILS OF RIVERS' 105
+
+ VII. THE VISIT TO ENGLAND IN 1882 134
+
+ VIII. SUNSHINE AND SHADOW 154
+
+ IX. A CHANGE OF FIELD 176
+
+ X. PERSONAL CHARACTERISTICS AS ILLUSTRATED BY
+ LETTERS TO RELATIVES AND FRIENDS 228
+
+ XI. CLOSING LABOURS 256
+
+ XII. THE LAST DAYS 298
+
+
+ LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+ PORTRAIT OF JAMES GILMOUR FROM A PHOTOGRAPH TAKEN
+ AT TIENTSIN ON APRIL 1891 _Frontispiece_
+
+ A MONGOL ENCAMPMENT 109
+
+ A MONGOL CAMEL CART 139
+
+ A CHINESE MULE LITTER 156
+
+ JAMES GILMOUR EQUIPPED FOR HIS WALKING EXPEDITION
+ IN MONGOLIA IN FEBRUARY 1884 159
+
+ JAMES GILMOUR'S TENT 245
+
+
+ MAPS
+
+ 1. MAP ILLUSTRATING JAMES GILMOUR'S JOURNEYS ON THE
+ GREAT PLAIN OF MONGOLIA 54
+
+ 2. MAP ILLUSTRATING JAMES GILMOUR'S LABOURS IN EASTERN
+ MONGOLIA 179
+
+ For readers of _James Gilmour of Mongolia_ not familiar with _Among
+ the Mongols_, a new Edition of that Work has been prepared and
+ published, price Two Shillings and Sixpence.
+
+
+
+
+JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+EARLY YEARS AND EDUCATION
+
+
+James Gilmour, of Mongolia, the son of James Gilmour and Elizabeth
+Pettigrew his wife, was born at Cathkin on Monday, June 12, 1843. He was
+the third in a family of six sons, all but one of whom grew up to
+manhood. His father was in very comfortable circumstances, and
+consequently James Gilmour never had the struggle with poverty through
+which so many of his great countrymen have had to pass. Cathkin, an
+estate of half a dozen farms in the parish of Carmunnock, is only five
+miles from Glasgow, and was owned by Humphrey Ewing Maclae, a retired
+India merchant, who resided in the substantial mansion-house on the
+estate. There were also the houses of a few residents, and a smithy and
+wright's workshops, for the convenience of the surrounding district.
+James Gilmour's father was the occupant of the wright's shop, as his
+father had been before him.
+
+His brother John, one of three who have survived him, has furnished the
+following interesting sketch of the family life in which James Gilmour
+was trained, and to which he owed so much of the charm and power which
+he manifested in later years:--
+
+'Our grandfather, Matthew Gilmour, combined the trades of mason and
+wright, working himself at both as occasion required; and our father,
+James Gilmour, continued the combination in his time in a modified
+degree, gradually discarding the mason trade and developing the
+wright's. Grandmother (father's mother) was a woman of authority, skill,
+and practical usefulness among the little community in which she
+resided. In cases requiring medical treatment, she was always in
+request; and in order to obtain the lymph pure for the vaccination of
+children she would take it herself direct from the cow. She was also a
+neat and skilful needlewoman.
+
+'Matthew Gilmour and his wife were people of strict integrity and
+Christian living. They walked regularly every Sunday the five miles to
+the Congregational Church in Glasgow, though there were several places
+of worship within two miles of their residence. I have often heard the
+old residents of the steep and rough country road they used to take for
+a short cut when nearing home tell how impressed they have been by the
+sight of the worthy couple and their family wending their way along in
+the dark winter Sabbath evenings by the light of a hand-lantern. Our
+parents continued the connection with the same body of worshippers in
+Glasgow as long as they resided in Cathkin, being members of Dr. Ralph
+Wardlaw's church. It was under his earnest eloquence, and by his wise
+pastoral care, we were trained.
+
+'The distance of our home from the place of worship did not admit of our
+attending as children any other than the regular Sabbath services; but
+we were not neglected in this respect at home, so far as it lay in our
+parents' ability to help us. We regularly gathered around our mother's
+knee, reading the impressive little stories found in such illustrated
+booklets as the _Teacher's Offering_, the _Child's Companion_, the
+_Children's Missionary Record_ (Church of Scotland), the _Tract
+Magazine_, and Watts' _Divine Songs for Children_. These readings were
+always accompanied with touching serious comments on them by mother,
+which tended very considerably to impress the lessons contained in them
+on our young hearts. I remember how she used to add: "Wouldn't it be
+fine if some of you, when you grow up, should be able to write such nice
+little stories as these for children, and do some good in the world in
+that way!" I have always had an idea that James' love of contributing
+short articles from China and Mongolia to the children's missionary
+magazines at home was due to these early impressions instilled into his
+mind by his mother. Father, too, on Sabbath evenings, generally placed
+the "big" Bible (Scott and Henry's) on the table, and read aloud the
+comments therein upon some portion of Scripture for our edification and
+entertainment. During the winter week-nights some part of the evening
+was often spent in reading aloud popular books then current, such as
+_Uncle Tom's Cabin_.
+
+'Family worship, morning and evening, was also a most regular and sacred
+observance in our house, and consisted of first, asking a blessing;
+second, singing twelve lines of a psalm or paraphrase, or a hymn from
+Wardlaw's Hymn-book; third, reading a chapter from the Old Testament in
+the mornings, and from the New in the evenings; and fourth, prayer. The
+chapters read were taken day by day in succession, and at the evening
+worship we read two verses each all round. This proved rather a trying
+ordeal for some of the apprentices, one or more of whom we usually had
+boarding with us, or to a new servant-girl, as their education in many
+cases had not been of too liberal a description. But they soon got more
+proficient, and if it led them to nothing higher, it was a good
+educational help. These devotional exercises were not common in the
+district in the mornings, and were apt to be broken in upon by callers
+at the wright's shop; but that was never entertained as an excuse for
+curtailing them. I suppose people in the district got to know of the
+custom, and avoided making their calls at a time when they would have to
+wait some little while for attention. Our parents, however, never
+allowed this practice or their religious inclinations to obtrude on
+their neighbours; all was done most unassumingly and humbly, as a matter
+of everyday course.
+
+'Our maternal grandfather, John Pettigrew by name, was a farmer and
+meal-miller on the estate of Cathkin, and was considered a man of
+sterling worth and integrity. Having had occasion to send his minister,
+the parson of Carmunnock parish, some bags of oatmeal from his mill, the
+minister suspected from some cause or other that he had got short weight
+or measure. The worthy miller was rather nettled at being thus impeached
+by his spiritual overseer, and that same night proceeded to the manse
+with the necessary articles required for determining the accuracy of the
+minister's suspicions. When this was done, it was found there remained
+something to the good, instead of a deficiency; this the miller swung
+over his shoulder in a bag and took back with him to the mill, as a
+lesson to the crestfallen divine to be more careful in future about
+challenging the integrity of his humble parishioner's transactions.
+
+'While James was quite a child the family removed to Glasgow, where our
+father entered into partnership with his brother Alexander as timber
+merchants. During this stay in Glasgow mother's health proved very
+unsatisfactory, and latterly both she and father having been prostrated
+and brought to death's door by a malignant fever, it was decided to
+relinquish the partnership and return to their former place in the
+country. James was five years old at that time. When he was between
+seven and eight he was sent with his older brothers to the new
+Subscription School in Bushyhill, Cambuslang, a distance of two miles.
+Here he remained till he was about twelve, when he and I were sent to
+Gorbals Youths' School in Greenside Street, Glasgow. We had thus five
+miles to go morning and evening, but we had season-tickets for the
+railway part of the distance, viz. between Rutherglen and Glasgow.
+Thomas Neil was master of this school. We were in the private room,
+rather a privileged place, compared with the rest of the school, seeing
+we received the personal attentions of Mr. Neil, and were almost free
+from corporal punishment, which was not by any means the case in the
+public rooms of the school--Mr. Neil being, I was going to say, a
+_terror to evildoers_, but he was in fact a terror to all kinds of
+doers, from the excitability of his temper and general sternness.
+
+'Here James usually kept the first or second place in the class, which
+was a large one; and if he happened to be turned to the bottom (an event
+which occurred pretty often to all the members of the class with Mr.
+Neil), he would determinedly endeavour to stifle a tearful little "cry,"
+thus demonstrating the state of his feelings at being so abased. But he
+never remained long at the bottom; like a cork sunk in water, he would
+rise at the first opportunity to his natural level at the top of the
+class. It was because of his diligence and success in his classes while
+at this school, I suppose, more than from any definite idea of what
+career he might follow in the future, that after leaving he was allowed
+to prosecute his studies at the Glasgow High School, where he gained
+many prizes, and fully justified his parents' decision of allowing him
+to go on with his studies instead of taking him away to a trade. At home
+he prosecuted his studies very untiringly both during session and
+vacation.
+
+'After entering the classes of the Glasgow University he studied in an
+attic room, the window of which overlooked an extensive and beautiful
+stretch of the Vale of Clyde. I remember feeling compassion for him
+sometimes as he sat at this window, knowing what an act of self-denial
+it must have been to one so boisterous and full of fun as he was to see
+us, after our work was over of an evening, having a jolly game at
+rounders, or something of that sort, while he had to sit poring over his
+books.
+
+'James was not a serious, melancholy student; he was indeed the very
+opposite of that when his little intervals of recreation occurred.
+During the day he would be out about the workshop and saw-mill, giving
+each in turn a poking and joking at times very tormenting to the
+recipients. If we had any little infirmity or weakness, he was sure to
+enlarge upon it and make us try to amend it, assuming the _rÙle_ and
+aspect of a drill-sergeant for the time being. He used to have the
+mid-finger of the right hand extended in such a way that he could nip
+and slap you with it very painfully. He used this finger constantly to
+pound and drill his comrades, all being done of course in the height of
+glee, frolic, and good-humour. This finger, no doubt by the unlawful use
+to which he put it, at one time developed a painful tumour, to the
+delight of those who were in the habit of receiving punishment from it.
+James pulled a long face, and acknowledged that it was a punishment sent
+him for using the finger in so mischievous a manner.
+
+'There was a pond or dam in connection with the sawmill. In this James
+was wont to practise the art of swimming. I remember he devised a plan
+of increasing his power of stroke in the water. He made four oval pieces
+of wood rather larger than his hands and feet, tacking straps on one
+side, so that his hands and feet would slip tightly into them. But my
+recollection is that they were soon discarded as an unsuitable addition
+to his natural resources. He was fond of hunting after geological
+specimens, getting the local blacksmith to make him a pocket hammer to
+take with him on his rambles for that purpose. He seldom cared for
+company in these wanderings among the mountains, glens, and woods of his
+native place and country. He would start early in the morning, and
+accomplish feats of walking and climbing during the course of a day.
+Indeed, none of his brothers ever thought of asking James to go with
+them in their little holiday trips, knowing that anything not the
+conception of his own fancy was but very rarely acceptable to him; and
+he was never one who would pander to your gratification merely to please
+you.
+
+'James was fond of boating. Once he hired a small skiff near the
+suspension-bridge at Glasgow Green, and proceeded with it up the river.
+Having gone a good way up, the idea appears to have taken him to
+endeavour to get the whole way to Hamilton, where, father having retired
+from business in 1866, our parents were now residing. This proved to be
+a very arduous task, as in a great many places on that part of the Clyde
+there is not depth of water to carry a boat. He managed, however, to
+accomplish the task by divesting himself of jacket, stockings, and
+shoes, and pulling the boat over all such shallow and rocky places
+(including the weir at Blantyre Mills, where the renowned African
+missionary and explorer, Dr. Livingstone, worked in his boyhood), until
+he reached the bridge on the river between Hamilton and Motherwell, a
+distance of eleven miles or more from Glasgow in a straight line, and
+much more following the numerous bends of the river. Here he made the
+boat secure and proceeded home, a distance of a mile, very tired and
+ravenously hungry. The great drawback to his satisfaction in this feat
+was his fear of the displeasure the boat-owner might feel at his not
+having returned the same night, and the rough usage to which he had
+subjected the boat in hauling it over the rocky places. He was much
+delighted, when he arrived with the boat down the river during the day,
+to find that the man was rather pleased than otherwise at his plucky
+exploit, telling him that he only remembered it being attempted once
+before.
+
+'During part of the time James attended college at Glasgow University,
+the classes were at so early an hour that he could not take advantage of
+the railway, and so had to walk in the whole way. This was an anxious
+time for his mother, who was ever most particular in seeing to the
+household duties herself, and always careful that her children should
+have a substantial breakfast when they went from home. I remember some
+of those winter mornings. Amidst the bustle of making and partaking of
+an early breakfast so as to be on the road in time, mother would press
+him to partake more liberally of something she had thoughtfully prepared
+for him; he would ejaculate: "Can't take it--no time!" and if she still
+insisted he would add in a solemn manner: "_Mother_, what if the door
+should be shut when I get there?" which, being understood by her as a
+scriptural quotation, was sufficient to quench her solicitations.
+
+'To avoid the worry of getting up so early, it was decided after a time
+that he should take advantage of an unlet three or four apartment house
+in a tenement which belonged to father in Cumberland Street, Glasgow. So
+a couple of chairs, table, bed, and some cooking-utensils were got
+together, and James entered into possession, cooking his own breakfast,
+and getting his other meals there or outside as his fancy or inclination
+prompted. Here I think he enjoyed himself very much. He had plenty of
+quiet time for study, and he could roam about the city and suburbs for
+experience, recreation, and instruction, visiting mills and other large
+manufacturing industries as he was inclined.
+
+'After our parents had removed to Hamilton, James took lodgings in
+George Street, a regular students' resort when the old college was in
+the High Street. It is now removed to the magnificent pile of buildings
+at Gilmorehill, in the western district of the city. The site of the old
+one in the High Street which James attended is now occupied by the
+North British and Glasgow and South-Western Railway Companies.'
+
+James Gilmour left England to begin his Mongolian life-work in February
+1870, and then commenced keeping a diary, from which we shall often
+quote, and which he carefully continued amid, oftentimes, circumstances
+of the greatest difficulty until his death. He gives the following
+reasons for this practice at the time when he was living in a Mongol
+tent learning the language, hundreds of miles away from his nearest
+fellow-worker:--
+
+ 'I think it a special duty to my friends, specially my mother, to
+ keep this diary, and to be particular in adding my state of mind in
+ addition to my mere outward circumstances. In my present isolated
+ position, which may be more isolated soon, any accident might
+ happen at any moment, after which I could not send home a letter,
+ and I think that by keeping my diary punctually and fully my
+ friends might have the melancholy satisfaction of following me to
+ the grave, as it were, through my writing.'
+
+In the record of his first outward voyage he included a sketch of his
+early life, which we briefly reproduce here, as the correlative and
+complement of the picture outlined by his brother:--
+
+ 'The earliest that I can remember of my life is the portion that
+ was spent in Glasgow, before I came with my parents out to the
+ country. Of this time I have only a vague recollection. Then
+ followed a number of years not very eventful beyond the general lot
+ of the years of childhood. One circumstance of these years often
+ comes up to my mind. One Sabbath all were at church except the
+ servant, Aggie Leitch, and myself. She took down an old copy of
+ Bunyan's _Pilgrim's Progress_, with rude plates, and by the help
+ of the pictures was explaining the whole book to me. I had not
+ heard any of it before, and was deeply interested. We had just got
+ as far as the terrible doings of Giant Despair and the horrors of
+ Doubting Castle, when all at once, without warning, there came a
+ terrible knock at our front door. I really thought the giant was
+ upon us. It was some wayfaring man asking the way or something, but
+ the terror I felt has made an indelible impression on me.
+
+ 'When of the approved age I went to school, wondering whether I
+ should ever be able to learn and do as others did. I was very
+ nervous and much afraid, and wrought so hard and was so ably
+ superintended by my mother that I made rapid progress, and was put
+ from one class to another with delightful rapidity. I was
+ dreadfully jealous of any one who was a good scholar like myself,
+ and to have any one above me in class annoyed me to such a degree
+ that I could not play cheerfully with him.
+
+ 'The date of my going to college was, I think, the November of the
+ year 1862, so that my first session at Glasgow University was
+ 1862-63. The classes I took were junior Latin and junior Greek. In
+ Latin I got about the twelfth prize, and in Greek I think the
+ third. The summer I spent partly in study, partly in helping my
+ father in his trade of a wright and joiner.
+
+ 'During 1863 and 1864 I lived in Glasgow, and worked very hard,
+ taking the first prize in middle Greek and a prize in senior Latin,
+ as well as a prize for private work in Greek, and another for the
+ same kind of work in Latin. This last I was specially proud of, as
+ in it I beat the two best fellows in the Latin class. Next session
+ (1864-65) I took a prize in senior Greek. I got nothing in the
+ logic, but in moral philosophy in 1865 I was one of those who took
+ an active part in the rebellion against Dr. Fleming, who, though he
+ was entitled to the full retiring pension, preferred to remain on
+ as professor, taking the fees and appointing a student to do the
+ work. We made a stand against this, and were able to bring him out
+ to his work; but it was too much for him, and he died in harness,
+ as he had wished.
+
+ 'In English literature I made no appearance in the pieces noted by
+ the students, but came out second in the competitive examination,
+ which of course astonished a good deal some of the noisy men who
+ had answered so much in the class and yet knew so little. I was
+ really proud of this prize, as I was sure it was honestly won, and
+ as I also felt that from my position in class I failed to get
+ credit for anything like what I knew. This session I went in for
+ the classical and philosophy parts of the degree, and got them. I
+ enjoyed a happy week after it was known that I had passed; and the
+ next thing I had to look forward to was going to the Theological
+ Hall of the Congregational Church of Scotland, which met in
+ Edinburgh in the beginning of May. The session at Edinburgh I
+ enjoyed very much. I had not too much work, and used at odd times
+ to take long walks and go long excursions. I was often on the
+ heights, and about Leith and Portobello.'
+
+The Rev. John Paterson of Airdrie, N.B., Gilmour's most intimate college
+friend at Glasgow, thus records his recollections of what he was in
+those days:--
+
+ 'I first made James Gilmour's acquaintance in the winter session of
+ 1864-5 at Glasgow University. He came to college with the
+ reputation of being a good linguist. This reputation was soon
+ confirmed by distinction in his classes, especially in Latin and
+ Greek. Though his advantages had been superior to most of us, and
+ his mental calibre was of a high order, he was always humble,
+ utterly devoid of pride or vanity. No doubt he was firm as a rock
+ on any question of conviction, but he was tender in the extreme,
+ and full of sympathy with the struggling. He was such a strong man
+ all round that he could afford to give every one justice, and such
+ a gentleman that he could not but be considerate. One day a country
+ student through sheer nervousness missed a class question in the
+ Junior Humanity, though the answer was on his tongue: the answering
+ of such a question would have brought any man to the front, and
+ with a sad heart he told his experience to Gilmour, whose look of
+ sympathy is remembered to this day. He always seemed anxious to be
+ useful, and he succeeded. During our second session, a brother of
+ mine married a cousin of his, and this union led to a closer
+ intimacy between us, and in future sessions we lodged together.
+
+ 'Throughout his college career Gilmour was a very hard-working
+ student; his patience, perseverance, and powers of application were
+ marvellous; and yet, as a rule, he was bright and cheerful, able in
+ a twinkling to throw off the cares of work, and enter with zest
+ into the topics of the day. He had a keen appreciation of the
+ humorous side of things, and his merry laugh did one good.
+ Altogether he was a delightful companion, and was held in universal
+ esteem. One of Gilmour's leading thoughts was unquestionably the
+ unspeakable value of time, and this intensified with years. There
+ was not a shred of indolence in his nature; it may be truthfully
+ said that he never wilfully lost an hour. Even when the college
+ work was uncongenial, he never scamped it, but mastered the
+ subject. He could not brook the idea of skimming a subject merely
+ to pass an examination, and there were few men of his time with
+ such wide and accurate knowledge.
+
+ 'Unlike many of his fellows, he did not relax his energies in
+ summer. During the recess he might have been seen wending his way
+ from the old home at Cathkin to the college library, and returning
+ laden with books. His superior scholarship secured for him
+ excellent certificates and many prizes, both for summer and winter
+ work, and it was noticeable that he shone most in written
+ examinations. On one occasion, in the Moral Philosophy class, which
+ then suffered from the failing health of the professor, the teacher
+ _pro tem._ appended, as a criticism of an essay of Gilmour's on
+ Utilitarianism, the words, "Wants thoroughness." This was a problem
+ to the diligent student, who tackled his critic at the end of the
+ hour, and apparently had the best of the argument; for he told me
+ afterwards that he had puzzled the judge to explain his own
+ verdict. There was a strong vein of combativeness in him; he liked
+ to try his strength, both mentally and physically, with others; and
+ it was no child's play to wrestle with him in either sense, though
+ he never harboured ill-feeling. He had the advantage of being in
+ easy circumstances, but was severely economical, wasting nothing.
+ He had quite a horror of intoxicating drinks. On one occasion,
+ perhaps for reasons of hospitality, some beer had found its way
+ into our room: he quietly lifted the window and poured the
+ dangerous liquid on the street, saying, "Better on God's earth than
+ in His image."
+
+ 'As the close of his career in Glasgow drew near, some of us could
+ see that all through he had been preparing for some great work on
+ which the whole ambition of his life was set. He always shrank
+ from speaking about himself, and in those days was not in the habit
+ of obtruding sacred things on his fellow-students. His views on
+ personal dealing then were changing, and became very decided in
+ after years. Earnest, honest, faithful to his convictions, as a
+ student he endeavoured to influence others for good more by the
+ silent eloquence of a holy life than by definite exhortations, and
+ I feel sure his power over some of us was all the greater on that
+ account. When it became known that Gilmour intended to be a foreign
+ missionary, there was not a little surprise expressed, especially
+ among rival fellow-students--men who had competed with him to their
+ cost. The moral effect of such a distinguished scholar giving his
+ life for Christ among the heathen was very great indeed. To me his
+ resolve to go abroad, though it induced a painful separation,
+ proved an unspeakable blessing. The reserve which had so long
+ prevailed between us on sacred things began to give way, and much
+ of our correspondence during his residence at Cheshunt College was
+ of a religious turn, though still more theological than practical.
+
+ 'The last evening we spent together before he left for China can
+ never be forgotten. We parted on Bothwell Bridge. We had walked
+ from the village without speaking a word, burdened with the sorrow
+ of separation. As we shook hands, he said with intense earnestness,
+ "Paterson, let us keep close to Christ." He knew Him and loved Him
+ much better than I did then; but about nine years ago, after
+ hearing good news from me, he wrote to say that for twelve years he
+ had prayed for me every day, and now praised God for the answer.'
+
+In the diary from which we have already quoted Gilmour thus concludes
+the sketch of his education:--
+
+ 'Near the close of the session of 1867 I opened negotiations with
+ the London Missionary Society, the consequence of which was that I
+ was removed to Cheshunt College in September of that same year.
+ Here (1867-1868) a new experience awaited me--resident college
+ life. At Glasgow we dined out, presented ourselves at classes only,
+ and did with ourselves whatever we liked in the interval. At
+ Cheshunt it was different. All the students live in the buildings
+ of the college, which can accommodate forty. Of course I felt a
+ little strange at first, and even long after had serious doubts as
+ to the settlement of the question, Which is better, life in or out
+ of college? The lectures, as a rule, were all in the forenoon.
+
+ 'The summer vacation I spent in studying for the Soper scholarship,
+ value twenty pounds, which was to be bestowed after examination.
+
+ 'I commenced the 1868 and 1869 session at Cheshunt, very busily,
+ and in addition to the class work and the Soper work, read some
+ books which gave almost a new turn to my mind and my ideas of
+ pastoral or missionary life. These books were James's _Earnest
+ Ministry_, Baxter's _Reformed Pastor_, and some of Bunyan's works,
+ which, through God's blessing, affected me very much for good.
+
+ 'The Soper examination should have come off before Christmas, but
+ it did not, so that I remained over Christmas at Cheshunt, grinding
+ away as hard as I could. I was longing eagerly for the time when
+ the examination would be over, that I might the more earnestly
+ devote myself to the work of preaching and evangelising. Well, the
+ examination came and passed off satisfactorily, and I got the
+ twenty pounds.
+
+ 'Now was the decisive point. Now had I come to another period,
+ when there was an opportunity of going on a new tack; but I found
+ myself tempted to seek after another honour, the first prize in
+ Cheshunt College. In my first session I had got the second only,
+ and now I had an opportunity of trying for the first. It was a
+ temptation indeed, but God triumphed. I looked back on my life, and
+ saw how often I had been tempted on from one thing to another,
+ after I had resolved that I would leave my time more free and at my
+ disposal for God, but always was I tempted on. So now I made a
+ stand, threw ambition to the winds, and set to reading my Bible in
+ good earnest. I made it my chief study during the last three months
+ of my residence at Cheshunt, and I look back upon that period of my
+ stay there as the most profitable I had.
+
+ 'In September, 1869, I entered the missionary seminary at Highgate,
+ and also studied Chinese in London with Professor Summers. I went
+ home again at Christmas, and on returning to London learned that I
+ could go to China as soon as I liked. I said I would go as soon as
+ the necessary arrangements could be made, and February 22, 1870,
+ was fixed upon as the date of my departure.'
+
+In this brief and rapid manner James Gilmour sketched, with not a few
+most characteristic touches, the first twenty-six years of his life. He
+enables us to see the quick, merry, receptive lad, developing, after a
+brilliant collegiate course and a careful training in theology and in
+practical Christian life, into the strong, resolute missionary. No one
+who knew him during this time failed to perceive the force of his
+character and the charm of his personality. The writer first came under
+his influence during his second session at Cheshunt. He was then in the
+prime of his early manhood, in the full possession of physical and
+intellectual vigour, and his soul was aflame with love to the Saviour
+and to the perishing heathen.
+
+He retained, moreover, the love of fun, the high spirits, the keen
+enjoyment of a good joke, and the constant readiness for an argument
+upon any subject under the sun, which had endeared him to his comrades
+in Glasgow. Every Cheshunt man of that day readily recalls, and rejoices
+as he does so, the memory of his good-natured practical joking, of his
+racy and pointed speeches upon all momentous 'house questions,' of his
+power as a reciter, and of his glowing personal piety. To know him even
+slightly was to respect him; and to enter at all into sympathy with him
+was to love him as long as life lasted.
+
+There are many reminiscences of those Cheshunt days, from which we can
+cull only a sufficient number to enable the reader to understand what
+manner of man he then was. These are drawn from the letters of his
+fellow-students, and from their recollections of his sayings and doings.
+'How well,' writes one, 'I remember his coming to Cheshunt! I was
+acting-senior at the opening of that session, and, according to custom
+with the new men, went to his room to shake hands with him. He said,
+"Who are you?" I told him. "What do you want?" I told him I had come
+according to custom to welcome him, and held out my hand, whereupon he
+put his hands behind him and said, "Time eno' to shake hands when we've
+quarrelled. But where do you live?" "Immediately over your head." "Then
+look here," said he, "don't make a row;" and so we parted. Dear old
+fellow! his memory makes life richer.'
+
+Another writes: 'He was a good elocutionist. He was also a keen debater,
+and so fond of argument that he would not hesitate to take opposite
+ground to his own cherished convictions and beliefs, simply for the sake
+of provoking discussion. So earnestly and logically (for he was a good
+dialectician) would he carry on the discussion that it was difficult to
+believe that he did not really hold the opinions for which he so
+pertinaciously contended. Sometimes this habit of mind reacted very
+amusingly upon himself, as the following will show. The subject fixed
+one Friday evening for debate in the discussion class was, "Have animals
+souls?" Though fully accepting the common belief that they have not,
+Gilmour, purely for the sake of argument, took the affirmative, and with
+such enthusiasm pleaded his cause that he brought himself to believe, as
+he told me afterwards, that animals have souls.'
+
+'At no time during his residence at Cheshunt could there have been any
+doubt as to Gilmour's piety or consecration to the great work of his
+future life; but during the second year it must have been manifest to
+all who knew him intimately that there was a deepening and broadening of
+his spiritual life. As I look back over the interval of years I can see
+that it was then he began to reach the high-water mark in Christian life
+and devotion which was so steadily maintained throughout his career in
+China and Mongolia. An apostolic passion for the salvation of his
+fellow-men took hold upon him. He would go out in the evening, mostly
+alone, and conduct short open-air services at Flamstead End, among the
+cottagers near Cheshunt railway station; seize opportunities of speaking
+to labourers working by the roadside or in the field through which he
+might be passing. He became very solicitous for the conversion of
+friends in Scotland, and would come to my study and ask me to kneel
+and pray with him that God's grace might be manifested to them, and that
+His blessing might rest upon letters which he had written and was
+sending to them. The ordinary style of preaching towards which students
+usually aspire lost its attractions for him, and his sermons assumed
+more and more the character of earnest exhortations, and addresses to
+the unconverted. When he knew what was to be his field of labour after
+his college course was over, how solicitous he was to go out fully
+prepared and fitted in spiritual equipment! The needs of the perishing
+heathen were very real and weighed heavily upon his heart, and he was
+very anxious to win volunteers among his college friends for this
+all-important work. How he longed and prayed for China's perishing
+millions only his most intimate friends know.'
+
+The Rev. H. R. Reynolds, D.D., for the past thirty years the honoured
+President of Cheshunt College, has recalled some of his early
+recollections of James Gilmour.
+
+'Though brusque and outspoken in manner, he was in many respects
+reserved and shy, and very slow to show or accept confidence. We all
+felt, however, that underneath a canny demeanour there was burning a
+very intense enthusiasm, and that a character of marked features was
+already formed, and would only develop along certain lines, settled, but
+not as yet fully disclosed to others.
+
+There was not a particle of make-believe in his composition. He shrank
+from praise, and was obviously anxious not to appear more reverential or
+wise or devoted than he knew himself to be. He even used, because it was
+natural to him, a rugged style of expression when speaking of things or
+persons or institutions which for the most part uplift our diction and
+generally induce us to adorn or make careful selection of our
+vocabulary. He rapped out expressions which might have suggested
+carelessness or irreverence or suppressed doubt, but I soon found that
+there was an intense fire of evangelistic zeal and an almost stormy
+enthusiasm for the conversion of souls to Christ.
+
+'Some special services were held at Cheshunt Street Chapel, in which
+Gilmour took part, and the part was at least as demonstrative, perhaps
+more so, except the music, as that of the modern Salvation Army ensign
+or commissioner. He started from the chapel entrance, on the Sunday
+evening, when considerable numbers were as usual parading the country
+street, and bare-headed approached every passer-by with some piquant,
+vigorous inquiry, or message or warning. In the main, his bold summons
+was, "Do you believe on the Lord Jesus Christ?" The entire population in
+the thoroughfare was stirred, and uncomplimentary jeers mingled with
+some awe-struck impressions that were then produced.
+
+'During the year 1869 he had those interviews with the late Mrs. Swan,
+of Edinburgh, which led to his choice by the London Missionary Society,
+at her instance, to reopen the long-suspended mission in Mongolia. For a
+while he remained in Peking preparing himself by familiarity with the
+people, their ideas, their language, and religion, for those almost
+historic bursts into the great desert and across the caravan routes to
+the huge fairs, and the renowned temples, to the living lamas and famous
+shrines of the nomadic Mongols, incessantly acting the part of
+travelling Hakim, itinerant book vendor, and fiery preacher of the
+Gospel of Christ.'
+
+In the year 1869 the policy of the London Missionary Society in the
+education of its students was very different from that which now
+obtains. After a course at a theological college of two, three, or four
+years, according to the literary attainments of the man at the time of
+his acceptance by the Directors, he was sent to the institution at
+Highgate designed to give training suitable for the special requirements
+of the embryo missionaries. In theory this institution was admirable; in
+practice Gilmour and others, much as they esteemed the principal, the
+Rev. J. Wardlaw, found it--or thought they found it--very largely a
+waste of time. The year 1869 saw the beginning of an investigation which
+ended in closing the missionary college at Highgate, and in the steps
+that led to the enquiry Gilmour took a leading part. One of his
+contemporaries at Highgate has thus described his influence upon both
+his fellow-students and the institution to which they belonged.
+
+'I first met Gilmour at Farquhar House, Highgate, the London Missionary
+Society's Institution, where in those days missionary students spent
+their last six months before going to the field. Some spent the time in
+studying the elements of the language of the land to which they were
+going; others attended University College Hospital, for the purpose of
+getting a little medical knowledge; while all tried to make themselves
+acquainted with the history of the people among whom they were to
+labour. Courses of special missionary lectures, which were highly valued
+by the men, were delivered by the Rev. J., afterwards Dr., Wardlaw.
+
+'Some of us were at Highgate a day or two before Gilmour came up from
+Scotland; and as his fame, or rather reports about him, had reached us
+from Cheshunt College, we were all very anxious to meet with him. When
+he did arrive we were, I think, all more or less disappointed, and yet I
+doubt if any of us could have told why, except that he was not the man
+we had pictured from the reports we had heard. When he walked quietly
+into the library I, for one, could hardly believe that the almost
+boyish-looking, open-faced, bright-eyed young man was really Gilmour.
+His dress made him appear even more youthful than he was, while there
+was an aspect of good humour about his face and a glance of his eye
+revealing any amount of fun and frolic. A great writer has said: "Nature
+has written a letter of credit on some men's faces, which is honoured
+almost wherever presented." James Gilmour's was a face on which Nature
+had written no ordinary letter of credit; for there was a sense in which
+one might very truly have said that his "face was his fortune." Honesty,
+good nature, and true manliness were so stamped upon every feature and
+line of it, that you had only to see him to feel that he was one of
+God's noblest works, and to be drawn to the man as by a magnetic
+influence.
+
+'Gilmour was a puzzle to most of our fellow-students, and they could not
+quite make him out. By some he was: regarded as very eccentric, which is
+another way of saying that he preserved a very marked individuality, and
+always had the courage of his convictions. They did not seem to
+understand how so much playfulness and piety, fervour and frolicsomeness
+could dwell in the same person. Long before we parted, however, in
+January, 1870, I feel certain that all had come to have not only a
+profound respect, but also a real heart-love for "dear old Gillie"!
+
+'The night before Gilmour left Highgate for the Christmas vacation we
+were all in his study, when someone, remarking on the risk he was
+running in going home to Scotland by sea, instead of by train, said in a
+jocular way: "Suppose the steamer is wrecked and you get drowned, to
+whom do you leave your books, Gilmour?" "Yes," he said at once, "that is
+well thought of. Come along, you fellows, and pick out the books you
+would like to keep in memory of me, if I never return." Of course we
+only laughed and said it was all a joke; but he said, "It is no joke
+with me, I mean what I say;" and so he did. He was in dead earnest, and
+nothing would satisfy him but that each should pick out the book or
+books he would like to have if he never returned. He then turned to me
+and said: "Now, I leave the rest to your care, and if I never return I
+want all on this shelf sent to my father and mother, and you can do
+anything you like with the rest." Had anyone else acted in that way, we
+should have certainly suspected that he had gone "_queer_"; but it was
+Gilmour, and we all understood the straight, matter-of-fact way in which
+he went about everything he did.
+
+'Through a misunderstanding, as we afterwards discovered, the students
+at Highgate came into collision with the Directors of the Society over
+the studies to be prosecuted. Additional classes were arranged, and
+these some of us declined to attend. This act of rebellion, as it was
+regarded at the Mission House, had to be put down with a firm hand, and
+a special meeting of the Board of Directors was called to deal with us.
+
+'The night before we were to meet the Board we met in Gilmour's study,
+to settle what we were to say to the Directors when we met them. One
+only of our number, when he saw that there was likely to be a rather
+serious interchange of ideas between us and the Directors, caved in
+completely, and would have nothing further to do with our resistance.
+
+'When we met the Board Gilmour made his defence in his frank,
+straightforward way, and, I am afraid, upset some of the Directors very
+much by his plain speaking. They did not know the man, and regarded him
+as one of the ringleaders in rebellion, and, of course, were not in the
+humour to do him justice. But when we met the subcommittee appointed to
+deal with us the misunderstanding came to an end, and they admitted that
+we had been in the right in objecting to the extra classes thus
+imposed.'
+
+During these last months in England James Gilmour paid much earnest heed
+to the culture of his soul. Just before he sailed for China, he set
+forth his inner experience and his keen sense of the difficulties of the
+course upon which he was embarking in the following letter to a Cheshunt
+friend:--
+
+ 'Companions I can scarcely hope to meet, and the feeling of being
+ _alone_ comes over me till I think of Christ and His blessed
+ promise, "Lo, I am with you alway, even to the end of the world."
+ No one who does not go away, leaving all and going alone, can feel
+ the force of this promise; and when I begin to feel my heart
+ threatening to go down, I betake myself to this companionship, and,
+ thank God, I have felt the blessedness of this promise rushing over
+ me repeatedly when I knelt down and spoke to Jesus as a present
+ companion, from whom I am sure to find sympathy. I have felt a
+ tingle of delight thrilling over me as I felt His presence, and
+ thought that wherever I may go He is still with me. I have once or
+ twice lately felt a melting sweetness in the name of Jesus as I
+ spoke to Him and told Him my trouble. Yes, and the trouble went
+ away, and I arose all right. Is it not blessed of Christ to care so
+ much for us poor feeble men, so sinful and so careless about
+ honouring Him? the moment we come to Him He is ready with His
+ consolations for us!
+
+ 'I have been thinking lately over some of the inducements we have
+ to live for Christ, and to confess Him and preach Him before men,
+ not conferring with flesh and blood. Why should we be trammelled by
+ the opinions and customs of men? Why should we care what men say of
+ us? Salvation and damnation are _realities_, Christ is a reality,
+ _Eternity_ is a reality, and we shall soon be there in reality, and
+ time shall soon be finished; and from our stand in eternity we
+ shall look back on what we did in time, and what shall we think of
+ it? Shall we be able to understand why we were afraid to speak to
+ this man or that woman about salvation? Shall we be able to
+ understand how we were ashamed to do what we knew was a Christian
+ duty before one whom we knew to be a mocker at religion? Our
+ cowardice shall seem small to us then. Let us now measure our
+ actions by the standard of that scene, let us now look upon the
+ things of time in the light of eternity, and we shall see them
+ better as they are, and live more as we shall wish then we had
+ done. It is not too late. We can secure yet what remains of our
+ life. The present still is ours. Let us use it. It may be that we
+ can't be great, let us be good; if we can't shine as great lights,
+ let us make our light shine as God has made it to shine. Let us
+ live lives as in the presence of Christ, anxious for His approval,
+ and glad to take the condemnation of the world, and of Christ's
+ professed servants even, if we get the commendation of angels and
+ our Master. The "well done!" is to the faithful servant--to the
+ _faithful_, not the great. Let us watch and pray that we may be
+ faithful. It is a little hard to be this, and to care little for
+ man.
+
+ 'Yesterday afternoon I preached here at home, and took the most
+ earnest sermon I had, "_Behold, I stand at the door and knock_."
+ Well, in doing so, I thought I was acting quite independently of
+ man; and even after I had preached it, thought I would not care for
+ man. But one man praised it, and I felt pleased, and, as might then
+ be expected, felt a little hurt when a friend called this morning
+ and told me that what I gave them yesterday was _no sermon at all_.
+ Now, if I had been regarding Christ alone, I would not have been
+ moved by either the one or the other of these criticisms; and I
+ wish that I could get above this sort of thing, and get beyond the
+ attempt at pleasing men at all. Why should we confer with men?'
+
+James Gilmour was ordained as a missionary to Mongolia in Augustine
+Chapel, Edinburgh, on February 10, 1870, and, in accordance with
+Nonconformist custom, he made a statement about the development of his
+religious life from which we take the following extract:--
+
+ 'My conversion took place after I had begun to attend the Arts
+ course in the University of Glasgow. I had gone to college with no
+ definite aim as to preparing for a profession; an opportunity was
+ offered me of attending classes, and I embraced it gladly,
+ confident that whatever training or knowledge I might there acquire
+ would prove serviceable to me afterwards in some way or other.
+
+ 'After I became satisfied that I had found the "way of life," I
+ decided to tell others of that way, and felt that I lay under
+ responsibility to do what I could to extend Christ's kingdom. Among
+ other plans of usefulness that suggested themselves to me was that
+ of entering the ministry. But, in my opinion, there were two things
+ that everyone who sought the office of the ministry should have,
+ viz., an experimental knowledge of the truth which it is the work
+ of the minister to preach, and a good education to help him to do
+ it; the former I believed I had, the latter I hoped to obtain. So I
+ quietly pursued the college course till I entered on the last
+ session, when, after prayerful consideration and mature
+ deliberation, I thought it my duty to offer myself as a candidate
+ for the ministry.
+
+ 'Having decided as to the capacity in which I should labour in
+ Christ's kingdom, the next thing which occupied my serious
+ attention was the _locality_ where I should labour. Occasionally
+ before I had thought of the relative claims of the home and foreign
+ fields, but during the summer, session in Edinburgh I thought the
+ matter out, and decided for the mission field; even on the low
+ ground of common sense I seemed to be called to be a missionary. Is
+ the kingdom a harvest field? Then I thought it reasonable that I
+ should seek to work where the work was most abundant and the
+ workers fewest. Labourers say they are overtaxed at home; what then
+ must be the case abroad, where there are wide stretching plains
+ already white to harvest, with scarcely here and there a solitary
+ reaper? To me the soul of an Indian seemed as precious as the soul
+ of an Englishman, and the Gospel as much for the Chinese as for the
+ European; and as the band of missionaries was few compared with the
+ company of home ministers, it seemed to me clearly to be my duty to
+ go abroad.
+
+ 'But I go out as a missionary not that I may follow the dictates of
+ common sense, but that I may obey that command of Christ, "_Go into
+ all the world and preach_." He who said "_preach_," said also, "Go
+ ye into and _preach_," and what Christ hath joined together let not
+ man put asunder.
+
+ 'This command seems to me to be strictly a missionary injunction,
+ and, as far as I can see, those to whom it was first delivered
+ regarded it in that light, so that, apart altogether from choice
+ and other lower reasons, my going forth is a matter of obedience to
+ a plain command; and in place of seeking to assign a reason for
+ going abroad, I would prefer to say that I have failed to discover
+ any reason why I should stay at home.'
+
+On February 22, 1870, James Gilmour embarked at Liverpool upon the
+steamship Diomed, and thus fairly started on the work of his life. Among
+his extant correspondence is a long letter which describes the voyage to
+China, and the way in which he utilised the opportunities it afforded
+for trying to do his Master's will.
+
+ 'We sailed from Liverpool, and my father saw me off. The passengers
+ were few--nine or ten. We had a cabin each. There was a Wesleyan
+ medical missionary named Hardey going out to Hankow. We soon drew
+ together. The doctor of the ship was a young fellow from Greenock,
+ and had been at Glasgow College when I was there last. Among the
+ 1,200 we had not stumbled upon each other. The married man was
+ something or other in the Consular service. A young lady passenger
+ was the daughter of a judge in China. A young man was going out to
+ try his fortune in China: his qualifications were some knowledge of
+ tea and a love of drink. Another decent young fellow was going out
+ to China as a tea-taster. Another young fellow was going out to
+ Australia _vi‚_ Singapore. Thus, you see, I was the only parson on
+ board; and as the ship's company was High Church, and I a
+ Dissenter, it may be seen that we did not fit each other exactly.
+ Some of the passengers were so High Church that one of them told me
+ he thought we Dissenters were sunk more deeply in error than the
+ Papists.
+
+ 'The captain was a sensible kind of rough seaman, and I at once
+ volunteered my services as chaplain, and was accepted, though with
+ some caution. He evidently thought me too young to be trusted with
+ a sermon; the Church of England prayers I might read, and he put
+ into my hands a book with a sermon for any Sunday and holy-day in
+ the year. I took the book and said I would look through it. The Bay
+ of Biscay was calm when we crossed it, but on Sunday morning we
+ were tumbling about off the Rock of Lisbon. As I could hardly keep
+ my legs, I did not think we should have had service; but we crowded
+ into the smoking-saloon (we were afraid to venture below, for
+ sickness), and I read prayers. Next Sunday I read a sermon from the
+ book. All the Sundays after that I gave them my own, and, as I was
+ under the impression that they had not heard much plain preaching,
+ did my best to let them hear the gospel pure and simple. I half
+ suspected they did not quite like it. It was hinted to me that they
+ complained of my preaching. The next Sunday came, and, under the
+ impression it might be the last time I would have the opportunity,
+ I made the most earnest and direct appeal to them I possibly could.
+ I was not a little thankful and astonished when, soon after, in
+ place of being asked to shut up, I was thanked for it, and assured
+ it was the best I had given them, and told that it was a waste of,
+ &c., &c., for me to go out as a missionary--I should have stopped
+ at home. After that I had no trouble with the passengers, and we
+ got on well together.
+
+ 'As for the men, from captain to cabin-boy there were about sixty.
+ Among these was one earnest Christian man, a German and a Baptist.
+ He was a quarter-master. He was a little peculiar in appearance,
+ and spoke English not quite smoothly. On one occasion, when some of
+ the passengers were laughing at something he had done and said, the
+ captain happened to pass, and, seeing what was up, remarked that
+ the man was a first-rate fellow--he never caught him idle. If you
+ except this man, the captain, and the boy, the whole ship's
+ company swore like troopers. So universal was the vice that the
+ men, I almost think, were hardly aware that they did swear. I was
+ puzzled. Sometimes when I went out in the morning I would hear a
+ volley of oaths coming from the mouth of a man who had been talking
+ quite seriously with me over-night.
+
+ Few of the men came to the service, and as they would not come to
+ us we went to them. Hardey and I, usually in the evenings,
+ conducted short little services in the forecastle as often as we
+ thought desirable. We were always well received and listened to
+ respectfully. I think I may say safely that all on board had
+ repeated opportunities of hearing the gospel as plainly as I could
+ put it, and a good many had something more than mere opportunities.
+ After it was dark I used to go out and get the men one by one, as
+ they sat in corners during their watch in the night. All they had
+ to do was to be within call when wanted, and many a good long talk
+ I have had with a good many of them. Of course, my object in
+ accosting them was religious conversation, and this I usually
+ succeeded in having; but on many occasions, that we might be quite
+ on a footing of equality, I had in return to listen to their yarns.
+ The man on the look-out was a frequent victim. I was always sure to
+ find a man there, generally alone, and never asleep. The man, also,
+ was changed at regular intervals, so that I knew exactly when I
+ would find a fresh man. When I talked to the look-out man, I used
+ to keep a sharp lookout myself, lest by distracting his attention I
+ should get him into trouble. Many a good hour have I stood at the
+ prow as we passed through the warm Indian Ocean, till my clothes
+ were wet with the dew of night; and then I would find my way down
+ to my cabin about midnight, with my head so full of the
+ ghost-stories I had just heard that I was really afraid I might
+ meet a real ghost coming out of my cabin.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+BEGINNING WORK
+
+
+In 1817 two missionaries, the Rev. E. Stallybrass and the Rev. W. Swan,
+left England to begin Christian work among the Buriats, a Mongolian
+tribe living under Russian authority. At Selenginsk and at Onagen Dome
+they laboured for many years; but in 1841 the Russian Emperor ordered
+them to leave the country. From the command of the autocrat there was no
+appeal, and the mission came to an end. But in the good providence of
+God the two missionaries had translated the whole Bible into Buriat; the
+Old Testament being printed in Siberia in 1840, the New Testament in
+London in 1846. Notwithstanding the suppression of the mission, the Word
+of God in the Mongol tongue continued to circulate among the people.
+
+It was to the reopening and development of this missionary work among
+the Mongol tribes that James Gilmour consecrated his life. He was
+appointed, in the first instance, to the London Mission at Peking, and
+that centre formed his first base of operations. He continued also a
+member of that mission until the close of his life. He reached the
+Chinese capital on May 18, 1870. At once he settled down to hard and
+continuous work at the Chinese language, endeavouring also from the
+first to discover the best means of restarting the Mongol Mission. The
+very full diary which he kept lies before us as we write, and enables us
+to understand the varying progress and hindrance, encouragement and
+despondency of this time.
+
+ '_June 11, 1870._--Mr. Gulick advises me to pay little attention to
+ the Chinese and go in hot and strong for the Mongolian. I am not
+ quite sure that he is not right, after all. However, I mean to
+ stick into the Chinese yet for a time to come with my teacher and
+ to mix among the people as much as I can. I went out to-night and
+ with the gate-keeper and two of his companions had a lot of talk,
+ in which I learned a good lot. I hope to benefit largely by this
+ pleasant mode of study. Perhaps by this means I may be able to do
+ them good. Lord grant it!'
+
+ '_June 12, 1870._--I am to-day twenty-seven years of age, and what
+ have I done? Let the time that is past suffice to have wrought the
+ will of the flesh. The prospect I have before me now is the most
+ inspiriting one any man can have. Health, strength, as much
+ conscious ability as makes one hope to be able to get the language
+ of the people to whom I am sent, a new field of work among men who
+ are decidedly religious and simple-minded, left pretty much to my
+ own ideas as to what is best to be done in the attempted
+ evangelization of Mongolia, friends left in Britain behind me
+ praying for me, comfort and peace here in the prosecution of my
+ present studies, the idea that what I do is for eternity, and that
+ this life is but the short prelude to an eternal state, the thought
+ that after death there shall break on my view a thousand truths
+ that now I long in vain to know--these thoughts and many others
+ make my present life happy, and in a manner careless as to what
+ should come. In time may I be able to do my part as I ought, and
+ may God have great mercy upon me!'
+
+On June 22, 1870, the news of the Tientsin massacre reached Peking. A
+Roman Catholic convent had been destroyed and thirteen French people
+killed. Very great uncertainty prevailed as to whether this indicated a
+further purpose of attacking all missions and all foreigners, and for a
+while things looked very dark. It was a time in which the nerve and
+courage and faith of men were severely tried, and splendidly did Gilmour
+endure the test. While unable to escape wholly from the fears common to
+all, his reply to the counsels of worldly prudence and selfish dread was
+advance in his work. When others were wondering whether they might not
+have to retreat, he, alone, in almost total ignorance of the language,
+entirely unfamiliar with the country, went up to the great Mongolian
+plain, and entered upon the service so close to his heart--personal
+intercourse with and effort for the Mongols.
+
+How trying a season this was his diary reveals. Under date of June 23,
+1870, the day after the first tidings of the outbreak had been received,
+he writes:--
+
+ 'The Roman Catholic missionaries have suffered severely, and the
+ Protestant missionaries are not in a very safe condition. We are
+ living on the slope of a volcano that may put forth its slumbering
+ rage at any moment. For example, people ask why there is no rain,
+ and blame the foreigners for it; and should a famine ensue, we may
+ fare hard for it. Now is the time for trying what stuff a man's
+ religion is made of. We may be all dead men directly; are we afraid
+ to die? Our death might further the cause of Christ more than our
+ life could do. We must die some time or other; now that we have a
+ near view of its possibility, how can we look forward to it? God!
+ do Thou make my faith firm and bright, so that death may seem
+ small and not to be feared. Help me to trust Thee and Christ
+ implicitly, so that with calm mind I may work while Thou dost let
+ me live, and when Thou dost call me home, let me come gladly.'
+
+The further entries in his Diary at this time depict his inner
+experience from day to day:--
+
+ '_July 10._--Rose 6.20. Dull morning, rained a little. Felt
+ uncomfortable at the idea of being killed; felt troubled at the
+ idea of leaving Peking. How am I to pack and carry my goods? Felt
+ troubled at remaining in the midst of a troubled city, with a
+ government weak and stupid. How is my mission to get on beginning
+ thus? O God, let me cast all my care upon Thee, and commit my soul
+ also to Thy safe keeping. Keep me, O God, in perfect peace! Rain
+ made a thin meeting this morning, but all was quiet. In afternoon
+ went with Mr. Edkins to the west; things uncommonly quiet and
+ peaceful.
+
+ '_July 12._--While others are writing to papers and trying to stir
+ up the feelings of the people, so that they may take action in the
+ matter, perhaps I may be able to do some good moving Heaven. My
+ creed leads me to think that prayer is efficacious, and surely a
+ day's asking God to overrule all these events for good is not lost.
+ Still, there is a great feeling that when a man is praying he is
+ doing nothing, and this feeling, I am sure, makes us give undue
+ importance to work, sometimes even to the hurrying over or even to
+ the neglect of prayer.
+
+ '_July 22._--A good deal troubled about the present state of
+ matters. I don't exactly know how to estimate rumours and reports,
+ and this may cause me more uneasiness than there is any need for.
+ Still, I don't know. At times I feel a great revulsion from being
+ killed, at other times I feel as if I could be killed quietly, and
+ not dislike the thing much. Sometimes the tone of those about us is
+ hopeful, and that causes hope also. Sometimes the prospect of a
+ speedy removal, a half flight, comes upon me with great force, and
+ to see all its annoyance, not to speak of the danger, is not
+ pleasant at all. Oh for the simple, childlike faith that can trust
+ all things to God and leave all care upon Him! Ought we not to have
+ it? Is God not the same God now that He was when He delivered His
+ people from Egypt, and His saints from the hands of their enemies,
+ from the mouth of the lions, and the fiery furnace? Cannot God keep
+ us yet--will He not do it? But then comes the thought, perhaps God
+ does not wish us to live, but to die. Often has He allowed His
+ saints to be slain. What then? Well, as the men in the furnace said
+ of God, "Will He care to defend us? if not, be it known unto you we
+ will not yield." I might have died in childhood, in youth, before
+ conversion, and if then, alas! alas! I can remember the time when
+ the pains of hell got such a terrible hold upon me that I would
+ have gladly changed places in the world with anyone who had the
+ hope of salvation. Death, life, prospects, honour, shame, seemed
+ nothing compared with this hope of salvation, which I was then
+ without. "Could I ever be saved?" was the question; "would I ever
+ have the hope that I knew others had?" Had I died in darkness--God
+ be thanked, the light has shined forth, and I have the hope of
+ eternal life. May God make me more Christlike, and give me stronger
+ hope! Well, then, this hope I have; from this fearful pit I have
+ been delivered; in the light I now walk. God I call my Father,
+ Christ my Saviour, heaven my home, earth and the life here the
+ entrance to real life. If there is anything in our faith or in our
+ belief, then heaven is as much better than earth as it is higher
+ than earth, and our souls life is insured from all harm. If a man
+ is insured against all possible harm, why should he be afraid? Not
+ one hair of our head shall perish! O Lord, help me to live this
+ faith and to be in this frame of mind. In this city are many
+ foreigners, who came here to learn the language, &c., and many of
+ them have no great hope of heaven. They seem calm enough, and are
+ no doubt calm enough; shall the courage of the world, shall the
+ courage of scepticism, shall the courage of carelessness be greater
+ and produce better fruit than the courage of the Christian? O Lord,
+ preserve me from the sin of dishonouring Thy name through fear and
+ cowardice! Let us be bold in the Lord!'
+
+By the end of July 1870, Gilmour had reached a fixed resolution to go to
+Mongolia as soon as the necessary arrangements could be made. A severe
+test had been applied to him, and the way in which he met it gives the
+key to the whole of his after life. He used the trial as a help onwards
+in the path of duty, and the chain of events which would have led many
+men to postpone indefinitely the beginning of a new and hard work only
+drove him the more eagerly into new fields. The reasons that influenced
+him are set forth in his official report written many months later.
+
+ 'After the massacre at Tientsin, very grave fears prevailed at
+ Peking; no one could tell how far the ramifications of the plot
+ might extend, and it was impossible to sift the matter. The people
+ openly talked of an extermination, and claimed to have the tacit
+ favour of the Government in this; nay more, the Government itself
+ issued ambiguous, if not insinuating, proclamations, which fomented
+ the excitement of the populace to such an extent that the days were
+ fixed for the "Clearing of Peking." The mob was thoroughly quieted
+ on the first of the days fixed by a twenty hours' pour of
+ tremendous rain, which converted Peking into a muddy, boatless
+ Venice, and kept the people safely at home in their helpless felt
+ shoes, as securely as if their feet had been put into the stocks.
+ This was Friday. Tuesday was the reserve day; Saturday and Sabbath
+ one felt the tide of excitement rising, and on Monday morning the
+ Peking Gazette came out with an Imperial edict that at once allayed
+ the excitement, and assured us that there was no danger for the
+ present.
+
+ 'We had then to draw breath and look about us calmly, and the
+ general conclusion that the "Old Pekingers" came to was that the
+ French would be compelled to resort to force of arms to gain
+ redress. The attitude of the Chinese people and Government made
+ them think so, and so they determined to wait on quietly in Peking
+ till things should get thick, and then it would be time to go
+ south. I think I may safely say that everyone drew out an inventory
+ of his things, and not a few had their most necessary things packed
+ "on the sly," and were ready to start on short notice.
+
+ 'Up to this point I stood quietly aside; but now was my time to
+ reason, and on the data they supplied I reasoned thus: "If I go
+ south, no Mongol can be prevailed on to go with me, and so I am
+ shut out from my work, and that for an indefinite time. If I can
+ get away north, then I can go on with the language, and perhaps
+ come down after the smoke clears away, knowing Mongolian, and
+ having lost no time." I felt a great aversion to travelling so far
+ alone, and with such imperfect knowledge of the language, but as I
+ thought it over from day to day I was more and more convinced that
+ to run the risk of having to go south would be to prove unfaithful
+ to duty, and so I conferred no longer with likings or dislikings,
+ resolved to go should an opportunity offer, and in the meantime
+ worked away at Chinese.
+
+ 'By-and-by a Russian merchant turned up; he was going to Kiachta,
+ so I started with him. I could not go sooner, as it was not safe to
+ travel in the country before the Imperial edict was issued; to wait
+ longer was to run the risk of not going at all.'
+
+
+[Illustration: MAP ILLUSTRATING JAMES GILMOUR'S JOURNEYS ON THE GREAT
+PLAIN OF MONGOLIA]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+MONGOLIAN APPRENTICESHIP
+
+
+The name Mongolia denotes a vast and almost unknown territory situated
+between China Proper and Siberia, constituting the largest dependency of
+the Chinese Empire. It stretches from the Sea of Japan on the east to
+Turkestan on the west, a distance of nearly 3,000 miles; and from the
+southern boundary of Asiatic Russia to the Great Wall of China, a
+distance of about 900 miles. It consists of high tablelands, lifted up
+considerably above the level of Northern China, and is approached only
+through rugged mountain passes. The central portion of this enormous
+area is called the Desert of Gobi.
+
+A kind of highway for the considerable commercial traffic between China
+and Russia runs through the eastern central part of Mongolia, leaving
+China at the frontier town of Kalgan, and touching Russia at the
+frontier town of Kiachta. Along this route during all but the winter
+months, caravans of camel-carts and ox-carts attended by companies of
+Mongols and Chinese are constantly passing. The staple export from China
+is tea; the chief imports are salt, soda, hides, and timber.
+
+The west and the centre of Mongolia is occupied by nomad Mongols. They
+have clusters of huts and tents in fixed locations which form their
+winter dwellings. But in summer they journey over the great plains in
+search of the best pasturage for their flocks and herds. They are
+consequently exceedingly difficult to reach by any other method than
+that of sharing their roving tent life. In the southeastern district of
+Mongolia there are large numbers of agricultural Mongols who speak both
+Chinese and Mongolian. The towns in this part are almost wholly
+inhabited by Chinese.
+
+The winter in Mongolia is both long and severe; in the summer the heat
+is often very oppressive, and the great Plain is subject to severe
+storms of dust, rain and wind.
+
+Buddhism is all-powerful, and the larger half of the male population are
+lamas or Buddhist priests. 'Meet a Mongol on the road, and the
+probability is that he is saying his prayers and counting his beads as
+he rides along. Ask him where he is going, and on what errand, as the
+custom is, and likely he will tell you he is going to some shrine to
+worship. Follow him to the temple, and there you will find him one of a
+company with dust-marked forehead, moving lips, and the never absent
+beads, going the rounds of the sacred place, prostrating himself at
+every shrine, bowing before every idol, and striking pious attitudes at
+every new object of reverence that meets his eye. Go to Mongolia itself,
+and probably one of the first great sights that meet your eye will be a
+temple of imposing grandeur, resplendent from afar in colours and gold.'
+
+'The Mongol's religion marks out for him certain seemingly indifferent
+actions as good or bad, meritorious or sinful. There is scarcely one
+single step in life, however insignificant, which he can take without
+first consulting his religion through his priest. Not only does his
+religion insist on moulding his soul, and colouring his whole spiritual
+existence, but it determines for him the colour and cut of his coat. It
+would be difficult to find another instance in which any religion has
+grasped a country so universally and completely as Buddhism has
+Mongolia.'[1]
+
+[1] _Among the Mongols_, p. 211.
+
+It was to the herculean task of attempting single-handed to evangelise a
+region and a people like this that James Gilmour addressed himself. His
+early journeys are fully set forth in _Among the Mongols_, and we do not
+propose to repeat them here. Our object rather is to depict, so far as
+possible, the inner life of James Gilmour, and the real nature of the
+work he accomplished. He left Peking on August 5, and reached Kalgan
+four days later. On August 27 he started for his first trip across the
+great plain of Mongolia to Kiachta. A Russian postmaster was to be his
+companion, but, to avoid travelling on Sunday, Gilmour started a day
+ahead, and then waited for the Russian to come up. Here is his first
+view of scenes he was so often in later life to visit.
+
+ '_Sabbath, August 28._--Awoke about 5 A.M. just as it was drawing
+ towards light, and saw that we were right out into the Plain.
+
+ 'I am writing up my diary, with a lot of people looking into my
+ cart. I have just given them a Mongol Catechism, and I hope it may
+ do them good. God, do Thou bless it to them! Would I could speak to
+ them, but I cannot. I am glad to be saved the trouble of travelling
+ to-day. My mind feels at rest for the present. I am looking about
+ me, and having my first look at the life I am likely to lead.
+ There are several more Mongol dwellings within sight, plenty of
+ camels, horses, and oxen. The Mongols have a tent of their own, and
+ the "commandant's" tent has also been put up. A Mongol has just
+ come up and changed his dress, his cloak serving him as a tent
+ meantime. I am hesitating whether to try to read in my cart or go
+ off a little way with my plaid and umbrella.
+
+ 'Had not a very intellectual or spiritual day after all. Went in
+ the afternoon away to the east. Had a good view and a time of
+ devotion at a cairn from which an eagle rose as I approached.
+ Returned to the camp and bought milk and some cheese. Intended to
+ make porridge, but the fire was not good on account of the blowing,
+ so I drank off my milk, ate some bread, and went to sleep.'
+
+The journey across the desert, including a visit to Urga, occupied a
+month. It was full of intense interest for the traveller, and many of
+the most abiding impressions of his life and work were then received.
+His diary reveals the deep yearnings of his heart for the salvation of
+the Mongols. Under the date September 11, 1870, he writes:--
+
+ 'Astir by daybreak. Camels watering; made porridge and tea. This is
+ the Lord's day; help me, O Lord, to be in the spirit, and to be
+ glad and rejoice in the day which Thou hast made! Several huts in
+ sight. When shall I be able to speak to the people? O Lord, suggest
+ by the Spirit how I should come among them, and guide me in gaining
+ the language, and in preparing myself to teach the life and love of
+ Christ Jesus! Oh, let me live for Christ, and feel day by day the
+ blessedness of a will given up to God, and the happiness of a life
+ which has its every circumstance working for my good!'
+
+ His constant rule was to rest from all journeying, so far as
+ possible, on the Sabbath. After another week's experience, on
+ September 18 he thus records his impressions:--
+
+ 'Encamped just over the plain we saw at sunset last night. We are
+ some distance from the real exit, but not far. This is the Lord's
+ day; God help me to be in the spirit notwithstanding all
+ distractions. Oh that God would give me more of His Spirit, more of
+ His felt Presence, more of the spirit and power of prayer, that I
+ may bring down blessings on this poor people of Mongolia! As I look
+ at them and their huts I ask again and again how am I to go among
+ them; in comfort and in a waggon, with all my things about me; or
+ in poverty, reducing myself to their level? If I go among them
+ rich, they will be continually begging, and perhaps regard me more
+ as a source of gifts than anything else. If I go with nothing but
+ the Gospel, there will be nothing to distract their attention from
+ the unspeakable gift.
+
+ '8.15 A.M.-3.15 P.M. Good long walk. Met camels and came upon a
+ cart encampment, estimated at one hundred and seventy. Know where I
+ am on the map. There is a camel encampment where we are. Two huts
+ from which comes fuel. Read to-day in II Chronicles xvi. God never
+ failed those who trusted in Him and appealed to Him. God was
+ displeased with the King of Judah because, after the deliverance
+ from the Lubims, Ethiopians, &c., he trusted to the arm of flesh to
+ deliver him from the Syrians. Do we not in our day rest too much on
+ the arm of flesh? Cannot the same wonders be done now as of old? Do
+ not the eyes of the Lord run to and fro throughout the whole earth,
+ still to show Himself strong on behalf of those who put their trust
+ in Him? Oh that God would give me more practical faith in Him!
+ Where is now the Lord God of Elijah? He is waiting for Elijah to
+ call on Him. God give me some of Elijah's spirit, and let my power
+ be of God, and my hope from Him for the conversion of this people.
+
+ 'It is nothing to the Lord to save by many or by them that have no
+ power. Help me, O God, for I rest on Thee, and in Thy name I go
+ against this multitude!'
+
+Kiachta, on the southern frontier of Siberia, was reached September 28,
+1870, and there Gilmour was at once plunged into a series of troubles.
+The Russian and Chinese authorities would not recognise his passport,
+and he had to wait months before another could be obtained from Peking.
+He found absolutely no sympathy in his work. He knew next to nothing of
+the Mongol language. Yet with robust faith, with whole-hearted courage,
+with a resolution that nothing could daunt, he set to work. A Scotch
+trader, named Grant, was kind to him, and found accommodation for him at
+his house. At first he tried the orthodox plan of getting a Mongol
+teacher to visit and instruct him. Before he secured one he used to
+visit such Mongols as he found in the neighbourhood, trying to acquire a
+vocabulary from them, asking the names of the articles they were using,
+their actions, and all such other matters as he could make them
+understand. But his loneliness, his ignorance of the language, the
+inaction to which he was condemned, partly by his difficulty in getting
+a suitable teacher, and partly by the uncertainty as to whether the
+authorities would allow him to remain, told upon his eager spirit as
+week after week passed by, and he became subject to fits of severe
+depression. Here is a picture of one of these early days. He had been
+trying to talk with a Buriat carpenter, in a place called Kudara, not
+far from Kiachta:--
+
+ 'After getting my quota of words I walked through the town. The
+ main object in it is the church, a large whitewashed structure
+ built by Mr. Grant's father-in-law when he was a rich man. He was
+ made poor, comparatively speaking, in one night by a great fire
+ which burnt up all before it. In addition to the church are some
+ streets of Cossack houses, desolate enough looking, the streets
+ desolate enough at best, but rendered much more so this morning by
+ the snow melting in the sun, which is still high, and manages to
+ thaw away all the snow that falls in places where it shines, though
+ it was frost all day in the shade. Passing the town I made for the
+ river, which rolled on quiet and cold. Passed through large
+ orchards of apple(?) trees; doubled about, went to the extreme
+ west, got on a hill, and came round home again in time for dinner
+ at 4 P.M. I felt very lonely, and not having a teacher I am thrown
+ idle, as it were, a great part of the day after I get my words. It
+ is true I am taking notice of all I see, but it always occurs to me
+ that this is not furthering the Mongolian Mission in any direct
+ way. I often think of what Dr. Alexander said in his charge at my
+ ordination: "_You do not go to discover new countries._" Would I
+ had a teacher, that the language might go on full swing! To-day I
+ felt a good deal like Elijah in the wilderness, when the reaction
+ came on after his slaughter of the priests of Baal. He prayed that
+ he might die. I wonder if I am telling the truth when I say that I
+ felt drawn towards suicide. I take this opportunity of declaring
+ strongly that on all occasions two missionaries should go together.
+ I was not of this opinion a few weeks ago, but I had no idea how
+ weak an individual I am. My eyes have filled with tears frequently
+ these last few days in spite of myself, and I do not wonder in the
+ least that Grant's brother shot himself. _Oh! the intense
+ loneliness of Christ's life_, not a single one understood Him! He
+ bore it. O Jesus, let me follow in Thy steps, and have in me the
+ same Spirit that Thou hadst!
+
+ 'Read papers in the evening (Oct 5). So Jones of Singrauli is dead!
+ I heard him in Exeter Hall, May, a year or two ago, and heard a
+ good deal of him through Dr. Evans, of Chestnut College. I am
+ persuaded he was a missionary among a thousand. When he returned to
+ his station he found that during his absence matters had got out of
+ order a good deal, and he set about putting them right. Now he is
+ dead! How prodigal God seems of His workers--Hartley, Jones, both A
+ 1, both gone. God's ways are not ours. We would have preserved
+ these two at all risk and expense, but God _takes_ them away, and
+ it seems to us as if He were hurting His own cause. God knows best,
+ but to _us_ it is a great mystery.'
+
+Two days later he received a letter telling him of the death of a
+brilliant young Glasgow student, and he enters in his diary comments
+which received only too complete an illustration in his own subsequent
+career:--
+
+ 'Another splendid student going from college to the grave. This is
+ a thing of common occurrence with reference to Glasgow College,
+ and, if I am not mistaken, I have seen it somewhere publicly
+ commented on. Men, poor it may be, strive through college with a
+ mind and determination beyond their circumstances and bodily
+ strength, fight a great battle with poverty and more clever
+ students, resolute to take the first place if possible, and just as
+ the college is finished with them, and sending them forth to the
+ field of life decorated with all the honours it can bestow, the
+ fond Alma Mater has to keep on mourning and drop her tear over an
+ early grave.
+
+ 'Are the young men to blame? Who can be restrained by the
+ cold-blooded calculation of preserving health? "There is my
+ opponent, I'll thrash him if I can; better to toil out my
+ life-blood drop by drop than let it mount to my cheek as a mantle
+ of shame when I find myself defeated when I might have been
+ victorious." Then they conscientiously work themselves to death. If
+ they did not work as hard as they do, and refrain from recreation
+ as they do, they would have in their breasts the uneasy feeling
+ that they have not done as much as they might have done; and what
+ noble nature can be content to live under that accusation written
+ against them by the supreme court in their own breasts?
+
+ 'Several times I have resolved to refrain for health's sake, but in
+ a short time found such an uneasy feeling about not doing as much
+ as I might, that I had to give it up and go at it. I _never_ feel
+ that I have done as much as I might, and when I am doing most I
+ feel best.'
+
+Very dissatisfied with his progress, and stung one day by a remark of
+Grant's to the effect that he did not seem to speak Mongolian readily,
+Gilmour changed his plans. He resolved to go out upon the Plain, and
+persuade some Mongol to allow him to share his tent. On December 13,
+1870, he left Kiachta and journeyed out into Mongolia to the first
+cluster of tents, named Olau Bourgass. There he found a friendly Mongol.
+'Grant's contractor. Found him at his prayers. He motioned me to sit
+down, and when his devotions were finished he gave me a warm welcome. He
+lives alone in his tent, having nothing to care for but the horses for
+the courier service, and a couple of lamas[2] to attend to his wants,
+one of whom goes with the letters when they come. We talked, and I
+learned a great deal, when at last I broke my mind to him, and was glad
+to find that he received it favourably. I settled to remain there during
+the night. Nothing very remarkable happened except that we were invaded
+by a great blustering lama, intoxicated. He came ramping into the tent
+as if he would have knocked everything down. After a time he went away
+and lodged in the next hut. I went to bed about ten and slept well,
+though my feet were cold towards morning.'
+
+[2] A lama is a priest of the lama section of Buddists. More than half
+the population of Mongolia are lamas.
+
+The next three months were passed mainly in this tent. Gilmour used,
+whenever possible, to return to Kiachta to spend the Sunday at Grant's
+house; but by enduring the hardships and suffering all the
+inconveniences of ordinary Mongol life he rapidly acquired the
+colloquial, and he also made an indelible impression upon the minds and
+hearts of the natives, who ever afterwards spoke of him as 'Our
+Gilmour.' He saw Mongol life as it was, free from all the illusion and
+romance sometimes thrown around it. He became intimately acquainted with
+the various Mongol types, and he began to enter into the native habits
+of thought. His diary contains many a scene like the following:--
+
+ 'I gave the lama a book on Saturday, and when I came back on
+ Tuesday I found he had read it through twice. He set upon me with
+ questions, getting me to admit premises, and then reasoned from
+ them. Christ being at the right hand of God was a great point with
+ him. If God has no form, how can anyone be at His right hand? Then,
+ again, if God is everywhere, Christ is everywhere right and left of
+ God, and how can that be?
+
+ 'The omnipresence was a staggerer. Was God in that pot, in the
+ tent, in his boot? Did he tread upon God? Then was God inside the
+ kettle? Did the hot tea not scald Him? Again, if God was inside the
+ kettle, the kettle was living! And so he held it up to the laughing
+ circle as a new species of animal. I asked him if a fly were inside
+ the kettle, would the kettle be alive? "No," he said; "but a fly
+ does not fill the space as God must do." "Well, then," said I, "is
+ my coat alive because I fill it?" This settled the question.'
+
+In March 1871 he visited Selenginsk and Onagen Dome, the scene of the
+labours of Stallybrass and Swan from 1817 to 1841, and then he took a
+run into Siberia, crossing Lake Baikal and visiting Irkutsk. At the
+latter place he reviews the past few months:--
+
+ 'Another week has passed over my head with many hopes and fears.
+ This day, a week ago, I was nearing Ana in doubt as to many things;
+ now I am in Irkutsk, having my path marked with mercies. In many
+ points of my journey I expected difficulties which might have
+ stopped me short in my path, but all these have disappeared, and I
+ am here, having succeeded beyond expectations. One thing is not
+ right: my readiness to forget the ways in which God has helped me.
+ Sometimes for weeks and months I look forward to some crisis which
+ is coming; it comes off well, and in two days I am as if I had
+ forgotten that to which I had looked forward with so much
+ apprehension. In this manner I am not only guilty of ingratitude,
+ but lose much joy and strength of faith and hope. What should make
+ me more happy than the thought of the helps and deliverances that
+ God has vouchsafed me; and in troubles present and to come, what
+ can give me more faith and courage than to remember that out of
+ such troubles I was delivered before?
+
+ 'One thing I sometimes think of. I left Britain with no intention
+ of travelling; I expected to settle down quietly and confine myself
+ to a circle I could impress. This plan has been completely changed
+ and overruled. Two months have I been in Peking; two weeks have I
+ been in Kalgan; a month have I been in the desert; a month have I
+ been in Kudara, a small Russian frontier military post; a month and
+ a half have I been in Kiachta; two months have I been in Mongolia;
+ and now two weeks have I been travelling in Russia. A year and a
+ month have elapsed since I left home, and during that time I have
+ been walking to and fro on the face of the earth, and going up and
+ down in it. In this way I have not found my life at all dull, but
+ very stirring. Indeed, many people would have left home to travel
+ as I have done. I sought it not; it came, and I took it. So as yet
+ I have no hardships to complain of. To see the places and things I
+ have seen--Liverpool, Wales, Rock of Lisbon, Gibraltar, Malta,
+ Egypt, Port Said, Canal, Suez, Red Sea, Cape Gardafui, Indian
+ Ocean, Penang, Straits of Malacca, Singapore, Hong Kong, Shanghai,
+ Tientsin, Peking, Kalgan, Desert, Urga, Kiachta, Russia, Baikal,
+ Irkutsk--only even to see these, men will make long journeys. I
+ have seen them all without seeking them, with the exception of
+ Baikal and Irkutsk. These are all by the way, and I dwell upon them
+ as proofs that God, in sending His servants from home and kindred,
+ often gives them pleasure and worldly enjoyment on the way, which
+ He does not promise, and which they have no right to expect.'
+
+After another but briefer sojourn at Olau Bourgass he set out on his
+return journey, visited Urga, then crossed the great plain on horseback
+in the course of fourteen days, and reached Kalgan on June 11. After a
+rest there he made two excursions into Mongolia, visiting Lama Miao,
+one of the great Mongol religious centres, in the first; and occupying
+some weeks with a further spell of Mongol tent life during the second.
+
+His diary, under date of September 22, 1871, while he was resting at
+Kalgan, thus sums up his experiences:--
+
+ 'I desire to-day to look back on the way by which the Lord has led
+ me for the last year. In September 1870 I was looking out eagerly,
+ anxiously for someone who was going to Russia, that I might go with
+ him. I could find no one. I made it a subject of prayer, and at
+ last, when I was on my knees, in came McCoy to tell me of a Russian
+ who was going up without delay. I saw the Russian, and arranged to
+ go, and started. "While they are speaking I will answer them."
+
+ 'On the journey between Peking and Kalgan I was alone, I may say,
+ and could speak little Chinese, yet I got on very well; and though
+ my money was in a box on the back of a donkey, yet it came in all
+ safe, none lost. In Kalgan I had difficulty at first about finding
+ camels, but at length the Russian postmaster turned out to be going
+ home. The time when was uncertain, quite; his departure depended on
+ the coming of his successor. I prayed about this, and one day was
+ informed that the successor had arrived much sooner than was
+ expected, and that we were to start in a day or two. We did start,
+ and after a prosperous journey arrived safely at Kiachta.
+
+ 'There I found Grant and Hegemann, two Englishmen. I went to live
+ in Grant's country house at Kudara. A difficulty arose about a
+ teacher. I prayed about this, and strolling along came upon a tent
+ in which was a man who was out of employment, and he being
+ educated, I engaged him to be my teacher. In Kiachta, after some
+ delay, I got a teacher, but not to my satisfaction. After I had
+ been with him a time Grant remarked one day that I did not seem to
+ be making much progress in the language. This stung me to the
+ quick, and made me go down into Mongolia. Here I was directed to
+ the tent of Grant's contractor, and with him I made arrangements to
+ live. I thank God for not permitting me to get a good teacher in
+ Kiachta. Had I got a good teacher there, I would simply have
+ remained there, and I am sure would not have learned half as much
+ of the language as I did in the tent at Mongolia, would have got
+ none of the insight I gained into the style of Mongolian life, and
+ would not have got the introduction I had there to numerous
+ Mongols. At the time I was immensely chagrined that I could not get
+ a proper teacher, but now, after the lapse of only a few months, I
+ can see good reason for thanking God for leading me by that way.
+ This should teach me to trust God more than I do when things seem
+ to thwart my purpose.
+
+ 'Again, I was under a great disappointment about the delay that
+ occurred in the sending of my passport from Peking. In consequence
+ of its not coming I was unable to go to Urga with Lobsung and
+ Sherrub in February. I felt it much at the time, but some months
+ after (in June) I learned that these men with whom I wanted to go
+ suffered excessively on the road; so much so that, had I gone with
+ them, I might have got my feet frozen and died with the cold. Here
+ again I have to praise God for not giving me my own way.
+
+ "Thy way, not mine, O Lord;
+ However dark it be."
+
+ 'Then, again, I had long desired to visit the scene of the former
+ Siberian Mission, and through the mercy of Providence I was
+ permitted to do this. My journey back through the desert also was
+ marked by mercies. Truly I may stand and say,
+
+ "When all Thy mercies, O my God,
+ My rising soul surveys,
+ Transported with the view, I'm lost
+ In wonder, love, and praise."'
+
+
+
+After his wanderings even Kalgan was a haven of rest, and he had secured
+there a base of operations. 'Now,' he writes, 'that I have got my study
+window pasted up, and a nice little stove set going, it seems so
+comfortable that it would be snug to stay where I am. But comfort is not
+the missionary's rule. My object in going into Mongolia at this time is
+to have an opportunity of reviewing and extending my knowledge of the
+colloquial, which has become a little rusty consequent upon its disuse
+to a great extent while here, trying to get up the written.'
+
+All who are even superficially acquainted with Chinese matters know how
+difficult it is to acquire the colloquial, and still more the written
+language. Mongolian is not nearly so difficult, but it presents a task
+needing vigour of intellect and strength of will. Both of these Gilmour
+possessed in a measure far above the average.
+
+'In the written,' he states on October 7, 1871, 'I am still far from at
+home. Most of the Bible I can read slowly and at sight. Many words I can
+write. I think I could write a bad letter myself alone. The other day I
+did so. My teacher said it was well written, and said also he rejoiced
+in the progress of his scholar; but I put this down to mere politeness.'
+
+During this visit he stayed in the tent of a Mongol named Mahabul, who
+lived there with his wife and an only son, a lama. They were all much
+addicted to the use of whisky.
+
+ '_October 14, '71._--To-day rose before the sun, read words, wrote
+ at the account of my journey from Urga, went to the mountain for
+ devotion, revisited the silver worker, who is making the bride's
+ ornaments, dined, visited the Norying's lama son, who fell from a
+ horse and broke his leg, had tea, and went to visit tents a mile or
+ two to the south. There found, as master of the tent, a blackman (a
+ layman) I had seen before, and as visitor a lama I had left in
+ Mahabul's tent when I went out. From one thing to another we got to
+ speak of God and His book. At last they asked me to read them a
+ portion. I read in English a few verses, and then gave them the
+ parable of the Prodigal Son in Mongol colloquial. I also gave them
+ a specimen of a sermon, and explained shortly the nature of God,
+ when they all seemed pleased. The lama finished up the thing by
+ saying, "Your outward appearance differs from us, but inwardly you
+ agree with us." Coming home I felt amply repaid for all the
+ uncomfort and solitude, and leading a Mongol life, by the
+ comparative ease with which I can converse with them, and the
+ manner in which they wonder at my proficiency in the colloquial.'
+
+In his official report he rapidly summarises the achievements of the
+last nine months:--
+
+ 'By the middle of February I had a limited knowledge of the
+ colloquial, picked up from listening to and joining in the
+ conversation going on among the inmates of the tent at Olau
+ Bourgass, and those with the numerous visitors who took occasion to
+ call on my lama, who was rather a famous man. At the end of
+ February the lama returned south to Urga, and I went back into
+ Russia, and got a Buriat teacher. This individual, however, turned
+ out so incredibly lazy, and I felt so dull alone in my large
+ comfortable rooms, after the friendly bustle and crowd of the
+ little tent, with its cheery fire, that I could not stand it. So I
+ got my teacher and myself into a tarantass, and went off to visit
+ the scenes of the former mission in Siberia. My teacher proved very
+ useful. He spoke Russian very well, I spoke Mongolian to him, and
+ thus we travelled, the doubtful wonder of all Russians, who could
+ not understand how a man not born a Buriat could get acquainted
+ with that language, and yet know no Russian. After visiting the
+ converts, partly for the sake of diverting the curious eyes of the
+ Russians from the great aim of my journey and partly in the
+ traveller's spirit, I turned westward and crossed the Baikal on the
+ ice, and remained a few days in the capital of Siberia, Irkutsk. On
+ returning to Kiachta I found another teacher, and went out for
+ another month into Mongolia and tent life. All the while that I was
+ in Mongolia I used to return to Kiachta once a week, usually on
+ Saturday, and abide in the land of habitations till Monday.
+
+ 'Early in May I started for the south. I had intended to remain
+ over the summer in Urga, but unexpected difficulties turned up, and
+ led me to decide on going down to Kalgan at once. From Urga to
+ Kalgan (600 miles) was done on horseback, accompanied by a single
+ Mongol; and as we carried no luggage, we had to depend on the
+ hospitality of the Mongols for lodging and cooking, or, as they
+ call the latter, "pot and ladle."
+
+ 'In this way I saw a very great deal of tent life during the twelve
+ or thirteen days the ride lasted. I got into Kalgan just two days
+ before the rainy season came on (June 15), and having, after
+ difficulty, secured a teacher, passed the summer in Kalgan studying
+ the book language and practising writing. In October I went up
+ again to the grassland and spent some weeks revising my knowledge
+ of the colloquial and observing the difference between the northern
+ and southern manner of speaking. I finally left Mongolia in a
+ furious storm on the morning of November 1, and re-entered Peking
+ November 9.'
+
+Gilmour on his return was naturally an object of great interest to all
+the missionary and to some of the official community. He soon settled
+down to the study of Chinese, and to such mission work as he could
+usefully engage in during the winter at Peking. A letter to the writer,
+under date of January 21, 1872, enables us to realise somewhat the life
+of this period:--
+
+ 'My dear Lovett,--Though I acknowledged receipt of your last
+ welcome epistle, I am aware I owe you a return, and here it is ...
+ I have thought that perhaps an account of how a Sabbath goes in
+ Peking might not be uninteresting, and I'll just confine myself to
+ to-day. Well, this morning, on getting up, I found my stove was
+ out. This is a very unusual thing, but it just happens once, say,
+ in three weeks. The thermometer was about 5∞. The first thing after
+ getting dressed was not to call my servant, as you might suppose,
+ but to go in quest of letters. A mail had come in the night before,
+ but I had returned home too late last night to see it. So I went
+ over to Dr. Dudgeon's house before he was up, prowled about till I
+ found the mail, but there was nothing for me. I returned to my cold
+ room, and was there till the breakfast-bell rang. I board with
+ Edkins, and to go there is a pleasant break in the monotony.
+
+ 'On coming back to my quarters I found the room full of smoke,
+ doors and windows open, my boy on his knees fussing about the
+ stove, and saying, _Moo too poo shing_--"the wood won't do." I saw
+ at once that that would not do for me, so I buttoned up my coat and
+ went out on to the great street for a walk. The street on which we
+ live, the Ha Ta Mun (great street), runs north and south, and a
+ cold wind was blowing down the road, carrying clouds of dust with
+ it. Through the dust, however, were visible the paraphernalia of
+ two funerals, one going north, the other going south. They met just
+ opposite our place. That going south was much the grander of the
+ two, and had a long procession of people carrying emblematical
+ devices, honorific umbrellas, drums, gongs, and musical
+ instruments. Ever and anon a man took quantities of paper discs
+ with square holes cut in the centre and scattered them to the north
+ wind. The papers are supposed to represent cash, and were scrambled
+ for eagerly by the urchins, though they could be valuable only as
+ waste paper. In the procession also was carried the chair in which
+ the deceased used to ride, his mule cart also figured conspicuous,
+ and then came the mourners.
+
+ 'As you know, mourning garb in China is _white_, and I noticed that
+ some of the mourners had adopted a neat device. All Chinamen who
+ can afford to be warm in winter wear robes lined inside with fur. A
+ rich robe is lined with fine material, but the common thing is
+ white lambskin. Well, these fellows simply become turn-coats for
+ the time, and put on their fur robes inside out, and thus were in
+ the fashion. The coffin itself was laid in a magnificent bier
+ towering high, surmounted by a gilt top piece, hung with silks, and
+ borne by forty-eight bearers.
+
+ 'Of course everything has to make way for the funeral. The Peking
+ streets are very wide, and at the same time very narrow. In the
+ centre and high up is a cart road with an up and a down line, along
+ the sides of this are ditches and holes, beyond these ditches and
+ holes is another way more or less passable, and beyond that again
+ the shops. The funeral procession took the crown of the road, crept
+ along at its snail's pace, while the traffic took to the side
+ roads.
+
+ 'After a good long walk among stalls and wheelbarrows I got back to
+ my abode, found a good fire, and that it was high time to go to the
+ Chinese service. I don't understand all I hear, but I understand
+ some, and make a point of hearing one and sometimes two Chinese
+ sermons on the Sabbath. An old Chinaman was preaching, and I could
+ see from the manner of the congregation that he was securing the
+ fixed attention of his hearers. Before the sermon was ended there
+ was a bustle at the door, and in came three Mongols with my Chinese
+ card. They were asked to wait till the service was concluded, then
+ I took them to my quarters and had some conversation with them. One
+ of them had come for the doctor, and wished to get cured of so
+ prosaic a disease as the itch.
+
+ 'Before I was finished with them, my servant came to say that
+ another Mongol had called for me and was waiting for me in
+ Edkins's. When I went over I found an old Mongol, a blackman,
+ fifty-eight years of age. This layman was named Am‰sa, and has been
+ in the habit of paying Mr. Edkins visits every winter when he comes
+ down to Peking. Last year he did not come, and we were concluding
+ that he had died. Of course we were glad to see him. I got him into
+ my room and we had quite an afternoon of it. The old man knew a
+ good deal about Christianity, and I gave him what additional
+ instruction I could. Of all the Mongols I have seen he is, perhaps,
+ the most ready to receive instruction.
+
+ 'It was quite late in the afternoon before he left, and I had just
+ time to take a walk at sunset and be back in time for dinner.
+ Immediately after that the people began to assemble for evening
+ service. This is held every Sabbath evening in Mr. Edkins's
+ parlour. Upwards of twenty usually compose the congregation. The
+ missionaries take the service in turn. After service the mass of
+ the congregation separated, but one man came with me to my room,
+ and there we sat talking till midnight, when my visitor rose to
+ depart.
+
+ 'There, you see, I have given you the history of one Sabbath in
+ Peking. It is a pretty fair sample of what goes on here very
+ frequently. However, when I find myself free on the afternoon I
+ accompany Mr. Edkins to some one of the two chapels, which are in
+ distant parts of the city. I do not go so much to hear him preach
+ as to have his conversation on the way there and back, and, as you
+ may suppose, we sometimes stumble upon an argument, and this makes
+ it quite lively.'
+
+The self-denying and arduous labours of his first sojourn in Mongolia
+had given to James Gilmour a knowledge of the language and an
+acquaintance with the nomadic Mongols of the Plain far in excess of that
+possessed by any other European. But even then, as also at a later date,
+the question was raised whether more fruitful work might not be done
+among the agricultural Mongols inhabiting the country to the north-east
+of Peking. Hence, on April 16, 1872, he started on his first journey
+through the district in which in later years the closing labours of his
+life were to be accomplished. He spent thirty-seven days in this
+preliminary tour, and travelled about 1,000 miles.
+
+Gilmour's first estimate of this region as a field of missionary
+enterprise, expressed on April 25, 1872, remained true to the end, even
+though in later years the exceptional difficulties of work among the
+nomads induced him at last, as we shall see, to settle among the
+agricultural Mongols:--
+
+ 'Though I saw a good many Mongol houses, yet I must say, I do not
+ feel much drawn to them in preference to the nomad Mongols. The
+ only possible recommendation I can think of is that, coming among
+ them, I might go and put up for some days at a time in a Chinese
+ inn. This would save me from great trouble in getting
+ introductions, and it might be less expensive. The great objection
+ I have to them is that, though a mission were established among
+ them, it would be more a mission in China than anywhere else. The
+ Mongols in these agricultural villages speak Chinese to a man, and
+ I cannot help feeling that, since there are so many missionaries in
+ Peking speaking the Chinese language, these Mongols fall to them,
+ and not to me.'
+
+Soon after his return from this trip into Eastern Mongolia, Mr. Gilmour
+sent home an elaborate report upon the conditions and prospects of the
+Mongol Mission. He deals with the whole question of the work, showing
+why, in his opinion, the _agricultural_ Mongols should be evangelised by
+Chinese missionaries. Mr. Edkins and others thought that Gilmour should
+undertake that labour, but after having seen more than any missionary of
+both regions and classes of Mongols, on the ground that he was the man
+'who had to go and begin,' he decided for the Plain.
+
+Even at this early date Mr. Gilmour urged repeatedly and strenuously
+upon the Directors the pressing need he felt for a colleague. And thus
+early began the long series of seeming fatalities that prevented him
+from ever receiving this joy and strength. Partly from the needs of the
+Peking Mission, and partly from respect to a notion which the American
+Board of Foreign Missions had that their occupancy of Kalgan, on the
+extreme southern limit, constituted _all_ Mongolia into one of their
+fields of work, the Rev. S. E. Meech, Mr. Gilmour's old college friend,
+who had been designated as his first colleague, was stationed at Peking.
+With reference to this, in closing the report above referred to, Gilmour
+wrote:--
+
+ 'Mr. Meech's perversion from Mongolia to China is much to be
+ deplored. I think it would be wrong in me not to inform you of the
+ true state of matters, and to remind you that it is little short of
+ nonsense to speak of reopening the Mongolian Mission so long as
+ there is only one man in the field. I am fully aware of the
+ difficulty of finding suitable men, and most fully sympathise with
+ you, but don't let us delude ourselves with the idea of Mongol
+ Mission work progressing till another man or two come and put their
+ shoulder to the wheel. All that I can do I am quite willing to do,
+ but my own progress is most seriously hampered because I am alone.'
+
+His whole subsequent life is evidence of the splendid way in which
+Gilmour justified these words, yet perhaps no legitimate blame can be
+laid at the door of the Directors of the London Missionary Society. Both
+the friends and the critics of missions are sometimes more ready to
+tabulate converts than to ponder and estimate aright the difficulties
+and drawbacks of the work. But in any estimate of the comparative
+success and failure of the Mongol Mission it should be borne in mind
+that Gilmour never really had a colleague. He never even had a companion
+for his work on the Plain, except his heroic and devoted wife. And in
+later years circumstances over which the Directors could exercise little
+or no control successively deprived him of the fellowship, after a very
+brief experience, of Dr. Roberts and Dr. Smith.
+
+In the summer of this year, in the company of Mr. Edkins, he visited the
+sacred city of Woo T'ai Shan, a famous place of Mongol pilgrimage.
+
+An amusing illustration of his well-known love of argument occurred on
+this trip. In Mr. Edkins he found a foeman in all respects worthy of
+his dialectic steel. Chinese mules will only travel in single file, even
+where the roads are wide enough to allow of their travelling abreast,
+and as Gilmour's went in front of that ridden by Mr. Edkins, he used to
+ride with his face to the tail of his beast, and thus the more readily
+and continuously conduct the argument then engaging their attention.
+
+In November he tried the experiment of living at the Yellow Temple in
+Peking during the winter, in order that he might meet and converse with
+the numerous Mongols who visit the capital every year. Here he not only
+made new friends, but he also frequently renewed acquaintance with those
+he had met on the Plain. These visited him in his compound, and were
+occasionally a weariness and vexation to him, inasmuch as they very
+frequently severely tried his patience, without affording him the
+comfort of knowing that the good tidings of the 'Jesus book' were
+finding an entrance into their dark minds and hard hearts.
+
+In a letter to an intimate college friend, the Rev. T. T. Matthews of
+Madagascar, which he wrote, November 21, 1872, he vividly describes this
+part of his work, giving some of his typical experiences:--
+
+ 'I am writing in the Yellow Temple, about a mile and a half from
+ Peking, and three or four miles from our mission premises. I have
+ rented a room, brought my Chinaman servant, and live as a Chinaman,
+ all but the clothes and the paganism. The reason of all this is
+ that near here, and in this temple, numerous Mongols put up when
+ they come from Mongolia to Peking. Our premises being three or four
+ miles away, and in a busy part of the town, the Mongols can't
+ easily find our place; so if they can't come to me I just go to
+ them. I came here yesterday, and can't tell yet how I may get on.
+ Mongols are shy in Peking, and even out here a little difficult of
+ access; but I must do what I can, and have patience.
+
+ 'Just now a company of eight or ten have arrived and put up, three
+ or four of them in the same court with me, the others in a place
+ close by. These are likely enough to come to see me; of course I'll
+ go and see them. You in Madagascar, I suppose, can't realise what
+ it is to be a missionary to a people whom you can't approach
+ without difficulty. Here the difficulty does not end; those I can
+ catch don't care one straw for Christianity. They have a system
+ which quite satisfies them, and what more do they want? Such is
+ their feeling, so you see I have got quite plenty to do; a hard
+ enough task, even the human part of it. But don't mistake, I am not
+ bewailing my lot, for that I have neither time nor inclination; I
+ am only telling you about my state.
+
+ 'I don't believe much in people talking about what they mean to do
+ in the future, but perhaps you will permit me to say that I would
+ like to start for Mongolia again in February or March. I have got a
+ sheepskin coat, so need not fear the cold. I perhaps may take with
+ me a stock of made-up medicines for specific diseases which are
+ common, and this may make an introduction in some cases at least.
+ Dr. Dudgeon has on our premises in Peking a hospital well attended
+ by Chinamen, and I go there sometimes and see how he doses them.
+
+ 'Now let me tell you a little about the inner life of Mongols.
+ People travelling through Mongolia wake up in the morning as their
+ camel-cart passes some rural encampment; they rub their eyes and
+ say, "How pleasant it would be to live in Mongolia like these
+ Mongols, free from care and the anxiety of busy life. They have
+ only their sheep, &c., to look after." This reflection is
+ accompanied with a sigh when they reflect on their own hard lot.
+ Now the fact of the matter is, these travellers know nothing about
+ it. They may print as much as they like about the pastoral felicity
+ of the simplicity of Mongol life; it is all humbug. Last night, two
+ Mongols whom I know well, a petty chief named "Myriad Joy" and his
+ scribe named "Mahabul" (I can't translate this last), came into my
+ room, and we had a tea-spree there and then. The two have been for
+ fifteen days in Peking on Government duty, and last night their
+ business was finished, and they were to mount their camels and head
+ north this morning. The chief gets from Peking about 30_l._ a year,
+ the scribe about 4_l._; and when they come thus on duty their
+ allowances, though small, enable them to make a little over and
+ above their salaries. The chief can stand no small amount of
+ Chinese whisky. I suspect he is deep in debt, and am sure that he
+ could pay his debt two or three times over if he only had the money
+ it took to paint his nose. The scribe was one of my teachers in
+ Mongolia. I lived in his house some time, and know only too well
+ about his affairs. He is hopelessly in debt. He had a large family
+ once, but now they are all dead except one married daughter and one
+ lama son about seventeen years of age, and good for nothing. His
+ "old woman," as the Mongol idiom has it, is still alive, and fond
+ of whisky, like her husband. If they had only been teetotalers they
+ might have now been comfortable; such, at least, is my impression.
+ I shall say nothing about what I saw in his tent, and confine
+ myself to last night and this morning.
+
+ 'Drinking my tea last night, Mahabul (the scribe) says to me: "My
+ chief here won't lend me nine shillings to buy a sheepskin coat for
+ my old woman, therefore she must be frozen to death in the winter;
+ my chief won't lend _me_ anything, other people he lends." The
+ chief said nothing for a while; but the scribe went on harping on
+ this string, till at last the chief launched out right and left on
+ his scribe, shouting loud enough for all the compound to hear. The
+ scribe took it coolly, and stopped him, saying: "Enough, enough; it
+ is past, it is past; my old woman can die, all die; no matter."
+ This did not soothe the irate chief at all, and a minute or two
+ later a furious quarrel broke out between them about something
+ else. The storm raged a long time, and in my room too, while they
+ were my guests! After some time the scribe left the room to attend
+ to the camels, when the chief confided to me his opinion of his
+ scribe. Later the chief left the room, and the scribe confided to
+ me his opinion of his chief; and I must say that the two seemed
+ well matched, with very little to choose between. The freedom with
+ which they spoke of each other was partly to be accounted for by
+ the fact that both were more or less drunk.
+
+ 'The chief squared up his accounts with the people about here, and
+ showed me in the scribe's absence a small parcel of silver which he
+ had reserved for use on the road. He showed it me under strict
+ injunctions not to tell the scribe. The scribe had more difficulty
+ in squaring up _his_ account. The last item that stuck in his
+ throat was a little bill his son had left. This son had started a
+ day or two before, and of course the father was responsible for the
+ debt. How he was to pay it he did not know, as he had not a single
+ cash about him. The Chinaman of the place threatened to detain him,
+ and the scribe laughed a bitter laugh at the idea. After a great
+ row they went off to sleep.
+
+ 'This morning early the scribe was at me before I was dressed. It
+ was the small debt again. The Chinaman knew better than to seize
+ the man; that would not have paid; he seized his coat, and actually
+ was detaining that as ransom for a sum equal to fourpence English!
+ He made a direct appeal to me to pay it, and of course I did it;
+ though I was a little disgusted with the man's meanness, as I had
+ given him a present of money amounting to about 1_l._ a few days
+ before. This son of his is a great eyesore to me. He is a young
+ lama, about as wicked a boy as I know. His brothers died of
+ consumption, and this fact enables him to do anything he likes with
+ his parents. If they refuse anything, he has only to feign
+ sickness, and they are in a huge state over him. He is a thoroughly
+ bad lad. Will not work, will not study, will do nothing but make
+ trouble and expense for his parents. Just fancy! His father and
+ mother are poor as church mice; and when his father was coming to
+ Peking the boy must beg to come too, and the father like a fool
+ must take him, and be at great expense for travelling, &c. One
+ thing made me furious. Out of the money I gave him he spent about
+ 4_s._ or more buying his good-for-nothing son an elegant
+ snuff-bottle. In short, the man's folly makes it utterly useless to
+ help him. I once before relieved him from threatened detention for
+ debt for the amount of twopence-halfpenny, just after I had made
+ him a present, and I expect perhaps to have to do so again. What
+ astonishes me is that the Mongols _can_ get into debt so far. I
+ don't believe my Mongol can pass a single man he knows without
+ being in danger of being dunned for some hopeless debt or other.
+ And yet his debt does not seem to distress him. He is most
+ distressed because people will not lend him more money.
+
+ 'The last of the chiefs was rather rich. He is (he says) to have a
+ profitable piece of Government work in hand in spring, and on the
+ strength of that wanted me to lend him now a shoe of silver, about
+ 15_l._, to be repaid to me in spring. Of course I did not. He then,
+ though my guest, kept on saying, "Heart small, heart small," which
+ pretty much amounts to saying, "Coward, coward." He finally took
+ revenge by offering to lend _me_ a shoe of silver in spring, but
+ of course I declined. A pretty pair they are! If what they say be
+ true, in spring they may make a good thing of it; but this has
+ happened to the scribe before, and in two months after he was as
+ poor as ever. In short, they are foolish and thriftless.
+
+ 'While I have been writing this letter I have overheard my Chinese
+ servant saying, in reply to a question from a Chinaman, "There is
+ such a thing as a preaching letter: you can preach by a letter." So
+ I am going now to preach. Don't get weary; stick to it. Don't be
+ lazy, but don't be in a hurry. Slow but sure; stick to it. We have
+ no great effort to make, but rather to stick to it patiently. "_No
+ good work is lost_," Sir William Thomson used to say in his
+ philosophy class, and it is eminently true in our case. (I wish
+ these Chinamen would hold their tongue.) All our good work will be
+ found, there is no doubt about that. All I am afraid of is that our
+ good work will amount to little when it is found. (These Chinamen
+ are a bore.) I sometimes think that if all we say be true, as it
+ is, that men at last shall stand before God--and we shall see them
+ after they know that all we say is true--and they will pitch into
+ us for not pitching into them more savagely; for not, in fact,
+ taking them by the "cuff" of the neck and dragging them into the
+ kingdom of God. I speak now of our countrymen and foreigners. As
+ regards heathen, they too shall stand revealed; and their mud gods
+ also, and rotten superstitions, shall stand revealed: how then
+ shall we feel when they shall look at us and blame us for not
+ waking them up more vigorously? An infidel has said that if he
+ could believe that men's future state depended at all upon what was
+ done in this life, he would let nothing hinder him from being up
+ and at men. He would be content to be counted a madman--anything,
+ if only he could do anything to make men's state better in the
+ world to come. (I wish these Chinamen would shut up; I came here to
+ meet Mongols, and I am like to be flooded out by Chinamen whose
+ language I only half understand.)
+
+ 'Now, _we believe_: how much do we do? Are there not some men whom
+ we might stir up who now escape? Could we do more? Are not souls
+ valuable enough for us to face anything if only we can save some?
+ Let us look to the end, or rather let us look at the present. In
+ the room in which I now write (the Chinamen have gone) is Jesus,
+ where you read this is Jesus: He stands and looks to us. He has
+ given up the clean heaven, and walked here and lived among dirt and
+ poverty, in solitude, misunderstood, without one intelligent
+ friend; He has borne the scorn of men, He has been put to the
+ horrible and shameful death of the cross, _all to save us_ and
+ others. We trust Him, He saves us; and all He asks is that we
+ should tell men about what He has done; and is there one man we
+ meet to whom we shall not speak? shall Christ look to us in vain to
+ declare simply what He has done? Perish the thought! Whatever may
+ be between us and speaking to men, let us go through it. If it be a
+ foreign language, remember Christ lived thirty years in
+ preparation. If it be hardship, cold, poor food, scorn, slight,
+ deaf ears--never mind, go ahead. Christ looks to us to go ahead, or
+ _come_ ahead, for He has gone through it all. Trouble, hardship,
+ trial, suffering,--all will soon pass and be done. And is there a
+ trouble or hardship we have yet surmounted for Christ's sake that
+ does not seem sweet to look back on? Then, come what likes, let us
+ face it; or, if we be overwhelmed, let us be overwhelmed with
+ undaunted faces looking in the right direction. By the mercy of God
+ may we be saved; and if saved how splendid it will be--no trouble,
+ no trial, no indigestible beef and brick-tea: everything _better
+ than_ we could wish it, and complete joy.
+
+ 'All this is not imagination or rhetoric, but _really before_ us;
+ so, by the strength which Christ gives, let us go on to it. Pray
+ for me. I pray for you; and if we don't meet on earth, you know
+ the trysting-place, "_the right-hand side_."'
+
+It can readily be seen that, under conditions of the kind sketched in
+this letter, time was not likely to hang heavily on his hands.
+Interviews like the following were held from time to time, and were not
+only encouraging and hopeful but reacted strongly upon his own heart and
+brain:--
+
+ 'This afternoon (Sabbath, November 24), I met Toobshing Baier in
+ the dispensary of the London Mission Hospital. At first I could not
+ remember the man. The face I knew. After a time his name came out
+ without, I flatter myself, his perceiving that I was fishing for
+ it. He was most anxious to see the doctor's medical instruments and
+ appliances. After he had seen quite a number of these, he came to
+ my room, and we sat down for a talk which lasted nearly from 5 to 7
+ o'clock. He began by reading a part of the rough draft of the new
+ translation of St. Matthew in Mongolian, which happened to be lying
+ on my table. He suggested that in place of "prophet," a word which
+ has been transferred bodily, we should use _juoug beelikty_. He
+ also remarked that our translation of "the foal of an ass" was not
+ the thing, and gave the word he thought was right. He was
+ accompanied by a young lama, who agreed with him in this
+ suggestion. The lama seemed well up, read Mongolian as easily as
+ Toobshing himself, and when Toobshing gave the Thibetan word for
+ _juoug beelikty_, the lama looked over his shoulder, spied a book
+ on a shelf, took it, found the place at once, and showed me the
+ Thibetan and Mongolian side by side.
+
+ 'Shortly after this Toobshing set himself up and proposed questions
+ and cases such as:
+
+ '"Is hell eternal?
+
+ '"Are all the heathen who have not heard the Gospel damned?
+
+ '"If a man lives without sin, is he damned?
+
+ '"If a man disregards Christ, but worships a supreme God in an
+ indefinite way, is he saved or not?
+
+ '"How can Christ save a man?
+
+ '"If a man prays to Christ to save him morn and even, but goes on
+ sinning meantime, how about him?
+
+ '"If a man prays for a thing, does he get it?
+
+ '"Do your unbelieving countrymen in England all go to hell?
+
+ '"Are there prophets now?
+
+ '"Is a new-born child a sinner?
+
+ '"Is one man then punished for another's fault?
+
+ '"Has anybody died, gone to heaven or hell, and come back to
+ report? [A Mongol has!]
+
+ '"Did Buddha live?" and so forth.
+
+ '[Answer, He lived, but did not do what is now said of him.]
+
+ '"If so, how do you know that the account of Christ is not made up
+ in the same way? Could not the disciples conspire to make the
+ Gospels?
+
+ 'To these and all other questions I endeavoured to give proper
+ answers; and this, our most delightful and profitable talk, lasted
+ till there was just time for me to snatch a hasty meal before the
+ usual service at 7.30 P.M.'
+
+Discussions of this nature were calculated to deepen thought and to
+promote heart-searching on the part of the Christian worker. They also
+illustrate some of the special difficulties which missionaries in China
+and India have to meet. With an elaborate religious ritual and
+literature, both Buddhist and Hindu can often, and do often, object
+against Christianity many of those, sometimes obvious, sometimes
+subtle, difficulties which the Gospel of Jesus Christ alone can remove,
+and which it removes by sanctifying and dominating the heart.
+
+In February 1873 Gilmour visited Tientsin for the first time since he
+passed through it on his arrival in China. Here he took part in several
+readings, temperance meetings, and religious services. At one of the
+readings:--
+
+ 'One joke happened. I was asked to give a recitation at a penny
+ reading for sailors. The piece was "The Execution of Montrose." I
+ got up in tragic style, said,
+
+ "Come hither, Evan Cameron,"
+
+ with the appropriate beckoning action, when a sailor in the middle
+ of the audience responded to the call, pressed his way out of the
+ passage, and was making for the platform. I could not stand this,
+ so I uttered a yell, and rushed off to hide myself, and it was some
+ time before the audience and speaker could compose themselves for a
+ fresh start Next day we were told that the unfortunate sailor was
+ beckoned to come hither from all parts of the ship.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+THE FIRST CAMPAIGN IN MONGOLIA
+
+
+In 1873 Gilmour resumed his visits to the Plain and on March 15 he was
+at Kalgan, writing, 'No appearance of getting away to the north. I
+promenade daily the streets and accost Mongols, but with no success as
+to getting camels, or even a horse to hire as far as Mahabul's. A day or
+two later Mahabul arrived in Kalgan on his way to Peking, and by his aid
+Gilmour secured two camels, and on March 24 he started north, reaching
+Mahabul's tent on the 28th. He at once endeavoured to secure the
+services of a Mongol named Lojing, and the usual series of delays and
+vexations occurred.
+
+ 'To-day (March 29) I got impatient and went for a walk. Came back,
+ and Lojing came and said he would go. Felt relieved; he wants me to
+ come back this way, and I consent, though I would rather not. He
+ came back in the afternoon, saying that he could not get off his
+ engagement to read prayers with some other lama for Gichik's
+ soul,[3] so that we cannot start before Thursday at noon. Mahabul's
+ wife gave him some whisky, and he went to the officers and got
+ drunk. He waited for a camel which was offered for sale. The camel
+ came when I was out. He was drunk, did not watch it, so it drifted
+ away before the storm. A boy on horseback was sent after it. When
+ it came it was a perfect object, yet they asked twenty taels for
+ it. He is to go after a camel to-morrow. He was so drunk that,
+ remembering Gichik's fate, I am uneasy to think of his riding my
+ tall camel. O Lord, give me patience!'
+
+[3] The son of the chief referred to on page 80, who had recently been
+killed by a fall from his horse.
+
+This and the three subsequent journeys over the Plain, made in the
+course of 1873, were full of incident illustrative of the difficulties
+of the work, the peculiarities of the people, and the restless energy
+and indomitable perseverance of the missionary. But the limitations of
+space forbid us to linger; we extract a few notes from the diary. It was
+on the second of these journeys, while at Lama Miao, that he witnessed
+the 'Mirth of Hell,' as he calls it, described in _Among the Mongols_,
+Chapter XI.
+
+ '_April 19, 1873._--To-day had more provocation from my Mongol, and
+ my earnest prayer is that I may be able to stand it all, and not
+ get soured in temper and feeling against the Mongols. I must have
+ patience. Some knowledge of camel's flesh also would help me not a
+ little. As it stands, I feel an incompetent "duffer."'
+
+ '_May 6._--Travelled parallel to the road in a stupid manner over
+ hill and dale, because Lojing chose to consider it a nearer way.
+ The way was no nearer at all and much more steep. At last got to a
+ lot of tents down in a hollow, called the "Great Water" (_Ihha
+ Osso_). Had quite a lot of people. One lama the most provoking
+ child (25 years old) I think I ever met. He was a perfect nuisance;
+ even the tone of his voice I could not abide. This individual came
+ to my tent even after I was down in bed. I was glad he was done for
+ once. Next morning he was in my tent before I was up, remarking,
+ "What a great sleeper you are!' Last night he had remarked, "How
+ early you go to bed!" I am afraid he is the most empty, poor fellow
+ I have known.'
+
+ '_May 13._--To-day also occurred another of my lama's conspicuous
+ stupidities; after asking the road to a set of tents where dwelt
+ friends of his own, he suddenly left the road and began the ascent
+ of a steep hill. I asked where he was going. He said to the tents.
+ I followed some distance, and then from the convergence of paths
+ judged that there was no pass where he was going, and accordingly
+ shouted to him to stop. Stop he did, and also looked thunder. I
+ asked him, "Have you travelled this way before?" "No," said he.
+ "Come this way, and follow the road." "You go that road," said he,
+ "I go this road." "Nothing of the kind," said I. "You come here,
+ and we'll get to tents." He came; but then and there began one of
+ his intolerable tirades against me, saying how disobedient I was,
+ and that _this was his own native place_, he knew. What a bad man I
+ was! He had hardly finished his fury when lo, behold, close before
+ us, right in our path, the very tents we were looking for! He is,
+ to use a Mongol idiom, "Stupider than stupid."'
+
+ '_Sept. 12._--We are now in a diphtheria district. I go into it,
+ and hope to remain some time, trusting myself to the hands of God.
+ I am safe enough in His hands. If He can forward mission work more
+ by my death than by my life, His will be done.'
+
+ '_Sept. 18._--To-day let pass me, as all were starting from the
+ temple, about six men and three women without telling them of
+ Jesus.'
+
+At the close of the year Mr. Gilmour sent home another elaborate report,
+a large portion of which appeared in the _Chronicle of the London
+Missionary Society_ for December 1874. We extract here a few paragraphs
+not then printed for obvious reasons. There was still a difficulty with
+the American Board, and there was still in London some inability to
+grasp the exact bearing and the full needs of the situation. The first
+extract is given here simply because it illustrates the noble
+unselfishness of Gilmour's character, and the way in which he
+persistently refused to be stopped by hindrances that would have barred
+the road against most men. He supplied a statement of account showing
+that even with the most rigid economy he had exceeded his allowance by
+110 taels, equivalent to from 25_l._ to 30_l._
+
+ 'This leaves me with a deficit of 110 taels 63 cents, and explains
+ how it is that I ask next year's (1874) grant to be raised to 150
+ taels at least. I had only two courses open to me, either to use up
+ the grants for 1872 and 1873, and stop without accomplishing all I
+ could, or to make full proof of my ministry and exceed the grants.
+ Considering the cause more important than silver, I chose the
+ latter course, and, despite the most rigid economy, exceeded to the
+ above amount. Present circumstances enable me to make up the
+ deficit from my own private purse, and I don't ask to be refunded,
+ but I don't know that I shall be flush of money next year, and _do_
+ ask that the grant may be not less than 150 taels, which is the
+ lowest estimate I can make.
+
+ 'As proof of the reasonableness of my request, and of my anxiety to
+ avoid drawing on the funds of the Society beyond what is absolutely
+ necessary, I may be allowed to state that this year, in addition to
+ making up the lacking 110-63 taels, I walked afoot behind my
+ caravan in the desert for _weeks_, to avoid the expense of
+ purchasing another camel.'
+
+On the question of Christian literature he placed on record some wise
+words, as needful now almost as when he penned them, in order to correct
+the notion that it is enough simply to place into the hands of a heathen
+a copy of the Word of God in his native tongue. The reply of Candace's
+eunuch, 'How can I understand unless someone shall guide me?' meets the
+missionary of to-day, as it met Philip in the days of old. The
+practically unanimous opinion of the Shanghai Conference held in 1890
+shows that the same need is still strongly felt by the missionaries of
+all the societies.
+
+ 'In addition to the Scriptures and the Catechism, I think small
+ simple books containing little portions of Scripture history or
+ little portions of Scripture teaching would be very useful. The
+ Bible is all very well for those who have advanced a little, but
+ there is very little of the narrative portions even--the simplest
+ parts of the whole book--which you can read without encountering
+ terrible names of persons or places, or quotations from the prophet
+ Isaiah or Jeremiah. When a Mongol comes upon these he feels
+ inclined to give up in despair. Even in China my experience has
+ been that people are slow to buy a complete gospel, even at less
+ than the paper on which it is printed costs, while they will buy
+ with avidity very small books at almost their full value.
+
+ 'Chinamen themselves notice this, and when surrounded by a crowd I
+ have heard them remark laughingly, "Small books go quick."
+ Remembering my instructions, which among other things say, "Pause
+ before you translate," I have hitherto refrained, but now have a
+ very small illustrated narrative in the press, another also
+ illustrated in manuscript, and other two not illustrated in
+ contemplation. If I find funds--the Peking branch of the Tract
+ Society is bankrupt just now--and get them out, you shall have
+ specimens. Probably they won't look well, being first attempts, but
+ you need not be ashamed of the Mongol of them, as they have been
+ written under my direction by a "crack" native scholar, and
+ carefully revised by Schereschewsky, who is a general linguist of
+ good ability, and has paid so much attention to Mongolian that he
+ revised the Gospel by Matthew in conjunction with Mr. Edkins, and
+ is at present at work on a Mongol dictionary.'
+
+Medical missions were only in their infancy in 1874, and Gilmour in the
+same report describes what many another has felt. He illustrates also
+one of his fixed principles, viz., always do _something_; and never let
+the work stop simply because you cannot do what is ideally the best.
+
+ 'I know very little about diseases and cures, but the little I _do_
+ know is extremely useful. Almost every Mongol, man and woman and
+ child, has something that wants putting right. To have studied
+ medicine at home would have been a great help, but though I cannot
+ hope now ever to gain a scientific knowledge of the subject, I am
+ glad that in our hospital here I have a good opportunity of
+ learning much from Dr. Dudgeon, and all I can do now is to make the
+ best of this good opportunity. I am told that professional men at
+ home are suspicious of giving a little medical knowledge to young
+ men going out as missionaries. I sided with them till I came here,
+ but here the case is different. At home it is all very well to
+ stand before the fire in your room, within sight of the brass plate
+ on the doctor's door on the opposite side of the street, and talk
+ about the danger of little knowledge; but when you are two weeks'
+ journey from any assistance, and see your fellow-traveller sitting
+ silent and swollen with violent toothache for days together, you
+ fervently wish you had a pair of forceps and the _dangerous_
+ amount of knowledge. And when in remote places you have the choice
+ of burying your servant or stopping his diarrh[oe]a, would you
+ prefer to talk nonsense about professional skill rather than give
+ him a dose of chlorodyne, even though it should be at the risk of
+ administering one drop more or less than a man who writes M.D. to
+ his name would have done?
+
+ 'I speak earnestly and from experience. No one has more detestation
+ than I have for the quack that patters in the presence of trained
+ skill; but from what I have seen and known of mission life, both in
+ myself and others, since coming to North China, I think it is a
+ little less than culpable homicide to deny a little hospital
+ training to men who may have to pass weeks and months of their
+ lives in places where they themselves, or those about them, may
+ sicken and die from curable diseases before the doctor could be
+ summoned, even supposing he could leave his post and come.'
+
+During the summer of 1874 James Gilmour continued his itinerating work
+among the nomads of the Plain. He met with much to discourage him, but
+he steadily enlarged his knowledge of the people and his acquaintance
+with the best methods of work among them. How difficult it was to adapt
+ordinary methods of teaching to their habits may be judged from the
+following sketch:--
+
+ 'My tent is not only my dwelling-house and dispensary, but also my
+ chapel. I always endeavour to instruct the visitors and patients as
+ far as I can. Preaching to Mongols is a little different from
+ preaching at home--a little different from preaching in China even.
+ You can get a congregation of heathen Chinese to listen for, say,
+ twenty minutes, or half an hour, or even longer; but begin to
+ preach to a lot of Mongols, and they begin to talk to each other,
+ or perhaps to ask you questions about your dress and your country.
+
+ 'The nature of their own service is partly to blame for this. When
+ a Mongol sends for a lama or two to read prayers in his tent, the
+ inmates, though present, don't think it necessary to attend much to
+ what is going on. Though they did attend, they would not be able to
+ understand, so talking goes on among them pretty much as usual. If
+ I were to stick myself up and begin, and start off sermonising to
+ them, I would be treated much as they treat their own lamas; so I
+ confine my preaching to conversations and arguments--a style of
+ teaching which I find secures their attention'.
+
+Many, too, are the sketches in his letters and diaries of the men he
+met. They are all drawn with that remarkable and largely unconscious
+power, which he possessed so fully, of being able to see very vividly
+the striking points and details of passing events, and of enabling those
+to whom he wrote, by his aptly chosen words, also to see exactly what
+passed before his eyes. One or two out of many examples must suffice:--
+
+ 'This season (1874) I met a deaf and dumb man. He was uneducated,
+ but of great quickness and intelligence. He could converse easily
+ and readily with his fellow-Mongols by signs, and I could ask many
+ simple questions and understand his answers without trouble. His
+ perception was remarkable. While sitting in the dusk outside my
+ tent, a messenger came from his father's tent to tell him that some
+ of the sheep were missing. A single turn of the hand followed by a
+ glance around, as if searching for something, was all that was
+ required. He had been sitting quietly in the circle, looking at us
+ talking; but the moment the communication was made he uttered an
+ inarticulate sound betraying great excitement, knocked the ashes
+ out of his pipe, stuck it into his boot, threw himself into the
+ saddle, and rode off into the gathering darkness to search for the
+ lost sheep. All agreed that he had an extra share of intelligence,
+ and he was evidently regarded as a capable and useful member of the
+ community.
+
+ 'One of the sad sights seen was that of a sick Chinaman near his
+ end. He was one of a company of four, who went about dressing skins
+ of which the Mongols make garments. He had been an opium taker, and
+ an incurable diarrh[oe]a had seized him. At the time he was lodging
+ with the Mongol for whom the party had come to dress skins; but the
+ Mongol, seeing he would die, and fearing trouble and expense over
+ his death, ordered him off the premises. Borrowing an ox cart, his
+ companions had him conveyed away some five or ten miles, jolted in
+ the rude vehicle and suffering from the blazing sun, to a place
+ where some Chinese acquaintances were digging a well. They had a
+ tent of their own, most likely a poor ragged white cloth affair,
+ open to the winds and pervious to the rain; and in this the poor
+ man hoped he might be permitted to die. It was the dark side of the
+ picture. The glorious summer, the green and flowery plains, the
+ fattening flocks, the herds exulting in the deep pastures, the gay
+ Mongols riding about, the white tents bathed in the sunlight and
+ gleaming from afar. In the midst of all this, a feeble man, far
+ from home and kin, sick unto death, cast forth from his poor
+ lodging, and seeking for a place to lie down and die in. The
+ Mongols are a hospitable race, but pray ye that ye may not get sick
+ on their hands.
+
+ 'On the whole I have been very well received everywhere, and have
+ been treated with great confidence. I have sometimes wondered at
+ the readiness with which they take medicine from the hand of an
+ utter stranger. One reason why they are ready to trust me,
+ doubtless, is that going among them, they can go round my tent and
+ see that there is nothing secret and terrible behind it; they enter
+ it and see all that is in it. They know and see that I am utterly
+ in their power, and, perhaps, reason that I am there with no intent
+ to harm, because if I made trouble I could not move another step
+ without their consent.
+
+ 'In the shape of converts I have seen no result. I have not, as far
+ as I am aware, seen any one who even _wanted_ to be a Christian;
+ but by healing their diseases I have had opportunity to tell many
+ of Jesus, the Great Physician.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+MARRIAGE
+
+
+During the year 1873 James Gilmour devoted much thought to the natural
+and all-important question of marriage. Uncommon as he was, in so many
+ways, it was, perhaps, to be expected that in this great undertaking he
+would depart from ordinary methods. The Rev. S. E. Meech had married, in
+1872, Miss Prankard, of London. After the return of Mr. Edkins to
+England, in May 1873, Mr. Gilmour went to board with Mr. and Mrs. Meech.
+There he saw the portrait of Mrs. Meech's sister, and often heard her
+referred to in conversation. Towards the close of 1873 he took Mrs.
+Meech into his confidence, and asked permission to enter into
+correspondence with her sister. The following most characteristic
+letters show the course of subsequent events:--
+
+
+ 'Peking, January 14, 1874.
+
+ 'My dear Parents,--I have written and proposed to a girl in
+ England. It is true I have never seen her and I know very little
+ about her; but what I do know is good. She is the sister of Mrs.
+ Meech, and is with her mother in London. Her mother supports
+ herself and daughter by keeping a school. One of the hindrances
+ will be perhaps that the mother will not be willing to part with
+ her daughter, as she is, no doubt, the life of the school. I don't
+ know, so I have written and made the offer, and leave them to
+ decide. If she cannot come, then there is no harm done. If she can
+ arrange to come, then my hope is fulfilled. If the young lady says
+ "Yes," she or her friends will no doubt write you, as I have asked
+ them to do.... You may think I am rash in writing to a girl I have
+ never seen. If you say so, I may just say that I have something of
+ the same feeling; but what am I to do? In addition I am very
+ easy-minded over it all, because I have exercised the best of my
+ thoughts on the subject, and put the whole matter into the hands of
+ God, asking Him, if it be best to bring her, if it be not best to
+ keep her away, and He can manage the whole thing well.'
+
+By some mischance this letter was delayed, and Mr. Gilmour's relatives
+were startled, one March day in 1874, by receiving from an entirely
+unknown lady in London a letter, containing the unlooked-for statement:
+'Your son, Mr. Gilmour, of Peking, has asked my daughter to write to
+you, telling you of her decision to join him as his wife. She has wished
+me to write to you for her, and will be pleased to hear from you when
+you feel inclined to write.'
+
+The friendly intercourse that followed soon convinced Mr. Gilmour's
+family, as any knowledge of Emily Prankard herself soon convinced all
+who made her acquaintance, that, however unusual it might appear, this
+was indeed one of the marriages made in heaven. By both parties God's
+blessing and guidance were invoked, upon both His benediction rested,
+and, after a brief separation in this world, they are now both enriched
+with the fuller knowledge and the perfect joy of the life beyond.
+
+No time was lost in the arrangements for Miss Prankard's departures to
+China. In a letter to his mother, dated October 2, 1874, Mr. Gilmour
+writes:--
+
+ 'You have seen Miss Prankard, but you have not told me what you
+ think of her. She was delighted with her visit to Scotland and with
+ you all. You will be glad to hear that I have had some delightful
+ letters from her. I wrote her, and she has written me in the most
+ unrestrained way concerning her spiritual hopes and condition, and
+ though we have never seen each other, yet we know more of each
+ other's inmost life and soul than, I am quite certain, most lovers
+ know of each other even after long personal courtship. It is quite
+ delightful to think that even now we can talk by letter with
+ perfect unreserve, and I tell _you_ this because I know you will be
+ glad to hear it. I knew she was a pious girl, else I would not have
+ asked her to come out to be a missionary's wife, but she turns out
+ better even than I thought, and I am not much afraid as to how we
+ shall get on together.'
+
+In the course of the autumn of 1874 Miss Prankard sailed, and in a
+letter to the writer, December 13, 1874, Gilmour thus refers to the
+close of his unusual but satisfactory courtship:--
+
+ 'I was married last week, Tuesday, December 8!
+
+ 'Mrs. Meech's sister is Mrs. Gilmour. We never saw each other till
+ a week before we were married, and my friends here drew long faces
+ and howled at me for being rash and inconsiderate. What if you
+ don't like each other? How then? It is for life! As if I did not
+ know all this long ago. Well, the time came, the vessel was due at
+ Shanghai, but would not come. Mr. Meech and I went down to Tientsin
+ and waited there a fortnight, but no tidings. At last on the
+ evening of Sabbath, November 29, a steamer's whistle was heard
+ miles away down the river. It was Mr. Meech's turn to preach. After
+ sermon he and I walked away down the river side to see what we
+ could see. After a while a light hove round the last bend, then a
+ green light, then the red light, then came the three lights of the
+ steamer! We listened. It was the high-pressure engine of the steam
+ launch which is used to lighten the deep-sea steamers before coming
+ up the narrow river. Fifteen minutes more and she was at the
+ landing stage. A friend went on board. Miss Prankard was on board
+ the Taku, which was still outside the bar, waiting for water to
+ bring her over and up to the settlement. The lighter was going to
+ unload and start down the river at five A.M., and Meech and I went
+ in her. About eight A.M. we met the steamer coming up, and when she
+ came abreast we saw Miss Prankard on board, but could not get from
+ our vessel to hers. The tide was favourable for running up, and
+ they were afraid to lose a minute, so would not stop the steamer;
+ we did not get on board till we reached the bund at Tientsin about
+ eleven A.M. We started for Peking next day, got there on Thursday,
+ and were married following Tuesday.
+
+ 'Our honeymoon is now almost over. I am to have only a week of it.
+ I hope to start with Meech on a mission trip to the country on
+ Tuesday next.'
+
+Miss Prankard's first view of her future husband was hardly what she
+might have expected. Mr. Meech has also sketched that scene on the
+river.
+
+'The morning was cold, and Gilmour was clad in an old overcoat which had
+seen much service in Siberia, and had a woollen comforter round his
+neck, having more regard to warmth than to appearance. We had to follow
+back to Tientsin, Gilmour being thought by those on board the steamer to
+be the engineer!'
+
+Two letters may be quoted in this connection. The first was to one of
+his most intimate Scotch friends.
+
+
+ 'London Mission, Peking,
+ 'January 31, 1875.
+
+ 'My dear----, Your kind, long, and much-looked-for letter dated May
+ 12, 1873, and August 21, 1874, reached me on January 9, 1875. Many
+ thanks for it, but I think it would be quite as well in future to
+ send me half the quantity in half the time, if you really find you
+ cannot write me oftener. As I was married on December 8, 1874, to
+ Mrs. Meech's sister, that lady, Mrs. Gilmour, had the great
+ pleasure of reading your earnest, long, and reiterated warning to
+ me not to have her. Your warning came too late. Had you posted your
+ letter on May 12, 1873, it might have been in time, as the first
+ letter that opened our acquaintance was written in January 1874. If
+ nothing else will have effect with you, perhaps the thought that
+ you might have saved me from the fate of having an English wife may
+ have some effect in moving you to post your letters early, even
+ though they should not be so long and full.
+
+ 'About my wife: as I want you to know her, I introduce you to her.
+ She is a jolly girl, as much, perhaps more, of a Christian and a
+ Christian missionary than I am. I don't know whether I told you how
+ it came about. I proposed first to a Scotch girl, but found I was
+ too late; I then put myself and the direction of this affair--I
+ mean the finding of a wife--into God's hands, asking Him to look me
+ out one, a good one too, and very soon I found myself in a position
+ to propose to Miss Prankard with all reasonable evidence that she
+ was the right sort of girl, and with some hope that she would not
+ disdain the offer. We had never seen each other, and had never
+ corresponded, but she had heard much about me from people in
+ England who knew me, and I had heard a good deal of her and seen
+ her letters written to her sister and to her sister's husband. The
+ first letter I wrote her was to propose, and the first letter she
+ wrote me was to accept--romantic enough!
+
+ 'I proposed in January, went up to Mongolia in spring, rode about
+ on my camels till July, and came down to Kalgan to find that I was
+ an accepted man! I went to Tientsin to meet her; we arrived here on
+ Thursday, and were married on Tuesday morning. We had a quiet week,
+ then I went to the country on a nine days' tour, and came back two
+ days before Christmas. We have been at home ever since. Such is the
+ romance of a matter-of-fact man.
+
+ 'You will see that the whole thing was gone about simply on the
+ faith principle, and from its success I am inclined to think more
+ and more highly of the plan. Without any gammon, I am much more
+ happy than ever even in my day-dreams I ventured to imagine I might
+ be. It is not only me that my wife pleases, but she has gained
+ golden opinions from most of the people who have met her among my
+ friends and acquaintances in Scotland and China. My parents were
+ scared one day last year by receiving a letter from a lady in
+ England, a lady whose name even they had not known before, stating
+ that her daughter had decided to become _my wife_. Didn't it stir
+ up the old people! They had never heard a word about it! My letter
+ to them, posted at the same time with the proposal, had been
+ delayed in London. The young lady went to Scotland, and was with
+ them two weeks, and came away having made such an impression on
+ them that they wrote me from home to say that "though I had
+ searched the country for a couple of years I could not have made a
+ better choice."
+
+ 'Perhaps I am tiring you, but I want to let you know all about it,
+ and to assure you that you need not be the least shy of me or of my
+ English wife. She is a good lassie, any quantity better than me,
+ and just as handy as a Scotch lass would have been. It was great
+ fun for her to read your tirade about English wives and your
+ warning about her. She is a jolly kind of body, and does not take
+ offence, but I guess if she comes across you she will wake you up a
+ bit.'
+
+The other letter was to Miss Bremner, and referred to the part Gilmour
+was to take in her marriage in 1883 to his brother Alexander:--
+
+ 'Now as to your affair, a much more serious matter. Alex has said
+ something about my part. I want to take part, but only such a small
+ part as will make it true to say, "assisted by the brother of the
+ bridegroom." It is for you and Dr. Macfadyen to say what that
+ _small_ part shall be; all I have to say about it, the smaller the
+ better.
+
+ 'My experiences of the ceremonies of social Christianity have been
+ mixed a little. In England I baptised a child by a wrong name, and
+ had actually to do it again. In China on a similar occasion I began
+ by saying, "Friends, God has given you this child," when the
+ seeming father stopped me, and explained that God had not given
+ them this child, but he himself had picked it up in a field where
+ it had been exposed.
+
+ 'I think I married only one Chinese couple, and to this day I doubt
+ if either the one or the other uttered a syllable where they should
+ have said, "I do." In my own case I think I must have said "I will"
+ in a feeble voice, for my wife when her turn came sung out "I will"
+ in a voice that startled herself and me, and made it ominous how
+ much _will_ she was going to have in the matter. Wishing you all
+ blessings,
+
+ 'Believe me yours truly,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+'IN JOURNEYINGS OFTEN, IN PERILS OF RIVERS'
+
+
+The year following the marriage, owing to the absence of Dr. Dudgeon on
+furlough, was spent almost entirely in Peking. In his absence Mr.
+Gilmour took charge of what may be called the unprofessional work of the
+hospital, the purely medical superintendence being in the hands of Dr.
+Bushell of the British Legation. He varied this work and the routine of
+ordinary mission duties by an occasional trip to other centres where
+fairs were being held, in the company of Mr. Murray, of the National
+Bible Society of Scotland, for the purpose of selling Christian books.
+There was often a very keen friendly rivalry as to which could sell the
+most, and not unfrequently very large quantities of tracts and booklets
+were thus put into circulation.
+
+Early in 1875, with the object of enabling his colleagues and his
+friends among the other missions which have centres in Peking the better
+to realise what life in Mongolia was like, he set up his Mongol tent in
+the compound, and invited them in companies of five or seven to partake
+of a Mongol dinner, cooked in Mongol fashion, and served as on the
+Plain. His diary records that five such entertainments were necessary,
+the utmost limit of the tent accommodation being reached on each
+occasion.
+
+'The guests came,' we are told, 'at the appointed time, and the fire of
+wood was lighted in the middle of the tent. While the guests sat around
+on felt spread upon the ground, Gilmour proceeded to cook the millet and
+the mutton which furnished the feast. When all was ready a blessing was
+asked and the meal was eaten. On one occasion a reverend gentleman was
+called on to ask the blessing, but declined, feeling apparently that
+what he was expected to eat was not of such a quality that he could ask
+a blessing on it. Gilmour used often to refer to this with much
+amusement, though at the time he felt some chagrin.'
+
+In 1876 the Mongolian trips were resumed. No colleague had yet been
+secured for him, and, with a bravery and consecration beyond all praise,
+Mrs. Gilmour accompanied him. This she did not once simply. For the
+first journey the novelty of the experience and the conviction that she
+could at any rate help to preserve her husband from the feeling of utter
+loneliness, which had been so hard to bear in past years, were powerful
+reasons. But she went a second and a third time. She went after the
+novelty had worn off, after she had learned by very stern experience how
+hard and rough the life was, after previous exposure had told but too
+severely upon her physical strength. And thus she deserves the eulogy
+passed upon her by her husband: 'She is a better missionary than I.'
+Comparisons of this kind are obviously out of the question. But it would
+be hard to find a more beautiful illustration of true wifely affection
+than the love for her husband that made her willing to share his Mongol
+tent as readily as the Peking compound. And if James Gilmour
+manifested a Christlike love for the ignorant and stolid Mongols, so
+also did the delicately nurtured and refined lady who, in order to do
+her part in winning them to the Saviour, endured privations, faced
+perils, and bore a daily and hourly series of trials so irksome and so
+repugnant that no motive short of all-absorbing love to Jesus Christ is
+strong enough to account for her endurance.
+
+Here are some pictures of what this life meant to Mrs. Gilmour. The
+first journey which they took together lasted from April 4 until
+September 23, 1876, one hundred and thirty-six days being passed in
+Mongolia itself.
+
+ 'On the evening of April 25 we came upon our servants' tent,
+ already pitched beside some Mongol tents near a stream. Our things
+ were unloaded from the Chinese cart, which soon drove off and left
+ us fairly launched out on the Plain. We had two tents--one for
+ ourselves and one for our servants. They were both alike, made of
+ common blue Chinese cloth outside, and of commoner white Chinese
+ cloth inside. It was originally intended that our tent should be
+ private for our retirement and for Mrs. Gilmour's use; but we soon
+ found that this idea could not be carried out. The Mongols are so
+ much in the habit of going freely into everybody's tent in Mongolia
+ that we found we could not retain our tent to ourselves without
+ running risk of offending them by our seeming haughtiness. That
+ they should think us uncongenial and distant would have been an
+ obstacle to our success among them. So we made a virtue of
+ necessity, and kept open house in the literal sense of the word. At
+ our meals, our devotions, our ablutions, there they were--much
+ amused and interested, of course. It was sometimes annoying to have
+ them so much and so constantly about, but there was no help for it,
+ and soon we began to care little for them, and took their
+ presence not only as a matter of course, but without being
+ disturbed by it.
+
+ 'One advantage of this sort of public life was that Mrs. Gilmour,
+ being almost constantly in the presence of the spoken language,
+ picked it up very accurately and very rapidly. It is hardly
+ possible to conceive a better plan of becoming easily and well
+ acquainted with any language than that of thus living where it is
+ impossible not to hear it in almost constant use.
+
+ 'Another advantage of this sort of public life was that one gained
+ the friendship of the people. This perfect freedom of intercourse
+ pleased them much, and even conciliated those not very friendly
+ inclined. It was quite common to hear visitors remark that, while
+ other foreigners in Mongolia are distant and harsh, these people
+ were gentle and accessible, and that such friendly people did a
+ great deal to remove the unfavourable impressions made by other
+ less considerate travellers.
+
+ 'Our sojourn extended to the end of August, giving us a little over
+ four months at a stretch of tent life. In that time we had
+ experience of many kinds of weather. At first it was cold. Even in
+ May ice was to be seen in the mornings. Then came heat, premature
+ and burning, and all the more trying for ourselves and cattle on
+ account of the lack of rain. Then we had a furious tempest, which
+ raged for about thirty-six hours, overturning our covered cart and
+ threatening to sweep ourselves and our tents away. We had to load
+ down our tent ropes with bags of earth, stones, sod, the bodies of
+ our carts, wheels, boxes, and anything we could find, and even then
+ we had but a precarious existence. Every now and then, by day and
+ by night, there would arise a shout from the one tent or the other,
+ and amid the roar of the wind we heard cries for the hammer and the
+ spare tent pins. We managed to fix ourselves without being blown
+ away, and when the storm was over we patched our riven tents,
+ and were thankful we had weathered it so well. Then came the summer
+ rains--late in season, it is true, but great in strength--pouring
+ and lashing and roaring, the great drops bursting through our rent
+ cloth, broken up into spray and looking like pepper shaken from a
+ box. We had waterproof sheets, but it was next to impossible to
+ keep anything dry. While the rain lasted we sat huddled in our rain
+ cloaks, or, spade in hand, cut new channels for suddenly
+ extemporised streams and pools that grew larger and continued to
+ come closer to our bedding and boxes. As soon as the sun returned,
+ there was a general drying of garments, mattresses, and sheepskin
+ robes. The heat was perhaps the most trying of our meteorological
+ experiences; but even that passed away at last, and before we had
+ left the plains night frost had reappeared, covering the pools
+ about well mouths with thin sheets of ice.
+
+[Illustration: A MONGOL ENCAMPMENT]
+
+ 'Later in the season, one afternoon, the loungers in the tent
+ looked out and remarked, "The Mandarin has come," and gave place to
+ a richly dressed, corpulent Mongol, who entered the tent, followed
+ by one of his servants. Salutations over, he soon showed his
+ colours and unmasked his batteries. He had come to fight, and we
+ both went at it tooth and nail. He had read a good deal, and had
+ come evidently prepared and primed, not in any spirit of
+ unfriendliness, but under the evident conviction that a better case
+ could be made out for Buddhism than for Christianity. The tent was
+ crammed with eager listeners, and we reasoned together from the
+ Creation to the finish, including all manner of side issues and
+ important questions. It was a long time before he could be
+ convinced that our Jesus was not spoken of and made known in the
+ Buddhist classics. When he was at length satisfied (on that point),
+ he wanted to know about the Trinity; how men could get good; how it
+ was right that men should escape punishment due to their misdeeds
+ by praying to Jesus; why God allowed animals, such as starving
+ dogs, to lead a life of suffering; why God did not keep sin from
+ entering the world; how could Jesus come, when it is said He is
+ always with us; and how about the souls who died before Jesus came.
+
+ 'At last the sun got low, and the Mandarin, with many words of
+ friendship, rode away, promising to come another day. But he never
+ came.'
+
+In a later journey they had a very narrow escape from one of the
+frequent perils of this tent life:--
+
+ 'In Mongolia we had one rather serious adventure. The south edge of
+ the Plain is famed for storms, and the night we camped there, just
+ after dark, began one of the fiercest thunderstorms I can remember
+ having seen. The wind roared, the rain dashed, the tent quivered;
+ the thunder rattled with a metallic ring, like shafts of iron
+ dashing against each other, as it darted along a sheet-iron sky;
+ the water rose in the tent till part of our bed was afloat. It was
+ hardly possible to hear each other speak; but amid and above all
+ the din of the tempest rose one sound not to be mistaken, the roar
+ of rushing water. There was a river to right of us, but the sound
+ came more from the left. Venturing out, I found there was a great
+ swift-flowing river on both sides of us; that we could not move
+ from the little piece of elevated land plain on which we had our
+ tent; and that a few inches more water, or an obstacle getting into
+ the path of the upper river, would send the full force of the
+ current down on our tents. Flocks, herds, men are said to be swept
+ away now and again in Mongolia, and for an hour our case seemed
+ doubtful; but about 11 P.M. the storm ceased and the danger was
+ over, and, though we had hardly anything left, we went to sleep,
+ thanking God for His preserving mercy.'
+
+Courageous, undoubtedly, Mrs. Gilmour was; her example of self-sacrifice
+in the Master's cause was lofty in itself, and is stimulating to every
+Christian mind. Yet it is to be greatly feared that the first of these
+journeys aggravated, if it did not actually develope, the disease from
+which she ultimately died. She found the ceaseless round of millet and
+mutton so unpalatable as at the last to be able hardly to eat at all;
+and experience of tent life was needful before she could realise how
+absolutely devoid it was of almost everything that a European lady looks
+upon as essential to daily existence, and thus make adequate preparation
+for the life. Yet, in 1878, she not only accompanied her husband again,
+better equipped by reason of previous experience, but she also took with
+her their infant boy.
+
+The winter of 1876 in Peking was devoted to work more or less directly
+bearing upon the Christian conquest of the nomad tribes.
+
+ 'Since returning from Mongolia I have had here a teacher whom I had
+ come from the plains. I read some Buddhist classics with him, then
+ had him write to my dictation some of the more striking incidents
+ narrated in the Book of Daniel; then finally had him write for me
+ an explanation of the way of salvation through Jesus. The extracts
+ from Daniel were written mostly with the idea of accustoming him to
+ my dictation; but the explanation of Christianity was a tract that
+ I had long wanted to write, in which I sought to make it as plain
+ as possible, not only that Jesus does save, but also that there is
+ no salvation through any other name. The Religious Tract Society
+ has consented to print for me both the extract from Daniel and the
+ explanation of Christianity.'
+
+During 1877 the ever-recurring question, inevitable, perhaps, and yet
+very paralysing to any steady progress, as to whether it was really
+worth while to continue labour in such a sterile field, came up once
+more for discussion. In an elaborate report, designed rather to elicit
+the views of the home authorities than to express his own, dated August
+18, 1877, Mr. Gilmour depicts rapidly and clearly his relations, on the
+one hand, to the workers in the station of the American Board at Kalgan,
+and, on the other, to his colleagues of the North China Committee of the
+London Society. The American Board had sent out another missionary, and
+Mr. Gilmour was at first inclined to the view that, although working
+independently, they might yet act practically as colleagues.
+
+ 'In addition, the new man, Rev. W. P. Sprague, and I one day
+ undertook to climb a mountain together, and, by the time we got
+ half-way up, we discovered that our ideas about working together
+ quite agreed, and that there was a fair and good prospect of our
+ making good harmonious colleagues in one work, though we belonged
+ to different societies and hailed from different nations. Here,
+ then, the thing seemed to be accomplished; here was a colleague
+ ready to my hand, or I to his.'
+
+But Mrs. Gulick, a most energetic and enthusiastic missionary to the
+Mongols, died, her husband was invalided to Japan, and Mr. Sprague found
+himself with the whole mission on his shoulders.
+
+ 'If things are to remain as they are, it amounts pretty much to
+ this, that in the warmer months of the year I can travel through
+ parts of Mongolia teaching the Gospel and dispensing medicines; the
+ rest of the year I can turn my attention to Chinese work in
+ Peking. This is a pleasant enough arrangement for me, but it is not
+ a very vigorous prosecution of the work of the Mongol mission. On
+ the other hand, such is the fewness of people to be reached in
+ Mongolia that it is only by alternating these periods of
+ deprivation with seasons of activity among the Chinese that a man
+ can keep his spirit alive.
+
+ 'As regards the opinion of other members of the Committee here, I
+ have never called for any formal expression of it, nor have they
+ (the members of Committee) ever been invited to discuss the
+ question of the Mongol mission in committee, but I know their
+ individual opinions in an informal way. Messrs. Meech and Barradale
+ don't say much; Mr. Owen thinks we will never do much in Mongolia
+ working upon so distant a base as Peking; Mr. Lees thinks it a pity
+ to take up such a seemingly unproductive field while so many more
+ promising fields call for attention; he moreover thinks that the
+ only way to do much for Mongolia is through China; Dr. Edkins
+ thinks I spend too much time and labour over the Mongols, his idea
+ being seemingly a combination of Mongol and Chinese work, with a
+ preponderating tendency towards Chinese; Dr. Dudgeon has always
+ regarded the Mongol mission as hardly practicable.
+
+ 'On the principle, however, of _Sow beside all waters_, and _Thou
+ knowest not which shall prosper, this or that_, perhaps it is well
+ that the Gospel should be exhibited to the Mongols also, and if
+ anyone is to go to Mongolia, perhaps many people would have more
+ disqualifications than myself.'
+
+In 1877 there was what seemed to be a very hopeful development of
+Christian work in Shantung, and Mr. Gilmour and Mr. Owen visited that
+district and baptized a large number of converts. Still later, Dr.
+Edkins and Mr. Owen, on another visit, baptized some two hundred
+people. With reference to this latter ingathering Mr. Gilmour wrote, 'I
+much regret that we have not some definite system of putting men on a
+period of probation.... About these two hundred I have nothing to say,
+but of the hundred odd Mr. Owen and I baptized in November I have to
+admit that, making all allowances, some of them cause me more anxiety
+than satisfaction.' There was, unfortunately, only too much ground for
+this fear. Ultimately the movement dwindled almost as rapidly as it had
+developed, and with little permanent benefit to the missionary cause.
+Shantung had been devastated by famine, locusts, and cholera.
+Missionaries brought relief to the stricken people, giving both money
+and food. Large numbers were drawn towards the new religion by this
+example of its deeds, and most of the converts had professed
+Christianity in the hope of getting something by its means. But this
+incident brought to a head a divergence of view as to the whole conduct
+of affairs in the Peking mission between the two older missionaries, Dr.
+Edkins and Dr. Dudgeon, and their three younger colleagues, Mr. Gilmour,
+Mr. Owen, and Mr. Meech. Into this strenuous and protracted controversy
+we do not propose to enter. Both parties were actuated by high and
+honourable motives; both were able to express their views pointedly, and
+with all appropriate force. In the end the view advocated by Mr. Gilmour
+triumphed. This was that, so far as possible, no pecuniary inducement
+whatever, either by way of payment for services, or even employment in
+connection with the mission, should be allowed to influence a Chinaman's
+judgment in the acceptance of Christianity. Gilmour could take an active
+part in the discussions only during his winter residence in Peking. But
+the reader who has followed its history so far will be quite prepared to
+learn that he made up for the infrequency of his participation in the
+controversy by the energy which he displayed when he did so. And in
+depicting Gilmour as he was, it is essential that he should be seen when
+opposing no less than, as he much preferred to be in all matters
+affecting the welfare of the mission, in the heartiest concord with his
+colleagues. And yet his keenest opponents would cordially assent to the
+following statement by one who took an active part in all the
+discussions. It is mainly for the purpose of emphasising this testimony
+that the matter is referred to here.
+
+'When in Peking Gilmour took his full share in the debates which were
+constantly arising. Although he could and did argue to the extremest
+point, and very hot and sharp words might be spoken during the
+discussion, he harboured no bitterness of feeling against his opponents.
+After excited argument he would get up and say, "Nevertheless I love
+you." Nor were these empty words. He was kind, and willing to help all,
+and was doing acts of service continually for those who opposed him
+most.'
+
+Towards the close of 1878 the Rev. J. S. Barradale, of the Tientsin
+Mission, died, leaving the Rev. J. Lees alone without a Chinese-speaking
+helper. Mr. Gilmour sympathised deeply with him in his loss, and wrote
+to say that, so long as Mr. Lees was thus left alone, he would be glad
+to make two trips annually to his country stations, either _with_ him or
+_for_ him. Mr. Gilmour's journal of this work is not only a record of
+the willingness with which he added gladly to his own heavy labours in
+order to assist a colleague; but it also gives some most realistic
+pictures of what ordinary life in China is like, and under what
+conditions evangelistic itineration there is carried on. Some of the
+districts visited had just been devastated by a severe famine.
+
+ 'From Tientsin to Hsiao Chang is five days' journey. Three hours
+ out from Tientsin we came upon some dogs feasting on a corpse lying
+ at a cross-road. The dogs belonged to cottagers near, but no
+ attempt was made by the owners to keep them away; no one took the
+ trouble to bury the body or cover it up even. Later on we passed
+ through one famine-devastated district. Half the houses in the
+ villages were unroofed; large tracts of land were untilled; the
+ landscape was almost entirely destitute of animal life; travellers
+ were nowhere to be seen; round the villages the little stacks of
+ straw and fuel were not to be seen; the lanes were silent; no dogs,
+ no cocks and hens, no pigs; no groups of children playing or
+ running after the foreigner as he passed by; and the words of
+ Scripture came to my mind, "the land desolate without inhabitant."
+ We continued to pass these desolations for about sixty English
+ miles. We stopped a night in one of these ruined villages, and Mr.
+ Lees took me round the place to see the nature and extent of the
+ destruction. Closer inspection revealed even more ruin than a mere
+ traveller's passing look would detect; for, evidently, some care
+ had been taken to leave house walls and boundary walls on the
+ street standing, so as to hide some part of the destruction, and
+ thus make things look better than they really were.
+
+ 'Natives of the place gave us numbers, which showed the population
+ was then estimated at not much, if any, more than half the former
+ population. It was expressly stated, however, that the missing half
+ were not regarded as all dead; very many were dead, had died in the
+ place, but many had gone elsewhere--in most cases no one knew
+ where. Of these some few would doubtless return; but it is to be
+ feared that the mortality in a hard year among famine refugees is
+ very large, and of those who left their homes and native places,
+ the few that may eventually return will be very few, I fear.
+
+ 'Doesn't the Bible say that it is a harder fate to die of famine
+ than to die by the sword--to die stricken through for want of the
+ fruits of the earth? But of all those who died in the famine in
+ North China there is one class whose case is perhaps more
+ distressing than ordinary. A large number of people seem to have
+ died just as the harvest--a plentiful one--ripened. Through all
+ these hard dreary months, when, day after day, month after month,
+ they looked for and longed for rain, those I now speak of struggled
+ through, kept up hope, fared hard, hoped eagerly, and at last saw
+ the rain come, saw the crops flourishing, saw them beginning to
+ ripen, congratulated themselves and others on the prospect of
+ abundant food and better days. But they were to see it with their
+ eyes, but not to eat thereof. As far as could be gathered from the
+ natives themselves, the case would seem to be thus.
+
+ 'The great mass of the population was much reduced in bodily
+ strength by the long period of half-starvation they went through;
+ summer and early autumn came with the rains and the attendant ague,
+ which last--the ague--still more reduced the strength of their
+ already emaciated frames. You can imagine them, with lean faces and
+ hungry eyes, tottering about the fields, and counting the days that
+ must yet elapse before the grain would ripen. The rage of hunger
+ was no longer to be borne; they anticipated by a few days the
+ ripening; took the grain, still a little green--perhaps sometimes
+ very green--and put it into the pot. But here again was another
+ difficulty. The fuel used is grain stalks, and the famine deprived
+ them at once of food and fuel. Green grain they might cook, but
+ green-grain stalks would not burn. Fuel was thus deficient; and
+ was it wonderful if, as they stood round the pot, and the fuel was
+ deficient, their patience should fail them and they should fall
+ upon the food half cooked? That was bad enough; but that is not
+ all. The Chinese have nearly as little self-control as children;
+ and is it to be wondered at if, when at last, after long months of
+ the slow torture of unappeased hunger, they found a full meal
+ before them, they should have eaten to the full? When a man
+ emaciated from having gone through a famine, and further enfeebled
+ after repeated prostrations by ague, at length rises up and gorges
+ himself with farinaceous food, half ripe and half cooked, the
+ consequences are not difficult to divine. Diarrh[oe]a and dysentery
+ set in, and became fearfully prevalent--not only prevalent, but
+ peculiarly fatal. To make matters worse, medicines in that part of
+ the country are dear; the people were too poor to get medical help,
+ and great numbers who had lived to see the famine end and
+ prosperity return lived only to see the prosperity, and to die when
+ it touched them. The famine fever in summer seems to have been
+ fearfully prevalent. It is said that in a single courtyard two or
+ three people would be lying about the gate, two or three under the
+ shadow of some house, two or three more inside the house--all
+ stricken down with fever. The air of some villages is said to have
+ been loaded with the effluvia to such an extent that one riding
+ along the street perceptibly discerned the taint in the atmosphere.
+ The fever was deadly too, but evidently not so deadly in proportion
+ as the autumn dysentery. Frequently, when talking to a boy, we
+ would hear he was an orphan, and, on inquiry, he told that his
+ father had died in autumn; frequently, in talking to a woman, we
+ would hear that she was a widow, and, on asking when her husband
+ died, the reply was, "Autumn."
+
+ 'We reached Hsiao Chang in a snowstorm on Saturday afternoon. A few
+ of the people, doubtless, heard of our arrival; but those of the
+ other villages probably did not know we had come; so that our being
+ there, perhaps, did not materially increase the number of the
+ congregation that assembled next day (Sunday). Sunday was a dull,
+ uncomfortable day; the ground covered with snow; the sky still
+ covered with clouds; no sunshine; yet there was a congregation of
+ about one hundred and thirty, of whom eighty (about) would be
+ women, and fifty (about) be men. The next Sabbath, January 26, was
+ still dull; the congregation numbered about two hundred and
+ eighty--men, say, one hundred and thirty; women, say, one hundred
+ and fifty. Mr. Lees took the women into the chapel. I took the men
+ outside in another court, and preached to them from a terrace which
+ gave me a commanding view of my congregation. Mr. Lees had too
+ little ventilation, I had too much of it; but both of our
+ congregations listened well, though there was no sun, though the
+ cold was intense, and though stray flakes of snow wandered slowly
+ down among us as we worshipped. The next Sabbath, February 2, was
+ fine. All except adherents were excluded, and the congregation
+ numbered about eighty men, and one hundred and twenty women. Twelve
+ men and seven women were baptized.
+
+ 'The most novel feature of the work I noticed was the eagerness
+ displayed to learn and sing hymns. Sometimes poor old women, from
+ whom we could not extract much Catechism information about the
+ unity in trinity and other theological mysteries, brightened up
+ their old wrinkled faces when asked if they could sing, and when
+ asked to give us a specimen of their singing, would raise their
+ cracked and quavering voices and go through "There is a happy
+ land," or "The Great Physician," or "Safe in the arms of Jesus," a
+ good deal out of tune here and there, it is true, but on the whole
+ creditably as regards music, and with an apparent earnestness and
+ feeling that was hard to witness with dry eyes. And if the old
+ women sang thus, what of the young people? They seemed to revel in
+ hymns. The old, big, orthodox hymn-book used in our chapels got a
+ good deal of patronage and attention; but their great favourites
+ were those in a small collection of the Sankey revival hymns
+ translated (with a few exceptions) and published by Mr. Lees. These
+ hymns contain good gospel, seem to be easily learned, and are set
+ to tunes which the Chinese seem never to sing themselves tired of.
+ The preachers have mastered a goodly number of them, and teach them
+ to all comers; but, Mr. Lees being a singer, of course, when he
+ arrived, there were high singing festivals, and the practice at
+ evening prayers was sometimes so vigorous and prolonged that the
+ tympanum of one of my ears began to show symptoms of defeat. These
+ hymns I regard as a most powerful auxiliary to the other Gospel
+ agencies at work, and I hope a great deal of good from them.
+
+ 'Every Chinaman wants looking after. Even the best and most
+ trustworthy men are all the better for being well and carefully
+ superintended. In fact, the better a man is, the better he pays for
+ being well looked after. The present state of country mission work
+ in North China calls for careful supervision in an especial degree.
+ Unforeseen circumstances arise that need prompt action where a
+ wrong course of action may be disastrous; something or other
+ happens that dismays the whole of the little Christian community;
+ something or other happens that lifts them up into pride; the
+ Christians are like little islands of Christianity isolated in a
+ vast ocean of heathenism, and the waves seem to threaten to swallow
+ them up. The missionary, simply by going and putting in an
+ appearance, or by giving a little simple advice, or by speaking a
+ few words of encouragement, or by devising a few simple methods, or
+ making a few simple arrangements, can often keep the Church out of
+ moral danger, infuse new hope and courage to the members and
+ preachers, and, under God, put fresh life and vigour into the whole
+ concern. As iron sharpeneth iron, so doth a man the face of his
+ friend; and this is true in an especial degree of a missionary and
+ his preachers and converts.'
+
+In the course of a subsequent tour in the same district, in 1880, he
+gives in his diary a sketch of a sermon preached by Liu, his Chinese
+helper, one which may be taken as a specimen of the best class of
+address given by a converted Chinaman to his fellow-countrymen.
+
+ 'Liu's subject was from Revelation, "Whosoever will, let him take
+ of the water of life freely." He went into an elaborate detail
+ about the use of water, washing, laying the dust in a room being
+ swept out, (‡ la Bunyan) making a sinking sand hard and good for a
+ cart and man to travel on. Finally, he got to a couple of good
+ stories about a man who got drunk and had his face blackened, so
+ that when he came home his own father did not know him and would
+ not let him in, and when he saw himself accidentally in a mirror he
+ did not know himself. His drunkenness had completely changed his
+ appearance and voice even.
+
+ 'So God made us in His own image, but sin has terribly changed us.
+ Purified by the Holy Ghost we may again be like ourselves and God.
+
+ 'The service lasted about two hours and ten minutes. The story
+ parts of the sermon were very effective.'
+
+A later entry in the diary runs: 'Had service. Preached "Jesus saves,"
+the sermon for the heathen of that name.' One who often heard him preach
+in China gives the following estimate of his power and method in
+delivering his message:--
+
+ 'As a preacher Gilmour was most unconventional. His sermons were
+ direct talks, without any attempt at rhetoric. They were
+ plentifully illustrated, largely from events in his own experience.
+ Laughable allusions or quaint ways of putting things were
+ frequently used. While there was not much attractive in the manner
+ of the preacher, the directness of his remark and his evident
+ earnestness always made his sermons appreciated and enjoyed. The
+ Chinese were always glad to hear him, and words he used to speak
+ are often referred to.'
+
+Writing on one occasion to a friend in England being educated for the
+Christian ministry, who had just taken one of the higher degrees at the
+London University, he said:--
+
+ 'I don't think our work is so much unlike, after all. You witness
+ for Christ, so do I; and though you are in a Christian country and
+ I in a heathen land, human nature is human nature, and not so
+ different as might be supposed. You may, pray you may, see more
+ fruit of your work than I do, but your trials, and difficulties,
+ and temptations will be, no doubt are, pretty much the same as
+ mine. May the Lord help you and bless you now and for ever! I hope
+ He will help you to have ever a heart ready to preach simply the
+ simple Gospel to your hearers, half of whom, perhaps, know almost
+ nothing of salvation, though they have been listening to sermons
+ about it all their lives, and would not know in the least to which
+ hand to turn if they were aroused and became anxious to be saved.
+ I'll give you a text, which I think peculiarly suitable for you,
+ now a graduate. Isaiah 1. 4--"The Lord God hath given me the tongue
+ of the learned, that I should know how to speak a word in season to
+ him that is weary." I like to dwell on this text. Learning should
+ not make deep sermons, hard to be understood; on the contrary, it
+ should be all employed to make the road simple and clear. Forgive
+ me for exhorting you so, but I can't refrain from it when I think
+ of the many learned men I know at home and here who employ their
+ learning in giving learned sermons, _not_ in making the way simple
+ and plain.'
+
+The sermon referred to in the extract quoted above from the diary is
+based on Matt. i. 21. It was never written out; but the notes of it lie
+before us, and we quote them as an illustration of his way of addressing
+both Chinese and English audiences. It may interest the reader to
+endeavour to make out from it the line of thought, and any who may have
+heard him preach or speak will find it easy to recall _how_ he preached
+it.
+
+ 'Matt. i. 21. 'He shall save people from their sins.'
+
+ 'Talk to a man, he admits he is sinner; by-and-by he will break off
+ and become good.
+
+ 'He does not really know what sin is. Egypt!
+
+ 'It is a _disease_; if you get it can you leave it off? Your blood
+ is tainted.
+
+ 'It is a _fire_; once light it, you can't quench it, it smoulders
+ and breaks out afresh.
+
+ 'It is an _evil root_, evil weed, can easy sow, not extirpate.
+
+ 'Sin is like the current above Niagara.
+
+ 'It becomes a _habit_. Indulgence makes habit grow.
+
+ 'It is like a _spider_; one thread after another binds up a fly.
+
+ 'Such is sin--murder, robbery, theft, adultery, uncleanness, lying,
+ covetousness, hatred, anger, malice, want of love to God or man.
+
+ 'Many of these sins you not accused of, but you have sin: sin is
+ fatal, can you free yourself? _Jesus is to do it._
+
+ 'Disease, fire, root, current, habit, fly. _The man cannot free
+ himself: Jesus must set him free._
+
+ 'Not only from _Hell_, but from sin.
+
+ 'Suppose you were freed only from Hell, and transported to Heaven,
+ could you be happy? Who would be your companions?
+
+ 'Ignorant (wicked) man in company of learned (holy).
+
+ '_A Tientsin vagrant_ became chair-bearer; had clothes, etc., but
+ only for a day; he was soon naked again.
+
+ 'Christ does not transport to Heaven only.
+
+ '_Disease._--Not die from it; He cures it.
+
+ '_Fire._--Not consumed by it; He quenches it.
+
+ '_Root_ of evil; He clears from the ground.
+
+ '_Niagara._--He lifts you out of the current on to an island.
+
+ '_Habit._--He sets you free from it.
+
+ '_Spider's fly._--He not only takes from the spider; but He sets it
+ free from the toils.
+
+ '_Jesus gives_ second nature; you are born again.
+
+ 'But upon one _condition_, your consent. The _disease_ is severe:
+ you must obey doctor; if you do not submit to operation; not take
+ bitter drugs; then he does not heal.
+
+ '_Lead_ a man to Peking: not come, not follow: leave him: lead to
+ heaven, paths of holiness not follow, not reach.
+
+ 'Has Christ saved you? If yes, visible to self and others. He is
+ not only an object of respect, admiration: He is the doctor into
+ whose hands you put your soul for treatment.
+
+ '_Two brothers_, Kite, Loe, Pet Dog.
+
+ '_John of Hankow's Liu_, see Chronicle; dead _v._ alive; sick (of
+ fever) _v._ whole. Is it last time? Mongols feel queer.
+
+ '_Missionaries._ Mongol doctor who had not courage to treat
+ himself.
+
+ '_S. S. Teacher_: Paul: be a castaway,
+
+ 'Christ Matt. i. 21-23.
+
+ 'Any religion good enough. No: no religion breaks bondage of sin:
+ go down to death in sin's slavery. Only Jesus can save from sin.
+ _Ask, and He'll do it._'
+
+During the winters in Peking he still used every effort to get at the
+Mongols frequenting the capital.
+
+ 'The Mongols who visit Peking connect themselves with two great
+ centres. "The Outside Lodging," which is about a mile or more north
+ of the north wall of Peking, and is also called the "Halha
+ Lodging," because it is the great resort of the Northern Mongols,
+ and the "Inside Lodging," which is near the inside of the south
+ wall of the Manchu City of Peking, is situated close behind the
+ English Legation, and is also called the "Cold Lodging;" this name
+ being probably due to the fact that in the open space in this
+ "Inside Lodging" a good many Mongols camp out in their tents, in
+ place of hiring courts and rooms from the Chinese. These are the
+ two great _centres_ for Mongols in Peking. Many of them lodge in
+ the immediate neighbourhood, and even those who lodge in other
+ parts of the city frequent these two centres; so that, if any one
+ wants to know whether or not any individual Mongol has come to
+ Peking, he seeks him at one or other of these marts.
+
+ 'In the winter of 1879-80 I set up a book-stall, with a Chinaman to
+ care for it, at the Outside Lodging, going myself, as a rule, every
+ second day. This winter I followed the example of the pedlars, and,
+ hanging two bags of books from my shoulders, hunted the Mongols
+ out, going not only to the trading places, but in and out among the
+ lanes where they lodged, visiting the Outside Lodging first and the
+ Inside Lodging later in the day. The number of Mongols outside the
+ city became latterly so small that it was not visited very often;
+ but during the Chinese eleventh and the first part of the twelfth
+ month, the number of Mongols to be met with at the Inside Lodging
+ was fair, and the number of books disposed of altogether, both
+ outside and inside the city, amounted to seven hundred and
+ fourteen.
+
+ 'In many cases the Mongols, before buying, and not unfrequently
+ after buying, would insist on having the book read, supposing that
+ they got more for their money when they not only had the book, but
+ had me let them hear its contents. Of course I was only too glad to
+ have the opportunity of reading, which readily changed to
+ opportunity for talking; and in this way, from time to time, little
+ groups of Mongols would gather round and listen to short addresses
+ on the main doctrines of Christianity. Several men whom I accosted
+ seemed familiar with the name of Jesus, and had some knowledge of
+ Christianity. Some bought the books eagerly; some not only did not
+ buy themselves, but exhorted others not to buy; some openly spoke
+ against Christianity; but a great many of those who listened to an
+ address or took part in a conversation evinced interest in the
+ subjects spoken of, and remarked that salvation by another bearing
+ our sin was a reasonable doctrine. As the purchasers of these books
+ hailed from all parts of Mongolia, the tracts thus put into their
+ hands will reach to even remote localities in the west, north, and
+ east, and my prayer is that the reading of them may be the
+ beginning of what shall lead to a saving knowledge of the truth in
+ some minds. Hoping for some good result, I had my address stamped
+ on many of the books, to enable such as might wish to learn more to
+ know where to come.
+
+ 'In some cases, Mongols wishing to buy books had no money, but were
+ willing to give goods instead; and thus it happened that I
+ sometimes made my way home at night with a miscellaneous collection
+ of cheese, sour-curd, butter and millet cake and sheep's fat,
+ representing the produce of part of the day's sales.'
+
+A short time before he returned to England on his first furlough he drew
+up a report, in which he places on record some of the results of his ten
+years' experience of Mongol life and habits.
+
+ 'On one occasion I was living some weeks in a Mongol's tent. It was
+ late in the year. Lights were put out soon after dark. The nights
+ were long in reality, and, in such unsatisfactory surroundings as
+ the discomforts of a poor tent and doubtful companions, the nights
+ seemed longer than they were. At sunrise I was only too glad to
+ escape from smoke and everything else to the retirement of the
+ crest of a low ridge of hills near the tent. This, perhaps the most
+ natural thing in the world for a foreigner, was utterly
+ inexplicable to the Mongols. The idea that any man should get out
+ of his bed at sunrise and climb a hill for nothing! He must be up
+ to mischief! He must be secretly taking away the luck of the land!
+ This went on for some time, the Mongols all alive with suspicion,
+ and the unsuspecting foreigner retiring regularly morning after
+ morning, till at length a drunken man blurted out the whole thing,
+ and openly stated the conviction that the inhabitants had arrived
+ at, namely, that this extraordinary morning walk of the foreigner
+ on the hill crest boded no good to the country. To remain among the
+ people I had to give up my morning retirement.
+
+ 'The Mongols are very suspicious of seeing a foreigner writing.
+ What _can_ he be up to? they say among themselves. Is he taking
+ notes of the capabilities of the country? Is he marking out a road
+ map, so that he can return guiding an army? Is he, as a wizard,
+ carrying off the good luck of the country in his note-book? These,
+ and a great many others, are the questions that they ask among
+ themselves and put to the foreigner when they see him writing; and
+ if he desires to conciliate the good-will of the people, and to win
+ their confidence, the missionary must abstain from walking and
+ writing while he is among them.
+
+ 'On another point, too, a missionary must be careful. He must not
+ go about shooting. Killing beasts or birds the Mongols regard as
+ peculiarly sinful, and anyone who wished to teach them religious
+ truth would make the attempt under great disadvantage if he carried
+ and used a gun. This, however, is a prejudice that it is not so
+ difficult to refrain from offending.
+
+ 'The diseases presented for treatment are legion, but the most
+ common cases are skin diseases and diseases of the eye and teeth.
+ Perhaps rheumatism is _the_ disease of Mongolia; but the manner of
+ life and customs of the Mongols are such that it is useless to
+ attempt to cure it. Cure it to-day, it is contracted again
+ to-morrow. Skin diseases present a fair field for a medical
+ missionary. They are so common, and the Mongolian treatment of them
+ is so far removed from common-sense, that anyone with a few
+ medicines and a little intelligence has ample opportunity of
+ benefiting many sufferers. The same may be said of the eye. The
+ glare of the sun on the Plain at all seasons, except when the grass
+ is fresh and green in summer, the blinding sheen from the snowy
+ expanse in winter, and the continual smoke that hangs like a cloud
+ two or three feet above the floor of the tent, all combine to
+ attack the eye. Eye diseases are therefore very common. The lama
+ medicines seem to be able to do nothing for such cases, and a few
+ remedies in a foreigner's hands work cures that seem wonderful to
+ the Mongols.
+
+ 'In many cases, when a Mongol applies to his doctor, he simply
+ extends his hand, and expects that the doctor, by simply feeling
+ his pulse, will be able to tell, not only the disease, but what
+ will cure it. As soon as the doctor has felt the pulse of one
+ hand, the patient at once extends the other hand that the pulse may
+ be felt there also, and great surprise is manifested when a
+ foreigner begins his diagnosis of a case by declining the proffered
+ wrist and asking questions.
+
+ 'The question of "How did you get this disease?" often elicits some
+ curiously superstitious replies. One man lays the blame on the
+ stars and constellations. Another confesses that when he was a lad
+ he was mischievous, and dug holes in the ground or cut shrubs on
+ the hill, and it is not difficult to see how he regards disease as
+ a punishment for digging, since by digging worms are killed; but
+ what cutting wood on a hill can have to do with sin it is harder to
+ see, except it be regarded as stealing the possessions of the
+ spiritual lord of the locality. In consulting a doctor, too, a
+ Mongol seems to lay a deal of stress on the belief that it is his
+ _fate_ to be cured by the medical man in question, and, if he finds
+ relief, often says that his meeting this particular doctor and
+ being cured is the result of prayers made at some previous time.
+
+ 'One difficulty in curing Mongols is that they frequently, when
+ supplied with medicines, depart entirely from the doctor's
+ instructions when they apply them; and a not unfrequent case is
+ that of the patient who, after applying to the foreigner for
+ medicine and getting it, is frightened by his success, or scared by
+ some lying report of his neighbours, or staggered at the fact that
+ the foreigner would not feel his pulse, or feel it at one wrist
+ only, lays aside the medicine carefully and does not use it at all.
+
+ 'In Mongolia, too, a foreigner is often asked to perform absurd,
+ laughable, or impossible cures. One man wants to be made clever,
+ another to be made fat, another to be cured of insanity, another of
+ tobacco, another of whisky, another of hunger, another of tea;
+ another wants to be made strong, so as to conquer in gymnastic
+ exercises; most men want medicine to make their beards grow; while
+ almost every man, woman, and child wants to have his or her skin
+ made as white as that of the foreigner.
+
+ 'When a Mongol is convinced that his case is hopeless he takes it
+ very calmly, and bows to his fate, whether it be death or chronic
+ disease; and Mongol doctors, and Mongol patients too, after a
+ succession of failures, regard the affliction as a thing fated, to
+ be unable to overcome which implies no lack of medical ability on
+ the doctor's part.
+
+ 'Of all the healing appliances in the hands of a foreigner none
+ strikes the fancy of a Mongol so much as the galvanic battery, and
+ it is rather curious that almost every Mongol who sees it and tries
+ its effect exclaims what a capital thing it would be for examining
+ accused persons. It would far surpass whipping, beating, or
+ suspending. Under its torture a guilty man could not but "confess."
+ Some one in England has advocated the use of the galvanic battery
+ in place of the cat in punishing criminals, and it is rather
+ curious to note the coincidence of the English and Mongol mind.
+
+ 'The Mongol doctors are not, it would seem, quite unacquainted with
+ the properties of galvanism. It is said that they are in the habit
+ of prescribing the loadstone ore, reduced to powder, as efficacious
+ when applied to sores, and one man hard of hearing had been
+ recommended by a lama to put a piece of loadstone into each ear and
+ chew a piece of iron in his mouth!
+
+ 'Divination is another point on which Mongols are troublesome. It
+ never for a moment enters their head that a man so intelligent and
+ well fitted out with appliances as a foreigner seems to them to be
+ cannot divine. Accordingly they come to him to divine for them
+ where they should camp to be lucky and get rich, when a man who has
+ gone on a journey will return, why no news has been received from a
+ son or husband who is serving in the army, where they should dig a
+ well so as to get plenty of good water near the surface, whether it
+ would be fortunate for them to venture on some trading speculation,
+ whether they should go on some projected journey, in what direction
+ they should search for lost cattle, or, more frequently than any of
+ the above, they come, men and women, old and young, to have the
+ general luck of their lives examined into. Great is their amazement
+ when the foreigner confesses his ignorance of such art, and greater
+ still is their incredulity.
+
+ 'The great obstacles to success in doctoring the Mongols are
+ two:--First: most of the afflicted Mongols suffer from chronic
+ diseases for which almost nothing can be done. Second: in many
+ cases, where alleviation or cures are effected, they are only of
+ short duration, as no amount of explanation or exhortation seems
+ sufficient to make them aware of the importance of guarding against
+ causes of disease. But, notwithstanding all this, many cures can be
+ effected on favourable subjects, and the fact that the missionary
+ carries medicines with him and attempts to heal, and that without
+ money and without price, aids the missionary cause by bringing him
+ into friendly communication with many who would doubtless hold
+ themselves aloof from any one who approached them in no other
+ character but that of a teacher of Christianity.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+THE VISIT TO ENGLAND IN 1882
+
+
+From 1880 onwards Mrs. Gilmour suffered severely from illness, and
+medical advisers recommended at length the rest and change of a visit to
+England. Mr. Gilmour's furlough was also nearly due. Consequently, in
+the spring of 1882, he and his family returned to England. This visit
+was helpful and memorable in many ways. The rest so thoroughly well
+earned was greatly enjoyed. The return to civilisation, the society of
+loved relatives and friends, the comforts of ordinary English life, and
+the change of thought and occupation which these involved--all reacted
+happily and refreshingly upon both Mr. Gilmour and his wife.
+
+But a sojourn at home is not by any means a season of entire rest for
+the jaded worker. The Churches constantly need the stimulus and
+awakening that are best supplied by the men who have been filling the
+hard places in the field. Gilmour also was so full of enthusiasm for his
+work, and so eager in his desire to benefit the Mongols, that he would
+doubtless have found for himself many opportunities of pleading their
+cause, had not the authorities of the London Missionary Society,
+following their usual custom, furnished him with a long list of
+deputation engagements, Into these he threw himself with an energy that
+very greatly enlarged the circle of his friendship, secured very many
+new supporters for the missionary cause, and obtained for himself, on
+the part of many, a devout, prayerful sympathy for the remainder of his
+earthly service.
+
+He had brought with him a large quantity of manuscript material dealing
+with his twelve years of Mongol life and experience. From this he
+prepared the volume which was published by the Religious Tract Society
+in April 1883, under the title of _Among the Mongols_.
+
+The book was very cordially welcomed by the press, and we single out for
+quotation a portion of one review which stands out pre-eminent not only
+for its literary quality, but also as placing on record the impression
+James Gilmour was able to make upon men entirely ignorant of him and his
+work by the simple narrative of his experiences. It appeared in the
+_Spectator_ for April 28, 1883.
+
+ 'We have a difficulty in passing judgment on this book. It is
+ possible, even probable, that the impression it has made on us is
+ individual to this reviewer, and due to an accident which, with
+ other readers, will not repeat itself. Having time, and an interest
+ in nomads, he read a page or two, and read on, and read on, for
+ five hours, till he had finished the book,--which is much too
+ short,--fascinated, lost, carried out of himself and England. He
+ was in Mongolia, sitting under a blue-cloth tent, with savage dogs
+ howling around, and gazing outside, through the doorless doorway,
+ on a vast panorama of poor tufted grass, stretching away to huge
+ black hills in the distance, and Tartars on camels, Tartars on
+ horses, Tartars on springless, unbreakable ox-carts, hastening up
+ to the encampment; while inside he listened to a quiet Scotchman,
+ resignedly yet clearly explaining everything in a voice---- there
+ was the puzzle. Where in the world had the reviewer heard that
+ voice before, with its patient monotone, as well known as his
+ oldest friend's, its constant digressions and "reflections," its
+ sentences so familiar, yet so new, sentences which, as each topic
+ came up, he could write before they were uttered. "James Gilmour,
+ M.A." Never knew him, or heard of him; yet here was he, talking
+ exactly as some one else had years ago talked a hundred times. So
+ oppressive at last became the will-o'-the-wisp reminiscence, that
+ the reviewer stopped, after an account of the Desert of Gobi, and
+ deliberately read it through again, in search of a clue which might
+ reawaken his memory. It was all in vain, and it was not till
+ another hundred pages had been passed, always under the impression
+ of that bewildering reminiscence, that he exclaimed to himself,
+ "That's it! Robinson Crusoe has turned missionary, lived years in
+ Mongolia, and written a book about it." That is this book. To any
+ one who, perhaps from early neglect, does not perceive this truth,
+ our judgment will seem erroneous; but to any one who does, we may
+ quite fearlessly appeal. The student of _Robinson Crusoe_ never
+ expected that particular pleasure in this life, and he will never
+ have it again; but for this once he has it to the full. Mr. James
+ Gilmour, though a man of whom any country may be proud, is not a
+ deep thinker, and not a bright writer, and not a man with the gift
+ of topographical, or, indeed, any other kind of description. He
+ thinks nothing extraordinary, and has nothing to say quotable.
+ There is a faint, far-off humour in him, humour sternly repressed;
+ but that, so far as we know, is the only quality in his writing
+ which makes him _littÈrateur_ at all. But Heaven, which has denied
+ him many gifts, has given him one in full measure,--the gift of
+ Defoe, the power of so stating things that the reader not only
+ believes them, but sees them in bodily presence, that he is there
+ wherever the author chooses to place him, under the blue tent,
+ careering over the black ice of Lake Baikal, or hobnobbing in tea
+ with priests as unlike Englishmen as it is possible for human
+ beings to be, yet, such is his art, in nowise unintelligible or
+ strange. It may be, as we have said, that it is an individual
+ impression, but we never read, save once, the kind of book in our
+ lives, did not deem it possible ever again to meet with this
+ special variety of unconscious literary skill. We are aware of a
+ dozen shortcomings, of a hundred points upon which Mr. Gilmour
+ ought to have given light, and has not; but there has been, if our
+ experience serves us at all, no book quite like this book since
+ _Robinson Crusoe_; and _Robinson Crusoe_ is not better, does not
+ tell a story more directly, or produce more instantaneous and final
+ conviction. Heaven help us all, if Mr. Gilmour tells us that he has
+ met any unknown race in Mongolia, say, people with the power of
+ making themselves invisible, for Tyndall will believe him, and
+ Huxley account for them, and the _Illustrated London News_ publish
+ their portraits--in the stage of invisibility. We do not say the
+ book is admirable, or perfect, or anything else superlative; but we
+ do say, and this with sure confidence, that no one who begins it
+ will leave it till the narrative ends, or doubt for an instant,
+ whether he knows Defoe or not, that he has been enchained by
+ something separate and distinct in literature, something almost
+ uncanny in the way it has gripped him, and made him see for ever a
+ scene he never expected to see.
+
+ 'We do not know that we have any more to say about the book. Its
+ merit is that, and no other; and we do not suppose anybody ever
+ proved _Robinson Crusoe's_ value by extracts. But we must say a
+ word or two about the author and his subject. Mr. Gilmour, though a
+ Scotchman, is apparently attached to the London Mission, and seems
+ to have quitted Peking for Mongolia on an impulse to teach Christ
+ to Tartars. He could not ride, he did not know Mongolian, he had an
+ objection to carry arms, and he had no special fitness except his
+ own character, which he knew nothing about, for the work.
+ Nevertheless, he went, and stayed years, living on half-frozen
+ prairies and deserts under open tents, on fat mutton, sheep's tails
+ particularly, tea, and boiled millet, eating only once a day
+ because Mongols do, and in all things, except lying, stealing, and
+ prurient talk, making himself a lama. As he could not ride, he rode
+ for a month over six hundred miles of dangerous desert, where the
+ rats undermine the grass, and at the end found that that difficulty
+ has disappeared for ever. As he could not talk, he "boarded out"
+ with a lama, listened and questioned, and questioned and listened,
+ till he knew Mongolian as Mongols know it, till his ears became so
+ open that he was painfully aware that Mongol conversation, like
+ that of most Asiatics, is choked with _doubles entendres_. As for
+ danger, he had made up his mind not to carry arms, not to be angry
+ with a heathen, happen what might, and--though he does not mention
+ this--not to be afraid of anything whatever, neither dogs nor
+ thieves, nor hunger nor the climate; and he kept those three
+ resolutions. If ever on earth there lived a man who kept the law of
+ Christ, and could give proofs of it, and be absolutely unconscious
+ that he was giving them, it is this man, whom the Mongols he lived
+ among called "our Gilmour." He wanted, naturally enough, sometimes
+ to meditate away from his hosts, and sometimes to take long walks,
+ and sometimes to geologise, but he found all these things roused
+ suspicion--for why should a stranger want to be alone; might it not
+ be "to steal away the luck of the land"?--and as a suspected
+ missionary is a useless missionary, Mr. Gilmour gave them all up,
+ and sat endlessly in tents, among lamas. And he says incidentally
+ that his fault is impatience, a dislike to be kept waiting!'
+
+[Illustration: A MONGOL CAMEL CART
+(_From a Native Sketch_)]
+
+The book met with a ready and wide acceptance. It soon 'found its
+public.' It was only to be expected that many of the friends and
+supporters of the London Missionary Society would welcome it. And there
+are others, like the reviewer, who 'have time and an interest in
+nomads,' who were certain to consult it. But in addition to these
+special classes the book did good service in some cases, by deepening
+the impression already made by other first-rate delineations of
+missionary enterprise and endurance, and in others by creating respect
+for missions and missionaries in minds hitherto strange to that feeling.
+In various editions very many thousands of the book have been sold
+during the nine years which have passed since the publication of the
+first edition.
+
+The success of his book led to the suggestion that he might easily find
+much useful employment for his pen. He did contribute some papers to the
+_Sunday at Home_, _Pall Mall Gazette_, and other publications. But in
+this, as in all other enterprises, loyalty to the great work of his life
+ruled him. He soon came to the conviction that he ought not to take time
+from the work of winning souls, and spend it in writing papers and
+books--and from the moment of that decision he put mere literary work
+resolutely aside.
+
+ 'I feel keenly,' he wrote in 1884, on his return to Peking, 'that
+ there is here more than I can do, and writing must go to the wall.'
+ And as late in his life as 1890 he added, 'I could have made, and
+ could now make, I believe, money by writing, but I do not write. I
+ settle down to teach illiterate Chinamen and Mongols, heal their
+ sores, and present Christ to them.'
+
+Towards the end of 1882 James Gilmour entered upon a long series of
+meetings on behalf of the London Missionary Society, consisting of
+sermons and addresses to Sunday School children on the Sunday, and
+speeches at public meetings during the week. A long series of his
+letters written to his wife between November 1882 and March 1883 is
+still extant, and they form an impressive record of the work considered
+suitable for a wearied missionary at home in search of rest and change.
+He visited Edinburgh, Falkirk, Glasgow, Liverpool, Kilsyth, Hamilton,
+Paisley, Dundee, St Andrews, Arbroath, Lytham, Aberdeen, Montrose,
+Manchester, Hingham, Cambridge, Norfolk, and Southampton. And this list
+exhausts only a portion of his excursions on the effort to stimulate and
+develope the faith and the zeal of the churches at home. His wanderings
+brought him into contact sometimes with relatives, sometimes with old
+college friends, now grave pastors fast hastening towards middle life.
+The meetings he attended always added to the circle of his friends, for
+none could hear his ringing voice, and feel the clasp of his hand, and
+pass under the influence of his ardent enthusiasm on behalf of the great
+enterprise of the modern Christian Church without receiving an
+impression never likely to be effaced.
+
+He in turn experienced a strong and abiding spiritual refreshment from
+this renewal, after twelve years' absence, of touch and fellowship with
+the Christian life of Great Britain. His earnestness deepened, he
+studied with intensest interest movements like the Salvation Army, then
+coming into great prominence, and other agencies for improving the
+religious life of the nation, and he rejoiced in all fellowship with
+other disciples of the Lord Jesus which had for its aim the
+strengthening of the life of faith.
+
+He rejoiced greatly when at infrequent intervals a Sunday came upon
+which he was entirely free from engagements. Such rare occasions he
+utilised very fully for spiritual edification. He was somewhat hampered
+in his possibilities on these days by the fact that his temporary home
+was at Bexley Heath, and his strong Sabbatarian views never permitted
+him to travel by rail or omnibus on the Lord's Day. The following letter
+shows how he passed one of these days.
+
+ 'Yesterday being a fine day I left home at 7.15 A.M., walked to
+ London (twelve miles), got to Spurgeon's at 10.30. Had a permit
+ from a seat-holder, was close to the platform, heard a good earnest
+ sermon, was introduced to Spurgeon in the vestry after service,
+ went home to one of his deacons for dinner, there met an American
+ who had under Mr. Moody been converted from drunkenness to God, and
+ whose craving for drink was as instantaneously and as thoroughly
+ expelled as the devils by Christ of old. After dinner visited
+ Spurgeon's Stockwell Orphanages, then walked to Camberwell and
+ dropped in, in passing, at the Catholic Apostolic Church and heard
+ a sermon from a man who would have described himself as an Apostle,
+ I suppose, and who ridiculed in a gentle and mild way the idea that
+ all men were to be partakers of the Gospel blessings which he
+ seemed to think were the special property of what he called "The
+ Church"; walked on to Lewisham, heard Morlais Jones: and then
+ walked home in the moonlight, arriving here footsore and weary
+ about 10.20 P.M. I enjoyed the day very much, all but the last four
+ or five miles home at night. I am thankful to find myself so
+ strong. I had a warm bath and slept like a top.'
+
+Those who were privileged to entertain James Gilmour, if congenial, and
+the old friends who were fortunate enough to secure him for even a brief
+period, often experienced his power of vivid and entrancing narration.
+His twelve years of service had been very full of varied and uncommon
+experience, and when in the vein he could make the hours pass almost as
+minutes. 'During this furlough,' writes Dr. Reynolds, 'I had several
+opportunities of intercourse with him, and listened to several of his
+addresses on the progress and need of missionary enterprise in the north
+of China and Mongolia, and was profoundly impressed by his earnestness,
+but I was more deeply moved when in quiet _tÍte-‡-tÍte_ he unveiled some
+of his special experiences. I should like to mention one. He once had
+great hope of the conversion to God of a Mongol, who had given him his
+entire confidence, and who was suffering from cataract in both eyes.
+Gilmour felt that this was a case in which surgical help might restore
+the sufferer to at least partial sight, and he made arrangements that in
+the escort of a Mongol the patient should find his way to the medical
+institution at Peking. He started on the pilgrimage when Gilmour, with
+his brave young wife, were encamped in a great temporary settlement of
+Mongols, who were in a state of considerable fanatical excitement
+against the new faith and its foreign teacher. Gilmour said, "We prayed
+night and day for the success of this experiment, and we arranged to
+cover all expenses connected with the arrangement." Alas! wind laden
+with dust, and blinding heat and other apparent accidents conspired
+against the poor sufferer, and when the necessary time had elapsed after
+the operation and the bandages were removed, the patient was found to
+be _stone blind_. The Mongol companion stirred up the poor fellow's
+suspicion by telling him that he knew why the Missionary had sent him to
+Peking. "I saw," said he, "the jewel of your eye in a bottle on the
+shelf. These Christians can get hundreds of taels for these jewels which
+they take out of our eyes."
+
+'When the blind man was brought back to Gilmour, his companion spread
+his suspicions and exasperating story in the entire district, and the
+fanatical hatred was augmented into seething and murderous passion, and
+our dear friends were in imminent peril for several weeks. If they had
+ventured to escape, it would have been a confession of a vile conspiracy
+with the Peking doctors, and a signal for their massacre. They remained
+to live down the ominous and odious charge, and in continuous effort to
+justify the simplicity of their motives and the purity and beneficence
+of their mission.
+
+'Deeply moved, as I was, by the story of this hairbreadth escape, I
+asked Mrs. Gilmour more about those fearful weeks of suspense, and she
+assured me that they had been perfectly calm, and that they were
+entirely resigned to God's will, whatever it might be.'
+
+'Many other trials of faith and patience were described by Gilmour,
+without one touch of self-approval or self-admiration, and the only
+trouble that haunted him was that the results of his long journeys and
+of his various missionary enterprises had been apparently so few.'
+
+It was certain that James Gilmour's power as a speaker would be utilised
+for the great event of the London Missionary Society's year, the annual
+meeting at Exeter Hall. This fell, in 1883, on May 10, and he was the
+last speaker. This involved waiting about two hours and a half for his
+speech, and corresponding exhaustion on the part of the audience. But
+none who were present will forget the rapid way in which he secured the
+attention of his hearers, and the ease with which he held it to the
+close. He chose to speak of work in China, rather than in Mongolia; the
+recent publication of his book helping among other reasons to determine
+this choice. Part of the speech deserves reproduction here, because it
+outlines very sharply the work that engaged much of his time while
+resident in Peking, and because nowhere else can such a realistic,
+sparkling, and lifelike picture of the preaching work of the Peking
+mission, and consequently more or less of all preaching in great Chinese
+cities, be found.
+
+ 'In Peking we have three chapels. A chapel there is merely a
+ Chinese shop, put into decent repair, and a signboard stuck over
+ the top. The Chinese are very fond of giving themselves very high
+ names. You will come to a man sitting in a little box scarcely big
+ enough for himself to turn round in, and if you read his sign, it
+ is some flowing name about a hall; it may be the "Hall of Continual
+ Virtue," or something of that kind, or the "Hall of the Five
+ Happinesses." So our title above our chapel just runs in the native
+ idiomatic style, and it is the "Gospel Hall.' Inside there is not
+ very much to see. The counter has been cleared away and the
+ shelves, and, in place of the mud, a brick floor has been put down;
+ and then there are forms arranged for the sitters, and there is a
+ low platform for the speaker. I do not know how it happens, but it
+ does happen, that up in the left-hand corner of the chapel--and it
+ is always the left-hand corner--there is a table and two chairs,
+ and on that table there is a teapot and set of cups, because in
+ China everything is done with tea. You must always begin in that
+ way. These chapels are open six days in the week in the afternoon.
+
+ 'Now, supposing you come in at the door, the natural thing for the
+ missionary seems to be just to walk up to this table and sit down,
+ and then the next thing is to get a congregation. Sometimes there
+ is no difficulty about getting it, if it happens to be a fair day
+ or there is a crowd in the streets. They simply pour in: but the
+ tide goes different ways sometimes, and does not pour in always
+ like that. I want to give you just a fair, square, honest idea of
+ what the thing is. Sometimes the congregation will not come in, and
+ sometimes, after a little while, one man looks in at the door and
+ sees a foreigner, and he is off. He has seen quite enough and does
+ not want to see any more; and if you were to ask him what he had
+ seen, he would not say he had seen a foreigner; no, he would say he
+ had seen "a foreign devil." And, friends, you would not be very
+ much astonished that some of those ignorant men coming from the
+ country are alarmed when they see a foreigner, if you could only
+ imagine the terrible lies that they circulate about us there; about
+ how we take out people's hearts for the purposes of magic, and
+ steal people's eyes to make photographic chemicals, and administer
+ medicines to bewitch them generally. I say that, if the first man
+ who comes to a chapel on an afternoon is a man who has heard these
+ things, you cannot be astonished that all you see of that man is
+ his back and his pigtail as he goes away.
+
+ 'Another man sometimes comes--a bolder man, and he comes in, and
+ the most natural thing for him seems to be to walk up to the table
+ and sit down on the other side, and there you and he are a pair.
+ The proper thing is to pour him out a cup of tea: that is
+ etiquette, and the etiquette seems to be that he should not drink
+ it. Sometimes, after the service begins, I see the native preacher
+ come slyly up, as if he did not mean anything at all; and he walks
+ up to the teapot, and lifts the lid quite quietly, and slips that
+ tea back into the pot again, and puts on the lid and warms it up,
+ and it is ready for the next man who comes.
+
+ 'If you get into conversation with one man, the congregation is,
+ for the most part, practically secured, because, though a Chinaman
+ is very much afraid of being spoken to directly by a foreigner,
+ most Chinamen are very curious to overhear any conversation that
+ may be carried on; so if you are speaking to him, in comes another
+ man to listen, and if you can get other men to come in and listen
+ over each other's backs, very soon more come in than the original
+ speaker cares to overhear his private conversation; and when that
+ step is reached, it is time to go to the platform and ask the
+ hearers to sit down and begin the regular service. Sometimes nobody
+ comes in, and then you have to try something else, and that is to
+ go and sit down a little nearer the door, and sometimes, in that
+ way, gradually a few people come in. But then in Peking sometimes
+ there is a great north-west wind blowing; and I think that is about
+ the hardest thing on a man's congregation before he gets it,
+ because, when the weather is unfavourable, there are not many
+ people about, and so we have to adopt another plan. We do not go on
+ to the streets, but inside the chapel the native preacher and I do
+ our best to sing a hymn. I say do our best, because sometimes these
+ native preachers do not succeed in singing very well; however, we
+ succeed in making a noise, and that is the thing that draws. The
+ people look in, and see what they suppose to be a foreigner and a
+ native chanting Buddhist prayers. In they come; they have not seen
+ that before, and they sit down, and, as soon as the hymn is
+ through, we have the opportunity of telling them the contents of
+ the hymn; and there you have your sermon ready to your hand.
+
+ 'But suppose you have got your congregation, it is not all
+ smooth-sailing water. Sometimes there are interruptions. Sometimes,
+ just when you have the ear of your audience, all at once a
+ tremendous row happens just outside the door, and the congregation
+ jump to their feet and rush out to see what is going on. I could
+ have told them if they had only asked me. No doubt, some unwise
+ Chinaman, in place of coming straight in and sitting down, stood on
+ the outskirt of the crowd on tiptoe. A city thief coming along
+ says, "Ah, there is my man," and he walks quietly up to him with a
+ pair of sharp scissors, cuts off his tobacco pouch, and goes off
+ with it. Of course, as soon as the man misses the pouch, his first
+ impulse is to grab his next neighbour; that neighbour remonstrates,
+ and then a fight commences.
+
+ 'Sometimes a funeral passes, and that is almost as serious an
+ interruption as a fight; because, although a Chinaman does not
+ think much about his soul after he dies, he thinks a vast deal
+ about his dead body, and, in order to be perfectly sure that he
+ will not be cheated by the undertaker, he buys his coffin before he
+ is sick, and sees that he has a good bargain. And so, having a good
+ coffin, he wants a good funeral; and it is said some men spend
+ nearly half of their fortune in having a grand procession when they
+ are carried to their grave. When one of these enormous funerals,
+ with a procession sometimes a quarter of a mile long, comes by, it
+ is a very bad job for your congregation. Out they go to have a look
+ at it.
+
+ 'Then the interruption is sometimes another thing, and this last
+ one is a more difficult case to settle. When one of the upper ten
+ thousand in China has a marriage, they want to have a great
+ exhibition; and after they have bought the furniture, they get and
+ hire a great many men, and have them dressed to carry that
+ furniture in procession along the streets and show it to their
+ neighbours. First comes a great wardrobe, and then a little
+ cupboard, a washstand, a square table, and all sorts of furniture.
+ Now when that comes, what are you to do? They have been at the
+ expense of paying for an exhibition for their neighbours to see,
+ and they feel that it would be unneighbourly if they did not step
+ to the door and look out and see the things carried past, and there
+ goes your congregation. Sometimes unusual interruptions happen. I
+ remember once a woman put her head in at the door. Women do not
+ come to these chapels often--I am very glad they do not. That woman
+ put her head in at the door, and I saw danger. She glared round the
+ place, and then she spied one man, and she shouted out something at
+ him: "Come out of that!" and, friends, he came out of that, in a
+ big hurry, too. He disturbed us very considerably. It was not the
+ woman so much as the man--we all pitied him as he went out.
+
+ 'Those audiences are very mixed, and they are very curious to your
+ eyes. Sometimes I see those audiences, most of whom we do not know
+ anything about, listening to what I have to tell them, quite as
+ still as you are now--their pipes out, the smoke cleared away. They
+ lean forward and listen just as still as audiences in this country
+ sometimes listen when the preacher, in an interesting discourse, is
+ coming up to a division of his subject. And, friends, let me tell
+ you what it is that makes them listen best of all--it is the
+ central doctrine of the truth of Christianity. When we come to tell
+ them of how Christ left the surroundings of heaven, and came to
+ spend so many years in such very poor, unsympathetic company on
+ earth (and that is a subject that a missionary sometimes can talk
+ feelingly upon when he has been in a foreign country for some
+ time), when we can tell them that, and then come to the last and
+ greatest part of all: how Christ allowed Himself, for love of man,
+ to be nailed to the cross, and not only that, but kept in Him that
+ gentle spirit that made Him pray for those who were putting Him to
+ death--oh, friends, when we come to that and tell them of it--I
+ know that a Chinaman is degraded, corrupt, sensual, material, but
+ he has a human heart; and when you can get at the heart, it
+ responds to the story of the Cross. We want to do something in
+ drawing the net, and so, on this table in the corner, there is a
+ pile of books, and as it gets towards the time to close, I say to
+ the friends, "Now, you will soon be going away to your evening
+ meal; and as I am a foreigner, probably you have not understood all
+ that I have said;" and then I say, "Now, before you go, there are a
+ number of books upon this table, where you will find the whole of
+ this subject put down in black and white; will you just come up and
+ have a look at the books before you go?" We want, if possible, to
+ establish a point of contact with them, and so to get a little
+ private conversation, as it were. If you ask them to come up and
+ look at a book, and they ask the price of it, you have an
+ opportunity of talking to them, and some of these men not only buy
+ the books, but they read them and come back for others.
+
+ 'Now, how does the matter stand? These heathen have been in our
+ chapel, and we have taken the opportunity of putting some of the
+ truth into their hearts; but I know a good part, much, it may be,
+ of what the man has heard when he goes out--well, it is stolen
+ away, or it is trampled under foot; but some part of it remains.
+
+ 'And now I can come to the practical part. I have not been trying
+ to entertain you, but I have been trying to interest you, and what
+ I want to impress upon you is this: after those men have left the
+ chapel you can do as much for their conversion as we can do in
+ China. I want you to pray for the conversion of these men to whom
+ we in Peking, and others in other parts of the world, are the means
+ of communicating these truths of Christ. I believe it is not only
+ the earnestness of the missionary that is going to produce results,
+ but it is your earnestness here. We are your agents, and I
+ believe, fervently, we shall have results there in direct
+ proportion to the measure of your earnestness here. I believe I am
+ speaking to the right people when I ask you to pray. Unprayed for,
+ I feel very much as if a diver were sent down to the bottom of a
+ river with no air to breathe, or as if a fireman were sent up to a
+ blazing building and held an empty hose; I feel very much as a
+ soldier who is firing blank cartridge at an enemy, and so I ask you
+ earnestly to pray that the Gospel may take saving and working
+ effect on the minds of those men to whose notice it has been
+ introduced by us. Not long ago, at the close of a local
+ anniversary, when we had been having a meeting, as we were going
+ home, three of us got off a tram-car--two ministers of the locality
+ and myself--and, as we were walking along, one said: "Ah, Gilmour,
+ it is all the same over again; it is just the old thing; you
+ missionaries come, and you have an anniversary, and the people's
+ earnestness seems to be stirred up, and you ask their prayers, and
+ it looks as if you would get them, but," he said, "you go away, and
+ the thing passes by and is just left where it was before." I do not
+ think that was quite correct. I think my brother was labouring
+ under a temporary fit of the blues, and I was very glad to find his
+ companion said it was not quite correct. What I want is this, to go
+ back to my work feeling that there are those behind us who are
+ praying earnestly that God's Spirit would work effectually in the
+ hearts of those to whom we have the privilege of preaching. If you
+ pray earnestly you can but work earnestly, and then you will also
+ give earnestly; and I do not think we can be too earnest in the
+ matter for which Christ was so much in earnest that He laid down
+ His own life.'
+
+The month of June and part of July was spent at Millport, a
+watering-place on the west coast of Scotland, near the lovely scenery
+of Arran. On July 4 he ascended Goatfell, and in so doing had an
+adventure which might have had very serious consequences. He started
+late, lost his way, but finally reached the summit at 8.45 P.M., and
+then, as he notes in his diary: 'Fog came on nearly at once with rain
+and thunder. Sat in the lee of a dripping rock on a wet stone and looked
+at a couple of acres of fog and granite boulders. Very dark and cold
+about midnight, the time wore on very slowly, more rain dripping, and
+fog. At 2 o'clock A.M. I began the descent, and in a short while it was
+light enough to see. Came on all right, and saw where I had missed the
+way.... I have not caught cold. I was wet all night, but kept wrapt up
+in my plaid and as warm as I could manage. Next day the minister
+congratulated me on being seen alive after my Goatfell adventure.'
+
+On September 1 the return voyage to China began, and Peking was reached
+on November 14.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+SUNSHINE AND SHADOW
+
+
+In Peking the old familiar round of mission duties recommenced. Gilmour
+after his absence of eighteen months was the same man, and yet not the
+same. He yearned for fruit in the conversion of souls, and he began to
+devote himself with more eager self-denial than ever to the winning of
+Chinamen's hearts for the Saviour. The winter of 1883-1884 was spent in
+Peking, and his diary is full of incidents illustrative of the time and
+effort he gave to dealing with individuals.
+
+In February, 1884, he made one of the most remarkable of his Mongolian
+journeys. He visited the Plain, travelling on foot, and thus subjecting
+himself to risks and hardships of a very serious order. But he had good
+reasons for his method, and he sets them forth with his usual clearness.
+Possibly no other journey of his life more strikingly testifies to his
+strict sense of duty, the unsparing way in which he spent himself in its
+discharge, and his eager desire to win souls.
+
+ 'On this occasion, partly owing to the shortness of the time at my
+ disposal, which made it hardly worth while to set up an
+ establishment, and partly owing to the peculiar season of the year,
+ which would have made it difficult to find pasture for travelling
+ cattle, I determined to go on foot, without medicines, in a
+ strictly spiritual capacity, and not seeking so much to make fresh
+ acquaintances or open up new ground as to revisit familiar
+ localities and see how far former evangelistic attempts had produced
+ any effect. In addition there were some individual Mongols who have
+ been taught a good deal about Christianity, and on whom I wished
+ once more, while there was still opportunity, to press the claims
+ of Christ.
+
+[Illustration: A CHINESE MULE LITTER]
+
+ 'Five cold days in a mule litter brought me to Kalgan, and another
+ day in a cart took me up over the pass and landed me in a Chinese
+ inn on the Mongolian plain. This inn has no separate rooms; the
+ guests all share the ample platform of the kitchen, and sleep on
+ straw mats laid over the brickwork, which is heated by flues
+ leading from fires on which their meals are cooked. The Chinese
+ innkeeper was an old friend of mine, and he permitted me to share
+ his room with him. From this, as a centre, I was able to make
+ expeditions to four Mongolian settlements.
+
+ 'My first visit was made to a lama whom I have known for years, and
+ who has been instructed in Christianity by others, both before and
+ since I made his acquaintance. He is a man of influence, wealth,
+ and leisure, and, though a priest, has a wife and child. I spent
+ almost a whole day with him, and hardly know what to think about
+ him. He seems to admit that there must be a God of the universe,
+ and admits that Christ may be a revelation of Him, but in the same
+ sense in which Buddha was. From one part of his conversation I was
+ almost led to believe that he had been praying to Jesus, but I
+ could get him to make no such admission. I fear that the inquiring
+ spirit of former years has given place to a spirit of indifference.
+ He has everything he wants, he has little or no care, seemingly; he
+ is content to let things drift, and keeps his mind easy. If he were
+ only waked up he might do much for his countrymen.
+
+ 'My second visit was to a temple and cluster of tents, where I
+ found some old acquaintances; was politely received, but nothing
+ more.
+
+ 'My third visit was to another cluster of tents, where I was at
+ once hailed as the doctor, and, _nolens volens_, compelled to
+ examine and prescribe for a number of diseases. Some cures
+ accomplished years before explained the enthusiasm of the friends
+ there, but for spiritual results I looked in vain.
+
+ 'My next expedition was to a place some miles--say eight--away.
+ Some years ago, in stormy weather, Mrs. Gilmour and I, soaked out
+ of our tent, had found shelter in the mud-house of a Mongol, who
+ refused to take anything for the use of his building, remarking
+ that we would be going and coming that way afterwards, and that
+ then we might give him a present of some foreign article or other.
+ I had sent him a few things, but had never since personally visited
+ him, and when I reached the settlement I was grieved to find that
+ the old man was dead. His son, a lad of twenty-three, had succeeded
+ to his estate, and his small official dignity and emoluments, and
+ received me in a most remarkably friendly way. He was just starting
+ from home, but on seeing me gave up all idea of his going away,
+ and, insisting on my staying in his tent for the night, spent the
+ remainder of the day with me.
+
+ 'Next day, slinging on one side a postman's brown bag containing my
+ kit and provisions; on the other an angler's waterproof bag, with
+ books, &c.; and carrying from a stick over my shoulder a Chinaman's
+ sheepskin coat, I left my landlord drinking the two ounces of hot
+ Chinese whisky which formed the invariable introduction to his
+ breakfast turned my face northwards, and started for a twenty-three
+ miles' walk to the settlement which, for some summers in
+ succession, has furnished me with men and oxen for my annual
+ journeys. Now the Mongols are familiar with the
+
+ Russians, who, as tea-agents, reside in Kalgan; they have seen many
+ passing foreign travellers on horses, camels, and in carts; they
+ have seen missionary journeys performed on donkeys and ox-carts;
+ but I think that that morning for the first time had they seen a
+ foreigner, with all his belongings hung about him, tramping the
+ country after the manner of their own begging lamas. There were few
+ people to meet on the road, but those I did meet asked the
+ customary questions in tones of great surprise, received my answers
+ with evident incredulity, and, for the most part rode away
+ muttering to themselves, _You eldib eem_, which may be translated
+ to mean, "Strange affair." My feet, through want of practice, I
+ suppose, soon showed symptoms of thinking this style of travelling
+ as strange as the Mongols did, and were badly blistered long before
+ the journey was over.
+
+[Illustration: JAMES GILMOUR EQUIPPED FOR HIS WALKING EXPEDITION IN
+MONGOLIA IN FEBRUARY 1884]
+
+ 'An occasional rest and a bite of snow varied the painful monotony
+ of the few last long miles; the river was reached at last, and,
+ crossing it, I was soon in front of the cluster of huts I had come
+ to visit, and on looking up I was agreeably astonished to find that
+ the first man to come out to meet me was the mandarin of the
+ district. He was soon joined by others, and, rescued from the dogs,
+ I was escorted to his tent, seated before the fire, and supplied
+ with a cup and full tea-pot. I had intended to drink tea in his
+ tent only for form's sake; but his tea was good, the snow seemed
+ only to have increased my thirst, the man himself was sincerely
+ friendly; under the circumstances my stoicism broke down, and the
+ mandarin's tea-pot was soon all but empty. Meanwhile, his tent had
+ been filling with friends and neighbours, to whom the news of my
+ arrival had spread, and in a little while I had round me a
+ representative from nearly every family in the village. Among the
+ others came my two servants--the priest and the layman who had
+ driven my ox-carts for me. Escorted by these I went to another
+ tent, rested there awhile, and then moved into a mud-built house.
+ The priest I had come to visit was busy lighting a fire which would
+ do nothing but smoke, and the room was soon full. Finding him
+ alone, I told him that I had come to speak to him and my other
+ friends about the salvation of their souls, and was pressing him to
+ accept Christ, when a layman I also knew entered. Without waiting
+ for me to say anything, the priest related the drift of our
+ conversation to the layman, who, tongs in hand, was trying to make
+ the fire blaze. Blaze it would not, but sent forth an increasing
+ volume of smoke, and the layman, invisible to me in the dense
+ cloud, though only about two yards away, spoke up and said that for
+ months he had been a scholar of Jesus, and that if the priest would
+ join him they would become Christians together. Whether the priest
+ would join him or not, his mind was made up, he would trust the
+ Saviour. By this time the cloud had settled down lower still. I was
+ lying flat on the platform, and the two men were crouching on the
+ floor--I could just see dimly the bottom of their skin coats--but
+ the place was beautiful to me as the gate of heaven, and the words
+ of the confession of Christ from out the cloud of smoke were
+ inspiriting to me as if they had been spoken by an angel from out
+ of a cloud of glory.
+
+ 'But neighbours came in, duty called the blackman (layman) away,
+ the evening meal had to be prepared and eaten, and it was not till
+ late at night that I had opportunity for a private talk with him
+ who had confessed Christ; and even then it was not private, because
+ we were within earshot of a family of people in their beds.
+
+ 'Of all the countries I have visited Mongolia is the most sparsely
+ peopled, and yet it is, of all the places I have seen, the most
+ difficult to get private conversation with any one. Everybody, even
+ half-grown children, seems to think he has a perfect right to
+ intrude on any and all conversation. Bar the door and deny
+ admittance, and you would be suspected of hatching a plot. Take a
+ man away for a stroll that you may talk to him in quiet, and you
+ would be suspected of some dangerous enchantment. Remembering that
+ one must always have some definite message or business to perform
+ when he travels, and hoping to be able to do something with this
+ same blackman, I had purposely left, in the Chinese inn, some
+ presents which I could not well carry with me, and after a day's
+ rest the blackman and I started to bring them. That gave us
+ twenty-three miles' private conversation, and a good answer to give
+ to all who demanded, "Where are you going?" "What to do?" He gave
+ me the history of the origin and growth of his belief in Christ. I
+ taught him much he did not know, and at a lonely place we sat down
+ and lifted our voices to heaven in prayer. It was the pleasantest
+ walk I ever had in Mongolia, and at the same time the most painful.
+ My feet broke down altogether. It was evident I could not walk back
+ again the next day, so, acting on my follower's advice, by a great
+ effort I walked into the inn as if my feet were all right; we
+ bargained for a cart and, the Chinaman not suspecting the state of
+ my feet, we got it at a reasonable rate. Mongols and Chinese joined
+ in explaining to me how much time and labour I would have saved if
+ I had hired a cart at first, taken everything with me, and not
+ returned to the inn at all. From their point of view they were
+ right; but the blackman and I looked at the thing from a different
+ standpoint. We had accomplished our purpose, and felt that we could
+ afford to let our neighbours plume themselves on their supposed
+ superior wisdom.
+
+ 'Another day's rest at this place gave me what I much wanted--an
+ opportunity for a long quiet talk with the mandarin of this small
+ tribe. I was especially anxious to explain to him the true nature
+ of Christianity, because the Mongol who professes Christianity
+ lives under his jurisdiction, and I felt sure that a right
+ understanding of the case might be of service in protecting the
+ professor from troubles that are likely to come to him through men
+ misunderstanding his case. The mandarin came. On my last visit I
+ had been the means of curing him of a troublesome complaint over
+ which he had spent much time and money; in addition, I had brought
+ him a present from England. He was perfectly friendly and
+ exceedingly attentive, and at the close of the conversation asked
+ some questions which I thought evinced that he had somewhat entered
+ into the spirit of the conversation. He is a man of few words, but
+ from what he said I hope that he feels something of the truth of
+ Christianity.
+
+ 'My next expedition was to a mandarin of wealth and rank, whose
+ encampment occupies a commanding site on a mountain-side
+ overlooking a large lake. I found him at home, and, as he knows
+ well the main doctrines of Christianity, my main mission to him at
+ this time was to try and rouse him to earnestness of thought and
+ action in regard to his personal relation to Christ. We spent great
+ part of the afternoon in earnest talking, and I was much pleased
+ with the manner in which he, from time to time, explained to
+ another mandarin, who was there as guest, doctrines and facts which
+ were alluded to in our conversation. Next morning he started on a
+ journey connected with the business of his office, and I returned
+ to my friendly quarters where I had left my belongings.
+
+ 'I felt it laid upon me to visit two lamas at a temple some seventy
+ miles from where I was, and started next day. I reached the temple
+ in three days, and found that both the lamas I had come to see were
+ dead. So, as far as they were concerned, I was too late. Both on
+ the road, however, and at the temple itself, I had good
+ opportunities for preaching and teaching. I met some interesting
+ men, and not only in tents where I was entertained as guest, but
+ sometimes out in the open desert, stray travellers would meet me,
+ dismount from their horses, and give me occasion for Christian
+ conversation. Five days completed this round, and after another
+ day's rest I started back for Kalgan, escorted for ten miles by him
+ who had professed Christ. We walked slowly, as we had much to say.
+ Arrived at the parting place, we sat down and prayed together. I
+ then left, and the last I saw of the poor fellow, there he was,
+ sitting in the same place still. I reached Kalgan without
+ adventure, and returned to Peking on March 21, having been away
+ just over a month.'
+
+Possibly the most touching comment upon this extraordinary journey is to
+give some of the brief entries which refer to it in the diary.
+
+ '_February 19, 1884._--Started in a litter for Mongolia. Good talk
+ in inn with innman.'
+
+ '_February 23._--Went to Mr. Williams. My letter had not reached
+ them. No one knew I was coming.'
+
+ '_February 25._--Over the Pass to Barosaij.'
+
+ '_February 26._--Spent the day with Tu Gishuae. Urged on him the
+ internal proof of Christianity--the change of heart.'
+
+ '_February 28._--Shabberti. Boyinto JauggÈ has desire to become
+ scholar of Jesus.'
+
+ '_March 1._--Walked here. Feet terribly bad. Snow on the road.
+ Great thirst. Badma Darag met me. Tea in his tent. Boyinto's
+ confession in the smoke of the _baishin_.'[4]
+
+[4] Fire in the centre of the tent.
+
+ '_March 2._--Sabbath. Quiet day. Much talk with all. The Lord
+ opened my lips.'
+
+ '_March 3._--Walked to Barosaij with Boyinto to bring my presents.
+ Talk about Christianity. Prayer in the desert. Feet terribly bad,
+ oh, such pain in walking.'
+
+ '_March 4._--Carted back.'
+
+ '_March 7._--Hara Oss. Walked back here. Called on Tu Lobsung.
+ Talk. He knew the way to heaven, but said, "Tell it to some of the
+ younger ones." "You go first," I replied. "You most need to know."'
+
+ '_March 8._--Terrible feet. Got to Chagan Hauran.'
+
+ '_March 14._--Boyinto accompanied me to Chagan Balgas with his
+ pony. Saw him sitting as long as I was in sight. Feet bad.'
+
+ '_March 21._--Left Pei Kuan at 4 A.M. Dark and snow. Terrible march
+ over slippery stones. Nan Kou at 7 A.M. No donkey on such a snowy
+ day. Hired the next twenty-seven li. Stiff march. Shatto at 11.35.
+ Terrible march to Ching Ho at 3 P.M. Terrible march to TÍ Sheng
+ MÍn. Home at 6.10. Prayer Meeting. Thanks be unto God for all His
+ mercies.'
+
+Early in 1885 Mr. Gilmour's heart was rejoiced by the tidings of the
+baptism of Boyinto, the Mongol to whom reference has been repeatedly
+made above. Although Gilmour's was not the hand to administer the rite,
+undoubtedly the conversion was the result of his work. On January 26,
+1885, he received a letter from the Rev. W. P. Sprague, of the American
+Mission at Kalgan, part of which we quote.
+
+
+ 'Kalgan: Jan. 14, 1885.
+
+ 'Dear Brother Gilmour,--I hasten to tell you the very good news.
+ Boyinto of Shabberti was baptized by my hand this day into the
+ Church of Christ, here at Kalgan, in the presence of our assembled
+ church and congregation. I'm sure you will rejoice and thank God
+ more than any of us. And I never saw our Christians so happy to
+ receive any one into the Church. The only thing I regret is that
+ it should not be your hand instead of mine to administer the sacred
+ rite.
+
+ 'I wrote you of his visit to us a month ago, and his application to
+ join the Church here, and our satisfaction with his appearance. He
+ turned up again yesterday morning, and spent all day with us. In
+ the afternoon we had, by previous appointment, a union meeting of
+ upper and lower city congregations, as a continuation of week of
+ prayer meeting, because the interest was so great. Mr. Roberts
+ preached, and in the after part of meeting, when two or three
+ others had risen for prayers, I asked Boyinto if he wanted to ask
+ Christians to pray for him, and he arose and expressed his desires,
+ including wanting to be baptized very plainly. We called church
+ meeting at close of the service, and proceeded to examine him for
+ admission to Church. He answered so well as to please every one,
+ making some happy hits, as when asked what sort of a place heaven
+ was, replied, "I haven't been there--how can I tell?" Then said,
+ "Would any one pray to go there if it were not a good place?" But
+ his straightforward, open simplicity was refreshing. There seemed
+ no reason for thinking he was other than an honest
+ believer--seeking to follow Jesus in all things. The native church
+ members first responded with enthusiasm that he was a most fit
+ candidate for receiving to the Church, and expressed great delight
+ at finding a Mongol who loved and trusted our Saviour. So we felt
+ with Peter, "Can any man forbid water that these should not be
+ baptized?" The others then asked me to baptize him on the morrow,
+ when we were to have another union meeting at our place. And could
+ you have seen his rising and answering my questions, give assent to
+ creed and covenant, and then see him remove his cap and bow his
+ head reverently and receive the water of baptism, your heart would
+ overflow with gratitude and praise to God for this first fruit
+ from Mongolia. After prayer we sang "From Greenland's icy
+ mountains," changed to "From Mongolia, &c," and we felt it as never
+ before.
+
+ 'Though God has thus given us great pleasure in gathering this
+ first fruit, still I feel, and we all feel, that the honour of the
+ work belongs to God, and the reward to you and others.'
+
+During 1884 and 1885 the regular work of the Peking mission occupied
+almost the whole of his time, the Rev. S. E. Meech being in England on
+furlough, and most of his duties therefore falling upon Mr. Gilmour.
+During his stay in England he had attended many of the Salvation Army
+meetings, and had caught much of their spirit. He had also come to the
+conviction that men needed to be dealt with individually rather than in
+the mass. Hence he gave much time to conversation, to teaching single
+persons the Christian catechism and the New Testament, and endeavouring,
+by talking and praying with them, to lead them to a knowledge of the
+truth. From six in the morning until ten at night he was at the service
+of all comers. In the afternoon he attended one or both of the Peking
+chapels, preaching if there were the opportunity, but always eagerly on
+the alert for any individuals showing signs of interest in the Gospel.
+It had been the custom of the missionaries to reserve the Sunday evening
+for an English service, devoted to their own spiritual refreshment.
+This, which was held in the mission compound, he ceased to attend, even
+although his absence sometimes made it impossible to hold the service,
+in order that he might find time to read and talk and pray with his
+Chinese servants. Frequently the meal-time would find him thus engaged,
+but the meal had to wait until his visitor had left, or until the
+interview came to its natural close. He ceased to read all newspapers
+except those distinctively Christian. He found no time for books, as he
+felt that direct work for the Chinese should fill the hours he might
+otherwise devote to reading. He became more wholly than ever the man of
+one book--the Bible--and so absorbed did he grow in this close dealing
+with souls that in the earlier stages of his wife's illness he felt
+constrained to place it before even her wish that he would remain by her
+at periods of severe suffering and weakness.
+
+ '_December 9, 1883._--At chapel met Wang from a place 300 li away
+ down in the country. He had heard a sermon there two or three years
+ before which he remembered, and could quote. I began the service,
+ and brought him up here to my study. We were talking when another
+ man, Jui, came in from 130 li north of Peking. He had to run away
+ from home on account of misconduct. These two kept me till dark.'
+
+In a letter to the Rev. S. E. Meech, dated November 9, 1885, Mr. Gilmour
+refers to a number of these individual cases in which he has been
+interesting himself, and the way in which he has dealt with them. It
+illustrates his method of close and careful dealing with each native.
+
+ 'Ch'ang attends Sunday and Friday services. My opinion about Ch'ang
+ is that he wants mission employ. He has no expectation of that from
+ me, and little from Rees. I think, too, that he does not mean to
+ break with Christianity or with us, and I faintly hope that his
+ experiences with us will do us good, though they have been most
+ painful to us. I think you'll find him much more tractable than he
+ would have been had he not been through these troubles with us.
+
+ 'Hsing has had the devil putting philosophic doubts into him. I
+ have pressed him to pelt the devil with Scripture, as our Master
+ did.
+
+ 'Li, shoemaker, I _do_ like. He cannot stay to Sunday service. I
+ take him before service therefore.
+
+ 'Fu does well. Last Friday he remained after prayer-meeting, and
+ talked till 9.40 about all manner of things secular and sacred. He
+ has most pleasant remembrances of Emily--Emily, too, liked him.
+
+ 'Jui Wu, the powder magazine man, is in a more hopeful case. He may
+ come all right yet.[5]
+
+[5] Fu is now (1892) an evangelist, and Jui Wu a dispenser, in the
+Chi Chou Mission.
+
+ 'Old Tai nearly went, but will now, I think, remain till you come.
+ He wants to tiffin with me on Sundays, and enjoys much four, five,
+ or six small cups of good strong tea with milk and sugar. He is
+ growing in grace.
+
+ 'Young Tai I am detaining after his father goes and reading with
+ him and teaching him. He gives up his trade for the day, and I want
+ to give him a good day.
+
+ 'Chao Erh attends well and is improved in circumstances.
+
+ 'Lu Ss[)u] is in his old trade, and doing well. He comes on Sundays
+ when he comes. He was the man I hoped least of, and as yet he
+ pleases me almost most.
+
+ 'Lama comes to-morrow to finish reconstructing Mongol catechism. I
+ may go on a two months' journey to Mongolia, starting in December.
+ I'll have to see the children to Tientsin in February, and want to
+ meet you.
+
+ 'Hs¸s as they were.[6]
+
+[6] Father and son; the only native preachers in the West City of
+Peking at that time.
+
+ 'I am very much encouraged and thankful about the little Church. I
+ can honestly say that I have tried to do my best for it during
+ your absence, and God has encouraged me a good deal in it. I have
+ reaped some that you have sown, and have endeavoured to sow
+ something for you to reap when you return.
+
+ 'I sometimes have deep fits of the blues when I think of the
+ children, but their mother was able to trust Jesus with them, and
+ why should not I?
+
+ 'The Mongol work, too, has entered on a new phase, and that opens
+ up a new future for me. It is a formidable affair. I don't think
+ I'll go to Kalgan or that region. I fear no doctor would stay with
+ me there. I may go away North-east. I can hardly tell yet.
+ Meantime, with God's help, I hope to do another month's work in
+ Peking, and then hand the thing over to Rees once for all. Most of
+ my books I'll sell. What use are they to me? I never have time to
+ read them, and am not likely ever to have.'
+
+The letter just quoted was written after the sad event to which we must
+now refer. Towards the close of the summer of 1885 Mr. Gilmour awoke to
+the fact that one of the heaviest sorrows of his life was coming upon
+him. For some years past Mrs. Gilmour had been subject to severe attacks
+of pain. The visit to England and the rest and change of the old home
+life had in a measure restored her. But hardly were they comfortably
+established in their old Peking quarters ere some of her most trying
+symptoms reappeared. With that brave heart and resolute spirit
+characteristic of her whole missionary career, for a time she gave
+herself to the duties of the mission and bore her full share of its
+anxieties and toils. But gradually she was constrained to recognise that
+her active work was over. From the first she had thrown herself
+whole-heartedly into missionary Service. She could converse fluently
+with the Mongols, having acquired their language in the same way as her
+husband, by enduring repeatedly all the privations of life in a Mongol
+tent. She had impressed them by her fondness for animals, by her
+gentleness of spirit, and by her evident interest in all that bore upon
+their own welfare. In Peking she had laboured hard among the women and
+girls, both in the matter of education and also of direct religious
+instruction. A very bitter element in her cup of sorrow was the
+conviction gradually forced upon her that her power to do this work was
+fast slipping away. In a letter to her sister, Mrs. Meech, then in
+England, dated May 2, 1885, she gives the first clear expression to this
+feeling: 'I would have written before, but I have been ill for about six
+weeks; not actually ill, except one week, but not able to do anything
+except the children's lessons and the harmonium on Sundays sometimes.
+All the rest has had to go. I am sorry, but it can't be helped. How long
+it will last I don't know. I can't get stronger, so I must be content to
+be tired. I am nothing more than weak, and a great many people are that.
+There has been a grand revival here. It seemed to pass like a mountain
+torrent, while I had only to look on and see. My only wonder was that
+people had lived so long without the happiness that they might have had
+for the taking. I didn't want to go to the meeting, I felt so weak and
+unable to bear the tension of spiritual excitement. But as it was it
+didn't tire me at all, but made me love a lot of the people. May the
+Chinese feel the flood tide of new life that has come into Peking! And
+they must, there can be nothing to hinder it.'
+
+The reference in the last part of this letter is to a great deepening
+of spiritual life that took place among the missionaries, and also among
+some of the European residents in Peking.
+
+The first explicit reference by Mr. Gilmour to his coming sorrow occurs
+in the Diary; but in his report, sent home a month later, and dated
+August 4, 1885, he wrote: 'Mrs. Gilmour is very ill, and now very weak.
+I fear all hope of her recovery is taken away. Her trouble is a
+run-down, but the serious complication is her lungs. We are at the hills
+in a temple with another family, the Childs. Mrs. Child came out in the
+same ship with Mrs. Gilmour, when, as Miss Prankard, she came first to
+China. Mrs. Child renders invaluable service to the sick one.'
+
+In the Diary the following entries show the course of sorrowful
+events:--
+
+ '_July 4, 1885._--It really dawns upon me to-day in such a way that
+ I can feel it that my wife is likely to die, and I too feel
+ something of how desolate it would be for me with my motherless
+ children sent away from me. Eh, man!'
+
+ '_August 22._--Emily spoke of being sometimes _so_ happy. She is
+ quite aware now she cannot recover.'
+
+ '_September 13_, Sunday, Peking.--Emily saw all the women. She felt
+ very weak to-day. Remarked at 7 P.M.: "Well, Jamie, I am going, I
+ suppose. I'll soon see you there. It won't be long." I said she
+ would not want me much there. She said fondly she would. "I think
+ I'll sit at the gate and look for you coming." Said she has been
+ out for the last time. Asked me not to go to chapel, but went.'
+
+ '_September 17._--To-day, in the morning, I promised Emily that I
+ would remain home from the chapel and give her a holiday. She was
+ _so_ pleased. We had a most enjoyable afternoon. She was so happy.
+ She sat up for an hour or so, and we conversed about all things,
+ the use of the beautiful in creation, &c.'
+
+All the next day Mrs. Gilmour slowly sank, and soon after the midnight
+of September 18 passed peacefully within 'the gate.' The story of the
+closing scene was thus told by her husband:--
+
+
+ 'Peking: Saturday, September 19, 1885.
+
+ 'My dear Meech,--Emily crossed the river last night, or this
+ morning rather at 12.15.
+
+ 'I was called in from the Friday evening prayer meeting just as it
+ was concluding, and found her with laboured breath and fixed eyes.
+ For a time we thought it was all to end at once. After a time she
+ got over it.
+
+ '10 P.M. was a repetition of 8 P.M.'s experience.
+
+ 'At 12 midnight she was labouring much in her breath, coughed a
+ very little cough, and all at once the rapidity of her breath
+ nearly doubled, suddenly her hand fell over powerless, her eyes
+ became fixed, there was some difficult breathing, and with Mrs.
+ Henderson on the one side of the bed, which had been moved when we
+ came from the hills into the sitting-room, she departed.
+
+ 'During these four hours she spoke little; once or twice she called
+ for milk, but for the most part contented herself with assenting or
+ dissenting to and from my remarks and suggestions by moving the
+ head.
+
+ 'At 10.30, seeing me sleepy and desiring to sleep herself, she
+ asked me to go and lie down, but I said I would not do so while she
+ was so ill.
+
+ 'I asked her if she felt all safe in the hands of Jesus. She nodded
+ her assent.
+
+ 'Some month or six weeks ago we two had talked about everything to
+ be done in case of her death, the children, etc., and not only
+ then, but more than once we had talked over spiritual things,
+ because we feared that when the end came she might not be able to
+ speak. I am glad we did so. During these four hours she was either
+ in such great distress, or, when free from distress, was so tired
+ and eager to sleep, that talking was hardly possible.
+
+ 'The "Rest" she so longed for she has now got.
+
+ 'I treasure what she said one day when she had been, I think,
+ reading her wall text, "T_o me to live is Christ, to die is gain_,"
+ when I asked her if _she_ felt it so. She said she did, and often
+ would remark that to go would be far better for her, but she was so
+ eager to get well for my sake and that of the children. For
+ herself, too, she was more and more enchanted with the beauty God
+ had put in the world. On Friday I went in, she waved her hand and
+ said, "What beauty!" It was some flowers on the table. A bunch of
+ grapes, a beauty, filled her mouth with praise to God for all His
+ goodness to her. The post waits. Funeral Monday.
+
+ 'Yours in sorrow,
+ 'J. GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Mrs. Gilmour was buried on September 21. Her faith was clear and strong.
+Uncommon as their courtship had been, the subsequent married life was
+very happy. She was the equal of her husband in missionary zeal and
+enthusiasm, and he himself bears testimony to the unerring skill which
+she possessed in gauging the moral qualities of the Chinese. She gave
+much time and labour to Christian work among the women and girls in
+Peking; and her husband was greatly helped in his work during the nearly
+eleven years of married life by her sound judgment, her strong
+affection, her loving Christian character, and her entire consecration
+to the Lord Jesus Christ.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+A CHANGE OF FIELD
+
+
+During 1885 James Gilmour gradually reached the conclusion that a change
+of field was desirable. He was aware that friends and colleagues more or
+less qualified to form an opinion had urged upon him the advisability of
+labouring in Eastern Mongolia among the agricultural Mongols. No one
+knew so well as himself the advantages and the disadvantages of this
+plan. The reasons that finally led him to a decision were noble and
+characteristic. It was a hard field, and no one else could or would go.
+The Mongols of the Plain were to some extent benefited by the American
+Mission at Kalgan; those dwelling in Eastern Mongolia were without a
+helper. Considerations like these, as he tells us, decided his new
+course of action.
+
+ 'In these circumstances my mind has turned away north-east from
+ Peking, where people are not so scarce, and where the Mongols live
+ as farmers. I have been to that region twice. I knew some people
+ who came from that region. As soon as Mr. Rees returns from Chi
+ Chou I hope to go again. A doctor might be induced to settle
+ somewhere there, and though it would be hard a bit, a family might
+ live there too, which I don't think would be possible on the plain
+ beyond Kalgan.
+
+ 'I am fully aware of the difficulties. They are:--
+
+ '1. I have no proper Chinaman to take with me. More than half the
+ population is Chinese, and I could not do well without a Chinaman.
+
+ '2. It is a new district and will take time to work up.
+
+ '3. It is not easily reached from Peking or anywhere else, and will
+ be a very isolated part.
+
+ '4. It is rather a rough and unsafe district.
+
+ 'I know all these, but feel, in reliance on God, like facing the
+ thing as the best and proper thing to do. There are inns all about,
+ and though for some time a private location may not be secured, we
+ can still go about among the people. My main hope, though, is in
+ settling down somewhere as a head centre, in close contact with the
+ people, so that I earnestly desire that the doctor should come. If
+ he is unmarried I would be glad to see him to-morrow. Could you not
+ get a doctor who would be willing to remain single till a location
+ could be secured? After a location has been secured let him marry
+ if he likes.
+
+ 'I think that the region I have in my mind would make a good centre
+ for a doctor, and that he would have plenty of practice among
+ Mongols and Chinese, especially if he could start a hospital for
+ in-patients.
+
+ 'I am very glad that the Mongolian region around Kalgan has shown
+ signs of bearing fruit. It has strengthened my faith much. I am
+ also glad that God has acknowledged in some degree my work here in
+ Peking, and I feel more hopeful than ever I did. God, too, has cut
+ me adrift from all my fixings, so that I feel quite ready to go
+ anywhere if only He goes with me.'
+
+Mr. Gilmour entered upon this new departure on the understanding that a
+medical colleague should be sent to him at the earliest possible moment.
+This responsibility the London Board assumed and endeavoured to
+discharge. The result was a severe trial to the faith, not only of the
+solitary worker but to all interested--and they were many--in the fate
+of the new mission. As we shall see later on, when a congenial and
+competent medical colleague reached him, and was entering with vigour
+and hope upon the work, Dr. Mackenzie of Tientsin suddenly died, and
+before the immediate and urgent claims of Tientsin the claims of
+Mongolia had to give way. But in estimating the success of both
+missions, that on the Plain, and that in Eastern Mongolia, it must never
+be forgotten that what Gilmour considered _essential_, the presence and
+help of a medical colleague, was never in the Providence of God granted
+to him for any length of time. In the account he gives of his first
+visit to the region as its missionary--he had been twice before on
+visits of inspection--he dwells upon this necessity.
+
+ 'I left Peking December 14, 1885, and re-entered Peking February
+ 16, 1886, so that my absence from here was just two months. The
+ part of Mongolia I went to is situated 800 li, or say 270 English
+ miles, north-east by east of Peking, and, at the usual rate of 90
+ li (or 30 miles) a day, is nine days distant. This is not the part
+ of Mongolia near Kalgan. Kalgan is north-north-west of Peking, five
+ days' journey.
+
+[Illustration: MAP ILLUSTRATING JAMES GILMOUR'S LABOURS IN EASTERN
+MONGOLIA]
+
+ 'Whilst I was considering my plans a Mongol appeared in Peking who
+ was willing to take me to his home, and I went with him, hoping
+ thus to get introduced to a district of country, an introduction
+ being both necessary and helpful. Ta ChÍng Tz[)u] is the name of
+ the place where, through his introduction, I was located from
+ December 23, 1885 to February 9, 1886. I had a room in an inn. I
+ spent some days at the home of my Mongol friend and made two
+ journeys to other places, but Ta ChÍng Tz[)u] was my headquarters.
+ It is a small market town, with a daily fair. The surrounding
+ neighbourhood is peopled with Mongols and Chinese in about equal
+ proportions. The Mongols are mostly lords of the soil, and style
+ the Chinese slaves, that is in the country. The real trade of the
+ whole locality is in the hands of the Chinese. The Mongols all
+ speak Chinese, and the town resident Mongols have, many of them,
+ forgotten Mongolian, and laugh at themselves as not being able to
+ speak their own language.
+
+ 'The country is like Wales in this respect, that, though Mongolian
+ is the native language, the coming language and the language that
+ is affected and sought after, is Chinese. Well-to-do Mongols have
+ Chinese teachers for their children, and read Chinese well. During
+ my stay there I sold more Chinese than Mongolian books, and talked
+ more Chinese than Mongolian, though my intercourse was largely with
+ Mongols.
+
+ 'Opium is largely grown there, so is tobacco, and large quantities
+ of whisky are manufactured and consumed. It was partly a famine
+ year. At a little distance from Ta ChÍng Tz[)u] the harvest had
+ failed, and I think the line of preaching that seemed to impress
+ the hearers most was one that reasoned with them about the growth,
+ manufacture, and use of these three, being so contrary to Heaven's
+ design in giving land and rain to grow food, that it was not to be
+ wondered at if, seeing how the land and rain were perverted, God
+ should send short rations. Evil speaking, vile language, made a
+ fourth subject which naturally came in for notice, and on all these
+ four subjects I scarcely ever spoke without gaining the nearly
+ universal concurrence of my little audiences.
+
+ 'The great theme, however, was Christ, and I think that most men in
+ that little market town, and a great many of those who used to
+ come to the fair, both heard and understood the great gospel truth
+ of salvation in Jesus.
+
+ 'Eager to see some more of the country, and in the hope that I
+ might be able to talk to him on the way, I hired a Mongol to carry
+ my bedding and books, and made a descent on a village thirty miles
+ away. The general cold of the winter was aggravated by a snowstorm
+ which overtook us at the little market town, and I have no words to
+ tell you how the cold felt that day as I paraded that one street. I
+ sold a fair number of books, though my hands were too much benumbed
+ almost to be able to hand the books out. I made some attempts at
+ preaching, but the muscles were also benumbed--that day _was_ a
+ _cold_ day.
+
+ 'I was turned out of two respectable inns at Bull Town because I
+ was a foot traveller, had no cart or animal, that is, and had to
+ put up in a tramps' tavern because I came as a tramp!
+
+ 'Next journey I made I hired a man and a _donkey_. The donkey was
+ my passport to respectability, and I was more comfortable too,
+ being able to take more bedding with me. I was warned against going
+ to Ch'ao Yang, sixty miles, the roads being represented as unsafe;
+ but I went and found no trouble, though there was a severe famine
+ in the district. I spent a day each at two market towns on the way,
+ and two days in Ch'ao Yang itself.
+
+ 'The journey home I made on foot, a donkey driven by a Mongol
+ carrying my bedding and books. I adopted this plan mainly to bring
+ myself into close contact with the Mongol. He proved himself a
+ capital fellow to travel with, but as yet has shown no signs of
+ belief in Christ. As we did long marches my feet suffered badly.'
+
+In a private letter written at this time he enters a little more fully
+into what he had to endure.
+
+ 'I had a good time in Mongolia, but oh! so cold. Some of the days I
+ spent in the markets were so very cold that my muscles seemed
+ benumbed, and speech even was difficult. I met with some spiritual
+ response, though, and with that I can stand cold. Eh! man, I have
+ got thin. I am feeding up at present. I left my medicines, books,
+ &c., there, and walked home here, a donkey carrying my baggage, a
+ distance of about three hundred miles, in seven and a half days, or
+ about forty miles a day, and my feet were really very bad.
+
+ 'At night I used to draw a woollen thread through the blisters. In
+ the morning I "hirpled" a little, but it was soon all right. I
+ walked, not because I had not money to ride, but to get at the
+ Mongol who was with me.'
+
+These graphic pictures enable us to realise how Mr. Gilmour began the
+last great missionary enterprise of his life. He returned to Peking, and
+then had to pass through that severe trial which comes to almost all
+missionaries in the foreign field, which is often one of their heaviest
+crosses. His two eldest boys were sent home for education. They sailed
+from Tientsin March 23, 1886, the diary for that day containing the
+brief but significant reference: 'At 6.45 A.M. came all the friends once
+more, at 7.30 cast off, and the vessel slowly fell out into the middle
+of the river. Oh! the parting!' But at 8.30 on the same morning the
+sorrowful father had started on his solitary return journey to Peking.
+Bereft now of both wife, and boys he was to pass the rest of his career
+in China, except for the brief intervals of residence in Peking, in the
+cheerless, noisy, uncongenial quarters of an ordinary Chinese inn. The
+return of the Rev. S. E. Meech in April 1886 set him entirely free from
+mission work in the capital. He had already acquired the needful
+experience of his new field of labour, and on April 22, 1886, he started
+anew for Eastern Mongolia. It is neither necessary nor desirable to
+enter into any very detailed description of the next three years. In
+many respects day after day was occupied with the round of ever
+recurring and similar duties, but it is desirable to enter, if we can,
+with some minuteness into his inner life, and to lay bare the spiritual
+sources and springs of his outward actions. It is in these, in our
+judgment, that the true beauty, the abiding lesson, and the great
+success of his life consist. And this he has enabled us to do. In a
+private, not an official, letter to the Rev. R. Wardlaw Thompson, the
+Foreign Secretary of the London Missionary Society, he indicates his
+actions and the motives that were impelling him so to act, during the
+summer of 1886. Differences of opinion arose with his fellow
+missionaries as to the wisdom of his methods and the soundness of his
+judgment. Those who differed most strongly from him knew little or
+nothing by personal observation and experience of the conditions of work
+either on the Plain or at Ch'ao Yang. But no question ever did or ever
+could arise as to the absolute consecration of his heart and life to the
+work of winning souls. The truth of the words in one of his official
+reports was manifest to all: 'Man, the fire of God is upon me to go and
+preach.'
+
+ 'The past four and a half months has been a time of no small trial
+ and spiritual tension. Since April 22 I have had no tidings of the
+ outer world. An agent of the Bible Society, who was selling books
+ in the district, was with me for a month, but he had gone out
+ before me, so that when we met he had no news for me, but wanted
+ news from me.
+
+ 'Some men, who gave promise of believing in Jesus, have fallen
+ away, and I have a haunting suspicion that it was one such man who,
+ on the morning of Sunday, June 6, stole my beautiful copy of the
+ revised Bible, leaving me till now with only a New Testament in
+ English. I had much difficulty in procuring that Bible, and wasn't
+ it heartless of a Chinaman to steal it for the leather binding, for
+ which even he could have hardly any use? I said not a single word
+ to anyone in the town about it, as I feared that making trouble
+ over it would hinder me in future, by making innkeepers afraid to
+ receive me, lest they should be held responsible for such losses. I
+ can hardly say though, that, at first at least, I took joyfully the
+ spoiling of my goods. Secret tears testified to my sense of the
+ loss, but falling back on the faith that all things work together
+ for my good, I was comforted, and gave the more earnest heed to the
+ New Testament.
+
+ 'Then the Chinese would ask, "How many people have believed and
+ entered the religion since you left Peking?" and such questions
+ kept before my mind painfully how slowly things move, and drew out
+ my soul in more painful longing for God's blessing in the
+ conversion of men.
+
+ 'In the beginning of July I must have got a touch of the sun.
+ Nearly all that month I was ill, but just then was the great annual
+ fair at Ch'ao Yang, so, ill and all, I had the tent put up daily
+ and dispensed medicines. My assistant, however, had to do most of
+ the preaching; I had not much strength for that. The first three
+ weeks in August I had diarrh[oe]a and dysentery. I was at Ta ChÍng
+ Tz[)u]. There was no fair, and but poor market gatherings, but,
+ weather permitting, we put up our tent daily and did good work.
+ Paul says (Gal. iv. 19), "My little children, of whom I am again in
+ travail until Christ be formed in you," and he is right. It is a
+ carrying of men in prayer until the image of Christ is formed in
+ them; and how many of them prove abortions.
+
+ 'One of the converts at Ta ChÍng Tz[)u] caused me no little
+ anxiety. I knew that he professed to be impressed last winter. He
+ said he wanted to call on me in my inn and tell me his
+ difficulties. I was eager to get home, but as he said he would have
+ no leisure before a certain date, I waited till then, nearly a
+ week, for almost no other purpose than to see him. He never came,
+ and I trudged back to Peking downcast about him.
+
+ 'This year when we came to Ta ChÍng Tz[)u] on our way to Ch'ao
+ Yang, on going to his place for breakfast (he is one of two
+ brothers who own and manage a restaurant, and both of them, and a
+ third brother, are members of a sect which forbids opium, whisky,
+ and tobacco), we were shown into the more private part, and he and
+ his brother and the cook set upon us to inquire more fully about
+ Christianity, how to enter it, etc, etc. This took me by surprise,
+ and made me so glad that my breakfast for the most part remained
+ uneaten, though we had travelled eight hours that morning. In the
+ evening I did not go for a meal, and my assistant on going was met
+ at the door by the inquirers, and so engaged in conversation about
+ Christianity that darkness set in, the cooking range was closed,
+ and the establishment shut for the day before they were finished.
+ My man had no dinner. Next day we went on towards Ch'ao Yang
+ thankful and happy. These restaurant people had a few days before
+ been visited by the Bible Society's agent, and had derived much
+ Christian benefit from his Chinese assistant.
+
+ 'Our interview with the restaurant men was on Monday. In Ch'ao Yang
+ next Sunday, just six days after being, so to speak, on the mount
+ of transfiguration with these Chinamen, on dismissing the few
+ hangers-on that remained at the close of the afternoon preaching,
+ and stepping down from the little vantage-ground from which I had
+ been speaking, one of the audience said he would go home with me to
+ my inn, as he had come with a letter to me from Ta ChÍng Tz[)u]
+ from the Bible agent. I went to the inn, read the letter, and found
+ that he and his Chinese helper had differed, and he had come to Ta
+ ChÍng Tz[)u] seeking me. He needed and asked my help, so next day I
+ started for Ta ChÍng Tz[)u], and on arriving there found that the
+ little place was full of the news of the quarrel between the
+ Christian foreigner and the Christian native. That was bad, but,
+ worse still, on going to the restaurant I found the earnestness of
+ the inquirers gone, and one of them said openly, "If this is the
+ sort of fruit that Christianity bears, what better is it than any
+ other religion?"
+
+ 'In a later visit paid in May they seemed colder still, and the
+ place where I had hoped to gather fruit seemed barren and hopeless.
+
+ 'In August we again visited Ta ChÍng Tz[)u]. I was blue. The fever
+ of July, the defection of the Mongol donkey man, who failed to come
+ for us, the diarrh[oe]a, which on the journey changed to dysentery,
+ being baffled in attempting to find suitable quarters in Ta ChÍng
+ Tz[)u], and the chilled hearts of the restaurant men, made our
+ entrance not cheerful. On the way my assistant and I had talked
+ over matters, and resolved by prayer and endeavour to see what
+ could be done for the restaurant men. Just ten days after our
+ arrival the eldest brother called on me in my inn and said,
+ "To-night I dismiss my gods, henceforth I am a Christian. I am
+ ready to be baptized any day you may be pleased to name."
+
+ 'I cannot say what a relief these words brought me. There still
+ remained anxieties in his case, but in a day or two things came out
+ all right, and day by day in public in the restaurant he might be
+ seen studying his catechism when unemployed, and speaking for
+ Christianity to all who asked what book that was.
+
+ 'He is a leading spirit, though a poor scholar, and was the deacon
+ or head of the branch of the sect in Ta ChÍng Tz[)u], called Tsai
+ li ti. There are some twelve or sixteen members. Most of them
+ joined the sect through his endeavours, and he is eager to rear up
+ Christianity in the same way. You will partly understand now how
+ anxious I am about him. If he goes on all right, we may soon have a
+ little company of believers there. If he falls away--well, all
+ things work together for my good.
+
+ 'One thing that moved these restaurant men towards Christianity was
+ an incident which happened in their establishment last winter. A
+ half-drunk Chinaman reviled me badly one evening at dinner. He laid
+ to my charge many bad and grievous things. Though they were utterly
+ false as regards me, they might be quite true of some other
+ foreigner whom he may have met. It was useless to reason with a
+ drunken man over a case of mistaken identity, so I said nothing,
+ ate my dinner, paid my bill, and went to my inn. The restaurant men
+ were very wroth with the man, they told me afterwards, and felt
+ like "going for" him themselves, and never forgot what they were
+ pleased to call my patience. In God's providence this little
+ incident seems to have been an important factor in impressing them
+ with favourable ideas of Christianity.
+
+ 'Another thing which seems to have impressed them was their seeing
+ me this August, day by day at my post in my tent, carrying on the
+ work, when they knew I was ill, and, according to their ideas,
+ should have been in bed. I was not really so ill as all that, but
+ that was their idea. I would be very glad to have another reviling
+ and another attack of dysentery if the same results would follow.
+
+ 'The profession of the other adherent at Ta ChÍng Tz[)u], and the
+ moving of the hearts, seemingly at least, of other two men who
+ live at a distance, and had to leave for home suddenly before
+ receiving full instruction, but of whom I try to have hope, have
+ all moved my heart and seem answers to a great longing I had been
+ crying to God about, namely, that He would give me power to move
+ these heathen. Oh that He would do it!
+
+ 'I have felt it my duty to become a vegetarian on trial. I don't
+ know whether I can carry it out. The Chinese look up so much to
+ this supposed asceticism that I am eager to acquire the influence a
+ successful vegetarianism would give me, and I am trying it in true
+ Chinese style, which forbids eggs, leeks and carrots, &c. As far as
+ I have gone all is well. I am a little afraid that the great
+ appetite it gives may drive me to eat till I become fat. We'll see.
+
+ 'The mothers bringing their babies moves me much. It reminds me of
+ scenes in Peking when another and more skilful hand ministered to
+ their diseases; then the picture of the family surroundings fills
+ itself up, and I have to seek a place where to weep.
+
+ 'Altogether it is a sowing in tears. The district is not an easy
+ one, the life which the work entails is a hard one. There is no
+ hardship or self-denial I am not ready to "go in for," but I want
+ you to understand me and let me have your sympathy.'
+
+This long extract, not too long we venture to think, as enabling us to
+see into the heart of the man, raises several points of great moment.
+Nothing could illustrate better his eagerness to get into close touch
+and perfect sympathy with the people. He had long before adopted the
+native dress of an ordinary shopkeeper or respectable workman. He now
+adapted himself, as far as possible, to the native food. He lived on
+such as the poor eat. Often he would take his bowl of porridge, native
+fashion, in the street, sitting down upon a low stool by the boiler of
+the itinerant restaurant keeper. The vegetarianism referred to was, as
+he indicates, very thoroughgoing and in accord with Chinese ideas.
+
+The great poverty of the people also pressed upon his attention the
+enormous waste induced by whisky drinking, and by the smoking of tobacco
+and opium. The sect Tsai li ti referred to was a small organisation
+among the Chinese for endeavouring to secure entire abstinence from all
+three. It did not seem tolerable to him that the level of Christian
+morality and practice with regard to these things should be lower than
+that of the heathen. Famine often visited those parts, and he came to
+hold the view that men could hardly pray, 'Give us this day our daily
+bread,' with any hope of a favourable answer, or even reasonably expect
+God's blessing upon their tillage of the soil, while they continued to
+use a large part of the grain produced in the manufacture of strong
+drink, and while they continued to set apart large districts for the
+cultivation of tobacco and opium. Hence, at first, he made entire
+abstinence from all three an indispensable requisite for admission into
+the Christian Church.
+
+It was hardly to be expected, perhaps, that his colleagues in the North
+China Mission would be able to see eye to eye with him on these points.
+With regard to opium the opinion as to abstinence is unanimous. With
+regard to the other two, the prevailing opinion was that, however
+desirable entire abstinence may be, it is not authoritatively commanded,
+and ought not to be made an indispensable qualification for baptism.
+
+It seemed to some of them that there was danger of the heathen
+confusing Christianity with their own Tsai li ti. In reply to such a
+suggestion Gilmour wrote: 'My hearers not know the difference between
+Tsai li ti and Christianity! Thanks be to God, this whole town and
+neighbourhood has rung with the truths of Christianity. Children, men,
+shop-boys, and, of all people in the world, a lad gathering grain stumps
+in the fields a long way off--it has been my lot to hear them repeat
+sayings of mine, when they saw me, and did not think I could hear them.'
+
+Into this controversy as a mere discussion we have no desire to enter.
+But to enable the reader to know Mr. Gilmour exactly as he was it
+deserves more than a passing reference. The following may be taken as an
+example of many letters that passed on this subject.
+
+ 'I start perhaps on Tuesday. Pardon me for expressing myself on one
+ matter--the Chinese teetotal business. You and some of my
+ colleagues seem to me as if I could not move you on this question.
+ It is a great grief to me. I think you are not right in your ideas
+ about this. I suppose you can beat me in argument. I am still more
+ than ever convinced that teetotalism is _right_ and _needful_ for
+ the success of native Christian life in China. We have some painful
+ instances here of that among the natives--specially two--one of the
+ two hailing from Tientsin.
+
+ 'I don't know your Tientsin Church history, but if it is anything
+ like ours here you would find men standing nowhere almost as to
+ Christian character, who but for drink and its concomitants might,
+ humanly speaking, have shone. And yet these are men to get whom out
+ of sin Christ died--brethren, for whom Christ died.
+
+ 'Pardon me again when I take a short cut to what I want to say: "_I
+ believe were Christ here now as a missionary amongst us He would
+ be an enthusiastic teetotaller and a non-smoker._"
+
+ 'Tobacco is comparatively a harmless matter, but it is not so
+ unimportant as it seems to us foreigners. Whisky should go, and I
+ feel that the Chinese would be quite ready, if led, to turn both
+ whisky and tobacco out together. They are born brothers in China,
+ _useless_, and _acknowledged_ to be such; harmful as far as they
+ are anything, and comparatively expensive.
+
+ 'I would like to see you start in your church an anti-tobacco and
+ whisky society; voluntary, of course, in a church established as
+ yours on the old lines. Though I stand alone, I believe the flowing
+ tide is with me.
+
+ 'Wishing you many souls in 1887, and eager that no minor difference
+ of opinion should hinder our prayers.
+
+ 'Yours I-hardly-know-how-to-say-what,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+In the _Chinese Recorder_, for which he had been in the habit of writing
+for many years, he published a paper in which he set forth with great
+clearness and fulness his views on this important matter. It deserves a
+place in the story of his life because in it he has sketched, as no one
+else could, himself, and some of his later methods of evangelistic
+address.
+
+ 'In December, 1885, in a district of North China new to me, I found
+ myself preaching to a small crowd of Chinese and Mongols in a small
+ market town. I was in a lane leading on to the main street. At my
+ back was a mud wall, in front and at both sides was the audience,
+ within hearing was the main street, above, a bright sun made the
+ place warm and cheerful. After listening a while the audience
+ wanted to know how good seasons could be secured. To the truths I
+ had been preaching they had listened with respect and fair
+ attention, but at the first opportunity for speaking they wanted to
+ know how to get a good harvest.
+
+ 'At first I paid little attention to this question, but after a
+ little while it was asked again, and that by several men in
+ succession, and I soon found that the people of the place had
+ little room for anything else in their thoughts. There was good
+ reason for it too. Their last harvest had been a poor one.
+ Three-tenths was about the yield. They too with their three-tenths
+ were comparatively well off. Some distance from them the yield had
+ not been more than two-tenths, and a little beyond that again,
+ there were fields which had been sown, but never reaped. There had
+ been nothing to reap. Nothing had grown. I passed some of these
+ fields afterwards and saw them. Was it wonderful then that the main
+ thought in their minds should be the harvest failure, and that they
+ should be mainly anxious to know how to secure a good season next
+ year? Looking at my audience I saw that nine-tenths of them were
+ poorly clad. Nearly one-half of them were quite insufficiently
+ clothed, and many were in garments suited to summer weather only. I
+ was in a sheepskin coat and felt shoes, and even thus was not too
+ warm, and could not help thinking how cold they must be, in their
+ torn clothes and ordinary shoes. In addition to this they seemed
+ hungry. I dare say perhaps one-half of them were in actual
+ suffering from deficiency of food.
+
+ 'Taking these things into consideration, I did not regard their
+ great and often-repeated question, "How about the harvest?" as
+ impertinent, and set myself to answer it. When the question was
+ again asked I replied by asking another, namely, "_Do you think you
+ deserve good harvests?_" This question usually made them stare and
+ ask, "Why should not we deserve good harvests?" and I would reply,
+ "In the first place, because of that _tobacco pipe in your mouth_."
+ A laugh of incredulity would usually pass round the audience, but
+ when done laughing, and asked to consider the folly of spending
+ money buying a pipe and tobacco when the smoker was shivering in
+ his rags, and hungry, and especially when asked what was the good
+ of smoking, they laughed no more. When pressed to say where the
+ tobacco came from, they would admit that the cultivation of tobacco
+ took up no small proportion of their better-class land, and when
+ pressed to say how much land was given up to tobacco cultivation,
+ they would admit, what did not seem to have occurred to them
+ before, that the amount of land given up to tobacco cultivation was
+ very large. How large it was I had no conception till the following
+ summer, when, walking round the suburbs, I would look over the low
+ mud walls of their gardens, and be amazed at the expanse of land
+ covered with the great, broad green leaf of the flourishing tobacco
+ plant.
+
+ 'Putting these things before my audience, they would admit that the
+ cultivation of tobacco was a misuse of a large portion of their
+ better land, that in cultivating and using tobacco they were doing
+ what was wrong, and hindering heaven from feeding them. Heaven had
+ given them good land and good rains for the purpose of growing
+ food. The growth of tobacco was defeating heaven's purpose, and as
+ long as they did so, what face had they to ask for good seasons? To
+ take good land and plant it with tobacco, with what face could they
+ ask heaven to send rain, seeing that if rain came, what grew would
+ not be grain but tobacco, a thing which they themselves to a man
+ admitted was no use at all? And so my audience would admit that as
+ preliminary to getting or even expecting a good harvest was the
+ discontinuance of the use and growth of tobacco.
+
+ 'In the course of a year and a half of outdoor preaching in streets
+ and at fairs, and private conversation with individuals, I never
+ met an audience that defended tobacco as useful, and do not think I
+ met more than three individuals who had anything to say in its
+ defence. Almost everyone, smokers included, admitted its
+ uselessness. Many do not seem to have thought the cultivation and
+ use of it any harm, or having any bearing on the question of food
+ supply and good harvests; they usually regarded it as simply a
+ piece of extravagance on their own part, which had no bearing on
+ anything or anybody beyond themselves. But when pointed out to them
+ they readily admit that tobacco cultivation lessens the production
+ of grain, and as readily admit that the wrongdoing in this misuse
+ of land is likely to further harm the harvest by offending heaven
+ into being unwilling to send rain. I myself never used to look on
+ smoking as any great evil, till led into this district, and thus
+ forced to study the subject. In England I had never seen tobacco
+ grown. A smoker there spends a few coppers, and smokes; what harm
+ does he do? Does not he increase trade and help the revenue? His
+ smoking seems to harm no one but himself. Such were my thoughts.
+ But in this district I see the cultivation of tobacco limiting the
+ supply of grain, thus raising the price of food, and consequently
+ making men go hungry. In addition I see men, women, and sometimes
+ children, in rags and hungry even, with pipes and tobacco, and when
+ they complain of heaven not supplying them with enough food to eat,
+ it would be less than honest not to point out to them that the
+ fault lies not with heaven, but with themselves, and that part at
+ least of the scarcity of grain they experience is due to the
+ cultivation and use of tobacco, which throughout that whole region
+ is very excessive.
+
+ 'I have dwelt thus at length on the tobacco question, not because
+ it is the most important of the three things here spoken of, but
+ because many good brethren have not been able to see with me on
+ this point. They feel, as I used to do before I went to that
+ region, that tobacco smoking is a small affair, not worth raising
+ into prominence or the region of conscience or Christian duty at
+ all. These brethren have not _seen_ how things work. I feel sure
+ that almost any missionary placed as I was would have done exactly
+ what I have done, taken a stand against this excessive growth and
+ more excessive use of tobacco, for, not content with what they
+ grow, they actually import quantities of it. Tobacco is not the
+ greatest cause of poverty and hunger in the district, but it is a
+ much greater factor in poverty than would at first be supposed. But
+ for its use in that district a large number of men, women, and
+ children, who are deficiently clothed and fed, would be warm and
+ sleek. Christ taught men to pray, "Give us this day our daily
+ bread." It must be wrong to make hundreds of men, women, and
+ children go half clad and half fed, simply that eighty or ninety
+ per cent. of the adults of that district may indulge in tobacco, a
+ thing, according to their own admission, utterly without use, and
+ for the continuance of which they can give no reason, further than
+ that they have acquired the habit and find it difficult to give it
+ up.
+
+ 'A more serious question, however, is the whisky. In going into
+ that region I was amazed at the quantity of whisky used. I used to
+ lodge in an inn and take my meals in an eating-house. There, twice
+ a day, I had an opportunity of studying the drinking habits of the
+ country. Almost every man who entered the eating-house first called
+ for a whisky warmer. Supplied with that, he would go out and buy
+ his whisky, coming back he would set it in the charcoal fire to
+ warm, and then slowly drink it from the tiny wine cups common in
+ China, inviting me to join him, and wondering at a man who could
+ evidently afford it, not treating himself to two ounces of whisky,
+ and wondering still more when he learned that I did not use
+ tobacco. It would be an exaggeration, but not a great
+ exaggeration, to say that every man who entered the eating-house
+ began his meal by drinking whisky. In replying to the question put
+ by my street audiences as to how they were to get good harvests, I
+ would ask them, after finishing the tobacco question, "How about
+ your whisky drinking?" Frequently they would anticipate me in this,
+ and say, "If tobacco is wrong, how about whisky?" To convince them
+ of the wrong of whisky was never difficult. To ask good harvests
+ from heaven, then take grain given by heaven for food, and turn it
+ into whisky, they did not need me to tell them this was wrong. And
+ there in that district it is a very crying wrong. The quantity used
+ is immense. Not only does it seem so to me, but natives from other
+ parts of China are struck by the excessive use of it.
+
+ 'The first time I travelled in the district, I was struck by the
+ manner in which they described the size and amount of trade of
+ towns about which I made inquiries. Such and such a place had or
+ had not a distillery and pawnshop. Such and such a town had so many
+ distilleries, and so many pawnshops. One travelling about the
+ country soon notes that nearly every imposing trading establishment
+ with grand premises seen from afar is either a distillery or a
+ pawnshop, or both combined. The bank notes current among the people
+ are issued, at but a small percentage, by distilleries and
+ pawnshops. The first crop to ripen in the district is barley, and
+ that, the natives will tell you, all goes to the distillery. On the
+ road you will meet large carts drawn by six or seven mules. The
+ load is grain, and of these carts a large number are owned by
+ distilleries, and go round the country collecting grain, from which
+ to brew whisky. One of the first things to be heard in the morning
+ after daylight, in a quiet market town, is a peculiar beating of a
+ wooden drum. Ask what it means, and you will be told it is such
+ and such a distillery calling its hands to breakfast. Ask how many
+ hands they have, and you may find that one establishment has some
+ sixty or seventy men who eat their food! The whisky trade is simply
+ enormous. It is out of all proportion to every other trade. The
+ women as a rule do not drink, the men do all the drinking--the
+ males I should say, for not a few boys acquire the habit of taking
+ whisky to their meals long before they can be called men. A very
+ few men do not use whisky at all. The poorer agricultural labourers
+ drink it only when they can get it, and just as much or as little
+ as they can get. Many men take regularly two ounces--Chinese
+ ounces--to each meal. Many take more. Many well-to-do people drink
+ half a catty per day. Others drink a whole catty.[7] Some drink a
+ catty and a half a day. A small proportion of the male population
+ find drinking a greater necessity than eating. These are usually
+ elderly men, but as I write I can think of two men, both young, and
+ both Mongols, one a priest, the other a layman, who have arrived at
+ this advanced stage of whisky drinking.
+
+[7] A Chinese weight equal to one pound and a third.
+
+ 'This excessive use of whisky has impoverished many families, and
+ has demoralised many men. It has caused many quarrels, and given
+ rise to many lawsuits. The evil caused by whisky is apparent to
+ all, but custom requires that friends should be honoured by being
+ offered whisky, business should be transacted over whisky, and the
+ general saying is that without whisky nothing can be done. A
+ farmer, for example, adding a few rooms to his buildings must
+ supply his masons and joiners with whisky. Thus in universal use,
+ the quantity consumed is immense. The quantity of grain used in the
+ distilleries is almost beyond computation, and I don't remember
+ ever meeting a Chinaman who did not admit that to distil whisky was
+ to do evil. They ask me how to get good harvests. I tell them;
+ "Give up abusing the grain you have got, before you ask for more.
+ If heaven sees you taking a large part of your superior land for
+ raising the useless tobacco, and taking a very large proportion of
+ the grain sent you as food, and using it not to eat, nor to feed
+ animals, but distilling it into the hurtful whisky, do you think
+ heaven, seeing all this waste going on, is likely to hear your
+ petitions and increase the supply of what you now waste so large a
+ proportion? If you bought food for your child, and he ate only half
+ and threw the other half to the pig, would you be likely to buy him
+ more just then, even though he might say he was hungry?" This
+ reasoning seems quite satisfactory and convincing to them, and
+ never fails to secure their expressed assent.
+
+ 'As to opium I never find it necessary to say much. All admit it to
+ be only and wholly bad. Yet the quantity grown in the district is
+ immense. In the early spring the very first movement of cultivation
+ is the irrigation and working of the opium land, and at the season
+ nearly all the best land blazes with bloom of the poppy. It is a
+ sight to see the country people going to the markets with the
+ "_milk_" in bowls and basins, and the buyers and sellers of it
+ riding along, each with a weighing-balance stuck in his belt.
+ Government restriction there is none, the duty imposed is not very
+ heavy, and public opinion raises no voice against it. It was
+ originally grown, say the natives, so as to keep money from going
+ out of the district in buying imported opium, but the more it was
+ grown the more it was used, and now the quantity raised and smoked
+ is immense. There is a small proportion of farmers who have good
+ land, suitable for growing opium, but who do not grow it. But these
+ men are few, and as a general rule the very best pieces of land are
+ set apart for the cultivation of opium. The common conscience of
+ the people tells them this is a wrong thing. When therefore they
+ ask how to get a good harvest, they themselves acknowledge that
+ the reply is just, which says, "First leave off the waste of
+ heaven's grace involved in the growth and manufacture of opium,
+ whisky, and tobacco, and then, and not till then, will it be
+ reasonable for you to ask heaven for more bountiful harvests."
+
+ 'In connection with all this, there is another fact that must not
+ be forgotten. Drinkers of whisky, and smokers, especially of opium,
+ the better the year is, the more they indulge. In a poor year they
+ use less whisky and opium; the better the year, and the cheaper
+ tobacco, whisky, and opium are, the more they use, so that in place
+ of making a proper return to heaven for a good year, they only take
+ the opportunity afforded them of running deeper into waste and
+ wrong-doing. Is this the way to get better harvests? Considering
+ the excessive growth and consumption of tobacco and opium, and the
+ excessive manufacture and use of whisky, what could any honest,
+ straightforward man say to the people, when they earnestly asked
+ how they were to get good harvests, but "_Repent, and cease this
+ great waste_"? And thus from no deliberate plan of mine, but from
+ the plain leading of circumstances, it came to pass that I felt
+ compelled to call upon the inhabitants of the district to lay aside
+ the use of not only opium but also of whisky and tobacco, as one of
+ the first steps toward worshipping the true God. Many friends have
+ demurred to my making teetotalism an essential of Christianity, and
+ many more have still more strongly demurred to my taking such a
+ pronounced stand against the use of tobacco. The position of my
+ friends is exactly the position I held myself before going into
+ that region, but after going to that region and seeing just how
+ things were, no other course seemed open to me, but to demand in
+ all who wanted to do right the abandonment of the whole three; and
+ I am convinced that almost any other missionary placed in the same
+ circumstances would have taken the same stand.
+
+ 'This position too commends itself to the native mind, and the
+ native mind, quite apart from me, and before my going into the
+ district, had already risen up in protest against these abuses,
+ and, in some parts of the country there, the Tsai li ti sect boasts
+ not a few members. The main practical doctrine of this sect is,
+ _Yen chiu pu tung_--abstinence from tobacco, whisky, and opium. The
+ very existence of this sect, and its flourishing condition there,
+ is a plain indication of what serious-minded natives felt about the
+ excessive use of these three things. Friends say that I am putting
+ this self-righteousness in place of faith in Christ and the
+ practice of higher duties. I do nothing of the sort. Beginning with
+ the Chinaman where I find him, and answering the questions which he
+ insists on asking first, I appeal to him to give up what he admits
+ to be wrongdoing, sin (_tsao nieh_), as the first step in ceasing
+ to do evil learning to do well, and coming into right relationship
+ with God through Christ. Some friends are much alarmed lest this
+ should lead to self-righteousness. There is no danger of that. The
+ danger lies all the other way. To leave Christians drinking whisky
+ and smoking tobacco in that region, would be to preach forgiveness
+ of sin through Christ to men who were still going on in the
+ practice of what their conscience told them was sin, and all must
+ admit that this would never do. The condition of things in that
+ region is such that I have no hesitation in saying that a man, to
+ be honest in obeying God by refraining from what is wrong, must
+ throw up his connexion with these three things, tobacco, whisky,
+ opium.
+
+ 'In _that region_. It will be noticed that I have carefully
+ confined my remarks to the state of things in _that region_. _That
+ region_ is peculiar in producing within its own bounds almost all
+ that is necessary for life and luxury even. It is peculiar too in
+ having just exactly as many inhabitants as it can support, no more,
+ no less. When the population increases too much it overflows into
+ Manchuria. When the population is less than the full complement, it
+ is instantly replenished by fresh arrivals from the South. The
+ production of tobacco, whisky, and opium, not only reduces a large
+ proportion of the inhabitants from comfort to misery, but also
+ reduces sensibly the number of inhabitants. But for these three
+ things many more men could find a living within the bounds of the
+ district Is not that little district an epitome of the world? Is
+ what is true of that district not true of the whole world? Opium is
+ a bad thing anywhere and everywhere. About that there need be no
+ debate. Whisky and tobacco reduce the comforts and the number of
+ the population there--is their effect not the same on the world in
+ general? Is it not true that but for tobacco and whisky there would
+ be food and clothes for a much larger population? And if so, do not
+ tobacco and whisky take the bread out of men's mouths and the
+ clothes off their backs? And if so, has not every smoker and
+ drinker a part in this sin? Christians pray, "_Give us this day our
+ daily bread._" Does not consistency require them to desist from
+ defeating this prayer by smoking and drinking, and thus reducing
+ the amount of the total production of the necessaries of life?
+
+ 'Tobacco seems harmless. It is less harmful than opium and whisky
+ by a long way. But its production sensibly reduces the supply of
+ grain and cotton, and thus hinders the feeding of the hungry and
+ the clothing the naked. Good earnest Christian men smoke and drink.
+ Evangelists and pastors owned of God in the salvation of souls
+ smoke and see no harm in it. The reason is they have never seen how
+ the thing works, and don't know the harm it does. I feel sure that
+ if they could see with their own eyes men, women, and children,
+ hungry and in rags, when but for tobacco and whisky they might be
+ well fed and well clothed, these same good brethren, whose example
+ is quoted against my position, would be the first and most earnest
+ to say, "I will neither smoke tobacco nor drink whisky while the
+ world stands."'
+
+At a later date, not from any change in his views, but in deference to
+the views of others, with whom he was always anxious to work in harmony,
+he modified his plans so far as not to make the use of whisky and
+tobacco absolute bars to admission into the Christian Church.
+
+His brethren also were opposed to the ascetic mode of life he adopted,
+and the extreme of hardship which he so often and so willingly
+encountered in his work. But he himself often said, and there are many
+references in his diary to the same effect, that the kind of life he was
+living in the interior was quite as healthy, and quite as conducive to
+longevity, as the ordinary and certainly much more comfortable life of a
+missionary at Peking. While it may be true that the exposure and
+sufferings of twenty years had so weakened him as to leave him powerless
+when seized by the last illness, yet the labours of twenty such years
+spent in the service of God and the service of man are surely the seeds
+from which there shall yet spring a rich harvest to the glory of God and
+to the blessing of the dark and degraded Mongols and Chinese.
+
+By the close of 1886 three main centres of work had been selected in the
+new district--Ta ChÍng Tz[)u], T· Ss[)u] Kou, and Ch'ao Yang--all three
+being towns of some importance. Mr. Gilmour used to spend a month or so
+in each town, visiting also the neighbourhood, especially those places
+where fairs were held, and where consequently the people came together
+in large numbers. He had a tent which he used to put up in a main
+thoroughfare, and there he stood from early morn until night healing the
+sick, selling Christian books, talking with inquirers, preaching at
+every opportunity the full and free Gospel of salvation. His constant
+and consistent life of Christlike self-denial in the effort to bless
+them told even more upon the beholders than all these other things
+combined. His correspondence is full of sharp and clear pictures of his
+daily toil, and of his spiritual experiences.
+
+ '_Ch'ao Yang, May 14, 1886._--The people are very poor here. Last
+ year the crops were not good. When the leaves come out on the
+ trees, the poor people break off branches and eat the seeds of the
+ elm-trees. I saw one woman up a high tree, taking down the seeds.
+ She took off half the door, laid it up against the tree, went on
+ the cross-bars like a ladder, and so got up. She threw down the
+ little branches and twigs, and her three children below gathered
+ them up. The elm seeds are just ripe now. They are the size of
+ large fish-scales; when the wind blows they come down like snow.
+
+ 'I met three lamas going to a far-off place to worship. Every two
+ or three steps they lay down flat on the ground, then got up other
+ two or three steps, then prostrated themselves again. They did not
+ know about Jesus saving people, and thought they would save
+ themselves in that way. Poor people! yet they don't like to hear
+ about Jesus saving people. They want the credit of thus saving
+ themselves.
+
+ '_September 3._--At Ta ChÍng Tz[)u] we had seven days and seven
+ nights' rain. It was a great flood. The river rose and washed away
+ about a hundred acres of land and forty or fifty houses. For two
+ days the river floated down house-roof timbers, beams, &c. One poor
+ man pulled down his house to save his timbers, and the house fell
+ on him and killed him. It was pitiful to see the river washing away
+ good land, two square yards falling into the roaring flood at a
+ time. The Chinamen did nothing: only stood and looked at it. Lots
+ of walls and many houses fell down. One house in the court next our
+ own fell down one morning after the rain was all over. The people
+ had just time to jump out at the window. No one was hurt. Our room
+ did not leak much, but the outside of the wall towards the street
+ fell down. The inside of the wall still stood, so our room was
+ whole. Chinese walls are all built in two skins. The one may fall
+ and the other stand.
+
+ '_October 25._--God has given the hunger and thirst for souls: will
+ He leave me unsatisfied? No, verily. I am reading at night, before
+ going to bed, the Psalms in a small-print copy of the Revised
+ Bible, holding it at arm's length almost, close up to a Chinese
+ candle, to suit my eyes; for I cannot see small print well now, and
+ I find much strength and courage in the old warrior's words.
+ Verily, the Psalms are inspired. No doubt about that. None that
+ wait on Him will be put to shame. He is here with me.
+
+ '_November 17._--We start about the fifth watch (6 A.M.), get to
+ the fair early, spend the day on the street; it is late before we
+ get quiet, and I fear it is now well on towards the third watch. I
+ am in first-class health, though my feet and socks are in a
+ decidedly bad way. The country is not at all safe, but we have as
+ yet been preserved. Some days ago, two men who slept on the same
+ kang with us, and started a little earlier than we did, were
+ robbed. We overtook the travellers arranging themselves after the
+ interview. I was annoyed at not getting away as soon as they left.
+ God so arranged it, you see.
+
+ 'I have got a step nearer to God lately. It is this: I do not now
+ strive to get near Him; I simply ask Christ to _take me nearer
+ Him_. Why shouldn't I? Does not Christ save men from distance from
+ God and bring us near? _Peace, Blessing, and Power_, by Haslam,
+ sent me by an old college mate in Scotland, was the means used.
+ This chum tried my soul much when I was at home last. I think I was
+ of use to him, and now he has been of much use to me. Let us sow
+ beside all waters.
+
+ 'My attitude now here is that of Psalm cxxiii. 2-4. I feel that God
+ can _perform_ for, by, or rather use me as His instrument in
+ performing, if He has a mind to; so I am looking for His hand,
+ gazing about among the people that come to my stand to see the ones
+ God has sent. I feel as helpless as a Chinese farmer in a drought;
+ but when God opens the heavens, down it will come. Amen.'
+
+Mr. Gilmour returned to Peking on December 13, having been away nearly
+eight months. The tabulated results of this missionary campaign were:
+
+ Patients seen (about) 5,717
+ Hearers preached to 23,755
+ Books sold 3,067
+ Tracts distributed 4,500
+ Miles travelled 1,860
+ Money spent 120.92 taels = (about) 30_l._ to 40_l._
+
+He adds, 'And out of all this there are only two men who have openly
+confessed Christ. In one sense it is a small result; in another sense
+there is much to be grateful for. I have to part with my assistant, and
+am uncertain about whom to take in his place. My travelling arrangements
+have broken down, and I am perplexed in more ways than I have patience
+to write about; but
+
+ Where He may lead I'll follow,
+ In Him my trust repose,
+ And every hour in perfect peace
+ I'll sing, "He knows, He knows."
+
+After a visit to Tientsin and a brief rest in Peking, largely occupied
+with preparations for his next sojourn in Mongolia, he started on
+January 25, 1887. At Ta ChÍng Tz[)u] he secured a kind of home, so as
+not to be exposed to all the discomforts and drawbacks of inn life,
+hoping also that a fixed centre might forward the preaching of the
+Gospel. Two rooms were taken for a year. They were situated at the inner
+end of a little trading court, around which were a tin-shop, a
+rope-spinner's room, and a stable. In one corner there was a pigsty.
+'When first I saw it I almost refused to occupy it; but really there is
+no help for it, and finally we took it for a year.' It is always
+difficult to secure premises in a Chinese town, and exceptionally so
+under the limitation of money and of suspicion and dislike to which
+Christian missionaries are always exposed. 'It is only a lodging for
+me,' Mr. Gilmour continues, 'convenient for seeing converts or
+inquirers. The court is much too small, and the place not sanitary. But
+don't be in the least uneasy. My health is quite as safe there as in the
+best premises in Peking. I intend to occupy them for a month at the
+beginning of the Chinese year, and ten or fifteen days in the fourth,
+seventh, and tenth months. I hope also to come to some arrangement for a
+lodging in Ch'ao Yang. In T· Ss[)u] Kou I am simply in an inn, and pay
+at the usual rate for the nights I am there.'
+
+A letter to his boys, dated March 24, 1887, depicts the kind of scene he
+so often witnessed, and the routine of work which would have proved so
+irksome but for the love and peace with which the Saviour filled his
+soul.
+
+ 'Mai Li Ying Tz[)u] is a very wicked place. There were no less than
+ fourteen large tents set up for gambling, and, in addition, some
+ thirty or forty mat-tents for gambling. I was there three days. The
+ first day people were shy. The second day they were not much
+ afraid. The third day I had quite a lot of patients. We sold a good
+ few books, preached a good deal, and doctored a number of patients.
+ From there we went to Bo-or-Chih, starting in the dark and
+ travelling seventeen English miles before breakfast. After we had
+ travelled ten miles we came to a little town just as people were
+ opening their doors. A seller of _chieh jao_, that sticky stuff,
+ had just set out his wheelbarrow with his pudding. We each bought a
+ great piece, wrapped it in a _chien ping_ (a thin scone), and
+ travelled on, eating it. That was our breakfast. Arrived at
+ Bo-or-Chih, we set up our table at once, and, after preaching for a
+ short time, patients came round us in crowds, and kept us busy till
+ late in the afternoon.
+
+ 'The inn in which I am staying now is owned by two men, brothers,
+ both of whom are opium smokers. The inn has a good trade, but it is
+ all no use: it all goes to opium, and no good comes of it. There
+ are two barbers connected with the place, and they both drink and
+ gamble, so that they are in rags and poverty, though they have a
+ fairly good business. It is so painful to see men degraded thus
+ when, but for drink and gambling, they might be well off.
+
+ '_April 28, 1887._--For the last week I have been very busy at a
+ great temple gathering, which lasted six days. Such crowds of
+ people came, though it was only a country district. It was the
+ great religious event of the year for the neighbourhood, and how do
+ you think they do? They hire a theatrical company to come and act
+ six days in a great mat stage, put up for the occasion in front of
+ the temple. Theatrical exhibitions are the religion of China. These
+ shows are supposed to be in honour of the idols in the temple. The
+ people think the gods will thus be pleased, and give them good
+ seasons, health, etc.
+
+ 'What a crowd of women came to worship at the temple on the great
+ day of the festival! Till noon that day women only were allowed to
+ enter: no men. How the women were dressed--in all the colours of
+ the rainbow, red trousers being especially prominent! How they
+ moved along on their little feet! Walk you along on your heels--as
+ I have seen you do--and that is just how they move.
+
+ 'No end of gamblers came too. There were twenty-six, or so, large
+ tents put up to gamble in, and about as many straw-mat booths, and
+ they all had plenty of trade. Eh, man, it is sad to see the utter
+ worldliness of these Chinese. They soon found me out. I had my tent
+ put up in a quiet place away from the bustle.[8] In front is the
+ great flying sign, "The Jesus Religion Gospel Hall." At the one
+ end, "God the Heavenly Father;" at the other, "Jesus the Saviour."
+ They found me out, not because they wanted to hear me preach, but
+ to get medicine. Oh, the numbers of suffering people I saw and
+ attended to! I used to go out early in the morning, and be there
+ all day, most of the time so busy that there was no time to eat. To
+ get food I had to steal away because everyone would want me just to
+ attend to him or her before I went. When I had attended to that one
+ there was another, and so on. I was able to cure a number of them,
+ and got preaching a good deal too. I sold a number of books. It was
+ the first time that a missionary had ever been there, and it was
+ difficult to make them understand.'
+
+[8] See the illustration on p. 245.
+
+It is, as a rule, by direct dealing with individuals that the best
+results of Christian work in China are obtained, and to this Mr. Gilmour
+was always ready to make everything give way. In season and out of
+season, at any hour of the day or night, he was at the service of
+inquirers. The sight of a seeking face could banish his most exhausting
+feeling of fatigue, and nothing so swiftly dispelled the depression,
+from which he so often and so severely suffered, as the sight of a
+heathen coming to be more perfectly instructed about 'the doctrine.'
+Here are one or two such scenes:--
+
+ 'In the eighth month we had great pleasure in finding Mr. Sun much
+ advanced in knowledge, and confessing his Christianity with great
+ boldness. Before we left he was baptized, and one or two others
+ were coming forward as inquirers--notably one man, who is a member
+ of a sect, was making earnest inquiries. These men seem to be
+ following after righteousness in their own half-instructed fashion.
+ These sects are strong in numbers in some parts of the district,
+ and, if God should give us some of these men as converts, we might
+ hope for rapid progress among their companions. The last that I
+ heard of this man, he was coming to Mr. Sun, asking many questions.
+ He lodged with us one night, and I invited him to breakfast with me
+ in the morning. He was declining on the plea that he was a
+ vegetarian. It was with much satisfaction that I was able to say in
+ reply, "So am I."
+
+ 'The Tsai li ti are strong in Ch'ao Yang. I have been praying and
+ working to gain them for a year and more. One evening a deputation
+ of two men called upon me in my inn, and said they had come
+ representing many who wanted to know about Christianity. They, the
+ Tsai li ti, had been watching me ever since I had come to Ch'ao
+ Yang. They had listened much and often to our preaching, and now
+ they had come to make formal inquiries. I gave them such
+ information as I thought they needed, and we got on well enough
+ till they asked me to refute a slander. The slander was to the
+ effect that in a chapel in Peking, the preacher would, when he
+ finished preaching, get down off the platform and have a smoke! I
+ had to admit that this was no slander, but a true statement. I had
+ a good deal to say in explanation of it; but, alas! the men came no
+ more.'
+
+To form any just estimate of Mr. Gilmour's work in Eastern Mongolia, it
+is needful constantly to bear in mind that it was practically a new
+departure. So far as we know, he is the only missionary in China
+connected with the London Missionary Society who adopted _in toto_ not
+only the native dress, but practically the native food, and, so far as a
+Christian man could, native habits of life. His average expense for food
+during his residence in his district was _threepence a day_. This rate
+of expenditure was, of course, possible only because he adopted
+vegetarianism. His practice acted and reacted upon his thought, and he
+came at this time to hold the view, for and against which a great deal
+may be said, that it was a mistake for Chinese missionaries to live as
+foreigners--that is, to wear foreign dress, arrange their houses and
+furniture as nearly as possible in European style, and eat European
+food. Both on its economical side and also as impressing the mind and
+heart of the Chinese, he believed that his was the more excellent way.
+
+Most of his co-workers at Peking and Tientsin did not agree with him. As
+agreement would have involved, perhaps, following his example, under
+conditions that differed widely from those of Ta ChÍng Tz[)u] and Ch'ao
+Yang, this difference of opinion was only what was to be expected. It is
+referred to here only as a well-known fact, and no story of Mr.
+Gilmour's life could be trustworthy which did not represent the decided
+way in which, when he felt that loyalty to his work and loyalty to his
+Master constrained him, he could and did act in direct opposition to the
+wishes and views of brethren whom he fervently loved.
+
+It became needful from time to time for him to justify his actions to
+the home authorities. Not that this was in any way needful from any
+doubt or lack of support on their part. But with regard to methods upon
+which there was marked divergence of view in the missionary committees
+abroad it was needful that a man like Gilmour should put his motives and
+reasons clearly before the governing powers. It is doing him bare
+justice to say that from this task he never shrank. The following
+extracts are from letters to the home officials of the London Missionary
+Society and they enable us to appreciate accurately the standpoint of
+the man whose thought they express. Writing in the light of the
+suggestion that perhaps he was putting a more severe strain upon his
+health than the efficient discharge of his difficult duty demanded, he
+says:--
+
+ 'I feel called to go through all this sort of thing, and feel
+ perfectly secure in God's hands. It is no choosing of mine, but
+ His; and, following His lead, I have as much right to expect
+ special provision to be made for me as the Israelites of old had in
+ the matters of the Red Sea, the manna and water in the desert, the
+ crossing Jordan, and the fall of Jericho.
+
+ 'One thing I am sure of. The thousands here need salvation; God is
+ most anxious to give it to them: where, then, is the hindrance? In
+ them? I hardly think so. In God? No. In me, then! The thing I am
+ praying away at now is that He would remove that hindrance by
+ whatever process necessary. I shall not be astonished if He puts me
+ through some fires or severe operations, nor shall I be sorry if
+ they only end by leaving me a channel through which His saving
+ grace can flow unhindered to these needy people. I dare not tell
+ you how much I pray for.
+
+ 'It is the foreign element in our lives that runs away with the
+ money. The foreign houses, foreign clothes, foreign food, are
+ ruinous. In selecting missionaries, physique able to stand native
+ houses, clothes, and food, should be as much a _sine qu‚ non_ as
+ health to bear the native climate. Native clothes are, I believe,
+ more safe for health than foreign clothes; they are more suited to
+ the climate, more comfortable than foreign clothes, and so dressed,
+ a Chinese house is quite comfortable. In past days I have suffered
+ extreme discomfort by attempting to live in foreign dress in native
+ houses.'
+
+And yet James Gilmour had nothing of the fanatic or bigot about him. At
+the period of his life with which we are now dealing, his severest trial
+was the loneliness due to his having no colleague. Whenever his brethren
+ventured to address remonstrances to him, they were due largely to the
+conviction that entire isolation, such as he had to endure throughout
+his Mongolian career, must tell adversely upon his temperament. But in
+judging the character of the man it only heightens our love and respect
+for him that he did not allow the utter and successive failures of all
+efforts to secure him a colleague to hinder the work. No man more
+readily and more constantly acted upon the principle of doing the next
+best thing. His idea of satisfactory conditions for the work was never
+reached; but this never led him for one day to relax his own efforts or
+to loosen the strong hand of his self-discipline.
+
+To any reader who has carefully followed the previous pages it must have
+become abundantly evident that Mr Gilmour believed in God's present and
+immediate influence in the passing events of daily life, and that the
+right attitude of life is one of absolute dependence upon, and
+submission to, the will of God. His diaries abound with proofs of this.
+He is delayed one morning in starting from his inn, and is annoyed. An
+hour or so later he overtakes the travellers who started earlier, and
+finds them just recovering from the assault of a band of robbers. The
+delay was God's providential care protecting him from robbery. And yet
+no man was ever less under the spell of religious fatalism. All that
+active effort and promptitude of mind and body could effect in the
+service of life he freely and constantly expended in his work. And
+indeed there lies before us a long letter written at T· Ss[)u] Kou on
+March 15, 1888, asking for an official proclamation from the Chinese
+authorities at Peking affirming 'that Christian worship is an allowed
+thing, and that native Christians are not required to contribute, or are
+exempted from contributing, to idol and heathen ceremonies, such as
+theatricals, or the building and repair of temples.' The proper official
+document was applied for at Peking, and in due time obtained.
+
+On March 24, 1888, James Gilmour was rejoiced by the seeming fulfilment
+of his heart's most eager desire--the arrival at T· Ss[)u] Kou of a
+fully qualified medical colleague, Dr. Roberts. We have seen how
+repeated had been his entreaties, how earnest his yearnings after this
+essential factor in the success of his mission. For a month he enjoyed
+to the full the uplifting of congenial fellowship and of skilled help.
+Then came a blow, harder almost to endure than the previous solitude.
+
+ 'Two days ago,' he writes under date of April 21, 1888, 'a man
+ pushed himself in among the crowd round my table as I was
+ dispensing medicines in the market-place here, and announced
+ himself as a courier from Tientsin. When asked what his news was,
+ he was silent, so I led him away towards my inn. Oh the way I again
+ asked what his news was. He groaned. I began to get alarmed, and
+ noticed that he carried with him a sword, covered merely with a
+ cloth scabbard. This looked warlike, and I wondered if there could
+ have been another massacre at Tientsin. Coming to a quiet place in
+ the street I _demanded_ his news, when he replied, "_Dr. Mackenzie
+ is dead, after a week's illness._" At the inn we got out our
+ letters from the bundle, and found the news true. In a little Dr.
+ Roberts looked up from a letter he was reading and said he was
+ appointed to the vacancy. _Then_ the full extent of my loss flashed
+ upon me. Mackenzie dead--Roberts to go to Tientsin! One of my
+ closest friends dead--my colleague removed!
+
+ 'Forty-eight hours have elapsed, and I am just coming right again.
+ I have been like a ship suddenly struck in mid-ocean by a mountain
+ sea breaking over it. You know in that case a ship staggers a bit,
+ and takes some time to shake clear and right herself.
+
+ 'As to Mackenzie. His friendship I very keenly appreciated. The
+ week of prayer in January 1887 we spent together in Peking. The
+ week of prayer in January 1888 we spent together in Tientsin. These
+ were seasons of great enjoyment. On parting we spoke of having a
+ week together again in April 1889. That is not to be. The full
+ extent of the loss will take some time to realise.
+
+ 'The prospect of Dr. Roberts settling permanently here in the
+ autumn gave light and brightness to the outlook. My faith is not
+ gone, but it would be untrue to say that I am not walking in the
+ dark. I shall do my best to hold on here single-handed; but I
+ earnestly hope that I am not to be alone much longer. Something
+ must be done. There is a limit to all human endurance.
+
+ 'Amid many storms we are holding on our way, and making progress
+ among the Chinese. Of the Mongols I have nothing cheering to
+ report. They come around and daily hear the Gospel; but, as yet at
+ least, there it ends. I look into their faces to see whom the Lord
+ is going to call, but have not seen him yet apparently. Meantime, I
+ am getting deeper and deeper into Chinese work and connections, and
+ sometimes the thought crosses my mind that my knowledge of
+ Mongolian is not employed to its best advantage here. On the other
+ hand, I see more Mongols here than I could see anywhere on the
+ Plain.'
+
+God's ways of dealing with His work and the workers are often very dim
+and obscure to finite understanding. Humanly speaking, no man in China
+could less easily be spared than Dr. Mackenzie; no man in all that vast
+empire more needed the joy of fellowship than he to whom it had just
+been granted. But the indomitable spirit shines clearly through the
+words of Gilmour: 'It would be untrue to say that I am not walking in
+the dark. I shall do my best to hold on here single-handed.' Seeing
+God's hand, as he did, in these sorrowful events, and believing that Dr.
+Roberts also was following the path of God's will, he turned again to
+his lonely tasks. But it was at a heavy cost. His health was giving way
+faster than he realised. The views of his brethren at Peking, that he
+would break down under the strain of the isolation, were to some extent
+justified. The home authorities did what they could, but nearly a year
+elapsed before Dr. Smith, who was appointed to succeed Dr. Roberts,
+reached Mongolia, and when he did so his first duty he felt was to order
+Mr. Gilmour to visit England for rest and change. But meanwhile he went
+bravely on. Like his Master, 'he endured the contradiction of sinners
+against himself,' and when 'he was reviled, he reviled not again.'
+
+ 'We left Ch'ao Yang,' he writes under date of September 3, 1888,
+ 'August 10, attended markets, got much rained in, and reached Ta
+ ChÍng Tz[)u] August 20. There I found that one of the Christians
+ had possessed himself of my bank book and drawn about fifteen taels
+ of my money which I had banked at the grocer's. The delinquent
+ turned up next day, walked in, and hung up his whip as if nothing
+ had happened. At the moment I was dining, and he sat down beside
+ me. I asked him quietly why he had treated me so. He said I might
+ be easy in mind; he had money and cattle he would pay me. "Go,
+ then, and bring me the money; till you do so, don't come to me
+ again." Off he went. Days passed and nothing was done to repair the
+ mischief. Meantime, the scandal was the talk of the small town, and
+ the scornful things said were so keen that Liu, my assistant, got
+ quite wild. He was indignant that I did not go to law with the man,
+ who all the while was swelling about on a donkey bought with the
+ money he stole from me, and using the most defiant and abusive
+ language towards me (not to my face, happily). The roughs of the
+ place began to be insolent, and a drunken man came and made a scene
+ in our quarters. Liu redoubled his attack on me, and even
+ threatened to go home to Shantung if I would do nothing but pray--a
+ course of action on my part which irritated him much. Li San, the
+ head Christian there, joined him in saying I ought to make a show
+ of power. I asked the two to read at their leisure Matt. v. 6, 7.
+ Liu warned me that I was in personal danger. The man was
+ panic-struck and highly nervous. I arranged an expedition to a
+ place some 90 li away, but got rained in and could not go. Finally,
+ the offender sent an embassy desiring peace, and, the day before we
+ left, a respectable deputation of mutual friends, Christian and
+ heathen, found its way one by one to my room, coming thus not to
+ attract attention, and last of all came the thief. According to
+ pre-arrangement I asked him, as he entered, what he had come for.
+ He walked up to the wall, knelt down, and confessed his sin in
+ prayer to God. The end of the matter is, he gives me one donkey and
+ the promise of another, is suspended as to membership for twelve
+ months, and is forbidden the chapel for three months.
+
+ 'I am not bright about Ta ChÍng Tz[)u], as you may suppose. Worse
+ than the stealing case is that of the head man, Li San, who says
+ that he was promised employment before he became a Christian! The
+ ten days we passed there we were the song of the drunkard and the
+ jest of the abjects; but the peace of God _passes all
+ understanding_, and that kept my heart and mind. We put a calm
+ front on; put out our stand daily, and carried ourselves as if
+ nothing had happened.
+
+ 'The great thought in my mind these days, and the great object of
+ my life, is to be like Christ. As He was in the world, so are we to
+ be. He was in the world to manifest God; we are in the world to
+ manifest Christ. Is that not so? Iniquities, I must confess,
+ prevail against me; but as contamination of sin flows to us from
+ Adam, does not regenerating power flow into us from Christ? Is it
+ not so?'
+
+Meanwhile work was going steadily forward and some impression was being
+made. He made a flying visit to Tientsin and Peking in the autumn, but
+was soon back at his post. In his report of work for the year he is able
+to point to progress.
+
+ '1888 has been a tumultuous year. In December, at Ch'ao Yang, there
+ was a sudden irruption of men and boys to learn the doctrine.
+ Evening after evening we had from twenty to fifty people in our
+ rooms to evening worship. We hardly knew how to account for it, but
+ did all we could to teach as many as we could. The cold weather
+ finally did much to stop the overcrowding, but there was good
+ interest kept up among many till the end of the year.
+
+ 'The baptisms for the year were, at Ta ChÍng Tz[)u], two; T· Ss[)u]
+ Kou, two; Ch'ao Yang, eight; total, twelve adults, all Chinese.
+
+ 'One man has been put out, so that the numbers stand as follows: Ta
+ ChÍng Tz[)u], four; T· Ss[)u] Kou, three; Ch'ao Yang, nine; total,
+ sixteen, all Chinese.
+
+ 'Three adults, Chinese, were baptized ten days ago, and I hope to
+ baptize two children next Sunday; but we have almost no promising
+ adherents here at present. There are three entire families
+ Christian, with Christian emblems on their door-posts; another
+ family is Christian, but cannot fly the colours on the door-posts
+ because the grandfather who has half the building is a heathen.
+
+ 'In still another family, where only the husband is Christian, they
+ have the Christian colours, but the family is heathen.
+
+ 'My heart is set on reinforcements. Can they not be had? I had
+ hoped Dr. Smith would have spent the winter with me, but he did
+ not. All the grace needed has been given me abundantly, but I don't
+ think there should be any more solitary work. I don't think it
+ pays in any sense.
+
+ 'In addition, it is almost time I had a change. My eyes are bad.
+ Doctors hesitate over my heart, say it is weak, and that its
+ condition would affect seriously an application for life assurance.
+ This winter I have gone in for a cough, which is not a good thing
+ at all, and it would be well for the continuity of the work that
+ there should be a young man on the field.
+
+ 'Don't be alarmed, though, and don't alarm my friends. The above is
+ for your own private information and guidance. I still regard
+ myself as in first-rate health.
+
+ 'I am not satisfied that we seem drifting away from the Mongols. At
+ present, though lots of Mongols are around, our work is all but
+ entirely Chinese. I am still of opinion that our best way to reach
+ them is from a Chinese basis. This may involve a matter of years
+ ahead, and therefore it is that I am eager to see the future of the
+ work provided for by being joined by a younger man or men.
+
+ 'Meantime I am trying to follow very fully and very faithfully the
+ leadings and indications of God. I have had times of sore spiritual
+ conflict and times of much spiritual rest, and my prayer is that
+ you and the Board may in all your arrangements and plans for
+ Mongolia be fully guided by Him. Oh that His full blessing would
+ descend richly on this district!'
+
+Dr. Smith reached Mongolia in March 1889, and for the first time met his
+colleague. He has placed on record for use in this biography his account
+of that first meeting. On reaching Ch'ao Yang, Dr. Smith found that Mr.
+Gilmour was not there. 'I followed the innkeeper,' he writes, 'to see
+the spot where my devoted colleague had spent so many lonely hours. We
+came to a little outhouse, with a kind of little court in front of it,
+not many yards wide. The outer door was locked by means of a padlock;
+but the innkeeper soon found an entrance by simply lifting the door off
+its wooden hinges, and then we were in the anteroom or rather kitchen.
+In it was a built-in cooking-pan, an earthenware bowl, and a wooden
+stick resembling a Scotch porridge-stick; and some brushwood which had
+been brought in to be in readiness when he next arrived at that inn. One
+of the two rooms, which lay on each side of this ante-room, was locked,
+and we could not open it, but through the chinks of the door I could see
+abundant traces of Gilmour. It was specially refreshing to see some
+genuine English on one of the boxes; it was "Ferris, Bourne, & Co.,
+Bristol," the people from whom he used to order his drugs. My servant
+and I decided to take up our quarters in the next room, which was
+evidently the servant's room. We soon managed to make ourselves very
+comfortable, and there was an unspeakable relief in at last being in a
+place which belonged to the London Mission, rented of course. We had to
+spend the Sunday there. Mr. Sun, the box-maker, soon came round, and
+seemed genuinely glad to see me, and offered to make all arrangements
+for the further stage of our journey. We then discharged our carts, and
+I sent with them my letters for home.
+
+'After spending the Sunday in company with the Christians there, we set
+out on the Monday morning with a local carter for Ta ChÍng Tz[)u], a
+distance of about twenty-three miles. We crossed a hilly and sparsely
+populated district, reminding me of some of the bleaker scenery in
+Scotland. On reaching the town we at once drove to the new private
+mission premises. It was a little house surrounded by a straw fence.
+Quite a crowd of rough-looking people followed us in. One of the doors
+had been stolen, and altogether it looked so unprotected that I decided
+to take up my quarters in a little Mongol inn, where Mr. Gilmour
+formerly lived. Next day I expected to meet Gilmour, and the two
+Christians there were fully expecting him. In the evening we had quite a
+levee; Li San and the other Christian, whom Gilmour used to call "Long
+Legs," sat drinking tea in my room for some time, and were very
+friendly; they were evidently trying to ingratiate themselves with me; I
+did not then know how disgracefully they had behaved to Gilmour, nor did
+I know the anxious business which was bringing Gilmour there at that
+time.
+
+'Next day or the following, I forget exactly which, I was sitting in my
+room, when a young man arrived, my servant being out at the time. I
+could not make him out at first, not being able to understand what he
+said; but he had such an evident air about him that he had some kind of
+business with me that it at last dawned upon me that he must be Mr.
+Gilmour's servant, and this was at once confirmed on the arrival of Lin
+Seng, my servant. He had been sent on ahead to announce Gilmour's
+arrival. It had been blowing a dust-storm all day, and on that account I
+hardly expected Gilmour, but now there was no doubt.
+
+'About four o'clock that afternoon Gilmour arrived, and I shall never
+forget that first meeting. I had pictured quite a different-looking man
+to myself. I saw a thin man of medium height, with a clean shaven face,
+got up in Chinese dress, much the same as the respectable shop-keepers
+in that part of the country wear. On his head was a cap lined with cat's
+fur. I was struck by the kindly but determined look on his face. He
+greeted me most cordially, and I remember he said, "I am glad to see
+you." He looked worn out and ill. I at once gave him his letters.
+
+'After arranging his things and seeing his men comfortably settled and
+getting over his first interview with the Christians there, he came up
+to my room in order to spend the night with me. We sat to all hours of
+the morning, chatting about things at home, and about his boys, whom I
+had seen before leaving Scotland.
+
+'For the next day he arranged the dreaded interview with Li San down at
+the mission premises. Gilmour warned me that it would be a long-winded
+affair, and wished me not to expect his return for a good number of
+hours. After waiting a long time I went down to see how the interview
+was progressing. Li San and Gilmour were sitting on the kang, in tailor
+fashion on each side of a low table, and Li San was singing hymns; but
+there was a strange look upon his face, as if he did not altogether feel
+like singing. Gilmour said to me in English that they had not come to
+business yet, and Gilmour was determined that Li San was to say the
+first word, so Gilmour invited him to sing hymn after hymn, and then I
+left. The whole idea seemed to be to get money out of Gilmour, and when
+he found that impossible he threatened to come down to Tientsin to
+accuse Gilmour to his missionary colleagues, of having broken his
+promise to give him employment. Gilmour had no recollection of having
+done so; he said to me that possibly one of his previous assistants may
+have on his own responsibility led Li San to form that idea.
+
+'Long Legs was also dogging Gilmour for money, and altogether they
+worried him; but he settled up everything. The premises were resold, and
+as Gilmour put it, "it was the funeral of that little church." They were
+threatening to prevent our leaving the town, as there seemed some doubt
+in Gilmour's mind as to whether we would be able to get a cart; these
+fears were disappointed; Li San got a cart for us.'
+
+Before Dr. Smith had passed many days in the society of Mr. Gilmour it
+became clear to the practised eye of the medical man that his colleague
+had been overstraining his health and strength. Notwithstanding his
+buoyancy and occasional high spirits all through his long years of work,
+James Gilmour had been subject to spells of severe depression. There are
+a very large number of brief entries in his diary to that effect. 'Felt
+blue to-day' is a frequent phrase, followed soon in the great majority
+of instances by words indicating a speedy recovery. Special events, that
+from time to time had a direct adverse influence upon his work,
+developed this state of mind rapidly and profoundly. The inevitable
+recall of Dr. Roberts, already described, is a case in point, and the
+diary at that season contains entries like these:
+
+ '_April 26, 1888._--These last days have been full of blessing and
+ peace in my own soul. I have been able to leave things at Ta ChÍng
+ Tz[)u];, and my colleagues all in God's hands.'
+
+ '_May 7._--Downcast day. No one to prayer.'
+
+ '_May 9._--In terrible darkness and tears for two days. Light broke
+ over me at my stand to-day in the thought that Jesus was tempted
+ forty days of the devil after His baptism, and that He felt
+ forsaken on the cross.'
+
+ '_May 27, Sunday._--Service, Romans xii. Present, four Christians.
+ Great depression.'
+
+The most constant force acting in the direction of mental depression was
+what appeared to him like the want of immediate success. He longed with
+an eager and almost painful intensity for signs that Gospel light had
+broken in upon the mental darkness of the men with whom he was in daily
+contact. He yearned for evidence that the love of Christ was winning the
+love of Chinese and Mongol hearts, as a mother yearns over her children.
+Hope deferred as to his medical colleague, ever recurring difficulties
+defeating all his efforts to secure suitable premises for his work,
+failure on the part of natives whom he had begun to trust, and all these
+things over and above the ceaseless strain of his daily toil, are more
+than sufficient to account for the state in which Dr. Smith found him.
+
+To those who knew him best, and who could appraise at their true value
+the toils and trials and disappointments of his daily lot, the wonder
+was not that he broke down; it was rather that physical collapse had not
+overtaken him sooner. There are many kinds of heroism, but it may be
+doubted whether any touches a higher level than that exhibited by this
+patient sower of the seed of life on the sterile field of Mongolia,
+bravely continuing to do so until imperatively urged to cease for a
+season, not by his consciousness of failing power, but by the alarm and
+influence of his medical co-worker.
+
+When the decision was once taken, it was acted upon promptly. March 26,
+1889, was the day, and Peking the place. On April 4 he left Peking, and
+on the 20th he sailed from Shanghai. He arrived in London on May 25.
+
+This visit to England in 1889 was a great refreshment bodily, mental,
+and spiritual, to the overwrought labourer. The voyage itself, enforcing
+rest from all ordinary avocations, by removing Mr. Gilmour from the
+depressing surroundings amid which he had spent so much of the last
+three years, began the restorative process. He was beginning to feel in
+himself great benefit from the change even by the time he reached
+London. But the six years which had passed since he last walked the
+London streets had left their mark upon him. He had drawn to the utmost
+upon his physical and spiritual strength in the service of those for
+whose conversion he lived and toiled. He had been through the deep
+waters of personal affliction when his wife passed into the sinless
+life. The many toils and hardships of the passing years had drawn deep
+furrows upon the cheery face, and the eyes showed evidence of the mental
+and spiritual strain.
+
+So sudden was the resolution to return, and so prompt his action upon
+it, that few knew even of the probability until he was actually here. On
+May 27, 1889, the writer was sitting in his room, overlooking the
+pleasant garden that brightens up the north-eastern corner of St Paul's
+Churchyard, in conversation with a gentleman, when a knock came at the
+door and a head appeared. Not seeing it very clearly, and at the same
+time asking for a minute's delay while the business in hand was
+completed, the head disappeared. As soon as the first visitor departed a
+man entered and stood near the door. I looked at him with the
+conviction that I knew him, and yet could not recall the true mental
+association, when the old smile broke over his face, and he burst into a
+laugh, saying, 'Why, man, you don't know me' 'Yes, I do,' I replied,
+'you're Gilmour; but I thought that at this moment you were in
+Mongolia.' But when I was able to scrutinise him closely I was shocked
+to see how very evident were the signs of stress and strain. It was not
+wholly inexcusable, even in an old friend, to fail to instantly
+recognise in the worn and apparently broken man, thought to be hard at
+work many thousands of miles away, the strong and cheery Gilmour of
+1883.
+
+Carrying him off home, we talked far into the night, not because his
+host thought it a good thing for the invalid, but because he was so full
+of his work and its difficulties and its pressing needs, and what he
+hoped to do on behalf of Mongolia by his visit home, that there seemed
+no possible alternative but to let him talk himself weary. And how
+splendidly he talked! He pictured his life at a Mongol inn. He ranged
+over the whole opium and whisky and tobacco controversy. He gave, with
+all the dramatic effect of which he was so great a master, the story of
+how he forced home upon the Chinese and Mongols, until even _they_
+admitted the force of the reasoning, how natural it was that famine
+should visit them when they gave up their land to opium, and their grain
+to the manufacture of whisky. He gave in rapid dialogue his own
+questions, the native rejoinders, and he so vividly pictured the scene
+that his hearer could fancy himself standing under the tent, surrounded
+by Chinese and Mongols, and assenting, as they did, to the earnest and
+far-reaching conclusions of the speaker.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+PERSONAL CHARACTERISTICS AS ILLUSTRATED BY LETTERS TO RELATIVES AND
+FRIENDS
+
+
+This break in active work affords a convenient occasion for exhibiting
+in a still stronger light, by means of selections from his
+correspondence, some important sides of James Gilmour's character. He
+was a good correspondent and wrote freely to his relatives and friends.
+We have quoted largely hitherto from his official reports and from
+letters that refer to the condition and progress of his life-work. But
+it is in the letters addressed to the circle of relatives and most
+intimate friends that he reveals more fully the deeper side of his life,
+and the strong and tender affection of his nature.
+
+He corresponded regularly with his parents until the earthly tie was
+broken by the death of his mother in 1884 and of his father in 1888. His
+letters to the latter were very beautiful, especially those designed to
+strengthen his faith in the closing years when he had passed the
+eightieth milestone. The tone of the correspondence may be judged from
+the following examples:--
+
+
+ 'Peking: Friday, January 23, 1885.
+
+ 'My dear Father,--So this must in future be the heading of my
+ letters--no longer my dear parents. Mother has gone. Yours of
+ November 21 reached me this afternoon, or evening rather. As I
+ came home from the chapel I found a beggar waiting at the gate. I
+ thought he was going to beg, but he did not. Inside I found the
+ gate-keeper waiting at our house door for a reply note, to say that
+ the letter had been delivered. I went to my study, and was praying
+ for a blessing on the chapel preaching when Emily came. I let her
+ in. She had your letter in her hand. It had come by Russia, and the
+ Russian post sometimes sends over our mail by a Peking beggar,
+ paying him of course.
+
+ 'I have not had time to think yet. On my heels came in men for the
+ prayer-meeting we hold in our house on Friday evening, and till now
+ I have been almost continuously engaged. It is now 10.20 P.M. It so
+ happens that this week I am much behind in my sermon preparation
+ for Sunday, and it also happens that I am going to preach on _whole
+ families_ believing on Christ. What brought this subject to my mind
+ is one of our old Christians who is dying, the only Christian in
+ his whole family. His great grief is that they (his family) remain
+ heathens. In addition, too, a Christian father admitted to a
+ missionary the other day that he had not taught Christ to his
+ daughter who had just died. Preaching on this subject I will have
+ something to say about my own dear, good, anxious mother, and of
+ how she used to say when I was a boy, "_What a terrible thing it
+ will be if I see you shut out of heaven!_" She did not say
+ terrible; "unco" was her word.
+
+ 'I have not yet had time to realise my loss, and cannot think of
+ the Hamilton house as being without her. Eh, man! you know how good
+ a mother she was to us, and I have some idea of what a companion
+ and help she was to you. You two had nearly fifty years together.
+ You must feel lonely without her. Fathers and mothers are thought
+ much of by the Chinese, and you, at my suggestion, were most
+ heartily and feelingly prayed for by the Chinese at our
+ prayer-meeting to-night. You would have felt quite touched could
+ you have heard and understood them.'
+
+There is a special interest attaching to the sentence used frequently by
+his mother. On page 41 he refers to his conversion, but no record
+appears to have been preserved, giving any detail or fixing with any
+exactness the date. But his brothers have a conviction that his constant
+recollection of the oft-repeated and well-remembered words, 'What an
+unco thing it will be if I see you shut out of heaven!' was one of the
+most potent influences in bringing about his conversion. The letters
+immediately following were written during the last two years of his
+father's life.
+
+ 'Let us not be disturbed at all about our not having more
+ communication. I pray often for you and remember you more
+ frequently still, and feel more and more that earth is a shifting
+ scene, that here we have no permanent place, that heaven is our
+ home, that your wife--my dear mother--has gone there, that my wife
+ has gone there and is now in the Golden City, and that, sooner or
+ later, you and I will be there, and that, when there, we'll have
+ plenty of time to sit about and talk all together in a company.
+ Lately I have come to see that we have but to put ourselves into
+ the hands of Jesus and let Him do with us as He likes, and He'll
+ save us _sure and certain_. He can make us willing even to let Him
+ change us and train us.
+
+ 'You are eighty years old. I am proud of you. I like to think of
+ your life. Mother told me, when I was a lad, of some of your early
+ struggles. God has been with you and guided you on through all to a
+ good old age of honour and respect and love. Trust Him and He'll
+ not leave you. Depend upon it, God has something better for us in
+ the world to come than He has ever given us here. And it is not
+ difficult to get it. God wants to give it to us all; offers it to
+ us, and is distressed if we don't take it. We have only to go to
+ Christ and ask Jesus to make it all right for us, and He'll do it.
+ I know you are in earnest. Jesus will turn away no earnest man.'
+
+Mr. Gilmour senior acted as steward of the little store which his son by
+rigid economy was amassing for the benefit of his children. Scotch
+thrift was well exemplified in them both. But in the course of 1887
+James Gilmour became troubled about this accumulation of even that small
+sum which he could call his own. In his lonely introspective Mongolian
+life the possession of money came to wear in his view the aspect of
+distrusting God. At this juncture the London Missionary Society was in a
+somewhat serious state as regards funds. A special appeal had been sent
+out indicating that if additional funds were not forthcoming, some
+fields of work might have to be given up. James Gilmour's response was
+an order to pay over anonymously the sum of 100_l._ to the general funds
+of the Society, and 50_l._ to that set apart for widows and orphans.
+
+
+ 'March 16, 1887.
+
+ 'My dear Father,--Some explanation is due to you of the order to
+ pay the London Missionary Society 100_l._ of my money as a
+ contribution to their funds.
+
+ 'The money that I have in the bank is the result of long and, much
+ of it, of self-denying savings on my part and the part of my late
+ wife--more on hers than mine, perhaps. When she died, and I was
+ going off to this remote and isolated field, it was a comfort to me
+ to think that in the event of my death there was a little sum laid
+ past which would help my sons to get an education. I have added to
+ that sum all I could from my house-furniture sale, &c., and it has
+ reached a good figure--the exact sum I cannot yet tell--I have not
+ yet had your account for 1886.
+
+ 'Some time ago God seemed to say, "_Entrust that money to My
+ keeping!_" and, as days went on, the command seemed to get more
+ loud and be ever present, so much so that finally I could not read
+ my Bible for it or pray. I had no resource left but to obey; I did
+ not like to give it up; but finally it has appeared to me that God
+ is only keeping the funds for the lads and that He will arrange for
+ them to have them all right when they are needed. How He can do
+ this I need not ask. He may, for instance, keep me alive for the
+ sake of the lads. In one sense it seems an unwise thing not to be
+ laying up something for the children's education; but that is only
+ one side of it. God seems to ask me to trust Him with my children,
+ and I trust Him with them. They are far from my care and control,
+ and I know such painful cases of the children of missionaries
+ growing up unbelievers that I dare not do anything that seems to me
+ not to be putting them fully into God's care and up-bringing.
+
+ 'In addition, I am exhorting people here to become Christians, by
+ doing which they throw themselves and their children outside of the
+ community. I tell them to do it, and trust God's protecting them in
+ troubles and helping them in difficulties; and I can hardly do that
+ if I have not faith in God myself for me and mine.
+
+ 'Again, I need God's help and blessing much in my work here, and I
+ do not seem to myself to be able to expect it if I do not trust
+ Him. So please regard the money removed as not lost, only put into
+ a safer bank.'
+
+The following letter, also dealing with money matters from the Christian
+point of view, is so striking in many ways that it has been deemed
+advisable to quote it _in extenso_:--
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang, Mongolia: May 6, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Father,--Enclosed please find some directions about the
+ disposal of my money. These arrangements are so contrary to my
+ previous arrangements that some explanation is due to you and to my
+ brothers. Here they are.
+
+ 'In my mission work out here I am much thrown upon God. The field
+ is a very hard one. The superstitions are like towns walled up to
+ heaven. The power of man avails nothing against them. As far as man
+ is concerned I am almost alone. I turn to God. I hear the words,
+ "Not by might nor by power, but by My Spirit," saith the Lord. I
+ trust Him. I call upon Him. I commune with Him. He comes near me. I
+ ask Him to convert men. There are conversions, a few true, as far
+ as I can judge. But there seems some barrier between God and me to
+ a certain extent. Thinking round to see what it can be, I hear a
+ voice saying, "Can't you trust Me with the money you have laid up
+ for your children?" I think over it I pray over it. I say, "I may
+ die and the boys need the money." God replies, "If you trust Me
+ with it, don't you think I'd give them it as they needed?" I say,
+ "But my father and brothers might not see it so, and might not like
+ the idea of destitute orphan children on their hands." God replies,
+ "With _Me_ for their banker children are not destitute, and if you
+ prefer father and brothers before Me, you are not worthy of Me."
+ Then I say, "What will you have me do?" God says, "Give Me the
+ money; I'll see they have all that is necessary." I dare not
+ disobey. I don't want to disobey. I am so much exercised over the
+ spiritual well-being of the boys, that I gladly do anything that
+ will make them in any sense more specially protÈgÈs of God. I am
+ alarmed at the fate of some missionaries' children who have not
+ turned out godly men. Preserve the boys from this!
+
+ 'This is no sudden resolution. I have thought and prayed much over
+ it. I can delay this step no longer without feeling I would be
+ refusing to follow God's guidance. I feel, too, that God has so
+ many ways in which He can bless the lads and me, that in making
+ this arrangement I am running no risk. The only thing I am not
+ quite clear about is the detailed disposition of the money.
+ Meantime, it seems to me that I can best use it for God in this
+ mission here. I mean to bank it in Peking, in the first instance,
+ and use it for renting or buying premises.
+
+ 'As to the general principle of having money for ourselves or
+ children, I do not think God asks us all to put all we may have or
+ get thus in His keeping, or asks me even to put _all_ into His
+ keeping in this especial manner. You know the money was originally
+ saved from the salary given by the mission, and in this sense is
+ peculiar. Money that I had earned by trade, or otherwise come by, I
+ do not think God would ask me to dispose of it so. But His voice
+ seems very plain in this present case.
+
+ 'My salary I shall still have paid to me, and the children's
+ remittances shall come as usual. If I live I guess this will be
+ enough for the education of the lads. If I die, the lads are not
+ destitute. Even in a worldly sense, and quite apart from this sum
+ which I am banking with God, and which I am sure He'll repay with
+ compound interest when needed, if left orphans they would be in
+ some sense provided for by the London Missionary Society, which,
+ though it gives no pensions to any one, yet yearly raises funds and
+ gives money to broken-down old missionaries, widows, and orphans. I
+ don't suppose it is much or enough, but it is something. I say this
+ that you may not be troubled should your faith be weak or waver.
+
+ 'I hope that these arrangements may not seem unwise to you, and
+ will commend themselves to you far enough to have your consent if
+ not your warm approval. For myself I am thankful that God has given
+ me faith enough to trust Him so. It has taken time to come to this.
+ Myself is a small matter--it takes more faith to trust for one's
+ children. Just fancy old Abraham offering his Isaac. Just fancy,
+ God so loved the world that He gave His only Son. Let us respond to
+ God's love.
+
+ 'Your loving son,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+In compliance with his wish a sum amounting to several hundred pounds
+was sent out to Peking and there banked by him. Had not the many
+difficulties which Chinese habits placed in the way prevented the
+completion of negotiations, there is hardly any doubt that James Gilmour
+would have himself spent this money on his own mission-field. He died
+before any of the negotiations for premises which he had commenced
+reached a successful issue. As he had not specified in his will that
+this sum was to be devoted to mission work, the trustees of his boys
+have had no alternative, and have felt it their duty to consider it a
+part of his estate, the income of which should be devoted to the
+education of his sons. But the intention of James Gilmour was clear and
+well known, and it is to be hoped that the interest felt by many friends
+in his life and work will prove strong enough to secure a permanent home
+for the mission as a memorial of its founder, and on the site of his
+glad and self-sacrificing toil.
+
+A year or two later, in a letter to his boys, he seeks to enforce the
+duty of careful, systematic giving to God.
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang: August 19, 1890.
+
+ 'I wonder if you are giving a tenth of all the money you get to
+ God. I think it is a right thing to do and a good thing. Mamma did
+ it: I do it: and God never let us want for money. I would be glad
+ if you would like to do it. But don't do it merely to please me.
+ Don't do it except you can do it gladly. God likes people to do
+ things gladly. I am quite sure you would get blessing by it. Money
+ given to God is never lost. And it is easier to begin the habit now
+ than later.
+
+ 'When you give it to God you can put it into the London Missionary
+ Society box; it would only be fair to give some little part of it
+ at the collection at the church to which you go. You could give
+ some of it for destitute children. It does not matter much where
+ you give it. I think the London Missionary Society has the best
+ claim. Think over it, boys. Jesus died to save us: surely we can
+ show our gratitude by giving Him some of our money?'
+
+Later letters to his father outline for us his religious experience, and
+enable us to realise something of the spiritual experience of these
+years.
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang: March 29, 1887.
+
+ 'I am wondering how you all are. God has been drawing me nearer to
+ Him these last weeks, and I am living in the hope that He will
+ bless me and my work largely some day. There is much ignorance to
+ be removed, much suspicion, much misunderstanding of me as a
+ foreigner, and I am hammering away as hard as I can. There are
+ mountains of difficulty to be removed, but I am trusting in God to
+ remove them, and these last days I have had much peace and joy in
+ my heart thinking of God's love to me and the salvation of Jesus. I
+ have no doubt at all about my being His, and sometimes the great
+ hope is almost too much to realise. But I am often at the same time
+ downcast that I cannot see more people here converted, and I think
+ that, if God has a favour to me and delights in me, He can well
+ move the hearts of these people to believe in His Son, and choose
+ out people to come and help me in my work. I am sometimes lonely
+ here, and wish I had a friend to talk to and tell all my troubles,
+ and then I think that Jesus is such a friend, and so I tell Him all
+ my griefs; but I would like to have a colleague.
+
+ 'I hope, my dear father, that your heart is contented and happy in
+ Jesus. Only let Him arrange all things for you as regards your
+ soul, and He'll do it all right. He can be trusted. Heaven is not
+ far away; we'll soon be there; comfort your heart. Won't it be too
+ blessed to be again with our wives, freed from all that is earthly,
+ and suffering, and surrounded by nothing but what is nice! This is
+ no dream: it is real; it is true; it is kept for us; it will be
+ ours. We'll see it soon; you and I will be there together. It may
+ be some time before we are there together; but years soon pass.
+ Cheer up, my father!
+
+ 'We miss much by not living near to Jesus--taking Him at His word
+ and expecting that He'll do all we need done for us both in saving
+ us and in making our hearts good. Jesus is real and heaven is real,
+ and our share in heaven, if we trust and follow Jesus, is real. You
+ say you are busy: so am I. You have cares: so have I. Go ahead and
+ look after your work and business; but you'll do it all the better
+ that your heart is at peace with God and at rest in Jesus. I find
+ that the closer I am to Jesus the better I can meet and bear all
+ troubles, trials, and difficulties, and you will find the same true
+ if you try.
+
+ 'I feel quite lifted up to-night. I have a room to myself. This is
+ the first time I have had a room to myself since leaving Peking
+ January 25. It is pleasant to be private a little. This room is
+ private to me alone only after (say) 8 P.M., when I am left in
+ peace. I hope to have this room for three weeks.
+
+ 'I am afraid, if you saw the room, you would not think it much of a
+ place. To-night, too, I have a pillow. For over three weeks I have
+ rested my head on some folded-up bag or article of dress: to-night
+ I have a pillow. Christ had not where to lay His head. In all
+ things I am still better off than He was. If I could only see souls
+ saved I would not care for the roughing it.'
+
+In a letter later in the same year to a missionary colleague in a
+distant field Mr. Gilmour unveils still further his religious history:--
+
+
+ 'Mongolia: October 7, 1887.
+
+ 'Yours of May 31 to hand three or four days ago. The China Inland
+ Mission has a lot of good men in it. It does a good work. It is
+ warm-hearted devotion that wins souls and gets God's approval. My
+ experience has been different from yours, happily. All along I have
+ gone on the "headlong for Christ" way of things here, even when
+ preaching to the most intellectual English and American audiences,
+ and they have received me royally. Man, God has waked me up these
+ last years to such an extent that I feel a different man. I
+ sometimes wonder now if I was converted before. I suppose I was,
+ but the life was a cold, dull one. Just the other day Jesus, so to
+ speak, put out His hand and touched me as I was reading a hymn,
+ something about desiring spiritual things and passing by Jesus
+ Himself. I wanted His blessing more than I wanted Him. That is not
+ right. Lately, too, I have become calm. Before I worked, oh so hard
+ and so much, and asked God to bless my work. Now I try to pray more
+ and get more blessing, and then work enough to let the blessing
+ find its way through me to men. And this is the better way. It is
+ the right way. And I work a lot even now. Perhaps as much as
+ before; but I don't worry at the things I cannot overtake. I feel,
+ too, more than I did, that God is guiding me. Oh! sometimes the
+ peace of God flows over me like a river. Then it is so blessed,
+ heaven is real. So is God: so is Jesus. Our lot is a great one.
+
+ 'Try not to fly around so much: take more time with God. Be more in
+ private prayer with Him, and see if He will not give you a greater
+ spiritual blessing for your people. After all, the great want, as I
+ gather from your letters, is the spiritual blessing on the people.
+ Ask it, man, and you'll get it. God's promises are sure. I am
+ trying to combine the China Inland Mission, the Salvation Army, and
+ the L.M.S. I have a great district, and a hard one, all to myself.
+ There is said to be a young doctor on his way out to me. I am
+ writing by this mail for three young laymen. Non-smoking and
+ teetotalism are conditions of Church membership. I have seen no
+ foreigner since January 25, and am not likely to see one till
+ December 5. My mails take an enormous time to reach me, and two
+ sent in June and July from Peking (eight days off) have never come
+ to hand at all. I am baffled, battered and bruised in soul in many
+ ways, but, thank God, holding on and believing that He is going to
+ bless me.
+
+ 'Eh, man, never talk of not going back. Go back, though you can
+ only do half work; go back, and work less and pray more. That is
+ what you need. I have been a vegetarian for over a year. I find
+ fasting helpful to prayer. Two books by Andrew Murray, Wellington,
+ Cape Town--_Abide in Christ, With Christ in the School of
+ Prayer_--have done me much good. May blessings be on your dear wife
+ and children! Yours, hoping to have a good long holiday with you in
+ heaven,
+
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Some years earlier in his career he had written a letter of brotherly
+remonstrance to one who, in a moment of depression and without any
+adequate cause, felt himself slighted. The same spirit breathes through
+both, but is richer and fuller in the later letter. God had been
+teaching James Gilmour in a hard, but a fruitful school.
+
+ 'I know of your zeal in working at home as well as abroad, and I am
+ greatly grieved to find you think you are badly treated. I think it
+ is very unfortunate that any agent should have that feeling about
+ his Society, L.M.S. or other. I am alarmed, too, my dear fellow, to
+ find you express yourself so strongly. It is hardly the thing.
+ Would Christ have said that? I do hope you will pardon my speaking
+ so, but you know sometimes a rash word does more harm than a deed
+ even. And I am anxious that you should have a peaceful mind. _I_
+ know your value, and wish to see you nearly perfect. Let me remind
+ you of a thing we both believe, and a thought I have often been
+ comforted by. Jesus has suffered even more for us than we can ever
+ suffer for Him, and what you do in raising funds and endeavouring
+ is done, not for L.M.S., but for Him, _for Him_, and He sees and
+ knows and won't forget, but sympathises and appreciates, and at the
+ end will speak up straight and open for His true men. I often lug
+ portmanteaus, walk afoot, and, as the Chinese say, "eat
+ bitterness," in China and in England. I am not thanked for it, but
+ He knows. No danger of being overlooked. Now, don't be "huffed" at
+ my lecturing you, and don't think I must think a lot of myself to
+ suppose that I am running up a bill of merit, like a Buddhist, and
+ think I am Jesus's creditor. My dear fellow, you know better than
+ that. I point out to you and remind you of the only way I know to
+ be persistently useful, and at the same time happy.'
+
+But of all the relationships of life--son, brother, friend, ambassador
+for Christ--that which most naturally, most profoundly, and most
+beautifully reveals his very heart is when he writes as the loving
+father to his distant motherless boys. A large number of his letters to
+them have been entrusted to the hands of his biographer. Many of them
+touch upon subjects too sacred for publication. They deal with those
+closest of earthly ties in which not even intimate friends can
+legitimately claim a share. But it was felt that they reveal a side of
+his nature and character that ought not to be entirely hidden in any
+picture of his life. For this reason a somewhat extensive selection has
+been made from this tender and helpful correspondence. When it first
+began the lads were too young to read the letters themselves, but he
+wrote long accounts of his work to be read to them, and it is pleasant
+to see how keen his eye became in noting such things as were likely to
+amuse them and to arrest their attention. Some of the letters are
+written in big letters resembling printed capitals. The brief, childlike
+letters that were sent to him by them were bound up into a paper volume,
+which he carried about with him during his Mongolian wanderings, and in
+looking them over he found an unfailing solace and refreshment. He often
+illustrated his own letters to them by rough but effective sketches of
+persons and things which he saw. The death of their mother had brought
+the lads and their father very near to one another, and although lost to
+sight, they always thought and spoke of the dear one who had gone as
+still of the family, as in perfect happiness, and waiting only God's
+time to reunite them in the happy life of heaven.
+
+When it was decided to entrust them to the care of an uncle in Scotland,
+Mr. Gilmour set out the desires he cherished with regard to their
+training. It is only to be regretted that similar plans are not formed
+and acted upon in the training of all children.
+
+ 'The laddies are here with me now, and I am both father and mother
+ to them. To-night I darned three stockings for them when they went
+ to bed. You see I have been away two months, and in a week or two I
+ may have to part from them for ten years, so I am having a little
+ leisure time with them. I sometimes do feel real bad at the idea of
+ the two orphan lads going away so far; but then the promise of
+ Christ that no one leaves parents or children for His sake, without
+ being repaid manifold, comforts me by making me believe that God
+ will raise up friends to comfort them wherever they may be.
+
+ 'Cheer up! The two worlds are one, and not far separate. Mrs.
+ Prankard, I hear, won't have Emily's name mentioned. We here go on
+ the other tack, and the children are all day long talking about
+ what mamma did and said, and adventures we had together. And why
+ not? The tears come sometimes: let them, they do no harm, are a
+ relief more than anything, and the time is coming when God will
+ wipe away all tears from our eyes.
+
+ 'I wish them to be Christ's from their youth up. I wish them to get
+ a good thorough education, not too expensive, to be able to read,
+ write, and spell well. Should either of them turn out likely, I
+ might be able to let both, or that one have a college education,
+ but I don't want either of them to go there if they don't show
+ adaptation for it.
+
+ 'What I want of you is something money cannot buy, motherly and
+ fatherly care in Christ for the desolate lads, whose whole life in
+ time and eternity too may largely depend on how they are trained
+ and treated during the next few years. I am not rich, but I can
+ support my boys. This Christian care and love, however, is what is
+ not to be had for money, so I beg it.
+
+ 'I had five hours' conversation with one Chinaman at a stretch the
+ other day. I think he was not far from the kingdom of God at first,
+ and I believe he is nearer now. All these things take time, and I
+ am most anxious to be with the children much these last days. Oh,
+ it is hard to think of them going off over the world in that
+ motherless fashion! We were at mamma's grave yesterday for the
+ first time since September 21. We sang "There is a land that is
+ fairer than day," in Chinese, and also a Chinese hymn we have here
+ with a chorus, which says, "We'll soon go and see them in our
+ heavenly home," and in English, "There is a happy land." The
+ children and I have no reluctance in speaking of mamma, and we
+ don't think of her as here or buried, but as in a fine place, happy
+ and well.'
+
+Here are a few short extracts from the earlier letters:--
+
+ 'Cheer up, my dear sonnies! We shall see each other some day yet.
+ Tell all your troubles to Jesus, and let Him be your friend. I, out
+ here, think often of mamma and her nice face, and how good she was
+ to you and to me. You will not forget her. She sees you every day,
+ and is so pleased when you are good lads. We'll all go some day and
+ be with her, won't that be good? Meantime, Jesus is taking care of
+ her, and will take care of us.
+
+ 'Sometimes, when I am writing a letter to you, and come to the foot
+ of a page, and want to turn over the leaf, I don't take blotting
+ paper and blot it, but kneel down and pray while it is drying.
+
+ 'I am going away, too, in a few days; then I'll have no one but
+ Chinese to speak to. Never mind, I'll just tell Jesus all my
+ affairs; I cannot go away from Him. He is never too busy to talk to
+ me. Just you, too, tell Jesus all your troubles. He sees both you
+ and me.'
+
+From the longer letters we select three or four, and give them exactly
+as they were written. From them the character of many others, from which
+only brief extracts can be taken, may be judged.
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang: April 10, 1887.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I am well and thankful for it. I am getting on well
+ too, thank God. I have had terrible weather lately though. Daily I
+ have my tent--it is only a cloth roof on six bamboo poles--put up
+ in the market-place. We have had three days' wind. Eh, man, the
+ first day the dust was terrible. But I had lots of patients and
+ remained out all day. At last we had to take down our tent. It
+ could not stand. The tent was carried to the inn, but we remained
+ with our table till evening. You would hardly have known us for
+ dust. But patients came all the time. Next day the tent was blown
+ down twice. Once a man's head got such a smack with the bamboo tent
+ pole, but he said nothing and took it quite pleasantly. A peep-show
+ man near us got his show blown down and scattered about. He
+ gathered it up and went home to his inn.
+
+[Illustration: JAMES GILMOUR'S TENT]
+
+ 'I am so glad that the people like us and trust us and come about
+ us for medicines. Women came too. Boys came too. Just now the
+ school boys have holiday for the fair, and they stand for a long
+ time together looking at me doctoring the people. What the boys
+ like to see is a glass bottle of eye medicine which I bring out and
+ set up. Then I dip a glass tube in and press an india-rubber
+ bulb. The air comes out in the water in bubbles and rises up to
+ the surface, and the boys are so delighted to see it bubbling. They
+ will wait a long time and like to see it ever so often. They are
+ sometimes troublesome, then I send them away. When they are good I
+ shove the glass tube deep down into the bottle, and they are so
+ delighted to see the air bubbling up from the bottom.
+
+ 'When a man comes to have a tooth pulled even the men are
+ delighted, and advise him to have it out. They want to see the fun.
+ Mothers send their little boys for medicine, and I am so pleased
+ with some of the little lads. They are so modest and so polite,
+ making a deep bow as they go away. Always be modest and polite, my
+ sons, and people will love you and treat you well.
+
+ 'The boys buy a lot of books too, and I preach to them earnestly,
+ because in ten years to come they will be men, and if they know
+ about Jesus now they may more easily become Christians some day
+ soon. You, Jimmie, know Jesus; does Willie? Teach him. Mamma is not
+ here to teach him, and I am far away. You are his big brother.
+ Teach you him like a good laddie as you are.
+
+ 'The other day when I was preaching a man was standing behind me
+ with a little black pig under his arm. He wanted to hear me preach,
+ but the pig would not be quiet. He held its mouth shut, but the
+ little pig would still manage to give a squeak now and again. At
+ last it would not be quiet at all, and he had to go away with it. I
+ could not help smiling at him. There is an old man here in my inn.
+ He is owner of the inn. His son manages the inn. The old man is not
+ very old. He is about sixty-five. But he used to be a great opium
+ smoker. A year or more ago he had a very serious illness and gave
+ up his opium, but he had wrecked his health by his smoking. He
+ cannot now live many months. He can hardly speak plainly now. He
+ comes to see me in my room, and I try to tell him about Jesus,
+ hoping that he may be saved. He listens, but he is not very bright
+ in his mind. I hope he may pray to Jesus.
+
+ 'The other day I had to pull my own tooth. It was the back tooth
+ and had been painful for days. There was no one who could do it for
+ me, so I sat down with a little Chinese looking-glass before a
+ candle, got a good hold of it with the forceps, and after a good
+ deal of wrenching out it came. He _was_ a deep-pronged fellow, and
+ he did bleed. I was so thankful that God helped me to get it out. I
+ can sleep now all right.
+
+ 'Our Mongol donkeyman wants to be a Christian. I hope he is
+ sincere, but he is very slow and dull at learning. There are three
+ other men here who are learning about Jesus too, but it is too
+ early yet to say much about them. A good many people learn some,
+ then stop. But it is late and I must go to bed, else I won't be
+ able to preach and doctor all day in the market-place at the fair
+ to-morrow.
+
+ 'Praying that God may bless you, my sons, and sending you much
+ love,
+
+ 'I am your affectionate Father,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+ 'Ta ChÍng Tz[)u]: Sept. 3, 1887.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I am well, and thankful for it. The three
+ Christians here come daily to evening worship. There are here
+ others who want to be Christians, but who have not courage enough.
+ One man's wife won't let him be a Christian; she says she will kill
+ herself if he does. Another man is in the same case. He is a
+ Chinaman, his wife is a Mongol. Still another man has a Mongol
+ wife, and she kept him back. The other day he came and confessed
+ Christianity. His wife does not consent, only says: "We'll see."
+ Another man's father hinders his son from Christianity. The lad is
+ a very nice lad.
+
+ 'Yesterday was the day when people make offerings of food and
+ fruit at the graves. One of the Christians was sent to do so. He
+ brought the melon here, and we ate half of it with him.
+
+ 'Still another man is forbidden by his father to be a Christian.
+ That is, in all, five men are Christians at heart, and read our
+ books and are learning Christianity, but do not confess Christ in
+ this one place. Do you know what Jesus says about such people
+ (Matt. x. 32-39)? Jesus says that, if they obey others rather than
+ Him, they are not worthy to be His disciples. I am praying for all
+ these people. I ask you, too, to pray for these and all like them,
+ that they may be able to confess Christ. It is difficult for men in
+ China to be Christians. How different with you! We all want you to
+ be Christians. Your father and friends all help you to be
+ Christians, and if you are not Christians we are all distressed.
+
+ 'Boys, do be true to Jesus. In your words and deeds honour Him.
+ Make _His_ heart glad. Jesus wants your love. He loves you and died
+ for you. You cannot but love Him if you think how He loves you.
+ Good-bye. Meantime I am just going to breakfast, and then for a day
+ on the street, trying to tell the people about Jesus. God bless
+ you, my dear lads!
+
+ 'It is now afternoon. I write a few lines. A lad in a shop here has
+ a tame dove. He has painted it all over different colours. It looks
+ absurd. I don't like to see it sitting about the shop. Doves look
+ so happy flying about. Mamma, too, liked to see birds on the trees
+ and houses wild, not kept in cages.
+
+ 'I guess you are just about getting your breakfast. Here it is
+ about 4 P.M. With you it should be 8 A.M. Saturday; I wish I could
+ see you. My love to you, my dear sons. May you always, both now and
+ when grown, be boys and men that know and love Jesus! I pray for
+ you. Your loving father,
+
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+In August 1884 a third son was given to Mr. and Mrs. Gilmour, whom they
+named Alexander. In 1887 spinal trouble developed, and in December of
+that year he died. 'Though often ill,' wrote his father when announcing
+the death to the uncle after whom he had been named, 'his life was a
+happy one. It is now happier than ever. Thanks be to God that there is,
+and that we know that there is, a bright and happy life beyond. Let us
+make that the great meeting-place for ourselves and our children and
+friends. May it stand before us as a joy! As ever and anon one and
+another goes there, may we feel that we have more and more interest
+there! Let us live looking to the joy set before us!' This baby-brother
+is the Alick referred to in the following letter:--
+
+
+ 'Ta ChÍng Tz[)u], Mongolia: February 11, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I am well, and thankful for it. I got here two days
+ ago. I had such a cold time of it on the road! I never felt the
+ cold so much before.
+
+ 'People here are very busy. This is the last day of the Chinese
+ year.
+
+ 'To-morrow is the first day of the Chinese year. Everybody is
+ buying all sorts of food, because the shops do not open for some
+ days after the new year. They are very busy, too, scraping off the
+ old papers at the sides of their doors and pasting up new papers.
+ They (the papers) are red, and look fine at first with the great
+ black Chinese characters written on them. But the sun after a while
+ takes the colour out of them.
+
+ 'They are busy, too, pasting up the new gods in their houses. They
+ (the gods) are sheets of paper with pictures of gods on them. Every
+ house has a god of the kitchen. They send him to heaven, as they
+ think, by burning him. They burnt the old one last Saturday. They
+ are putting up the new one now. They think that when he is burnt he
+ goes to heaven and reports to a god what he has seen in the house
+ during the year. I ask them if I burnt them would they think they
+ were going to heaven? They buy sticky sugar-cakes to give him so
+ that he may be pleased, and not tell on them for doing evil things.
+ They think, too, that the sugar sticks his lips together, so that
+ when he wants to tell on them he can't get his mouth open! Isn't it
+ all very silly and very sad? The shopkeepers, too, paste up a "god
+ of riches," thinking that thus they will become rich!
+
+ 'To-morrow (Sunday) I hope to baptize a man. He is a Chinaman. That
+ will make four Christians here. They all have faults and
+ weaknesses, and I am not very easy in my mind about them. Pray that
+ God may make them better and make them grow in grace. Pray, too,
+ that God may convert more of the people. Pray, too, that God may
+ give us a house of our own to live in. People here are afraid to
+ let us have a house. Now that Dr. Roberts is coming, we will need a
+ house. He is coming in six or seven weeks. Then he stays two
+ months, and goes back to Tientsin for a while again. We saw the
+ Christian at T· Ss[)u] Kou as we passed. The Ch'ao Yang man we have
+ not seen yet.
+
+ 'I have made all your letters to me into a book, and have them with
+ me. Your letters are nice to read, and show great improvement in
+ the writing. I am going to keep all your letters this year too and
+ bind them. You may like to see them when you grow big. The last
+ letter from you is dated October 27.
+
+ 'My dear sons, I think of you often and pray for you much.
+
+ 'You have a photo of mamma's grave. Little Alick's little mound is
+ close to mamma's, on the side nearer little Edie's. Mamma's and
+ Alick's coffins touch down below. They lie together. But mamma and
+ Alick are not there. They are in heaven, with its golden streets
+ and its beautiful river, and its trees of life, and its beautiful
+ gates, and its good, loving, kind people, and Jesus and God. They
+ are having such a nice time of it there!
+
+ 'My boys, don't be afraid of dying. Pray to Jesus, do the things He
+ likes, and if you die you will go to Him, to His fine place, where
+ you'll have everything that is nice and good. I don't know whether
+ you or I will go there first, but I hope that by-and-by we'll all
+ be there, mamma and Alick and all. I like to think of this.
+ Meantime let us be doing for Jesus all we can, telling people about
+ Him and trying to persuade them to be His people. Are your
+ schoolfellows Jesus' boys? Do you ever tell them of Him? Tell them,
+ my dear sons.
+
+ 'I hope to get letters from you in about a month.
+
+ 'Good-bye, my dear boys.
+
+ 'May you be good and diligent, and then you'll be happy. Jesus can
+ make you glad.
+
+ 'Your loving Father,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Mrs. Meech had shown much motherly kindness to her little nephew
+Alexander, and only a few months after he had died she herself lost a
+little son. Mr. Gilmour, on hearing the sad tidings, wrote to her as
+follows:--
+
+
+ 'Mongolia: March 25, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Mrs. Meech,--Many congratulations and condolences with
+ you. Your little son has gone to Emily. She'll look after the
+ little man as you looked after her little man. Just fancy! we have
+ family connections in heaven not a few, and ever increasing. I hope
+ you are now getting better and going on all right.
+
+ 'I am much cheered by the good news of soul movements in the West
+ Mission. May they continue and increase!
+
+ 'With many prayers for you all, and kept in constant remembrance of
+ you all by the date block,
+
+ 'Yours in loving sympathy,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+ 'May 30, 1888.
+
+ 'I am doctoring a little homeless lad's head here. I put on
+ ointment all over it to-day. He cried. I said I had medicine that
+ would stop the pain, and brought out six cash--one farthing--and
+ told him to go and have a bowl of buckwheat meal strings. All
+ laughed, he stopped crying, and did not seem to feel the pain after
+ that. Most of the people in the town are much impressed with the
+ improvement in the boy's head. Before he came to me I saw a Chinese
+ medicine-man poking at the lad's head with a straw. When he came I
+ rubbed on ointment with my finger. The bystanders were much pleased
+ to see I was not averse to touching the poor dirty lad's sore head.
+ Jesus touched a leper, and I like to do things like what Jesus
+ would do. That is the right way, boys. Always think what Jesus
+ would have done, and do like Him.'
+
+
+ 'Mongolia: Sept. 9, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I am out on a journey. I knew letters were being
+ sent me, and hoped to meet them. A long way off I saw a red
+ umbrella, the sun shining through the oilcloth. The thought passed
+ through my mind, "Can that be the messenger?" But I forgot all
+ about it, reading a book as I walked along. All at once I heard,
+ "He's come," and looking up, saw the red umbrella close at hand. It
+ _was_ him. The messenger returns to-morrow. I had had no letters
+ for eighty days.
+
+ 'I wrote you last on August 2. Since then several men have
+ professed Christ, and one man has been baptized.
+
+ 'One of the Christians at Ta ChÍng Tz[)u] stole my bankbook and
+ drew money of mine, amounting to about 3_l._ He says he is
+ penitent, and we have put him on a year's probation to see how he
+ does. He is a lazy man. Long ago I said, "If you are lazy, some day
+ the devil will make you a sinner," and so he did. Had he been a
+ diligent man he would not have been poor and would not have stolen.
+ Diligence is a good thing, laziness is a bad thing. A good
+ Christian cannot be lazy, because he knows Jesus does not like lazy
+ people. I may write you again in a few days. Hoping next mail to
+ get a letter from you (there was none this mail), and asking God to
+ bless you in everything, and guide you in all your life,
+
+ 'I am your loving Father,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR'
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang, Mongolia: Saturday, November 17, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--On the street to-day I saw a crowd standing. I went
+ up to see what they were looking at, and found two Chinese
+ gentlemen showing off a trained bird. One of the men stood down on
+ the street. The other put three little flags so that they stuck on
+ the wall. The bird then flew away, caught up a flag, and came
+ flying back to its master in the street, carrying the flag in its
+ bill. It looked very clever. Every time the bird brought a flag it
+ was rewarded by being fed with some nice food which it liked. It
+ was very pretty to see it. But after all it was a very trifling
+ employment for two grown gentlemen to be engaged in. Even the crowd
+ of ordinary Chinese seemed to think so.
+
+ 'I don't like to see birds in captivity. It is pretty to see them
+ wild flying about, and to hear them singing, but I pity them in
+ cages, and tied by string as the Chinese are fond of doing with
+ them. When I see birds tied I often think of mamma who used so much
+ to like to see them wild.
+
+ 'I remember one day in Mongolia mamma stopped me from plucking a
+ flower; she said it looked so pretty growing. Another time a beetle
+ flew and alighted somewhere; mamma said, "It is so glad that it is
+ alive, don't hurt it."
+
+ 'I am a good deal distressed to see the boys in the market-place.
+ They steal just as much as ever they can from the sellers of straw
+ and fuel, pluck out handfuls from the bundles and run away not at
+ all ashamed. If the owner does not chase them they get off with it.
+ If he throws down his load and runs after them they drop the
+ plunder, the owner picks it up, and no more is said about it.
+
+ 'In summer little naked boys follow people carrying fruit in open
+ baskets and steal it as they can: it all seems so dishonest, and no
+ one seems to care. On the street lots of people will see a thief
+ stealing a man's pipe and never say a word, because it is not their
+ business.'
+
+ 'I often think of you and pray for you. You do not forget mamma, I
+ am sure. She is with Jesus. Be you His lads, and do your lessons
+ well, and He'll guide you all through life. Be diligent and careful
+ lads, and you'll grow up useful and honoured men. Constantly tell
+ Jesus all your affairs.
+
+ 'Goodbye meantime, my boys.
+ 'Much love from your affectionate Father,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+CLOSING LABOURS
+
+
+James Gilmour remained in Great Britain less than eight months. The
+society of his boys was a great delight to him. He rejoiced in renewed
+intercourse with relatives and old friends. His religious convictions
+and his own spiritual life deepened still more. He went to a
+considerable number of meetings to speak on missionary work and needs,
+and he everywhere produced a great impression.
+
+Referring to this visit, and especially to his intercourse with the
+boys, a near relative writes:--
+
+'It was a time full of interest and pleasure. What a variety of moods,
+from the frolicsome to the pathetic, he displayed! But evidently his
+wife's death had laid hold upon his very soul, and there seemed so much
+more of sadness and tenderness than on his former visit, when he had
+enjoyed her bright companionship. On one occasion, referring to a
+medical missionary who had brought his wife home from China hopelessly
+ill, and who was expecting the end, he said: "Eh, man, he little knows
+the _terrible_ dark valley he has to come through, and if Christ is not
+with him he will be undone!" He spoke the words as though he were again
+going through his own agony, and then added: "But if Christ is with him
+he will come out of it with victory, and Christ will be dearer. But he
+has _no_ idea what he has to face, though he thinks he has."
+
+'He had looked forward to spending part of his time with his sons at
+Millport, where he had spent June and July 1883 with his wife and boys
+on his former visit. So we went there for a month, and they had a good
+time boating, and walking, and reviving old memories of the happy home
+circle. The thought of reunion was always made prominent. The boys must
+ever remember his earnest efforts to lead their thoughts heavenward, and
+they do think of heaven as a very real place.
+
+'While at Millport he spent several nights in pasting up texts on every
+place likely to catch the eye; on stones and gateways and fences all
+round the island. He felt he must work while time was granted to him. I
+had noticed him making paste, but thought nothing of it. I had heard the
+sound of a softly closing door at midnight, but thought it must be
+fancy. It had gone to my heart to feel his icy cold hand when he gave me
+his morning greeting. I noticed the little texts pasted up, but never
+thought of them as his work till the next day, when he began to make
+more paste, and then the whole thing came to me like a flash. I begged
+him with tears not to go out in the cold night air, and said that I knew
+God would rather have him stay in his warm comfortable bed and get well
+and strong. He answered so kindly: "Sister, it pains me to grieve you."
+But he finished his work nevertheless.
+
+'He was always wonderfully considerate, and grateful for any attention.
+Sometimes, when he saw me unusually tired, he would go and get an extra
+pillow and make me rest on the sofa, or when we came to the table he
+would place me in a comfortable chair and pour out the tea himself, or
+he would say: "Sister, take a cup yourself first, then you will be able
+to help us."
+
+'On the day before he left us to return to China he really said his
+farewell. We had finished dinner, and when he went out he stood and
+looked in through the window at the happy faces still around the table.
+He threw a kiss, and then his feelings overcame him, his lip quivered,
+the tears came to his eyes, and he hastened away. Later in the day, when
+I was speaking hopefully of seeing him again, he answered: "I shall see
+your face no more."
+
+'I know he felt very much giving up the comforts of civilised life, but
+he set his face to it. It touched me much the last evening he was with
+us, when, after I had to remind him two or three times of some business
+it was needful for him to attend to before he would go, he said: "I can
+hardly drag myself away from this bright cosy scene."
+
+'His was a rarely sensitive soul. It pained him to hear any one speaking
+evil of another. I have seen him turn deadly pale when he has heard any
+one impute a wrong motive. He longed for more of the spirit of Christ
+among men. How he longed, too, for more workers in the Mission field!
+Many a time he would say, after a walk through Hamilton on a Saturday
+evening: "Just think! In a little town like this there are men preaching
+at every other street corner, and I am alone in all of those hundreds of
+square miles in Mongolia! What you people are thinking of I cannot
+imagine!"'
+
+In a correspondence which he conducted with the daughter of one of his
+former professors there is very much that reveals how deep and strong
+his religious life had become, and how he had noted the current of
+renewed spirituality which is evident now in all sections of the
+Evangelical Church.
+
+From this correspondence we have been permitted to cull some beautiful
+and helpful passages.
+
+
+ 'Glasgow: November 18, 1889.
+
+ 'May He Himself lead you into closer and closer communion with Him,
+ and give you in very full measure His joy and His peace! For myself
+ and for you, I pray that we may be more captivated with Him and His
+ friendship. You know, I suppose, No. 565, "In the Secret of His
+ Presence," in the 750 edition of Sankey. No. 328, "O Christ, in
+ Thee my soul hath found," is one I like too, as being the
+ expression of partly experience and partly aspiration. He is truly
+ the true source of true satisfaction. May we be led to trust Him
+ more largely in all the things of our lives! I am sure, too it will
+ be the things where we have trusted Him most and been most
+ consecrated in His service that we shall value most when we look
+ back on life from the end. May you be largely satisfied with His
+ blessing and Himself!'
+
+
+ 'November 20, 1889.
+
+ 'I wonder if your experience is anything like mine--that I have
+ often got less benefit than I had hoped from special withdrawals
+ from common surroundings to get more into the presence of the Lord.
+ One or two prominent instances of this have happened to me. I am
+ glad He can be found anywhere, and that He is easy of access always
+ with favourable or unfavourable surroundings.
+
+ 'About feeling--never mind that at all. Things are so whether we
+ feel them or not. Let us take God at His word, and not consider
+ our feelings. God refuses no one who comes to Him in sincerity. Let
+ us be sure of this. I once heard Spurgeon say a good thing: "When
+ doubts or the devil comes and says, 'You are not saved; you are not
+ right with God,' I go to Him and say, 'If I never came before, I
+ come now; if I never trusted before, I trust now.'" That cuts off
+ all doubts about the present as standing on the past, and gives a
+ fresh start.
+
+ 'All over the kingdom there is a hunger and thirst among many for a
+ life of greater nearness to God; a feeling not only of the need of
+ God being more of a daily, hourly reality and factor in our life,
+ but that without Him more real and present life is not a
+ satisfactory thing. When this feeling takes possession of one, we
+ do not need to give up things as denying ourselves for Christ, so
+ much as that we are changed in attitude towards many things. We
+ drift away from them. Things that were gain to us we count loss for
+ Christ. Our aims are different. May our lives be more fully taken
+ captive thus! To a life lived thus, death is not a breaking off of
+ anything; it is an enlargement of sphere.'
+
+
+ 'Hamilton: December 5, 1889.
+
+ 'All I know about the process is just going to God and telling what
+ I want, and asking to be allowed to have it. "Seek, and ye shall
+ find; ask, and ye shall receive." I know no secret but this.... God
+ understands His scholars, and knows how to teach each one.
+ Different scholars may require different ways. We may trust
+ ourselves in His hands, only let us be earnest students. I have at
+ different times been quite surprised how a book, or a friend, or a
+ remark conveying just the teaching needed at the time has been
+ brought into my way. Yes, none teach like Him.'
+
+ '_December 25, 1889._--Oh that we may be more completely given over
+ and up to Him to be used at His pleasure and as He pleases! Oh for
+ more faith in Him! My lads are, I think, enjoying themselves; I
+ commit them to Him; but eh!'
+
+ '_January 1, 1890._--Just returned with my two lads after a day
+ spent in London seeing my ship, the "Peshawur". The ship is full.
+ My berth is not in a good place--but it is not bad, after all, and
+ it is not for long.... You'll have lots of need of wisdom, and
+ Jesus is made unto us wisdom as well as other things.... He'll
+ teach you all right. Don't let us refrain for fear we make
+ mistakes. The greatest mistake we could make would be to do
+ nothing....
+
+ 'Everyone is amazed to see me look so well. It is remarked on all
+ round. I feel remarkably well too....
+
+ 'May God be pleased to use me in His service!'
+
+
+His heart was in Mongolia. At the very earliest moment which the medical
+authorities and the Directors of the London Missionary Society would
+sanction he returned. He sailed for China on January 9, 1890. As the
+steamer was running down the English Channel he wrote a letter to an old
+college friend just returning to England whom he had not seen for twenty
+years, and whom he was very sorry to miss:--
+
+ 'In answer to yours of November 19 I directed an envelope to you
+ long ago. It has lain in my writing-case ever since, often seen but
+ always taken precedence of by the thing that stepped in before.
+ Now's your turn. I'm sorry you'll not see me in England. I sailed
+ yesterday My health has been restored, and I am off again.
+
+ 'You say you want reviving--Go direct to Jesus and ask it straight
+ out, and you'll get it straight away. This revived state is not a
+ thing you need to work yourself up into, or need others to help
+ you to rise into, or need to come to England to have operated upon
+ you--Jesus can effect it anywhere, and does effect it everywhere
+ whenever a man or woman, or men and women ask it. Ask and ye shall
+ receive.
+
+ 'My dear brother, I have learned that the source of much blessing
+ is just to go to Jesus and tell Him what you need. I am delighted
+ to hear you say you need blessing, because I know there is plenty
+ and to spare with Jesus. Oh for an outpouring on all parts of the
+ L.M.S. missions!
+
+ 'There is so much that I would like to say that it is hardly worth
+ while beginning to say anything; so I'll simply commend you to
+ Jesus in all His fulness.'
+
+On January 21, 1890, when nearing Port Said, he wrote:--
+
+ 'We have excellent company on board. Never had such a very pleasant
+ voyage. Some of the First Salooners come to our Bible readings.
+ Those who are unfriendly to Christianity are careful to give no
+ cause of offence and are polite. So far our voyage has been an
+ exquisite picnic. Knowing well what is before us, we still rejoice
+ in the present Elim and calmly trust for the future. I went on
+ board with a "tremendous cold." So did two or three others. Mine,
+ as I expected, went with the exposure.... No one teaches like Him
+ who also was the first of preachers. In daily, hourly, humble
+ communication with Him you will want for no wisdom and for no
+ guidance and for no shepherding. Rejoice in that you have Him to
+ manage everything for you.'
+
+He reached Peking on March 14, 1890, and on March 24 started again for
+Mongolia. He entered upon his last spell of work with a good heart and
+with high hopes. Dr. Smith was to be his medical colleague. While in
+England Mr. Gilmour had visited Cheshunt College, and had there fired
+the heart of Mr. Parker with the desire and purpose of being his
+colleague. He was looking forward to his speedy arrival. During his
+absence in England Dr. Smith had paid one brief visit to Mongolia by
+himself, and another, still briefer, in the company of the Rev. T.
+Bryson of Tientsin. Meanwhile the work had been going on slowly and
+steadily under the care of the native helper, Mr. Liu, and of some of
+the converts. We now follow the story of this last year's work as it is
+told in Mr. Gilmour's letters and reports. On May 9, 1890, he wrote to
+the Rev. R. Wardlaw Thompson:--
+
+ 'I have been all over the district, spending a month at Ch'ao Yang.
+ There we were privileged to baptize four adults, one a woman, and
+ one child, all Chinese. Two of these were young men who have been
+ under instruction for eight or nine months, and are very pleasing
+ cases indeed. The other two were a man and his wife, who is the
+ first woman who has had courage to be baptized in this district.
+ These last are an outcome of the medical work. They live in a small
+ hamlet where the first beginning of an interest in Christianity
+ took its rise from a man who came to me in the market-place with a
+ bad sore in his leg, which had been caused by a wound from his own
+ harvest sickle. The sore was cured, and friendly relations sprung
+ up with the whole hamlet, and I am thankful to hear that, though
+ only one family has put away its idols, all the neighbours are
+ friendly.
+
+ 'In Ch'ao Yang there are several inquirers. Some of the Christians
+ give great satisfaction, others are not so satisfactory. One man, a
+ Christian, tells me that his wife was possessed by an evil spirit,
+ and to please her and cure her he had to allow the re-establishment
+ of the worship of that spirit for her benefit. No sooner was this
+ done than the woman was cured! Such things are firmly believed in
+ by the Chinese.
+
+ 'A most pleasing incident in our experience at Ch'ao Yang was a
+ visit from a well-to-do farmer who lives some twenty li from the
+ town. He has been friendly and an inquirer from the first. He has
+ made no profession of Christianity, but says he reads his New
+ Testament regularly, and prays. He has also taught two men in his
+ neighbourhood. The one is a carpenter. The other is a farmer. They
+ know the Catechism, observe the Sunday, and meet with Mr. FÍng for
+ worship. Both of these men we saw, and their story seems true. FÍng
+ came and spent a day with us. I asked him why he did not make an
+ open profession of Christianity. His reply was that he lives with
+ his parents, as all Chinese do, and that he cannot arrange his
+ house disregarding them, who with his wife and children are still
+ heathen. He has been able only partially to do away with idols in
+ his own house. Outside too of his own house heathen pressure is so
+ great that, he says, were he to join Christianity it would be no
+ use for him to live! He says he lacks the courage single-handed to
+ meet all the persecution that would descend on him were he
+ baptized. Meantime he is instructing those about him in the hope,
+ apparently, that were there several together they could better
+ stand the trouble. It is an interesting case, but not at all
+ satisfactory. My hope about him is that, if he keeps conversant
+ with the Word of God, the Spirit may give him no rest till he has
+ courage to take his stand and make his confession.
+
+ 'We had a splendid month in the market-place. Chinese and Mongols
+ in plenty, both to preach to and to heal. One Mongol betrayed a
+ most intimate and full knowledge of Christianity. The drought gave
+ good opportunity of speaking of many things, and in most cases we
+ had respectful attention. It was a _hard_ month's work. Seven till
+ noon or a little after was our market time; the afternoon private
+ patients, the evening inquirers, makes a very long day, which
+ begins at daylight and does not end till after the second watch of
+ the night has been set. The Chinese usually secure a rest just
+ after noon, but frequently just then some patient would turn up,
+ and put an end to quiet. In most cases the strain is relieved by
+ holidays through rain and storm; but even this was wanting this
+ time, so we had almost uninterrupted work.
+
+ 'I am more than ever eager to have the medical work given over to a
+ medical man. One day in Ch'ao Yang a man came swaggering across the
+ open space in the marketplace. People pointed towards him and
+ laughed. He was laughable, the ridiculous part of him being a straw
+ hat which was an imitation, caricature rather, of a foreigner's
+ hat. I could not help laughing. It was no laughing matter, though.
+ He was a messenger from the cavalry camp just outside the town. He
+ had come to take me to treat two soldiers who had received
+ bullet-wounds in an encounter with Mongolian brigands. I had never
+ seen a bullet-wound in my life, but I knew I could do more for the
+ wounded men than any Chinese doctor; so I went. The wounds were
+ then forty-eight hours old, and I dressed them as best I could,
+ paying a daily visit for about a fortnight. Two wounds, though
+ deep, were merely flesh; with these I had no difficulty. The third
+ was a bone complication. I knew nothing of anatomy, had no books,
+ absolutely nothing to consult; what could I do but pray? And the
+ answer was startling. The third morning, when in the market-place
+ attending to the ordinary patients, but a good deal preoccupied
+ over the bone case, which I had determined should be finally dealt
+ with that day if possible at all, there tottered up to me through
+ the crowd a _live skeleton_, the outline of nearly every bone quite
+ distinct, covered only with yellow skin, which hung about in loose
+ folds. I think I see him yet--the chin as distinctively that of a
+ skeleton as if it had bleached months on the plain. The man was
+ about seventy, wore a pair of trousers, and had a loose garment
+ thrown over his shoulders. He came for cough medicine, I think; if
+ so, he got it; but I was soon engaged fingering and studying the
+ bone I had to see to that afternoon. I was deeply thankful, but
+ amidst all my gratitude the thing seemed so comical that I could
+ not help smiling, and a keen young Chinaman in the crowd remarked,
+ in an under tone, "That smile means something." So it did. It
+ meant, among other things, that I knew what to do with the wounded
+ soldier's damaged bone; and in a short time his wound was in a fair
+ way of healing. I was and am very thankful; but, after all, I am
+ more impressed than ever with the fact that things are badly out of
+ joint when there are lots of Christian doctors at home, and abroad
+ too, and I, knowledgeless, am left to do the doctoring in a large
+ district like this quite beyond the reach of medical help, not only
+ for the natives but even for myself should I need it.
+
+ 'A grim commentary on these wounds was the fact that in leaving
+ Ch'ao Yang I was to pass through a brigand-infested district--so
+ badly infested that travellers have abandoned the road. As saith
+ the Scripture, "The highways were unoccupied, and the travellers
+ walked through byways." I had avoided this road twice, and was
+ ashamed to avoid it again, so we went straight through it. We saw
+ no one to harm us, but a week ago it was just as likely that I
+ should to-day have been lying on a Chinese kang, trying to dress my
+ own wounds, as that I should have been sitting here writing to you.
+
+ 'I am at present waiting for Dr. Smith, whose last word to me,
+ dated Tientsin, April 9, was that I should either see him or hear
+ from him here between June 6 and 12.
+
+ 'Yesterday, Sunday, June 8, had a pleasant day. The three
+ Christians here have grown. Two of them have been through a good
+ deal of trouble and stood it well. The farmer, who has been very
+ ill, guessing we would be here, came in and spent the day with us.
+ They seem very earnest.'
+
+The beneficial result of the home visit of 1889 was very evident at this
+time. It had arrested the 'running down,' from which he had severely
+suffered. It had enabled him to renew old friendships, and to form new
+ones. His wholehearted devotion to the difficult work of his life and
+the wonderful intensity and depth of his faith had touched the hearts of
+many faithful men and women at home, who gladly responded to his
+oft-repeated request, 'Pray for me and for the conversion of the Chinese
+and the Mongols.' He renewed his interest in the broad current of the
+world's life. We have seen how some years previously he gave up all
+reading but the Bible. Now, while he studied the Bible with all his old
+eagerness, he had various newspapers sent to him, he rejoiced in the
+receipt of books sent by friends--especially those bearing upon the
+culture of the soul--and he kept his eye upon the religious and social
+movements of the day.
+
+The selections from his correspondence which follow illustrate these
+changes in him. He modified his mode of life in Mongolia. Having given
+up vegetarianism on his homeward voyage he did not resume it upon his
+re-entrance on Mongol life. He remained a total abstainer, and his
+hatred of opium, whisky, and tobacco continued as strong as ever,
+although he did not now make abstinence from the two latter a test of
+Church membership. He reserved more of the Sunday as a day of rest,
+taking only the religious services with the Christians and inquirers,
+and not, as formerly, setting up his tent on the street. The old
+careworn look disappeared, his form regained much of its former life and
+spring, and his face filled out, his smile resumed the brightness of
+old, and the voice came back to a good deal of its early clearness. All
+these evidences of a change for the better served to augur many years of
+happy work. In a letter to a friend he playfully alludes to the twenty
+or thirty years of labour yet remaining, and he often--half in jest and
+half in earnest--asserted that life in the interior was so healthy that
+he should probably outlive his fellow-workers at Tientsin and Peking.
+
+By the mail that conveyed the letter quoted on page 263 he also wrote to
+an Edinburgh friend:--
+
+ 'Do you know Adolphe Monod's _Farewell_? It was sent to me lately
+ by Rev. C. New, of Hastings, an old Cheshunt fellow-student. I have
+ enjoyed it all, but most, I think, chapter xii., "Of Things not
+ seen." A volume of sermons, entitled _The Baptism of the Spirit,
+ and other Sermons_, by Mr. New, I have enjoyed intensely. To the
+ meek child-like spirit desiring the sincere nourishing of the Word
+ nothing, I think, could be more helpful.... If ever you send a book
+ to the boys, let it be one that will do their souls good.
+
+ 'I may be filling my life too full, but between medical work and
+ spiritual work I have barely time to sleep, and I find that, for
+ any hope of continuance of work, I must have time to sleep. For the
+ last month I have been getting up at 4.30 A.M., and our evening
+ worship and after conversation was not over till, say, 9 or 9.15
+ or 9.30, or even, once or twice, till 10 P.M. Then it would take us
+ some time to square up the day's affairs, and spread out my
+ bedding. In the daytime I used to bolt my door, determined on an
+ hour's quiet; but often this was in vain. I would hear some poor
+ cultivator come for medicine; he had a long way to go home, and I
+ could not but let him in and attend to him.
+
+ 'Yesterday, as no one knew we were here, I escaped at 5.30 and made
+ for the hot springs, twelve miles away. I walked there and back,
+ and in consequence to-day am lame on my feet--badly blistered. I
+ had a grand day--so quiet. Going, I sat down behind a mud wall and
+ read the four first chapters of Hebrews. Arrived, I had my bath,
+ then got an empty room in an inn, had sleep, dinner, tea, and read
+ the rest of Hebrews. I never saw so much in Hebrews before.... On
+ the road I had a four-mile conversation with a farmer, who finally
+ said he believed Christianity was true. We have baptized six in all
+ since I returned, five adults and one child--_all Chinese_. "Be not
+ weary in well-doing. In due time we shall reap, if we faint not."
+ We are on God's side. God has need of us. Oh let us be such as God
+ can take pleasure in! Faithfulness and love to Him are what He
+ wants. Surely we can let Him have these two. Oh that it might be
+ that everyone in every contact with us might feel the spiritual
+ touch! Would not this be ideal Christian life? May He work it in
+ us!
+
+ 'Have you been to any Salvation Army efforts? I always felt better
+ for going, but latterly did not go much--I could not stand the
+ "row." I am eager that you should identify yourself with some
+ soul-saving agency. If it really is a soul-saving concern, I don't
+ think it matters very much what it is.'
+
+On July 21, 1890, he wrote to the same friend:--
+
+ 'Since July 3 we have had most extraordinary weather for this
+ part--rain and dull; there have been only four or five days when I
+ could go on to the street with my tent. I am therefore not so busy.
+ In addition, Dr. Smith has joined me, and as he does all the indoor
+ medical work, I am still less busy, and so I can write you more at
+ leisure than usual.
+
+ 'The rain reached a climax on Saturday night, July 19. Till then,
+ roofs and walls held out well. There were leaks in places, but
+ nothing serious. We thought it had cleared off. Not a bit of it.
+ The wind changed, it is true, but then rain came down in torrents,
+ the ceilings--all reeds and paper--began to give way. Ever and anon
+ splash came a bag of water, as the paper burst in different places,
+ and Dr. Smith and I had a lively time of it shifting our boxes and
+ bedding to dry spots. By dusk it was serious. I was just about my
+ wits' end when a Chinaman put his head into my room, and said with
+ a grin, half in jest, half in earnest, "There is a tent standing
+ idle out in that room, why not put it up in your room?" The idea of
+ putting up a tent in your bedroom seemed so absurd that we had a
+ good laugh over it; but after thinking over it awhile, and thinking
+ out how the thing could be done, we actually did it. It covered
+ two-thirds of my kang, and a little space on the floor where I put
+ my boxes. The inner corner of the tent I put up to cover my stock
+ of books and medicines, lit my lamp, brewed a pot of tea, and,
+ squatting on my feet, called in Dr. Smith. He said I looked "just
+ like an opium-smoker." Dr. Smith had a portable iron bedstead. On
+ the top he put floor mats and a waterproof, and, without
+ undressing, we went to bed. After a little a great crash was heard.
+ Some part of the buildings had come down. In the rain and dark it
+ was not easy to see what it was, but we at last found there had
+ been more noise than real damage. We were thankful when day
+ dawned.
+
+ 'The Chinese suffered much more than we did. Such a rain happens so
+ seldom--once in three or four or five years--that houses are not
+ roofed to resist it; the Chinese deeming it cheaper to take the
+ wetting than to spend the extra money it would take to make the
+ house stand such an extra rain.
+
+ 'In the wet weather I have been going into the Chinese Psalms, and
+ have been much struck with the happy state of those who "fear the
+ Lord," "trust in the Lord," and who, under a variety of
+ expressions, are described as being on the Lord's side, and under
+ His protection.
+
+ 'And all these promises we can take for ourselves. Did you see in
+ _The Christian_ some time ago a story from Annan, of an old woman
+ who was on the point of being sold out for not paying her rent? She
+ had no money. Her son was in America. A neighbour, thinking it
+ strange that her son had not sent her money, asked to see her
+ letters. There was one with a Post-office Order for 7_l._ 10_s._ in
+ it. She had had it for some time, but thought it was only a
+ picture. When cashed she was in funds. Wasn't she a stupid old
+ woman? To be bankrupt, with an uncashed P.O. Order in her
+ possession! How often we are much more stupid than she! To be
+ fearful, anxious, troubled, cast down, when we have all the
+ promises of God in our possession, ready for our use.
+
+ 'Let us cash our cheques. Nay, we have not only God's promises, but
+ God Himself for our portion. Why should we be spiritually bankrupt?
+
+ 'Another thing I notice is the difference subjective states make in
+ reading the Psalms. Sometimes I go over a Psalm and see little in
+ it. At another time I go over the same Psalm and find it full of
+ richness. How important it is to have the light of the Holy Spirit
+ in our Scripture reading!'
+
+ '_July 30._--The little _Wordless Book_ you sent soon fell into the
+ hands of a Chinese convert, who asked to be allowed to carry it
+ off. He wants to speak from it. He likes it because it gives him
+ _carte blanche_, and lets him say just what he likes....
+
+ 'How full the Psalms are! These days I am going through them in
+ Chinese, as I said; I take one each morning and commit some verses
+ of it carefully. Then, during the day, as time permits, I read a
+ few more. How one the soul of man is! When dull and cold and dead,
+ and feeling as if I could not pray, I turn to the Psalms. When most
+ in the spirit, the Psalms meet almost all the needs of expression.
+ And yet deluded men talk of the Bible as the outcome of the Jewish
+ mind! The greatest proof of the Divine source of the book is that
+ it fits the soul as well as a Chubb's key fits the lock it was made
+ for.... Now I am off to the street with my tent.'
+
+
+ 'Mongolia: July 28, 1890.
+
+ 'My dear Meech,--Dr. Smith came here July 2. The rains set in
+ immediately on his arrival, and we _have_ had it since. The
+ spiritual rain has not come yet, nor are there any signs of it.
+ When it does come may it come like the physical rain! Glad to see
+ you have been having some. May you have much more! Make the valley
+ full of ditches, brother, and then look out for the flood. Do you
+ think we'll be able to go up to Him at last and say, "We did our
+ part, but you did not do yours, Lord"? Eh, man! Elijah called down
+ fire with a short prayer, but his servant made six vain journeys to
+ the summit only to return with the discouraging news--nothing. May
+ the good Lord, who knows our frame and remembers we are dust, give
+ us a little now and again, at any rate, if only to keep us going
+ meantime! Eh, man! there will be no lack on His part. He'll shine
+ up all right, not only to perform, but to succour His servants who
+ trust in Him.'
+
+
+ 'July 28, 1890.
+
+ 'My dear Owen,--I know worry should be an unknown element in a
+ believer's experience. I am eager to have done with it. I thank Him
+ for much of its absence. But dissatisfaction with the present state
+ of things is not worry, but legitimate soul-longing, and the death
+ of that would be a bad thing.
+
+ 'I can hardly tell how I am; Since Dr. Smith came I have taken
+ little note of inward things or outward either. It is very pleasant
+ to have him here, and as the best sign of digestion is not to know
+ one has a stomach or a digestion, is the best sign of spiritual
+ health not to know one has a soul at all? I wonder is this so? His
+ presence has made a difference. Duty has kept me living quietly in
+ good lodgings, with only such work as I can easily do without any
+ over-rush, and the prospect of another month like it! I fear I am
+ not such company to him as he is to me.
+
+ 'We have had terrible rains; the rivers were not crossed for five
+ or six days, and, even after that, two men were swept away on two
+ separate days--four men, in all, from this one town alone.
+
+ 'I know you pray for us here. Eh, man! if the thing would move, if
+ the rain would come! "_As the eyes of servants_," etc. (Psalms
+ cxxiii., cxxvi.). I often read these Psalms together. And then I
+ think what would please me best as a master would be to see my
+ servant going ahead, energetically, and faithfully, and loyally
+ with his work, not moping about downcast. Then is not this what God
+ wants in us? So here goes cheerily and trustfully.'
+
+
+ 'August 10, 1890.
+
+ 'I cannot say God gives me all the victories I want, but He keeps
+ me in peace and faith, and that is not a little thing. My
+ devotional reading lately has taken the form of the Chinese Psalms,
+ and Schereschewsky's high Chinese notwithstanding (for which may he
+ be forgiven), they are very refreshing and strong. How like are the
+ heart-longings and soul-breathings of the old Judean hunted
+ outlaw--brigand, if you like to call him so--to the heart and soul
+ feelings of the educated Occidental of the nineteenth century! Poor
+ old Moses, another outlaw, what a battered old life he led, but
+ what a grand soul, and how wonderfully he outlived it all, and was
+ quite hale when called to die! How his people troubled him!--so
+ like the Chinese. Fancy Moses going up the mountain to die alone.
+ It is so nice to have a later glimpse of him in the New Testament
+ alongside of Elijah, who too was once under a cloud. God does not
+ keep up things. "As far as the east is from the west, so far hath
+ He removed our transgressions from us." Love to all.
+
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang, August 19, 1890.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I have just got here after a very hard journey of
+ four days. It is summer and the rains are on; the roads are very
+ bad.
+
+ 'Our first adventure was in a deep narrow gully going up a
+ mountain. We met a cart coming down. There was no room to pass and
+ no room to turn back. What were we to do? One of the carts had to
+ be pulled up the bank. Neither would go up. Both carters sat and
+ looked at each other. Our cart was heavy, the other cart was light.
+ After looking at each other awhile the other cart was pulled up and
+ our carter helped him down again after we had passed.
+
+ 'Our next adventure was in a river. The leading mule sank in a
+ quicksand. The carter, shoes and all, jumped into the water; in a
+ few seconds I had stripped all but a cinglet and pants, and was in
+ the river too. We got out after a little while.
+
+ 'Next day we stuck in a quagmire. We hitched the mules to the tail
+ of the cart, pulled it out, then dug a new road in the side of the
+ ravine and got past.
+
+ 'The third day we upset our cart in a very muddy place early in the
+ morning, and got caught in a thunder-shower in the afternoon. The
+ fourth day we stuck in a mud-hole half a mile from the end of our
+ journey, and when we got to our inn found our rooms in possession
+ of a crowd of people doing a wedding.
+
+ 'One thing made the journey very pleasant: it was this. Just as we
+ were starting, one of the Christians, a Chinese farmer, but a man
+ who is poor and dresses and eats very poorly, came and gave me two
+ tiao, about 3_s._ 2_d._, to give to God. I was so glad to see him
+ do it, and no doubt God was glad too. Then at the end of the
+ journey, when we were stuck in the mud-hole and could not get out,
+ up came one of the Christians, took off his stockings and shoes,
+ went into the mud and helped us out. The country was very beautiful
+ all the way--just at its best.'
+
+In a letter to another correspondent he depicts what is involved in
+Chinese travelling during the wet season:--
+
+ 'The last thing we had to do was to make a journey of eighty miles.
+ You would soon do that in England. Here, in August, it is no easy
+ matter. It is just the time when, on account of the rains, no one
+ should travel, and no one does travel who can help it. Carts would
+ not go. I had to find my way home from a cart inn the night before
+ we started along a newly rained-on muddy Chinese street in the
+ dark. Next day I had much brightness shed on the journey by one of
+ the Chinese Christians--a poor man with, oh, so poor a
+ coat--giving a donation to print Christian books. It amounted to
+ about $1.00 (one dollar) in all, but it meant a lot of self-denial
+ to him; and as I passed, a little later, the drought-parched
+ district where he lived, and looked at the poor fields, I wondered
+ where he got the money. I suppose God gave him the heart to give
+ it. Starting a journey with such a bit of light made it cheery.
+
+ 'We travelled at those eighty miles four days, and rested one
+ Sabbath, five days in all. Within three-quarters of a mile of the
+ end of our journey our cart stuck in a mud-hole. We had passed,
+ shortly before, the cottage of a Christian, and, after we had been
+ some half-hour or more in that hole, this Christian suddenly
+ appeared on the scene. He is a great fellow for being neat and
+ clean. In a few moments he was in the mud, ordering about the
+ carter, shouting at the mules, and lifting at the stern of the
+ cart. Even the mules felt there was some new factor added to the
+ problem. They made a new effort and out the cart came. Would you
+ credit it? A cart had been upset there some days before; it was
+ said they had lost some thirty shillings in silver. The natives,
+ hoping to find the money, literally dug up the highway and left a
+ pit there. We did not know this, thought it was an ordinary pool,
+ and drove straight into it. The Christian touch at the beginning of
+ the journey, and the little Christian adventure at the end, made
+ the journey and its remembrance quite pleasant.
+
+ 'I am now reading Moule's _Veni Creator_, which came a few days
+ ago. What helps me most just at present is the Psalms. I take a few
+ verses every morning (almost), and learn off the Chinese
+ translations of them. I never knew there was so much in the Psalms
+ before. I believe that even at the end of a long life, this
+ (discovery of more and more in God's Word) will hold true of all
+ the Bible, and then for the beyond there is the Inexhaustible
+ Himself--satisfaction for the present and plenty for the future.
+
+ 'The endless sorrows and sufferings of this people here come home
+ much to me. I see much of their bodily suffering, and in some
+ feeble measure bear their sorrows and carry their griefs without
+ being able to relieve them much. How dead and dark they are to
+ things spiritual!'
+
+Dr. Smith, who spent some weeks with Mr. Gilmour during this summer, has
+sent the following most interesting sketch of his daily life at this
+period. They were together for the most part at T· Ss[)u] Kou.
+
+ 'He always got up at daylight, folded up bedding, and then began
+ reading. About six a man arrived, selling hot millet and bean
+ porridge. He bought two bowls of this for early breakfast. He
+ continued reading Chinese, generally aloud; and when he came to a
+ difficult word he repeated it again and again, in order to impress
+ it upon his memory. About eight he had breakfast, consisting of
+ Chinese rolls and a cup of cocoa.
+
+ 'At nine he went to the street with his tent, Mr. Liu, the native
+ preacher, accompanying him. One of the inn-servants assisted the
+ latter in carrying tent and medicine boxes and in erecting same.
+ The tent was erected in a broad street at the back of our inn,
+ where a daily market was held. The medicine boxes were placed on a
+ little table, in front of which stood a wooden form and another at
+ the side. The patients were seated on these. Any difficult cases
+ were sent to the inn to be treated by me. On the table were also a
+ number of copies of various tracts and portions of Scripture. Mr.
+ Gilmour dispensed medicines, talked and preached as the opportunity
+ offered.
+
+ 'About one he returned to the inn, and had dinner, consisting of
+ meat, etc., which was bought at a Chinese cook-shop. About three
+ we generally took a walk to the country. We used to go out to look
+ at the various crops, and Mr. Gilmour would chat away to one and
+ another whom we met on the road. He was generally recognised, and
+ in the most friendly way. I have a very pleasant recollection of
+ these times; often our conversation would turn to home, to our boys
+ and friends. Sometimes he would tell me about his student friends,
+ while at other times he used to tell me of his deputation work at
+ home, and about the various people he had met there.
+
+ 'Often a gentleman would come up and ask, "Where are you going?" to
+ which Mr. Gilmour would reply, "We are cooling ourselves; we are
+ going nowhere." It was always a mystery to people what we could
+ possibly mean by taking walks to the country. One day two lads
+ followed us for some miles across some low hills, anxious to know
+ our business, and getting well laughed at by their friends, poor
+ fellows, on their return to the town.
+
+ 'One thing about Mr. Gilmour always impressed me deeply--his
+ wonderful knowledge of the little touches of Chinese politeness,
+ and his wonderful power of observation. He loved the
+ Chinese--looked upon them and treated them as brothers, and was a
+ man who lived much in prayer; and in this lay his great power as a
+ missionary.
+
+ 'When he met a Mongol he would exchange a few words of Mongol with
+ him, and it was wonderful to see the man's face light up as he
+ heard his own tongue. All the Mongols knew that he could speak
+ their language, and as one of the few who did.
+
+ 'As we returned to the town and were walking along the street, many
+ of the passers-by would bow; and here and there a shopkeeper would
+ give him a friendly bow. Sometimes he would buy a few peaches or
+ apples, and not unfrequently he would give a sweetmeat vendor two
+ cash for two sweets, handing one to me.
+
+ 'About half-past four we returned to the inn, and then, as a rule,
+ some people would be there waiting to see him. Mr. Sun, the
+ box-maker, used often to come to read the Scriptures with Mr.
+ Gilmour, and then they would discuss various points; Mr. Sun giving
+ his opinion, and then Mr. Gilmour putting him right. Sometimes an
+ outsider would drop in, and then, not unfrequently, Mr. Sun would
+ talk to him about the Gospel.
+
+ 'About six Mr. Gilmour had some cocoa and bread. At the time of the
+ lighting of the candles Mr. Gilmour had made it a rule for the
+ Christians to assemble for evening prayers, and, accordingly, they
+ all turned up then. A Chinese table was placed in the centre of Mr.
+ Gilmour's room, and three wooden forms were placed round the table
+ for the accommodation of the preacher and the Christians. Mr.
+ Gilmour and I used to sit on chairs at the vacant side of the
+ table. On the table stood two Chinese candlesticks, each surmounted
+ by a Chinese candle. A Chinese candle is made from the castor bean,
+ and is fixed to the candlestick by running the iron pin on the
+ latter into a hollow straw in the end of the candle. Then we also
+ had a Chinese oil lamp. The upper vessel is simply a little
+ earthenware saucer, containing a little oil, and in it lie some
+ threads of cotton (a cotton wick). This is made to project over the
+ edge of the saucer and is then lighted. The lower part of the lamp
+ is simply an earthenware receptacle, in which the oil for
+ replenishing the lamp is kept, and, while in use, the little lamp
+ is supported in it. This often used to remind me of the parable of
+ the virgins, and in reading that parable by the light of such a
+ lamp one is able to make it very realistic to Chinamen.
+
+ 'Our evening worship consisted in first singing a hymn, Mr. Gilmour
+ leading. Then Mr. Gilmour offered up a short prayer; after which we
+ read a chapter either in the Old or New Testament, reading verse
+ about. Each man had a copy of the Scriptures. Then Mr. Gilmour
+ gave a little address on the chapter; after which we had another
+ prayer--one of the Christians being asked this time. Then another
+ hymn and the benediction.
+
+ 'Usually one or more of the Christians would remain chatting with
+ Mr. Gilmour. As soon as they had gone we had a cup of cocoa
+ together. Then Mr. Gilmour and I used to have evening prayers
+ together. He used to read a chapter from a little book by Mr.
+ Moule, and then we both prayed.
+
+ 'After this we used to sit chatting together until bedtime, and so
+ ended a day.'
+
+In August 1890 Dr. Smith lost his wife, who as Miss Philip had become
+known and beloved by a large number of friends of the London Missionary
+Society, both in Great Britain and Australia. He had also become so ill
+that the ensuing weakness, together with the great shock of his wife's
+sudden loss, compelled him, early in 1891, to return to England on a
+visit. Before doing so he was able to take Mr. Parker, the young and
+active colleague appointed to assist Mr. Gilmour, out to Mongolia,
+reaching T· Ss[)u] Kou on December 5. Greatly encouraged by the arrival
+of his young helper, Mr. Gilmour was grievously disappointed by the
+enforced return of Dr. Smith, and the indefinite postponement of the
+hospital scheme that was so near to his heart, and upon which he always
+asserted, in his judgment, the ultimate success of the mission depended.
+But discipline of this kind only drove him back more entirely upon God.
+In a letter to Mr. Owen, dated December 29, 1890, he writes:--
+
+ About myself I have lots to be thankful for. I am mostly in the
+ light, sometimes very sweetly. Sometimes, though, it is cold and
+ dark; but I just hold on, and it is all right. Romans viii. I find
+ good reading in dull spiritual weather, and the Psalms too are
+ useful. When I feel I cannot make headway in devotion, I open at
+ the Psalms and push out in my canoe, and let myself be carried
+ along in the stream of devotion which flows through the whole book.
+ The current always sets towards God, and in most places is strong
+ and deep. These old men--eh, man! they beat us hollow, with all our
+ New Testament and all our devotional aids and manuals. And yet I
+ don't know. In the old time there were giants--one here and there.
+ Now there are many nameless but efficient men of only ordinary
+ stature.
+
+ 'Brother, let us be faithful. That is what God wants. What He
+ needs. What He can use. I was greatly struck by one saying of Mrs.
+ Booth's. It will not be so very different there (in heaven) to what
+ it is here. I guess she is right. I guess there will be differences
+ of occupation there as here, and I guess that our life here is a
+ training for life and work there. Oh the mystery! How thin a wall
+ divides it from us! How well the secret has been kept from of old
+ till now! May the richest blessings be on you and yours and your
+ work!
+
+ 'Yours affectionately,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+The year 1891 found Mr. Gilmour hard at work as usual, in good health
+and spirits, and with the hope and apparently the prospect of many years
+of service before him. And yet, just as the summer was beginning, he was
+called to the presence of the King, and to the perfect work and
+fellowship of 'the Church of the firstborn.' Had he been able to choose
+his fate he would hardly have wished it other than it was. His work in
+Mongolia was steadily growing; slowly, it is true, but yet gaining a
+strength and impetus that will abide, and has well begun the conquest of
+Mongolia for Christ. Though practically without a medical colleague, and
+actually without the hospital for which he had so toiled and prayed, he
+was cheered and strengthened by the constant presence and fellowship of
+Mr. Parker. His letters are all in a cheery and buoyant strain, and,
+although referring not unfrequently to the future life, without a hint
+or a suspicion that he was in any degree conscious of the rapid way in
+which the days of his earthly life were running out. In a letter to Mr.
+Thompson, dated January 7, he says, 'You will be glad to hear I am in
+good health and spirits.'
+
+
+To Mr. Owen he wrote on March 2:--
+
+ 'Does God not mean to have a medical man here? I wonder! Wondering,
+ I tell Him as I tell you, and try to leave it with Him, and in very
+ great part _do_ leave it to Him too. It is good to have His calm
+ mercy and help. How's your soul, brother? I'll tell you how mine
+ is--eager to experience more of the Almighty power inworking
+ inside. Eager to be more transformed. Less conformed to the world.
+ Eager to touch God more, and have Him touch me more, so that I can
+ feel His touch.
+
+ 'I am distressed at so few conversions here. But again sometimes
+ very fully satisfied in believing I am trying to do His will. That
+ makes me calm. I am scared at our property venture, but again trust
+ in God, and the fears subside. The world to come, too, sometimes
+ looms up clear as not far distant, and the light that shines from
+ that makes things seem different a good deal.'
+
+From other letters that remain we catch glimpses of the course of his
+action and thought during these last weeks. During the year 1869 he met
+in Edinburgh Mrs. Swan, the widow of one of the pioneers of the Mongol
+Mission of 1817 to 1841, and that interview gave the chief direction to
+the work of his life. In March 1891 he heard of Mrs. Swan's death, and
+he wrote to Miss Cullen, her niece, the following letter:--
+
+ 'I sent you a post-card acknowledging receipt of your kind letter
+ of December 10, saying that Mrs. Swan had passed away on November
+ 22. I had not heard, and just then I had not time to write. I am
+ now at the east end of my district, three days' journey from where
+ the mail reached me.
+
+ 'I am much moved to think that letter to me was her last. And there
+ is a fitness that it should be so. "Baptized for the dead," as the
+ phrase is. In some sense I am successor to her work, and it was not
+ out of keeping that her last letter should have been to the field
+ which all along had such a large place and keen interest in her
+ heart, where so many more good works found a place. I often think
+ of all the kindness and friendship I have experienced at her hands,
+ both on my visits to Edinburgh and through letters. Missionaries
+ miss such lives much when they are removed. I need not speak to
+ you, who knew her so well, of what a charming hostess she made, and
+ of how, even in her old age, all her great and abiding earnestness
+ had running through it all so much happy Scotch humour.
+
+ 'I had no idea Mrs. Swan was so old. Eighty-one, she did not look
+ old except about the last time I saw her, and then I had no idea
+ her age was so great. She has gone; but for many years to come, if
+ I am spared, I shall from time to time revisit her in her house in
+ Edinburgh, and see her at the table with the quiet Jane moving
+ noiselessly around, or see her seated at her desk in the corner,
+ writing letters. Remember me very kindly to your father--fit
+ brother for such a sister. Their separation cannot be very long at
+ the longest. For that matter of it, those of us who are here
+ longest must soon be gone, and when the going comes, or looms
+ before us, let us look not at the going, but at the being _there_.'
+
+Having paid considerable attention to the work and methods of the
+Salvation Army, the publication of _In Darkest England_ interested him
+greatly, and on March 9 he sent in a letter the following trenchant
+criticism, all the more noteworthy because of his strong sympathy with
+much in the Army that others find it hard to accept.
+
+ 'Got here Saturday. Had a good Sunday with the Christians. To-day
+ it snowed, and thus we have had time to put our house in order. I
+ have read Booth's scheme in the _Review of Reviews_. I am greatly
+ puzzled. It is _so_ far a departure from Booth's principle of doing
+ spiritual work only. It reads well, but Booth must know just as
+ well as I do that much of the theory will never work in practice.
+ What I dislike most in it is, it is in spiritual things doing
+ exactly what it attempts to do in secular things--namely, it
+ threatens to swallow up in a great holy syndicate no end of smaller
+ charities which have been and are working efficiently. Again, the
+ finally impenitent are to be cast off. Yes, that is just the rub.
+ It will leave the good-for-nothings, many of them cast out as
+ before. Nor will Booth's despotism do in the long run. But I am for
+ the scheme and for old Booth too; but, nevertheless, there is both
+ a limit and an end to all despotism and despotisms. But I am more
+ favourable to the scheme than these words would seem to indicate.'
+
+Mr. Parker, who bids fair to be a successor after Gilmour's own heart,
+in his first report of his experiences in Mongolia gave a bright and
+hopeful view of his colleague.
+
+ 'On arriving at T· Ss[)u] Kou we found Gilmour very well indeed;
+ looking better than he did when I saw him in England. He was
+ jubilant over our coming, and it has been a great source of
+ happiness to me to know that God's sending me here has up till now
+ given happiness and comfort to one of His faithful servants. I have
+ had a slight taste of being left alone, and I must confess Gilmour
+ has had something to endure during the last few years.
+
+ 'We are living in hired rooms of an inn. Gilmour is not in this
+ courtyard. I have been alone here with my Chinese boy for the last
+ five weeks (Dr. Smith being in Ch'ao Yang until a few days ago). I
+ have been unable to get a proper teacher at present. Gilmour's
+ student has been teaching me. He speaks distinctly. With him I have
+ made very fair progress. I hope in a few days to secure a proper
+ teacher.
+
+ 'Another thing which has taught me a good amount of the Chinese I
+ know is having to give orders to my Chinese boy in house-keeping
+ generally. I am thankful to God for past experiences in my life,
+ though they were rather rough; for here I find they come in very
+ usefully. I had to teach my boy how to cook and do things
+ generally. It was rather an amusing piece of work, seeing that I
+ knew nothing of the language. Each order I gave him was a comedy in
+ two or three acts, all played out in dumb show. In telling him what
+ I wished purchased I was obliged to imitate sounds which are
+ peculiar to certain beasts and birds, which when he understood, he
+ announced that fact by opening wide his eyes and emitting a loud
+ "Ah!" which was generally followed by the name of the thing
+ indicated bellowed forth at the top of his voice as if I were
+ deaf. Also he in turn, when he had anything to tell me, always
+ stood in the centre of the room and went through a whole
+ performance. On one occasion, when he wished to tell me that a
+ certain dog had stolen the day's meat, the performance was so
+ amusing that, when he had got through, I asked him what he was
+ trying to say, in order that I might once more see the fun.
+
+ 'Forgive me for taking up your time with such frivolous things. But
+ I have picked up much of the language in that way, although at the
+ cost of being grimed with soot and burning my fingers. All that is
+ now past, and the boy is very useful, and, although now a heathen,
+ I am hoping that by my influence he may be led to know the love of
+ Jesus Christ. I am very glad that I came straight out here. I am
+ sure I shall learn the language (of the _people_, perhaps _not_ of
+ the _books_) better than in the frontier cities. I am constantly
+ forced to try and speak. Every day I have some visitors here whom I
+ must try and entertain. I feel stupid at times with them, and
+ perhaps they think I am; but, nevertheless, each day's experience
+ is adding to my vocabulary. And when so learnt, I know that people
+ will understand me when I speak.
+
+ 'Gilmour is doing a valuable work. Every day he goes to the street
+ and sets out his table with his boxes of medicines and books. He
+ has three narrow benches, on one of which he sits, the other two
+ being for his patients. Of the latter he has any amount, coming
+ with all the ills to which humanity is heir. It is a busy street,
+ not of the best repute, for it is where all the traders in
+ second-hand clothes and dealers in marine stores spread out their
+ wares.
+
+ 'For some weeks I went out at a certain hour to take care of
+ Gilmour's stand while he went and got a "refresher" in the shape of
+ some indigestible pudding made of millet-flour with beans for
+ plums. He generally left me with a patient or two requiring some
+ lotion in the eye or some wound to dress. Then I, being a
+ new-comer and a typical "foreign devil" (being red of hair and in
+ complexion), always brought a large following down the street with
+ me, and attracted a great crowd round the stand. At first it was
+ not pleasant to sit there and be stared at without being able to
+ speak to them; but after a while I got very interested in the
+ different faces that came round. On one occasion I noticed the
+ crowd eagerly discussing something among themselves, giving me a
+ scrutinising look now and then. Now and again one would turn to his
+ fellow and rub his finger across his upper lip as if he was feeling
+ for his moustache. I had only been here a week or so then, and knew
+ very little of the language; but I listened attentively, and at
+ last I heard them speaking the Chinese numerals, and then it all
+ dawned upon me that they were inquiring about and discussing my
+ age; so I up with my fingers indicating the years of my pilgrimage.
+ I never saw a crowd so amused. "Ah, ah!" they said, and opened
+ their eyes, highly delighted that I was able to tell them what they
+ wanted to know. Then I had my turn, and, pointing to a man here and
+ there in the crowd, I used what little of Chinese I had in guessing
+ their ages.
+
+ 'But the sights of misery, suffering, and wretchedness which gather
+ round Gilmour's stand are simply appalling. His work seems to me to
+ come nearest to Christ's own way of blessing men. Healing them of
+ their wounds, giving comfort in sickness, and at the same time
+ telling them the gospel of Eternal Salvation through Jesus Christ.
+ One day that I went I found Gilmour tying a bandage on a poor
+ beggar's knee. The beggar was a boy about sixteen years of age,
+ entirely naked, with the exception of a piece of sacking for a loin
+ cloth. He had been creeping about, almost frozen with cold, and a
+ dog (who, no doubt, thought he was simply an animated bone) had
+ attacked him.
+
+ 'The people here are desperately poor, and the misery and
+ suffering one sees crawling through the streets every day is
+ heart-rending. I have not a doubt that I am in a real mission
+ field, and thank God that He has given me the opportunity to do
+ something towards alleviating some of this misery. But what about
+ the work as regards the saving of souls and establishing of a
+ Church? I can only speak of the work in T· Ss[)u] Kou. It is in its
+ initiatory stage. All the Christians and adherents can sit round
+ the four sides of my table. But I am highly pleased with them.'
+
+The letters of this period have a very tender and sacred association for
+all who received them, since they reached England after the telegraphic
+tidings of James Gilmour's death had brought sorrow to his many friends.
+They came, in a sense, like a message from one 'within the veil.' Some
+of these refer to the books he was reading, and from which he had
+derived benefit; some depict phases of his experience; some bear
+directly upon his work and its needs; all possess the solemn value and
+are read in the clearer light imparted to them by Death.
+
+The first was written to one of his brothers.
+
+ 'Do you know _In the Volume of the Book_, by Dr. Pentecost? It is A
+ 1. I have just read it. It is not a dear book. Read it, man, by all
+ means. It gives zest to the old Bible. I am reading through the New
+ Testament at about the rate of a gospel a day, or two epistles.
+ Rapid reading has advantages. Close study of minute portions has
+ other advantages. All sorts of reading are valuable. Go for your
+ Bible, brother. There is no end more in it than ever you or I have
+ yet seen. I am going for it both in Chinese and English, and it
+ pays as nothing else does. In Jesus is all _fulness_. Supply
+ yourself from Him. May the richest blessings be on you from Him!
+ Heaven's ahead, brother. Hurrah!'
+
+The next was to the Edinburgh correspondent from whose letters we have
+previously taken extracts.
+
+ 'This mail was sent off February 2. It came back the same day. The
+ man was scared by robbers. He leaves to-morrow. We are well. We are
+ _idle_. Would you believe it? It is Chinese New Year time, and I
+ cannot go on the street with my stand. No people: soon will be. We
+ are thankful for the rest. It won't last long.... Oh, it is good to
+ have Jesus to tell all to. May He be more of an intimate friend to
+ you and to me! The troubles of this earthly life are not few. How
+ many were Paul's! I am reading Farrar's _Life and Work of Paul_. It
+ puts much new light on the epistles. What a time the man Paul had
+ of it! Yet he called them "light afflictions." How much lighter are
+ ours! And the same heaven he looked to is for us--the same
+ crown--not to him only, but to all who love the appearing of
+ Christ. You love Him. Rejoice and be glad. I _am_ so glad that the
+ crown is not only for such as Paul, whom we cannot hope to imitate,
+ but for those (ii. Timothy iv. 8) who have loved His appearing. We
+ _do_ that, don't we? May the joy set before us enable us to endure,
+ when endurance is needed! May your heart rest in Him! May your soul
+ cling to Him! May His light always shine on your path! May I
+ always, even in dark days and dark times, have His light in my
+ heart and soul! Don't regard me as one always on the sunny heights,
+ but as one often cast down, often in much feebleness, in much
+ unworthiness, and falling so far short of my own ideal. But it is
+ good to think that, in Christ, we are perfect, that He makes up
+ all.
+
+ 'Parker and I read _Holy of Holies_, when together. It is a good
+ book. Meantime, he and I are three days' journey separate, and may
+ be so for a month to come yet. I hope he likes it. It is a little
+ hard on him, but I had to come here on mission business, and, if
+ needed, will return to him at any time. Looking again at Heb. vi.
+ 4-6.'
+
+His correspondent had asked him about this passage.
+
+ 'It is said--it is impossible to "renew them again to repentance."
+ Does it not seem clear that what is described cannot be the case of
+ one who has the repentant heart? I think so decidedly, and that
+ passage has no bearing on the sinner who repents.... No one will
+ come to harm who commits himself to His keeping. And no one will
+ lack leading who has God for his guide. If I could only hear of or
+ from the friends I pray for, that they had given themselves over to
+ God's keeping, I would be at rest and thankful. You are trusting in
+ Him. You will not be ashamed. He will take care to supply every
+ needed blessing at the right time and in the right way.
+
+ 'Some day, I believe we shall stand in Eternity and look back on
+ Time. How ashamed we then shall be of any want of trust and of any
+ unfaithfulness! May He help us to look at things now in _that_
+ light, and how to do as we then shall wish we had done!...
+
+ 'I would be glad if you would send me half a dozen copies of the
+ _Wordless Book_. Two copies fell into the hands of robbers and were
+ thus lost....
+
+ 'I shall be glad to have the _Life of Faith_. You might mark any
+ passages that strike you.'
+
+In a letter to the Rev. J. Paterson, dated April 1, he writes:--
+
+ 'It helps me much out here to get the best consecrated literature,
+ and to get it early. Men in the most difficult and dangerous fields
+ should be the best armed and equipped. Some of these books open up
+ new treasures to me in God's Word. I do not use them in place of
+ God's Word, but as openers to the treasures.'
+
+In almost the last letter from him received by his brother Alexander and
+dated April 24, 1891, the following passage occurs:--
+
+ '_The Practice of the Presence of God_, being conversations and
+ letters of Brother Lawrence. Please send a copy to yourself, John,
+ Matthew, Paterson, Miss Gowan, and ten copies to me, charging all
+ costs to me, of course. It is by a Roman Catholic: don't imitate
+ his Roman Catholicism, but his practice of the presence of God.'
+
+In April Mr. Gilmour journeyed to Tientsin, and was unanimously elected
+to preside over the annual meeting of the North China District Committee
+of the London Missionary Society as chairman. His last communication to
+the home Society, with the exception of one brief note upon a matter of
+committee business, was a post-card, dated April 20, 1891, received in
+London some weeks after the tidings of his death. It runs:--
+
+ 'Arrived here yesterday. The world keeps shrinking. Left T· Ss[)u]
+ Kou Monday 8 A.M. Tuesday noon dined in a border Mongol village, in
+ a Mongol's inn, served by a Mongol waiter, in presence of a number
+ of Mongols. Got to London Missionary Society's Compound, Tientsin,
+ Saturday, 5 P.M. Our headquarters are just five days from the
+ extended railway. Am in A 1 health, everybody says so here, and
+ that truly. Meantime am in clover, physically and spiritually. With
+ prayers for the home end of the London Missionary Society's work.
+
+ 'Yours truly,
+ 'J. GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Just thirty-one days later he was lying dead in the same compound. How
+the interval passed is told by those who enjoyed those closing days of
+lofty spiritual fellowship. Had it been foreseen that the end was so
+near, the fervour and impressiveness and help of his presence could
+hardly have been increased. Before, however, passing to the details of
+this last month, the following letters are given _in extenso_ as they
+form the last lengthy sketches of his work drawn by his own hand.
+
+
+ 'Tientsin, L.M.S.: April 20, 1891.
+
+ My dear Mrs. Lovett,--I guess you are at the bottom of 10_l._ from
+ Clapham Congregational Church Working Society (Ladies). Ar'n't you?
+ If so, thanks. If not--I was going to say you ought to be--but my
+ courage fails me. Anyhow, you can read and please forward the
+ enclosed with my best thanks to the friends. I got here two days
+ ago, and am here for a short time. The railway has gone out
+ eastwards, is still going, and has now a station near me in
+ Mongolia--near me being five long days' journey; but that is near,
+ as near and far go here.
+
+ 'I have many grateful and many prayerful remembrances of England
+ and English friends, and a vivid remembrance of your kindness when
+ I was with you. My regards to your parents. I hope you and your
+ husband and children are all well. I heard of Mr. Lovett being in
+ America--_American Pictures_ on the stocks?
+
+ 'I had intended to write you a nice letter, but it won't come, and
+ the letter must go as it is. Please read into the remaining blank
+ sheet all the feelings and good wishes I should express and do
+ feel, and next time I write you, may it not be in the ebb tide, at
+ the end of a mail.
+
+ 'Your husband's a Director. I _do_ hope they are sending me a
+ doctor. If he can do anything in the matter, I wish he would.
+
+ 'Yours, dried up and feeling dumb,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Enclosed in the above was the following letter, dated March 10, and
+addressed to 'The Clapham Congregational Church Ladies' Working
+Society.'
+
+ 'Dear Friends,--Many thanks for your handsome donation (10_l._),
+ notice of which has reached me last night. I am told you want to
+ hear from me. All right. I am just back from a month's raid into
+ Ch'ao Yang. Had a fine time. Good weather and plenty of work in the
+ marketplace. Baptized four adults, three being women--all Chinese.
+ It is the day of small things truly, but I am not a little
+ encouraged, over the women especially. That now makes four
+ Christian families in Ch'ao Yang or its immediate neighbourhood.
+ The two wives baptized this time have Christian husbands. It has
+ all along been our prayer that the unsaved relatives of the saved
+ might be saved.
+
+ 'Mrs. Chu's husband was baptized a couple of years ago. She
+ consented to his taking their two children to me to be baptized,
+ but she herself would have nothing to do with Christianity or
+ Christ. This time she got over her difficulties. I was much
+ pleased, especially as she had annoyed her husband a good deal last
+ year about his having been beaten about his Christianity. She also
+ had her little child baptized. Pray that God may keep and help them
+ in all the many complications that will arise on account of their
+ Christianity, living as they do in a composite family, the ruling
+ powers of which are heathen.
+
+ 'Mrs. Ning is a model wife. They are poor. Her husband cannot dress
+ in good clothes, but is always as neat as a virtuous wife, skilful
+ with her needle, can make him. She mends so neatly. I once
+ discarded a vest (Chinese) and gave it to her husband. He took it
+ home, and later on I saw him swelling about in it quite like a neat
+ old gentleman, though I was almost ashamed to give it him.
+
+ 'They have had family worship in their home for a year or two--they
+ say. We went to baptize her. It was such a small, poor house, but
+ so very nice inside. Mother and grown daughters and little girl,
+ with father and grown son, all sleep on a little brick platform,
+ hardly big enough for me--one man. She and the grown daughter
+ support the family by needlework--making horsehair women's head
+ fittings, which the father sells, when he has nothing more to do.
+
+ 'The son is epileptic and can earn nothing, and is, in addition, a
+ great eater. He is a good man and a Christian. As we entered, the
+ son and daughter went out. The mother and little daughter were
+ baptized. The father did not wish his big daughter baptized. When
+ she is married she will get a heathen mother-in-law, who will go
+ for her and make her worship idols. So said the father. In a few
+ days the father came back, saying that out of fear of the coming
+ mother-in-law he had not had his daughter baptized, but that his
+ daughter had pressed him so hard that she was as formidable as the
+ mother-in-law. The daughter says she'll stick to her God and let
+ them stick to theirs, and so she was baptized. She has a hot time
+ before her. Chinese mothers-in-law are no joke. Pray for the lassie
+ that:--(_a_) she may be steadfast; (_b_) she may be wise; (_c_) she
+ may be gentle in her resistance; (_d_) enabled by God to endure;
+ and that the mother-in-law may be restrained. God can do all
+ things.
+
+ 'Here, in T· Ss[)u] Kou, two of the Christians have wives very
+ much opposed to Christianity, and give their husbands hot times.
+ Remember the husbands, please, and all such in their shoes, in
+ prayer, and may the darkened women themselves be enlightened. You
+ have no notion how deeply sunk in superstition the women are. Still
+ another Christian has a wife whom he has to allow to worship a
+ weasel, because the woman shows symptoms of being possessed by the
+ beast if she does not worship it!
+
+ 'The other day a woman came to my stand in the market-place, saying
+ that "Mr. Yellow" troubled her. "Mr. Yellow" turned out to be the
+ weasel, and she firmly believed her sickness was due to the beast.
+
+ 'We are badly in want of a lady medical man in this district. Don't
+ you know of one who would do? Are there none of you who could study
+ medicine and go out as doctors to some of the many needy places?
+ Much was hoped for this district from the late Mrs. Smith, but God
+ took her. Any one who comes here should have good health, and not
+ fear seclusion from foreign company. I would suggest that a couple
+ should come, a medical and a non-medical. There is a house which
+ could be got for such a couple, only I don't see how they could get
+ on without knowing some Chinese. Perhaps some one of the Peking or
+ Tientsin ladies already speaking Chinese would volunteer to be a
+ medical lady's companion. Would that God would stir some of you up!
+ Meantime, thanks for the money. Thanks also for the prayers which I
+ take for granted you let us have. You might also pray for a woman
+ who has a very good, quiet, Christian husband, but herself has such
+ a temper that she cannot in decency take on a Christian profession.
+ Eh, man! eh, man! it is curious that I, a widower, should be left
+ to look after women's souls out here, when lots of women are
+ competing for men's situations and businesses at home. I guess
+ things will come right some day, though I may or may not see it.
+
+ 'Very gratefully,
+ 'Yours sincerely,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+On May 8 he sent the following note to Mrs. Williams, the wife of the
+Rev. Mark Williams of the American Board. Their Society happened to be
+holding its annual meeting at the same time in Tientsin as the London
+Society. Mr. Gilmour was just entering his fatal illness as he penned
+these lines, the last, we believe, that he wrote. They are a beautiful
+testimony to the strength of his affection for the Mongols to whom he
+and his wife had ministered so well long before, and on whose behalf
+they had suffered so much and so deeply. Standing as he was on the
+borderland of the heavenly country, he recalls the hard toil of his
+early days, and he leaves to those who must carry on to a successful
+issue, not only his work, but also the great enterprise of winning all
+China for Jesus Christ, this as a last legacy--the fruit of his prayer,
+his faith, his toil and his utter self-sacrifice--namely, the conviction
+that the need of China is 'good, honest, quiet, earnest, persistent work
+in old lines and ways.'
+
+
+ 'Tientsin: May 8, Friday.
+
+ 'My dear Mrs. Williams,--Thanks for returning the photos. Not
+ having delivered them to you personally, I feared that in the
+ present whirl of people and business they might have been mislaid,
+ or even not reached you.
+
+ 'It is a great pleasure to see you here at this time. Many memories
+ of past times and days come up. Though never again likely to see
+ Kalgan, I often in thought go along its narrow, hard streets, and
+ its up and down sideways, call in at your house, see all your
+ faces, even that of the youthful Stephen, and the studious Etta;
+ and often go up over the Pass into the grass land.
+
+ 'It is like a rest for a little while beside the palms and wells of
+ Elim to meet you all here.
+
+ 'Your peaceful, happy family fills me with gratitude to God. May He
+ bless them all (your children), and lead them not only into paths
+ of peace and pleasantness, but of useful service for Him! You and
+ your husband seem well. May many useful years of ripely experienced
+ labour be yours!
+
+ 'Lately, I am being more and more impressed with the idea that what
+ is wanted in China is not new "lightning" methods so much as good,
+ honest, quiet, earnest, persistent work in old lines and ways.
+
+ 'With many grateful memories of all old-time Kalgan kindness, and
+ hoping to see a note from you, or Mr. Williams, say once a year or
+ so, and with prayers for you and all Kalgan-wards Mongols,
+
+ 'Yours, cheered by the vision of you all,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+THE LAST DAYS
+
+
+At Tientsin James Gilmour was the guest of Dr. Roberts--for too brief a
+time his colleague in Mongolia--and the doctor's sister, who kept house
+for him. The story of the closing days cannot be better told than in
+their words. To Miss Roberts fell the sorrowful task of sending the news
+of their irreparable bereavement to the two motherless lads in England.
+
+
+ 'Tientsin: June 6, 1891.
+
+ 'My dear Willie and Jimmie,--You will wonder who I am that call you
+ by your names and yet have never known you.
+
+ 'But I think, when you hear that your dear father spent the last
+ five weeks of his life with my brother, Dr. Roberts, and myself,
+ perhaps you will not be sorry to get a few lines from an unknown
+ friend. It is now many weeks since we received a letter from Mr.
+ Gilmour saying he hoped to be able to attend the annual meetings in
+ Tientsin, and who would take him in? My brother replied at once,
+ saying what a real pleasure it would be if he would stay with us.
+ And so he came, and about a fortnight before the time, of which we
+ were all the more glad. He looked the very picture of health on his
+ arrival, and was in excellent spirits; many remarked how very well
+ and strong he looked.
+
+ 'I remember well the day he arrived, it was a Saturday afternoon.
+ I suggested that he should have some dinner at once, but,
+ thoughtful-like, as your father always was, he said, "No, thank
+ you, I have already had all I want; I shall not require anything
+ more till your next ordinary meal."
+
+ 'By-and-by we showed him his room, "whose windows opened to the
+ sun-rising." We had made it as pretty and comfortable as we could,
+ and brightened it with freshly cut flowers. The next day I noticed
+ he had taken the tablecloth off his writing-table, and in the
+ evening he handed it to me, saying, if I remember rightly, "Here,
+ mademoiselle, is your tablecloth. I am afraid of inking it. You had
+ better put it away." I was grieved, and begged he would use, and
+ ink it, too, for the matter of that; but it was no use, not on any
+ account would he spoil my cloth, and therefore would not use it.
+
+ 'He seemed very happy with us, and I think thoroughly appreciated
+ the homelikeness of his surroundings after his lonely life in
+ Mongolia, and the dismal rooms of a Chinese inn, and it was such a
+ pleasure to minister to his comforts in every possible way we could
+ think of.
+
+ 'He used to spend his days, as a rule, in the following way:--
+
+ 'After breakfast he would write letters. At 10.45, after a cup of
+ cocoa, he would go over to the hospital, returning at 1 o'clock to
+ dinner. This over, he would go back with my brother to see the
+ in-patients. At 4.30 we would all have tea together, after which he
+ would make calls, or go for a walk, or talk over committee matters
+ with Mr. Lees or Mr. Bryson. Many evenings he would be invited out,
+ or would be at a meeting, or would spend it quietly at home; and so
+ the time went by till meetings began. Then the whole day till 4
+ P.M. was spent in committee, and at six Mr. Gilmour had a
+ Bible-class for an hour with the Chinese preachers who had come to
+ attend some of the meetings.
+
+ 'These were nearly over when your father began to complain of
+ feeling done up and of having fever. The following Sunday he was in
+ bed. This was only eleven days before he died. On Monday, however,
+ he was better. and up, and was able to be with us all day, and took
+ the Communion with us all in the evening. Then we chatted together
+ for some time and sang hymns, amongst others, "God be with you till
+ we meet again!" No. 494 in Sankey's _Songs and Solos_.
+
+ 'In this connection let me tell you some of Mr. Gilmour's favourite
+ hymns in the book just mentioned. Amongst these were Nos. 494, 535,
+ 150, 328. I dare say you would like to learn them and sing them for
+ his sake.
+
+ 'Your dear father was only in bed ten days before the end came, and
+ all this time he spoke but little. He was too feverish and ill to
+ want to talk or to listen: he just lay quietly, bearing his
+ sickness with remarkable patience. One day, observing he was a
+ little restless, I went to his bedside and asked him if he wanted
+ anything. "No, nothing," was his reply, "only that the Lord would
+ deliver me out of this distress."
+
+ 'The last few days his mind was not clear, but all his wanderings
+ were about his work. It was the last day but one of his life; he
+ was more restless than usual, trying all the time to rouse himself,
+ as if for a journey, when he looked up and said, "Where are we
+ going?"
+
+ '"To heaven," I answered, "to see the Lord."
+
+ '"No," he replied, "that is not the address."
+
+ '"Yes it is, Mr. Gilmour," I said again. "We are going to heaven;
+ would you not like to go and see the Lord Jesus?"
+
+ 'Then he seemed to take in the meaning of my words, and reverently
+ bowed his head in assent, his lips quivered, and his eyes filled
+ with tears; and he was quieted, like a weary child who has lost his
+ way and finds on inquiry that only a few more steps and he will be
+ at rest and at home.
+
+ 'The next day, his last, was still more restless. At one time he
+ seemed to be addressing an audience and earnestly gesticulating
+ with his hands; and, with as much force as he could command, he
+ said: "We are not spending the time as we should; we ought to be
+ waiting on God in prayer for blessing on the work He has given us
+ to do. I would like to make a rattling speech--but I cannot--I am
+ very ill--and can only say these few words." And then he nodded his
+ head and waved his hand, as if in farewell to his listeners.
+
+ 'It was seven o'clock in the evening when my brother saw the end
+ was not far off, and at once we sent for all the other members of
+ the Mission that all might watch with him in this last solemn hour.
+ He was unconscious the whole time, and his breathing laboured.
+
+ 'The two doctors battled for an hour and a half to keep off Death's
+ fatal grasp, but to no purpose: the Lord wanted His faithful
+ worker, and we could not keep him, though we wanted him much, and
+ knew that Willie and Jimmie in England needed him more.
+
+ 'Gradually the breathing became quieter and quieter, till at last,
+ about 9.30, he just closed his eyes and "fell asleep," with the
+ peace of Heaven resting on his face.'
+
+In a letter sent by Dr. Roberts to Dr. Smith, who was then in England, a
+few further particulars are given.
+
+ 'He preached one Sunday evening a very solemn sermon on "Examine
+ yourself," and no one can soon forget the way he preached. During
+ the annual meetings he was extra busy. Everyone remarked what a
+ good chairman he made, and in the devotional meetings from 9 to
+ 9.30 A.M. he was always ready to lead in prayer or speak a few
+ words. Freshness, to the point, and to the heart--characterised all
+ he did or said. In the evenings he conducted services for the
+ native preachers present at the annual gathering, and to these
+ meetings he took one foreigner each night to assist in the
+ speaking.
+
+ 'It was at the close of this busy week, when tired out, that he got
+ the fever which eventually carried him home. The fever was very
+ irregular in type, but after some days I felt it was an exceptional
+ type of typhus fever. Great weakness of the heart was a
+ characteristic feature all through his case, and but for this sad
+ complication I believe he would have been alive to-day. Weak action
+ of the heart was an old enemy of his. For the first week of his
+ illness he did not feel very poorly, and we had many chats
+ together, and some prayer and reading of God's Word every night
+ nearly. But in the second week his temperature went up to 106∞,
+ and, though it came down under anti-pyretics, he seemed never to
+ regain his former ground. His mind became more and more clouded.
+ Parker took the night nursing, my sister the day, and I sat with
+ him when time allowed. On Thursday, May 21, the day on which he
+ died, he was very delirious all day, though he knew us all. I did
+ not give up hope till 7 P.M., when his heart failed him in spite of
+ active stimulation. It was then that we all gathered round his bed.
+ I did my utmost with the help of Frazer to avert the sad end; but
+ ere long, seeing our efforts were vain, we ceased, and sat in his
+ room and saw him gradually and very peacefully pass away, his
+ breath getting feebler and feebler till he closed his eyes and fell
+ asleep in Jesus.'
+
+The funeral took place towards evening on May 23, 1891. It was a lovely
+afternoon, and the sun shining brightly lent additional force to the
+words of John Bunyan which were printed upon the simple sheet containing
+the hymn to be sung at the grave: 'The pilgrim they laid in an upper
+chamber whose window opened towards the Sun-rising.' The coffin was
+borne to the grave by two relays of bearers; the first consisted of
+three European and three native preachers; the second, on the one side,
+of the Rev. S. E. Meech, his brother-in-law; the Rev. J. Parker, his
+colleague, and Dr. Roberts; and on the other Liu, his faithful Chinese
+preacher and helper, Chang, the tutor of the theological class at
+Tientsin, and Hsi, his courier, a native of T· Ss[)u] Kou. His last
+resting-place immediately adjoins that of his dearly loved friend, Dr.
+Mackenzie, and the service at the grave was conducted by the Rev.
+Jonathan Lees and the Rev. J. Parker. Chang offered prayer, and a
+farewell hymn was sung.
+
+ Sleep on, beloved, sleep, and take thy rest;
+ Lay down thy head upon thy Saviour's breast;
+ We love thee well; but Jesus loves thee best--
+ Good night! Good night! Good night!
+
+ Until the shadows from this earth are cast;
+ Until He gathers in His sheaves at last;
+ Until the twilight gloom be overpast--
+ Good night! Good night! Good night!
+
+ Until we meet again before His throne,
+ Clothed in the spotless robe He gives His own,
+ Until we know even as we are known--
+ Good night! Good night! Good night!
+
+Little Chinese boys who had known and loved Mr. Gilmour came forward and
+threw handfuls of flowers into his grave, loving hands laid upon the
+coffin a wreath of white blossoms on behalf of the now orphaned boys
+far away, and the simple but beautiful service was closed by a
+spontaneous act on the part of the Chinese converts present. Pressing
+near the grave of him whose heart loved China and the Chinese with a
+fervour and an enthusiasm that may have been equalled, but certainly
+have never been surpassed, they sang in their own tongue the hymn
+beginning, 'In the Christian's home in glory.'
+
+The labourer had entered into the rest he had so often seen by the eye
+of faith. 'There remains,' he wrote, less than a year before his death,
+'a rest. Somewhere ahead. Not very far at the longest. Perfect, quiet,
+full, without solitude, isolation, or inability to accomplish; when the
+days of our youth will be more than restored to us; where, should
+mysteries remain, there will be no torment in them. And the reunions
+there! Continuous too, with no feeling that the rest of to-day is
+to-morrow to be ended by a plunge again into a world seething with
+iniquity, and groaning with suffering.'
+
+Many pages might be filled with loving eulogies of James Gilmour. But
+the best of all is the simple story of his life. Yet two or three
+references to his work and influence must here find a place.
+
+From the pen of Dr. Reynolds comes this weighty testimony:--
+
+ 'The end of his career came all too suddenly, and in gathering
+ together my impressions of it as a whole, I am convinced that I
+ have seldom seen a man so entirely possessed by a grand idea, so
+ utterly persuaded that we had a debt to pay to the heathen world,
+ so invincibly sure that Christian faith and life was the one
+ supreme need of these regions beyond our circle of light. Few men
+ have cast the bread upon greater waters, have sown the seed over a
+ wider area, or had to mourn more sadly over those heart-breaking
+ months which intervene between the seedtime and the harvest.
+ Impartial critics have recognised the intense honesty, the shrewd
+ wit, the faculty of vision, the power to tell the story of his rare
+ experiences with such verisimilitude as to force upon the reader a
+ ready acquiescence in every detail of his narrative. But his
+ Christian brethren saw a deeper vein than this in Gilmour's
+ achievements. He was ablaze from first to last with a passionate
+ desire to set forth Christ in His majesty and mercy, in all His
+ power to heal and to command. I had unexpected opportunities of
+ finding how tender and affectionate his nature was; how grateful
+ and enthusiastic his love to his Hamilton home, to his father,
+ mother, and wife, and how faithful and loyal he was to the society
+ and the brotherhood of his Alma Mater.'
+
+The Rev. G. Owen, at a memorial service held in Peking very shortly
+after Mr. Gilmour's death, gave a sketch of his character and work, and
+thus summed up his life:--
+
+ 'He spared himself in nothing, but gave himself wholly to God. He
+ kept nothing back. All was laid upon the altar. I doubt if even St.
+ Paul endured more for Christ than did James Gilmour. I doubt, too,
+ if Christ ever received from human hands or human heart more
+ loving, devoted service.
+
+ 'If anyone asks, "Would it not have been better if Mr. Gilmour had
+ taken more care of himself and lived longer?" I would answer: "I
+ don't know. His life was beautiful, and I would not alter it if I
+ could. A few years of such service as he gave Christ are worth a
+ hundred years of humdrum toil. We need the inspiration of such a
+ life as his. Heaven, too, is the richer for such a man and such a
+ life. The pearly gates opened wide, I have no doubt, to receive
+ him. Angels and men gave him glad welcome, and what a smile would
+ light up the Saviour's face as He received His faithful servant
+ home!"
+
+ 'And he being dead yet speaketh. He says, "Be faithful, work hard,
+ for the night cometh when no man can work. Be earnest, for life is
+ brief; be ready, for life is uncertain." But why did God call him
+ away in the midst of life and work? I don't know. Possibly work
+ here is not of such importance as we think. Or there is more
+ important service elsewhere waiting for such men as Mr. Gilmour. He
+ has been faithful over a few things; he has been made ruler over
+ many things, and has entered into the joy of his Lord.'
+
+Mr. Parker wrote to the sons of his late colleague on June 6, 1891:--
+
+ 'It is sad that my first letter to you should be to tell you about
+ your father's death, of which no doubt you have heard long ago....
+ The last photographs of yourselves which you sent out he always had
+ where he could see them. Whenever he travelled he took them with
+ him. At Tientsin during his last illness he had them on a low side
+ table, just on a level with his bed, so that as he lay there he
+ could see them.... He was very happy, and died like a faithful
+ soldier who had finished his work. It is sad, dear boys, to lose a
+ father such as he was, but it is a great blessing to have had such
+ a father, one so brave, so courageous, one who for the sake of
+ Christ suffered bodily discomfort and pain, suffered terrible
+ loneliness that he might win some of God's sinning children back
+ to their Father's arms. He lived and suffered for the Mongols, and
+ though God denied him the honour of baptizing even one of them, yet
+ so faithful was he to his work that he toiled on to the very last.
+ "Faithful unto death" are words fully exemplified in your father's
+ life.'
+
+In his first letter from Mongolia after his prompt return to carry on in
+a like spirit of faith and devotion the work from which Mr. Gilmour had
+been summoned away Mr. Parker depicts the grief of the native Christians
+on learning their loss. 'The sorrow of the converts here (Ch'ao Yang) at
+the news of Gilmour's death was very touching Grown-up men burst into
+tears and sobbed like children when they were told he was dead. All
+along the route where Gilmour was such a familiar visitor, in the
+market-place, and at their fairs, the first question they asked as soon
+as they saw me was, "Has Mr. Gilmour come?" And at my reply there was
+always great astonishment, accompanied by expressions of sorrow. Every
+day at evening prayers I can hear Gilmour's name mingled with their
+petitions. The Christians here have sent a letter of sympathy to his two
+boys.
+
+ 'Here in Ch'ao Yang there are any amount of Mongols, not nomadic,
+ tent-loving, but settled here, and hence they do not have to be
+ sought. Right in the centre of the town is an immense Mongol temple
+ with two or three hundred priests. Every day I have several of the
+ priests in here, and yet I have heard again and again that this
+ mission is misplaced. Some such words often pained the heart that
+ is now still in death. But this is, and shall be, essentially a
+ Mongol mission in this, that as the best efforts of dear Gilmour
+ were for making Christ known to the Mongols, my best endeavours
+ shall be to this end. But if some hungry Chinaman, standing by as I
+ hold out the bread of life to his Mongol brother, seeks to eat of
+ it, he shall have it, and be as welcome as the other.'
+
+The letter to the children referred to in Mr. Parker's report is a
+fitting description of James Gilmour's life, and he himself would have
+desired no other panegyric. It came from the hearts of men on whose
+behalf he had given his very best, and it shows how strong a hold he had
+obtained upon their affection.
+
+ 'We respectfully enquire for the peace and happiness of your
+ excellencies, our brothers Gilmour, also for the peace of your
+ whole school. In the first place Pastor Gilmour in his preaching
+ and doctoring at Ch'ao Yang, north of the Pass, truly loved others
+ as himself, was considerate and humble, and had the likeness of
+ (our) Saviour Jesus. Not only the Christians thank him without end,
+ but even those outside the Church (the heathen) bless him without
+ limit. We, who through Pastor Gilmour have obtained the doctrine of
+ the second birth, and received the grace of Jesus, had hoped with
+ Mr. Gilmour to have assembled on the earth until our heads were
+ white and in the future life to have gone with him to heaven.
+ Little did we think we should have been so unhappy. He has already
+ gone to the Lord. We certainly know he is in the presence of the
+ Lord, not only praying for us, but also for you our brothers.
+
+ 'We pray you, when you see this letter, not to grieve beyond
+ measure. We hope that you will study with increased ardour, so as
+ to obtain the heavenly wisdom, like Solomon, and that afterwards
+ you may come to China, to this Ch'ao Yang, to preach the Gospel
+ widely. As the father did, may the sons follow, is our earnest
+ desire.
+
+ 'Signed by the Ch'ao Yang Christians,
+
+ 'LIU MAO LIN (preacher).
+ P'ANG TIEN K'UEI.
+ WANG SHENG.
+ NING FU TUNG.
+ CHANG WAN CH'UAN.
+ CHANG KUEI.
+ CHIANG SHENG.
+ WANG HUI HSIEN.
+ LIU I (your father's servant).
+ SUNG KANG.
+ CH'U WEN YUAN.
+ CHANG CHEN.
+ CHANG MAO CHI.
+ NING KUANG CHEN.
+ LIU CHO.
+ T'IEN TE CH'UN.
+ HU TE.'
+
+
+Here, then, we leave him. If the story of his life fail to touch the
+heart, to deepen faith, to exalt our estimate of renewed human nature,
+and to revive enthusiasm in work for Christ at home and abroad, the
+fault must be in him who has tried to tell it, and to set in order the
+facts.
+
+God's ways are ofttimes dark. James Gilmour had often felt this, and, to
+those who knew him, it seemed as though he were taken just when God's
+work needed him most, when the first-fruits of the coming harvest were
+being gathered, when his knowledge of the Chinese and the Mongols, and
+their knowledge of him and affection for him, were beginning to tell.
+But God knows best, and nothing can deprive the Church of Christ of the
+splendid self-sacrifice, of the noble perseverance in the path of duty
+of the bright example of courage, devotion, enthusiasm for souls, and
+patient continuance in well doing shining so clearly through all the
+long, years of toil. Love, self-crucifixion, Jesus Christ closely
+followed in adversity, in loneliness, in manifold perils, under almost
+every conceivable form of trial and hindrance and resistance both
+active and passive--these are the seeds James Gilmour has sown so richly
+on the hard Mongolian Plain, and over its Eastern mountains and valleys.
+'In due time we shall reap if we faint not.' His work goes on. He is now
+doing the Master's bidding in the higher service. There, we must fain
+believe, he is finding full scope for those altogether exceptional
+spiritual affinities, and powers and capacities which stand out so
+conspicuously all through the story of his inner life. Upon us who yet
+remain rests the responsibility of carrying forward the work he began,
+of reinforcing the workers, of bearing Mongolia upon our prayers until
+Buddhism shall fade away before the pure truth and the perfect love of
+Jesus Christ, and even the hard and unresponsive Mongols come to
+recognise the truths James Gilmour so long and so faithfully tried to
+teach them--that they need the Great Physician even more than they need
+the earthly doctor, and that He is more able and willing to heal the
+hurt of their souls than the earthly physician is to remove the disease
+of their bodies.
+
+Is not the real lesson of James Gilmour's life twofold? If it be looked
+at from the point of view of results, it should give clear and vivid
+ideas of the unwisdom of being cast down by the absence of results in
+face of the difficulties of missionary work in China. It is to be feared
+that there are still large numbers of good Christian people who believe
+that for the conversion of Chinamen and Mongols all that is requisite is
+to put into the hands of the heathen a copy of God's Word in their
+native tongue, and then preach to them the good tidings of salvation. No
+man in this, or in past generation, has done this more faithfully than
+James Gilmour. No man ever believed more firmly in the truth that it is
+'not by might nor by power,' but by the direct influence of the Holy
+Spirit, that the intellect and conscience and heart of the heathen are
+to be subdued to the Saviour. No man ever wrestled more eagerly and
+fervently in prayer on behalf of the ignorant and sinful, and yet his
+avowed converts can be numbered on the fingers. Does this prove that God
+is unfaithful? Does this tend to show that the enterprise is hopeless?
+Or has God been teaching us, by the life of one of His ablest and truest
+servants, the lesson of patient continuance in the path of His commands,
+whether He blesses or whether He withholds? Is He not proclaiming to His
+Church the need of a self-sacrifice _in all its members_ commensurate
+with that displayed by James Gilmour and others who like him have not
+counted their lives dear unto themselves in the struggle with
+heathenism? Some must go in the 'forlorn hope.' Some must lay down their
+lives in preparing the highway of our God. 'Herein is the saying true,
+One soweth and another reapeth.' But succeeding toilers in the Mongolian
+field, as the direct result of James Gilmour's sowing, will be able in
+days to come to apply to themselves our Lord's words, 'I sent you to
+reap that whereon ye have not laboured:--others have laboured, and ye
+are entered into their labour.'
+
+If the life of James Gilmour be looked at altogether apart from the
+results that can be entered in tables of statistics, how splendidly
+inspiring it is! Faithful to his Master, faithful to his work, although
+the Master _seemed_ to delay the blessing, although the work wore down
+the worker. 'I,' said St. Paul to the thankless Corinthian Church,
+'will most gladly spend and be spent for your souls. If I love you more
+abundantly, am I loved the less? But be it so.' And in the Epistle to
+the Romans he applied to the Jews who were resisting the Gospel the
+ancient words of Isaiah: 'But as to Israel He saith, All the day long
+did I spread out my hands unto a disobedient and gainsaying people. I
+say then, Did God cast off His people? God forbid.' Nor will God cast
+off the Israel of China, or the Mongols who gave to the faithful teacher
+respect, attention, and in a way the love of their hearts, but who as
+yet have not surrendered those hearts to their true Lord. James Gilmour,
+in season and out of season, in almost constant solitude, in
+superabounding physical labours that often overburdened him, and once
+nearly broke him down, in the long disappointment of the most cherished
+hopes, and under the constant strain of what would have crushed any but
+a giant in faith, lived a life which, if it taught no other lesson, was
+yet well worth living to teach this--that Jesus Christ can and does give
+His servants the victory over apparent non-success, after the most
+vehement and long-sustained effort to secure success, and that this is
+the greatest victory possible to renewed and sanctified human nature.
+
+
+ PRINTED BY
+ SPOTTISWOODE AND CO., NEW STREET SQUARE
+ LONDON
+
+
+ CHEAP EDITION.
+
+ Crown 8vo. 2s. 6d. cloth boards.
+
+
+ JAMES GILMOUR
+ OF MONGOLIA:
+
+ _HIS DIARIES, LETTERS, AND REPORTS._
+
+
+[Illustration: Sincerely yours James Gilmour]
+
+
+ EDITED AND ARRANGED BY
+ RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.
+
+ _Author of 'Norwegian Pictures,' 'The Printed English Bible,'
+ 'London Pictures,' &c._
+
+
+ PUBLISHED BY THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY,
+ 56 PATERNOSTER ROW, LONDON.
+
+ [P.T.O.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ Press Notices
+
+ OF
+
+ THE LIFE OF GILMOUR.
+
+'The story of James Gilmour will, if we mistake not, take a place of its
+own in modern missionary literature. To a world devoted so much to
+mercenary interests, and a Church too given to take things easily, the
+life is at once a rebuke and an appeal not easily to be
+forgotten.'--CHRISTIAN WORLD.
+
+'We are sure that this work will be read with the deepest interest by
+Churchmen as well as Nonconformists.'--RECORD.
+
+'A notable addition to the number of impressive and fascinating
+missionary books--a volume fit to stand on the same shelf with the
+biographies of Paton and Mackay.'--BRITISH WEEKLY.
+
+'James Gilmour may appear to some as a hero, to others as a deluded
+enthusiast, but no one who takes up this account of his life and work
+can fail to be fascinated by it.'--MANCHESTER GUARDIAN.
+
+'Out of sight the most interesting and valuable missionary biography of
+recent years.'--LITERARY WORLD.
+
+'Not only deeply interesting as a record of missionary labour, but teems
+with characteristic sketches of Chinese manners, customs, and
+scenery.'--TIMES (WEEKLY).
+
+'Unlike many missionary records, his letters and journals can be read.
+Indeed, it is difficult to stop reading, once you have begun.' NATIONAL
+OBSERVER.
+
+'For an age which, as the editor remarks, likes "large and quick
+returns" for its investments, the history of a man who had for many
+years to possess his soul in patience has a real and permanent value.'
+DAILY TELEGRAPH.
+
+'From every point of view the book deserves the highest praise.' GLASGOW
+HERALD.
+
+'Not the least interesting portion of the book will be its strange
+pictures of life amid Mongol surroundings.'--LIVERPOOL COURIER.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ By JAMES GILMOUR.
+
+ AMONG THE MONGOLS.
+
+ BY THE LATE
+ REV. JAMES GILMOUR, M.A.
+
+ With Engravings. 2s. 6d. cloth, gilt.
+
+'There has been, if our experience serves us at all, no book quite like
+this since "Robinson Crusoe"; and "Robinson Crusoe" is not better, does
+not tell a story more directly, or produce more instantaneous and final
+conviction. No one who begins this book will leave it till the narrative
+ends, or doubt for an instant, whether he knows Defoe or not, that he
+has been enchained by something separate and distinct in literature,
+something almost uncanny in the way it has gripped him, and made him see
+for ever a scene he never expected to see.'--THE SPECTATOR.
+
+'Mr. Gilmour tells a story well, and though he tells it quite simply and
+straightforwardly, he never misses the point of it. He writes, moreover,
+after having had exceptional chances of gaining a thorough acquaintance
+with the Mongolian character.'--THE GUARDIAN.
+
+'There is a charm in the quiet way in which the modest missionary tells
+of his life in Tartar tents, of the long rides across the grassy plain,
+and of the daily life of the nomads among whom he passed so many years.'
+FORTNIGHTLY REVIEW.
+
+'Mr. Gilmour's volume is one of the most charming books about a strange
+people that we have read for many a day.'--NATURE.
+
+'Mr. Gilmour has lived _tÍte-‡-tÍte_ with a Buddhist Lama under his own
+movable roof; he has shared the hospitality of the desert caravan; he
+has taken his turn in the night-watch against thieves; and he has dwelt
+as a lodger in their more permanent abodes of trellis-work and felt. As
+a picture of the raw material from which Chinese civilisation has been
+finally evolved--the primitive stage of Tartar nomad communities--these
+sketches possess a great sociological value; while from the point of
+view of the reader for amusement alone they are full of liveliness and
+local colouring.' PALL MALL GAZETTE.
+
+'Although it appears in unpretentious form, this is a really remarkable
+chronicle of travel and adventure.'--THE GLOBE.
+
+
+ By JAMES GILMOUR.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+
+ Crown 8vo. 5s. cloth.
+
+ MORE ABOUT THE MONGOLS.
+
+ Selected and Arranged from Mr. GILMOUR'S Diaries and Papers
+ By RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.,
+ _Author of 'James Gilmour of Mongolia' &c._
+
+'The style of the writer and the novelty of the theme, and the heart
+which so longs for "Mongols" showing itself on many a page, combine to
+make the work intensely interesting, instructive, and impressive.'--THE
+PRESBYTERIAN.
+
+'The experiences of a devoted missionary, whose gift of circumstantial
+narrative has not inaptly been likened to Defoe's.'--THE TIMES.
+
+'It is indeed a delightful volume, which will be welcomed by all who
+desire the extension of Christ's kingdom on earth.'--ENGLISH CHURCHMAN.
+
+'Extracts from the diaries of one of the most adventurous and
+self-denying of missionaries.'--SATURDAY REVIEW.
+
+'Will be welcomed wherever the name of James Gilmour is known.' THE
+RECORD.
+
+'A fascinating volume of travels, and a series of observations on men
+and manners which show the stuff of which our British missionaries are
+made.' METHODIST TIMES.
+
+'Will delight readers of all ages.'--CHRISTIAN WORLD.
+
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ Crown 8vo. 2s. 6d. cloth, gilt edges.
+
+ JAMES GILMOUR AND HIS BOYS.
+
+ By RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.
+
+ With Facsimile Letters and many Illustrations.
+
+'Ought to be in every Sunday School library.'--THE CHRISTIAN.
+
+'It is full of curious passages of adventure; and has a strong religious
+interest which will not fail to give young readers an intelligent
+appreciation of the nature of foreign mission work.'--SCOTSMAN.
+
+'It has been skilfully put together and will make an admirable
+gift-book.' BRITISH WEEKLY.
+
+'It should find a place in all Christian homes.' WESTERN MORNING NEWS.
+
+'It is one that all boys, and girls too, will delight to read.' SCOTTISH
+LEADER.
+
+'A fascinating volume from beginning to end.'--BAPTIST.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ PUBLISHED BY THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY,
+ 56 Paternoster Row, London; and Sold by all Booksellers.
+
+ _Spottiswoode & Co. Printers, New-street Square, London._
+
+
+
+
+*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA ***
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
+be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
+law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
+so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the
+United States without permission and without paying copyright
+royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
+of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
+concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
+and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following
+the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use
+of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for
+copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very
+easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation
+of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project
+Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away--you may
+do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected
+by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark
+license, especially commercial redistribution.
+
+START: FULL LICENSE
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
+Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
+www.gutenberg.org/license.
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
+destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
+possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
+Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
+by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
+person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
+1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
+agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
+Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
+of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
+works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
+States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
+United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
+claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
+displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
+all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
+that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
+free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
+works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
+Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
+comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
+same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
+you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
+in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
+check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
+agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
+distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
+other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
+representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
+country other than the United States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
+immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
+prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
+on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
+performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
+
+ This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
+ most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
+ restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
+ under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
+ eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
+ United States, you will have to check the laws of the country where
+ you are located before using this eBook.
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
+derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
+contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
+copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
+the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
+redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
+either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
+obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
+trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
+additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
+will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
+posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
+beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
+any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
+to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
+other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
+version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm website
+(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
+to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
+of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
+Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
+full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+provided that:
+
+* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
+ to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
+ agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
+ Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
+ within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
+ legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
+ payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
+ Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
+ Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
+ Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
+ copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
+ all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
+ works.
+
+* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
+ any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
+ receipt of the work.
+
+* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
+are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
+from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of
+the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the Foundation as set
+forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
+Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
+contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
+or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
+intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
+other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
+cannot be read by your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
+with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
+with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
+lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
+or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
+opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
+the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
+without further opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
+OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
+LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
+damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
+violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
+agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
+limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
+unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
+remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
+accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
+production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
+including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
+the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
+or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
+additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
+Defect you cause.
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
+computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
+exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
+from people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
+generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
+Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
+www.gutenberg.org
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
+U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's business office is located at 809 North 1500 West,
+Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up
+to date contact information can be found at the Foundation's website
+and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without
+widespread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
+DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
+state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
+donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
+freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
+distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
+volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
+the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
+necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
+edition.
+
+Most people start at our website which has the main PG search
+facility: www.gutenberg.org
+
+This website includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+
diff --git a/31525-0.zip b/31525-0.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5aefe99
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-0.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h.zip b/31525-h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bb8ac1e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h/31525-h.htm b/31525-h/31525-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7d90df1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/31525-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,11381 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
+"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
+<head>
+<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=utf-8" />
+<meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
+<title>The Project Gutenberg eBook of James Gilmour Of Mongolia, by Richard Lovett</title>
+
+<style type="text/css">
+
+body {
+ margin-left: 10%;
+ margin-right: 10%;
+}
+
+ h1,h2,h3,h4,h5,h6 {
+ text-align: center; /* all headings centered */
+ clear: both;
+}
+
+p {
+ margin-top: .75em;
+ text-align: justify;
+ margin-bottom: .75em;
+}
+
+hr {
+ width: 33%;
+ margin-top: 2em;
+ margin-bottom: 2em;
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+ clear: both;
+}
+
+table {
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+}
+
+.pagenum { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */
+ /* visibility: hidden; */
+ position: absolute;
+ left: 92%;
+ font-size: smaller;
+ text-align: right;
+} /* page numbers */
+
+.center {text-align: center;}
+
+.pto {text-align: right;}
+
+.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
+
+.u {text-decoration: underline;}
+
+.caption {font-weight: bold;}
+
+/* Images */
+.figcenter {
+ margin: auto;
+ text-align: center;
+}
+
+/* Footnotes */
+
+.footnote {margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-size: 0.9em;}
+
+.footnote .label {position: absolute; right: 84%; text-align: right;}
+
+.fnanchor {
+ vertical-align: super;
+ font-size: .8em;
+ text-decoration:
+ none;
+}
+
+.tranotes {border: solid 1px #8b4513;
+ font-size: smaller;
+ width: 65%;
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+ padding-left: 1em;
+ padding-right: 1em;
+ background: #fbf5e6;}
+
+ </style>
+ </head>
+<body>
+
+<div style='text-align:center; font-size:1.2em; font-weight:bold'>The Project Gutenberg eBook of James Gilmour of Mongolia, by James Gilmour</div>
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
+most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
+whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
+of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online
+at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you
+are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws of the
+country where you are located before using this eBook.
+</div>
+<div style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:1em; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Title: James Gilmour of Mongolia<br />
+  His diaries, letters, and reports</div>
+<div style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:1em; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Author: James Gilmour</div>
+<div style='display:block; margin-top:1em; margin-bottom:1em; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Editor: Richard Lovett</div>
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>Release Date: March 6, 2010 [eBook #31525]<br />
+[Most recently updated: October 24, 2021]</div>
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>Language: English</div>
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>Character set encoding: UTF-8</div>
+<div style='display:block; margin-left:2em; text-indent:-2em'>Produced by: Peter Vickers, the Bookworm and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team</div>
+<div style='margin-top:2em; margin-bottom:4em'>*** START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA ***</div>
+
+<div class="tranotes">
+<span class="smcap">Transcriber's Note:</span><br /><br />Minor spelling and typographical errors have been
+corrected without note. Some illustrations have been relocated for
+better flow. The character 'u' with a breve appears in many Chinese or Mongolian
+names and should display properly, even though it is transcribed as [)u] in
+the text version.<br /><br />
+
+</div>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 300px;"><a name="frontispiece" id="frontispiece">
+<img src="images/frontispiece.jpg" alt="Sincerely yours - James Gilmour" title="" /></a>
+</div>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<h1>JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA</h1>
+
+<p class="center"><i>HIS DIARIES LETTERS AND REPORTS</i><br /><br /></p>
+<p>&#160;</p>
+
+
+<p class="center">EDITED AND ARRANGED BY</p>
+<h2>RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.</h2>
+<p class="center">AUTHOR OF 'NORWEGIAN PICTURES' ETC</p>
+<p>&#160;</p>
+
+
+<p class="center"><i>WITH A PORTRAIT, TWO MAPS AND<br />
+FIVE ILLUSTRATIONS</i><br /><br /></p>
+<p>&#160;</p>
+
+<p class="center">THIRD AND CHEAPER EDITION</p>
+<p>&#160;</p>
+
+<h4>LONDON<br />
+THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY</h4>
+<p class="center">56 Paternoster Row, 65 St Paul's Churchyard<br />
+1895</p>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<table summary="Poem - O Christ, in thee my soul hath found">
+<tr>
+<td>
+<p>
+O Christ, in Thee my soul hath found,<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">And found in Thee alone,</span><br />
+The peace, the joy I sought so long,<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">The bliss till now unknown.</span><br />
+<br />
+I sighed for rest and happiness,<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">I yearned for them, not Thee;</span><br />
+But while I passed my Saviour by,<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">His love laid hold on me.</span><br />
+<br />
+Now none but Christ can satisfy,<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">None other name for me;</span><br />
+There's love, and life, and lasting joy,<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Lord Jesus, found in Thee.</span>
+</p>
+</td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<h2><a name="PREFACE" id="PREFACE"></a>PREFACE</h2>
+
+
+<p>This book in its more expensive forms has been before the
+public for nearly two years. It has been very widely read,
+and it has received extraordinary attention from many
+sections of the press. The author has received from all
+parts of the world most striking testimonies as to the way
+in which this record of James Gilmour's heroic self-sacrifice
+for the Lord Jesus and on behalf of his beloved Mongols
+for the Master's sake has touched the hearts of Christian
+workers. It has deepened their faith, strengthened their
+zeal, nerved them for whole-hearted consecration to the
+same Master, and cheered many a solitary and lonely
+heart.</p>
+
+<p>Many requests have been received for an edition at a
+price which will place the book within the reach of Sunday
+School teachers, of those Christian workers who have but
+little to spend upon books, and of the elder scholars in our
+schools. The Committee of the Religious Tract Society have
+gladly met this request at the earliest possible moment.</p>
+
+<p>In this new form their hope and prayer is that James
+Gilmour, being dead, may yet speak to many hearts, arousing
+them to diligent, and faithful, and self-denying service
+for Jesus Christ.</p>
+
+<p>The book, in this its newest form, is identical in all
+respects with the first and second editions, except that only
+one portrait is given and the appendices are left out.</p>
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+
+<h3>CONTENTS</h3>
+<table width="75%" summary="Contents">
+<tr>
+<td colspan="2"><span class="smcap">CHAPTER</span></td>
+<td align="right"><span class="smcap">PAGE</span></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>I.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">Early Years and Education</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_I">15</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>II.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">Beginning Work</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_II">46</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>III.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">Mongolian Apprenticeship</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_III">55</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>IV.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">The First Campaign in Mongolia</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_IV">88</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>V.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">Marriage</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_V">98</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>VI.</td>
+<td>'<span class="smcap">In Journeyings often, in Perils of Rivers</span>'</td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_VI">105</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>VII.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">The Visit to England in 1882</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_VII">134</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>VIII.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">Sunshine and Shadow</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_VIII">154</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>IX.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">A Change of Field</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_IX">176</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td valign="top">X.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">Personal Characteristics as Illustrated by<br /> Letters to Relatives and Friends</span></td>
+<td align="right" valign="bottom"><a href="#CHAPTER_X">228</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>XI.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">Closing Labours</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_XI">256</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>XII.</td>
+<td><span class="smcap">The Last Days</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_XII">298</a></td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h3>LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS</h3>
+<table width="75%" summary="Illustrations">
+<tr>
+<td><span class="smcap">Portrait of James Gilmour from a Photograph taken
+ at Tientsin on April 1891</span></td>
+<td valign="top" align="right"><a href="#frontispiece"><i>Frontispiece</i></a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td><span class="smcap">A Mongol Encampment</span> </td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#p109">109</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td><span class="smcap">A Mongol Camel Cart</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#p139">139</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td><span class="smcap">A Chinese Mule Litter</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#p156">156</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td><span class="smcap">James Gilmour Equipped for his Walking Expedition
+ in Mongolia in February 1884</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#p159">159</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td><span class="smcap">James Gilmour's Tent</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#p245">245</a></td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+
+
+<h3>MAPS</h3>
+<table width="75%" summary="Maps">
+<tr>
+<td>1. <span class="smcap">Map Illustrating James Gilmour's Journeys on the
+ Great Plain of Mongolia</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#Page_54">54</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>2. <span class="smcap">Map Illustrating James Gilmour's Labours in Eastern
+ Mongolia</span></td>
+<td align="right"><a href="#Page_178">178</a></td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+
+
+<blockquote><p>For readers of <i>James Gilmour of Mongolia</i> not familiar with <i>Among the
+Mongols</i>, a new Edition of that Work has been prepared and published,
+price Two Shillings and Sixpence.</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_15" id="Page_15">[Pg 15]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="James_Gilmour_of_Mongolia" id="James_Gilmour_of_Mongolia"></a><span class="smcap">James Gilmour of Mongolia</span></h2>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_I" id="CHAPTER_I"></a>CHAPTER I</h2>
+
+<h3>EARLY YEARS AND EDUCATION</h3>
+
+
+<p>James Gilmour, of Mongolia, the son of James Gilmour
+and Elizabeth Pettigrew his wife, was born at Cathkin on
+Monday, June 12, 1843. He was the third in a family
+of six sons, all but one of whom grew up to manhood.
+His father was in very comfortable circumstances, and
+consequently James Gilmour never had the struggle with
+poverty through which so many of his great countrymen
+have had to pass. Cathkin, an estate of half a dozen
+farms in the parish of Carmunnock, is only five miles from
+Glasgow, and was owned by Humphrey Ewing Maclae,
+a retired India merchant, who resided in the substantial
+mansion-house on the estate. There were also the houses
+of a few residents, and a smithy and wright's workshops,
+for the convenience of the surrounding district. James
+Gilmour's father was the occupant of the wright's shop, as
+his father had been before him.</p>
+
+<p>His brother John, one of three who have survived him,
+has furnished the following interesting sketch of the family
+life in which James Gilmour was trained, and to which he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_16" id="Page_16">[Pg 16]</a></span>
+owed so much of the charm and power which he manifested
+in later years:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>'Our grandfather, Matthew Gilmour, combined the
+trades of mason and wright, working himself at both as
+occasion required; and our father, James Gilmour, continued
+the combination in his time in a modified degree,
+gradually discarding the mason trade and developing the
+wright's. Grandmother (father's mother) was a woman
+of authority, skill, and practical usefulness among the little
+community in which she resided. In cases requiring
+medical treatment, she was always in request; and in
+order to obtain the lymph pure for the vaccination of
+children she would take it herself direct from the cow.
+She was also a neat and skilful needlewoman.</p>
+
+<p>'Matthew Gilmour and his wife were people of strict
+integrity and Christian living. They walked regularly
+every Sunday the five miles to the Congregational Church
+in Glasgow, though there were several places of worship
+within two miles of their residence. I have often heard
+the old residents of the steep and rough country road they
+used to take for a short cut when nearing home tell how
+impressed they have been by the sight of the worthy couple
+and their family wending their way along in the dark
+winter Sabbath evenings by the light of a hand-lantern.
+Our parents continued the connection with the same body
+of worshippers in Glasgow as long as they resided in Cathkin,
+being members of Dr. Ralph Wardlaw's church. It
+was under his earnest eloquence, and by his wise pastoral
+care, we were trained.</p>
+
+<p>'The distance of our home from the place of worship
+did not admit of our attending as children any other than<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_17" id="Page_17">[Pg 17]</a></span>
+the regular Sabbath services; but we were not neglected
+in this respect at home, so far as it lay in our parents' ability
+to help us. We regularly gathered around our mother's
+knee, reading the impressive little stories found in such
+illustrated booklets as the <i>Teacher's Offering</i>, the <i>Child's
+Companion</i>, the <i>Children's Missionary Record</i> (Church of
+Scotland), the <i>Tract Magazine</i>, and Watts' <i>Divine Songs
+for Children</i>. These readings were always accompanied
+with touching serious comments on them by mother,
+which tended very considerably to impress the lessons
+contained in them on our young hearts. I remember how
+she used to add: "Wouldn't it be fine if some of you, when
+you grow up, should be able to write such nice little stories
+as these for children, and do some good in the world in
+that way!" I have always had an idea that James' love of
+contributing short articles from China and Mongolia to the
+children's missionary magazines at home was due to these
+early impressions instilled into his mind by his mother.
+Father, too, on Sabbath evenings, generally placed the
+"big" Bible (Scott and Henry's) on the table, and read
+aloud the comments therein upon some portion of Scripture
+for our edification and entertainment. During the winter
+week-nights some part of the evening was often spent in
+reading aloud popular books then current, such as <i>Uncle
+Tom's Cabin</i>.</p>
+
+<p>'Family worship, morning and evening, was also a most
+regular and sacred observance in our house, and consisted
+of first, asking a blessing; second, singing twelve lines
+of a psalm or paraphrase, or a hymn from Wardlaw's
+Hymn-book; third, reading a chapter from the Old Testament
+in the mornings, and from the New in the evenings;<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_18" id="Page_18">[Pg 18]</a></span>
+and fourth, prayer. The chapters read were taken day by
+day in succession, and at the evening worship we read two
+verses each all round. This proved rather a trying ordeal
+for some of the apprentices, one or more of whom we
+usually had boarding with us, or to a new servant-girl, as
+their education in many cases had not been of too liberal
+a description. But they soon got more proficient, and if it
+led them to nothing higher, it was a good educational help.
+These devotional exercises were not common in the district
+in the mornings, and were apt to be broken in upon
+by callers at the wright's shop; but that was never entertained
+as an excuse for curtailing them. I suppose people
+in the district got to know of the custom, and avoided
+making their calls at a time when they would have to
+wait some little while for attention. Our parents, however,
+never allowed this practice or their religious inclinations to
+obtrude on their neighbours; all was done most unassumingly
+and humbly, as a matter of everyday course.</p>
+
+<p>'Our maternal grandfather, John Pettigrew by name,
+was a farmer and meal-miller on the estate of Cathkin,
+and was considered a man of sterling worth and integrity.
+Having had occasion to send his minister, the parson of
+Carmunnock parish, some bags of oatmeal from his mill,
+the minister suspected from some cause or other that he had
+got short weight or measure. The worthy miller was rather
+nettled at being thus impeached by his spiritual overseer,
+and that same night proceeded to the manse with the
+necessary articles required for determining the accuracy of
+the minister's suspicions. When this was done, it was found
+there remained something to the good, instead of a deficiency;
+this the miller swung over his shoulder in a bag<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_19" id="Page_19">[Pg 19]</a></span>
+and took back with him to the mill, as a lesson to the
+crestfallen divine to be more careful in future about challenging
+the integrity of his humble parishioner's transactions.</p>
+
+<p>'While James was quite a child the family removed
+to Glasgow, where our father entered into partnership
+with his brother Alexander as timber merchants. During
+this stay in Glasgow mother's health proved very unsatisfactory,
+and latterly both she and father having been
+prostrated and brought to death's door by a malignant
+fever, it was decided to relinquish the partnership and
+return to their former place in the country. James was
+five years old at that time. When he was between seven
+and eight he was sent with his older brothers to the new
+Subscription School in Bushyhill, Cambuslang, a distance
+of two miles. Here he remained till he was about twelve,
+when he and I were sent to Gorbals Youths' School in
+Greenside Street, Glasgow. We had thus five miles to go
+morning and evening, but we had season-tickets for the
+railway part of the distance, viz. between Rutherglen and
+Glasgow. Thomas Neil was master of this school. We
+were in the private room, rather a privileged place, compared
+with the rest of the school, seeing we received the
+personal attentions of Mr. Neil, and were almost free from
+corporal punishment, which was not by any means the
+case in the public rooms of the school&mdash;Mr. Neil being, I
+was going to say, a <i>terror to evildoers</i>, but he was in fact a
+terror to all kinds of doers, from the excitability of his
+temper and general sternness.</p>
+
+<p>'Here James usually kept the first or second place in
+the class, which was a large one; and if he happened to be
+turned to the bottom (an event which occurred pretty often<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_20" id="Page_20">[Pg 20]</a></span>
+to all the members of the class with Mr. Neil), he would
+determinedly endeavour to stifle a tearful little "cry," thus
+demonstrating the state of his feelings at being so abased.
+But he never remained long at the bottom; like a cork
+sunk in water, he would rise at the first opportunity to his
+natural level at the top of the class. It was because of his
+diligence and success in his classes while at this school, I
+suppose, more than from any definite idea of what career
+he might follow in the future, that after leaving he was
+allowed to prosecute his studies at the Glasgow High
+School, where he gained many prizes, and fully justified
+his parents' decision of allowing him to go on with his
+studies instead of taking him away to a trade. At home
+he prosecuted his studies very untiringly both during session
+and vacation.</p>
+
+<p>'After entering the classes of the Glasgow University
+he studied in an attic room, the window of which overlooked
+an extensive and beautiful stretch of the Vale of Clyde. I
+remember feeling compassion for him sometimes as he sat
+at this window, knowing what an act of self-denial it must
+have been to one so boisterous and full of fun as he was to
+see us, after our work was over of an evening, having a
+jolly game at rounders, or something of that sort, while he
+had to sit poring over his books.</p>
+
+<p>'James was not a serious, melancholy student; he was
+indeed the very opposite of that when his little intervals of
+recreation occurred. During the day he would be out about
+the workshop and saw-mill, giving each in turn a poking
+and joking at times very tormenting to the recipients.
+If we had any little infirmity or weakness, he was sure to
+enlarge upon it and make us try to amend it, assuming<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_21" id="Page_21">[Pg 21]</a></span>
+the <i>rôle</i> and aspect of a drill-sergeant for the time being.
+He used to have the mid-finger of the right hand extended
+in such a way that he could nip and slap you with it
+very painfully. He used this finger constantly to pound
+and drill his comrades, all being done of course in the height
+of glee, frolic, and good-humour. This finger, no doubt by
+the unlawful use to which he put it, at one time developed
+a painful tumour, to the delight of those who were in the
+habit of receiving punishment from it. James pulled a
+long face, and acknowledged that it was a punishment
+sent him for using the finger in so mischievous a manner.</p>
+
+<p>'There was a pond or dam in connection with the sawmill.
+In this James was wont to practise the art of
+swimming. I remember he devised a plan of increasing
+his power of stroke in the water. He made four oval pieces
+of wood rather larger than his hands and feet, tacking straps
+on one side, so that his hands and feet would slip tightly
+into them. But my recollection is that they were soon discarded
+as an unsuitable addition to his natural resources.
+He was fond of hunting after geological specimens, getting
+the local blacksmith to make him a pocket hammer to take
+with him on his rambles for that purpose. He seldom cared
+for company in these wanderings among the mountains,
+glens, and woods of his native place and country. He
+would start early in the morning, and accomplish feats of
+walking and climbing during the course of a day. Indeed,
+none of his brothers ever thought of asking James to go
+with them in their little holiday trips, knowing that anything
+not the conception of his own fancy was but very
+rarely acceptable to him; and he was never one who would
+pander to your gratification merely to please you.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_22" id="Page_22">[Pg 22]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'James was fond of boating. Once he hired a small
+skiff near the suspension-bridge at Glasgow Green, and proceeded
+with it up the river. Having gone a good way up,
+the idea appears to have taken him to endeavour to get the
+whole way to Hamilton, where, father having retired from
+business in 1866, our parents were now residing. This
+proved to be a very arduous task, as in a great many
+places on that part of the Clyde there is not depth of
+water to carry a boat. He managed, however, to accomplish
+the task by divesting himself of jacket, stockings,
+and shoes, and pulling the boat over all such shallow
+and rocky places (including the weir at Blantyre Mills,
+where the renowned African missionary and explorer, Dr.
+Livingstone, worked in his boyhood), until he reached the
+bridge on the river between Hamilton and Motherwell, a
+distance of eleven miles or more from Glasgow in a straight
+line, and much more following the numerous bends of the
+river. Here he made the boat secure and proceeded home,
+a distance of a mile, very tired and ravenously hungry. The
+great drawback to his satisfaction in this feat was his fear
+of the displeasure the boat-owner might feel at his not
+having returned the same night, and the rough usage to
+which he had subjected the boat in hauling it over the
+rocky places. He was much delighted, when he arrived
+with the boat down the river during the day, to find that
+the man was rather pleased than otherwise at his plucky
+exploit, telling him that he only remembered it being
+attempted once before.</p>
+
+<p>'During part of the time James attended college at
+Glasgow University, the classes were at so early an hour
+that he could not take advantage of the railway, and so had<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_23" id="Page_23">[Pg 23]</a></span>
+to walk in the whole way. This was an anxious time for
+his mother, who was ever most particular in seeing to the
+household duties herself, and always careful that her children
+should have a substantial breakfast when they went from
+home. I remember some of those winter mornings. Amidst
+the bustle of making and partaking of an early breakfast so
+as to be on the road in time, mother would press him to
+partake more liberally of something she had thoughtfully
+prepared for him; he would ejaculate: "Can't take it&mdash;no
+time!" and if she still insisted he would add in a solemn
+manner: "<i>Mother</i>, what if the door should be shut when I
+get there?" which, being understood by her as a scriptural
+quotation, was sufficient to quench her solicitations.</p>
+
+<p>'To avoid the worry of getting up so early, it was decided
+after a time that he should take advantage of an unlet
+three or four apartment house in a tenement which belonged
+to father in Cumberland Street, Glasgow. So a couple
+of chairs, table, bed, and some cooking-utensils were got
+together, and James entered into possession, cooking his
+own breakfast, and getting his other meals there or outside
+as his fancy or inclination prompted. Here I think he
+enjoyed himself very much. He had plenty of quiet time for
+study, and he could roam about the city and suburbs for
+experience, recreation, and instruction, visiting mills and
+other large manufacturing industries as he was inclined.</p>
+
+<p>'After our parents had removed to Hamilton, James took
+lodgings in George Street, a regular students' resort when
+the old college was in the High Street. It is now removed
+to the magnificent pile of buildings at Gilmorehill, in the
+western district of the city. The site of the old one in the
+High Street which James attended is now occupied by the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_24" id="Page_24">[Pg 24]</a></span>
+North British and Glasgow and South-Western Railway
+Companies.'</p>
+
+<p>James Gilmour left England to begin his Mongolian life-work
+in February 1870, and then commenced keeping a
+diary, from which we shall often quote, and which he carefully
+continued amid, oftentimes, circumstances of the
+greatest difficulty until his death. He gives the following
+reasons for this practice at the time when he was living in
+a Mongol tent learning the language, hundreds of miles
+away from his nearest fellow-worker:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I think it a special duty to my friends, specially my
+mother, to keep this diary, and to be particular in adding
+my state of mind in addition to my mere outward circumstances.
+In my present isolated position, which may be
+more isolated soon, any accident might happen at any
+moment, after which I could not send home a letter, and I
+think that by keeping my diary punctually and fully my
+friends might have the melancholy satisfaction of following
+me to the grave, as it were, through my writing.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In the record of his first outward voyage he included
+a sketch of his early life, which we briefly reproduce here,
+as the correlative and complement of the picture outlined
+by his brother:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'The earliest that I can remember of my life is the
+portion that was spent in Glasgow, before I came with my
+parents out to the country. Of this time I have only a
+vague recollection. Then followed a number of years not
+very eventful beyond the general lot of the years of childhood.
+One circumstance of these years often comes up
+to my mind. One Sabbath all were at church except the
+servant, Aggie Leitch, and myself. She took down an old
+copy of Bunyan's <i>Pilgrim's Progress</i>, with rude plates, and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_25" id="Page_25">[Pg 25]</a></span>
+by the help of the pictures was explaining the whole book
+to me. I had not heard any of it before, and was deeply
+interested. We had just got as far as the terrible doings
+of Giant Despair and the horrors of Doubting Castle, when
+all at once, without warning, there came a terrible knock
+at our front door. I really thought the giant was upon
+us. It was some wayfaring man asking the way or something,
+but the terror I felt has made an indelible impression
+on me.</p>
+
+<p>'When of the approved age I went to school, wondering
+whether I should ever be able to learn and do as others
+did. I was very nervous and much afraid, and wrought so
+hard and was so ably superintended by my mother that I
+made rapid progress, and was put from one class to another
+with delightful rapidity. I was dreadfully jealous of any
+one who was a good scholar like myself, and to have any
+one above me in class annoyed me to such a degree that I
+could not play cheerfully with him.</p>
+
+<p>'The date of my going to college was, I think, the
+November of the year 1862, so that my first session at
+Glasgow University was 1862-63. The classes I took
+were junior Latin and junior Greek. In Latin I got about
+the twelfth prize, and in Greek I think the third. The
+summer I spent partly in study, partly in helping my father
+in his trade of a wright and joiner.</p>
+
+<p>'During 1863 and 1864 I lived in Glasgow, and worked
+very hard, taking the first prize in middle Greek and a
+prize in senior Latin, as well as a prize for private work
+in Greek, and another for the same kind of work in Latin.
+This last I was specially proud of, as in it I beat the two
+best fellows in the Latin class. Next session (1864-65) I
+took a prize in senior Greek. I got nothing in the logic,
+but in moral philosophy in 1865 I was one of those who
+took an active part in the rebellion against Dr. Fleming,
+who, though he was entitled to the full retiring pension,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_26" id="Page_26">[Pg 26]</a></span>
+preferred to remain on as professor, taking the fees and
+appointing a student to do the work. We made a stand
+against this, and were able to bring him out to his work;
+but it was too much for him, and he died in harness, as he
+had wished.</p>
+
+<p>'In English literature I made no appearance in the
+pieces noted by the students, but came out second in the
+competitive examination, which of course astonished a
+good deal some of the noisy men who had answered so
+much in the class and yet knew so little. I was really
+proud of this prize, as I was sure it was honestly won, and
+as I also felt that from my position in class I failed to get
+credit for anything like what I knew. This session I went
+in for the classical and philosophy parts of the degree, and
+got them. I enjoyed a happy week after it was known
+that I had passed; and the next thing I had to look forward
+to was going to the Theological Hall of the Congregational
+Church of Scotland, which met in Edinburgh
+in the beginning of May. The session at Edinburgh I
+enjoyed very much. I had not too much work, and used
+at odd times to take long walks and go long excursions.
+I was often on the heights, and about Leith and Portobello.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The Rev. John Paterson of Airdrie, N.B., Gilmour's
+most intimate college friend at Glasgow, thus records his
+recollections of what he was in those days:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I first made James Gilmour's acquaintance in the
+winter session of 1864-5 at Glasgow University. He came
+to college with the reputation of being a good linguist.
+This reputation was soon confirmed by distinction in his
+classes, especially in Latin and Greek. Though his advantages
+had been superior to most of us, and his mental
+calibre was of a high order, he was always humble, utterly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_27" id="Page_27">[Pg 27]</a></span>
+devoid of pride or vanity. No doubt he was firm as a rock
+on any question of conviction, but he was tender in the
+extreme, and full of sympathy with the struggling. He
+was such a strong man all round that he could afford to
+give every one justice, and such a gentleman that he could
+not but be considerate. One day a country student through
+sheer nervousness missed a class question in the Junior
+Humanity, though the answer was on his tongue: the
+answering of such a question would have brought any man
+to the front, and with a sad heart he told his experience to
+Gilmour, whose look of sympathy is remembered to this
+day. He always seemed anxious to be useful, and he succeeded.
+During our second session, a brother of mine
+married a cousin of his, and this union led to a closer
+intimacy between us, and in future sessions we lodged
+together.</p>
+
+<p>'Throughout his college career Gilmour was a very
+hard-working student; his patience, perseverance, and
+powers of application were marvellous; and yet, as a rule,
+he was bright and cheerful, able in a twinkling to throw off
+the cares of work, and enter with zest into the topics of the
+day. He had a keen appreciation of the humorous side of
+things, and his merry laugh did one good. Altogether he
+was a delightful companion, and was held in universal
+esteem. One of Gilmour's leading thoughts was unquestionably
+the unspeakable value of time, and this intensified
+with years. There was not a shred of indolence in his
+nature; it may be truthfully said that he never wilfully
+lost an hour. Even when the college work was uncongenial,
+he never scamped it, but mastered the subject.
+He could not brook the idea of skimming a subject merely<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_28" id="Page_28">[Pg 28]</a></span>
+to pass an examination, and there were few men of his
+time with such wide and accurate knowledge.</p>
+
+<p>'Unlike many of his fellows, he did not relax his
+energies in summer. During the recess he might have
+been seen wending his way from the old home at Cathkin
+to the college library, and returning laden with books.
+His superior scholarship secured for him excellent certificates
+and many prizes, both for summer and winter work,
+and it was noticeable that he shone most in written examinations.
+On one occasion, in the Moral Philosophy class,
+which then suffered from the failing health of the professor,
+the teacher <i>pro tem.</i> appended, as a criticism of an
+essay of Gilmour's on Utilitarianism, the words, "Wants
+thoroughness." This was a problem to the diligent student,
+who tackled his critic at the end of the hour, and apparently
+had the best of the argument; for he told me afterwards
+that he had puzzled the judge to explain his own verdict.
+There was a strong vein of combativeness in him; he liked
+to try his strength, both mentally and physically, with
+others; and it was no child's play to wrestle with him in
+either sense, though he never harboured ill-feeling. He had
+the advantage of being in easy circumstances, but was
+severely economical, wasting nothing. He had quite a horror
+of intoxicating drinks. On one occasion, perhaps for reasons
+of hospitality, some beer had found its way into our room:
+he quietly lifted the window and poured the dangerous
+liquid on the street, saying, "Better on God's earth than in
+His image."</p>
+
+<p>'As the close of his career in Glasgow drew near, some
+of us could see that all through he had been preparing for
+some great work on which the whole ambition of his life<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_29" id="Page_29">[Pg 29]</a></span>
+was set. He always shrank from speaking about himself,
+and in those days was not in the habit of obtruding sacred
+things on his fellow-students. His views on personal dealing
+then were changing, and became very decided in after
+years. Earnest, honest, faithful to his convictions, as a
+student he endeavoured to influence others for good more
+by the silent eloquence of a holy life than by definite
+exhortations, and I feel sure his power over some of us was
+all the greater on that account. When it became known
+that Gilmour intended to be a foreign missionary, there
+was not a little surprise expressed, especially among rival
+fellow-students&mdash;men who had competed with him to
+their cost. The moral effect of such a distinguished scholar
+giving his life for Christ among the heathen was very
+great indeed. To me his resolve to go abroad, though it
+induced a painful separation, proved an unspeakable blessing.
+The reserve which had so long prevailed between
+us on sacred things began to give way, and much of our
+correspondence during his residence at Cheshunt College
+was of a religious turn, though still more theological than
+practical.</p>
+
+<p>'The last evening we spent together before he left for
+China can never be forgotten. We parted on Bothwell
+Bridge. We had walked from the village without speaking a
+word, burdened with the sorrow of separation. As we shook
+hands, he said with intense earnestness, "Paterson, let us
+keep close to Christ." He knew Him and loved Him much
+better than I did then; but about nine years ago, after
+hearing good news from me, he wrote to say that for
+twelve years he had prayed for me every day, and now
+praised God for the answer.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_30" id="Page_30">[Pg 30]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>In the diary from which we have already quoted Gilmour
+thus concludes the sketch of his education:&mdash;</p>
+
+
+<blockquote><p>'Near the close of the session of 1867 I opened negotiations
+with the London Missionary Society, the consequence
+of which was that I was removed to Cheshunt College in
+September of that same year. Here (1867-1868) a new
+experience awaited me&mdash;resident college life. At Glasgow
+we dined out, presented ourselves at classes only, and did
+with ourselves whatever we liked in the interval. At
+Cheshunt it was different. All the students live in the
+buildings of the college, which can accommodate forty.
+Of course I felt a little strange at first, and even long after
+had serious doubts as to the settlement of the question,
+Which is better, life in or out of college? The lectures, as
+a rule, were all in the forenoon.</p>
+
+<p>'The summer vacation I spent in studying for the Soper
+scholarship, value twenty pounds, which was to be bestowed
+after examination.</p>
+
+<p>'I commenced the 1868 and 1869 session at Cheshunt,
+very busily, and in addition to the class work and the Soper
+work, read some books which gave almost a new turn to my
+mind and my ideas of pastoral or missionary life. These
+books were James's <i>Earnest Ministry</i>, Baxter's <i>Reformed
+Pastor</i>, and some of Bunyan's works, which, through God's
+blessing, affected me very much for good.</p>
+
+<p>'The Soper examination should have come off before
+Christmas, but it did not, so that I remained over Christmas
+at Cheshunt, grinding away as hard as I could. I was
+longing eagerly for the time when the examination would
+be over, that I might the more earnestly devote myself to
+the work of preaching and evangelising. Well, the
+examination came and passed off satisfactorily, and I got
+the twenty pounds.</p>
+
+<p>'Now was the decisive point. Now had I come to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_31" id="Page_31">[Pg 31]</a></span>
+another period, when there was an opportunity of going on
+a new tack; but I found myself tempted to seek after
+another honour, the first prize in Cheshunt College. In my
+first session I had got the second only, and now I had an
+opportunity of trying for the first. It was a temptation
+indeed, but God triumphed. I looked back on my life,
+and saw how often I had been tempted on from one thing
+to another, after I had resolved that I would leave my time
+more free and at my disposal for God, but always was I
+tempted on. So now I made a stand, threw ambition to
+the winds, and set to reading my Bible in good earnest.
+I made it my chief study during the last three months of
+my residence at Cheshunt, and I look back upon that
+period of my stay there as the most profitable I had.</p>
+
+<p>'In September, 1869, I entered the missionary seminary
+at Highgate, and also studied Chinese in London with
+Professor Summers. I went home again at Christmas, and
+on returning to London learned that I could go to China as
+soon as I liked. I said I would go as soon as the necessary
+arrangements could be made, and February 22, 1870,
+was fixed upon as the date of my departure.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In this brief and rapid manner James Gilmour sketched,
+with not a few most characteristic touches, the first twenty-six
+years of his life. He enables us to see the quick, merry,
+receptive lad, developing, after a brilliant collegiate course
+and a careful training in theology and in practical Christian
+life, into the strong, resolute missionary. No one who
+knew him during this time failed to perceive the force of
+his character and the charm of his personality. The
+writer first came under his influence during his second
+session at Cheshunt. He was then in the prime of his early
+manhood, in the full possession of physical and intellectual<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_32" id="Page_32">[Pg 32]</a></span>
+vigour, and his soul was aflame with love to the Saviour
+and to the perishing heathen.</p>
+
+<p>He retained, moreover, the love of fun, the high spirits,
+the keen enjoyment of a good joke, and the constant readiness
+for an argument upon any subject under the sun,
+which had endeared him to his comrades in Glasgow.
+Every Cheshunt man of that day readily recalls, and rejoices
+as he does so, the memory of his good-natured practical
+joking, of his racy and pointed speeches upon all
+momentous 'house questions,' of his power as a reciter, and
+of his glowing personal piety. To know him even slightly
+was to respect him; and to enter at all into sympathy
+with him was to love him as long as life lasted.</p>
+
+<p>There are many reminiscences of those Cheshunt days,
+from which we can cull only a sufficient number to enable
+the reader to understand what manner of man he then was.
+These are drawn from the letters of his fellow-students,
+and from their recollections of his sayings and doings.
+'How well,' writes one, 'I remember his coming to Cheshunt!
+I was acting-senior at the opening of that session,
+and, according to custom with the new men, went to his
+room to shake hands with him. He said, "Who are you?"
+I told him. "What do you want?" I told him I had
+come according to custom to welcome him, and held out
+my hand, whereupon he put his hands behind him and
+said, "Time eno' to shake hands when we've quarrelled.
+But where do you live?" "Immediately over your head."
+"Then look here," said he, "don't make a row;" and so we
+parted. Dear old fellow! his memory makes life richer.'</p>
+
+<p>Another writes: 'He was a good elocutionist. He was
+also a keen debater, and so fond of argument that he would<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_33" id="Page_33">[Pg 33]</a></span>
+not hesitate to take opposite ground to his own cherished
+convictions and beliefs, simply for the sake of provoking
+discussion. So earnestly and logically (for he was a good
+dialectician) would he carry on the discussion that it was
+difficult to believe that he did not really hold the opinions
+for which he so pertinaciously contended. Sometimes
+this habit of mind reacted very amusingly upon himself, as
+the following will show. The subject fixed one Friday
+evening for debate in the discussion class was, "Have
+animals souls?" Though fully accepting the common
+belief that they have not, Gilmour, purely for the sake of
+argument, took the affirmative, and with such enthusiasm
+pleaded his cause that he brought himself to believe, as he
+told me afterwards, that animals have souls.'</p>
+
+<p>'At no time during his residence at Cheshunt could
+there have been any doubt as to Gilmour's piety or consecration
+to the great work of his future life; but during the
+second year it must have been manifest to all who knew
+him intimately that there was a deepening and broadening
+of his spiritual life. As I look back over the interval of
+years I can see that it was then he began to reach the
+high-water mark in Christian life and devotion which was
+so steadily maintained throughout his career in China and
+Mongolia. An apostolic passion for the salvation of his
+fellow-men took hold upon him. He would go out in the
+evening, mostly alone, and conduct short open-air services
+at Flamstead End, among the cottagers near Cheshunt
+railway station; seize opportunities of speaking to labourers
+working by the roadside or in the field through which
+he might be passing. He became very solicitous for the
+conversion of friends in Scotland, and would come to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_34" id="Page_34">[Pg 34]</a></span>
+my study and ask me to kneel and pray with him that
+God's grace might be manifested to them, and that His
+blessing might rest upon letters which he had written and
+was sending to them. The ordinary style of preaching
+towards which students usually aspire lost its attractions
+for him, and his sermons assumed more and more the
+character of earnest exhortations, and addresses to the
+unconverted. When he knew what was to be his field of
+labour after his college course was over, how solicitous he
+was to go out fully prepared and fitted in spiritual equipment!
+The needs of the perishing heathen were very real
+and weighed heavily upon his heart, and he was very
+anxious to win volunteers among his college friends for this
+all-important work. How he longed and prayed for China's
+perishing millions only his most intimate friends know.'</p>
+
+<p>The Rev. H. R. Reynolds, D.D., for the past thirty years
+the honoured President of Cheshunt College, has recalled
+some of his early recollections of James Gilmour.</p>
+
+<p>'Though brusque and outspoken in manner, he was in
+many respects reserved and shy, and very slow to show or
+accept confidence. We all felt, however, that underneath
+a canny demeanour there was burning a very intense
+enthusiasm, and that a character of marked features was
+already formed, and would only develop along certain
+lines, settled, but not as yet fully disclosed to others.</p>
+
+<p>There was not a particle of make-believe in his composition.
+He shrank from praise, and was obviously
+anxious not to appear more reverential or wise or devoted
+than he knew himself to be. He even used, because it was
+natural to him, a rugged style of expression when speaking
+of things or persons or institutions which for the most part<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_35" id="Page_35">[Pg 35]</a></span>
+uplift our diction and generally induce us to adorn or make
+careful selection of our vocabulary. He rapped out expressions
+which might have suggested carelessness or irreverence
+or suppressed doubt, but I soon found that there was
+an intense fire of evangelistic zeal and an almost stormy
+enthusiasm for the conversion of souls to Christ.</p>
+
+<p>'Some special services were held at Cheshunt Street
+Chapel, in which Gilmour took part, and the part was at
+least as demonstrative, perhaps more so, except the music,
+as that of the modern Salvation Army ensign or commissioner.
+He started from the chapel entrance, on the
+Sunday evening, when considerable numbers were as usual
+parading the country street, and bare-headed approached
+every passer-by with some piquant, vigorous inquiry, or
+message or warning. In the main, his bold summons was,
+"Do you believe on the Lord Jesus Christ?" The entire
+population in the thoroughfare was stirred, and uncomplimentary
+jeers mingled with some awe-struck impressions
+that were then produced.</p>
+
+<p>'During the year 1869 he had those interviews with the
+late Mrs. Swan, of Edinburgh, which led to his choice by
+the London Missionary Society, at her instance, to reopen
+the long-suspended mission in Mongolia. For a while he
+remained in Peking preparing himself by familiarity with
+the people, their ideas, their language, and religion, for
+those almost historic bursts into the great desert and across
+the caravan routes to the huge fairs, and the renowned
+temples, to the living lamas and famous shrines of the
+nomadic Mongols, incessantly acting the part of travelling
+Hakim, itinerant book vendor, and fiery preacher of the
+Gospel of Christ.'<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_36" id="Page_36">[Pg 36]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>In the year 1869 the policy of the London Missionary
+Society in the education of its students was very different
+from that which now obtains. After a course at a theological
+college of two, three, or four years, according to the
+literary attainments of the man at the time of his acceptance
+by the Directors, he was sent to the institution at Highgate
+designed to give training suitable for the special requirements
+of the embryo missionaries. In theory this institution
+was admirable; in practice Gilmour and others, much
+as they esteemed the principal, the Rev. J. Wardlaw, found
+it&mdash;or thought they found it&mdash;very largely a waste of time.
+The year 1869 saw the beginning of an investigation
+which ended in closing the missionary college at Highgate,
+and in the steps that led to the enquiry Gilmour took a
+leading part. One of his contemporaries at Highgate has
+thus described his influence upon both his fellow-students
+and the institution to which they belonged.</p>
+
+<p>'I first met Gilmour at Farquhar House, Highgate, the
+London Missionary Society's Institution, where in those
+days missionary students spent their last six months before
+going to the field. Some spent the time in studying the
+elements of the language of the land to which they were
+going; others attended University College Hospital, for the
+purpose of getting a little medical knowledge; while all tried
+to make themselves acquainted with the history of the people
+among whom they were to labour. Courses of special
+missionary lectures, which were highly valued by the men,
+were delivered by the Rev. J., afterwards Dr., Wardlaw.</p>
+
+<p>'Some of us were at Highgate a day or two before
+Gilmour came up from Scotland; and as his fame, or
+rather reports about him, had reached us from Cheshunt<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_37" id="Page_37">[Pg 37]</a></span>
+College, we were all very anxious to meet with him.
+When he did arrive we were, I think, all more or less disappointed,
+and yet I doubt if any of us could have told why,
+except that he was not the man we had pictured from the
+reports we had heard. When he walked quietly into the
+library I, for one, could hardly believe that the almost boyish-looking,
+open-faced, bright-eyed young man was really
+Gilmour. His dress made him appear even more youthful
+than he was, while there was an aspect of good humour about
+his face and a glance of his eye revealing any amount of fun
+and frolic. A great writer has said: "Nature has written a
+letter of credit on some men's faces, which is honoured almost
+wherever presented." James Gilmour's was a face on which
+Nature had written no ordinary letter of credit; for there
+was a sense in which one might very truly have said that
+his "face was his fortune." Honesty, good nature, and true
+manliness were so stamped upon every feature and line of
+it, that you had only to see him to feel that he was one of
+God's noblest works, and to be drawn to the man as by a
+magnetic influence.</p>
+
+<p>'Gilmour was a puzzle to most of our fellow-students,
+and they could not quite make him out. By some he was:
+regarded as very eccentric, which is another way of saying
+that he preserved a very marked individuality, and always
+had the courage of his convictions. They did not seem
+to understand how so much playfulness and piety, fervour
+and frolicsomeness could dwell in the same person. Long
+before we parted, however, in January, 1870, I feel certain
+that all had come to have not only a profound respect, but
+also a real heart-love for "dear old Gillie"!</p>
+
+<p>'The night before Gilmour left Highgate for the Christmas<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_38" id="Page_38">[Pg 38]</a></span>
+vacation we were all in his study, when someone, remarking
+on the risk he was running in going home to Scotland
+by sea, instead of by train, said in a jocular way: "Suppose
+the steamer is wrecked and you get drowned, to whom do
+you leave your books, Gilmour?" "Yes," he said at once,
+"that is well thought of. Come along, you fellows, and
+pick out the books you would like to keep in memory of
+me, if I never return." Of course we only laughed and
+said it was all a joke; but he said, "It is no joke with me,
+I mean what I say;" and so he did. He was in dead earnest,
+and nothing would satisfy him but that each should pick
+out the book or books he would like to have if he never
+returned. He then turned to me and said: "Now, I
+leave the rest to your care, and if I never return I want
+all on this shelf sent to my father and mother, and you
+can do anything you like with the rest." Had anyone else
+acted in that way, we should have certainly suspected that
+he had gone "<i>queer</i>"; but it was Gilmour, and we all
+understood the straight, matter-of-fact way in which he
+went about everything he did.</p>
+
+<p>'Through a misunderstanding, as we afterwards discovered,
+the students at Highgate came into collision with
+the Directors of the Society over the studies to be prosecuted.
+Additional classes were arranged, and these some
+of us declined to attend. This act of rebellion, as it was
+regarded at the Mission House, had to be put down with
+a firm hand, and a special meeting of the Board of
+Directors was called to deal with us.</p>
+
+<p>'The night before we were to meet the Board we met
+in Gilmour's study, to settle what we were to say to the
+Directors when we met them. One only of our number,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_39" id="Page_39">[Pg 39]</a></span>
+when he saw that there was likely to be a rather serious
+interchange of ideas between us and the Directors, caved
+in completely, and would have nothing further to do with
+our resistance.</p>
+
+<p>'When we met the Board Gilmour made his defence in
+his frank, straightforward way, and, I am afraid, upset some
+of the Directors very much by his plain speaking. They
+did not know the man, and regarded him as one of the
+ringleaders in rebellion, and, of course, were not in the
+humour to do him justice. But when we met the subcommittee
+appointed to deal with us the misunderstanding
+came to an end, and they admitted that we had been in the
+right in objecting to the extra classes thus imposed.'</p>
+
+<p>During these last months in England James Gilmour
+paid much earnest heed to the culture of his soul. Just
+before he sailed for China, he set forth his inner experience
+and his keen sense of the difficulties of the course upon
+which he was embarking in the following letter to a Cheshunt
+friend:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Companions I can scarcely hope to meet, and the feeling
+of being <i>alone</i> comes over me till I think of Christ and
+His blessed promise, "Lo, I am with you alway, even to the
+end of the world." No one who does not go away, leaving all
+and going alone, can feel the force of this promise; and
+when I begin to feel my heart threatening to go down, I
+betake myself to this companionship, and, thank God, I
+have felt the blessedness of this promise rushing over me
+repeatedly when I knelt down and spoke to Jesus as a
+present companion, from whom I am sure to find sympathy.
+I have felt a tingle of delight thrilling over me as I felt His
+presence, and thought that wherever I may go He is still
+with me. I have once or twice lately felt a melting sweetness<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_40" id="Page_40">[Pg 40]</a></span>
+in the name of Jesus as I spoke to Him and told Him
+my trouble. Yes, and the trouble went away, and I arose
+all right. Is it not blessed of Christ to care so much for us
+poor feeble men, so sinful and so careless about honouring
+Him? the moment we come to Him He is ready with His
+consolations for us!</p>
+
+<p>'I have been thinking lately over some of the inducements
+we have to live for Christ, and to confess Him
+and preach Him before men, not conferring with flesh and
+blood. Why should we be trammelled by the opinions
+and customs of men? Why should we care what men say
+of us? Salvation and damnation are <i>realities</i>, Christ is a
+reality, <i>Eternity</i> is a reality, and we shall soon be there in
+reality, and time shall soon be finished; and from our stand
+in eternity we shall look back on what we did in time, and
+what shall we think of it? Shall we be able to understand
+why we were afraid to speak to this man or that woman
+about salvation? Shall we be able to understand how we
+were ashamed to do what we knew was a Christian duty
+before one whom we knew to be a mocker at religion?
+Our cowardice shall seem small to us then. Let us now
+measure our actions by the standard of that scene, let us
+now look upon the things of time in the light of eternity,
+and we shall see them better as they are, and live more as
+we shall wish then we had done. It is not too late. We
+can secure yet what remains of our life. The present still
+is ours. Let us use it. It may be that we can't be great,
+let us be good; if we can't shine as great lights, let us
+make our light shine as God has made it to shine. Let us
+live lives as in the presence of Christ, anxious for His
+approval, and glad to take the condemnation of the world,
+and of Christ's professed servants even, if we get the commendation
+of angels and our Master. The "well done!" is
+to the faithful servant&mdash;to the <i>faithful</i>, not the great. Let<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_41" id="Page_41">[Pg 41]</a></span>
+us watch and pray that we may be faithful. It is a little
+hard to be this, and to care little for man.</p>
+
+<p>'Yesterday afternoon I preached here at home, and took
+the most earnest sermon I had, "<i>Behold, I stand at the door
+and knock</i>." Well, in doing so, I thought I was acting quite
+independently of man; and even after I had preached it,
+thought I would not care for man. But one man praised it,
+and I felt pleased, and, as might then be expected, felt a little
+hurt when a friend called this morning and told me that
+what I gave them yesterday was <i>no sermon at all</i>. Now, if
+I had been regarding Christ alone, I would not have been
+moved by either the one or the other of these criticisms;
+and I wish that I could get above this sort of thing, and
+get beyond the attempt at pleasing men at all. Why
+should we confer with men?'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>James Gilmour was ordained as a missionary to Mongolia
+in Augustine Chapel, Edinburgh, on February 10,
+1870, and, in accordance with Nonconformist custom, he
+made a statement about the development of his religious
+life from which we take the following extract:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'My conversion took place after I had begun to attend
+the Arts course in the University of Glasgow. I had gone
+to college with no definite aim as to preparing for a profession;
+an opportunity was offered me of attending classes,
+and I embraced it gladly, confident that whatever training
+or knowledge I might there acquire would prove serviceable
+to me afterwards in some way or other.</p>
+
+<p>'After I became satisfied that I had found the "way of
+life," I decided to tell others of that way, and felt that I lay
+under responsibility to do what I could to extend Christ's
+kingdom. Among other plans of usefulness that suggested
+themselves to me was that of entering the ministry. But,
+in my opinion, there were two things that everyone who<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_42" id="Page_42">[Pg 42]</a></span>
+sought the office of the ministry should have, viz., an
+experimental knowledge of the truth which it is the work
+of the minister to preach, and a good education to help
+him to do it; the former I believed I had, the latter I hoped
+to obtain. So I quietly pursued the college course till I
+entered on the last session, when, after prayerful consideration
+and mature deliberation, I thought it my duty to offer
+myself as a candidate for the ministry.</p>
+
+<p>'Having decided as to the capacity in which I should
+labour in Christ's kingdom, the next thing which occupied
+my serious attention was the <i>locality</i> where I should labour.
+Occasionally before I had thought of the relative claims
+of the home and foreign fields, but during the summer,
+session in Edinburgh I thought the matter out, and decided
+for the mission field; even on the low ground of common
+sense I seemed to be called to be a missionary. Is the
+kingdom a harvest field? Then I thought it reasonable
+that I should seek to work where the work was most abundant
+and the workers fewest. Labourers say they are overtaxed
+at home; what then must be the case abroad, where
+there are wide stretching plains already white to harvest,
+with scarcely here and there a solitary reaper? To me the
+soul of an Indian seemed as precious as the soul of an
+Englishman, and the Gospel as much for the Chinese as
+for the European; and as the band of missionaries was few
+compared with the company of home ministers, it seemed
+to me clearly to be my duty to go abroad.</p>
+
+<p>'But I go out as a missionary not that I may follow the
+dictates of common sense, but that I may obey that command
+of Christ, "<i>Go into all the world and preach</i>." He
+who said "<i>preach</i>," said also, "Go ye into and <i>preach</i>," and
+what Christ hath joined together let not man put asunder.</p>
+
+<p>'This command seems to me to be strictly a missionary
+injunction, and, as far as I can see, those to whom it was first
+delivered regarded it in that light, so that, apart altogether<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_43" id="Page_43">[Pg 43]</a></span>
+from choice and other lower reasons, my going forth is a
+matter of obedience to a plain command; and in place of
+seeking to assign a reason for going abroad, I would prefer
+to say that I have failed to discover any reason why I
+should stay at home.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>On February 22, 1870, James Gilmour embarked at
+Liverpool upon the steamship Diomed, and thus fairly
+started on the work of his life. Among his extant correspondence
+is a long letter which describes the voyage
+to China, and the way in which he utilised the opportunities
+it afforded for trying to do his Master's will.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'We sailed from Liverpool, and my father saw me off.
+The passengers were few&mdash;nine or ten. We had a cabin
+each. There was a Wesleyan medical missionary named
+Hardey going out to Hankow. We soon drew together.
+The doctor of the ship was a young fellow from Greenock,
+and had been at Glasgow College when I was there last.
+Among the 1,200 we had not stumbled upon each other.
+The married man was something or other in the Consular
+service. A young lady passenger was the daughter of a
+judge in China. A young man was going out to try his
+fortune in China: his qualifications were some knowledge
+of tea and a love of drink. Another decent young fellow
+was going out to China as a tea-taster. Another young
+fellow was going out to Australia <i>viâ</i> Singapore. Thus,
+you see, I was the only parson on board; and as the ship's
+company was High Church, and I a Dissenter, it may be
+seen that we did not fit each other exactly. Some of the
+passengers were so High Church that one of them told
+me he thought we Dissenters were sunk more deeply in
+error than the Papists.</p>
+
+<p>'The captain was a sensible kind of rough seaman, and
+I at once volunteered my services as chaplain, and was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_44" id="Page_44">[Pg 44]</a></span>
+accepted, though with some caution. He evidently thought
+me too young to be trusted with a sermon; the Church of
+England prayers I might read, and he put into my hands
+a book with a sermon for any Sunday and holy-day
+in the year. I took the book and said I would look
+through it. The Bay of Biscay was calm when we crossed
+it, but on Sunday morning we were tumbling about off the
+Rock of Lisbon. As I could hardly keep my legs, I did
+not think we should have had service; but we crowded into
+the smoking-saloon (we were afraid to venture below, for
+sickness), and I read prayers. Next Sunday I read a
+sermon from the book. All the Sundays after that I gave
+them my own, and, as I was under the impression that
+they had not heard much plain preaching, did my best to
+let them hear the gospel pure and simple. I half suspected
+they did not quite like it. It was hinted to me that they
+complained of my preaching. The next Sunday came,
+and, under the impression it might be the last time I would
+have the opportunity, I made the most earnest and direct
+appeal to them I possibly could. I was not a little
+thankful and astonished when, soon after, in place of being
+asked to shut up, I was thanked for it, and assured it was
+the best I had given them, and told that it was a waste
+of, &amp;c., &amp;c., for me to go out as a missionary&mdash;I should have
+stopped at home. After that I had no trouble with the
+passengers, and we got on well together.</p>
+
+<p>'As for the men, from captain to cabin-boy there were
+about sixty. Among these was one earnest Christian
+man, a German and a Baptist. He was a quarter-master.
+He was a little peculiar in appearance, and spoke English
+not quite smoothly. On one occasion, when some of the
+passengers were laughing at something he had done and
+said, the captain happened to pass, and, seeing what was
+up, remarked that the man was a first-rate fellow&mdash;he never
+caught him idle. If you except this man, the captain,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_45" id="Page_45">[Pg 45]</a></span>
+and the boy, the whole ship's company swore like troopers.
+So universal was the vice that the men, I almost think,
+were hardly aware that they did swear. I was puzzled.
+Sometimes when I went out in the morning I would hear
+a volley of oaths coming from the mouth of a man who
+had been talking quite seriously with me over-night.</p>
+
+<p>Few of the men came to the service, and as they would
+not come to us we went to them. Hardey and I, usually
+in the evenings, conducted short little services in the forecastle
+as often as we thought desirable. We were always
+well received and listened to respectfully. I think I may
+say safely that all on board had repeated opportunities of
+hearing the gospel as plainly as I could put it, and a good
+many had something more than mere opportunities. After
+it was dark I used to go out and get the men one by one,
+as they sat in corners during their watch in the night. All
+they had to do was to be within call when wanted, and
+many a good long talk I have had with a good many of
+them. Of course, my object in accosting them was religious
+conversation, and this I usually succeeded in having;
+but on many occasions, that we might be quite on a footing
+of equality, I had in return to listen to their yarns. The
+man on the look-out was a frequent victim. I was always
+sure to find a man there, generally alone, and never asleep.
+The man, also, was changed at regular intervals, so that I
+knew exactly when I would find a fresh man. When I
+talked to the look-out man, I used to keep a sharp lookout
+myself, lest by distracting his attention I should get
+him into trouble. Many a good hour have I stood at the
+prow as we passed through the warm Indian Ocean, till
+my clothes were wet with the dew of night; and then I
+would find my way down to my cabin about midnight,
+with my head so full of the ghost-stories I had just heard
+that I was really afraid I might meet a real ghost coming
+out of my cabin.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_46" id="Page_46">[Pg 46]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_II" id="CHAPTER_II"></a>CHAPTER II</h2>
+
+<h3>BEGINNING WORK</h3>
+
+
+<p>In 1817 two missionaries, the Rev. E. Stallybrass and the
+Rev. W. Swan, left England to begin Christian work
+among the Buriats, a Mongolian tribe living under Russian
+authority. At Selenginsk and at Onagen Dome they
+laboured for many years; but in 1841 the Russian Emperor
+ordered them to leave the country. From the command
+of the autocrat there was no appeal, and the mission came
+to an end. But in the good providence of God the two
+missionaries had translated the whole Bible into Buriat;
+the Old Testament being printed in Siberia in 1840, the
+New Testament in London in 1846. Notwithstanding the
+suppression of the mission, the Word of God in the Mongol
+tongue continued to circulate among the people.</p>
+
+<p>It was to the reopening and development of this missionary
+work among the Mongol tribes that James Gilmour
+consecrated his life. He was appointed, in the first instance,
+to the London Mission at Peking, and that centre formed
+his first base of operations. He continued also a member
+of that mission until the close of his life. He reached the
+Chinese capital on May 18, 1870. At once he settled
+down to hard and continuous work at the Chinese language,
+endeavouring also from the first to discover the best means<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_47" id="Page_47">[Pg 47]</a></span>
+of restarting the Mongol Mission. The very full diary
+which he kept lies before us as we write, and enables us to
+understand the varying progress and hindrance, encouragement
+and despondency of this time.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>June 11, 1870.</i>&mdash;Mr. Gulick advises me to pay little
+attention to the Chinese and go in hot and strong for the
+Mongolian. I am not quite sure that he is not right, after
+all. However, I mean to stick into the Chinese yet for a
+time to come with my teacher and to mix among the people
+as much as I can. I went out to-night and with the gate-keeper
+and two of his companions had a lot of talk, in
+which I learned a good lot. I hope to benefit largely by
+this pleasant mode of study. Perhaps by this means I
+may be able to do them good. Lord grant it!'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>June 12, 1870.</i>&mdash;I am to-day twenty-seven years of
+age, and what have I done? Let the time that is past
+suffice to have wrought the will of the flesh. The prospect
+I have before me now is the most inspiriting one any man
+can have. Health, strength, as much conscious ability as
+makes one hope to be able to get the language of the
+people to whom I am sent, a new field of work among
+men who are decidedly religious and simple-minded, left
+pretty much to my own ideas as to what is best to be done
+in the attempted evangelization of Mongolia, friends left
+in Britain behind me praying for me, comfort and peace
+here in the prosecution of my present studies, the idea that
+what I do is for eternity, and that this life is but the short
+prelude to an eternal state, the thought that after death
+there shall break on my view a thousand truths that now I
+long in vain to know&mdash;these thoughts and many others
+make my present life happy, and in a manner careless as
+to what should come. In time may I be able to do my
+part as I ought, and may God have great mercy upon me!'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_48" id="Page_48">[Pg 48]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>On June 22, 1870, the news of the Tientsin massacre
+reached Peking. A Roman Catholic convent had been
+destroyed and thirteen French people killed. Very great
+uncertainty prevailed as to whether this indicated a further
+purpose of attacking all missions and all foreigners, and
+for a while things looked very dark. It was a time in
+which the nerve and courage and faith of men were severely
+tried, and splendidly did Gilmour endure the test. While
+unable to escape wholly from the fears common to all, his
+reply to the counsels of worldly prudence and selfish dread
+was advance in his work. When others were wondering
+whether they might not have to retreat, he, alone, in
+almost total ignorance of the language, entirely unfamiliar
+with the country, went up to the great Mongolian plain,
+and entered upon the service so close to his heart&mdash;personal
+intercourse with and effort for the Mongols.</p>
+
+<p>How trying a season this was his diary reveals. Under
+date of June 23, 1870, the day after the first tidings of the
+outbreak had been received, he writes:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'The Roman Catholic missionaries have suffered severely,
+and the Protestant missionaries are not in a very safe
+condition. We are living on the slope of a volcano that
+may put forth its slumbering rage at any moment. For
+example, people ask why there is no rain, and blame the
+foreigners for it; and should a famine ensue, we may fare
+hard for it. Now is the time for trying what stuff a man's
+religion is made of. We may be all dead men directly;
+are we afraid to die? Our death might further the cause
+of Christ more than our life could do. We must die
+some time or other; now that we have a near view of its
+possibility, how can we look forward to it? God! do
+Thou make my faith firm and bright, so that death may<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_49" id="Page_49">[Pg 49]</a></span>
+seem small and not to be feared. Help me to trust Thee
+and Christ implicitly, so that with calm mind I may work
+while Thou dost let me live, and when Thou dost call me
+home, let me come gladly.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The further entries in his Diary at this time depict
+his inner experience from day to day:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>July 10.</i>&mdash;Rose 6.20. Dull morning, rained a little.
+Felt uncomfortable at the idea of being killed; felt troubled
+at the idea of leaving Peking. How am I to pack and
+carry my goods? Felt troubled at remaining in the midst of a
+troubled city, with a government weak and stupid. How is
+my mission to get on beginning thus? O God, let me cast
+all my care upon Thee, and commit my soul also to Thy
+safe keeping. Keep me, O God, in perfect peace! Rain
+made a thin meeting this morning, but all was quiet. In
+afternoon went with Mr. Edkins to the west; things uncommonly
+quiet and peaceful.</p>
+
+<p>'<i>July 12.</i>&mdash;While others are writing to papers and trying
+to stir up the feelings of the people, so that they may
+take action in the matter, perhaps I may be able to do
+some good moving Heaven. My creed leads me to think
+that prayer is efficacious, and surely a day's asking God
+to overrule all these events for good is not lost. Still,
+there is a great feeling that when a man is praying he is
+doing nothing, and this feeling, I am sure, makes us give
+undue importance to work, sometimes even to the hurrying
+over or even to the neglect of prayer.</p>
+
+<p>'<i>July 22.</i>&mdash;A good deal troubled about the present state
+of matters. I don't exactly know how to estimate rumours
+and reports, and this may cause me more uneasiness than
+there is any need for. Still, I don't know. At times I feel
+a great revulsion from being killed, at other times I feel as
+if I could be killed quietly, and not dislike the thing much.
+Sometimes the tone of those about us is hopeful, and that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_50" id="Page_50">[Pg 50]</a></span>
+causes hope also. Sometimes the prospect of a speedy
+removal, a half flight, comes upon me with great force, and
+to see all its annoyance, not to speak of the danger, is not
+pleasant at all. Oh for the simple, childlike faith that can
+trust all things to God and leave all care upon Him!
+Ought we not to have it? Is God not the same God now
+that He was when He delivered His people from Egypt,
+and His saints from the hands of their enemies, from
+the mouth of the lions, and the fiery furnace? Cannot
+God keep us yet&mdash;will He not do it? But then comes the
+thought, perhaps God does not wish us to live, but to die.
+Often has He allowed His saints to be slain. What then?
+Well, as the men in the furnace said of God, "Will He care
+to defend us? if not, be it known unto you we will not yield."
+I might have died in childhood, in youth, before conversion,
+and if then, alas! alas! I can remember the time when
+the pains of hell got such a terrible hold upon me that I
+would have gladly changed places in the world with anyone
+who had the hope of salvation. Death, life, prospects,
+honour, shame, seemed nothing compared with this hope
+of salvation, which I was then without. "Could I ever be
+saved?" was the question; "would I ever have the hope
+that I knew others had?" Had I died in darkness&mdash;God
+be thanked, the light has shined forth, and I have the hope of
+eternal life. May God make me more Christlike, and give
+me stronger hope! Well, then, this hope I have; from this
+fearful pit I have been delivered; in the light I now walk.
+God I call my Father, Christ my Saviour, heaven my home,
+earth and the life here the entrance to real life. If there is
+anything in our faith or in our belief, then heaven is as
+much better than earth as it is higher than earth, and our
+souls life is insured from all harm. If a man is insured
+against all possible harm, why should he be afraid? Not
+one hair of our head shall perish! O Lord, help me to live
+this faith and to be in this frame of mind. In this city are<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_51" id="Page_51">[Pg 51]</a></span>
+many foreigners, who came here to learn the language, &amp;c.,
+and many of them have no great hope of heaven. They
+seem calm enough, and are no doubt calm enough; shall
+the courage of the world, shall the courage of scepticism,
+shall the courage of carelessness be greater and produce
+better fruit than the courage of the Christian? O Lord,
+preserve me from the sin of dishonouring Thy name
+through fear and cowardice! Let us be bold in the Lord!'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>By the end of July 1870, Gilmour had reached a fixed
+resolution to go to Mongolia as soon as the necessary
+arrangements could be made. A severe test had been
+applied to him, and the way in which he met it gives the key
+to the whole of his after life. He used the trial as a help
+onwards in the path of duty, and the chain of events which
+would have led many men to postpone indefinitely the
+beginning of a new and hard work only drove him the
+more eagerly into new fields. The reasons that influenced
+him are set forth in his official report written many months
+later.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'After the massacre at Tientsin, very grave fears prevailed
+at Peking; no one could tell how far the ramifications
+of the plot might extend, and it was impossible to sift the
+matter. The people openly talked of an extermination,
+and claimed to have the tacit favour of the Government in
+this; nay more, the Government itself issued ambiguous, if
+not insinuating, proclamations, which fomented the excitement
+of the populace to such an extent that the days were
+fixed for the "Clearing of Peking." The mob was thoroughly
+quieted on the first of the days fixed by a twenty
+hours' pour of tremendous rain, which converted Peking
+into a muddy, boatless Venice, and kept the people safely
+at home in their helpless felt shoes, as securely as if their
+feet had been put into the stocks. This was Friday.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_52" id="Page_52">[Pg 52]</a></span>
+Tuesday was the reserve day; Saturday and Sabbath one
+felt the tide of excitement rising, and on Monday morning
+the Peking Gazette came out with an Imperial edict that
+at once allayed the excitement, and assured us that there
+was no danger for the present.</p>
+
+<p>'We had then to draw breath and look about us calmly,
+and the general conclusion that the "Old Pekingers" came
+to was that the French would be compelled to resort to
+force of arms to gain redress. The attitude of the Chinese
+people and Government made them think so, and so they
+determined to wait on quietly in Peking till things should
+get thick, and then it would be time to go south. I think
+I may safely say that everyone drew out an inventory of
+his things, and not a few had their most necessary things
+packed "on the sly," and were ready to start on short notice.</p>
+
+<p>'Up to this point I stood quietly aside; but now
+was my time to reason, and on the data they supplied I
+reasoned thus: "If I go south, no Mongol can be prevailed
+on to go with me, and so I am shut out from my work, and
+that for an indefinite time. If I can get away north, then
+I can go on with the language, and perhaps come down
+after the smoke clears away, knowing Mongolian, and
+having lost no time." I felt a great aversion to travelling
+so far alone, and with such imperfect knowledge of the
+language, but as I thought it over from day to day I was
+more and more convinced that to run the risk of having to
+go south would be to prove unfaithful to duty, and so I
+conferred no longer with likings or dislikings, resolved to
+go should an opportunity offer, and in the meantime
+worked away at Chinese.</p>
+
+<p>'By-and-by a Russian merchant turned up; he was
+going to Kiachta, so I started with him. I could not go
+sooner, as it was not safe to travel in the country before the
+Imperial edict was issued; to wait longer was to run the
+risk of not going at all.'</p></blockquote>
+<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_54" id="Page_54">[Pg 54]</a></span></p>
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 500px;">
+<img src="images/54.jpg" width="500" height="758" alt="Map illustrating James Gilmour&#39;s journeys on the Great Plain of Mongolia" title="Map illustrating James Gilmour&#39;s journeys on the Great Plain of Mongolia" />
+</div>
+<p>
+<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_55" id="Page_55">[Pg 55]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_III" id="CHAPTER_III"></a>CHAPTER III</h2>
+
+<h3>MONGOLIAN APPRENTICESHIP</h3>
+
+
+<p>The name Mongolia denotes a vast and almost unknown
+territory situated between China Proper and Siberia, constituting
+the largest dependency of the Chinese Empire.
+It stretches from the Sea of Japan on the east to Turkestan
+on the west, a distance of nearly 3,000 miles; and
+from the southern boundary of Asiatic Russia to the
+Great Wall of China, a distance of about 900 miles. It
+consists of high tablelands, lifted up considerably above
+the level of Northern China, and is approached only
+through rugged mountain passes. The central portion
+of this enormous area is called the Desert of Gobi.</p>
+
+<p>A kind of highway for the considerable commercial
+traffic between China and Russia runs through the eastern
+central part of Mongolia, leaving China at the frontier town
+of Kalgan, and touching Russia at the frontier town of
+Kiachta. Along this route during all but the winter
+months, caravans of camel-carts and ox-carts attended by
+companies of Mongols and Chinese are constantly passing.
+The staple export from China is tea; the chief imports are
+salt, soda, hides, and timber.</p>
+
+<p>The west and the centre of Mongolia is occupied by
+nomad Mongols. They have clusters of huts and tents in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_56" id="Page_56">[Pg 56]</a></span>
+fixed locations which form their winter dwellings. But in
+summer they journey over the great plains in search of the
+best pasturage for their flocks and herds. They are consequently
+exceedingly difficult to reach by any other method
+than that of sharing their roving tent life. In the southeastern
+district of Mongolia there are large numbers of
+agricultural Mongols who speak both Chinese and Mongolian.
+The towns in this part are almost wholly inhabited
+by Chinese.</p>
+
+<p>The winter in Mongolia is both long and severe; in the
+summer the heat is often very oppressive, and the great
+Plain is subject to severe storms of dust, rain and wind.</p>
+
+<p>Buddhism is all-powerful, and the larger half of the
+male population are lamas or Buddhist priests. 'Meet a
+Mongol on the road, and the probability is that he is
+saying his prayers and counting his beads as he rides
+along. Ask him where he is going, and on what errand,
+as the custom is, and likely he will tell you he is going to
+some shrine to worship. Follow him to the temple, and
+there you will find him one of a company with dust-marked
+forehead, moving lips, and the never absent beads, going
+the rounds of the sacred place, prostrating himself at every
+shrine, bowing before every idol, and striking pious attitudes
+at every new object of reverence that meets his eye.
+Go to Mongolia itself, and probably one of the first great
+sights that meet your eye will be a temple of imposing
+grandeur, resplendent from afar in colours and gold.'</p>
+
+<p>'The Mongol's religion marks out for him certain seemingly
+indifferent actions as good or bad, meritorious or
+sinful. There is scarcely one single step in life, however
+insignificant, which he can take without first consulting<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_57" id="Page_57">[Pg 57]</a></span>
+his religion through his priest. Not only does his religion
+insist on moulding his soul, and colouring his whole
+spiritual existence, but it determines for him the colour
+and cut of his coat. It would be difficult to find another
+instance in which any religion has grasped a country so
+universally and completely as Buddhism has Mongolia.'<a name="FNanchor_1_1" id="FNanchor_1_1"></a><a href="#Footnote_1_1" class="fnanchor">[1]</a></p>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_1_1" id="Footnote_1_1"></a><a href="#FNanchor_1_1"><span class="label">[1]</span></a> <i>Among the Mongols</i>, p. 211.</p></div>
+
+<p>It was to the herculean task of attempting single-handed
+to evangelise a region and a people like this that
+James Gilmour addressed himself. His early journeys are
+fully set forth in <i>Among the Mongols</i>, and we do not propose
+to repeat them here. Our object rather is to depict,
+so far as possible, the inner life of James Gilmour, and
+the real nature of the work he accomplished. He left
+Peking on August 5, and reached Kalgan four days later.
+On August 27 he started for his first trip across the great
+plain of Mongolia to Kiachta. A Russian postmaster was
+to be his companion, but, to avoid travelling on Sunday,
+Gilmour started a day ahead, and then waited for the
+Russian to come up. Here is his first view of scenes he
+was so often in later life to visit.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>Sabbath, August 28.</i>&mdash;Awoke about 5 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span> just as it
+was drawing towards light, and saw that we were right out
+into the Plain.</p>
+
+<p>'I am writing up my diary, with a lot of people looking
+into my cart. I have just given them a Mongol Catechism,
+and I hope it may do them good. God, do Thou bless it to
+them! Would I could speak to them, but I cannot. I am
+glad to be saved the trouble of travelling to-day. My
+mind feels at rest for the present. I am looking about me,
+and having my first look at the life I am likely to lead.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_58" id="Page_58">[Pg 58]</a></span>
+There are several more Mongol dwellings within sight,
+plenty of camels, horses, and oxen. The Mongols have
+a tent of their own, and the "commandant's" tent has also
+been put up. A Mongol has just come up and changed
+his dress, his cloak serving him as a tent meantime. I
+am hesitating whether to try to read in my cart or go off
+a little way with my plaid and umbrella.</p>
+
+<p>'Had not a very intellectual or spiritual day after all.
+Went in the afternoon away to the east. Had a good
+view and a time of devotion at a cairn from which an eagle
+rose as I approached. Returned to the camp and bought
+milk and some cheese. Intended to make porridge, but
+the fire was not good on account of the blowing, so I drank
+off my milk, ate some bread, and went to sleep.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The journey across the desert, including a visit to Urga,
+occupied a month. It was full of intense interest for the
+traveller, and many of the most abiding impressions of his
+life and work were then received. His diary reveals the deep
+yearnings of his heart for the salvation of the Mongols.
+Under the date September 11, 1870, he writes:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Astir by daybreak. Camels watering; made porridge
+and tea. This is the Lord's day; help me, O Lord, to be
+in the spirit, and to be glad and rejoice in the day which
+Thou hast made! Several huts in sight. When shall I be
+able to speak to the people? O Lord, suggest by the
+Spirit how I should come among them, and guide me in
+gaining the language, and in preparing myself to teach the
+life and love of Christ Jesus! Oh, let me live for Christ,
+and feel day by day the blessedness of a will given up to
+God, and the happiness of a life which has its every circumstance
+working for my good!'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_59" id="Page_59">[Pg 59]</a></span></p><p>His constant rule was to rest from all journeying, so far
+as possible, on the Sabbath. After another week's experience,
+on September 18 he thus records his impressions:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Encamped just over the plain we saw at sunset last
+night. We are some distance from the real exit, but not far.
+This is the Lord's day; God help me to be in the spirit
+notwithstanding all distractions. Oh that God would give
+me more of His Spirit, more of His felt Presence, more of
+the spirit and power of prayer, that I may bring down
+blessings on this poor people of Mongolia! As I look at
+them and their huts I ask again and again how am I to go
+among them; in comfort and in a waggon, with all my things
+about me; or in poverty, reducing myself to their level?
+If I go among them rich, they will be continually begging,
+and perhaps regard me more as a source of gifts than anything
+else. If I go with nothing but the Gospel, there
+will be nothing to distract their attention from the unspeakable
+gift.</p>
+
+<p>'8.15 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span>-3.15 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> Good long walk. Met camels and
+came upon a cart encampment, estimated at one hundred
+and seventy. Know where I am on the map. There is a
+camel encampment where we are. Two huts from which
+comes fuel. Read to-day in II Chronicles xvi. God never
+failed those who trusted in Him and appealed to Him.
+God was displeased with the King of Judah because, after
+the deliverance from the Lubims, Ethiopians, &amp;c., he trusted
+to the arm of flesh to deliver him from the Syrians. Do
+we not in our day rest too much on the arm of flesh?
+Cannot the same wonders be done now as of old? Do not
+the eyes of the Lord run to and fro throughout the whole
+earth, still to show Himself strong on behalf of those who
+put their trust in Him? Oh that God would give me more
+practical faith in Him! Where is now the Lord God of
+Elijah? He is waiting for Elijah to call on Him. God<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_60" id="Page_60">[Pg 60]</a></span>
+give me some of Elijah's spirit, and let my power be of God,
+and my hope from Him for the conversion of this people.</p>
+
+<p>'It is nothing to the Lord to save by many or by them
+that have no power. Help me, O God, for I rest on Thee,
+and in Thy name I go against this multitude!'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Kiachta, on the southern frontier of Siberia, was
+reached September 28, 1870, and there Gilmour was at
+once plunged into a series of troubles. The Russian and
+Chinese authorities would not recognise his passport, and
+he had to wait months before another could be obtained from
+Peking. He found absolutely no sympathy in his work.
+He knew next to nothing of the Mongol language. Yet
+with robust faith, with whole-hearted courage, with a resolution
+that nothing could daunt, he set to work. A
+Scotch trader, named Grant, was kind to him, and found
+accommodation for him at his house. At first he tried the
+orthodox plan of getting a Mongol teacher to visit and
+instruct him. Before he secured one he used to visit such
+Mongols as he found in the neighbourhood, trying to acquire
+a vocabulary from them, asking the names of the articles
+they were using, their actions, and all such other matters as
+he could make them understand. But his loneliness, his
+ignorance of the language, the inaction to which he was
+condemned, partly by his difficulty in getting a suitable
+teacher, and partly by the uncertainty as to whether the
+authorities would allow him to remain, told upon his eager
+spirit as week after week passed by, and he became subject
+to fits of severe depression. Here is a picture of one of
+these early days. He had been trying to talk with a
+Buriat carpenter, in a place called Kudara, not far from
+Kiachta:<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_61" id="Page_61">[Pg 61]</a></span>&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'After getting my quota of words I walked through the
+town. The main object in it is the church, a large whitewashed
+structure built by Mr. Grant's father-in-law when
+he was a rich man. He was made poor, comparatively speaking,
+in one night by a great fire which burnt up all before
+it. In addition to the church are some streets of Cossack
+houses, desolate enough looking, the streets desolate
+enough at best, but rendered much more so this morning
+by the snow melting in the sun, which is still high, and
+manages to thaw away all the snow that falls in places
+where it shines, though it was frost all day in the shade.
+Passing the town I made for the river, which rolled on
+quiet and cold. Passed through large orchards of apple(?)
+trees; doubled about, went to the extreme west, got on a
+hill, and came round home again in time for dinner at
+4 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> I felt very lonely, and not having a teacher I am
+thrown idle, as it were, a great part of the day after I get
+my words. It is true I am taking notice of all I see, but
+it always occurs to me that this is not furthering the
+Mongolian Mission in any direct way. I often think of
+what Dr. Alexander said in his charge at my ordination:
+"<i>You do not go to discover new countries.</i>" Would I had a
+teacher, that the language might go on full swing! To-day
+I felt a good deal like Elijah in the wilderness, when the
+reaction came on after his slaughter of the priests of Baal.
+He prayed that he might die. I wonder if I am telling
+the truth when I say that I felt drawn towards suicide. I
+take this opportunity of declaring strongly that on all
+occasions two missionaries should go together. I was not
+of this opinion a few weeks ago, but I had no idea how
+weak an individual I am. My eyes have filled with tears
+frequently these last few days in spite of myself, and I do
+not wonder in the least that Grant's brother shot himself.
+<i>Oh! the intense loneliness of Christ's life</i>, not a single one
+understood Him! He bore it. O Jesus, let me follow in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_62" id="Page_62">[Pg 62]</a></span>
+Thy steps, and have in me the same Spirit that Thou
+hadst!</p>
+
+<p>'Read papers in the evening (Oct 5). So Jones of
+Singrauli is dead! I heard him in Exeter Hall, May, a
+year or two ago, and heard a good deal of him through
+Dr. Evans, of Chestnut College. I am persuaded he was
+a missionary among a thousand. When he returned to his
+station he found that during his absence matters had got
+out of order a good deal, and he set about putting them
+right. Now he is dead! How prodigal God seems of His
+workers&mdash;Hartley, Jones, both A 1, both gone. God's ways
+are not ours. We would have preserved these two at all
+risk and expense, but God <i>takes</i> them away, and it seems to
+us as if He were hurting His own cause. God knows best,
+but to <i>us</i> it is a great mystery.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Two days later he received a letter telling him of the
+death of a brilliant young Glasgow student, and he enters
+in his diary comments which received only too complete
+an illustration in his own subsequent career:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Another splendid student going from college to the
+grave. This is a thing of common occurrence with reference
+to Glasgow College, and, if I am not mistaken, I have
+seen it somewhere publicly commented on. Men, poor
+it may be, strive through college with a mind and determination
+beyond their circumstances and bodily strength,
+fight a great battle with poverty and more clever students,
+resolute to take the first place if possible, and just as the
+college is finished with them, and sending them forth to the
+field of life decorated with all the honours it can bestow,
+the fond Alma Mater has to keep on mourning and drop
+her tear over an early grave.</p>
+
+<p>'Are the young men to blame? Who can be restrained
+by the cold-blooded calculation of preserving health?<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_63" id="Page_63">[Pg 63]</a></span>
+"There is my opponent, I'll thrash him if I can; better to
+toil out my life-blood drop by drop than let it mount to my
+cheek as a mantle of shame when I find myself defeated
+when I might have been victorious." Then they conscientiously
+work themselves to death. If they did not work as
+hard as they do, and refrain from recreation as they do,
+they would have in their breasts the uneasy feeling that
+they have not done as much as they might have done;
+and what noble nature can be content to live under that
+accusation written against them by the supreme court in
+their own breasts?</p>
+
+<p>'Several times I have resolved to refrain for health's sake,
+but in a short time found such an uneasy feeling about not
+doing as much as I might, that I had to give it up and
+go at it. I <i>never</i> feel that I have done as much as I might,
+and when I am doing most I feel best.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Very dissatisfied with his progress, and stung one day
+by a remark of Grant's to the effect that he did not seem to
+speak Mongolian readily, Gilmour changed his plans. He
+resolved to go out upon the Plain, and persuade some
+Mongol to allow him to share his tent. On December 13,
+1870, he left Kiachta and journeyed out into Mongolia to
+the first cluster of tents, named Olau Bourgass. There he
+found a friendly Mongol. 'Grant's contractor. Found
+him at his prayers. He motioned me to sit down, and
+when his devotions were finished he gave me a warm
+welcome. He lives alone in his tent, having nothing to
+care for but the horses for the courier service, and a couple
+of lamas<a name="FNanchor_2_2" id="FNanchor_2_2"></a><a href="#Footnote_2_2" class="fnanchor">[2]</a> to attend to his wants, one of whom goes with the
+letters when they come. We talked, and I learned a great<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_64" id="Page_64">[Pg 64]</a></span>
+deal, when at last I broke my mind to him, and was glad
+to find that he received it favourably. I settled to remain
+there during the night. Nothing very remarkable happened
+except that we were invaded by a great blustering
+lama, intoxicated. He came ramping into the tent as
+if he would have knocked everything down. After a time
+he went away and lodged in the next hut. I went to bed
+about ten and slept well, though my feet were cold towards
+morning.'</p>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_2_2" id="Footnote_2_2"></a><a href="#FNanchor_2_2"><span class="label">[2]</span></a> A lama is a priest of the lama section of Buddists. More than half the
+population of Mongolia are lamas.</p></div>
+
+<p>The next three months were passed mainly in this
+tent. Gilmour used, whenever possible, to return to
+Kiachta to spend the Sunday at Grant's house; but by
+enduring the hardships and suffering all the inconveniences
+of ordinary Mongol life he rapidly acquired the colloquial,
+and he also made an indelible impression upon the minds
+and hearts of the natives, who ever afterwards spoke of
+him as 'Our Gilmour.' He saw Mongol life as it was, free
+from all the illusion and romance sometimes thrown around
+it. He became intimately acquainted with the various
+Mongol types, and he began to enter into the native
+habits of thought. His diary contains many a scene like
+the following:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I gave the lama a book on Saturday, and when I
+came back on Tuesday I found he had read it through
+twice. He set upon me with questions, getting me to
+admit premises, and then reasoned from them. Christ
+being at the right hand of God was a great point with him.
+If God has no form, how can anyone be at His right
+hand? Then, again, if God is everywhere, Christ is everywhere
+right and left of God, and how can that be?</p>
+
+<p>'The omnipresence was a staggerer. Was God in that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_65" id="Page_65">[Pg 65]</a></span>
+pot, in the tent, in his boot? Did he tread upon God?
+Then was God inside the kettle? Did the hot tea not
+scald Him? Again, if God was inside the kettle, the kettle
+was living! And so he held it up to the laughing circle as
+a new species of animal. I asked him if a fly were inside
+the kettle, would the kettle be alive? "No," he said; "but
+a fly does not fill the space as God must do." "Well, then,"
+said I, "is my coat alive because I fill it?" This settled
+the question.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In March 1871 he visited Selenginsk and Onagen
+Dome, the scene of the labours of Stallybrass and Swan
+from 1817 to 1841, and then he took a run into Siberia, crossing
+Lake Baikal and visiting Irkutsk. At the latter place
+he reviews the past few months:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Another week has passed over my head with many
+hopes and fears. This day, a week ago, I was nearing
+Ana in doubt as to many things; now I am in Irkutsk,
+having my path marked with mercies. In many points of
+my journey I expected difficulties which might have stopped
+me short in my path, but all these have disappeared,
+and I am here, having succeeded beyond expectations.
+One thing is not right: my readiness to forget the ways in
+which God has helped me. Sometimes for weeks and
+months I look forward to some crisis which is coming; it
+comes off well, and in two days I am as if I had forgotten
+that to which I had looked forward with so much apprehension.
+In this manner I am not only guilty of ingratitude,
+but lose much joy and strength of faith and hope.
+What should make me more happy than the thought of
+the helps and deliverances that God has vouchsafed me;
+and in troubles present and to come, what can give me
+more faith and courage than to remember that out of such
+troubles I was delivered before?<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_66" id="Page_66">[Pg 66]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'One thing I sometimes think of. I left Britain with
+no intention of travelling; I expected to settle down quietly
+and confine myself to a circle I could impress. This plan
+has been completely changed and overruled. Two months
+have I been in Peking; two weeks have I been in Kalgan;
+a month have I been in the desert; a month have I been in
+Kudara, a small Russian frontier military post; a month
+and a half have I been in Kiachta; two months have I been
+in Mongolia; and now two weeks have I been travelling in
+Russia. A year and a month have elapsed since I left
+home, and during that time I have been walking to and
+fro on the face of the earth, and going up and down in it.
+In this way I have not found my life at all dull, but very
+stirring. Indeed, many people would have left home to
+travel as I have done. I sought it not; it came, and I
+took it. So as yet I have no hardships to complain of.
+To see the places and things I have seen&mdash;Liverpool,
+Wales, Rock of Lisbon, Gibraltar, Malta, Egypt, Port
+Said, Canal, Suez, Red Sea, Cape Gardafui, Indian Ocean,
+Penang, Straits of Malacca, Singapore, Hong Kong,
+Shanghai, Tientsin, Peking, Kalgan, Desert, Urga, Kiachta,
+Russia, Baikal, Irkutsk&mdash;only even to see these, men will
+make long journeys. I have seen them all without seeking
+them, with the exception of Baikal and Irkutsk. These
+are all by the way, and I dwell upon them as proofs that
+God, in sending His servants from home and kindred, often
+gives them pleasure and worldly enjoyment on the way,
+which He does not promise, and which they have no right
+to expect.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>After another but briefer sojourn at Olau Bourgass he
+set out on his return journey, visited Urga, then crossed
+the great plain on horseback in the course of fourteen days,
+and reached Kalgan on June 11. After a rest there he
+made two excursions into Mongolia, visiting Lama Miao,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_67" id="Page_67">[Pg 67]</a></span>
+one of the great Mongol religious centres, in the first; and
+occupying some weeks with a further spell of Mongol tent
+life during the second.</p>
+
+<p>His diary, under date of September 22, 1871, while he
+was resting at Kalgan, thus sums up his experiences:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I desire to-day to look back on the way by which the
+Lord has led me for the last year. In September 1870 I
+was looking out eagerly, anxiously for someone who was
+going to Russia, that I might go with him. I could find
+no one. I made it a subject of prayer, and at last, when I
+was on my knees, in came McCoy to tell me of a Russian
+who was going up without delay. I saw the Russian, and
+arranged to go, and started. "While they are speaking I
+will answer them."</p>
+
+<p>'On the journey between Peking and Kalgan I was
+alone, I may say, and could speak little Chinese, yet I got
+on very well; and though my money was in a box on the
+back of a donkey, yet it came in all safe, none lost. In
+Kalgan I had difficulty at first about finding camels, but
+at length the Russian postmaster turned out to be going
+home. The time when was uncertain, quite; his departure
+depended on the coming of his successor. I prayed about
+this, and one day was informed that the successor had
+arrived much sooner than was expected, and that we were
+to start in a day or two. We did start, and after a prosperous
+journey arrived safely at Kiachta.</p>
+
+<p>'There I found Grant and Hegemann, two Englishmen.
+I went to live in Grant's country house at Kudara. A
+difficulty arose about a teacher. I prayed about this, and
+strolling along came upon a tent in which was a man who
+was out of employment, and he being educated, I engaged
+him to be my teacher. In Kiachta, after some delay, I got
+a teacher, but not to my satisfaction. After I had been
+with him a time Grant remarked one day that I did not<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_68" id="Page_68">[Pg 68]</a></span>
+seem to be making much progress in the language. This
+stung me to the quick, and made me go down into
+Mongolia. Here I was directed to the tent of Grant's
+contractor, and with him I made arrangements to live. I
+thank God for not permitting me to get a good teacher in
+Kiachta. Had I got a good teacher there, I would simply
+have remained there, and I am sure would not have
+learned half as much of the language as I did in the tent
+at Mongolia, would have got none of the insight I gained
+into the style of Mongolian life, and would not have got
+the introduction I had there to numerous Mongols. At
+the time I was immensely chagrined that I could not get a
+proper teacher, but now, after the lapse of only a few
+months, I can see good reason for thanking God for leading
+me by that way. This should teach me to trust God
+more than I do when things seem to thwart my
+purpose.</p>
+
+<p>'Again, I was under a great disappointment about the
+delay that occurred in the sending of my passport from
+Peking. In consequence of its not coming I was unable
+to go to Urga with Lobsung and Sherrub in February. I
+felt it much at the time, but some months after (in June) I
+learned that these men with whom I wanted to go suffered
+excessively on the road; so much so that, had I gone with
+them, I might have got my feet frozen and died with the
+cold. Here again I have to praise God for not giving me
+my own way.</p>
+
+<table summary="Poem - Thy way, not mine, O Lord">
+<tr>
+<td>
+<span>"Thy way, not mine, O Lord;<br /></span>
+<span style="margin-left: 2em">However dark it be."<br /></span>
+</td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>'Then, again, I had long desired to visit the scene of
+the former Siberian Mission, and through the mercy of
+Providence I was permitted to do this. My journey back
+through the desert also was marked by mercies. Truly I
+may stand and say,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_69" id="Page_69">[Pg 69]</a></span></p>
+
+<table summary="Poem - When all thy mercies">
+<tr>
+<td>
+<span>"When all Thy mercies, O my God,<br /></span>
+<span style="margin-left: 2em">My rising soul surveys,<br /></span>
+<span>Transported with the view, I'm lost<br /></span>
+<span style="margin-left: 2em">In wonder, love, and praise."'<br /></span>
+</td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>After his wanderings even Kalgan was a haven of rest,
+and he had secured there a base of operations. 'Now,'
+he writes, 'that I have got my study window pasted up,
+and a nice little stove set going, it seems so comfortable
+that it would be snug to stay where I am. But comfort is
+not the missionary's rule. My object in going into Mongolia
+at this time is to have an opportunity of reviewing
+and extending my knowledge of the colloquial, which has
+become a little rusty consequent upon its disuse to a great
+extent while here, trying to get up the written.'</p>
+
+<p>All who are even superficially acquainted with Chinese
+matters know how difficult it is to acquire the colloquial,
+and still more the written language. Mongolian is not
+nearly so difficult, but it presents a task needing vigour of
+intellect and strength of will. Both of these Gilmour possessed
+in a measure far above the average.</p>
+
+<p>'In the written,' he states on October 7, 1871, 'I am
+still far from at home. Most of the Bible I can read slowly
+and at sight. Many words I can write. I think I could
+write a bad letter myself alone. The other day I did so.
+My teacher said it was well written, and said also he rejoiced
+in the progress of his scholar; but I put this down to
+mere politeness.'</p>
+
+<p>During this visit he stayed in the tent of a Mongol
+named Mahabul, who lived there with his wife and an
+only son, a lama. They were all much addicted to the
+use of whisky.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_70" id="Page_70">[Pg 70]</a></span></p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>October 14, '71.</i>&mdash;To-day rose before the sun, read
+words, wrote at the account of my journey from Urga, went
+to the mountain for devotion, revisited the silver worker,
+who is making the bride's ornaments, dined, visited the
+Norying's lama son, who fell from a horse and broke his
+leg, had tea, and went to visit tents a mile or two to the
+south. There found, as master of the tent, a blackman (a
+layman) I had seen before, and as visitor a lama I had
+left in Mahabul's tent when I went out. From one thing
+to another we got to speak of God and His book. At last
+they asked me to read them a portion. I read in English
+a few verses, and then gave them the parable of the Prodigal
+Son in Mongol colloquial. I also gave them a specimen
+of a sermon, and explained shortly the nature of God, when
+they all seemed pleased. The lama finished up the thing
+by saying, "Your outward appearance differs from us, but
+inwardly you agree with us." Coming home I felt amply
+repaid for all the uncomfort and solitude, and leading a
+Mongol life, by the comparative ease with which I can
+converse with them, and the manner in which they wonder
+at my proficiency in the colloquial.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In his official report he rapidly summarises the achievements
+of the last nine months:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'By the middle of February I had a limited knowledge
+of the colloquial, picked up from listening to and joining
+in the conversation going on among the inmates of the
+tent at Olau Bourgass, and those with the numerous visitors
+who took occasion to call on my lama, who was rather a
+famous man. At the end of February the lama returned
+south to Urga, and I went back into Russia, and got a
+Buriat teacher. This individual, however, turned out so
+incredibly lazy, and I felt so dull alone in my large
+comfortable rooms, after the friendly bustle and crowd of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_71" id="Page_71">[Pg 71]</a></span>
+the little tent, with its cheery fire, that I could not stand it.
+So I got my teacher and myself into a tarantass, and went
+off to visit the scenes of the former mission in Siberia.
+My teacher proved very useful. He spoke Russian very
+well, I spoke Mongolian to him, and thus we travelled,
+the doubtful wonder of all Russians, who could not understand
+how a man not born a Buriat could get acquainted
+with that language, and yet know no Russian. After
+visiting the converts, partly for the sake of diverting the
+curious eyes of the Russians from the great aim of my
+journey and partly in the traveller's spirit, I turned westward
+and crossed the Baikal on the ice, and remained a
+few days in the capital of Siberia, Irkutsk. On returning
+to Kiachta I found another teacher, and went out for
+another month into Mongolia and tent life. All the while
+that I was in Mongolia I used to return to Kiachta once a
+week, usually on Saturday, and abide in the land of habitations
+till Monday.</p>
+
+<p>'Early in May I started for the south. I had intended
+to remain over the summer in Urga, but unexpected difficulties
+turned up, and led me to decide on going down to
+Kalgan at once. From Urga to Kalgan (600 miles)
+was done on horseback, accompanied by a single Mongol;
+and as we carried no luggage, we had to depend on the
+hospitality of the Mongols for lodging and cooking, or, as
+they call the latter, "pot and ladle."</p>
+
+<p>'In this way I saw a very great deal of tent life
+during the twelve or thirteen days the ride lasted. I got
+into Kalgan just two days before the rainy season came
+on (June 15), and having, after difficulty, secured a teacher,
+passed the summer in Kalgan studying the book language
+and practising writing. In October I went up again to
+the grassland and spent some weeks revising my knowledge
+of the colloquial and observing the difference between the
+northern and southern manner of speaking. I finally left<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_72" id="Page_72">[Pg 72]</a></span>
+Mongolia in a furious storm on the morning of November 1,
+and re-entered Peking November 9.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Gilmour on his return was naturally an object of great
+interest to all the missionary and to some of the official
+community. He soon settled down to the study of Chinese,
+and to such mission work as he could usefully engage
+in during the winter at Peking. A letter to the writer,
+under date of January 21, 1872, enables us to realise
+somewhat the life of this period:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'My dear Lovett,&mdash;Though I acknowledged receipt of
+your last welcome epistle, I am aware I owe you a return,
+and here it is ... I have thought that perhaps an account
+of how a Sabbath goes in Peking might not be uninteresting,
+and I'll just confine myself to to-day. Well, this
+morning, on getting up, I found my stove was out. This is
+a very unusual thing, but it just happens once, say, in three
+weeks. The thermometer was about 5°. The first thing
+after getting dressed was not to call my servant, as you
+might suppose, but to go in quest of letters. A mail had
+come in the night before, but I had returned home too
+late last night to see it. So I went over to Dr. Dudgeon's
+house before he was up, prowled about till I found the
+mail, but there was nothing for me. I returned to my
+cold room, and was there till the breakfast-bell rang. I
+board with Edkins, and to go there is a pleasant break in
+the monotony.</p>
+
+<p>'On coming back to my quarters I found the room full
+of smoke, doors and windows open, my boy on his knees
+fussing about the stove, and saying, <i>Moo too poo shing</i>&mdash;"the
+wood won't do." I saw at once that that would not do for
+me, so I buttoned up my coat and went out on to the great
+street for a walk. The street on which we live, the Ha Ta
+Mun (great street), runs north and south, and a cold wind was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_73" id="Page_73">[Pg 73]</a></span>
+blowing down the road, carrying clouds of dust with it.
+Through the dust, however, were visible the paraphernalia
+of two funerals, one going north, the other going south.
+They met just opposite our place. That going south was
+much the grander of the two, and had a long procession of
+people carrying emblematical devices, honorific umbrellas,
+drums, gongs, and musical instruments. Ever and anon
+a man took quantities of paper discs with square holes cut
+in the centre and scattered them to the north wind. The
+papers are supposed to represent cash, and were scrambled
+for eagerly by the urchins, though they could be valuable
+only as waste paper. In the procession also was carried
+the chair in which the deceased used to ride, his mule cart
+also figured conspicuous, and then came the mourners.</p>
+
+<p>'As you know, mourning garb in China is <i>white</i>, and I
+noticed that some of the mourners had adopted a neat
+device. All Chinamen who can afford to be warm in winter
+wear robes lined inside with fur. A rich robe is lined
+with fine material, but the common thing is white lambskin.
+Well, these fellows simply become turn-coats for the
+time, and put on their fur robes inside out, and thus were
+in the fashion. The coffin itself was laid in a magnificent
+bier towering high, surmounted by a gilt top piece, hung
+with silks, and borne by forty-eight bearers.</p>
+
+<p>'Of course everything has to make way for the funeral.
+The Peking streets are very wide, and at the same time very
+narrow. In the centre and high up is a cart road with an
+up and a down line, along the sides of this are ditches and
+holes, beyond these ditches and holes is another way more
+or less passable, and beyond that again the shops. The
+funeral procession took the crown of the road, crept along
+at its snail's pace, while the traffic took to the side roads.</p>
+
+<p>'After a good long walk among stalls and wheelbarrows
+I got back to my abode, found a good fire, and that it was
+high time to go to the Chinese service. I don't understand all<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_74" id="Page_74">[Pg 74]</a></span>
+I hear, but I understand some, and make a point of hearing
+one and sometimes two Chinese sermons on the Sabbath.
+An old Chinaman was preaching, and I could see from the
+manner of the congregation that he was securing the fixed
+attention of his hearers. Before the sermon was ended there
+was a bustle at the door, and in came three Mongols with
+my Chinese card. They were asked to wait till the service
+was concluded, then I took them to my quarters and had
+some conversation with them. One of them had come for
+the doctor, and wished to get cured of so prosaic a disease
+as the itch.</p>
+
+<p>'Before I was finished with them, my servant came to
+say that another Mongol had called for me and was waiting
+for me in Edkins's. When I went over I found an old
+Mongol, a blackman, fifty-eight years of age. This layman
+was named Amäsa, and has been in the habit of paying
+Mr. Edkins visits every winter when he comes down to
+Peking. Last year he did not come, and we were concluding
+that he had died. Of course we were glad to see him. I
+got him into my room and we had quite an afternoon of it.
+The old man knew a good deal about Christianity, and I
+gave him what additional instruction I could. Of all the
+Mongols I have seen he is, perhaps, the most ready to receive
+instruction.</p>
+
+<p>'It was quite late in the afternoon before he left, and I
+had just time to take a walk at sunset and be back in time
+for dinner. Immediately after that the people began to
+assemble for evening service. This is held every Sabbath
+evening in Mr. Edkins's parlour. Upwards of twenty usually
+compose the congregation. The missionaries take the
+service in turn. After service the mass of the congregation
+separated, but one man came with me to my room, and
+there we sat talking till midnight, when my visitor rose to
+depart.</p>
+
+<p>'There, you see, I have given you the history of one<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_75" id="Page_75">[Pg 75]</a></span>
+Sabbath in Peking. It is a pretty fair sample of what goes
+on here very frequently. However, when I find myself free
+on the afternoon I accompany Mr. Edkins to some one of
+the two chapels, which are in distant parts of the city. I do
+not go so much to hear him preach as to have his conversation
+on the way there and back, and, as you may suppose,
+we sometimes stumble upon an argument, and this makes it
+quite lively.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The self-denying and arduous labours of his first sojourn
+in Mongolia had given to James Gilmour a knowledge of
+the language and an acquaintance with the nomadic Mongols
+of the Plain far in excess of that possessed by any
+other European. But even then, as also at a later date, the
+question was raised whether more fruitful work might not
+be done among the agricultural Mongols inhabiting the
+country to the north-east of Peking. Hence, on April 16,
+1872, he started on his first journey through the district in
+which in later years the closing labours of his life were to
+be accomplished. He spent thirty-seven days in this preliminary
+tour, and travelled about 1,000 miles.</p>
+
+<p>Gilmour's first estimate of this region as a field of missionary
+enterprise, expressed on April 25, 1872, remained
+true to the end, even though in later years the exceptional
+difficulties of work among the nomads induced him at last,
+as we shall see, to settle among the agricultural Mongols:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Though I saw a good many Mongol houses, yet I
+must say, I do not feel much drawn to them in preference
+to the nomad Mongols. The only possible recommendation
+I can think of is that, coming among them, I might go
+and put up for some days at a time in a Chinese inn. This
+would save me from great trouble in getting introductions,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_76" id="Page_76">[Pg 76]</a></span>
+and it might be less expensive. The great objection I
+have to them is that, though a mission were established
+among them, it would be more a mission in China than
+anywhere else. The Mongols in these agricultural villages
+speak Chinese to a man, and I cannot help feeling that,
+since there are so many missionaries in Peking speaking
+the Chinese language, these Mongols fall to them, and not
+to me.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Soon after his return from this trip into Eastern Mongolia,
+Mr. Gilmour sent home an elaborate report upon
+the conditions and prospects of the Mongol Mission. He
+deals with the whole question of the work, showing why,
+in his opinion, the <i>agricultural</i> Mongols should be evangelised
+by Chinese missionaries. Mr. Edkins and others
+thought that Gilmour should undertake that labour, but
+after having seen more than any missionary of both regions
+and classes of Mongols, on the ground that he was the
+man 'who had to go and begin,' he decided for the Plain.</p>
+
+<p>Even at this early date Mr. Gilmour urged repeatedly
+and strenuously upon the Directors the pressing need he
+felt for a colleague. And thus early began the long
+series of seeming fatalities that prevented him from ever
+receiving this joy and strength. Partly from the needs of
+the Peking Mission, and partly from respect to a notion
+which the American Board of Foreign Missions had that
+their occupancy of Kalgan, on the extreme southern limit,
+constituted <i>all</i> Mongolia into one of their fields of work,
+the Rev. S. E. Meech, Mr. Gilmour's old college friend, who
+had been designated as his first colleague, was stationed
+at Peking. With reference to this, in closing the report
+above referred to, Gilmour wrote:<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_77" id="Page_77">[Pg 77]</a></span>&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Mr. Meech's perversion from Mongolia to China is
+much to be deplored. I think it would be wrong in me not
+to inform you of the true state of matters, and to remind you
+that it is little short of nonsense to speak of reopening the
+Mongolian Mission so long as there is only one man
+in the field. I am fully aware of the difficulty of finding
+suitable men, and most fully sympathise with you, but
+don't let us delude ourselves with the idea of Mongol
+Mission work progressing till another man or two come
+and put their shoulder to the wheel. All that I can do I
+am quite willing to do, but my own progress is most
+seriously hampered because I am alone.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>His whole subsequent life is evidence of the splendid
+way in which Gilmour justified these words, yet perhaps
+no legitimate blame can be laid at the door of the Directors
+of the London Missionary Society. Both the friends and
+the critics of missions are sometimes more ready to tabulate
+converts than to ponder and estimate aright the difficulties
+and drawbacks of the work. But in any estimate of the
+comparative success and failure of the Mongol Mission it
+should be borne in mind that Gilmour never really had a
+colleague. He never even had a companion for his work
+on the Plain, except his heroic and devoted wife. And in
+later years circumstances over which the Directors could
+exercise little or no control successively deprived him of
+the fellowship, after a very brief experience, of Dr. Roberts
+and Dr. Smith.</p>
+
+<p>In the summer of this year, in the company of Mr.
+Edkins, he visited the sacred city of Woo T'ai Shan, a
+famous place of Mongol pilgrimage.</p>
+
+<p>An amusing illustration of his well-known love of argument
+occurred on this trip. In Mr. Edkins he found a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_78" id="Page_78">[Pg 78]</a></span>
+foeman in all respects worthy of his dialectic steel.
+Chinese mules will only travel in single file, even where
+the roads are wide enough to allow of their travelling
+abreast, and as Gilmour's went in front of that ridden by
+Mr. Edkins, he used to ride with his face to the tail of his
+beast, and thus the more readily and continuously conduct
+the argument then engaging their attention.</p>
+
+<p>In November he tried the experiment of living at the
+Yellow Temple in Peking during the winter, in order that
+he might meet and converse with the numerous Mongols
+who visit the capital every year. Here he not only made
+new friends, but he also frequently renewed acquaintance
+with those he had met on the Plain. These visited him
+in his compound, and were occasionally a weariness and
+vexation to him, inasmuch as they very frequently severely
+tried his patience, without affording him the comfort of
+knowing that the good tidings of the 'Jesus book' were
+finding an entrance into their dark minds and hard hearts.</p>
+
+<p>In a letter to an intimate college friend, the Rev. T. T.
+Matthews of Madagascar, which he wrote, November 21,
+1872, he vividly describes this part of his work, giving some
+of his typical experiences:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I am writing in the Yellow Temple, about a mile and
+a half from Peking, and three or four miles from our mission
+premises. I have rented a room, brought my Chinaman
+servant, and live as a Chinaman, all but the clothes and the
+paganism. The reason of all this is that near here, and in
+this temple, numerous Mongols put up when they come
+from Mongolia to Peking. Our premises being three or
+four miles away, and in a busy part of the town, the
+Mongols can't easily find our place; so if they can't come<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_79" id="Page_79">[Pg 79]</a></span>
+to me I just go to them. I came here yesterday, and
+can't tell yet how I may get on. Mongols are shy in
+Peking, and even out here a little difficult of access; but I
+must do what I can, and have patience.</p>
+
+<p>'Just now a company of eight or ten have arrived and
+put up, three or four of them in the same court with me,
+the others in a place close by. These are likely enough
+to come to see me; of course I'll go and see them. You in
+Madagascar, I suppose, can't realise what it is to be a
+missionary to a people whom you can't approach without
+difficulty. Here the difficulty does not end; those I can
+catch don't care one straw for Christianity. They have a
+system which quite satisfies them, and what more do they
+want? Such is their feeling, so you see I have got quite
+plenty to do; a hard enough task, even the human part of
+it. But don't mistake, I am not bewailing my lot, for that
+I have neither time nor inclination; I am only telling you
+about my state.</p>
+
+<p>'I don't believe much in people talking about what they
+mean to do in the future, but perhaps you will permit me
+to say that I would like to start for Mongolia again in
+February or March. I have got a sheepskin coat, so need
+not fear the cold. I perhaps may take with me a stock of
+made-up medicines for specific diseases which are common,
+and this may make an introduction in some cases at least.
+Dr. Dudgeon has on our premises in Peking a hospital well
+attended by Chinamen, and I go there sometimes and see
+how he doses them.</p>
+
+<p>'Now let me tell you a little about the inner life of
+Mongols. People travelling through Mongolia wake up in
+the morning as their camel-cart passes some rural encampment;
+they rub their eyes and say, "How pleasant it would
+be to live in Mongolia like these Mongols, free from care
+and the anxiety of busy life. They have only their sheep,
+&amp;c., to look after." This reflection is accompanied with a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_80" id="Page_80">[Pg 80]</a></span>
+sigh when they reflect on their own hard lot. Now the
+fact of the matter is, these travellers know nothing about it.
+They may print as much as they like about the pastoral
+felicity of the simplicity of Mongol life; it is all humbug.
+Last night, two Mongols whom I know well, a petty chief
+named "Myriad Joy" and his scribe named "Mahabul"
+(I can't translate this last), came into my room, and we
+had a tea-spree there and then. The two have been for
+fifteen days in Peking on Government duty, and last night
+their business was finished, and they were to mount their
+camels and head north this morning. The chief gets
+from Peking about 30<i>l.</i> a year, the scribe about 4<i>l.</i>; and
+when they come thus on duty their allowances, though
+small, enable them to make a little over and above their
+salaries. The chief can stand no small amount of Chinese
+whisky. I suspect he is deep in debt, and am sure that he
+could pay his debt two or three times over if he only had
+the money it took to paint his nose. The scribe was one
+of my teachers in Mongolia. I lived in his house some
+time, and know only too well about his affairs. He is
+hopelessly in debt. He had a large family once, but now
+they are all dead except one married daughter and one
+lama son about seventeen years of age, and good for nothing.
+His "old woman," as the Mongol idiom has it, is still alive,
+and fond of whisky, like her husband. If they had only been
+teetotalers they might have now been comfortable; such, at
+least, is my impression. I shall say nothing about what I
+saw in his tent, and confine myself to last night and this
+morning.</p>
+
+<p>'Drinking my tea last night, Mahabul (the scribe) says
+to me: "My chief here won't lend me nine shillings to buy
+a sheepskin coat for my old woman, therefore she must
+be frozen to death in the winter; my chief won't lend <i>me</i>
+anything, other people he lends." The chief said nothing
+for a while; but the scribe went on harping on this string, till<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_81" id="Page_81">[Pg 81]</a></span>
+at last the chief launched out right and left on his scribe,
+shouting loud enough for all the compound to hear. The
+scribe took it coolly, and stopped him, saying: "Enough,
+enough; it is past, it is past; my old woman can die, all die;
+no matter." This did not soothe the irate chief at all, and
+a minute or two later a furious quarrel broke out between
+them about something else. The storm raged a long time,
+and in my room too, while they were my guests! After
+some time the scribe left the room to attend to the camels,
+when the chief confided to me his opinion of his scribe.
+Later the chief left the room, and the scribe confided to me
+his opinion of his chief; and I must say that the two seemed
+well matched, with very little to choose between. The
+freedom with which they spoke of each other was partly to
+be accounted for by the fact that both were more or less
+drunk.</p>
+
+<p>'The chief squared up his accounts with the people
+about here, and showed me in the scribe's absence a small
+parcel of silver which he had reserved for use on the road.
+He showed it me under strict injunctions not to tell the
+scribe. The scribe had more difficulty in squaring up <i>his</i>
+account. The last item that stuck in his throat was a little
+bill his son had left. This son had started a day or two
+before, and of course the father was responsible for the
+debt. How he was to pay it he did not know, as he had
+not a single cash about him. The Chinaman of the place
+threatened to detain him, and the scribe laughed a bitter
+laugh at the idea. After a great row they went off to
+sleep.</p>
+
+<p>'This morning early the scribe was at me before I was
+dressed. It was the small debt again. The Chinaman
+knew better than to seize the man; that would not have
+paid; he seized his coat, and actually was detaining that
+as ransom for a sum equal to fourpence English! He
+made a direct appeal to me to pay it, and of course I did it;<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_82" id="Page_82">[Pg 82]</a></span>
+though I was a little disgusted with the man's meanness, as
+I had given him a present of money amounting to about
+1<i>l.</i> a few days before. This son of his is a great eyesore
+to me. He is a young lama, about as wicked a boy as I
+know. His brothers died of consumption, and this fact
+enables him to do anything he likes with his parents. If
+they refuse anything, he has only to feign sickness, and they
+are in a huge state over him. He is a thoroughly bad lad.
+Will not work, will not study, will do nothing but make
+trouble and expense for his parents. Just fancy! His
+father and mother are poor as church mice; and when his
+father was coming to Peking the boy must beg to come too,
+and the father like a fool must take him, and be at great
+expense for travelling, &amp;c. One thing made me furious.
+Out of the money I gave him he spent about 4<i>s.</i> or more
+buying his good-for-nothing son an elegant snuff-bottle.
+In short, the man's folly makes it utterly useless to help
+him. I once before relieved him from threatened detention
+for debt for the amount of twopence-halfpenny, just
+after I had made him a present, and I expect perhaps to
+have to do so again. What astonishes me is that the
+Mongols <i>can</i> get into debt so far. I don't believe my
+Mongol can pass a single man he knows without being in
+danger of being dunned for some hopeless debt or other.
+And yet his debt does not seem to distress him. He is
+most distressed because people will not lend him more
+money.</p>
+
+<p>'The last of the chiefs was rather rich. He is (he says)
+to have a profitable piece of Government work in hand
+in spring, and on the strength of that wanted me to lend
+him now a shoe of silver, about 15<i>l.</i>, to be repaid to me in
+spring. Of course I did not. He then, though my guest,
+kept on saying, "Heart small, heart small," which pretty
+much amounts to saying, "Coward, coward." He finally
+took revenge by offering to lend <i>me</i> a shoe of silver in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_83" id="Page_83">[Pg 83]</a></span>
+spring, but of course I declined. A pretty pair they are!
+If what they say be true, in spring they may make a good
+thing of it; but this has happened to the scribe before, and
+in two months after he was as poor as ever. In short, they
+are foolish and thriftless.</p>
+
+<p>'While I have been writing this letter I have overheard
+my Chinese servant saying, in reply to a question from a
+Chinaman, "There is such a thing as a preaching letter: you
+can preach by a letter." So I am going now to preach.
+Don't get weary; stick to it. Don't be lazy, but don't
+be in a hurry. Slow but sure; stick to it. We have no
+great effort to make, but rather to stick to it patiently. "<i>No
+good work is lost</i>," Sir William Thomson used to say in
+his philosophy class, and it is eminently true in our case.
+(I wish these Chinamen would hold their tongue.) All
+our good work will be found, there is no doubt about that.
+All I am afraid of is that our good work will amount to
+little when it is found. (These Chinamen are a bore.)
+I sometimes think that if all we say be true, as it is, that
+men at last shall stand before God&mdash;and we shall see them
+after they know that all we say is true&mdash;and they will pitch
+into us for not pitching into them more savagely; for not,
+in fact, taking them by the "cuff" of the neck and dragging
+them into the kingdom of God. I speak now of our
+countrymen and foreigners. As regards heathen, they too
+shall stand revealed; and their mud gods also, and rotten
+superstitions, shall stand revealed: how then shall we feel
+when they shall look at us and blame us for not waking them
+up more vigorously? An infidel has said that if he could
+believe that men's future state depended at all upon what
+was done in this life, he would let nothing hinder him from
+being up and at men. He would be content to be counted
+a madman&mdash;anything, if only he could do anything to make
+men's state better in the world to come. (I wish these
+Chinamen would shut up; I came here to meet Mongols,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_84" id="Page_84">[Pg 84]</a></span>
+and I am like to be flooded out by Chinamen whose language
+I only half understand.)</p>
+
+<p>'Now, <i>we believe</i>: how much do we do? Are there not
+some men whom we might stir up who now escape? Could
+we do more? Are not souls valuable enough for us to
+face anything if only we can save some? Let us look to
+the end, or rather let us look at the present. In the room
+in which I now write (the Chinamen have gone) is Jesus,
+where you read this is Jesus: He stands and looks to us.
+He has given up the clean heaven, and walked here and
+lived among dirt and poverty, in solitude, misunderstood,
+without one intelligent friend; He has borne the scorn of
+men, He has been put to the horrible and shameful death
+of the cross, <i>all to save us</i> and others. We trust Him, He
+saves us; and all He asks is that we should tell men about
+what He has done; and is there one man we meet to whom
+we shall not speak? shall Christ look to us in vain to declare
+simply what He has done? Perish the thought! Whatever
+may be between us and speaking to men, let us go through
+it. If it be a foreign language, remember Christ lived thirty
+years in preparation. If it be hardship, cold, poor food,
+scorn, slight, deaf ears&mdash;never mind, go ahead. Christ looks
+to us to go ahead, or <i>come</i> ahead, for He has gone through
+it all. Trouble, hardship, trial, suffering,&mdash;all will soon pass
+and be done. And is there a trouble or hardship we have
+yet surmounted for Christ's sake that does not seem sweet
+to look back on? Then, come what likes, let us face it; or,
+if we be overwhelmed, let us be overwhelmed with undaunted
+faces looking in the right direction. By the mercy of God
+may we be saved; and if saved how splendid it will be&mdash;no
+trouble, no trial, no indigestible beef and brick-tea: everything
+<i>better than</i> we could wish it, and complete joy.</p>
+
+<p>'All this is not imagination or rhetoric, but <i>really before</i>
+us; so, by the strength which Christ gives, let us go on to
+it. Pray for me. I pray for you; and if we don't meet<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_85" id="Page_85">[Pg 85]</a></span>
+on earth, you know the trysting-place, "<i>the right-hand
+side</i>."'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>It can readily be seen that, under conditions of the kind
+sketched in this letter, time was not likely to hang heavily
+on his hands. Interviews like the following were held from
+time to time, and were not only encouraging and hopeful
+but reacted strongly upon his own heart and brain:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'This afternoon (Sabbath, November 24), I met
+Toobshing Baier in the dispensary of the London Mission
+Hospital. At first I could not remember the man. The
+face I knew. After a time his name came out without, I
+flatter myself, his perceiving that I was fishing for it.
+He was most anxious to see the doctor's medical instruments
+and appliances. After he had seen quite a number
+of these, he came to my room, and we sat down for a
+talk which lasted nearly from 5 to 7 o'clock. He began
+by reading a part of the rough draft of the new translation
+of St. Matthew in Mongolian, which happened
+to be lying on my table. He suggested that in place of
+"prophet," a word which has been transferred bodily, we
+should use <i>juoug beelikty</i>. He also remarked that our
+translation of "the foal of an ass" was not the thing, and
+gave the word he thought was right. He was accompanied
+by a young lama, who agreed with him in this suggestion.
+The lama seemed well up, read Mongolian as easily as
+Toobshing himself, and when Toobshing gave the Thibetan
+word for <i>juoug beelikty</i>, the lama looked over his shoulder,
+spied a book on a shelf, took it, found the place at once,
+and showed me the Thibetan and Mongolian side by
+side.</p>
+
+<p>'Shortly after this Toobshing set himself up and proposed
+questions and cases such as:</p>
+
+<p>'"Is hell eternal?<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_86" id="Page_86">[Pg 86]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'"Are all the heathen who have not heard the Gospel
+damned?</p>
+
+<p>'"If a man lives without sin, is he damned?</p>
+
+<p>'"If a man disregards Christ, but worships a supreme
+God in an indefinite way, is he saved or not?</p>
+
+<p>'"How can Christ save a man?</p>
+
+<p>'"If a man prays to Christ to save him morn and even,
+but goes on sinning meantime, how about him?</p>
+
+<p>'"If a man prays for a thing, does he get it?</p>
+
+<p>'"Do your unbelieving countrymen in England all go to
+hell?</p>
+
+<p>'"Are there prophets now?</p>
+
+<p>'"Is a new-born child a sinner?</p>
+
+<p>'"Is one man then punished for another's fault?</p>
+
+<p>'"Has anybody died, gone to heaven or hell, and come
+back to report? [A Mongol has!]</p>
+
+<p>'"Did Buddha live?" and so forth.</p>
+
+<p>'[Answer, He lived, but did not do what is now said of
+him.]</p>
+
+<p>'"If so, how do you know that the account of Christ is
+not made up in the same way? Could not the disciples
+conspire to make the Gospels?</p>
+
+<p>'To these and all other questions I endeavoured to give
+proper answers; and this, our most delightful and profitable
+talk, lasted till there was just time for me to snatch a
+hasty meal before the usual service at 7.30 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span>'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Discussions of this nature were calculated to deepen
+thought and to promote heart-searching on the part of the
+Christian worker. They also illustrate some of the special
+difficulties which missionaries in China and India have
+to meet. With an elaborate religious ritual and literature,
+both Buddhist and Hindu can often, and do often, object
+against Christianity many of those, sometimes obvious,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_87" id="Page_87">[Pg 87]</a></span>
+sometimes subtle, difficulties which the Gospel of Jesus
+Christ alone can remove, and which it removes by sanctifying
+and dominating the heart.</p>
+
+<p>In February 1873 Gilmour visited Tientsin for the
+first time since he passed through it on his arrival in China.
+Here he took part in several readings, temperance meetings,
+and religious services. At one of the readings:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'One joke happened. I was asked to give a recitation at
+a penny reading for sailors. The piece was "The Execution
+of Montrose." I got up in tragic style, said,</p>
+
+<p class="center">
+"Come hither, Evan Cameron,"
+</p>
+
+<p>with the appropriate beckoning action, when a sailor in
+the middle of the audience responded to the call, pressed
+his way out of the passage, and was making for the platform.
+I could not stand this, so I uttered a yell, and rushed off
+to hide myself, and it was some time before the audience
+and speaker could compose themselves for a fresh start
+Next day we were told that the unfortunate sailor was
+beckoned to come hither from all parts of the ship.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_88" id="Page_88">[Pg 88]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_IV" id="CHAPTER_IV"></a>CHAPTER IV</h2>
+
+<h3>THE FIRST CAMPAIGN IN MONGOLIA</h3>
+
+
+<p>In 1873 Gilmour resumed his visits to the Plain and on
+March 15 he was at Kalgan, writing, 'No appearance of
+getting away to the north. I promenade daily the streets
+and accost Mongols, but with no success as to getting
+camels, or even a horse to hire as far as Mahabul's. A day
+or two later Mahabul arrived in Kalgan on his way to
+Peking, and by his aid Gilmour secured two camels, and
+on March 24 he started north, reaching Mahabul's tent on
+the 28th. He at once endeavoured to secure the services
+of a Mongol named Lojing, and the usual series of delays
+and vexations occurred.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'To-day (March 29) I got impatient and went for a
+walk. Came back, and Lojing came and said he would
+go. Felt relieved; he wants me to come back this way,
+and I consent, though I would rather not. He came back
+in the afternoon, saying that he could not get off his
+engagement to read prayers with some other lama for
+Gichik's soul,<a name="FNanchor_3_3" id="FNanchor_3_3"></a><a href="#Footnote_3_3" class="fnanchor">[3]</a> so that we cannot start before Thursday at
+noon. Mahabul's wife gave him some whisky, and he went
+to the officers and got drunk. He waited for a camel which
+was offered for sale. The camel came when I was out.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_89" id="Page_89">[Pg 89]</a></span>
+He was drunk, did not watch it, so it drifted away before
+the storm. A boy on horseback was sent after it. When
+it came it was a perfect object, yet they asked twenty taels
+for it. He is to go after a camel to-morrow. He was so
+drunk that, remembering Gichik's fate, I am uneasy to
+think of his riding my tall camel. O Lord, give me
+patience!'</p></blockquote>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_3_3" id="Footnote_3_3"></a><a href="#FNanchor_3_3"><span class="label">[3]</span></a> The son of the chief referred to on <a href="#Page_80">page 80</a>, who had recently been
+killed by a fall from his horse.</p></div>
+
+<p>This and the three subsequent journeys over the Plain,
+made in the course of 1873, were full of incident illustrative
+of the difficulties of the work, the peculiarities of the people,
+and the restless energy and indomitable perseverance of the
+missionary. But the limitations of space forbid us to
+linger; we extract a few notes from the diary. It was on
+the second of these journeys, while at Lama Miao, that he
+witnessed the 'Mirth of Hell,' as he calls it, described in
+<i>Among the Mongols</i>, Chapter XI.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>April 19, 1873.</i>&mdash;To-day had more provocation from
+my Mongol, and my earnest prayer is that I may be able
+to stand it all, and not get soured in temper and feeling
+against the Mongols. I must have patience. Some
+knowledge of camel's flesh also would help me not a
+little. As it stands, I feel an incompetent "duffer."'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>May 6.</i>&mdash;Travelled parallel to the road in a stupid
+manner over hill and dale, because Lojing chose to consider
+it a nearer way. The way was no nearer at all and much more
+steep. At last got to a lot of tents down in a hollow,
+called the "Great Water" (<i>Ihha Osso</i>). Had quite a lot
+of people. One lama the most provoking child (25 years
+old) I think I ever met. He was a perfect nuisance; even
+the tone of his voice I could not abide. This individual
+came to my tent even after I was down in bed. I was glad
+he was done for once. Next morning he was in my tent<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_90" id="Page_90">[Pg 90]</a></span>
+before I was up, remarking, "What a great sleeper you
+are!' Last night he had remarked, "How early you go to
+bed!" I am afraid he is the most empty, poor fellow I
+have known.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>May 13.</i>&mdash;To-day also occurred another of my lama's
+conspicuous stupidities; after asking the road to a set of
+tents where dwelt friends of his own, he suddenly left the
+road and began the ascent of a steep hill. I asked where
+he was going. He said to the tents. I followed some
+distance, and then from the convergence of paths judged
+that there was no pass where he was going, and accordingly
+shouted to him to stop. Stop he did, and also looked
+thunder. I asked him, "Have you travelled this way
+before?" "No," said he. "Come this way, and follow
+the road." "You go that road," said he, "I go this road."
+"Nothing of the kind," said I. "You come here, and we'll
+get to tents." He came; but then and there began one of
+his intolerable tirades against me, saying how disobedient I
+was, and that <i>this was his own native place</i>, he knew. What
+a bad man I was! He had hardly finished his fury when
+lo, behold, close before us, right in our path, the very tents
+we were looking for! He is, to use a Mongol idiom,
+"Stupider than stupid."'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>Sept. 12.</i>&mdash;We are now in a diphtheria district. I go
+into it, and hope to remain some time, trusting myself to
+the hands of God. I am safe enough in His hands. If He
+can forward mission work more by my death than by my
+life, His will be done.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>Sept. 18.</i>&mdash;To-day let pass me, as all were starting
+from the temple, about six men and three women without
+telling them of Jesus.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>At the close of the year Mr. Gilmour sent home another
+elaborate report, a large portion of which appeared in the
+<i>Chronicle of the London Missionary Society</i> for December<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_91" id="Page_91">[Pg 91]</a></span>
+1874. We extract here a few paragraphs not then printed
+for obvious reasons. There was still a difficulty with the
+American Board, and there was still in London some
+inability to grasp the exact bearing and the full needs of
+the situation. The first extract is given here simply because
+it illustrates the noble unselfishness of Gilmour's
+character, and the way in which he persistently refused to
+be stopped by hindrances that would have barred the
+road against most men. He supplied a statement of
+account showing that even with the most rigid economy
+he had exceeded his allowance by 110 taels, equivalent to
+from 25<i>l.</i> to 30<i>l.</i></p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'This leaves me with a deficit of 110 taels 63 cents, and
+explains how it is that I ask next year's (1874) grant to
+be raised to 150 taels at least. I had only two courses
+open to me, either to use up the grants for 1872 and 1873,
+and stop without accomplishing all I could, or to make
+full proof of my ministry and exceed the grants. Considering
+the cause more important than silver, I chose the
+latter course, and, despite the most rigid economy, exceeded
+to the above amount. Present circumstances enable me
+to make up the deficit from my own private purse, and I
+don't ask to be refunded, but I don't know that I shall be
+flush of money next year, and <i>do</i> ask that the grant may
+be not less than 150 taels, which is the lowest estimate I
+can make.</p>
+
+<p>'As proof of the reasonableness of my request, and of
+my anxiety to avoid drawing on the funds of the Society
+beyond what is absolutely necessary, I may be allowed to
+state that this year, in addition to making up the lacking
+110-63 taels, I walked afoot behind my caravan in the
+desert for <i>weeks</i>, to avoid the expense of purchasing another
+camel.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_92" id="Page_92">[Pg 92]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>On the question of Christian literature he placed on
+record some wise words, as needful now almost as when
+he penned them, in order to correct the notion that it
+is enough simply to place into the hands of a heathen a
+copy of the Word of God in his native tongue. The reply
+of Candace's eunuch, 'How can I understand unless someone
+shall guide me?' meets the missionary of to-day, as it
+met Philip in the days of old. The practically unanimous
+opinion of the Shanghai Conference held in 1890 shows
+that the same need is still strongly felt by the missionaries
+of all the societies.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'In addition to the Scriptures and the Catechism, I
+think small simple books containing little portions of Scripture
+history or little portions of Scripture teaching would be
+very useful. The Bible is all very well for those who have
+advanced a little, but there is very little of the narrative
+portions even&mdash;the simplest parts of the whole book&mdash;which
+you can read without encountering terrible names
+of persons or places, or quotations from the prophet Isaiah
+or Jeremiah. When a Mongol comes upon these he feels
+inclined to give up in despair. Even in China my experience
+has been that people are slow to buy a complete
+gospel, even at less than the paper on which it is printed
+costs, while they will buy with avidity very small books at
+almost their full value.</p>
+
+<p>'Chinamen themselves notice this, and when surrounded
+by a crowd I have heard them remark laughingly,
+"Small books go quick." Remembering my instructions,
+which among other things say, "Pause before you translate,"
+I have hitherto refrained, but now have a very small
+illustrated narrative in the press, another also illustrated in
+manuscript, and other two not illustrated in contemplation.
+If I find funds&mdash;the Peking branch of the Tract Society is<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_93" id="Page_93">[Pg 93]</a></span>
+bankrupt just now&mdash;and get them out, you shall have specimens.
+Probably they won't look well, being first attempts,
+but you need not be ashamed of the Mongol of them, as they
+have been written under my direction by a "crack" native
+scholar, and carefully revised by Schereschewsky, who is a
+general linguist of good ability, and has paid so much
+attention to Mongolian that he revised the Gospel by
+Matthew in conjunction with Mr. Edkins, and is at present
+at work on a Mongol dictionary.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Medical missions were only in their infancy in 1874, and
+Gilmour in the same report describes what many another
+has felt. He illustrates also one of his fixed principles,
+viz., always do <i>something</i>; and never let the work stop
+simply because you cannot do what is ideally the best.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I know very little about diseases and cures, but the
+little I <i>do</i> know is extremely useful. Almost every Mongol,
+man and woman and child, has something that wants putting
+right. To have studied medicine at home would have
+been a great help, but though I cannot hope now ever to
+gain a scientific knowledge of the subject, I am glad that in
+our hospital here I have a good opportunity of learning
+much from Dr. Dudgeon, and all I can do now is to make
+the best of this good opportunity. I am told that professional
+men at home are suspicious of giving a little
+medical knowledge to young men going out as missionaries.
+I sided with them till I came here, but here the case is
+different. At home it is all very well to stand before the
+fire in your room, within sight of the brass plate on the
+doctor's door on the opposite side of the street, and talk
+about the danger of little knowledge; but when you are
+two weeks' journey from any assistance, and see your
+fellow-traveller sitting silent and swollen with violent toothache
+for days together, you fervently wish you had a pair<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_94" id="Page_94">[Pg 94]</a></span>
+of forceps and the <i>dangerous</i> amount of knowledge. And
+when in remote places you have the choice of burying
+your servant or stopping his diarrh&oelig;a, would you prefer
+to talk nonsense about professional skill rather than give
+him a dose of chlorodyne, even though it should be at the
+risk of administering one drop more or less than a man
+who writes M.D. to his name would have done?</p>
+
+<p>'I speak earnestly and from experience. No one has
+more detestation than I have for the quack that patters
+in the presence of trained skill; but from what I have seen
+and known of mission life, both in myself and others, since
+coming to North China, I think it is a little less than
+culpable homicide to deny a little hospital training to men
+who may have to pass weeks and months of their lives in
+places where they themselves, or those about them, may
+sicken and die from curable diseases before the doctor could
+be summoned, even supposing he could leave his post and
+come.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>During the summer of 1874 James Gilmour continued
+his itinerating work among the nomads of the Plain. He
+met with much to discourage him, but he steadily enlarged
+his knowledge of the people and his acquaintance with the
+best methods of work among them. How difficult it was
+to adapt ordinary methods of teaching to their habits may
+be judged from the following sketch:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'My tent is not only my dwelling-house and dispensary,
+but also my chapel. I always endeavour to instruct the
+visitors and patients as far as I can. Preaching to Mongols
+is a little different from preaching at home&mdash;a little different
+from preaching in China even. You can get a congregation
+of heathen Chinese to listen for, say, twenty minutes, or half
+an hour, or even longer; but begin to preach to a lot of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_95" id="Page_95">[Pg 95]</a></span>
+Mongols, and they begin to talk to each other, or perhaps
+to ask you questions about your dress and your country.</p>
+
+<p>'The nature of their own service is partly to blame for
+this. When a Mongol sends for a lama or two to read
+prayers in his tent, the inmates, though present, don't think
+it necessary to attend much to what is going on. Though
+they did attend, they would not be able to understand, so
+talking goes on among them pretty much as usual. If I
+were to stick myself up and begin, and start off sermonising
+to them, I would be treated much as they treat their own
+lamas; so I confine my preaching to conversations and
+arguments&mdash;a style of teaching which I find secures their
+attention'.</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Many, too, are the sketches in his letters and diaries of
+the men he met. They are all drawn with that remarkable
+and largely unconscious power, which he possessed so
+fully, of being able to see very vividly the striking points
+and details of passing events, and of enabling those to
+whom he wrote, by his aptly chosen words, also to see
+exactly what passed before his eyes. One or two out of
+many examples must suffice:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'This season (1874) I met a deaf and dumb man. He
+was uneducated, but of great quickness and intelligence. He
+could converse easily and readily with his fellow-Mongols
+by signs, and I could ask many simple questions and
+understand his answers without trouble. His perception
+was remarkable. While sitting in the dusk outside my
+tent, a messenger came from his father's tent to tell him
+that some of the sheep were missing. A single turn of
+the hand followed by a glance around, as if searching
+for something, was all that was required. He had
+been sitting quietly in the circle, looking at us talking; but
+the moment the communication was made he uttered an<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_96" id="Page_96">[Pg 96]</a></span>
+inarticulate sound betraying great excitement, knocked
+the ashes out of his pipe, stuck it into his boot, threw himself
+into the saddle, and rode off into the gathering darkness
+to search for the lost sheep. All agreed that he had
+an extra share of intelligence, and he was evidently regarded
+as a capable and useful member of the community.</p>
+
+<p>'One of the sad sights seen was that of a sick Chinaman
+near his end. He was one of a company of four, who went
+about dressing skins of which the Mongols make garments.
+He had been an opium taker, and an incurable diarrh&oelig;a
+had seized him. At the time he was lodging with the
+Mongol for whom the party had come to dress skins; but
+the Mongol, seeing he would die, and fearing trouble and
+expense over his death, ordered him off the premises.
+Borrowing an ox cart, his companions had him conveyed
+away some five or ten miles, jolted in the rude vehicle and
+suffering from the blazing sun, to a place where some
+Chinese acquaintances were digging a well. They had a
+tent of their own, most likely a poor ragged white cloth
+affair, open to the winds and pervious to the rain; and in
+this the poor man hoped he might be permitted to die. It
+was the dark side of the picture. The glorious summer, the
+green and flowery plains, the fattening flocks, the herds exulting
+in the deep pastures, the gay Mongols riding about, the
+white tents bathed in the sunlight and gleaming from afar.
+In the midst of all this, a feeble man, far from home and kin,
+sick unto death, cast forth from his poor lodging, and seeking
+for a place to lie down and die in. The Mongols are a
+hospitable race, but pray ye that ye may not get sick on
+their hands.</p>
+
+<p>'On the whole I have been very well received everywhere,
+and have been treated with great confidence. I have
+sometimes wondered at the readiness with which they take
+medicine from the hand of an utter stranger. One reason
+why they are ready to trust me, doubtless, is that going<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_97" id="Page_97">[Pg 97]</a></span>
+among them, they can go round my tent and see that
+there is nothing secret and terrible behind it; they enter
+it and see all that is in it. They know and see that I am
+utterly in their power, and, perhaps, reason that I am there
+with no intent to harm, because if I made trouble I could
+not move another step without their consent.</p>
+
+<p>'In the shape of converts I have seen no result. I have
+not, as far as I am aware, seen any one who even <i>wanted</i>
+to be a Christian; but by healing their diseases I have had
+opportunity to tell many of Jesus, the Great Physician.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_98" id="Page_98">[Pg 98]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_V" id="CHAPTER_V"></a>CHAPTER V</h2>
+
+<h3>MARRIAGE</h3>
+
+
+<p>During the year 1873 James Gilmour devoted much
+thought to the natural and all-important question of
+marriage. Uncommon as he was, in so many ways, it
+was, perhaps, to be expected that in this great undertaking
+he would depart from ordinary methods. The Rev. S. E.
+Meech had married, in 1872, Miss Prankard, of London.
+After the return of Mr. Edkins to England, in May 1873,
+Mr. Gilmour went to board with Mr. and Mrs. Meech.
+There he saw the portrait of Mrs. Meech's sister, and often
+heard her referred to in conversation. Towards the close
+of 1873 he took Mrs. Meech into his confidence, and asked
+permission to enter into correspondence with her sister.
+The following most characteristic letters show the course of
+subsequent events:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Peking, January 14, 1874.&nbsp;&nbsp;
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Parents,&mdash;I have written and proposed to a
+girl in England. It is true I have never seen her and I
+know very little about her; but what I do know is good.
+She is the sister of Mrs. Meech, and is with her mother in
+London. Her mother supports herself and daughter by keeping
+a school. One of the hindrances will be perhaps that
+the mother will not be willing to part with her daughter,
+as she is, no doubt, the life of the school. I don't know,
+so I have written and made the offer, and leave them to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_99" id="Page_99">[Pg 99]</a></span>
+decide. If she cannot come, then there is no harm done.
+If she can arrange to come, then my hope is fulfilled. If
+the young lady says "Yes," she or her friends will no doubt
+write you, as I have asked them to do.... You may think
+I am rash in writing to a girl I have never seen. If you
+say so, I may just say that I have something of the same
+feeling; but what am I to do? In addition I am very easy-minded
+over it all, because I have exercised the best of my
+thoughts on the subject, and put the whole matter into the
+hands of God, asking Him, if it be best to bring her, if it be
+not best to keep her away, and He can manage the whole
+thing well.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>By some mischance this letter was delayed, and Mr.
+Gilmour's relatives were startled, one March day in 1874,
+by receiving from an entirely unknown lady in London a
+letter, containing the unlooked-for statement: 'Your son, Mr.
+Gilmour, of Peking, has asked my daughter to write to you,
+telling you of her decision to join him as his wife. She
+has wished me to write to you for her, and will be pleased
+to hear from you when you feel inclined to write.'</p>
+
+<p>The friendly intercourse that followed soon convinced
+Mr. Gilmour's family, as any knowledge of Emily Prankard
+herself soon convinced all who made her acquaintance, that,
+however unusual it might appear, this was indeed one of the
+marriages made in heaven. By both parties God's blessing
+and guidance were invoked, upon both His benediction
+rested, and, after a brief separation in this world, they are
+now both enriched with the fuller knowledge and the
+perfect joy of the life beyond.</p>
+
+<p>No time was lost in the arrangements for Miss Prankard's
+departures to China. In a letter to his mother, dated
+October 2, 1874, Mr. Gilmour writes:<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_100" id="Page_100">[Pg 100]</a></span>&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'You have seen Miss Prankard, but you have not told
+me what you think of her. She was delighted with her
+visit to Scotland and with you all. You will be glad to
+hear that I have had some delightful letters from her. I
+wrote her, and she has written me in the most unrestrained
+way concerning her spiritual hopes and condition,
+and though we have never seen each other, yet we know
+more of each other's inmost life and soul than, I am quite
+certain, most lovers know of each other even after long
+personal courtship. It is quite delightful to think that
+even now we can talk by letter with perfect unreserve, and
+I tell <i>you</i> this because I know you will be glad to hear it.
+I knew she was a pious girl, else I would not have asked
+her to come out to be a missionary's wife, but she turns
+out better even than I thought, and I am not much afraid
+as to how we shall get on together.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In the course of the autumn of 1874 Miss Prankard
+sailed, and in a letter to the writer, December 13, 1874,
+Gilmour thus refers to the close of his unusual but satisfactory
+courtship:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I was married last week, Tuesday, December 8!</p>
+
+<p>'Mrs. Meech's sister is Mrs. Gilmour. We never saw
+each other till a week before we were married, and my
+friends here drew long faces and howled at me for being
+rash and inconsiderate. What if you don't like each
+other? How then? It is for life! As if I did not know
+all this long ago. Well, the time came, the vessel was due
+at Shanghai, but would not come. Mr. Meech and I went
+down to Tientsin and waited there a fortnight, but no
+tidings. At last on the evening of Sabbath, November
+29, a steamer's whistle was heard miles away down the
+river. It was Mr. Meech's turn to preach. After sermon
+he and I walked away down the river side to see what we<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_101" id="Page_101">[Pg 101]</a></span>
+could see. After a while a light hove round the last bend,
+then a green light, then the red light, then came the three
+lights of the steamer! We listened. It was the high-pressure
+engine of the steam launch which is used to lighten
+the deep-sea steamers before coming up the narrow river.
+Fifteen minutes more and she was at the landing stage.
+A friend went on board. Miss Prankard was on board the
+Taku, which was still outside the bar, waiting for water to
+bring her over and up to the settlement. The lighter was
+going to unload and start down the river at five <span class="smcap">A.M.</span>, and
+Meech and I went in her. About eight <span class="smcap">A.M.</span> we met the
+steamer coming up, and when she came abreast we saw
+Miss Prankard on board, but could not get from our
+vessel to hers. The tide was favourable for running up,
+and they were afraid to lose a minute, so would not stop
+the steamer; we did not get on board till we reached the
+bund at Tientsin about eleven <span class="smcap">A.M.</span> We started for Peking
+next day, got there on Thursday, and were married following
+Tuesday.</p>
+
+<p>'Our honeymoon is now almost over. I am to have
+only a week of it. I hope to start with Meech on a
+mission trip to the country on Tuesday next.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Miss Prankard's first view of her future husband was
+hardly what she might have expected. Mr. Meech has
+also sketched that scene on the river.</p>
+
+<p>'The morning was cold, and Gilmour was clad in an
+old overcoat which had seen much service in Siberia, and
+had a woollen comforter round his neck, having more
+regard to warmth than to appearance. We had to follow
+back to Tientsin, Gilmour being thought by those on board
+the steamer to be the engineer!'</p>
+
+<p>Two letters may be quoted in this connection. The
+first was to one of his most intimate Scotch friends.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_102" id="Page_102">[Pg 102]</a></span></p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'London Mission, Peking,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'January 31, 1875.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear&mdash;&mdash;, Your kind, long, and much-looked-for
+letter dated May 12, 1873, and August 21, 1874, reached
+me on January 9, 1875. Many thanks for it, but I think
+it would be quite as well in future to send me half the
+quantity in half the time, if you really find you cannot
+write me oftener. As I was married on December 8,
+1874, to Mrs. Meech's sister, that lady, Mrs. Gilmour, had
+the great pleasure of reading your earnest, long, and
+reiterated warning to me not to have her. Your warning
+came too late. Had you posted your letter on May 12,
+1873, it might have been in time, as the first letter that
+opened our acquaintance was written in January 1874.
+If nothing else will have effect with you, perhaps the
+thought that you might have saved me from the fate of
+having an English wife may have some effect in moving
+you to post your letters early, even though they should
+not be so long and full.</p>
+
+<p>'About my wife: as I want you to know her, I introduce
+you to her. She is a jolly girl, as much, perhaps more, of
+a Christian and a Christian missionary than I am. I don't
+know whether I told you how it came about. I proposed
+first to a Scotch girl, but found I was too late; I then put
+myself and the direction of this affair&mdash;I mean the finding
+of a wife&mdash;into God's hands, asking Him to look me out
+one, a good one too, and very soon I found myself in a
+position to propose to Miss Prankard with all reasonable
+evidence that she was the right sort of girl, and with some
+hope that she would not disdain the offer. We had never
+seen each other, and had never corresponded, but she had
+heard much about me from people in England who knew
+me, and I had heard a good deal of her and seen her
+letters written to her sister and to her sister's husband. The<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_103" id="Page_103">[Pg 103]</a></span>
+first letter I wrote her was to propose, and the first letter
+she wrote me was to accept&mdash;romantic enough!</p>
+
+<p>'I proposed in January, went up to Mongolia in spring,
+rode about on my camels till July, and came down to
+Kalgan to find that I was an accepted man! I went to
+Tientsin to meet her; we arrived here on Thursday, and
+were married on Tuesday morning. We had a quiet week,
+then I went to the country on a nine days' tour, and
+came back two days before Christmas. We have been
+at home ever since. Such is the romance of a matter-of-fact
+man.</p>
+
+<p>'You will see that the whole thing was gone about
+simply on the faith principle, and from its success I am
+inclined to think more and more highly of the plan.
+Without any gammon, I am much more happy than ever
+even in my day-dreams I ventured to imagine I might be.
+It is not only me that my wife pleases, but she has gained
+golden opinions from most of the people who have met
+her among my friends and acquaintances in Scotland and
+China. My parents were scared one day last year by receiving
+a letter from a lady in England, a lady whose
+name even they had not known before, stating that her
+daughter had decided to become <i>my wife</i>. Didn't it stir
+up the old people! They had never heard a word about
+it! My letter to them, posted at the same time with the
+proposal, had been delayed in London. The young lady
+went to Scotland, and was with them two weeks, and
+came away having made such an impression on them
+that they wrote me from home to say that "though I
+had searched the country for a couple of years I could not
+have made a better choice."</p>
+
+<p>'Perhaps I am tiring you, but I want to let you
+know all about it, and to assure you that you need not
+be the least shy of me or of my English wife. She is a
+good lassie, any quantity better than me, and just as handy<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_104" id="Page_104">[Pg 104]</a></span>
+as a Scotch lass would have been. It was great fun for
+her to read your tirade about English wives and your
+warning about her. She is a jolly kind of body, and
+does not take offence, but I guess if she comes across
+you she will wake you up a bit.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The other letter was to Miss Bremner, and referred to
+the part Gilmour was to take in her marriage in 1883
+to his brother Alexander:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Now as to your affair, a much more serious matter.
+Alex has said something about my part. I want to take
+part, but only such a small part as will make it true to say,
+"assisted by the brother of the bridegroom." It is for you
+and Dr. Macfadyen to say what that <i>small</i> part shall be;
+all I have to say about it, the smaller the better.</p>
+
+<p>'My experiences of the ceremonies of social Christianity
+have been mixed a little. In England I baptised a child
+by a wrong name, and had actually to do it again. In
+China on a similar occasion I began by saying, "Friends,
+God has given you this child," when the seeming father
+stopped me, and explained that God had not given them
+this child, but he himself had picked it up in a field where
+it had been exposed.</p>
+
+<p>'I think I married only one Chinese couple, and to this
+day I doubt if either the one or the other uttered a syllable
+where they should have said, "I do." In my own case I
+think I must have said "I will" in a feeble voice, for my
+wife when her turn came sung out "I will" in a voice that
+startled herself and me, and made it ominous how much
+<i>will</i> she was going to have in the matter. Wishing you
+all blessings,</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Believe me yours truly,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour</span>.'
+</p></blockquote>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" /><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_105" id="Page_105">[Pg 105]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VI" id="CHAPTER_VI"></a>CHAPTER VI</h2>
+
+<h3>'IN JOURNEYINGS OFTEN, IN PERILS OF RIVERS'</h3>
+
+
+<p>The year following the marriage, owing to the absence of
+Dr. Dudgeon on furlough, was spent almost entirely in
+Peking. In his absence Mr. Gilmour took charge of what
+may be called the unprofessional work of the hospital, the
+purely medical superintendence being in the hands of
+Dr. Bushell of the British Legation. He varied this work
+and the routine of ordinary mission duties by an occasional
+trip to other centres where fairs were being held, in the
+company of Mr. Murray, of the National Bible Society of
+Scotland, for the purpose of selling Christian books. There
+was often a very keen friendly rivalry as to which could sell
+the most, and not unfrequently very large quantities of
+tracts and booklets were thus put into circulation.</p>
+
+<p>Early in 1875, with the object of enabling his colleagues
+and his friends among the other missions which have centres
+in Peking the better to realise what life in Mongolia was
+like, he set up his Mongol tent in the compound, and
+invited them in companies of five or seven to partake of a
+Mongol dinner, cooked in Mongol fashion, and served as
+on the Plain. His diary records that five such entertainments
+were necessary, the utmost limit of the tent accommodation
+being reached on each occasion.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_106" id="Page_106">[Pg 106]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'The guests came,' we are told, 'at the appointed time,
+and the fire of wood was lighted in the middle of the tent.
+While the guests sat around on felt spread upon the
+ground, Gilmour proceeded to cook the millet and the
+mutton which furnished the feast. When all was ready a
+blessing was asked and the meal was eaten. On one
+occasion a reverend gentleman was called on to ask the
+blessing, but declined, feeling apparently that what he was
+expected to eat was not of such a quality that he could
+ask a blessing on it. Gilmour used often to refer to this
+with much amusement, though at the time he felt some
+chagrin.'</p>
+
+<p>In 1876 the Mongolian trips were resumed. No colleague
+had yet been secured for him, and, with a bravery
+and consecration beyond all praise, Mrs. Gilmour accompanied
+him. This she did not once simply. For the first
+journey the novelty of the experience and the conviction
+that she could at any rate help to preserve her husband
+from the feeling of utter loneliness, which had been so
+hard to bear in past years, were powerful reasons. But
+she went a second and a third time. She went after the
+novelty had worn off, after she had learned by very stern
+experience how hard and rough the life was, after previous
+exposure had told but too severely upon her physical
+strength. And thus she deserves the eulogy passed upon
+her by her husband: 'She is a better missionary than I.'
+Comparisons of this kind are obviously out of the question.
+But it would be hard to find a more beautiful illustration
+of true wifely affection than the love for her husband that
+made her willing to share his Mongol tent as readily as
+the Peking compound. And if James Gilmour manifested<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_107" id="Page_107">[Pg 107]</a></span>
+a Christlike love for the ignorant and stolid Mongols, so
+also did the delicately nurtured and refined lady who, in
+order to do her part in winning them to the Saviour,
+endured privations, faced perils, and bore a daily and
+hourly series of trials so irksome and so repugnant that
+no motive short of all-absorbing love to Jesus Christ is
+strong enough to account for her endurance.</p>
+
+<p>Here are some pictures of what this life meant to Mrs.
+Gilmour. The first journey which they took together
+lasted from April 4 until September 23, 1876, one hundred
+and thirty-six days being passed in Mongolia itself.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'On the evening of April 25 we came upon our
+servants' tent, already pitched beside some Mongol tents
+near a stream. Our things were unloaded from the
+Chinese cart, which soon drove off and left us fairly
+launched out on the Plain. We had two tents&mdash;one for
+ourselves and one for our servants. They were both alike,
+made of common blue Chinese cloth outside, and of
+commoner white Chinese cloth inside. It was originally
+intended that our tent should be private for our retirement
+and for Mrs. Gilmour's use; but we soon found that
+this idea could not be carried out. The Mongols are so
+much in the habit of going freely into everybody's tent in
+Mongolia that we found we could not retain our tent to
+ourselves without running risk of offending them by our
+seeming haughtiness. That they should think us uncongenial
+and distant would have been an obstacle to our
+success among them. So we made a virtue of necessity,
+and kept open house in the literal sense of the word. At
+our meals, our devotions, our ablutions, there they were&mdash;much
+amused and interested, of course. It was sometimes
+annoying to have them so much and so constantly about,
+but there was no help for it, and soon we began to care<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_108" id="Page_108">[Pg 108]</a></span>
+little for them, and took their presence not only as a matter
+of course, but without being disturbed by it.</p>
+
+<p>'One advantage of this sort of public life was that Mrs.
+Gilmour, being almost constantly in the presence of the
+spoken language, picked it up very accurately and very
+rapidly. It is hardly possible to conceive a better plan of
+becoming easily and well acquainted with any language
+than that of thus living where it is impossible not to hear
+it in almost constant use.</p>
+
+<p>'Another advantage of this sort of public life was that
+one gained the friendship of the people. This perfect freedom
+of intercourse pleased them much, and even conciliated
+those not very friendly inclined. It was quite common to
+hear visitors remark that, while other foreigners in Mongolia
+are distant and harsh, these people were gentle and accessible,
+and that such friendly people did a great deal to
+remove the unfavourable impressions made by other less
+considerate travellers.</p>
+
+<p>'Our sojourn extended to the end of August, giving us
+a little over four months at a stretch of tent life. In that
+time we had experience of many kinds of weather. At
+first it was cold. Even in May ice was to be seen in the
+mornings. Then came heat, premature and burning, and
+all the more trying for ourselves and cattle on account of
+the lack of rain. Then we had a furious tempest, which
+raged for about thirty-six hours, overturning our covered
+cart and threatening to sweep ourselves and our tents away.
+We had to load down our tent ropes with bags of earth,
+stones, sod, the bodies of our carts, wheels, boxes, and
+anything we could find, and even then we had but a
+precarious existence. Every now and then, by day and
+by night, there would arise a shout from the one tent
+or the other, and amid the roar of the wind we heard
+cries for the hammer and the spare tent pins. We
+managed to fix ourselves without being blown away, and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_109" id="Page_109">[Pg 109]</a></span>
+when the storm was over we patched our riven tents, and
+were thankful we had weathered it so well. Then came
+the summer rains&mdash;late in season, it is true, but great in
+strength&mdash;pouring and lashing and roaring, the great drops
+bursting through our rent cloth, broken up into spray
+and looking like pepper shaken from a box. We had
+waterproof sheets, but it was next to impossible to keep
+anything dry. While the rain lasted we sat huddled in
+our rain cloaks, or, spade in hand, cut new channels for
+suddenly extemporised streams and pools that grew larger
+and continued to come closer to our bedding and boxes.
+As soon as the sun returned, there was a general drying of
+garments, mattresses, and sheepskin robes. The heat was
+perhaps the most trying of our meteorological experiences;
+but even that passed away at last, and before we had left
+the plains night frost had reappeared, covering the pools
+about well mouths with thin sheets of ice.</p></blockquote>
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 493px;">
+<a name="p109" id="p109">
+<img src="images/109.jpg" width="493" height="298" alt="A MONGOL ENCAMPMENT" title="A MONGOL ENCAMPMENT" />
+<span class="caption">A MONGOL ENCAMPMENT</span></a>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Later in the season, one afternoon, the loungers in the
+tent looked out and remarked, "The Mandarin has come,"
+and gave place to a richly dressed, corpulent Mongol, who
+entered the tent, followed by one of his servants. Salutations
+over, he soon showed his colours and unmasked his
+batteries. He had come to fight, and we both went at it
+tooth and nail. He had read a good deal, and had come
+evidently prepared and primed, not in any spirit of unfriendliness,
+but under the evident conviction that a better
+case could be made out for Buddhism than for Christianity.
+The tent was crammed with eager listeners, and we reasoned
+together from the Creation to the finish, including all
+manner of side issues and important questions. It was a
+long time before he could be convinced that our Jesus was
+not spoken of and made known in the Buddhist classics.
+When he was at length satisfied (on that point), he wanted
+to know about the Trinity; how men could get good; how
+it was right that men should escape punishment due to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_112" id="Page_112">[Pg 112]</a></span>
+their misdeeds by praying to Jesus; why God allowed
+animals, such as starving dogs, to lead a life of suffering;
+why God did not keep sin from entering the world; how
+could Jesus come, when it is said He is always with us;
+and how about the souls who died before Jesus came.</p>
+
+<p>'At last the sun got low, and the Mandarin, with many
+words of friendship, rode away, promising to come another
+day. But he never came.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In a later journey they had a very narrow escape from
+one of the frequent perils of this tent life:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'In Mongolia we had one rather serious adventure.
+The south edge of the Plain is famed for storms, and the
+night we camped there, just after dark, began one of the
+fiercest thunderstorms I can remember having seen. The
+wind roared, the rain dashed, the tent quivered; the thunder
+rattled with a metallic ring, like shafts of iron dashing
+against each other, as it darted along a sheet-iron sky; the
+water rose in the tent till part of our bed was afloat. It
+was hardly possible to hear each other speak; but amid
+and above all the din of the tempest rose one sound not to
+be mistaken, the roar of rushing water. There was a river
+to right of us, but the sound came more from the left.
+Venturing out, I found there was a great swift-flowing river
+on both sides of us; that we could not move from the little
+piece of elevated land plain on which we had our tent; and
+that a few inches more water, or an obstacle getting into
+the path of the upper river, would send the full force of the
+current down on our tents. Flocks, herds, men are said to
+be swept away now and again in Mongolia, and for an hour
+our case seemed doubtful; but about 11 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> the storm
+ceased and the danger was over, and, though we had hardly
+anything left, we went to sleep, thanking God for His
+preserving mercy.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_113" id="Page_113">[Pg 113]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Courageous, undoubtedly, Mrs. Gilmour was; her example
+of self-sacrifice in the Master's cause was lofty in
+itself, and is stimulating to every Christian mind. Yet it is
+to be greatly feared that the first of these journeys aggravated,
+if it did not actually develope, the disease from
+which she ultimately died. She found the ceaseless round
+of millet and mutton so unpalatable as at the last to be
+able hardly to eat at all; and experience of tent life was
+needful before she could realise how absolutely devoid
+it was of almost everything that a European lady looks
+upon as essential to daily existence, and thus make adequate
+preparation for the life. Yet, in 1878, she not only accompanied
+her husband again, better equipped by reason of
+previous experience, but she also took with her their infant
+boy.</p>
+
+<p>The winter of 1876 in Peking was devoted to work more
+or less directly bearing upon the Christian conquest of the
+nomad tribes.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Since returning from Mongolia I have had here a
+teacher whom I had come from the plains. I read some
+Buddhist classics with him, then had him write to my
+dictation some of the more striking incidents narrated in
+the Book of Daniel; then finally had him write for me
+an explanation of the way of salvation through Jesus.
+The extracts from Daniel were written mostly with the
+idea of accustoming him to my dictation; but the explanation
+of Christianity was a tract that I had long wanted
+to write, in which I sought to make it as plain as possible,
+not only that Jesus does save, but also that there is no
+salvation through any other name. The Religious Tract
+Society has consented to print for me both the extract
+from Daniel and the explanation of Christianity.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_114" id="Page_114">[Pg 114]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>During 1877 the ever-recurring question, inevitable,
+perhaps, and yet very paralysing to any steady progress,
+as to whether it was really worth while to continue labour
+in such a sterile field, came up once more for discussion.
+In an elaborate report, designed rather to elicit the views
+of the home authorities than to express his own, dated
+August 18, 1877, Mr. Gilmour depicts rapidly and clearly
+his relations, on the one hand, to the workers in the station
+of the American Board at Kalgan, and, on the other, to his
+colleagues of the North China Committee of the London
+Society. The American Board had sent out another
+missionary, and Mr. Gilmour was at first inclined to the
+view that, although working independently, they might yet
+act practically as colleagues.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'In addition, the new man, Rev. W. P. Sprague, and I
+one day undertook to climb a mountain together, and, by
+the time we got half-way up, we discovered that our ideas
+about working together quite agreed, and that there was
+a fair and good prospect of our making good harmonious
+colleagues in one work, though we belonged to different
+societies and hailed from different nations. Here, then, the
+thing seemed to be accomplished; here was a colleague
+ready to my hand, or I to his.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>But Mrs. Gulick, a most energetic and enthusiastic
+missionary to the Mongols, died, her husband was invalided
+to Japan, and Mr. Sprague found himself with the whole
+mission on his shoulders.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'If things are to remain as they are, it amounts pretty
+much to this, that in the warmer months of the year I can
+travel through parts of Mongolia teaching the Gospel and
+dispensing medicines; the rest of the year I can turn my<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_115" id="Page_115">[Pg 115]</a></span>
+attention to Chinese work in Peking. This is a pleasant
+enough arrangement for me, but it is not a very vigorous
+prosecution of the work of the Mongol mission. On the
+other hand, such is the fewness of people to be reached in
+Mongolia that it is only by alternating these periods of
+deprivation with seasons of activity among the Chinese
+that a man can keep his spirit alive.</p>
+
+<p>'As regards the opinion of other members of the Committee
+here, I have never called for any formal expression
+of it, nor have they (the members of Committee) ever
+been invited to discuss the question of the Mongol mission
+in committee, but I know their individual opinions in an informal
+way. Messrs. Meech and Barradale don't say much;
+Mr. Owen thinks we will never do much in Mongolia
+working upon so distant a base as Peking; Mr. Lees
+thinks it a pity to take up such a seemingly unproductive
+field while so many more promising fields call for attention;
+he moreover thinks that the only way to do much
+for Mongolia is through China; Dr. Edkins thinks I spend
+too much time and labour over the Mongols, his idea being
+seemingly a combination of Mongol and Chinese work,
+with a preponderating tendency towards Chinese; Dr.
+Dudgeon has always regarded the Mongol mission as
+hardly practicable.</p>
+
+<p>'On the principle, however, of <i>Sow beside all waters</i>,
+and <i>Thou knowest not which shall prosper, this or that</i>, perhaps
+it is well that the Gospel should be exhibited to the
+Mongols also, and if anyone is to go to Mongolia, perhaps
+many people would have more disqualifications than myself.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In 1877 there was what seemed to be a very hopeful
+development of Christian work in Shantung, and Mr.
+Gilmour and Mr. Owen visited that district and baptized a
+large number of converts. Still later, Dr. Edkins and Mr.
+Owen, on another visit, baptized some two hundred people.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_116" id="Page_116">[Pg 116]</a></span>
+With reference to this latter ingathering Mr. Gilmour wrote,
+'I much regret that we have not some definite system of
+putting men on a period of probation.... About these
+two hundred I have nothing to say, but of the hundred odd
+Mr. Owen and I baptized in November I have to admit
+that, making all allowances, some of them cause me more
+anxiety than satisfaction.' There was, unfortunately, only
+too much ground for this fear. Ultimately the movement
+dwindled almost as rapidly as it had developed, and with
+little permanent benefit to the missionary cause. Shantung
+had been devastated by famine, locusts, and cholera.
+Missionaries brought relief to the stricken people, giving
+both money and food. Large numbers were drawn towards
+the new religion by this example of its deeds, and most
+of the converts had professed Christianity in the hope of
+getting something by its means. But this incident brought
+to a head a divergence of view as to the whole conduct
+of affairs in the Peking mission between the two older
+missionaries, Dr. Edkins and Dr. Dudgeon, and their three
+younger colleagues, Mr. Gilmour, Mr. Owen, and Mr.
+Meech. Into this strenuous and protracted controversy
+we do not propose to enter. Both parties were actuated
+by high and honourable motives; both were able to express
+their views pointedly, and with all appropriate force. In
+the end the view advocated by Mr. Gilmour triumphed.
+This was that, so far as possible, no pecuniary inducement
+whatever, either by way of payment for services, or even
+employment in connection with the mission, should be
+allowed to influence a Chinaman's judgment in the acceptance
+of Christianity. Gilmour could take an active part
+in the discussions only during his winter residence in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_117" id="Page_117">[Pg 117]</a></span>
+Peking. But the reader who has followed its history so
+far will be quite prepared to learn that he made up for
+the infrequency of his participation in the controversy
+by the energy which he displayed when he did so. And
+in depicting Gilmour as he was, it is essential that he
+should be seen when opposing no less than, as he much
+preferred to be in all matters affecting the welfare of the
+mission, in the heartiest concord with his colleagues.
+And yet his keenest opponents would cordially assent to the
+following statement by one who took an active part in all
+the discussions. It is mainly for the purpose of emphasising
+this testimony that the matter is referred to here.</p>
+
+<p>'When in Peking Gilmour took his full share in the
+debates which were constantly arising. Although he could
+and did argue to the extremest point, and very hot and sharp
+words might be spoken during the discussion, he harboured
+no bitterness of feeling against his opponents. After excited
+argument he would get up and say, "Nevertheless I
+love you." Nor were these empty words. He was kind,
+and willing to help all, and was doing acts of service continually
+for those who opposed him most.'</p>
+
+<p>Towards the close of 1878 the Rev. J. S. Barradale, of
+the Tientsin Mission, died, leaving the Rev. J. Lees alone
+without a Chinese-speaking helper. Mr. Gilmour sympathised
+deeply with him in his loss, and wrote to say that,
+so long as Mr. Lees was thus left alone, he would be glad
+to make two trips annually to his country stations, either
+<i>with</i> him or <i>for</i> him. Mr. Gilmour's journal of this work
+is not only a record of the willingness with which he added
+gladly to his own heavy labours in order to assist a
+colleague; but it also gives some most realistic pictures of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_118" id="Page_118">[Pg 118]</a></span>
+what ordinary life in China is like, and under what conditions
+evangelistic itineration there is carried on. Some of
+the districts visited had just been devastated by a severe
+famine.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'From Tientsin to Hsiao Chang is five days' journey.
+Three hours out from Tientsin we came upon some dogs
+feasting on a corpse lying at a cross-road. The dogs
+belonged to cottagers near, but no attempt was made by
+the owners to keep them away; no one took the trouble to
+bury the body or cover it up even. Later on we passed
+through one famine-devastated district. Half the houses
+in the villages were unroofed; large tracts of land were
+untilled; the landscape was almost entirely destitute of
+animal life; travellers were nowhere to be seen; round the
+villages the little stacks of straw and fuel were not to be
+seen; the lanes were silent; no dogs, no cocks and hens, no
+pigs; no groups of children playing or running after the
+foreigner as he passed by; and the words of Scripture came
+to my mind, "the land desolate without inhabitant." We
+continued to pass these desolations for about sixty English
+miles. We stopped a night in one of these ruined villages,
+and Mr. Lees took me round the place to see the nature
+and extent of the destruction. Closer inspection revealed
+even more ruin than a mere traveller's passing look would
+detect; for, evidently, some care had been taken to leave
+house walls and boundary walls on the street standing, so as
+to hide some part of the destruction, and thus make things
+look better than they really were.</p>
+
+<p>'Natives of the place gave us numbers, which showed
+the population was then estimated at not much, if any,
+more than half the former population. It was expressly
+stated, however, that the missing half were not regarded as
+all dead; very many were dead, had died in the place, but
+many had gone elsewhere&mdash;in most cases no one knew<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_119" id="Page_119">[Pg 119]</a></span>
+where. Of these some few would doubtless return; but it
+is to be feared that the mortality in a hard year among
+famine refugees is very large, and of those who left their
+homes and native places, the few that may eventually
+return will be very few, I fear.</p>
+
+<p>'Doesn't the Bible say that it is a harder fate to die of
+famine than to die by the sword&mdash;to die stricken through for
+want of the fruits of the earth? But of all those who died
+in the famine in North China there is one class whose case
+is perhaps more distressing than ordinary. A large number
+of people seem to have died just as the harvest&mdash;a plentiful
+one&mdash;ripened. Through all these hard dreary months,
+when, day after day, month after month, they looked for
+and longed for rain, those I now speak of struggled through,
+kept up hope, fared hard, hoped eagerly, and at last saw
+the rain come, saw the crops flourishing, saw them beginning
+to ripen, congratulated themselves and others on the prospect
+of abundant food and better days. But they were to
+see it with their eyes, but not to eat thereof. As far as
+could be gathered from the natives themselves, the case
+would seem to be thus.</p>
+
+<p>'The great mass of the population was much reduced
+in bodily strength by the long period of half-starvation
+they went through; summer and early autumn came with
+the rains and the attendant ague, which last&mdash;the ague&mdash;still
+more reduced the strength of their already emaciated frames.
+You can imagine them, with lean faces and hungry eyes,
+tottering about the fields, and counting the days that must
+yet elapse before the grain would ripen. The rage of
+hunger was no longer to be borne; they anticipated by a
+few days the ripening; took the grain, still a little green&mdash;perhaps
+sometimes very green&mdash;and put it into the pot. But
+here again was another difficulty. The fuel used is grain
+stalks, and the famine deprived them at once of food and
+fuel. Green grain they might cook, but green-grain stalks<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_120" id="Page_120">[Pg 120]</a></span>
+would not burn. Fuel was thus deficient; and was it
+wonderful if, as they stood round the pot, and the fuel was
+deficient, their patience should fail them and they should
+fall upon the food half cooked? That was bad enough;
+but that is not all. The Chinese have nearly as little self-control
+as children; and is it to be wondered at if, when at
+last, after long months of the slow torture of unappeased
+hunger, they found a full meal before them, they should
+have eaten to the full? When a man emaciated from
+having gone through a famine, and further enfeebled after
+repeated prostrations by ague, at length rises up and gorges
+himself with farinaceous food, half ripe and half cooked,
+the consequences are not difficult to divine. Diarrh&oelig;a and
+dysentery set in, and became fearfully prevalent&mdash;not only
+prevalent, but peculiarly fatal. To make matters worse,
+medicines in that part of the country are dear; the people
+were too poor to get medical help, and great numbers who
+had lived to see the famine end and prosperity return lived
+only to see the prosperity, and to die when it touched them.
+The famine fever in summer seems to have been fearfully
+prevalent. It is said that in a single courtyard two or
+three people would be lying about the gate, two or three
+under the shadow of some house, two or three more inside
+the house&mdash;all stricken down with fever. The air of some
+villages is said to have been loaded with the effluvia to
+such an extent that one riding along the street perceptibly
+discerned the taint in the atmosphere. The fever was
+deadly too, but evidently not so deadly in proportion as
+the autumn dysentery. Frequently, when talking to a boy,
+we would hear he was an orphan, and, on inquiry, he told
+that his father had died in autumn; frequently, in talking
+to a woman, we would hear that she was a widow, and, on
+asking when her husband died, the reply was, "Autumn."</p>
+
+<p>'We reached Hsiao Chang in a snowstorm on Saturday
+afternoon. A few of the people, doubtless, heard of our<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_121" id="Page_121">[Pg 121]</a></span>
+arrival; but those of the other villages probably did not
+know we had come; so that our being there, perhaps, did not
+materially increase the number of the congregation that
+assembled next day (Sunday). Sunday was a dull, uncomfortable
+day; the ground covered with snow; the sky still
+covered with clouds; no sunshine; yet there was a congregation
+of about one hundred and thirty, of whom eighty
+(about) would be women, and fifty (about) be men. The
+next Sabbath, January 26, was still dull; the congregation
+numbered about two hundred and eighty&mdash;men, say, one
+hundred and thirty; women, say, one hundred and fifty.
+Mr. Lees took the women into the chapel. I took the men
+outside in another court, and preached to them from a
+terrace which gave me a commanding view of my congregation.
+Mr. Lees had too little ventilation, I had too
+much of it; but both of our congregations listened well,
+though there was no sun, though the cold was intense, and
+though stray flakes of snow wandered slowly down among
+us as we worshipped. The next Sabbath, February 2,
+was fine. All except adherents were excluded, and the
+congregation numbered about eighty men, and one hundred
+and twenty women. Twelve men and seven women were
+baptized.</p>
+
+<p>'The most novel feature of the work I noticed was the
+eagerness displayed to learn and sing hymns. Sometimes
+poor old women, from whom we could not extract much
+Catechism information about the unity in trinity and other
+theological mysteries, brightened up their old wrinkled
+faces when asked if they could sing, and when asked to
+give us a specimen of their singing, would raise their
+cracked and quavering voices and go through "There is a
+happy land," or "The Great Physician," or "Safe in the
+arms of Jesus," a good deal out of tune here and there, it is
+true, but on the whole creditably as regards music, and
+with an apparent earnestness and feeling that was hard to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_122" id="Page_122">[Pg 122]</a></span>
+witness with dry eyes. And if the old women sang thus,
+what of the young people? They seemed to revel in
+hymns. The old, big, orthodox hymn-book used in our
+chapels got a good deal of patronage and attention; but
+their great favourites were those in a small collection of
+the Sankey revival hymns translated (with a few exceptions)
+and published by Mr. Lees. These hymns contain
+good gospel, seem to be easily learned, and are set to tunes
+which the Chinese seem never to sing themselves tired of.
+The preachers have mastered a goodly number of them,
+and teach them to all comers; but, Mr. Lees being a singer,
+of course, when he arrived, there were high singing festivals,
+and the practice at evening prayers was sometimes so
+vigorous and prolonged that the tympanum of one of my
+ears began to show symptoms of defeat. These hymns I
+regard as a most powerful auxiliary to the other Gospel
+agencies at work, and I hope a great deal of good from
+them.</p>
+
+<p>'Every Chinaman wants looking after. Even the best
+and most trustworthy men are all the better for being well
+and carefully superintended. In fact, the better a man is,
+the better he pays for being well looked after. The present
+state of country mission work in North China calls for
+careful supervision in an especial degree. Unforeseen
+circumstances arise that need prompt action where a wrong
+course of action may be disastrous; something or other
+happens that dismays the whole of the little Christian community;
+something or other happens that lifts them up into
+pride; the Christians are like little islands of Christianity
+isolated in a vast ocean of heathenism, and the waves seem
+to threaten to swallow them up. The missionary, simply
+by going and putting in an appearance, or by giving a little
+simple advice, or by speaking a few words of encouragement,
+or by devising a few simple methods, or making a
+few simple arrangements, can often keep the Church out of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_123" id="Page_123">[Pg 123]</a></span>
+moral danger, infuse new hope and courage to the members
+and preachers, and, under God, put fresh life and vigour
+into the whole concern. As iron sharpeneth iron, so doth
+a man the face of his friend; and this is true in an especial
+degree of a missionary and his preachers and converts.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In the course of a subsequent tour in the same district,
+in 1880, he gives in his diary a sketch of a sermon preached
+by Liu, his Chinese helper, one which may be taken as a
+specimen of the best class of address given by a converted
+Chinaman to his fellow-countrymen.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Liu's subject was from Revelation, "Whosoever will,
+let him take of the water of life freely." He went into an
+elaborate detail about the use of water, washing, laying
+the dust in a room being swept out, (à la Bunyan) making
+a sinking sand hard and good for a cart and man to travel
+on. Finally, he got to a couple of good stories about a
+man who got drunk and had his face blackened, so that
+when he came home his own father did not know him and
+would not let him in, and when he saw himself accidentally
+in a mirror he did not know himself. His drunkenness
+had completely changed his appearance and voice even.</p>
+
+<p>'So God made us in His own image, but sin has terribly
+changed us. Purified by the Holy Ghost we may again
+be like ourselves and God.</p>
+
+<p>'The service lasted about two hours and ten minutes.
+The story parts of the sermon were very effective.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>A later entry in the diary runs: 'Had service. Preached
+"Jesus saves," the sermon for the heathen of that name.'
+One who often heard him preach in China gives the following
+estimate of his power and method in delivering his
+message:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_124" id="Page_124">[Pg 124]</a></span></p><blockquote><p>'As a preacher Gilmour was most unconventional. His
+sermons were direct talks, without any attempt at rhetoric.
+They were plentifully illustrated, largely from events in
+his own experience. Laughable allusions or quaint ways
+of putting things were frequently used. While there was
+not much attractive in the manner of the preacher, the
+directness of his remark and his evident earnestness always
+made his sermons appreciated and enjoyed. The Chinese
+were always glad to hear him, and words he used to speak
+are often referred to.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Writing on one occasion to a friend in England being
+educated for the Christian ministry, who had just taken one
+of the higher degrees at the London University, he said:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I don't think our work is so much unlike, after all.
+You witness for Christ, so do I; and though you are in a
+Christian country and I in a heathen land, human nature is
+human nature, and not so different as might be supposed.
+You may, pray you may, see more fruit of your work than
+I do, but your trials, and difficulties, and temptations will be,
+no doubt are, pretty much the same as mine. May the
+Lord help you and bless you now and for ever! I hope He
+will help you to have ever a heart ready to preach simply the
+simple Gospel to your hearers, half of whom, perhaps, know
+almost nothing of salvation, though they have been listening
+to sermons about it all their lives, and would not
+know in the least to which hand to turn if they were
+aroused and became anxious to be saved. I'll give you a
+text, which I think peculiarly suitable for you, now a
+graduate. Isaiah 1. 4&mdash;"The Lord God hath given me the
+tongue of the learned, that I should know how to speak a
+word in season to him that is weary." I like to dwell on
+this text. Learning should not make deep sermons, hard
+to be understood; on the contrary, it should be all employed<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_125" id="Page_125">[Pg 125]</a></span>
+to make the road simple and clear. Forgive me for
+exhorting you so, but I can't refrain from it when I think
+of the many learned men I know at home and here who
+employ their learning in giving learned sermons, <i>not</i> in
+making the way simple and plain.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The sermon referred to in the extract quoted above from
+the diary is based on Matt. i. 21. It was never written
+out; but the notes of it lie before us, and we quote them
+as an illustration of his way of addressing both Chinese
+and English audiences. It may interest the reader to
+endeavour to make out from it the line of thought, and any
+who may have heard him preach or speak will find it easy
+to recall <i>how</i> he preached it.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Matt. i. 21. 'He shall save people from their sins.'</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Talk to a man, he admits he is sinner; by-and-by he
+will break off and become good.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'He does not really know what sin is. Egypt!</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'It is a <i>disease</i>; if you get it can you leave it off?
+Your blood is tainted.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'It is a <i>fire</i>; once light it, you can't quench it, it
+smoulders and breaks out afresh.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'It is an <i>evil root</i>, evil weed, can easy sow, not extirpate.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Sin is like the current above Niagara.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'It becomes a <i>habit</i>. Indulgence makes habit grow.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'It is like a <i>spider</i>; one thread after another binds up a
+fly.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Such is sin&mdash;murder, robbery, theft, adultery, uncleanness,
+lying, covetousness, hatred, anger, malice, want of
+love to God or man.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Many of these sins you not accused of, but you
+have sin: sin is fatal, can you free yourself? <i>Jesus is to
+do it.</i><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_126" id="Page_126">[Pg 126]</a></span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Disease, fire, root, current, habit, fly. <i>The man cannot
+free himself: Jesus must set him free.</i></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Not only from <i>Hell</i>, but from sin.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Suppose you were freed only from Hell, and transported
+to Heaven, could you be happy? Who would be your
+companions?</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Ignorant (wicked) man in company of learned (holy).</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>A Tientsin vagrant</i> became chair-bearer; had clothes,
+etc., but only for a day; he was soon naked again.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Christ does not transport to Heaven only.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Disease.</i>&mdash;Not die from it; He cures it.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Fire.</i>&mdash;Not consumed by it; He quenches it.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Root</i> of evil; He clears from the ground.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Niagara.</i>&mdash;He lifts you out of the current on to an
+island.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Habit.</i>&mdash;He sets you free from it.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Spider's fly.</i>&mdash;He not only takes from the spider; but He
+sets it free from the toils.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Jesus gives</i> second nature; you are born again.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'But upon one <i>condition</i>, your consent. The <i>disease</i> is
+severe: you must obey doctor; if you do not submit to
+operation; not take bitter drugs; then he does not heal.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Lead</i> a man to Peking: not come, not follow: leave
+him: lead to heaven, paths of holiness not follow, not reach.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Has Christ saved you? If yes, visible to self and others.
+He is not only an object of respect, admiration: He is the
+doctor into whose hands you put your soul for treatment.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Two brothers</i>, Kite, Loe, Pet Dog.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>John of Hankow's Liu</i>, see Chronicle; dead <i>v.</i> alive;
+sick (of fever) <i>v.</i> whole. Is it last time? Mongols feel
+queer.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>Missionaries.</i> Mongol doctor who had not courage
+to treat himself.</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'<i>S. S. Teacher</i>: Paul: be a castaway,</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Christ Matt. i. 21-23.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_127" id="Page_127">[Pg 127]</a></span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em">'Any religion good enough. No: no religion breaks
+bondage of sin: go down to death in sin's slavery. Only
+Jesus can save from sin. <i>Ask, and He'll do it.</i>'</p>
+
+<p>During the winters in Peking he still used every effort
+to get at the Mongols frequenting the capital.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'The Mongols who visit Peking connect themselves
+with two great centres. "The Outside Lodging," which is
+about a mile or more north of the north wall of Peking,
+and is also called the "Halha Lodging," because it is the
+great resort of the Northern Mongols, and the "Inside
+Lodging," which is near the inside of the south wall of
+the Manchu City of Peking, is situated close behind the
+English Legation, and is also called the "Cold Lodging;"
+this name being probably due to the fact that in the open
+space in this "Inside Lodging" a good many Mongols
+camp out in their tents, in place of hiring courts and rooms
+from the Chinese. These are the two great <i>centres</i> for
+Mongols in Peking. Many of them lodge in the immediate
+neighbourhood, and even those who lodge in other parts
+of the city frequent these two centres; so that, if any one
+wants to know whether or not any individual Mongol has
+come to Peking, he seeks him at one or other of these marts.</p>
+
+<p>'In the winter of 1879-80 I set up a book-stall, with a
+Chinaman to care for it, at the Outside Lodging, going
+myself, as a rule, every second day. This winter I followed
+the example of the pedlars, and, hanging two bags of books
+from my shoulders, hunted the Mongols out, going not
+only to the trading places, but in and out among the lanes
+where they lodged, visiting the Outside Lodging first and
+the Inside Lodging later in the day. The number of
+Mongols outside the city became latterly so small that it
+was not visited very often; but during the Chinese eleventh
+and the first part of the twelfth month, the number of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_128" id="Page_128">[Pg 128]</a></span>
+Mongols to be met with at the Inside Lodging was fair, and
+the number of books disposed of altogether, both outside
+and inside the city, amounted to seven hundred and fourteen.</p>
+
+<p>'In many cases the Mongols, before buying, and not
+unfrequently after buying, would insist on having the book
+read, supposing that they got more for their money when
+they not only had the book, but had me let them hear its
+contents. Of course I was only too glad to have the
+opportunity of reading, which readily changed to opportunity
+for talking; and in this way, from time to time,
+little groups of Mongols would gather round and listen to
+short addresses on the main doctrines of Christianity.
+Several men whom I accosted seemed familiar with the
+name of Jesus, and had some knowledge of Christianity.
+Some bought the books eagerly; some not only did not
+buy themselves, but exhorted others not to buy; some
+openly spoke against Christianity; but a great many of
+those who listened to an address or took part in a conversation
+evinced interest in the subjects spoken of, and
+remarked that salvation by another bearing our sin was a
+reasonable doctrine. As the purchasers of these books
+hailed from all parts of Mongolia, the tracts thus put into
+their hands will reach to even remote localities in the west,
+north, and east, and my prayer is that the reading of them
+may be the beginning of what shall lead to a saving knowledge
+of the truth in some minds. Hoping for some good
+result, I had my address stamped on many of the books,
+to enable such as might wish to learn more to know where
+to come.</p>
+
+<p>'In some cases, Mongols wishing to buy books had no
+money, but were willing to give goods instead; and thus it
+happened that I sometimes made my way home at night
+with a miscellaneous collection of cheese, sour-curd, butter
+and millet cake and sheep's fat, representing the produce
+of part of the day's sales.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_129" id="Page_129">[Pg 129]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>A short time before he returned to England on his first
+furlough he drew up a report, in which he places on record
+some of the results of his ten years' experience of Mongol
+life and habits.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'On one occasion I was living some weeks in a Mongol's
+tent. It was late in the year. Lights were put out soon
+after dark. The nights were long in reality, and, in such
+unsatisfactory surroundings as the discomforts of a poor
+tent and doubtful companions, the nights seemed longer
+than they were. At sunrise I was only too glad to escape
+from smoke and everything else to the retirement of the
+crest of a low ridge of hills near the tent. This, perhaps
+the most natural thing in the world for a foreigner, was
+utterly inexplicable to the Mongols. The idea that any
+man should get out of his bed at sunrise and climb a hill
+for nothing! He must be up to mischief! He must be
+secretly taking away the luck of the land! This went on
+for some time, the Mongols all alive with suspicion, and
+the unsuspecting foreigner retiring regularly morning after
+morning, till at length a drunken man blurted out the
+whole thing, and openly stated the conviction that the
+inhabitants had arrived at, namely, that this extraordinary
+morning walk of the foreigner on the hill crest boded no
+good to the country. To remain among the people I had
+to give up my morning retirement.</p>
+
+<p>'The Mongols are very suspicious of seeing a foreigner
+writing. What <i>can</i> he be up to? they say among themselves.
+Is he taking notes of the capabilities of the
+country? Is he marking out a road map, so that he can
+return guiding an army? Is he, as a wizard, carrying off
+the good luck of the country in his note-book? These,
+and a great many others, are the questions that they ask
+among themselves and put to the foreigner when they see<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_130" id="Page_130">[Pg 130]</a></span>
+him writing; and if he desires to conciliate the good-will
+of the people, and to win their confidence, the missionary
+must abstain from walking and writing while he is among
+them.</p>
+
+<p>'On another point, too, a missionary must be careful.
+He must not go about shooting. Killing beasts or birds
+the Mongols regard as peculiarly sinful, and anyone who
+wished to teach them religious truth would make the
+attempt under great disadvantage if he carried and used a
+gun. This, however, is a prejudice that it is not so difficult
+to refrain from offending.</p>
+
+<p>'The diseases presented for treatment are legion, but
+the most common cases are skin diseases and diseases of
+the eye and teeth. Perhaps rheumatism is <i>the</i> disease of
+Mongolia; but the manner of life and customs of the
+Mongols are such that it is useless to attempt to cure it.
+Cure it to-day, it is contracted again to-morrow. Skin
+diseases present a fair field for a medical missionary. They
+are so common, and the Mongolian treatment of them is so
+far removed from common-sense, that anyone with a few
+medicines and a little intelligence has ample opportunity
+of benefiting many sufferers. The same may be said of the
+eye. The glare of the sun on the Plain at all seasons,
+except when the grass is fresh and green in summer, the
+blinding sheen from the snowy expanse in winter, and the
+continual smoke that hangs like a cloud two or three feet
+above the floor of the tent, all combine to attack the eye.
+Eye diseases are therefore very common. The lama
+medicines seem to be able to do nothing for such cases,
+and a few remedies in a foreigner's hands work cures that
+seem wonderful to the Mongols.</p>
+
+<p>'In many cases, when a Mongol applies to his doctor,
+he simply extends his hand, and expects that the doctor,
+by simply feeling his pulse, will be able to tell, not only
+the disease, but what will cure it. As soon as the doctor<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_131" id="Page_131">[Pg 131]</a></span>
+has felt the pulse of one hand, the patient at once extends
+the other hand that the pulse may be felt there also, and
+great surprise is manifested when a foreigner begins his
+diagnosis of a case by declining the proffered wrist and
+asking questions.</p>
+
+<p>'The question of "How did you get this disease?"
+often elicits some curiously superstitious replies. One man
+lays the blame on the stars and constellations. Another
+confesses that when he was a lad he was mischievous, and
+dug holes in the ground or cut shrubs on the hill, and it is
+not difficult to see how he regards disease as a punishment
+for digging, since by digging worms are killed; but what
+cutting wood on a hill can have to do with sin it is harder
+to see, except it be regarded as stealing the possessions of
+the spiritual lord of the locality. In consulting a doctor,
+too, a Mongol seems to lay a deal of stress on the belief
+that it is his <i>fate</i> to be cured by the medical man in question,
+and, if he finds relief, often says that his meeting this
+particular doctor and being cured is the result of prayers
+made at some previous time.</p>
+
+<p>'One difficulty in curing Mongols is that they frequently,
+when supplied with medicines, depart entirely from the
+doctor's instructions when they apply them; and a not
+unfrequent case is that of the patient who, after applying
+to the foreigner for medicine and getting it, is frightened
+by his success, or scared by some lying report of his neighbours,
+or staggered at the fact that the foreigner would not
+feel his pulse, or feel it at one wrist only, lays aside the
+medicine carefully and does not use it at all.</p>
+
+<p>'In Mongolia, too, a foreigner is often asked to perform
+absurd, laughable, or impossible cures. One man wants to
+be made clever, another to be made fat, another to be
+cured of insanity, another of tobacco, another of whisky,
+another of hunger, another of tea; another wants to be
+made strong, so as to conquer in gymnastic exercises; most<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_132" id="Page_132">[Pg 132]</a></span>
+men want medicine to make their beards grow; while
+almost every man, woman, and child wants to have his or
+her skin made as white as that of the foreigner.</p>
+
+<p>'When a Mongol is convinced that his case is hopeless
+he takes it very calmly, and bows to his fate, whether it be
+death or chronic disease; and Mongol doctors, and Mongol
+patients too, after a succession of failures, regard the affliction
+as a thing fated, to be unable to overcome which
+implies no lack of medical ability on the doctor's part.</p>
+
+<p>'Of all the healing appliances in the hands of a foreigner
+none strikes the fancy of a Mongol so much as the galvanic
+battery, and it is rather curious that almost every Mongol
+who sees it and tries its effect exclaims what a capital
+thing it would be for examining accused persons. It would
+far surpass whipping, beating, or suspending. Under its
+torture a guilty man could not but "confess." Some one
+in England has advocated the use of the galvanic battery
+in place of the cat in punishing criminals, and it is rather
+curious to note the coincidence of the English and Mongol
+mind.</p>
+
+<p>'The Mongol doctors are not, it would seem, quite unacquainted
+with the properties of galvanism. It is said
+that they are in the habit of prescribing the loadstone ore,
+reduced to powder, as efficacious when applied to sores, and
+one man hard of hearing had been recommended by a lama
+to put a piece of loadstone into each ear and chew a piece
+of iron in his mouth!</p>
+
+<p>'Divination is another point on which Mongols are
+troublesome. It never for a moment enters their head that
+a man so intelligent and well fitted out with appliances as
+a foreigner seems to them to be cannot divine. Accordingly
+they come to him to divine for them where they
+should camp to be lucky and get rich, when a man who
+has gone on a journey will return, why no news has been
+received from a son or husband who is serving in the army,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_133" id="Page_133">[Pg 133]</a></span>
+where they should dig a well so as to get plenty of good
+water near the surface, whether it would be fortunate for
+them to venture on some trading speculation, whether they
+should go on some projected journey, in what direction
+they should search for lost cattle, or, more frequently than
+any of the above, they come, men and women, old and
+young, to have the general luck of their lives examined
+into. Great is their amazement when the foreigner confesses
+his ignorance of such art, and greater still is their
+incredulity.</p>
+
+<p>'The great obstacles to success in doctoring the Mongols
+are two:&mdash;First: most of the afflicted Mongols suffer
+from chronic diseases for which almost nothing can be
+done. Second: in many cases, where alleviation or cures
+are effected, they are only of short duration, as no amount
+of explanation or exhortation seems sufficient to make
+them aware of the importance of guarding against causes
+of disease. But, notwithstanding all this, many cures can
+be effected on favourable subjects, and the fact that the
+missionary carries medicines with him and attempts to
+heal, and that without money and without price, aids the
+missionary cause by bringing him into friendly communication
+with many who would doubtless hold themselves
+aloof from any one who approached them in no other
+character but that of a teacher of Christianity.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_134" id="Page_134">[Pg 134]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VII" id="CHAPTER_VII"></a>CHAPTER VII</h2>
+
+<h3>THE VISIT TO ENGLAND IN 1882</h3>
+
+
+<p>From 1880 onwards Mrs. Gilmour suffered severely from
+illness, and medical advisers recommended at length the
+rest and change of a visit to England. Mr. Gilmour's
+furlough was also nearly due. Consequently, in the spring
+of 1882, he and his family returned to England. This
+visit was helpful and memorable in many ways. The rest
+so thoroughly well earned was greatly enjoyed. The
+return to civilisation, the society of loved relatives and
+friends, the comforts of ordinary English life, and the
+change of thought and occupation which these involved&mdash;all
+reacted happily and refreshingly upon both Mr. Gilmour
+and his wife.</p>
+
+<p>But a sojourn at home is not by any means a season of
+entire rest for the jaded worker. The Churches constantly
+need the stimulus and awakening that are best supplied by
+the men who have been filling the hard places in the field.
+Gilmour also was so full of enthusiasm for his work, and
+so eager in his desire to benefit the Mongols, that he
+would doubtless have found for himself many opportunities
+of pleading their cause, had not the authorities of the
+London Missionary Society, following their usual custom,
+furnished him with a long list of deputation engagements,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_135" id="Page_135">[Pg 135]</a></span>
+Into these he threw himself with an energy that very
+greatly enlarged the circle of his friendship, secured very
+many new supporters for the missionary cause, and obtained
+for himself, on the part of many, a devout, prayerful
+sympathy for the remainder of his earthly service.</p>
+
+<p>He had brought with him a large quantity of manuscript
+material dealing with his twelve years of Mongol
+life and experience. From this he prepared the volume
+which was published by the Religious Tract Society in
+April 1883, under the title of <i>Among the Mongols</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The book was very cordially welcomed by the press,
+and we single out for quotation a portion of one review
+which stands out pre-eminent not only for its literary
+quality, but also as placing on record the impression James
+Gilmour was able to make upon men entirely ignorant
+of him and his work by the simple narrative of his experiences.
+It appeared in the <i>Spectator</i> for April 28, 1883.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'We have a difficulty in passing judgment on this
+book. It is possible, even probable, that the impression it
+has made on us is individual to this reviewer, and due to
+an accident which, with other readers, will not repeat itself.
+Having time, and an interest in nomads, he read a page or
+two, and read on, and read on, for five hours, till he had
+finished the book,&mdash;which is much too short,&mdash;fascinated,
+lost, carried out of himself and England. He was in
+Mongolia, sitting under a blue-cloth tent, with savage dogs
+howling around, and gazing outside, through the doorless
+doorway, on a vast panorama of poor tufted grass, stretching
+away to huge black hills in the distance, and Tartars
+on camels, Tartars on horses, Tartars on springless,
+unbreakable ox-carts, hastening up to the encampment;
+while inside he listened to a quiet Scotchman, resignedly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_136" id="Page_136">[Pg 136]</a></span>
+yet clearly explaining everything in a voice&mdash;&mdash; there was
+the puzzle. Where in the world had the reviewer heard
+that voice before, with its patient monotone, as well known
+as his oldest friend's, its constant digressions and "reflections,"
+its sentences so familiar, yet so new, sentences
+which, as each topic came up, he could write before they
+were uttered. "James Gilmour, M.A." Never knew him,
+or heard of him; yet here was he, talking exactly as some
+one else had years ago talked a hundred times. So
+oppressive at last became the will-o'-the-wisp reminiscence,
+that the reviewer stopped, after an account of the Desert
+of Gobi, and deliberately read it through again, in search
+of a clue which might reawaken his memory. It was all
+in vain, and it was not till another hundred pages had
+been passed, always under the impression of that bewildering
+reminiscence, that he exclaimed to himself, "That's it!
+Robinson Crusoe has turned missionary, lived years in
+Mongolia, and written a book about it." That is this
+book. To any one who, perhaps from early neglect, does
+not perceive this truth, our judgment will seem erroneous;
+but to any one who does, we may quite fearlessly appeal.
+The student of <i>Robinson Crusoe</i> never expected that
+particular pleasure in this life, and he will never have it
+again; but for this once he has it to the full. Mr. James
+Gilmour, though a man of whom any country may be
+proud, is not a deep thinker, and not a bright writer, and
+not a man with the gift of topographical, or, indeed, any
+other kind of description. He thinks nothing extraordinary,
+and has nothing to say quotable. There is a
+faint, far-off humour in him, humour sternly repressed; but
+that, so far as we know, is the only quality in his writing
+which makes him <i>littérateur</i> at all. But Heaven, which
+has denied him many gifts, has given him one in full
+measure,&mdash;the gift of Defoe, the power of so stating things
+that the reader not only believes them, but sees them in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_137" id="Page_137">[Pg 137]</a></span>
+bodily presence, that he is there wherever the author
+chooses to place him, under the blue tent, careering over the
+black ice of Lake Baikal, or hobnobbing in tea with priests
+as unlike Englishmen as it is possible for human beings to
+be, yet, such is his art, in nowise unintelligible or strange. It
+may be, as we have said, that it is an individual impression,
+but we never read, save once, the kind of book in
+our lives, did not deem it possible ever again to meet with
+this special variety of unconscious literary skill. We are
+aware of a dozen shortcomings, of a hundred points upon
+which Mr. Gilmour ought to have given light, and has
+not; but there has been, if our experience serves us at all,
+no book quite like this book since <i>Robinson Crusoe</i>; and
+<i>Robinson Crusoe</i> is not better, does not tell a story more
+directly, or produce more instantaneous and final conviction.
+Heaven help us all, if Mr. Gilmour tells us that he
+has met any unknown race in Mongolia, say, people with
+the power of making themselves invisible, for Tyndall will
+believe him, and Huxley account for them, and the <i>Illustrated
+London News</i> publish their portraits&mdash;in the stage of
+invisibility. We do not say the book is admirable, or perfect,
+or anything else superlative; but we do say, and this
+with sure confidence, that no one who begins it will leave
+it till the narrative ends, or doubt for an instant, whether
+he knows Defoe or not, that he has been enchained by
+something separate and distinct in literature, something
+almost uncanny in the way it has gripped him, and made
+him see for ever a scene he never expected to see.</p>
+
+<p>'We do not know that we have any more to say about
+the book. Its merit is that, and no other; and we do not
+suppose anybody ever proved <i>Robinson Crusoe's</i> value by
+extracts. But we must say a word or two about the
+author and his subject. Mr. Gilmour, though a Scotchman,
+is apparently attached to the London Mission, and
+seems to have quitted Peking for Mongolia on an impulse to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_138" id="Page_138">[Pg 138]</a></span>
+teach Christ to Tartars. He could not ride, he did not
+know Mongolian, he had an objection to carry arms, and
+he had no special fitness except his own character, which
+he knew nothing about, for the work. Nevertheless, he
+went, and stayed years, living on half-frozen prairies and
+deserts under open tents, on fat mutton, sheep's tails particularly,
+tea, and boiled millet, eating only once a day
+because Mongols do, and in all things, except lying, stealing,
+and prurient talk, making himself a lama. As he
+could not ride, he rode for a month over six hundred miles
+of dangerous desert, where the rats undermine the grass,
+and at the end found that that difficulty has disappeared
+for ever. As he could not talk, he "boarded out" with a
+lama, listened and questioned, and questioned and listened,
+till he knew Mongolian as Mongols know it, till his ears
+became so open that he was painfully aware that Mongol
+conversation, like that of most Asiatics, is choked with
+<i>doubles entendres</i>. As for danger, he had made up his mind
+not to carry arms, not to be angry with a heathen, happen
+what might, and&mdash;though he does not mention this&mdash;not
+to be afraid of anything whatever, neither dogs nor
+thieves, nor hunger nor the climate; and he kept those
+three resolutions. If ever on earth there lived a man who
+kept the law of Christ, and could give proofs of it, and be
+absolutely unconscious that he was giving them, it is this
+man, whom the Mongols he lived among called "our
+Gilmour." He wanted, naturally enough, sometimes to
+meditate away from his hosts, and sometimes to take long
+walks, and sometimes to geologise, but he found all these
+things roused suspicion&mdash;for why should a stranger want
+to be alone; might it not be "to steal away the luck of
+the land"?&mdash;and as a suspected missionary is a useless
+missionary, Mr. Gilmour gave them all up, and sat endlessly
+in tents, among lamas. And he says incidentally that
+his fault is impatience, a dislike to be kept waiting!'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_139" id="Page_139">[Pg 139]</a></span></p>
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 490px;"><a id="p139" name="p139">
+<img src="images/139.jpg" width="490" height="218" alt="A MONGOL CAMEL CART" title="" />
+<span class="caption">A MONGOL CAMEL CART<br />(<i>From a Native Sketch</i>)</span></a>
+</div>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_141" id="Page_141">[Pg 141]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The book met with a ready and wide acceptance. It
+soon 'found its public.' It was only to be expected that
+many of the friends and supporters of the London Missionary
+Society would welcome it. And there are others,
+like the reviewer, who 'have time and an interest in
+nomads,' who were certain to consult it. But in addition
+to these special classes the book did good service in some
+cases, by deepening the impression already made by other
+first-rate delineations of missionary enterprise and endurance,
+and in others by creating respect for missions and
+missionaries in minds hitherto strange to that feeling. In
+various editions very many thousands of the book have
+been sold during the nine years which have passed since
+the publication of the first edition.</p>
+
+<p>The success of his book led to the suggestion that he
+might easily find much useful employment for his pen.
+He did contribute some papers to the <i>Sunday at Home</i>,
+<i>Pall Mall Gazette</i>, and other publications. But in this, as
+in all other enterprises, loyalty to the great work of his life
+ruled him. He soon came to the conviction that he ought
+not to take time from the work of winning souls, and
+spend it in writing papers and books&mdash;and from the
+moment of that decision he put mere literary work
+resolutely aside.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I feel keenly,' he wrote in 1884, on his return to
+Peking, 'that there is here more than I can do, and
+writing must go to the wall.' And as late in his life as
+1890 he added, 'I could have made, and could now make,
+I believe, money by writing, but I do not write. I settle
+down to teach illiterate Chinamen and Mongols, heal their
+sores, and present Christ to them.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_142" id="Page_142">[Pg 142]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Towards the end of 1882 James Gilmour entered upon
+a long series of meetings on behalf of the London Missionary
+Society, consisting of sermons and addresses to
+Sunday School children on the Sunday, and speeches at
+public meetings during the week. A long series of his
+letters written to his wife between November 1882 and
+March 1883 is still extant, and they form an impressive
+record of the work considered suitable for a wearied missionary
+at home in search of rest and change. He visited
+Edinburgh, Falkirk, Glasgow, Liverpool, Kilsyth, Hamilton,
+Paisley, Dundee, St Andrews, Arbroath, Lytham, Aberdeen,
+Montrose, Manchester, Hingham, Cambridge, Norfolk,
+and Southampton. And this list exhausts only a portion
+of his excursions on the effort to stimulate and develope
+the faith and the zeal of the churches at home. His wanderings
+brought him into contact sometimes with relatives,
+sometimes with old college friends, now grave pastors fast
+hastening towards middle life. The meetings he attended
+always added to the circle of his friends, for none could
+hear his ringing voice, and feel the clasp of his hand, and
+pass under the influence of his ardent enthusiasm on behalf
+of the great enterprise of the modern Christian Church
+without receiving an impression never likely to be effaced.</p>
+
+<p>He in turn experienced a strong and abiding spiritual
+refreshment from this renewal, after twelve years' absence,
+of touch and fellowship with the Christian life of Great
+Britain. His earnestness deepened, he studied with intensest
+interest movements like the Salvation Army, then
+coming into great prominence, and other agencies for
+improving the religious life of the nation, and he rejoiced
+in all fellowship with other disciples of the Lord Jesus<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_143" id="Page_143">[Pg 143]</a></span>
+which had for its aim the strengthening of the life of
+faith.</p>
+
+<p>He rejoiced greatly when at infrequent intervals a
+Sunday came upon which he was entirely free from
+engagements. Such rare occasions he utilised very fully
+for spiritual edification. He was somewhat hampered in
+his possibilities on these days by the fact that his temporary
+home was at Bexley Heath, and his strong Sabbatarian
+views never permitted him to travel by rail or omnibus on
+the Lord's Day. The following letter shows how he passed
+one of these days.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Yesterday being a fine day I left home at 7.15 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span>,
+walked to London (twelve miles), got to Spurgeon's at 10.30.
+Had a permit from a seat-holder, was close to the platform,
+heard a good earnest sermon, was introduced to Spurgeon
+in the vestry after service, went home to one of his deacons
+for dinner, there met an American who had under Mr.
+Moody been converted from drunkenness to God, and
+whose craving for drink was as instantaneously and as
+thoroughly expelled as the devils by Christ of old. After
+dinner visited Spurgeon's Stockwell Orphanages, then
+walked to Camberwell and dropped in, in passing, at the
+Catholic Apostolic Church and heard a sermon from a man
+who would have described himself as an Apostle, I suppose,
+and who ridiculed in a gentle and mild way the idea that
+all men were to be partakers of the Gospel blessings which
+he seemed to think were the special property of what he
+called "The Church"; walked on to Lewisham, heard
+Morlais Jones: and then walked home in the moonlight,
+arriving here footsore and weary about 10.20 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> I
+enjoyed the day very much, all but the last four or five miles
+home at night. I am thankful to find myself so strong. I
+had a warm bath and slept like a top.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_144" id="Page_144">[Pg 144]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Those who were privileged to entertain James Gilmour,
+if congenial, and the old friends who were fortunate enough
+to secure him for even a brief period, often experienced his
+power of vivid and entrancing narration. His twelve years
+of service had been very full of varied and uncommon
+experience, and when in the vein he could make the hours
+pass almost as minutes. 'During this furlough,' writes Dr.
+Reynolds, 'I had several opportunities of intercourse with
+him, and listened to several of his addresses on the progress
+and need of missionary enterprise in the north of
+China and Mongolia, and was profoundly impressed by his
+earnestness, but I was more deeply moved when in quiet
+<i>tête-à-tête</i> he unveiled some of his special experiences. I
+should like to mention one. He once had great hope of
+the conversion to God of a Mongol, who had given him his
+entire confidence, and who was suffering from cataract in
+both eyes. Gilmour felt that this was a case in which
+surgical help might restore the sufferer to at least partial
+sight, and he made arrangements that in the escort of a
+Mongol the patient should find his way to the medical
+institution at Peking. He started on the pilgrimage when
+Gilmour, with his brave young wife, were encamped in a
+great temporary settlement of Mongols, who were in a
+state of considerable fanatical excitement against the new
+faith and its foreign teacher. Gilmour said, "We prayed
+night and day for the success of this experiment, and we
+arranged to cover all expenses connected with the arrangement."
+Alas! wind laden with dust, and blinding heat and
+other apparent accidents conspired against the poor sufferer,
+and when the necessary time had elapsed after the operation
+and the bandages were removed, the patient was found<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_145" id="Page_145">[Pg 145]</a></span>
+to be <i>stone blind</i>. The Mongol companion stirred up the
+poor fellow's suspicion by telling him that he knew why the
+Missionary had sent him to Peking. "I saw," said he, "the
+jewel of your eye in a bottle on the shelf. These Christians
+can get hundreds of taels for these jewels which they take
+out of our eyes."</p>
+
+<p>'When the blind man was brought back to Gilmour, his
+companion spread his suspicions and exasperating story in
+the entire district, and the fanatical hatred was augmented
+into seething and murderous passion, and our dear friends
+were in imminent peril for several weeks. If they had
+ventured to escape, it would have been a confession of a
+vile conspiracy with the Peking doctors, and a signal for
+their massacre. They remained to live down the ominous
+and odious charge, and in continuous effort to justify the
+simplicity of their motives and the purity and beneficence
+of their mission.</p>
+
+<p>'Deeply moved, as I was, by the story of this hairbreadth
+escape, I asked Mrs. Gilmour more about those
+fearful weeks of suspense, and she assured me that they
+had been perfectly calm, and that they were entirely resigned
+to God's will, whatever it might be.'</p>
+
+<p>'Many other trials of faith and patience were described
+by Gilmour, without one touch of self-approval or self-admiration,
+and the only trouble that haunted him was
+that the results of his long journeys and of his various
+missionary enterprises had been apparently so few.'</p>
+
+<p>It was certain that James Gilmour's power as a
+speaker would be utilised for the great event of the London
+Missionary Society's year, the annual meeting at Exeter
+Hall. This fell, in 1883, on May 10, and he was the last<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_146" id="Page_146">[Pg 146]</a></span>
+speaker. This involved waiting about two hours and a
+half for his speech, and corresponding exhaustion on the
+part of the audience. But none who were present will
+forget the rapid way in which he secured the attention of
+his hearers, and the ease with which he held it to the close.
+He chose to speak of work in China, rather than in
+Mongolia; the recent publication of his book helping
+among other reasons to determine this choice. Part of the
+speech deserves reproduction here, because it outlines very
+sharply the work that engaged much of his time while
+resident in Peking, and because nowhere else can such a
+realistic, sparkling, and lifelike picture of the preaching
+work of the Peking mission, and consequently more or less
+of all preaching in great Chinese cities, be found.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'In Peking we have three chapels. A chapel there is
+merely a Chinese shop, put into decent repair, and a signboard
+stuck over the top. The Chinese are very fond of
+giving themselves very high names. You will come to a
+man sitting in a little box scarcely big enough for himself
+to turn round in, and if you read his sign, it is some flowing
+name about a hall; it may be the "Hall of Continual
+Virtue," or something of that kind, or the "Hall of the
+Five Happinesses." So our title above our chapel just runs
+in the native idiomatic style, and it is the "Gospel Hall.'
+Inside there is not very much to see. The counter has
+been cleared away and the shelves, and, in place of the
+mud, a brick floor has been put down; and then there are
+forms arranged for the sitters, and there is a low platform
+for the speaker. I do not know how it happens, but it
+does happen, that up in the left-hand corner of the chapel&mdash;and
+it is always the left-hand corner&mdash;there is a table
+and two chairs, and on that table there is a teapot and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_147" id="Page_147">[Pg 147]</a></span>
+set of cups, because in China everything is done with tea.
+You must always begin in that way. These chapels are
+open six days in the week in the afternoon.</p>
+
+<p>'Now, supposing you come in at the door, the natural
+thing for the missionary seems to be just to walk up to this
+table and sit down, and then the next thing is to get
+a congregation. Sometimes there is no difficulty about
+getting it, if it happens to be a fair day or there is a crowd
+in the streets. They simply pour in: but the tide goes
+different ways sometimes, and does not pour in always like
+that. I want to give you just a fair, square, honest idea of
+what the thing is. Sometimes the congregation will not
+come in, and sometimes, after a little while, one man looks
+in at the door and sees a foreigner, and he is off. He has
+seen quite enough and does not want to see any more;
+and if you were to ask him what he had seen, he would
+not say he had seen a foreigner; no, he would say he had
+seen "a foreign devil." And, friends, you would not be
+very much astonished that some of those ignorant men
+coming from the country are alarmed when they see a
+foreigner, if you could only imagine the terrible lies that
+they circulate about us there; about how we take out
+people's hearts for the purposes of magic, and steal people's
+eyes to make photographic chemicals, and administer medicines
+to bewitch them generally. I say that, if the first man
+who comes to a chapel on an afternoon is a man who has
+heard these things, you cannot be astonished that all you
+see of that man is his back and his pigtail as he goes away.</p>
+
+<p>'Another man sometimes comes&mdash;a bolder man, and
+he comes in, and the most natural thing for him seems to
+be to walk up to the table and sit down on the other
+side, and there you and he are a pair. The proper thing
+is to pour him out a cup of tea: that is etiquette, and
+the etiquette seems to be that he should not drink it.
+Sometimes, after the service begins, I see the native<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_148" id="Page_148">[Pg 148]</a></span>
+preacher come slyly up, as if he did not mean anything at
+all; and he walks up to the teapot, and lifts the lid quite
+quietly, and slips that tea back into the pot again, and
+puts on the lid and warms it up, and it is ready for the next
+man who comes.</p>
+
+<p>'If you get into conversation with one man, the congregation
+is, for the most part, practically secured, because,
+though a Chinaman is very much afraid of being spoken
+to directly by a foreigner, most Chinamen are very curious
+to overhear any conversation that may be carried on; so
+if you are speaking to him, in comes another man to listen,
+and if you can get other men to come in and listen over
+each other's backs, very soon more come in than the
+original speaker cares to overhear his private conversation;
+and when that step is reached, it is time to go to the platform
+and ask the hearers to sit down and begin the regular
+service. Sometimes nobody comes in, and then you have
+to try something else, and that is to go and sit down a
+little nearer the door, and sometimes, in that way, gradually
+a few people come in. But then in Peking sometimes
+there is a great north-west wind blowing; and I think that
+is about the hardest thing on a man's congregation before
+he gets it, because, when the weather is unfavourable, there
+are not many people about, and so we have to adopt
+another plan. We do not go on to the streets, but inside
+the chapel the native preacher and I do our best to sing a
+hymn. I say do our best, because sometimes these native
+preachers do not succeed in singing very well; however,
+we succeed in making a noise, and that is the thing that
+draws. The people look in, and see what they suppose to
+be a foreigner and a native chanting Buddhist prayers. In
+they come; they have not seen that before, and they sit
+down, and, as soon as the hymn is through, we have the
+opportunity of telling them the contents of the hymn; and
+there you have your sermon ready to your hand.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_149" id="Page_149">[Pg 149]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'But suppose you have got your congregation, it is not
+all smooth-sailing water. Sometimes there are interruptions.
+Sometimes, just when you have the ear of your
+audience, all at once a tremendous row happens just outside
+the door, and the congregation jump to their feet and
+rush out to see what is going on. I could have told them
+if they had only asked me. No doubt, some unwise Chinaman,
+in place of coming straight in and sitting down, stood
+on the outskirt of the crowd on tiptoe. A city thief coming
+along says, "Ah, there is my man," and he walks quietly up
+to him with a pair of sharp scissors, cuts off his tobacco pouch,
+and goes off with it. Of course, as soon as the man misses
+the pouch, his first impulse is to grab his next neighbour;
+that neighbour remonstrates, and then a fight commences.</p>
+
+<p>'Sometimes a funeral passes, and that is almost as
+serious an interruption as a fight; because, although a
+Chinaman does not think much about his soul after he
+dies, he thinks a vast deal about his dead body, and, in
+order to be perfectly sure that he will not be cheated by
+the undertaker, he buys his coffin before he is sick, and
+sees that he has a good bargain. And so, having a good
+coffin, he wants a good funeral; and it is said some men
+spend nearly half of their fortune in having a grand procession
+when they are carried to their grave. When one
+of these enormous funerals, with a procession sometimes
+a quarter of a mile long, comes by, it is a very bad job
+for your congregation. Out they go to have a look at it.</p>
+
+<p>'Then the interruption is sometimes another thing, and
+this last one is a more difficult case to settle. When one
+of the upper ten thousand in China has a marriage, they
+want to have a great exhibition; and after they have
+bought the furniture, they get and hire a great many men,
+and have them dressed to carry that furniture in procession
+along the streets and show it to their neighbours. First
+comes a great wardrobe, and then a little cupboard, a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_150" id="Page_150">[Pg 150]</a></span>
+washstand, a square table, and all sorts of furniture. Now
+when that comes, what are you to do? They have been at
+the expense of paying for an exhibition for their neighbours
+to see, and they feel that it would be unneighbourly if they
+did not step to the door and look out and see the things
+carried past, and there goes your congregation. Sometimes
+unusual interruptions happen. I remember once a
+woman put her head in at the door. Women do not come
+to these chapels often&mdash;I am very glad they do not. That
+woman put her head in at the door, and I saw danger.
+She glared round the place, and then she spied one man,
+and she shouted out something at him: "Come out of
+that!" and, friends, he came out of that, in a big hurry,
+too. He disturbed us very considerably. It was not the
+woman so much as the man&mdash;we all pitied him as he went out.</p>
+
+<p>'Those audiences are very mixed, and they are very
+curious to your eyes. Sometimes I see those audiences,
+most of whom we do not know anything about, listening to
+what I have to tell them, quite as still as you are now&mdash;their
+pipes out, the smoke cleared away. They lean forward
+and listen just as still as audiences in this country
+sometimes listen when the preacher, in an interesting discourse,
+is coming up to a division of his subject. And,
+friends, let me tell you what it is that makes them listen
+best of all&mdash;it is the central doctrine of the truth of Christianity.
+When we come to tell them of how Christ left the
+surroundings of heaven, and came to spend so many years
+in such very poor, unsympathetic company on earth (and
+that is a subject that a missionary sometimes can talk
+feelingly upon when he has been in a foreign country for
+some time), when we can tell them that, and then come to
+the last and greatest part of all: how Christ allowed Himself,
+for love of man, to be nailed to the cross, and not only
+that, but kept in Him that gentle spirit that made Him
+pray for those who were putting Him to death&mdash;oh, friends,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_151" id="Page_151">[Pg 151]</a></span>
+when we come to that and tell them of it&mdash;I know that a
+Chinaman is degraded, corrupt, sensual, material, but he
+has a human heart; and when you can get at the heart, it
+responds to the story of the Cross. We want to do something
+in drawing the net, and so, on this table in the corner,
+there is a pile of books, and as it gets towards the time to
+close, I say to the friends, "Now, you will soon be going
+away to your evening meal; and as I am a foreigner, probably
+you have not understood all that I have said;" and
+then I say, "Now, before you go, there are a number of
+books upon this table, where you will find the whole of this
+subject put down in black and white; will you just come
+up and have a look at the books before you go?" We want,
+if possible, to establish a point of contact with them, and so
+to get a little private conversation, as it were. If you ask
+them to come up and look at a book, and they ask the
+price of it, you have an opportunity of talking to them, and
+some of these men not only buy the books, but they read
+them and come back for others.</p>
+
+<p>'Now, how does the matter stand? These heathen have
+been in our chapel, and we have taken the opportunity
+of putting some of the truth into their hearts; but I know
+a good part, much, it may be, of what the man has heard
+when he goes out&mdash;well, it is stolen away, or it is trampled
+under foot; but some part of it remains.</p>
+
+<p>'And now I can come to the practical part. I have
+not been trying to entertain you, but I have been trying
+to interest you, and what I want to impress upon you is
+this: after those men have left the chapel you can do
+as much for their conversion as we can do in China. I
+want you to pray for the conversion of these men to
+whom we in Peking, and others in other parts of the world,
+are the means of communicating these truths of Christ. I
+believe it is not only the earnestness of the missionary that
+is going to produce results, but it is your earnestness here.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_152" id="Page_152">[Pg 152]</a></span>
+We are your agents, and I believe, fervently, we shall have
+results there in direct proportion to the measure of your
+earnestness here. I believe I am speaking to the right
+people when I ask you to pray. Unprayed for, I feel very
+much as if a diver were sent down to the bottom of a river
+with no air to breathe, or as if a fireman were sent up to a
+blazing building and held an empty hose; I feel very much
+as a soldier who is firing blank cartridge at an enemy, and
+so I ask you earnestly to pray that the Gospel may take
+saving and working effect on the minds of those men to
+whose notice it has been introduced by us. Not long ago,
+at the close of a local anniversary, when we had been having
+a meeting, as we were going home, three of us got off a
+tram-car&mdash;two ministers of the locality and myself&mdash;and, as
+we were walking along, one said: "Ah, Gilmour, it is all
+the same over again; it is just the old thing; you missionaries
+come, and you have an anniversary, and the people's
+earnestness seems to be stirred up, and you ask their
+prayers, and it looks as if you would get them, but," he
+said, "you go away, and the thing passes by and is just
+left where it was before." I do not think that was quite
+correct. I think my brother was labouring under a temporary
+fit of the blues, and I was very glad to find his companion
+said it was not quite correct. What I want is this,
+to go back to my work feeling that there are those behind
+us who are praying earnestly that God's Spirit would work
+effectually in the hearts of those to whom we have the
+privilege of preaching. If you pray earnestly you can but
+work earnestly, and then you will also give earnestly; and
+I do not think we can be too earnest in the matter for
+which Christ was so much in earnest that He laid down His
+own life.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The month of June and part of July was spent at Millport,
+a watering-place on the west coast of Scotland, near<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_153" id="Page_153">[Pg 153]</a></span>
+the lovely scenery of Arran. On July 4 he ascended Goatfell,
+and in so doing had an adventure which might have
+had very serious consequences. He started late, lost his
+way, but finally reached the summit at 8.45 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span>, and then,
+as he notes in his diary: 'Fog came on nearly at once
+with rain and thunder. Sat in the lee of a dripping rock
+on a wet stone and looked at a couple of acres of fog and
+granite boulders. Very dark and cold about midnight, the
+time wore on very slowly, more rain dripping, and fog.
+At 2 o'clock <span class="smcap">A.M.</span> I began the descent, and in a short while
+it was light enough to see. Came on all right, and saw
+where I had missed the way.... I have not caught cold.
+I was wet all night, but kept wrapt up in my plaid and as
+warm as I could manage. Next day the minister congratulated
+me on being seen alive after my Goatfell adventure.'</p>
+
+<p>On September 1 the return voyage to China began,
+and Peking was reached on November 14.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_154" id="Page_154">[Pg 154]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VIII" id="CHAPTER_VIII"></a>CHAPTER VIII</h2>
+
+<h3>SUNSHINE AND SHADOW</h3>
+
+
+<p>In Peking the old familiar round of mission duties
+recommenced. Gilmour after his absence of eighteen
+months was the same man, and yet not the same. He
+yearned for fruit in the conversion of souls, and he began
+to devote himself with more eager self-denial than ever to
+the winning of Chinamen's hearts for the Saviour. The
+winter of 1883-1884 was spent in Peking, and his diary is
+full of incidents illustrative of the time and effort he gave
+to dealing with individuals.</p>
+
+<p>In February, 1884, he made one of the most remarkable
+of his Mongolian journeys. He visited the Plain,
+travelling on foot, and thus subjecting himself to risks and
+hardships of a very serious order. But he had good reasons
+for his method, and he sets them forth with his usual clearness.
+Possibly no other journey of his life more strikingly
+testifies to his strict sense of duty, the unsparing way in
+which he spent himself in its discharge, and his eager desire
+to win souls.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'On this occasion, partly owing to the shortness of the
+time at my disposal, which made it hardly worth while to
+set up an establishment, and partly owing to the peculiar
+season of the year, which would have made it difficult to
+<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_156" id="Page_156">[Pg 156]</a></span>
+find pasture for travelling cattle, I determined to go on
+foot, without medicines, in a strictly spiritual capacity, and
+not seeking so much to make fresh acquaintances or open
+up new ground as to revisit familiar localities and see how
+far former evangelistic attempts had produced any effect.
+In addition there were some individual Mongols who have
+been taught a good deal about Christianity, and on whom
+I wished once more, while there was still opportunity, to
+press the claims of Christ.</p></blockquote>
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 500px;"><a id="p156" name="p156">
+<img src="images/156.jpg" width="500" height="240" alt="A CHINESE MULE LITTER" title="" />
+<span class="caption">A CHINESE MULE LITTER</span></a>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Five cold days in a mule litter brought me to Kalgan,
+and another day in a cart took me up over the pass and
+landed me in a Chinese inn on the Mongolian plain. This
+inn has no separate rooms; the guests all share the ample
+platform of the kitchen, and sleep on straw mats laid over
+the brickwork, which is heated by flues leading from fires
+on which their meals are cooked. The Chinese innkeeper
+was an old friend of mine, and he permitted me to share
+his room with him. From this, as a centre, I was able to
+make expeditions to four Mongolian settlements.</p>
+
+<p>'My first visit was made to a lama whom I have known
+for years, and who has been instructed in Christianity by
+others, both before and since I made his acquaintance. He
+is a man of influence, wealth, and leisure, and, though a
+priest, has a wife and child. I spent almost a whole day
+with him, and hardly know what to think about him. He
+seems to admit that there must be a God of the universe,
+and admits that Christ may be a revelation of Him, but in
+the same sense in which Buddha was. From one part of
+his conversation I was almost led to believe that he had
+been praying to Jesus, but I could get him to make no such
+admission. I fear that the inquiring spirit of former years
+has given place to a spirit of indifference. He has everything
+he wants, he has little or no care, seemingly; he is
+content to let things drift, and keeps his mind easy. If he
+were only waked up he might do much for his countrymen.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_158" id="Page_158">[Pg 158]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'My second visit was to a temple and cluster of tents,
+where I found some old acquaintances; was politely received,
+but nothing more.</p>
+
+<p>'My third visit was to another cluster of tents, where I
+was at once hailed as the doctor, and, <i>nolens volens</i>, compelled
+to examine and prescribe for a number of diseases.
+Some cures accomplished years before explained the enthusiasm
+of the friends there, but for spiritual results I looked
+in vain.</p>
+
+<p>'My next expedition was to a place some miles&mdash;say
+eight&mdash;away. Some years ago, in stormy weather, Mrs.
+Gilmour and I, soaked out of our tent, had found shelter in
+the mud-house of a Mongol, who refused to take anything
+for the use of his building, remarking that we would be
+going and coming that way afterwards, and that then we
+might give him a present of some foreign article or other.
+I had sent him a few things, but had never since personally
+visited him, and when I reached the settlement I was
+grieved to find that the old man was dead. His son, a lad
+of twenty-three, had succeeded to his estate, and his small
+official dignity and emoluments, and received me in a most
+remarkably friendly way. He was just starting from home,
+but on seeing me gave up all idea of his going away, and,
+insisting on my staying in his tent for the night, spent the
+remainder of the day with me.</p>
+
+<p>'Next day, slinging on one side a postman's brown bag
+containing my kit and provisions; on the other an angler's
+waterproof bag, with books, &amp;c.; and carrying from a stick
+over my shoulder a Chinaman's sheepskin coat, I left my
+landlord drinking the two ounces of hot Chinese whisky
+which formed the invariable introduction to his breakfast
+turned my face northwards, and started for a twenty-three
+miles' walk to the settlement which, for some summers in
+succession, has furnished me with men and oxen for my
+annual journeys. Now the Mongols are familiar with the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_159" id="Page_159">[Pg 159]</a></span>
+Russians, who, as tea-agents, reside in Kalgan; they have
+seen many passing foreign travellers on horses, camels, and
+in carts; they have seen missionary journeys performed
+on donkeys and ox-carts; but I think that that morning
+for the first time had they seen a foreigner, with all his
+belongings hung about him, tramping the country after
+the manner of their own begging lamas. There were few
+people to meet on the road, but those I did meet asked the
+customary questions in tones of great surprise, received my
+answers with evident incredulity, and, for the most part
+rode away muttering to themselves, <i>You eldib eem</i>, which
+may be translated to mean, "Strange affair." My feet,
+through want of practice, I suppose, soon showed symptoms
+of thinking this style of travelling as strange as the Mongols
+did, and were badly blistered long before the journey was
+over.</p></blockquote>
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 350px;"><a id="p159" name="p159"></a>
+<img src="images/159.jpg" alt="JAMES GILMOUR EQUIPPED FOR HIS WALKING EXPEDITION IN
+MONGOLIA IN FEBRUARY 1884" title="" />
+<span class="caption">JAMES GILMOUR EQUIPPED FOR HIS WALKING EXPEDITION IN
+MONGOLIA IN FEBRUARY 1884</span>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote><p>'An occasional rest and a bite of snow varied the
+painful monotony of the few last long miles; the river was
+reached at last, and, crossing it, I was soon in front of the
+cluster of huts I had come to visit, and on looking up I
+was agreeably astonished to find that the first man to come
+out to meet me was the mandarin of the district. He was
+soon joined by others, and, rescued from the dogs, I was
+escorted to his tent, seated before the fire, and supplied with
+a cup and full tea-pot. I had intended to drink tea in his
+tent only for form's sake; but his tea was good, the snow
+seemed only to have increased my thirst, the man himself
+was sincerely friendly; under the circumstances my stoicism
+broke down, and the mandarin's tea-pot was soon all but
+empty. Meanwhile, his tent had been filling with friends
+and neighbours, to whom the news of my arrival had spread,
+and in a little while I had round me a representative from
+nearly every family in the village. Among the others came
+my two servants&mdash;the priest and the layman who had
+driven my ox-carts for me. Escorted by these I went to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_162" id="Page_162">[Pg 162]</a></span>
+another tent, rested there awhile, and then moved into a
+mud-built house. The priest I had come to visit was busy
+lighting a fire which would do nothing but smoke, and the
+room was soon full. Finding him alone, I told him that I
+had come to speak to him and my other friends about the
+salvation of their souls, and was pressing him to accept
+Christ, when a layman I also knew entered. Without
+waiting for me to say anything, the priest related the drift
+of our conversation to the layman, who, tongs in hand, was
+trying to make the fire blaze. Blaze it would not, but sent
+forth an increasing volume of smoke, and the layman, invisible
+to me in the dense cloud, though only about two
+yards away, spoke up and said that for months he had been
+a scholar of Jesus, and that if the priest would join him
+they would become Christians together. Whether the
+priest would join him or not, his mind was made up, he
+would trust the Saviour. By this time the cloud had
+settled down lower still. I was lying flat on the platform,
+and the two men were crouching on the floor&mdash;I could just
+see dimly the bottom of their skin coats&mdash;but the place was
+beautiful to me as the gate of heaven, and the words of the
+confession of Christ from out the cloud of smoke were
+inspiriting to me as if they had been spoken by an angel
+from out of a cloud of glory.</p>
+
+<p>'But neighbours came in, duty called the blackman
+(layman) away, the evening meal had to be prepared and
+eaten, and it was not till late at night that I had opportunity
+for a private talk with him who had confessed Christ;
+and even then it was not private, because we were within
+earshot of a family of people in their beds.</p>
+
+<p>'Of all the countries I have visited Mongolia is the
+most sparsely peopled, and yet it is, of all the places I have
+seen, the most difficult to get private conversation with any
+one. Everybody, even half-grown children, seems to think
+he has a perfect right to intrude on any and all conversation.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_163" id="Page_163">[Pg 163]</a></span>
+Bar the door and deny admittance, and you would
+be suspected of hatching a plot. Take a man away for a
+stroll that you may talk to him in quiet, and you would be
+suspected of some dangerous enchantment. Remembering
+that one must always have some definite message or business
+to perform when he travels, and hoping to be able to
+do something with this same blackman, I had purposely
+left, in the Chinese inn, some presents which I could not
+well carry with me, and after a day's rest the blackman
+and I started to bring them. That gave us twenty-three
+miles' private conversation, and a good answer to give to
+all who demanded, "Where are you going?" "What to
+do?" He gave me the history of the origin and growth
+of his belief in Christ. I taught him much he did not
+know, and at a lonely place we sat down and lifted our
+voices to heaven in prayer. It was the pleasantest walk I
+ever had in Mongolia, and at the same time the most
+painful. My feet broke down altogether. It was evident
+I could not walk back again the next day, so, acting on
+my follower's advice, by a great effort I walked into the
+inn as if my feet were all right; we bargained for a cart
+and, the Chinaman not suspecting the state of my feet, we
+got it at a reasonable rate. Mongols and Chinese joined
+in explaining to me how much time and labour I would
+have saved if I had hired a cart at first, taken everything
+with me, and not returned to the inn at all. From their
+point of view they were right; but the blackman and I
+looked at the thing from a different standpoint. We had
+accomplished our purpose, and felt that we could afford to
+let our neighbours plume themselves on their supposed
+superior wisdom.</p>
+
+<p>'Another day's rest at this place gave me what I much
+wanted&mdash;an opportunity for a long quiet talk with the
+mandarin of this small tribe. I was especially anxious to
+explain to him the true nature of Christianity, because the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_164" id="Page_164">[Pg 164]</a></span>
+Mongol who professes Christianity lives under his jurisdiction,
+and I felt sure that a right understanding of the case
+might be of service in protecting the professor from troubles
+that are likely to come to him through men misunderstanding
+his case. The mandarin came. On my last visit
+I had been the means of curing him of a troublesome
+complaint over which he had spent much time and money;
+in addition, I had brought him a present from England.
+He was perfectly friendly and exceedingly attentive, and
+at the close of the conversation asked some questions
+which I thought evinced that he had somewhat entered
+into the spirit of the conversation. He is a man of few
+words, but from what he said I hope that he feels something
+of the truth of Christianity.</p>
+
+<p>'My next expedition was to a mandarin of wealth and
+rank, whose encampment occupies a commanding site on
+a mountain-side overlooking a large lake. I found him
+at home, and, as he knows well the main doctrines of
+Christianity, my main mission to him at this time was to
+try and rouse him to earnestness of thought and action in
+regard to his personal relation to Christ. We spent great
+part of the afternoon in earnest talking, and I was much
+pleased with the manner in which he, from time to time,
+explained to another mandarin, who was there as guest,
+doctrines and facts which were alluded to in our conversation.
+Next morning he started on a journey connected
+with the business of his office, and I returned to my friendly
+quarters where I had left my belongings.</p>
+
+<p>'I felt it laid upon me to visit two lamas at a temple
+some seventy miles from where I was, and started next
+day. I reached the temple in three days, and found that
+both the lamas I had come to see were dead. So, as far
+as they were concerned, I was too late. Both on the road,
+however, and at the temple itself, I had good opportunities
+for preaching and teaching. I met some interesting men,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_165" id="Page_165">[Pg 165]</a></span>
+and not only in tents where I was entertained as guest, but
+sometimes out in the open desert, stray travellers would
+meet me, dismount from their horses, and give me occasion
+for Christian conversation. Five days completed this round,
+and after another day's rest I started back for Kalgan,
+escorted for ten miles by him who had professed Christ.
+We walked slowly, as we had much to say. Arrived at the
+parting place, we sat down and prayed together. I then
+left, and the last I saw of the poor fellow, there he was,
+sitting in the same place still. I reached Kalgan without
+adventure, and returned to Peking on March 21, having
+been away just over a month.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Possibly the most touching comment upon this extraordinary
+journey is to give some of the brief entries which
+refer to it in the diary.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>February 19, 1884.</i>&mdash;Started in a litter for Mongolia.
+Good talk in inn with innman.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>February 23.</i>&mdash;Went to Mr. Williams. My letter had
+not reached them. No one knew I was coming.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>February 25.</i>&mdash;Over the Pass to Barosaij.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>February 26.</i>&mdash;Spent the day with Tu Gishuae. Urged
+on him the internal proof of Christianity&mdash;the change of
+heart.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>February 28.</i>&mdash;Shabberti. Boyinto Jauggé has desire
+to become scholar of Jesus.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>March 1.</i>&mdash;Walked here. Feet terribly bad. Snow
+on the road. Great thirst. Badma Darag met me. Tea
+in his tent. Boyinto's confession in the smoke of the
+<i>baishin</i>.'<a name="FNanchor_4_4" id="FNanchor_4_4"></a><a href="#Footnote_4_4" class="fnanchor">[4]</a></p>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_4_4" id="Footnote_4_4"></a><a href="#FNanchor_4_4"><span class="label">[4]</span></a> Fire in the centre of the tent.</p></div>
+
+<p>'<i>March 2.</i>&mdash;Sabbath. Quiet day. Much talk with all.
+The Lord opened my lips.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>March 3.</i>&mdash;Walked to Barosaij with Boyinto to bring<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_166" id="Page_166">[Pg 166]</a></span>
+my presents. Talk about Christianity. Prayer in the
+desert. Feet terribly bad, oh, such pain in walking.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>March 4.</i>&mdash;Carted back.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>March 7.</i>&mdash;Hara Oss. Walked back here. Called on
+Tu Lobsung. Talk. He knew the way to heaven, but
+said, "Tell it to some of the younger ones." "You go first,"
+I replied. "You most need to know."'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>March 8.</i>&mdash;Terrible feet. Got to Chagan Hauran.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>March 14.</i>&mdash;Boyinto accompanied me to Chagan
+Balgas with his pony. Saw him sitting as long as I was
+in sight. Feet bad.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>March 21.</i>&mdash;Left Pei Kuan at 4 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span> Dark and snow.
+Terrible march over slippery stones. Nan Kou at 7 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span>
+No donkey on such a snowy day. Hired the next twenty-seven
+li. Stiff march. Shatto at 11.35. Terrible march
+to Ching Ho at 3 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> Terrible march to Tê Sheng Mên.
+Home at 6.10. Prayer Meeting. Thanks be unto God for
+all His mercies.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Early in 1885 Mr. Gilmour's heart was rejoiced by the
+tidings of the baptism of Boyinto, the Mongol to whom
+reference has been repeatedly made above. Although
+Gilmour's was not the hand to administer the rite, undoubtedly
+the conversion was the result of his work. On
+January 26, 1885, he received a letter from the Rev. W. P.
+Sprague, of the American Mission at Kalgan, part of which
+we quote.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Kalgan: Jan. 14, 1885.
+</p>
+
+<p>'Dear Brother Gilmour,&mdash;I hasten to tell you the very
+good news. Boyinto of Shabberti was baptized by my
+hand this day into the Church of Christ, here at Kalgan,
+in the presence of our assembled church and congregation.
+I'm sure you will rejoice and thank God more than any of
+us. And I never saw our Christians so happy to receive<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_167" id="Page_167">[Pg 167]</a></span>
+any one into the Church. The only thing I regret is that
+it should not be your hand instead of mine to administer
+the sacred rite.</p>
+
+<p>'I wrote you of his visit to us a month ago, and his
+application to join the Church here, and our satisfaction with
+his appearance. He turned up again yesterday morning,
+and spent all day with us. In the afternoon we had, by
+previous appointment, a union meeting of upper and lower
+city congregations, as a continuation of week of prayer
+meeting, because the interest was so great. Mr. Roberts
+preached, and in the after part of meeting, when two or
+three others had risen for prayers, I asked Boyinto if he
+wanted to ask Christians to pray for him, and he arose and
+expressed his desires, including wanting to be baptized very
+plainly. We called church meeting at close of the service,
+and proceeded to examine him for admission to Church.
+He answered so well as to please every one, making some
+happy hits, as when asked what sort of a place heaven
+was, replied, "I haven't been there&mdash;how can I tell?"
+Then said, "Would any one pray to go there if it were not
+a good place?" But his straightforward, open simplicity
+was refreshing. There seemed no reason for thinking he
+was other than an honest believer&mdash;seeking to follow Jesus
+in all things. The native church members first responded
+with enthusiasm that he was a most fit candidate for
+receiving to the Church, and expressed great delight at
+finding a Mongol who loved and trusted our Saviour. So
+we felt with Peter, "Can any man forbid water that these
+should not be baptized?" The others then asked me to
+baptize him on the morrow, when we were to have another
+union meeting at our place. And could you have seen his
+rising and answering my questions, give assent to creed
+and covenant, and then see him remove his cap and bow
+his head reverently and receive the water of baptism, your
+heart would overflow with gratitude and praise to God for<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_168" id="Page_168">[Pg 168]</a></span>
+this first fruit from Mongolia. After prayer we sang "From
+Greenland's icy mountains," changed to "From Mongolia,
+&amp;c.," and we felt it as never before.</p>
+
+<p>'Though God has thus given us great pleasure in
+gathering this first fruit, still I feel, and we all feel, that the
+honour of the work belongs to God, and the reward to you
+and others.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>During 1884 and 1885 the regular work of the Peking
+mission occupied almost the whole of his time, the Rev.
+S. E. Meech being in England on furlough, and most of his
+duties therefore falling upon Mr. Gilmour. During his
+stay in England he had attended many of the Salvation
+Army meetings, and had caught much of their spirit. He
+had also come to the conviction that men needed to be dealt
+with individually rather than in the mass. Hence he gave
+much time to conversation, to teaching single persons the
+Christian catechism and the New Testament, and endeavouring,
+by talking and praying with them, to lead them
+to a knowledge of the truth. From six in the morning
+until ten at night he was at the service of all comers. In
+the afternoon he attended one or both of the Peking
+chapels, preaching if there were the opportunity, but always
+eagerly on the alert for any individuals showing signs of
+interest in the Gospel. It had been the custom of the
+missionaries to reserve the Sunday evening for an English
+service, devoted to their own spiritual refreshment. This,
+which was held in the mission compound, he ceased to
+attend, even although his absence sometimes made it impossible
+to hold the service, in order that he might find time
+to read and talk and pray with his Chinese servants. Frequently
+the meal-time would find him thus engaged, but the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_169" id="Page_169">[Pg 169]</a></span>
+meal had to wait until his visitor had left, or until the interview
+came to its natural close. He ceased to read all newspapers
+except those distinctively Christian. He found no
+time for books, as he felt that direct work for the Chinese
+should fill the hours he might otherwise devote to reading.
+He became more wholly than ever the man of one book&mdash;the
+Bible&mdash;and so absorbed did he grow in this close dealing
+with souls that in the earlier stages of his wife's illness
+he felt constrained to place it before even her wish that
+he would remain by her at periods of severe suffering and
+weakness.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>December 9, 1883.</i>&mdash;At chapel met Wang from a place
+300 li away down in the country. He had heard a sermon
+there two or three years before which he remembered, and
+could quote. I began the service, and brought him up here
+to my study. We were talking when another man, Jui,
+came in from 130 li north of Peking. He had to run away
+from home on account of misconduct. These two kept me
+till dark.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In a letter to the Rev. S. E. Meech, dated November 9,
+1885, Mr. Gilmour refers to a number of these individual
+cases in which he has been interesting himself, and the
+way in which he has dealt with them. It illustrates his
+method of close and careful dealing with each native.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Ch'ang attends Sunday and Friday services. My
+opinion about Ch'ang is that he wants mission employ.
+He has no expectation of that from me, and little from
+Rees. I think, too, that he does not mean to break with
+Christianity or with us, and I faintly hope that his experiences
+with us will do us good, though they have been most
+painful to us. I think you'll find him much more tractable<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_170" id="Page_170">[Pg 170]</a></span>
+than he would have been had he not been through these
+troubles with us.</p>
+
+<p>'Hsing has had the devil putting philosophic doubts
+into him. I have pressed him to pelt the devil with
+Scripture, as our Master did.</p>
+
+<p>'Li, shoemaker, I <i>do</i> like. He cannot stay to Sunday
+service. I take him before service therefore.</p>
+
+<p>'Fu does well. Last Friday he remained after prayer-meeting,
+and talked till 9.40 about all manner of things
+secular and sacred. He has most pleasant remembrances
+of Emily&mdash;Emily, too, liked him.</p>
+
+<p>'Jui Wu, the powder magazine man, is in a more hopeful
+case. He may come all right yet.<a name="FNanchor_5_5" id="FNanchor_5_5"></a><a href="#Footnote_5_5" class="fnanchor">[5]</a></p>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_5_5" id="Footnote_5_5"></a><a href="#FNanchor_5_5"><span class="label">[5]</span></a> Fu is now (1892) an evangelist, and Jui Wu a dispenser, in the Chi Chou
+Mission.</p></div>
+
+<p>'Old Tai nearly went, but will now, I think, remain till
+you come. He wants to tiffin with me on Sundays, and
+enjoys much four, five, or six small cups of good strong
+tea with milk and sugar. He is growing in grace.</p>
+
+<p>'Young Tai I am detaining after his father goes and
+reading with him and teaching him. He gives up his
+trade for the day, and I want to give him a good day.</p>
+
+<p>'Chao Erh attends well and is improved in circumstances.</p>
+
+<p>'Lu Ss&#365;; is in his old trade, and doing well. He comes
+on Sundays when he comes. He was the man I hoped
+least of, and as yet he pleases me almost most.</p>
+
+<p>'Lama comes to-morrow to finish reconstructing Mongol
+catechism. I may go on a two months' journey to
+Mongolia, starting in December. I'll have to see the
+children to Tientsin in February, and want to meet you.</p>
+
+<p>'Hsüs as they were.<a name="FNanchor_6_6" id="FNanchor_6_6"></a><a href="#Footnote_6_6" class="fnanchor">[6]</a></p>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_6_6" id="Footnote_6_6"></a><a href="#FNanchor_6_6"><span class="label">[6]</span></a> Father and son; the only native preachers in the West City of Peking
+at that time.</p></div>
+
+<p>'I am very much encouraged and thankful about the
+little Church. I can honestly say that I have tried to do<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_171" id="Page_171">[Pg 171]</a></span>
+my best for it during your absence, and God has encouraged
+me a good deal in it. I have reaped some that you
+have sown, and have endeavoured to sow something for
+you to reap when you return.</p>
+
+<p>'I sometimes have deep fits of the blues when I think
+of the children, but their mother was able to trust Jesus
+with them, and why should not I?</p>
+
+<p>'The Mongol work, too, has entered on a new phase,
+and that opens up a new future for me. It is a formidable
+affair. I don't think I'll go to Kalgan or that region. I
+fear no doctor would stay with me there. I may go away
+North-east. I can hardly tell yet. Meantime, with God's
+help, I hope to do another month's work in Peking, and
+then hand the thing over to Rees once for all. Most of
+my books I'll sell. What use are they to me? I never
+have time to read them, and am not likely ever to have.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The letter just quoted was written after the sad event to
+which we must now refer. Towards the close of the summer
+of 1885 Mr. Gilmour awoke to the fact that one of the
+heaviest sorrows of his life was coming upon him. For some
+years past Mrs. Gilmour had been subject to severe attacks
+of pain. The visit to England and the rest and change of
+the old home life had in a measure restored her. But
+hardly were they comfortably established in their old Peking
+quarters ere some of her most trying symptoms reappeared.
+With that brave heart and resolute spirit characteristic of
+her whole missionary career, for a time she gave herself to
+the duties of the mission and bore her full share of its
+anxieties and toils. But gradually she was constrained to
+recognise that her active work was over. From the first
+she had thrown herself whole-heartedly into missionary
+Service. She could converse fluently with the Mongols,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[Pg 172]</a></span>
+having acquired their language in the same way as her
+husband, by enduring repeatedly all the privations of life
+in a Mongol tent. She had impressed them by her fondness
+for animals, by her gentleness of spirit, and by her
+evident interest in all that bore upon their own welfare.
+In Peking she had laboured hard among the women and
+girls, both in the matter of education and also of direct
+religious instruction. A very bitter element in her cup of
+sorrow was the conviction gradually forced upon her that
+her power to do this work was fast slipping away. In a
+letter to her sister, Mrs. Meech, then in England, dated
+May 2, 1885, she gives the first clear expression to this feeling:
+'I would have written before, but I have been ill for
+about six weeks; not actually ill, except one week, but not
+able to do anything except the children's lessons and the
+harmonium on Sundays sometimes. All the rest has had
+to go. I am sorry, but it can't be helped. How long it
+will last I don't know. I can't get stronger, so I must be
+content to be tired. I am nothing more than weak, and a
+great many people are that. There has been a grand
+revival here. It seemed to pass like a mountain torrent,
+while I had only to look on and see. My only wonder was
+that people had lived so long without the happiness that
+they might have had for the taking. I didn't want to go
+to the meeting, I felt so weak and unable to bear the
+tension of spiritual excitement. But as it was it didn't
+tire me at all, but made me love a lot of the people. May
+the Chinese feel the flood tide of new life that has come
+into Peking! And they must, there can be nothing to
+hinder it.'</p>
+
+<p>The reference in the last part of this letter is to a great<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[Pg 173]</a></span>
+deepening of spiritual life that took place among the
+missionaries, and also among some of the European residents
+in Peking.</p>
+
+<p>The first explicit reference by Mr. Gilmour to his
+coming sorrow occurs in the Diary; but in his report, sent
+home a month later, and dated August 4, 1885, he wrote:
+'Mrs. Gilmour is very ill, and now very weak. I fear all
+hope of her recovery is taken away. Her trouble is a run-down,
+but the serious complication is her lungs. We are
+at the hills in a temple with another family, the Childs.
+Mrs. Child came out in the same ship with Mrs. Gilmour,
+when, as Miss Prankard, she came first to China. Mrs.
+Child renders invaluable service to the sick one.'</p>
+
+<p>In the Diary the following entries show the course of
+sorrowful events:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>July 4, 1885.</i>&mdash;It really dawns upon me to-day in such
+a way that I can feel it that my wife is likely to die, and I
+too feel something of how desolate it would be for me with
+my motherless children sent away from me. Eh, man!'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>August 22.</i>&mdash;Emily spoke of being sometimes <i>so</i> happy.
+She is quite aware now she cannot recover.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>September 13</i>, Sunday, Peking.&mdash;Emily saw all the
+women. She felt very weak to-day. Remarked at 7 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span>:
+"Well, Jamie, I am going, I suppose. I'll soon see you there.
+It won't be long." I said she would not want me much
+there. She said fondly she would. "I think I'll sit at the
+gate and look for you coming." Said she has been out for
+the last time. Asked me not to go to chapel, but went.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>September 17.</i>&mdash;To-day, in the morning, I promised
+Emily that I would remain home from the chapel and give
+her a holiday. She was <i>so</i> pleased. We had a most enjoyable
+afternoon. She was so happy. She sat up for an<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[Pg 174]</a></span>
+hour or so, and we conversed about all things, the use of
+the beautiful in creation, &amp;c.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>All the next day Mrs. Gilmour slowly sank, and soon
+after the midnight of September 18 passed peacefully
+within 'the gate.' The story of the closing scene was thus
+told by her husband:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Peking: Saturday, September 19, 1885.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Meech,&mdash;Emily crossed the river last night,
+or this morning rather at 12.15.</p>
+
+<p>'I was called in from the Friday evening prayer meeting
+just as it was concluding, and found her with laboured
+breath and fixed eyes. For a time we thought it was all
+to end at once. After a time she got over it.</p>
+
+<p>'10 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> was a repetition of 8 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span>'s experience.</p>
+
+<p>'At 12 midnight she was labouring much in her breath,
+coughed a very little cough, and all at once the rapidity of
+her breath nearly doubled, suddenly her hand fell over
+powerless, her eyes became fixed, there was some difficult
+breathing, and with Mrs. Henderson on the one side of the
+bed, which had been moved when we came from the hills
+into the sitting-room, she departed.</p>
+
+<p>'During these four hours she spoke little; once or twice
+she called for milk, but for the most part contented herself
+with assenting or dissenting to and from my remarks
+and suggestions by moving the head.</p>
+
+<p>'At 10.30, seeing me sleepy and desiring to sleep herself,
+she asked me to go and lie down, but I said I would
+not do so while she was so ill.</p>
+
+<p>'I asked her if she felt all safe in the hands of Jesus.
+She nodded her assent.</p>
+
+<p>'Some month or six weeks ago we two had talked
+about everything to be done in case of her death, the
+children, etc., and not only then, but more than once we
+had talked over spiritual things, because we feared that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_175" id="Page_175">[Pg 175]</a></span>
+when the end came she might not be able to speak. I am
+glad we did so. During these four hours she was either
+in such great distress, or, when free from distress, was so
+tired and eager to sleep, that talking was hardly possible.</p>
+
+<p>'The "Rest" she so longed for she has now got.</p>
+
+<p>'I treasure what she said one day when she had been,
+I think, reading her wall text, "T<i>o me to live is Christ, to
+die is gain</i>," when I asked her if <i>she</i> felt it so. She said she
+did, and often would remark that to go would be far better
+for her, but she was so eager to get well for my sake and
+that of the children. For herself, too, she was more and
+more enchanted with the beauty God had put in the world.
+On Friday I went in, she waved her hand and said, "What
+beauty!" It was some flowers on the table. A bunch of
+grapes, a beauty, filled her mouth with praise to God for
+all His goodness to her. The post waits. Funeral Monday.</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Yours in sorrow,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">J. Gilmour.</span>'
+</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Mrs. Gilmour was buried on September 21. Her
+faith was clear and strong. Uncommon as their courtship
+had been, the subsequent married life was very happy. She
+was the equal of her husband in missionary zeal and
+enthusiasm, and he himself bears testimony to the unerring
+skill which she possessed in gauging the moral qualities of
+the Chinese. She gave much time and labour to Christian
+work among the women and girls in Peking; and her
+husband was greatly helped in his work during the nearly
+eleven years of married life by her sound judgment, her
+strong affection, her loving Christian character, and her
+entire consecration to the Lord Jesus Christ.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_176" id="Page_176">[Pg 176]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_IX" id="CHAPTER_IX"></a>CHAPTER IX</h2>
+
+<h3>A CHANGE OF FIELD</h3>
+
+
+<p>During 1885 James Gilmour gradually reached the conclusion
+that a change of field was desirable. He was
+aware that friends and colleagues more or less qualified to
+form an opinion had urged upon him the advisability of
+labouring in Eastern Mongolia among the agricultural
+Mongols. No one knew so well as himself the advantages
+and the disadvantages of this plan. The reasons that finally
+led him to a decision were noble and characteristic. It was
+a hard field, and no one else could or would go. The Mongols
+of the Plain were to some extent benefited by the American
+Mission at Kalgan; those dwelling in Eastern Mongolia
+were without a helper. Considerations like these, as he
+tells us, decided his new course of action.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'In these circumstances my mind has turned away
+north-east from Peking, where people are not so scarce,
+and where the Mongols live as farmers. I have been to
+that region twice. I knew some people who came from
+that region. As soon as Mr. Rees returns from Chi Chou
+I hope to go again. A doctor might be induced to settle
+somewhere there, and though it would be hard a bit, a
+family might live there too, which I don't think would be
+possible on the plain beyond Kalgan.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[Pg 177]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'I am fully aware of the difficulties. They are:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>'1. I have no proper Chinaman to take with me. More
+than half the population is Chinese, and I could not do
+well without a Chinaman.</p>
+
+<p>'2. It is a new district and will take time to work up.</p>
+
+<p>'3. It is not easily reached from Peking or anywhere
+else, and will be a very isolated part.</p>
+
+<p>'4. It is rather a rough and unsafe district.</p>
+
+<p>'I know all these, but feel, in reliance on God, like facing
+the thing as the best and proper thing to do. There are
+inns all about, and though for some time a private location
+may not be secured, we can still go about among the people.
+My main hope, though, is in settling down somewhere as a
+head centre, in close contact with the people, so that I
+earnestly desire that the doctor should come. If he is
+unmarried I would be glad to see him to-morrow. Could
+you not get a doctor who would be willing to remain single
+till a location could be secured? After a location has been
+secured let him marry if he likes.</p>
+
+<p>'I think that the region I have in my mind would make
+a good centre for a doctor, and that he would have plenty
+of practice among Mongols and Chinese, especially if he
+could start a hospital for in-patients.</p>
+
+<p>'I am very glad that the Mongolian region around
+Kalgan has shown signs of bearing fruit. It has strengthened
+my faith much. I am also glad that God has acknowledged
+in some degree my work here in Peking, and I feel
+more hopeful than ever I did. God, too, has cut me adrift
+from all my fixings, so that I feel quite ready to go anywhere
+if only He goes with me.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Mr. Gilmour entered upon this new departure on the
+understanding that a medical colleague should be sent to
+him at the earliest possible moment. This responsibility<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[Pg 178]</a></span>
+the London Board assumed and endeavoured to discharge.
+The result was a severe trial to the faith, not only of the
+solitary worker but to all interested&mdash;and they were many&mdash;in
+the fate of the new mission. As we shall see later on,
+when a congenial and competent medical colleague reached
+him, and was entering with vigour and hope upon the
+work, Dr. Mackenzie of Tientsin suddenly died, and before
+the immediate and urgent claims of Tientsin the claims of
+Mongolia had to give way. But in estimating the success
+of both missions, that on the Plain, and that in Eastern
+Mongolia, it must never be forgotten that what Gilmour
+considered <i>essential</i>, the presence and help of a medical
+colleague, was never in the Providence of God granted to
+him for any length of time. In the account he gives of his
+first visit to the region as its missionary&mdash;he had been
+twice before on visits of inspection&mdash;he dwells upon this
+necessity.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I left Peking December 14, 1885, and re-entered
+Peking February 16, 1886, so that my absence from here
+was just two months. The part of Mongolia I went to is
+situated 800 li, or say 270 English miles, north-east by
+east of Peking, and, at the usual rate of 90 li (or 30 miles)
+a day, is nine days distant. This is not the part of
+Mongolia near Kalgan. Kalgan is north-north-west of
+Peking, five days' journey.</p></blockquote>
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 500px;"><a name="p179" id="p179">
+<img src="images/179.jpg" width="500" height="744" alt="Map illustrating James Gilmour&#39;s labours in Eastern Mongolia" title="" /></a>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Whilst I was considering my plans a Mongol appeared
+in Peking who was willing to take me to his home, and I
+went with him, hoping thus to get introduced to a district
+of country, an introduction being both necessary and helpful.
+Ta Chêng Tz&#365; is the name of the place where,
+through his introduction, I was located from December 23,
+1885 to February 9, 1886. I had a room in an inn. I spent
+<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_181" id="Page_181">[Pg 181]</a></span>some days at the home of my Mongol friend and made two
+journeys to other places, but Ta Chêng Tz&#365; was my headquarters.
+It is a small market town, with a daily fair.
+The surrounding neighbourhood is peopled with Mongols
+and Chinese in about equal proportions. The Mongols are
+mostly lords of the soil, and style the Chinese slaves, that
+is in the country. The real trade of the whole locality is
+in the hands of the Chinese. The Mongols all speak
+Chinese, and the town resident Mongols have, many of
+them, forgotten Mongolian, and laugh at themselves as not
+being able to speak their own language.</p>
+
+<p>'The country is like Wales in this respect, that, though
+Mongolian is the native language, the coming language
+and the language that is affected and sought after, is
+Chinese. Well-to-do Mongols have Chinese teachers for
+their children, and read Chinese well. During my stay
+there I sold more Chinese than Mongolian books, and
+talked more Chinese than Mongolian, though my intercourse
+was largely with Mongols.</p>
+
+<p>'Opium is largely grown there, so is tobacco, and large
+quantities of whisky are manufactured and consumed. It
+was partly a famine year. At a little distance from Ta
+Chêng Tz&#365; the harvest had failed, and I think the line of
+preaching that seemed to impress the hearers most was one
+that reasoned with them about the growth, manufacture,
+and use of these three, being so contrary to Heaven's
+design in giving land and rain to grow food, that it was
+not to be wondered at if, seeing how the land and rain
+were perverted, God should send short rations. Evil
+speaking, vile language, made a fourth subject which naturally
+came in for notice, and on all these four subjects I
+scarcely ever spoke without gaining the nearly universal
+concurrence of my little audiences.</p>
+
+<p>'The great theme, however, was Christ, and I think
+that most men in that little market town, and a great<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_182" id="Page_182">[Pg 182]</a></span>
+many of those who used to come to the fair, both heard
+and understood the great gospel truth of salvation in
+Jesus.</p>
+
+<p>'Eager to see some more of the country, and in the
+hope that I might be able to talk to him on the way, I hired
+a Mongol to carry my bedding and books, and made a
+descent on a village thirty miles away. The general cold
+of the winter was aggravated by a snowstorm which overtook
+us at the little market town, and I have no words to
+tell you how the cold felt that day as I paraded that one
+street. I sold a fair number of books, though my hands
+were too much benumbed almost to be able to hand the
+books out. I made some attempts at preaching, but the
+muscles were also benumbed&mdash;that day <i>was</i> a <i>cold</i> day.</p>
+
+<p>'I was turned out of two respectable inns at Bull Town
+because I was a foot traveller, had no cart or animal, that
+is, and had to put up in a tramps' tavern because I came
+as a tramp!</p>
+
+<p>'Next journey I made I hired a man and a <i>donkey</i>.
+The donkey was my passport to respectability, and I was
+more comfortable too, being able to take more bedding
+with me. I was warned against going to Ch'ao Yang, sixty
+miles, the roads being represented as unsafe; but I went
+and found no trouble, though there was a severe famine in
+the district. I spent a day each at two market towns on
+the way, and two days in Ch'ao Yang itself.</p>
+
+<p>'The journey home I made on foot, a donkey driven by
+a Mongol carrying my bedding and books. I adopted this
+plan mainly to bring myself into close contact with the
+Mongol. He proved himself a capital fellow to travel
+with, but as yet has shown no signs of belief in Christ. As
+we did long marches my feet suffered badly.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In a private letter written at this time he enters a little
+more fully into what he had to endure.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[Pg 183]</a></span></p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I had a good time in Mongolia, but oh! so cold.
+Some of the days I spent in the markets were so very cold
+that my muscles seemed benumbed, and speech even was
+difficult. I met with some spiritual response, though, and
+with that I can stand cold. Eh! man, I have got thin. I
+am feeding up at present. I left my medicines, books, &amp;c.,
+there, and walked home here, a donkey carrying my baggage,
+a distance of about three hundred miles, in seven and
+a half days, or about forty miles a day, and my feet were
+really very bad.</p>
+
+<p>'At night I used to draw a woollen thread through the
+blisters. In the morning I "hirpled" a little, but it was
+soon all right. I walked, not because I had not money to
+ride, but to get at the Mongol who was with me.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>These graphic pictures enable us to realise how Mr.
+Gilmour began the last great missionary enterprise of his
+life. He returned to Peking, and then had to pass through
+that severe trial which comes to almost all missionaries
+in the foreign field, which is often one of their heaviest
+crosses. His two eldest boys were sent home for education.
+They sailed from Tientsin March 23, 1886, the diary for
+that day containing the brief but significant reference:
+'At 6.45 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span> came all the friends once more, at 7.30 cast
+off, and the vessel slowly fell out into the middle of the
+river. Oh! the parting!' But at 8.30 on the same
+morning the sorrowful father had started on his solitary
+return journey to Peking. Bereft now of both wife, and
+boys he was to pass the rest of his career in China, except
+for the brief intervals of residence in Peking, in the cheerless,
+noisy, uncongenial quarters of an ordinary Chinese
+inn. The return of the Rev. S. E. Meech in April 1886
+set him entirely free from mission work in the capital.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_184" id="Page_184">[Pg 184]</a></span>
+He had already acquired the needful experience of his new
+field of labour, and on April 22, 1886, he started anew for
+Eastern Mongolia. It is neither necessary nor desirable to
+enter into any very detailed description of the next three
+years. In many respects day after day was occupied with
+the round of ever recurring and similar duties, but it is
+desirable to enter, if we can, with some minuteness into his
+inner life, and to lay bare the spiritual sources and springs
+of his outward actions. It is in these, in our judgment,
+that the true beauty, the abiding lesson, and the great
+success of his life consist. And this he has enabled us to
+do. In a private, not an official, letter to the Rev. R.
+Wardlaw Thompson, the Foreign Secretary of the London
+Missionary Society, he indicates his actions and the motives
+that were impelling him so to act, during the summer of
+1886. Differences of opinion arose with his fellow missionaries
+as to the wisdom of his methods and the soundness
+of his judgment. Those who differed most strongly
+from him knew little or nothing by personal observation
+and experience of the conditions of work either on the
+Plain or at Ch'ao Yang. But no question ever did or ever
+could arise as to the absolute consecration of his heart and
+life to the work of winning souls. The truth of the
+words in one of his official reports was manifest to all:
+'Man, the fire of God is upon me to go and preach.'</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'The past four and a half months has been a time of no
+small trial and spiritual tension. Since April 22 I have
+had no tidings of the outer world. An agent of the Bible
+Society, who was selling books in the district, was with me
+for a month, but he had gone out before me, so that when
+we met he had no news for me, but wanted news from me.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_185" id="Page_185">[Pg 185]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'Some men, who gave promise of believing in Jesus,
+have fallen away, and I have a haunting suspicion that it
+was one such man who, on the morning of Sunday, June 6,
+stole my beautiful copy of the revised Bible, leaving me till
+now with only a New Testament in English. I had much
+difficulty in procuring that Bible, and wasn't it heartless of
+a Chinaman to steal it for the leather binding, for which
+even he could have hardly any use? I said not a single
+word to anyone in the town about it, as I feared that
+making trouble over it would hinder me in future, by
+making innkeepers afraid to receive me, lest they should
+be held responsible for such losses. I can hardly say
+though, that, at first at least, I took joyfully the spoiling of
+my goods. Secret tears testified to my sense of the loss,
+but falling back on the faith that all things work together
+for my good, I was comforted, and gave the more earnest
+heed to the New Testament.</p>
+
+<p>'Then the Chinese would ask, "How many people have
+believed and entered the religion since you left Peking?"
+and such questions kept before my mind painfully how
+slowly things move, and drew out my soul in more
+painful longing for God's blessing in the conversion of
+men.</p>
+
+<p>'In the beginning of July I must have got a touch of
+the sun. Nearly all that month I was ill, but just then was
+the great annual fair at Ch'ao Yang, so, ill and all, I had
+the tent put up daily and dispensed medicines. My assistant,
+however, had to do most of the preaching; I had
+not much strength for that. The first three weeks in
+August I had diarrh&oelig;a and dysentery. I was at Ta Chêng
+Tz&#365;. There was no fair, and but poor market gatherings,
+but, weather permitting, we put up our tent daily and did
+good work. Paul says (Gal. iv. 19), "My little children, of
+whom I am again in travail until Christ be formed in you,"
+and he is right. It is a carrying of men in prayer until the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_186" id="Page_186">[Pg 186]</a></span>
+image of Christ is formed in them; and how many of them
+prove abortions.</p>
+
+<p>'One of the converts at Ta Chêng Tz&#365; caused me no
+little anxiety. I knew that he professed to be impressed
+last winter. He said he wanted to call on me in my inn
+and tell me his difficulties. I was eager to get home, but
+as he said he would have no leisure before a certain date,
+I waited till then, nearly a week, for almost no other
+purpose than to see him. He never came, and I trudged
+back to Peking downcast about him.</p>
+
+<p>'This year when we came to Ta Chêng Tz&#365; on our way
+to Ch'ao Yang, on going to his place for breakfast (he
+is one of two brothers who own and manage a restaurant,
+and both of them, and a third brother, are members of a
+sect which forbids opium, whisky, and tobacco), we were
+shown into the more private part, and he and his brother
+and the cook set upon us to inquire more fully about
+Christianity, how to enter it, etc, etc. This took me by
+surprise, and made me so glad that my breakfast for the
+most part remained uneaten, though we had travelled eight
+hours that morning. In the evening I did not go for a
+meal, and my assistant on going was met at the door by
+the inquirers, and so engaged in conversation about Christianity
+that darkness set in, the cooking range was closed,
+and the establishment shut for the day before they were
+finished. My man had no dinner. Next day we went on
+towards Ch'ao Yang thankful and happy. These restaurant
+people had a few days before been visited by the Bible
+Society's agent, and had derived much Christian benefit
+from his Chinese assistant.</p>
+
+<p>'Our interview with the restaurant men was on Monday.
+In Ch'ao Yang next Sunday, just six days after being, so
+to speak, on the mount of transfiguration with these Chinamen,
+on dismissing the few hangers-on that remained at
+the close of the afternoon preaching, and stepping down<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_187" id="Page_187">[Pg 187]</a></span>
+from the little vantage-ground from which I had been
+speaking, one of the audience said he would go home
+with me to my inn, as he had come with a letter to me
+from Ta Chêng Tz&#365; from the Bible agent. I went to
+the inn, read the letter, and found that he and his Chinese
+helper had differed, and he had come to Ta Chêng
+Tz&#365; seeking me. He needed and asked my help, so next
+day I started for Ta Chêng Tz&#365;, and on arriving there
+found that the little place was full of the news of the
+quarrel between the Christian foreigner and the Christian
+native. That was bad, but, worse still, on going to
+the restaurant I found the earnestness of the inquirers
+gone, and one of them said openly, "If this is the sort of
+fruit that Christianity bears, what better is it than any
+other religion?"</p>
+
+<p>'In a later visit paid in May they seemed colder still,
+and the place where I had hoped to gather fruit seemed
+barren and hopeless.</p>
+
+<p>'In August we again visited Ta Chêng Tz&#365;. I was
+blue. The fever of July, the defection of the Mongol
+donkey man, who failed to come for us, the diarrh&oelig;a,
+which on the journey changed to dysentery, being baffled
+in attempting to find suitable quarters in Ta Chêng Tz&#365;,
+and the chilled hearts of the restaurant men, made our
+entrance not cheerful. On the way my assistant and I
+had talked over matters, and resolved by prayer and endeavour
+to see what could be done for the restaurant men.
+Just ten days after our arrival the eldest brother called on
+me in my inn and said, "To-night I dismiss my gods,
+henceforth I am a Christian. I am ready to be baptized
+any day you may be pleased to name."</p>
+
+<p>'I cannot say what a relief these words brought me.
+There still remained anxieties in his case, but in a day or
+two things came out all right, and day by day in public in
+the restaurant he might be seen studying his catechism<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[Pg 188]</a></span>
+when unemployed, and speaking for Christianity to all who
+asked what book that was.</p>
+
+<p>'He is a leading spirit, though a poor scholar, and was
+the deacon or head of the branch of the sect in Ta Chêng
+Tz&#365;, called Tsai li ti. There are some twelve or sixteen
+members. Most of them joined the sect through his
+endeavours, and he is eager to rear up Christianity in the
+same way. You will partly understand now how anxious
+I am about him. If he goes on all right, we may soon have
+a little company of believers there. If he falls away&mdash;well,
+all things work together for my good.</p>
+
+<p>'One thing that moved these restaurant men towards
+Christianity was an incident which happened in their
+establishment last winter. A half-drunk Chinaman reviled
+me badly one evening at dinner. He laid to my charge
+many bad and grievous things. Though they were utterly
+false as regards me, they might be quite true of some other
+foreigner whom he may have met. It was useless to reason
+with a drunken man over a case of mistaken identity, so I
+said nothing, ate my dinner, paid my bill, and went to my
+inn. The restaurant men were very wroth with the man,
+they told me afterwards, and felt like "going for" him
+themselves, and never forgot what they were pleased to
+call my patience. In God's providence this little incident
+seems to have been an important factor in impressing them
+with favourable ideas of Christianity.</p>
+
+<p>'Another thing which seems to have impressed them
+was their seeing me this August, day by day at my post in
+my tent, carrying on the work, when they knew I was ill,
+and, according to their ideas, should have been in bed. I
+was not really so ill as all that, but that was their idea.
+I would be very glad to have another reviling and another
+attack of dysentery if the same results would follow.</p>
+
+<p>'The profession of the other adherent at Ta Chêng Tz&#365;,
+and the moving of the hearts, seemingly at least, of other<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[Pg 189]</a></span>
+two men who live at a distance, and had to leave for home
+suddenly before receiving full instruction, but of whom I try
+to have hope, have all moved my heart and seem answers to
+a great longing I had been crying to God about, namely,
+that He would give me power to move these heathen. Oh
+that He would do it!</p>
+
+<p>'I have felt it my duty to become a vegetarian on trial.
+I don't know whether I can carry it out. The Chinese
+look up so much to this supposed asceticism that I am eager
+to acquire the influence a successful vegetarianism would
+give me, and I am trying it in true Chinese style, which
+forbids eggs, leeks and carrots, &amp;c. As far as I have gone
+all is well. I am a little afraid that the great appetite it
+gives may drive me to eat till I become fat. We'll see.</p>
+
+<p>'The mothers bringing their babies moves me much.
+It reminds me of scenes in Peking when another and
+more skilful hand ministered to their diseases; then the
+picture of the family surroundings fills itself up, and I have
+to seek a place where to weep.</p>
+
+<p>'Altogether it is a sowing in tears. The district is not
+an easy one, the life which the work entails is a hard one.
+There is no hardship or self-denial I am not ready to "go
+in for," but I want you to understand me and let me have
+your sympathy.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>This long extract, not too long we venture to think, as
+enabling us to see into the heart of the man, raises several
+points of great moment. Nothing could illustrate better
+his eagerness to get into close touch and perfect sympathy
+with the people. He had long before adopted the native
+dress of an ordinary shopkeeper or respectable workman.
+He now adapted himself, as far as possible, to the native
+food. He lived on such as the poor eat. Often he would
+take his bowl of porridge, native fashion, in the street,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[Pg 190]</a></span>
+sitting down upon a low stool by the boiler of the itinerant
+restaurant keeper. The vegetarianism referred to was, as
+he indicates, very thoroughgoing and in accord with Chinese
+ideas.</p>
+
+<p>The great poverty of the people also pressed upon his
+attention the enormous waste induced by whisky drinking,
+and by the smoking of tobacco and opium. The sect Tsai
+li ti referred to was a small organisation among the Chinese
+for endeavouring to secure entire abstinence from all three.
+It did not seem tolerable to him that the level of Christian
+morality and practice with regard to these things should be
+lower than that of the heathen. Famine often visited those
+parts, and he came to hold the view that men could hardly
+pray, 'Give us this day our daily bread,' with any hope of
+a favourable answer, or even reasonably expect God's
+blessing upon their tillage of the soil, while they continued
+to use a large part of the grain produced in the
+manufacture of strong drink, and while they continued to
+set apart large districts for the cultivation of tobacco and
+opium. Hence, at first, he made entire abstinence from all
+three an indispensable requisite for admission into the
+Christian Church.</p>
+
+<p>It was hardly to be expected, perhaps, that his colleagues
+in the North China Mission would be able to see eye to eye
+with him on these points. With regard to opium the
+opinion as to abstinence is unanimous. With regard
+to the other two, the prevailing opinion was that, however
+desirable entire abstinence may be, it is not authoritatively
+commanded, and ought not to be made an indispensable
+qualification for baptism.</p>
+
+<p>It seemed to some of them that there was danger of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[Pg 191]</a></span>
+the heathen confusing Christianity with their own Tsai li ti.
+In reply to such a suggestion Gilmour wrote: 'My hearers
+not know the difference between Tsai li ti and Christianity!
+Thanks be to God, this whole town and neighbourhood has
+rung with the truths of Christianity. Children, men, shop-boys,
+and, of all people in the world, a lad gathering grain
+stumps in the fields a long way off&mdash;it has been my lot to
+hear them repeat sayings of mine, when they saw me, and
+did not think I could hear them.'</p>
+
+<p>Into this controversy as a mere discussion we have no
+desire to enter. But to enable the reader to know Mr.
+Gilmour exactly as he was it deserves more than a passing
+reference. The following may be taken as an example of
+many letters that passed on this subject.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I start perhaps on Tuesday. Pardon me for expressing
+myself on one matter&mdash;the Chinese teetotal business. You
+and some of my colleagues seem to me as if I could not
+move you on this question. It is a great grief to me. I
+think you are not right in your ideas about this. I suppose
+you can beat me in argument. I am still more than
+ever convinced that teetotalism is <i>right</i> and <i>needful</i> for the
+success of native Christian life in China. We have some
+painful instances here of that among the natives&mdash;specially
+two&mdash;one of the two hailing from Tientsin.</p>
+
+<p>'I don't know your Tientsin Church history, but if it is
+anything like ours here you would find men standing
+nowhere almost as to Christian character, who but for
+drink and its concomitants might, humanly speaking, have
+shone. And yet these are men to get whom out of sin
+Christ died&mdash;brethren, for whom Christ died.</p>
+
+<p>'Pardon me again when I take a short cut to what I<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_192" id="Page_192">[Pg 192]</a></span>
+want to say: "<i>I believe were Christ here now as a missionary
+amongst us He would be an enthusiastic teetotaller and a
+non-smoker.</i>"</p>
+
+<p>'Tobacco is comparatively a harmless matter, but it is
+not so unimportant as it seems to us foreigners. Whisky
+should go, and I feel that the Chinese would be quite
+ready, if led, to turn both whisky and tobacco out together.
+They are born brothers in China, <i>useless</i>, and <i>acknowledged</i>
+to be such; harmful as far as they are anything, and comparatively
+expensive.</p>
+
+<p>'I would like to see you start in your church an anti-tobacco
+and whisky society; voluntary, of course, in a
+church established as yours on the old lines. Though I
+stand alone, I believe the flowing tide is with me.</p>
+
+<p>'Wishing you many souls in 1887, and eager that no
+minor difference of opinion should hinder our prayers.</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Yours I-hardly-know-how-to-say-what,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In the <i>Chinese Recorder</i>, for which he had been in
+the habit of writing for many years, he published a paper
+in which he set forth with great clearness and fulness his
+views on this important matter. It deserves a place in the
+story of his life because in it he has sketched, as no one
+else could, himself, and some of his later methods of evangelistic
+address.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'In December, 1885, in a district of North China new
+to me, I found myself preaching to a small crowd of
+Chinese and Mongols in a small market town. I was in
+a lane leading on to the main street. At my back was
+a mud wall, in front and at both sides was the audience,
+within hearing was the main street, above, a bright sun
+made the place warm and cheerful. After listening a
+while the audience wanted to know how good seasons<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[Pg 193]</a></span>
+could be secured. To the truths I had been preaching
+they had listened with respect and fair attention, but at
+the first opportunity for speaking they wanted to know
+how to get a good harvest.</p>
+
+<p>'At first I paid little attention to this question, but
+after a little while it was asked again, and that by several
+men in succession, and I soon found that the people of the
+place had little room for anything else in their thoughts.
+There was good reason for it too. Their last harvest had
+been a poor one. Three-tenths was about the yield. They
+too with their three-tenths were comparatively well off.
+Some distance from them the yield had not been more
+than two-tenths, and a little beyond that again, there were
+fields which had been sown, but never reaped. There had
+been nothing to reap. Nothing had grown. I passed
+some of these fields afterwards and saw them. Was it
+wonderful then that the main thought in their minds should
+be the harvest failure, and that they should be mainly
+anxious to know how to secure a good season next year?
+Looking at my audience I saw that nine-tenths of them
+were poorly clad. Nearly one-half of them were quite
+insufficiently clothed, and many were in garments suited
+to summer weather only. I was in a sheepskin coat and
+felt shoes, and even thus was not too warm, and could not
+help thinking how cold they must be, in their torn clothes
+and ordinary shoes. In addition to this they seemed
+hungry. I dare say perhaps one-half of them were in actual
+suffering from deficiency of food.</p>
+
+<p>'Taking these things into consideration, I did not
+regard their great and often-repeated question, "How about
+the harvest?" as impertinent, and set myself to answer it.
+When the question was again asked I replied by asking
+another, namely, "<i>Do you think you deserve good harvests?</i>"
+This question usually made them stare and ask, "Why
+should not we deserve good harvests?" and I would<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[Pg 194]</a></span>
+reply, "In the first place, because of that <i>tobacco pipe in your
+mouth</i>." A laugh of incredulity would usually pass round
+the audience, but when done laughing, and asked to consider
+the folly of spending money buying a pipe and
+tobacco when the smoker was shivering in his rags, and
+hungry, and especially when asked what was the good of
+smoking, they laughed no more. When pressed to say
+where the tobacco came from, they would admit that the
+cultivation of tobacco took up no small proportion of their
+better-class land, and when pressed to say how much land
+was given up to tobacco cultivation, they would admit,
+what did not seem to have occurred to them before, that
+the amount of land given up to tobacco cultivation was
+very large. How large it was I had no conception till
+the following summer, when, walking round the suburbs,
+I would look over the low mud walls of their gardens,
+and be amazed at the expanse of land covered with the
+great, broad green leaf of the flourishing tobacco plant.</p>
+
+<p>'Putting these things before my audience, they would
+admit that the cultivation of tobacco was a misuse of a large
+portion of their better land, that in cultivating and using
+tobacco they were doing what was wrong, and hindering
+heaven from feeding them. Heaven had given them good
+land and good rains for the purpose of growing food. The
+growth of tobacco was defeating heaven's purpose, and as
+long as they did so, what face had they to ask for good
+seasons? To take good land and plant it with tobacco,
+with what face could they ask heaven to send rain, seeing
+that if rain came, what grew would not be grain but
+tobacco, a thing which they themselves to a man admitted
+was no use at all? And so my audience would admit that
+as preliminary to getting or even expecting a good harvest
+was the discontinuance of the use and growth of tobacco.</p>
+
+<p>'In the course of a year and a half of outdoor preaching
+in streets and at fairs, and private conversation with<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_195" id="Page_195">[Pg 195]</a></span>
+individuals, I never met an audience that defended tobacco
+as useful, and do not think I met more than three individuals
+who had anything to say in its defence. Almost
+everyone, smokers included, admitted its uselessness. Many
+do not seem to have thought the cultivation and use of it
+any harm, or having any bearing on the question of food
+supply and good harvests; they usually regarded it as
+simply a piece of extravagance on their own part, which
+had no bearing on anything or anybody beyond themselves.
+But when pointed out to them they readily admit that
+tobacco cultivation lessens the production of grain, and as
+readily admit that the wrongdoing in this misuse of land
+is likely to further harm the harvest by offending heaven
+into being unwilling to send rain. I myself never used to
+look on smoking as any great evil, till led into this district,
+and thus forced to study the subject. In England I had
+never seen tobacco grown. A smoker there spends a few
+coppers, and smokes; what harm does he do? Does not he
+increase trade and help the revenue? His smoking seems
+to harm no one but himself. Such were my thoughts.
+But in this district I see the cultivation of tobacco limiting
+the supply of grain, thus raising the price of food, and consequently
+making men go hungry. In addition I see men,
+women, and sometimes children, in rags and hungry even,
+with pipes and tobacco, and when they complain of heaven
+not supplying them with enough food to eat, it would be
+less than honest not to point out to them that the fault
+lies not with heaven, but with themselves, and that part at
+least of the scarcity of grain they experience is due to the
+cultivation and use of tobacco, which throughout that whole
+region is very excessive.</p>
+
+<p>'I have dwelt thus at length on the tobacco question,
+not because it is the most important of the three things
+here spoken of, but because many good brethren have not
+been able to see with me on this point. They feel, as I<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_196" id="Page_196">[Pg 196]</a></span>
+used to do before I went to that region, that tobacco
+smoking is a small affair, not worth raising into prominence
+or the region of conscience or Christian duty at all.
+These brethren have not <i>seen</i> how things work. I feel
+sure that almost any missionary placed as I was would
+have done exactly what I have done, taken a stand against
+this excessive growth and more excessive use of tobacco,
+for, not content with what they grow, they actually import
+quantities of it. Tobacco is not the greatest cause of
+poverty and hunger in the district, but it is a much greater
+factor in poverty than would at first be supposed. But for
+its use in that district a large number of men, women, and
+children, who are deficiently clothed and fed, would be
+warm and sleek. Christ taught men to pray, "Give us this
+day our daily bread." It must be wrong to make hundreds
+of men, women, and children go half clad and half fed,
+simply that eighty or ninety per cent. of the adults of that
+district may indulge in tobacco, a thing, according to their
+own admission, utterly without use, and for the continuance
+of which they can give no reason, further than that
+they have acquired the habit and find it difficult to give it
+up.</p>
+
+<p>'A more serious question, however, is the whisky. In
+going into that region I was amazed at the quantity of
+whisky used. I used to lodge in an inn and take my meals
+in an eating-house. There, twice a day, I had an opportunity
+of studying the drinking habits of the country.
+Almost every man who entered the eating-house first
+called for a whisky warmer. Supplied with that, he would
+go out and buy his whisky, coming back he would set it in
+the charcoal fire to warm, and then slowly drink it from
+the tiny wine cups common in China, inviting me to join
+him, and wondering at a man who could evidently afford
+it, not treating himself to two ounces of whisky, and wondering
+still more when he learned that I did not use tobacco.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_197" id="Page_197">[Pg 197]</a></span>
+It would be an exaggeration, but not a great exaggeration,
+to say that every man who entered the eating-house
+began his meal by drinking whisky. In replying to the
+question put by my street audiences as to how they
+were to get good harvests, I would ask them, after
+finishing the tobacco question, "How about your whisky
+drinking?" Frequently they would anticipate me in this,
+and say, "If tobacco is wrong, how about whisky?"
+To convince them of the wrong of whisky was never
+difficult. To ask good harvests from heaven, then take
+grain given by heaven for food, and turn it into whisky,
+they did not need me to tell them this was wrong. And
+there in that district it is a very crying wrong. The
+quantity used is immense. Not only does it seem so to
+me, but natives from other parts of China are struck by
+the excessive use of it.</p>
+
+<p>'The first time I travelled in the district, I was struck
+by the manner in which they described the size and amount
+of trade of towns about which I made inquiries. Such
+and such a place had or had not a distillery and pawnshop.
+Such and such a town had so many distilleries, and
+so many pawnshops. One travelling about the country
+soon notes that nearly every imposing trading establishment
+with grand premises seen from afar is either a distillery
+or a pawnshop, or both combined. The bank notes
+current among the people are issued, at but a small percentage,
+by distilleries and pawnshops. The first crop to
+ripen in the district is barley, and that, the natives will tell
+you, all goes to the distillery. On the road you will meet
+large carts drawn by six or seven mules. The load is
+grain, and of these carts a large number are owned by
+distilleries, and go round the country collecting grain,
+from which to brew whisky. One of the first things to
+be heard in the morning after daylight, in a quiet market
+town, is a peculiar beating of a wooden drum. Ask what it<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[Pg 198]</a></span>
+means, and you will be told it is such and such a distillery
+calling its hands to breakfast. Ask how many hands they
+have, and you may find that one establishment has some
+sixty or seventy men who eat their food! The whisky trade
+is simply enormous. It is out of all proportion to every
+other trade. The women as a rule do not drink, the men
+do all the drinking&mdash;the males I should say, for not a few
+boys acquire the habit of taking whisky to their meals
+long before they can be called men. A very few men do
+not use whisky at all. The poorer agricultural labourers
+drink it only when they can get it, and just as much or
+as little as they can get. Many men take regularly two
+ounces&mdash;Chinese ounces&mdash;to each meal. Many take more.
+Many well-to-do people drink half a catty per day. Others
+drink a whole catty.<a name="FNanchor_7_7" id="FNanchor_7_7"></a><a href="#Footnote_7_7" class="fnanchor">[7]</a> Some drink a catty and a half a day.
+A small proportion of the male population find drinking a
+greater necessity than eating. These are usually elderly
+men, but as I write I can think of two men, both young,
+and both Mongols, one a priest, the other a layman, who
+have arrived at this advanced stage of whisky drinking.</p>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_7_7" id="Footnote_7_7"></a><a href="#FNanchor_7_7"><span class="label">[7]</span></a> A Chinese weight equal to one pound and a third.</p></div>
+
+<p>'This excessive use of whisky has impoverished many
+families, and has demoralised many men. It has caused
+many quarrels, and given rise to many lawsuits. The evil
+caused by whisky is apparent to all, but custom requires
+that friends should be honoured by being offered whisky,
+business should be transacted over whisky, and the general
+saying is that without whisky nothing can be done. A
+farmer, for example, adding a few rooms to his buildings
+must supply his masons and joiners with whisky. Thus in
+universal use, the quantity consumed is immense. The
+quantity of grain used in the distilleries is almost beyond
+computation, and I don't remember ever meeting a Chinaman
+who did not admit that to distil whisky was to do evil.
+They ask me how to get good harvests. I tell them;<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_199" id="Page_199">[Pg 199]</a></span>
+"Give up abusing the grain you have got, before you ask
+for more. If heaven sees you taking a large part of your
+superior land for raising the useless tobacco, and taking a
+very large proportion of the grain sent you as food, and
+using it not to eat, nor to feed animals, but distilling it into
+the hurtful whisky, do you think heaven, seeing all this
+waste going on, is likely to hear your petitions and increase
+the supply of what you now waste so large a proportion?
+If you bought food for your child, and he ate only half
+and threw the other half to the pig, would you be likely
+to buy him more just then, even though he might say he
+was hungry?" This reasoning seems quite satisfactory
+and convincing to them, and never fails to secure their
+expressed assent.</p>
+
+<p>'As to opium I never find it necessary to say much.
+All admit it to be only and wholly bad. Yet the quantity
+grown in the district is immense. In the early spring the
+very first movement of cultivation is the irrigation and
+working of the opium land, and at the season nearly all
+the best land blazes with bloom of the poppy. It is a sight
+to see the country people going to the markets with the
+"<i>milk</i>" in bowls and basins, and the buyers and sellers of
+it riding along, each with a weighing-balance stuck in his
+belt. Government restriction there is none, the duty imposed
+is not very heavy, and public opinion raises no voice
+against it. It was originally grown, say the natives, so as
+to keep money from going out of the district in buying
+imported opium, but the more it was grown the more it
+was used, and now the quantity raised and smoked is
+immense. There is a small proportion of farmers who
+have good land, suitable for growing opium, but who do
+not grow it. But these men are few, and as a general rule
+the very best pieces of land are set apart for the cultivation
+of opium. The common conscience of the people tells
+them this is a wrong thing. When therefore they ask how<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[Pg 200]</a></span>
+to get a good harvest, they themselves acknowledge that
+the reply is just, which says, "First leave off the waste of
+heaven's grace involved in the growth and manufacture of
+opium, whisky, and tobacco, and then, and not till then,
+will it be reasonable for you to ask heaven for more
+bountiful harvests."</p>
+
+<p>'In connection with all this, there is another fact that
+must not be forgotten. Drinkers of whisky, and smokers,
+especially of opium, the better the year is, the more they
+indulge. In a poor year they use less whisky and opium;
+the better the year, and the cheaper tobacco, whisky, and
+opium are, the more they use, so that in place of making a
+proper return to heaven for a good year, they only take
+the opportunity afforded them of running deeper into
+waste and wrong-doing. Is this the way to get better
+harvests? Considering the excessive growth and consumption
+of tobacco and opium, and the excessive manufacture
+and use of whisky, what could any honest, straightforward
+man say to the people, when they earnestly asked how
+they were to get good harvests, but "<i>Repent, and cease this
+great waste</i>"? And thus from no deliberate plan of mine,
+but from the plain leading of circumstances, it came to pass
+that I felt compelled to call upon the inhabitants of the
+district to lay aside the use of not only opium but also of
+whisky and tobacco, as one of the first steps toward worshipping
+the true God. Many friends have demurred to
+my making teetotalism an essential of Christianity, and
+many more have still more strongly demurred to my taking
+such a pronounced stand against the use of tobacco. The
+position of my friends is exactly the position I held myself
+before going into that region, but after going to that
+region and seeing just how things were, no other course
+seemed open to me, but to demand in all who wanted
+to do right the abandonment of the whole three; and
+I am convinced that almost any other missionary placed<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[Pg 201]</a></span>
+in the same circumstances would have taken the same
+stand.</p>
+
+<p>'This position too commends itself to the native mind,
+and the native mind, quite apart from me, and before my
+going into the district, had already risen up in protest
+against these abuses, and, in some parts of the country
+there, the Tsai li ti sect boasts not a few members. The
+main practical doctrine of this sect is, <i>Yen chiu pu tung</i>&mdash;abstinence
+from tobacco, whisky, and opium. The very
+existence of this sect, and its flourishing condition there, is
+a plain indication of what serious-minded natives felt about
+the excessive use of these three things. Friends say that I
+am putting this self-righteousness in place of faith in Christ
+and the practice of higher duties. I do nothing of the sort.
+Beginning with the Chinaman where I find him, and
+answering the questions which he insists on asking first, I
+appeal to him to give up what he admits to be wrongdoing,
+sin (<i>tsao nieh</i>), as the first step in ceasing to do evil
+learning to do well, and coming into right relationship with
+God through Christ. Some friends are much alarmed lest
+this should lead to self-righteousness. There is no danger
+of that. The danger lies all the other way. To leave
+Christians drinking whisky and smoking tobacco in that
+region, would be to preach forgiveness of sin through
+Christ to men who were still going on in the practice of
+what their conscience told them was sin, and all must
+admit that this would never do. The condition of things
+in that region is such that I have no hesitation in saying
+that a man, to be honest in obeying God by refraining from
+what is wrong, must throw up his connexion with these
+three things, tobacco, whisky, opium.</p>
+
+<p>'In <i>that region</i>. It will be noticed that I have carefully
+confined my remarks to the state of things in <i>that region</i>.
+<i>That region</i> is peculiar in producing within its own bounds
+almost all that is necessary for life and luxury even. It is<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[Pg 202]</a></span>
+peculiar too in having just exactly as many inhabitants as
+it can support, no more, no less. When the population increases
+too much it overflows into Manchuria. When the
+population is less than the full complement, it is instantly
+replenished by fresh arrivals from the South. The production
+of tobacco, whisky, and opium, not only reduces a
+large proportion of the inhabitants from comfort to misery,
+but also reduces sensibly the number of inhabitants. But
+for these three things many more men could find a living
+within the bounds of the district Is not that little district an
+epitome of the world? Is what is true of that district not
+true of the whole world? Opium is a bad thing anywhere
+and everywhere. About that there need be no debate.
+Whisky and tobacco reduce the comforts and the number of
+the population there&mdash;is their effect not the same on the world
+in general? Is it not true that but for tobacco and whisky
+there would be food and clothes for a much larger population?
+And if so, do not tobacco and whisky take the bread
+out of men's mouths and the clothes off their backs? And
+if so, has not every smoker and drinker a part in this sin?
+Christians pray, "<i>Give us this day our daily bread.</i>" Does
+not consistency require them to desist from defeating this
+prayer by smoking and drinking, and thus reducing the
+amount of the total production of the necessaries of life?</p>
+
+<p>'Tobacco seems harmless. It is less harmful than
+opium and whisky by a long way. But its production
+sensibly reduces the supply of grain and cotton, and thus
+hinders the feeding of the hungry and the clothing the naked.
+Good earnest Christian men smoke and drink. Evangelists
+and pastors owned of God in the salvation of souls
+smoke and see no harm in it. The reason is they have
+never seen how the thing works, and don't know the
+harm it does. I feel sure that if they could see with
+their own eyes men, women, and children, hungry and in
+rags, when but for tobacco and whisky they might be<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[Pg 203]</a></span>
+well fed and well clothed, these same good brethren,
+whose example is quoted against my position, would be
+the first and most earnest to say, "I will neither smoke
+tobacco nor drink whisky while the world stands."'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>At a later date, not from any change in his views,
+but in deference to the views of others, with whom he was
+always anxious to work in harmony, he modified his plans
+so far as not to make the use of whisky and tobacco
+absolute bars to admission into the Christian Church.</p>
+
+<p>His brethren also were opposed to the ascetic mode of
+life he adopted, and the extreme of hardship which he so
+often and so willingly encountered in his work. But he
+himself often said, and there are many references in his diary
+to the same effect, that the kind of life he was living in the
+interior was quite as healthy, and quite as conducive to
+longevity, as the ordinary and certainly much more comfortable
+life of a missionary at Peking. While it may be true
+that the exposure and sufferings of twenty years had so
+weakened him as to leave him powerless when seized by
+the last illness, yet the labours of twenty such years spent
+in the service of God and the service of man are surely
+the seeds from which there shall yet spring a rich harvest
+to the glory of God and to the blessing of the dark and
+degraded Mongols and Chinese.</p>
+
+<p>By the close of 1886 three main centres of work had
+been selected in the new district&mdash;Ta Chêng Tz&#365;, Tá Ss&#365;
+Kou, and Ch'ao Yang&mdash;all three being towns of some importance.
+Mr. Gilmour used to spend a month or so in
+each town, visiting also the neighbourhood, especially those
+places where fairs were held, and where consequently the
+people came together in large numbers. He had a tent<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_204" id="Page_204">[Pg 204]</a></span>
+which he used to put up in a main thoroughfare, and there
+he stood from early morn until night healing the sick,
+selling Christian books, talking with inquirers, preaching at
+every opportunity the full and free Gospel of salvation.
+His constant and consistent life of Christlike self-denial
+in the effort to bless them told even more upon the beholders
+than all these other things combined. His correspondence
+is full of sharp and clear pictures of his daily
+toil, and of his spiritual experiences.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>Ch'ao Yang, May 14, 1886.</i>&mdash;The people are very poor
+here. Last year the crops were not good. When the
+leaves come out on the trees, the poor people break off
+branches and eat the seeds of the elm-trees. I saw one
+woman up a high tree, taking down the seeds. She took
+off half the door, laid it up against the tree, went on the
+cross-bars like a ladder, and so got up. She threw down
+the little branches and twigs, and her three children below
+gathered them up. The elm seeds are just ripe now. They
+are the size of large fish-scales; when the wind blows they
+come down like snow.</p>
+
+<p>'I met three lamas going to a far-off place to worship.
+Every two or three steps they lay down flat on the ground,
+then got up other two or three steps, then prostrated
+themselves again. They did not know about Jesus saving
+people, and thought they would save themselves in that
+way. Poor people! yet they don't like to hear about Jesus
+saving people. They want the credit of thus saving themselves.</p>
+
+<p>'<i>September 3.</i>&mdash;At Ta Chêng Tz&#365; we had seven days
+and seven nights' rain. It was a great flood. The river
+rose and washed away about a hundred acres of land and
+forty or fifty houses. For two days the river floated down
+house-roof timbers, beams, &amp;c. One poor man pulled down<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_205" id="Page_205">[Pg 205]</a></span>
+his house to save his timbers, and the house fell on him and
+killed him. It was pitiful to see the river washing away
+good land, two square yards falling into the roaring flood
+at a time. The Chinamen did nothing: only stood and
+looked at it. Lots of walls and many houses fell down.
+One house in the court next our own fell down one morning
+after the rain was all over. The people had just time
+to jump out at the window. No one was hurt. Our room
+did not leak much, but the outside of the wall towards the
+street fell down. The inside of the wall still stood, so our
+room was whole. Chinese walls are all built in two skins.
+The one may fall and the other stand.</p>
+
+<p>'<i>October 25.</i>&mdash;God has given the hunger and thirst for
+souls: will He leave me unsatisfied? No, verily. I am
+reading at night, before going to bed, the Psalms in a small-print
+copy of the Revised Bible, holding it at arm's length
+almost, close up to a Chinese candle, to suit my eyes; for
+I cannot see small print well now, and I find much strength
+and courage in the old warrior's words. Verily, the Psalms
+are inspired. No doubt about that. None that wait on
+Him will be put to shame. He is here with me.</p>
+
+<p>'<i>November 17.</i>&mdash;We start about the fifth watch (6 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span>),
+get to the fair early, spend the day on the street; it is late
+before we get quiet, and I fear it is now well on towards
+the third watch. I am in first-class health, though my
+feet and socks are in a decidedly bad way. The country
+is not at all safe, but we have as yet been preserved. Some
+days ago, two men who slept on the same kang with us,
+and started a little earlier than we did, were robbed. We
+overtook the travellers arranging themselves after the
+interview. I was annoyed at not getting away as soon as
+they left. God so arranged it, you see.</p>
+
+<p>'I have got a step nearer to God lately. It is this: I
+do not now strive to get near Him; I simply ask Christ to
+<i>take me nearer Him</i>. Why shouldn't I? Does not Christ<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[Pg 206]</a></span>
+save men from distance from God and bring us near? <i>Peace,
+Blessing, and Power</i>, by Haslam, sent me by an old college
+mate in Scotland, was the means used. This chum tried
+my soul much when I was at home last. I think I was of
+use to him, and now he has been of much use to me. Let
+us sow beside all waters.</p>
+
+<p>'My attitude now here is that of Psalm cxxiii. 2-4. I
+feel that God can <i>perform</i> for, by, or rather use me as His
+instrument in performing, if He has a mind to; so I am
+looking for His hand, gazing about among the people that
+come to my stand to see the ones God has sent. I feel as
+helpless as a Chinese farmer in a drought; but when God
+opens the heavens, down it will come. Amen.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Mr. Gilmour returned to Peking on December 13,
+having been away nearly eight months. The tabulated
+results of this missionary campaign were:</p>
+
+<table summary="Missionary campaign results" width="65%">
+<tr>
+<td>Patients seen (about)</td>
+<td align="right">5,717</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>Hearers preached to</td>
+<td align="right">23,755</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>Books sold</td>
+<td align="right">3,067</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>Tracts distributed</td>
+<td align="right">4,500</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>Miles travelled</td>
+<td align="right">1,860</td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+<td>Money spent</td>
+<td align="right">120.92 taels = (about) 30<i>l.</i> to 40<i>l.</i></td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>He adds, 'And out of all this there are only two
+men who have openly confessed Christ. In one sense it
+is a small result; in another sense there is much to be
+grateful for. I have to part with my assistant, and am
+uncertain about whom to take in his place. My travelling
+arrangements have broken down, and I am perplexed in
+more ways than I have patience to write about; but</p>
+
+<table summary="Poem - Where He may lead">
+<tr>
+<td>
+Where He may lead I'll follow,<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">In Him my trust repose,</span><br />
+And every hour in perfect peace<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">I'll sing, "He knows, He knows."</span><br />
+</td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[Pg 207]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>After a visit to Tientsin and a brief rest in Peking,
+largely occupied with preparations for his next sojourn in
+Mongolia, he started on January 25, 1887. At Ta Chêng
+Tz&#365; he secured a kind of home, so as not to be exposed to
+all the discomforts and drawbacks of inn life, hoping also
+that a fixed centre might forward the preaching of the
+Gospel. Two rooms were taken for a year. They were
+situated at the inner end of a little trading court, around
+which were a tin-shop, a rope-spinner's room, and a stable.
+In one corner there was a pigsty. 'When first I saw it I
+almost refused to occupy it; but really there is no help for
+it, and finally we took it for a year.' It is always difficult
+to secure premises in a Chinese town, and exceptionally so
+under the limitation of money and of suspicion and dislike
+to which Christian missionaries are always exposed. 'It is
+only a lodging for me,' Mr. Gilmour continues, 'convenient
+for seeing converts or inquirers. The court is much too
+small, and the place not sanitary. But don't be in the least
+uneasy. My health is quite as safe there as in the best
+premises in Peking. I intend to occupy them for a month
+at the beginning of the Chinese year, and ten or fifteen
+days in the fourth, seventh, and tenth months. I hope also
+to come to some arrangement for a lodging in Ch'ao Yang.
+In Tá Ss&#365; Kou I am simply in an inn, and pay at the
+usual rate for the nights I am there.'</p>
+
+<p>A letter to his boys, dated March 24, 1887, depicts the
+kind of scene he so often witnessed, and the routine of work
+which would have proved so irksome but for the love and
+peace with which the Saviour filled his soul.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Mai Li Ying Tz&#365; is a very wicked place. There
+were no less than fourteen large tents set up for gambling,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_208" id="Page_208">[Pg 208]</a></span>
+and, in addition, some thirty or forty mat-tents for gambling.
+I was there three days. The first day people
+were shy. The second day they were not much afraid.
+The third day I had quite a lot of patients. We sold a
+good few books, preached a good deal, and doctored a
+number of patients. From there we went to Bo-or-Chih,
+starting in the dark and travelling seventeen English
+miles before breakfast. After we had travelled ten miles
+we came to a little town just as people were opening
+their doors. A seller of <i>chieh jao</i>, that sticky stuff, had
+just set out his wheelbarrow with his pudding. We
+each bought a great piece, wrapped it in a <i>chien ping</i>
+(a thin scone), and travelled on, eating it. That was
+our breakfast. Arrived at Bo-or-Chih, we set up our table
+at once, and, after preaching for a short time, patients
+came round us in crowds, and kept us busy till late in the
+afternoon.</p>
+
+<p>'The inn in which I am staying now is owned by two
+men, brothers, both of whom are opium smokers. The
+inn has a good trade, but it is all no use: it all goes to
+opium, and no good comes of it. There are two barbers
+connected with the place, and they both drink and gamble,
+so that they are in rags and poverty, though they have a
+fairly good business. It is so painful to see men degraded
+thus when, but for drink and gambling, they might be well
+off.</p>
+
+<p>'<i>April 28, 1887</i>.&mdash;For the last week I have been very
+busy at a great temple gathering, which lasted six days.
+Such crowds of people came, though it was only a country
+district. It was the great religious event of the year for the
+neighbourhood, and how do you think they do? They hire
+a theatrical company to come and act six days in a great
+mat stage, put up for the occasion in front of the temple.
+Theatrical exhibitions are the religion of China. These
+shows are supposed to be in honour of the idols in the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_209" id="Page_209">[Pg 209]</a></span>
+temple. The people think the gods will thus be pleased,
+and give them good seasons, health, etc.</p>
+
+<p>'What a crowd of women came to worship at the
+temple on the great day of the festival! Till noon that
+day women only were allowed to enter: no men. How
+the women were dressed&mdash;in all the colours of the rainbow,
+red trousers being especially prominent! How they moved
+along on their little feet! Walk you along on your heels&mdash;as
+I have seen you do&mdash;and that is just how they move.</p>
+
+<p>'No end of gamblers came too. There were twenty-six,
+or so, large tents put up to gamble in, and about as
+many straw-mat booths, and they all had plenty of trade.
+Eh, man, it is sad to see the utter worldliness of these Chinese.
+They soon found me out. I had my tent put up in a
+quiet place away from the bustle.<a name="FNanchor_8_8" id="FNanchor_8_8"></a><a href="#Footnote_8_8" class="fnanchor">[8]</a> In front is the great
+flying sign, "The Jesus Religion Gospel Hall." At the one
+end, "God the Heavenly Father;" at the other, "Jesus the
+Saviour." They found me out, not because they wanted
+to hear me preach, but to get medicine. Oh, the numbers
+of suffering people I saw and attended to! I used to go
+out early in the morning, and be there all day, most of the
+time so busy that there was no time to eat. To get food I
+had to steal away because everyone would want me just to
+attend to him or her before I went. When I had attended
+to that one there was another, and so on. I was able to
+cure a number of them, and got preaching a good deal too.
+I sold a number of books. It was the first time that a
+missionary had ever been there, and it was difficult to
+make them understand.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<div class="footnote"><p><a name="Footnote_8_8" id="Footnote_8_8"></a><a href="#FNanchor_8_8"><span class="label">[8]</span></a> See the illustration on <a href="#Page_245">p. 245</a>.</p></div>
+
+<p>It is, as a rule, by direct dealing with individuals that
+the best results of Christian work in China are obtained,
+and to this Mr. Gilmour was always ready to make everything
+give way. In season and out of season, at any hour<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_210" id="Page_210">[Pg 210]</a></span>
+of the day or night, he was at the service of inquirers.
+The sight of a seeking face could banish his most exhausting
+feeling of fatigue, and nothing so swiftly dispelled
+the depression, from which he so often and so
+severely suffered, as the sight of a heathen coming to be
+more perfectly instructed about 'the doctrine.' Here are
+one or two such scenes:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'In the eighth month we had great pleasure in finding
+Mr. Sun much advanced in knowledge, and confessing his
+Christianity with great boldness. Before we left he was
+baptized, and one or two others were coming forward as
+inquirers&mdash;notably one man, who is a member of a sect,
+was making earnest inquiries. These men seem to be
+following after righteousness in their own half-instructed
+fashion. These sects are strong in numbers in some parts
+of the district, and, if God should give us some of these
+men as converts, we might hope for rapid progress among
+their companions. The last that I heard of this man, he
+was coming to Mr. Sun, asking many questions. He
+lodged with us one night, and I invited him to breakfast
+with me in the morning. He was declining on the plea
+that he was a vegetarian. It was with much satisfaction that
+I was able to say in reply, "So am I."</p>
+
+<p>'The Tsai li ti are strong in Ch'ao Yang. I have
+been praying and working to gain them for a year and
+more. One evening a deputation of two men called upon
+me in my inn, and said they had come representing many
+who wanted to know about Christianity. They, the Tsai li
+ti, had been watching me ever since I had come to Ch'ao
+Yang. They had listened much and often to our preaching,
+and now they had come to make formal inquiries. I
+gave them such information as I thought they needed, and
+we got on well enough till they asked me to refute a slander.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_211" id="Page_211">[Pg 211]</a></span>
+The slander was to the effect that in a chapel
+in Peking, the preacher would, when he finished preaching,
+get down off the platform and have a smoke! I had to
+admit that this was no slander, but a true statement. I
+had a good deal to say in explanation of it; but, alas! the
+men came no more.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>To form any just estimate of Mr. Gilmour's work in
+Eastern Mongolia, it is needful constantly to bear in mind
+that it was practically a new departure. So far as we know,
+he is the only missionary in China connected with the
+London Missionary Society who adopted <i>in toto</i> not only
+the native dress, but practically the native food, and, so far
+as a Christian man could, native habits of life. His average
+expense for food during his residence in his district was
+<i>threepence a day</i>. This rate of expenditure was, of course,
+possible only because he adopted vegetarianism. His
+practice acted and reacted upon his thought, and he came
+at this time to hold the view, for and against which a great
+deal may be said, that it was a mistake for Chinese
+missionaries to live as foreigners&mdash;that is, to wear foreign
+dress, arrange their houses and furniture as nearly as
+possible in European style, and eat European food. Both
+on its economical side and also as impressing the mind
+and heart of the Chinese, he believed that his was the more
+excellent way.</p>
+
+<p>Most of his co-workers at Peking and Tientsin did not
+agree with him. As agreement would have involved, perhaps,
+following his example, under conditions that differed
+widely from those of Ta Chêng Tz&#365; and Ch'ao Yang, this
+difference of opinion was only what was to be expected.
+It is referred to here only as a well-known fact, and no<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[Pg 212]</a></span>
+story of Mr. Gilmour's life could be trustworthy which did
+not represent the decided way in which, when he felt that
+loyalty to his work and loyalty to his Master constrained
+him, he could and did act in direct opposition to the
+wishes and views of brethren whom he fervently loved.</p>
+
+<p>It became needful from time to time for him to justify
+his actions to the home authorities. Not that this was
+in any way needful from any doubt or lack of support on
+their part. But with regard to methods upon which there
+was marked divergence of view in the missionary committees
+abroad it was needful that a man like Gilmour
+should put his motives and reasons clearly before the
+governing powers. It is doing him bare justice to say
+that from this task he never shrank. The following
+extracts are from letters to the home officials of the
+London Missionary Society and they enable us to appreciate
+accurately the standpoint of the man whose thought
+they express. Writing in the light of the suggestion that
+perhaps he was putting a more severe strain upon his
+health than the efficient discharge of his difficult duty demanded,
+he says:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I feel called to go through all this sort of thing, and
+feel perfectly secure in God's hands. It is no choosing of
+mine, but His; and, following His lead, I have as much
+right to expect special provision to be made for me as
+the Israelites of old had in the matters of the Red Sea, the
+manna and water in the desert, the crossing Jordan, and
+the fall of Jericho.</p>
+
+<p>'One thing I am sure of. The thousands here need
+salvation; God is most anxious to give it to them: where,
+then, is the hindrance? In them? I hardly think so. In<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[Pg 213]</a></span>
+God? No. In me, then! The thing I am praying away
+at now is that He would remove that hindrance by whatever
+process necessary. I shall not be astonished if He
+puts me through some fires or severe operations, nor
+shall I be sorry if they only end by leaving me a channel
+through which His saving grace can flow unhindered to
+these needy people. I dare not tell you how much I
+pray for.</p>
+
+<p>'It is the foreign element in our lives that runs away
+with the money. The foreign houses, foreign clothes, foreign
+food, are ruinous. In selecting missionaries, physique able
+to stand native houses, clothes, and food, should be as
+much a <i>sine quâ non</i> as health to bear the native climate.
+Native clothes are, I believe, more safe for health than
+foreign clothes; they are more suited to the climate, more
+comfortable than foreign clothes, and so dressed, a Chinese
+house is quite comfortable. In past days I have suffered
+extreme discomfort by attempting to live in foreign dress
+in native houses.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>And yet James Gilmour had nothing of the fanatic
+or bigot about him. At the period of his life with which
+we are now dealing, his severest trial was the loneliness
+due to his having no colleague. Whenever his brethren
+ventured to address remonstrances to him, they were due
+largely to the conviction that entire isolation, such as he
+had to endure throughout his Mongolian career, must tell
+adversely upon his temperament. But in judging the
+character of the man it only heightens our love and respect
+for him that he did not allow the utter and successive
+failures of all efforts to secure him a colleague to hinder the
+work. No man more readily and more constantly acted
+upon the principle of doing the next best thing. His idea<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_214" id="Page_214">[Pg 214]</a></span>
+of satisfactory conditions for the work was never reached;
+but this never led him for one day to relax his own efforts
+or to loosen the strong hand of his self-discipline.</p>
+
+<p>To any reader who has carefully followed the previous
+pages it must have become abundantly evident that Mr
+Gilmour believed in God's present and immediate influence
+in the passing events of daily life, and that the right attitude
+of life is one of absolute dependence upon, and submission
+to, the will of God. His diaries abound with proofs
+of this. He is delayed one morning in starting from his
+inn, and is annoyed. An hour or so later he overtakes the
+travellers who started earlier, and finds them just recovering
+from the assault of a band of robbers. The delay was
+God's providential care protecting him from robbery. And
+yet no man was ever less under the spell of religious
+fatalism. All that active effort and promptitude of mind
+and body could effect in the service of life he freely and
+constantly expended in his work. And indeed there lies
+before us a long letter written at Tá Ss&#365; Kou on March 15,
+1888, asking for an official proclamation from the Chinese
+authorities at Peking affirming 'that Christian worship
+is an allowed thing, and that native Christians are not
+required to contribute, or are exempted from contributing,
+to idol and heathen ceremonies, such as theatricals, or the
+building and repair of temples.' The proper official document
+was applied for at Peking, and in due time obtained.</p>
+
+<p>On March 24, 1888, James Gilmour was rejoiced by the
+seeming fulfilment of his heart's most eager desire&mdash;the
+arrival at Tá Ss&#365; Kou of a fully qualified medical colleague,
+Dr. Roberts. We have seen how repeated had been his
+entreaties, how earnest his yearnings after this essential<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_215" id="Page_215">[Pg 215]</a></span>
+factor in the success of his mission. For a month he enjoyed
+to the full the uplifting of congenial fellowship and
+of skilled help. Then came a blow, harder almost to endure
+than the previous solitude.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Two days ago,' he writes under date of April 21,
+1888, 'a man pushed himself in among the crowd
+round my table as I was dispensing medicines in the
+market-place here, and announced himself as a courier
+from Tientsin. When asked what his news was, he was
+silent, so I led him away towards my inn. Oh the way I
+again asked what his news was. He groaned. I began to
+get alarmed, and noticed that he carried with him a sword,
+covered merely with a cloth scabbard. This looked warlike,
+and I wondered if there could have been another
+massacre at Tientsin. Coming to a quiet place in the
+street I <i>demanded</i> his news, when he replied, "<i>Dr. Mackenzie
+is dead, after a week's illness.</i>" At the inn we got out
+our letters from the bundle, and found the news true. In
+a little Dr. Roberts looked up from a letter he was reading
+and said he was appointed to the vacancy. <i>Then</i> the full
+extent of my loss flashed upon me. Mackenzie dead&mdash;Roberts
+to go to Tientsin! One of my closest friends
+dead&mdash;my colleague removed!</p>
+
+<p>'Forty-eight hours have elapsed, and I am just coming
+right again. I have been like a ship suddenly struck in
+mid-ocean by a mountain sea breaking over it. You know
+in that case a ship staggers a bit, and takes some time to
+shake clear and right herself.</p>
+
+<p>'As to Mackenzie. His friendship I very keenly appreciated.
+The week of prayer in January 1887 we spent
+together in Peking. The week of prayer in January 1888
+we spent together in Tientsin. These were seasons of
+great enjoyment. On parting we spoke of having a week<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_216" id="Page_216">[Pg 216]</a></span>
+together again in April 1889. That is not to be. The full
+extent of the loss will take some time to realise.</p>
+
+<p>'The prospect of Dr. Roberts settling permanently here
+in the autumn gave light and brightness to the outlook.
+My faith is not gone, but it would be untrue to say that I
+am not walking in the dark. I shall do my best to hold
+on here single-handed; but I earnestly hope that I am not
+to be alone much longer. Something must be done.
+There is a limit to all human endurance.</p>
+
+<p>'Amid many storms we are holding on our way, and
+making progress among the Chinese. Of the Mongols I
+have nothing cheering to report. They come around and
+daily hear the Gospel; but, as yet at least, there it ends. I
+look into their faces to see whom the Lord is going to call,
+but have not seen him yet apparently. Meantime, I am
+getting deeper and deeper into Chinese work and connections,
+and sometimes the thought crosses my mind that my
+knowledge of Mongolian is not employed to its best
+advantage here. On the other hand, I see more Mongols
+here than I could see anywhere on the Plain.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>God's ways of dealing with His work and the workers
+are often very dim and obscure to finite understanding.
+Humanly speaking, no man in China could less easily be
+spared than Dr. Mackenzie; no man in all that vast
+empire more needed the joy of fellowship than he to whom
+it had just been granted. But the indomitable spirit shines
+clearly through the words of Gilmour: 'It would be
+untrue to say that I am not walking in the dark. I shall do
+my best to hold on here single-handed.' Seeing God's hand,
+as he did, in these sorrowful events, and believing that Dr.
+Roberts also was following the path of God's will, he turned
+again to his lonely tasks. But it was at a heavy cost. His<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_217" id="Page_217">[Pg 217]</a></span>
+health was giving way faster than he realised. The views
+of his brethren at Peking, that he would break down under
+the strain of the isolation, were to some extent justified.
+The home authorities did what they could, but nearly a
+year elapsed before Dr. Smith, who was appointed to
+succeed Dr. Roberts, reached Mongolia, and when he did
+so his first duty he felt was to order Mr. Gilmour to visit
+England for rest and change. But meanwhile he went
+bravely on. Like his Master, 'he endured the contradiction
+of sinners against himself,' and when 'he was reviled, he
+reviled not again.'</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'We left Ch'ao Yang,' he writes under date of September
+3, 1888, 'August 10, attended markets, got much rained in,
+and reached Ta Chêng Tz&#365; August 20. There I found that
+one of the Christians had possessed himself of my bank
+book and drawn about fifteen taels of my money which I
+had banked at the grocer's. The delinquent turned up
+next day, walked in, and hung up his whip as if nothing
+had happened. At the moment I was dining, and he sat
+down beside me. I asked him quietly why he had treated
+me so. He said I might be easy in mind; he had money
+and cattle he would pay me. "Go, then, and bring me the
+money; till you do so, don't come to me again." Off he
+went. Days passed and nothing was done to repair the
+mischief. Meantime, the scandal was the talk of the small
+town, and the scornful things said were so keen that Liu,
+my assistant, got quite wild. He was indignant that I did
+not go to law with the man, who all the while was swelling
+about on a donkey bought with the money he stole from
+me, and using the most defiant and abusive language
+towards me (not to my face, happily). The roughs of the
+place began to be insolent, and a drunken man came and
+made a scene in our quarters. Liu redoubled his attack<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_218" id="Page_218">[Pg 218]</a></span>
+on me, and even threatened to go home to Shantung if I
+would do nothing but pray&mdash;a course of action on my part
+which irritated him much. Li San, the head Christian there,
+joined him in saying I ought to make a show of power. I
+asked the two to read at their leisure Matt. v. 6, 7. Liu
+warned me that I was in personal danger. The man was
+panic-struck and highly nervous. I arranged an expedition
+to a place some 90 li away, but got rained in and could not
+go. Finally, the offender sent an embassy desiring peace,
+and, the day before we left, a respectable deputation of
+mutual friends, Christian and heathen, found its way one by
+one to my room, coming thus not to attract attention, and last
+of all came the thief. According to pre-arrangement I asked
+him, as he entered, what he had come for. He walked up to
+the wall, knelt down, and confessed his sin in prayer to God.
+The end of the matter is, he gives me one donkey and the
+promise of another, is suspended as to membership for twelve
+months, and is forbidden the chapel for three months.</p>
+
+<p>'I am not bright about Ta Chêng Tz&#365;, as you may suppose.
+Worse than the stealing case is that of the head man,
+Li San, who says that he was promised employment before
+he became a Christian! The ten days we passed there we
+were the song of the drunkard and the jest of the abjects;
+but the peace of God <i>passes all understanding</i>, and that
+kept my heart and mind. We put a calm front on; put
+out our stand daily, and carried ourselves as if nothing had
+happened.</p>
+
+<p>'The great thought in my mind these days, and the
+great object of my life, is to be like Christ. As He was in
+the world, so are we to be. He was in the world to manifest
+God; we are in the world to manifest Christ. Is that not
+so? Iniquities, I must confess, prevail against me; but
+as contamination of sin flows to us from Adam, does
+not regenerating power flow into us from Christ? Is it
+not so?'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_219" id="Page_219">[Pg 219]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Meanwhile work was going steadily forward and some
+impression was being made. He made a flying visit to
+Tientsin and Peking in the autumn, but was soon back at
+his post. In his report of work for the year he is able to
+point to progress.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'1888 has been a tumultuous year. In December, at
+Ch'ao Yang, there was a sudden irruption of men and boys
+to learn the doctrine. Evening after evening we had from
+twenty to fifty people in our rooms to evening worship.
+We hardly knew how to account for it, but did all we
+could to teach as many as we could. The cold weather
+finally did much to stop the overcrowding, but there was
+good interest kept up among many till the end of the
+year.</p>
+
+<p>'The baptisms for the year were, at Ta Chêng Tz&#365;,
+two; Tá Ss&#365; Kou, two; Ch'ao Yang, eight; total, twelve
+adults, all Chinese.</p>
+
+<p>'One man has been put out, so that the numbers stand
+as follows: Ta Chêng Tz&#365;, four; Tá Ss&#365; Kou, three;
+Ch'ao Yang, nine; total, sixteen, all Chinese.</p>
+
+<p>'Three adults, Chinese, were baptized ten days ago,
+and I hope to baptize two children next Sunday; but we
+have almost no promising adherents here at present. There
+are three entire families Christian, with Christian emblems
+on their door-posts; another family is Christian, but cannot
+fly the colours on the door-posts because the grandfather
+who has half the building is a heathen.</p>
+
+<p>'In still another family, where only the husband is
+Christian, they have the Christian colours, but the family is
+heathen.</p>
+
+<p>'My heart is set on reinforcements. Can they not be
+had? I had hoped Dr. Smith would have spent the winter
+with me, but he did not. All the grace needed has been
+given me abundantly, but I don't think there should<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_220" id="Page_220">[Pg 220]</a></span>
+be any more solitary work. I don't think it pays in any
+sense.</p>
+
+<p>'In addition, it is almost time I had a change. My
+eyes are bad. Doctors hesitate over my heart, say it is
+weak, and that its condition would affect seriously an
+application for life assurance. This winter I have gone in
+for a cough, which is not a good thing at all, and it would
+be well for the continuity of the work that there should be
+a young man on the field.</p>
+
+<p>'Don't be alarmed, though, and don't alarm my friends.
+The above is for your own private information and guidance.
+I still regard myself as in first-rate health.</p>
+
+<p>'I am not satisfied that we seem drifting away from the
+Mongols. At present, though lots of Mongols are around,
+our work is all but entirely Chinese. I am still of opinion
+that our best way to reach them is from a Chinese basis.
+This may involve a matter of years ahead, and therefore it
+is that I am eager to see the future of the work provided
+for by being joined by a younger man or men.</p>
+
+<p>'Meantime I am trying to follow very fully and very
+faithfully the leadings and indications of God. I have had
+times of sore spiritual conflict and times of much spiritual
+rest, and my prayer is that you and the Board may in all
+your arrangements and plans for Mongolia be fully guided
+by Him. Oh that His full blessing would descend richly
+on this district!'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Dr. Smith reached Mongolia in March 1889, and for
+the first time met his colleague. He has placed on record
+for use in this biography his account of that first meeting.
+On reaching Ch'ao Yang, Dr. Smith found that Mr. Gilmour
+was not there. 'I followed the innkeeper,' he writes, 'to see
+the spot where my devoted colleague had spent so many
+lonely hours. We came to a little outhouse, with a kind<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_221" id="Page_221">[Pg 221]</a></span>
+of little court in front of it, not many yards wide. The
+outer door was locked by means of a padlock; but the
+innkeeper soon found an entrance by simply lifting the
+door off its wooden hinges, and then we were in the anteroom
+or rather kitchen. In it was a built-in cooking-pan,
+an earthenware bowl, and a wooden stick resembling
+a Scotch porridge-stick; and some brushwood which had
+been brought in to be in readiness when he next arrived
+at that inn. One of the two rooms, which lay on each side
+of this ante-room, was locked, and we could not open it,
+but through the chinks of the door I could see abundant
+traces of Gilmour. It was specially refreshing to see some
+genuine English on one of the boxes; it was "Ferris,
+Bourne, &amp; Co., Bristol," the people from whom he used to
+order his drugs. My servant and I decided to take up our
+quarters in the next room, which was evidently the
+servant's room. We soon managed to make ourselves very
+comfortable, and there was an unspeakable relief in at last
+being in a place which belonged to the London Mission,
+rented of course. We had to spend the Sunday there.
+Mr. Sun, the box-maker, soon came round, and seemed
+genuinely glad to see me, and offered to make all arrangements
+for the further stage of our journey. We then discharged
+our carts, and I sent with them my letters for
+home.</p>
+
+<p>'After spending the Sunday in company with the
+Christians there, we set out on the Monday morning with
+a local carter for Ta Chêng Tz&#365;, a distance of about twenty-three
+miles. We crossed a hilly and sparsely populated
+district, reminding me of some of the bleaker scenery in
+Scotland. On reaching the town we at once drove to the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[Pg 222]</a></span>
+new private mission premises. It was a little house surrounded
+by a straw fence. Quite a crowd of rough-looking
+people followed us in. One of the doors had been stolen,
+and altogether it looked so unprotected that I decided to
+take up my quarters in a little Mongol inn, where Mr.
+Gilmour formerly lived. Next day I expected to meet
+Gilmour, and the two Christians there were fully expecting
+him. In the evening we had quite a levee; Li San and
+the other Christian, whom Gilmour used to call "Long
+Legs," sat drinking tea in my room for some time, and were
+very friendly; they were evidently trying to ingratiate
+themselves with me; I did not then know how disgracefully
+they had behaved to Gilmour, nor did I know the
+anxious business which was bringing Gilmour there at that
+time.</p>
+
+<p>'Next day or the following, I forget exactly which, I
+was sitting in my room, when a young man arrived, my
+servant being out at the time. I could not make him
+out at first, not being able to understand what he said;
+but he had such an evident air about him that he had some
+kind of business with me that it at last dawned upon me
+that he must be Mr. Gilmour's servant, and this was at once
+confirmed on the arrival of Lin Seng, my servant. He had
+been sent on ahead to announce Gilmour's arrival. It had
+been blowing a dust-storm all day, and on that account I
+hardly expected Gilmour, but now there was no doubt.</p>
+
+<p>'About four o'clock that afternoon Gilmour arrived, and
+I shall never forget that first meeting. I had pictured
+quite a different-looking man to myself. I saw a thin man
+of medium height, with a clean shaven face, got up in
+Chinese dress, much the same as the respectable shop-keepers<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_223" id="Page_223">[Pg 223]</a></span>
+in that part of the country wear. On his head was
+a cap lined with cat's fur. I was struck by the kindly but
+determined look on his face. He greeted me most
+cordially, and I remember he said, "I am glad to see
+you." He looked worn out and ill. I at once gave him
+his letters.</p>
+
+<p>'After arranging his things and seeing his men comfortably
+settled and getting over his first interview with the
+Christians there, he came up to my room in order to spend
+the night with me. We sat to all hours of the morning,
+chatting about things at home, and about his boys, whom I
+had seen before leaving Scotland.</p>
+
+<p>'For the next day he arranged the dreaded interview
+with Li San down at the mission premises. Gilmour
+warned me that it would be a long-winded affair, and
+wished me not to expect his return for a good number of
+hours. After waiting a long time I went down to see how
+the interview was progressing. Li San and Gilmour were
+sitting on the kang, in tailor fashion on each side of a
+low table, and Li San was singing hymns; but there was
+a strange look upon his face, as if he did not altogether feel
+like singing. Gilmour said to me in English that they had
+not come to business yet, and Gilmour was determined
+that Li San was to say the first word, so Gilmour invited
+him to sing hymn after hymn, and then I left. The whole
+idea seemed to be to get money out of Gilmour, and when
+he found that impossible he threatened to come down to
+Tientsin to accuse Gilmour to his missionary colleagues,
+of having broken his promise to give him employment.
+Gilmour had no recollection of having done so; he said
+to me that possibly one of his previous assistants may<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_224" id="Page_224">[Pg 224]</a></span>
+have on his own responsibility led Li San to form that
+idea.</p>
+
+<p>'Long Legs was also dogging Gilmour for money, and
+altogether they worried him; but he settled up everything.
+The premises were resold, and as Gilmour put it, "it was
+the funeral of that little church." They were threatening to
+prevent our leaving the town, as there seemed some doubt in
+Gilmour's mind as to whether we would be able to get a cart;
+these fears were disappointed; Li San got a cart for us.'</p>
+
+<p>Before Dr. Smith had passed many days in the society
+of Mr. Gilmour it became clear to the practised eye of the
+medical man that his colleague had been overstraining his
+health and strength. Notwithstanding his buoyancy and
+occasional high spirits all through his long years of work,
+James Gilmour had been subject to spells of severe depression.
+There are a very large number of brief entries in his
+diary to that effect. 'Felt blue to-day' is a frequent
+phrase, followed soon in the great majority of instances by
+words indicating a speedy recovery. Special events, that
+from time to time had a direct adverse influence upon his
+work, developed this state of mind rapidly and profoundly.
+The inevitable recall of Dr. Roberts, already described, is a
+case in point, and the diary at that season contains entries
+like these:</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>April 26, 1888.</i>&mdash;These last days have been full of
+blessing and peace in my own soul. I have been able to
+leave things at Ta Chêng Tz&#365;;, and my colleagues all in
+God's hands.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>May 7.</i>&mdash;Downcast day. No one to prayer.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>May 9.</i>&mdash;In terrible darkness and tears for two days.
+Light broke over me at my stand to-day in the thought<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_225" id="Page_225">[Pg 225]</a></span>
+that Jesus was tempted forty days of the devil after His
+baptism, and that He felt forsaken on the cross.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>May 27, Sunday.</i>&mdash;Service, Romans xii. Present, four
+Christians. Great depression.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The most constant force acting in the direction of
+mental depression was what appeared to him like the want
+of immediate success. He longed with an eager and
+almost painful intensity for signs that Gospel light had
+broken in upon the mental darkness of the men with whom
+he was in daily contact. He yearned for evidence that
+the love of Christ was winning the love of Chinese and
+Mongol hearts, as a mother yearns over her children. Hope
+deferred as to his medical colleague, ever recurring difficulties
+defeating all his efforts to secure suitable premises for
+his work, failure on the part of natives whom he had begun
+to trust, and all these things over and above the ceaseless
+strain of his daily toil, are more than sufficient to account
+for the state in which Dr. Smith found him.</p>
+
+<p>To those who knew him best, and who could appraise
+at their true value the toils and trials and disappointments
+of his daily lot, the wonder was not that he broke down;
+it was rather that physical collapse had not overtaken him
+sooner. There are many kinds of heroism, but it may be
+doubted whether any touches a higher level than that exhibited
+by this patient sower of the seed of life on the
+sterile field of Mongolia, bravely continuing to do so until
+imperatively urged to cease for a season, not by his consciousness
+of failing power, but by the alarm and influence
+of his medical co-worker.</p>
+
+<p>When the decision was once taken, it was acted upon<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[Pg 226]</a></span>
+promptly. March 26, 1889, was the day, and Peking the
+place. On April 4 he left Peking, and on the 20th he
+sailed from Shanghai. He arrived in London on May 25.</p>
+
+<p>This visit to England in 1889 was a great refreshment
+bodily, mental, and spiritual, to the overwrought labourer.
+The voyage itself, enforcing rest from all ordinary avocations,
+by removing Mr. Gilmour from the depressing surroundings
+amid which he had spent so much of the last
+three years, began the restorative process. He was beginning
+to feel in himself great benefit from the change even
+by the time he reached London. But the six years which
+had passed since he last walked the London streets had
+left their mark upon him. He had drawn to the utmost
+upon his physical and spiritual strength in the service of
+those for whose conversion he lived and toiled. He had
+been through the deep waters of personal affliction when
+his wife passed into the sinless life. The many toils and
+hardships of the passing years had drawn deep furrows
+upon the cheery face, and the eyes showed evidence of the
+mental and spiritual strain.</p>
+
+<p>So sudden was the resolution to return, and so prompt
+his action upon it, that few knew even of the probability
+until he was actually here. On May 27, 1889, the writer
+was sitting in his room, overlooking the pleasant garden
+that brightens up the north-eastern corner of St Paul's
+Churchyard, in conversation with a gentleman, when a
+knock came at the door and a head appeared. Not seeing
+it very clearly, and at the same time asking for a minute's
+delay while the business in hand was completed, the head
+disappeared. As soon as the first visitor departed a man
+entered and stood near the door. I looked at him with<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_227" id="Page_227">[Pg 227]</a></span>
+the conviction that I knew him, and yet could not recall the
+true mental association, when the old smile broke over his
+face, and he burst into a laugh, saying, 'Why, man, you
+don't know me' 'Yes, I do,' I replied, 'you're Gilmour; but
+I thought that at this moment you were in Mongolia.' But
+when I was able to scrutinise him closely I was shocked
+to see how very evident were the signs of stress and strain.
+It was not wholly inexcusable, even in an old friend, to
+fail to instantly recognise in the worn and apparently
+broken man, thought to be hard at work many thousands
+of miles away, the strong and cheery Gilmour of 1883.</p>
+
+<p>Carrying him off home, we talked far into the night, not
+because his host thought it a good thing for the invalid,
+but because he was so full of his work and its difficulties
+and its pressing needs, and what he hoped to do on behalf
+of Mongolia by his visit home, that there seemed no possible
+alternative but to let him talk himself weary. And
+how splendidly he talked! He pictured his life at a
+Mongol inn. He ranged over the whole opium and whisky
+and tobacco controversy. He gave, with all the dramatic
+effect of which he was so great a master, the story of how
+he forced home upon the Chinese and Mongols, until even
+<i>they</i> admitted the force of the reasoning, how natural it was
+that famine should visit them when they gave up their land
+to opium, and their grain to the manufacture of whisky.
+He gave in rapid dialogue his own questions, the native rejoinders,
+and he so vividly pictured the scene that his hearer
+could fancy himself standing under the tent, surrounded by
+Chinese and Mongols, and assenting, as they did, to the
+earnest and far-reaching conclusions of the speaker.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_228" id="Page_228">[Pg 228]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_X" id="CHAPTER_X"></a>CHAPTER X</h2>
+
+<h3>PERSONAL CHARACTERISTICS AS ILLUSTRATED BY
+LETTERS TO RELATIVES AND FRIENDS</h3>
+
+
+<p>This break in active work affords a convenient occasion
+for exhibiting in a still stronger light, by means of selections
+from his correspondence, some important sides of James
+Gilmour's character. He was a good correspondent and wrote
+freely to his relatives and friends. We have quoted largely
+hitherto from his official reports and from letters that refer
+to the condition and progress of his life-work. But it is in
+the letters addressed to the circle of relatives and most
+intimate friends that he reveals more fully the deeper side
+of his life, and the strong and tender affection of his nature.</p>
+
+<p>He corresponded regularly with his parents until the
+earthly tie was broken by the death of his mother in 1884
+and of his father in 1888. His letters to the latter were
+very beautiful, especially those designed to strengthen his
+faith in the closing years when he had passed the eightieth
+milestone. The tone of the correspondence may be judged
+from the following examples:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Peking: Friday, January 23, 1885.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Father,&mdash;So this must in future be the heading
+of my letters&mdash;no longer my dear parents. Mother
+has gone. Yours of November 21 reached me this afternoon,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_229" id="Page_229">[Pg 229]</a></span>
+or evening rather. As I came home from the
+chapel I found a beggar waiting at the gate. I thought
+he was going to beg, but he did not. Inside I found the
+gate-keeper waiting at our house door for a reply note, to
+say that the letter had been delivered. I went to my study,
+and was praying for a blessing on the chapel preaching
+when Emily came. I let her in. She had your letter in
+her hand. It had come by Russia, and the Russian post
+sometimes sends over our mail by a Peking beggar, paying
+him of course.</p>
+
+<p>'I have not had time to think yet. On my heels came
+in men for the prayer-meeting we hold in our house on
+Friday evening, and till now I have been almost continuously
+engaged. It is now 10.20 P.M. It so happens that
+this week I am much behind in my sermon preparation for
+Sunday, and it also happens that I am going to preach on
+<i>whole families</i> believing on Christ. What brought this
+subject to my mind is one of our old Christians who is
+dying, the only Christian in his whole family. His great
+grief is that they (his family) remain heathens. In addition,
+too, a Christian father admitted to a missionary the other
+day that he had not taught Christ to his daughter who had
+just died. Preaching on this subject I will have something
+to say about my own dear, good, anxious mother, and of
+how she used to say when I was a boy, "<i>What a terrible
+thing it will be if I see you shut out of heaven!</i>" She did
+not say terrible; "unco" was her word.</p>
+
+<p>'I have not yet had time to realise my loss, and cannot
+think of the Hamilton house as being without her. Eh,
+man! you know how good a mother she was to us, and I
+have some idea of what a companion and help she was to
+you. You two had nearly fifty years together. You must
+feel lonely without her. Fathers and mothers are thought
+much of by the Chinese, and you, at my suggestion, were
+most heartily and feelingly prayed for by the Chinese at<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[Pg 230]</a></span>
+our prayer-meeting to-night. You would have felt quite
+touched could you have heard and understood them.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>There is a special interest attaching to the sentence
+used frequently by his mother. On <a href="#Page_41">page 41</a> he refers to
+his conversion, but no record appears to have been preserved,
+giving any detail or fixing with any exactness the
+date. But his brothers have a conviction that his constant
+recollection of the oft-repeated and well-remembered words,
+'What an unco thing it will be if I see you shut out of
+heaven!' was one of the most potent influences in bringing
+about his conversion. The letters immediately following
+were written during the last two years of his father's
+life.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Let us not be disturbed at all about our not having
+more communication. I pray often for you and remember
+you more frequently still, and feel more and more that
+earth is a shifting scene, that here we have no permanent
+place, that heaven is our home, that your wife&mdash;my dear
+mother&mdash;has gone there, that my wife has gone there and
+is now in the Golden City, and that, sooner or later, you
+and I will be there, and that, when there, we'll have plenty
+of time to sit about and talk all together in a company.
+Lately I have come to see that we have but to put ourselves
+into the hands of Jesus and let Him do with us as He
+likes, and He'll save us <i>sure and certain</i>. He can make us
+willing even to let Him change us and train us.</p>
+
+<p>'You are eighty years old. I am proud of you. I like
+to think of your life. Mother told me, when I was a lad, of
+some of your early struggles. God has been with you and
+guided you on through all to a good old age of honour and
+respect and love. Trust Him and He'll not leave you.
+Depend upon it, God has something better for us in the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_231" id="Page_231">[Pg 231]</a></span>
+world to come than He has ever given us here. And it is
+not difficult to get it. God wants to give it to us all; offers
+it to us, and is distressed if we don't take it. We have
+only to go to Christ and ask Jesus to make it all right for
+us, and He'll do it. I know you are in earnest. Jesus will
+turn away no earnest man.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Mr. Gilmour senior acted as steward of the little store
+which his son by rigid economy was amassing for the
+benefit of his children. Scotch thrift was well exemplified
+in them both. But in the course of 1887 James Gilmour
+became troubled about this accumulation of even that
+small sum which he could call his own. In his lonely
+introspective Mongolian life the possession of money came
+to wear in his view the aspect of distrusting God. At this
+juncture the London Missionary Society was in a somewhat
+serious state as regards funds. A special appeal had
+been sent out indicating that if additional funds were not
+forthcoming, some fields of work might have to be given
+up. James Gilmour's response was an order to pay over
+anonymously the sum of 100<i>l.</i> to the general funds of the
+Society, and 50<i>l.</i> to that set apart for widows and orphans.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'March 16, 1887.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Father,&mdash;Some explanation is due to you of
+the order to pay the London Missionary Society 100<i>l.</i> of my
+money as a contribution to their funds.</p>
+
+<p>'The money that I have in the bank is the result of
+long and, much of it, of self-denying savings on my part
+and the part of my late wife&mdash;more on hers than mine,
+perhaps. When she died, and I was going off to this
+remote and isolated field, it was a comfort to me to think
+that in the event of my death there was a little sum laid
+past which would help my sons to get an education. I<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_232" id="Page_232">[Pg 232]</a></span>
+have added to that sum all I could from my house-furniture
+sale, &amp;c., and it has reached a good figure&mdash;the exact
+sum I cannot yet tell&mdash;I have not yet had your account
+for 1886.</p>
+
+<p>'Some time ago God seemed to say, "<i>Entrust that money
+to My keeping!</i>" and, as days went on, the command
+seemed to get more loud and be ever present, so much so
+that finally I could not read my Bible for it or pray. I
+had no resource left but to obey; I did not like to give it
+up; but finally it has appeared to me that God is only
+keeping the funds for the lads and that He will arrange for
+them to have them all right when they are needed. How
+He can do this I need not ask. He may, for instance, keep
+me alive for the sake of the lads. In one sense it seems
+an unwise thing not to be laying up something for the
+children's education; but that is only one side of it.
+God seems to ask me to trust Him with my children, and
+I trust Him with them. They are far from my care and
+control, and I know such painful cases of the children of
+missionaries growing up unbelievers that I dare not do
+anything that seems to me not to be putting them fully
+into God's care and up-bringing.</p>
+
+<p>'In addition, I am exhorting people here to become
+Christians, by doing which they throw themselves and their
+children outside of the community. I tell them to do it,
+and trust God's protecting them in troubles and helping
+them in difficulties; and I can hardly do that if I have
+not faith in God myself for me and mine.</p>
+
+<p>'Again, I need God's help and blessing much in my
+work here, and I do not seem to myself to be able to
+expect it if I do not trust Him. So please regard the
+money removed as not lost, only put into a safer bank.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The following letter, also dealing with money matters
+from the Christian point of view, is so striking in many<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_233" id="Page_233">[Pg 233]</a></span>
+ways that it has been deemed advisable to quote it <i>in
+extenso</i>:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Ch'ao Yang, Mongolia: May 6, 1888.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Father,&mdash;Enclosed please find some directions
+about the disposal of my money. These arrangements
+are so contrary to my previous arrangements that some
+explanation is due to you and to my brothers. Here they
+are.</p>
+
+<p>'In my mission work out here I am much thrown upon
+God. The field is a very hard one. The superstitions are
+like towns walled up to heaven. The power of man avails
+nothing against them. As far as man is concerned I am
+almost alone. I turn to God. I hear the words, "Not by
+might nor by power, but by My Spirit," saith the Lord. I
+trust Him. I call upon Him. I commune with Him. He
+comes near me. I ask Him to convert men. There are
+conversions, a few true, as far as I can judge. But there
+seems some barrier between God and me to a certain
+extent. Thinking round to see what it can be, I hear a
+voice saying, "Can't you trust Me with the money you have
+laid up for your children?" I think over it I pray over
+it. I say, "I may die and the boys need the money." God
+replies, "If you trust Me with it, don't you think I'd give
+them it as they needed?" I say, "But my father and
+brothers might not see it so, and might not like the idea of
+destitute orphan children on their hands." God replies,
+"With <i>Me</i> for their banker children are not destitute, and
+if you prefer father and brothers before Me, you are not
+worthy of Me." Then I say, "What will you have me do?"
+God says, "Give Me the money; I'll see they have all that
+is necessary." I dare not disobey. I don't want to disobey.
+I am so much exercised over the spiritual well-being
+of the boys, that I gladly do anything that will make them
+in any sense more specially protégés of God. I am alarmed<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_234" id="Page_234">[Pg 234]</a></span>
+at the fate of some missionaries' children who have not
+turned out godly men. Preserve the boys from this!</p>
+
+<p>'This is no sudden resolution. I have thought and
+prayed much over it. I can delay this step no longer without
+feeling I would be refusing to follow God's guidance. I feel,
+too, that God has so many ways in which He can bless the
+lads and me, that in making this arrangement I am running
+no risk. The only thing I am not quite clear about is the
+detailed disposition of the money. Meantime, it seems to
+me that I can best use it for God in this mission here. I
+mean to bank it in Peking, in the first instance, and use it
+for renting or buying premises.</p>
+
+<p>'As to the general principle of having money for ourselves
+or children, I do not think God asks us all to put all
+we may have or get thus in His keeping, or asks me even
+to put <i>all</i> into His keeping in this especial manner. You
+know the money was originally saved from the salary
+given by the mission, and in this sense is peculiar. Money
+that I had earned by trade, or otherwise come by, I do not
+think God would ask me to dispose of it so. But His
+voice seems very plain in this present case.</p>
+
+<p>'My salary I shall still have paid to me, and the children's
+remittances shall come as usual. If I live I guess
+this will be enough for the education of the lads. If I die,
+the lads are not destitute. Even in a worldly sense, and
+quite apart from this sum which I am banking with God,
+and which I am sure He'll repay with compound interest
+when needed, if left orphans they would be in some sense
+provided for by the London Missionary Society, which,
+though it gives no pensions to any one, yet yearly raises
+funds and gives money to broken-down old missionaries,
+widows, and orphans. I don't suppose it is much or
+enough, but it is something. I say this that you may not
+be troubled should your faith be weak or waver.</p>
+
+<p>'I hope that these arrangements may not seem unwise<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_235" id="Page_235">[Pg 235]</a></span>
+to you, and will commend themselves to you far enough to
+have your consent if not your warm approval. For myself
+I am thankful that God has given me faith enough to trust
+Him so. It has taken time to come to this. Myself is a
+small matter&mdash;it takes more faith to trust for one's children.
+Just fancy old Abraham offering his Isaac. Just fancy,
+God so loved the world that He gave His only Son. Let
+us respond to God's love.</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Your loving son,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.&nbsp;&nbsp;</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In compliance with his wish a sum amounting to several
+hundred pounds was sent out to Peking and there banked
+by him. Had not the many difficulties which Chinese
+habits placed in the way prevented the completion of
+negotiations, there is hardly any doubt that James Gilmour
+would have himself spent this money on his own mission-field.
+He died before any of the negotiations for premises
+which he had commenced reached a successful
+issue. As he had not specified in his will that this sum
+was to be devoted to mission work, the trustees of his boys
+have had no alternative, and have felt it their duty to consider
+it a part of his estate, the income of which should be
+devoted to the education of his sons. But the intention
+of James Gilmour was clear and well known, and it
+is to be hoped that the interest felt by many friends in his
+life and work will prove strong enough to secure a permanent
+home for the mission as a memorial of its founder,
+and on the site of his glad and self-sacrificing toil.</p>
+
+<p>A year or two later, in a letter to his boys, he seeks
+to enforce the duty of careful, systematic giving to
+God.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_236" id="Page_236">[Pg 236]</a></span></p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Ch'ao Yang: August 19, 1890.
+</p>
+
+<p>'I wonder if you are giving a tenth of all the money
+you get to God. I think it is a right thing to do and a
+good thing. Mamma did it: I do it: and God never let us
+want for money. I would be glad if you would like to do it.
+But don't do it merely to please me. Don't do it except
+you can do it gladly. God likes people to do things
+gladly. I am quite sure you would get blessing by it.
+Money given to God is never lost. And it is easier to
+begin the habit now than later.</p>
+
+<p>'When you give it to God you can put it into the
+London Missionary Society box; it would only be fair to
+give some little part of it at the collection at the church to
+which you go. You could give some of it for destitute
+children. It does not matter much where you give it. I
+think the London Missionary Society has the best claim.
+Think over it, boys. Jesus died to save us: surely we can
+show our gratitude by giving Him some of our money?'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Later letters to his father outline for us his religious
+experience, and enable us to realise something of the
+spiritual experience of these years.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Ch'ao Yang: March 29, 1887.
+</p>
+
+<p>'I am wondering how you all are. God has been drawing
+me nearer to Him these last weeks, and I am living in
+the hope that He will bless me and my work largely some
+day. There is much ignorance to be removed, much suspicion,
+much misunderstanding of me as a foreigner, and I
+am hammering away as hard as I can. There are mountains
+of difficulty to be removed, but I am trusting in God
+to remove them, and these last days I have had much
+peace and joy in my heart thinking of God's love to me
+and the salvation of Jesus. I have no doubt at all about<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_237" id="Page_237">[Pg 237]</a></span>
+my being His, and sometimes the great hope is almost too
+much to realise. But I am often at the same time downcast
+that I cannot see more people here converted, and I
+think that, if God has a favour to me and delights in me,
+He can well move the hearts of these people to believe in
+His Son, and choose out people to come and help me in
+my work. I am sometimes lonely here, and wish I had a
+friend to talk to and tell all my troubles, and then I think
+that Jesus is such a friend, and so I tell Him all my griefs;
+but I would like to have a colleague.</p>
+
+<p>'I hope, my dear father, that your heart is contented and
+happy in Jesus. Only let Him arrange all things for you
+as regards your soul, and He'll do it all right. He can be
+trusted. Heaven is not far away; we'll soon be there;
+comfort your heart. Won't it be too blessed to be again
+with our wives, freed from all that is earthly, and suffering,
+and surrounded by nothing but what is nice! This is no
+dream: it is real; it is true; it is kept for us; it will be
+ours. We'll see it soon; you and I will be there together.
+It may be some time before we are there together; but
+years soon pass. Cheer up, my father!</p>
+
+<p>'We miss much by not living near to Jesus&mdash;taking
+Him at His word and expecting that He'll do all we need
+done for us both in saving us and in making our hearts
+good. Jesus is real and heaven is real, and our share in
+heaven, if we trust and follow Jesus, is real. You say you
+are busy: so am I. You have cares: so have I. Go
+ahead and look after your work and business; but you'll do
+it all the better that your heart is at peace with God and
+at rest in Jesus. I find that the closer I am to Jesus the
+better I can meet and bear all troubles, trials, and difficulties,
+and you will find the same true if you try.</p>
+
+<p>'I feel quite lifted up to-night. I have a room to
+myself. This is the first time I have had a room to
+myself since leaving Peking January 25. It is pleasant to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_238" id="Page_238">[Pg 238]</a></span>
+be private a little. This room is private to me alone only
+after (say) 8 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span>, when I am left in peace. I hope to have
+this room for three weeks.</p>
+
+<p>'I am afraid, if you saw the room, you would not think
+it much of a place. To-night, too, I have a pillow. For
+over three weeks I have rested my head on some folded-up
+bag or article of dress: to-night I have a pillow. Christ
+had not where to lay His head. In all things I am still
+better off than He was. If I could only see souls saved I
+would not care for the roughing it.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In a letter later in the same year to a missionary
+colleague in a distant field Mr. Gilmour unveils still further
+his religious history:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Mongolia: October 7, 1887.
+</p>
+
+<p>'Yours of May 31 to hand three or four days ago.
+The China Inland Mission has a lot of good men in it. It
+does a good work. It is warm-hearted devotion that wins
+souls and gets God's approval. My experience has been
+different from yours, happily. All along I have gone on
+the "headlong for Christ" way of things here, even when
+preaching to the most intellectual English and American
+audiences, and they have received me royally. Man,
+God has waked me up these last years to such an extent
+that I feel a different man. I sometimes wonder now if I
+was converted before. I suppose I was, but the life was a
+cold, dull one. Just the other day Jesus, so to speak, put out
+His hand and touched me as I was reading a hymn, something
+about desiring spiritual things and passing by Jesus
+Himself. I wanted His blessing more than I wanted Him.
+That is not right. Lately, too, I have become calm.
+Before I worked, oh so hard and so much, and asked God
+to bless my work. Now I try to pray more and get more
+blessing, and then work enough to let the blessing find its
+way through me to men. And this is the better way.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_239" id="Page_239">[Pg 239]</a></span>
+It is the right way. And I work a lot even now. Perhaps
+as much as before; but I don't worry at the things I cannot
+overtake. I feel, too, more than I did, that God is
+guiding me. Oh! sometimes the peace of God flows over
+me like a river. Then it is so blessed, heaven is real. So
+is God: so is Jesus. Our lot is a great one.</p>
+
+<p>'Try not to fly around so much: take more time with
+God. Be more in private prayer with Him, and see if He
+will not give you a greater spiritual blessing for your
+people. After all, the great want, as I gather from your
+letters, is the spiritual blessing on the people. Ask it, man,
+and you'll get it. God's promises are sure. I am trying
+to combine the China Inland Mission, the Salvation Army,
+and the L.M.S. I have a great district, and a hard one,
+all to myself. There is said to be a young doctor on his
+way out to me. I am writing by this mail for three
+young laymen. Non-smoking and teetotalism are conditions
+of Church membership. I have seen no foreigner
+since January 25, and am not likely to see one till
+December 5. My mails take an enormous time to reach
+me, and two sent in June and July from Peking (eight days
+off) have never come to hand at all. I am baffled, battered
+and bruised in soul in many ways, but, thank God, holding
+on and believing that He is going to bless me.</p>
+
+<p>'Eh, man, never talk of not going back. Go back, though
+you can only do half work; go back, and work less and pray
+more. That is what you need. I have been a vegetarian
+for over a year. I find fasting helpful to prayer. Two
+books by Andrew Murray, Wellington, Cape Town&mdash;<i>Abide
+in Christ, With Christ in the School of Prayer</i>&mdash;have
+done me much good. May blessings be on your dear wife
+and children! Yours, hoping to have a good long holiday
+with you in heaven,</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_240" id="Page_240">[Pg 240]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Some years earlier in his career he had written a letter
+of brotherly remonstrance to one who, in a moment of
+depression and without any adequate cause, felt himself
+slighted. The same spirit breathes through both, but is
+richer and fuller in the later letter. God had been teaching
+James Gilmour in a hard, but a fruitful school.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I know of your zeal in working at home as well as
+abroad, and I am greatly grieved to find you think you are
+badly treated. I think it is very unfortunate that any
+agent should have that feeling about his Society, L.M.S. or
+other. I am alarmed, too, my dear fellow, to find you
+express yourself so strongly. It is hardly the thing.
+Would Christ have said that? I do hope you will pardon
+my speaking so, but you know sometimes a rash word
+does more harm than a deed even. And I am anxious
+that you should have a peaceful mind. <i>I</i> know your value,
+and wish to see you nearly perfect. Let me remind you
+of a thing we both believe, and a thought I have often
+been comforted by. Jesus has suffered even more for us
+than we can ever suffer for Him, and what you do in
+raising funds and endeavouring is done, not for L.M.S., but
+for Him, <i>for Him</i>, and He sees and knows and won't
+forget, but sympathises and appreciates, and at the end
+will speak up straight and open for His true men. I often
+lug portmanteaus, walk afoot, and, as the Chinese say,
+"eat bitterness," in China and in England. I am not
+thanked for it, but He knows. No danger of being overlooked.
+Now, don't be "huffed" at my lecturing you, and
+don't think I must think a lot of myself to suppose that I
+am running up a bill of merit, like a Buddhist, and think I
+am Jesus's creditor. My dear fellow, you know better
+than that. I point out to you and remind you of the only<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_241" id="Page_241">[Pg 241]</a></span>
+way I know to be persistently useful, and at the same
+time happy.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>But of all the relationships of life&mdash;son, brother, friend,
+ambassador for Christ&mdash;that which most naturally, most
+profoundly, and most beautifully reveals his very heart is
+when he writes as the loving father to his distant motherless
+boys. A large number of his letters to them have
+been entrusted to the hands of his biographer. Many of
+them touch upon subjects too sacred for publication. They
+deal with those closest of earthly ties in which not even
+intimate friends can legitimately claim a share. But
+it was felt that they reveal a side of his nature and
+character that ought not to be entirely hidden in any
+picture of his life. For this reason a somewhat extensive
+selection has been made from this tender and helpful
+correspondence. When it first began the lads were too
+young to read the letters themselves, but he wrote long
+accounts of his work to be read to them, and it is pleasant
+to see how keen his eye became in noting such things as
+were likely to amuse them and to arrest their attention.
+Some of the letters are written in big letters resembling
+printed capitals. The brief, childlike letters that were
+sent to him by them were bound up into a paper volume,
+which he carried about with him during his Mongolian
+wanderings, and in looking them over he found an unfailing
+solace and refreshment. He often illustrated his own
+letters to them by rough but effective sketches of persons
+and things which he saw. The death of their mother had
+brought the lads and their father very near to one another,
+and although lost to sight, they always thought and spoke
+of the dear one who had gone as still of the family, as in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_242" id="Page_242">[Pg 242]</a></span>
+perfect happiness, and waiting only God's time to reunite
+them in the happy life of heaven.</p>
+
+<p>When it was decided to entrust them to the care of an
+uncle in Scotland, Mr. Gilmour set out the desires he
+cherished with regard to their training. It is only to be
+regretted that similar plans are not formed and acted upon
+in the training of all children.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'The laddies are here with me now, and I am both
+father and mother to them. To-night I darned three
+stockings for them when they went to bed. You see I
+have been away two months, and in a week or two I may
+have to part from them for ten years, so I am having a
+little leisure time with them. I sometimes do feel real
+bad at the idea of the two orphan lads going away so far;
+but then the promise of Christ that no one leaves parents
+or children for His sake, without being repaid manifold,
+comforts me by making me believe that God will raise up
+friends to comfort them wherever they may be.</p>
+
+<p>'Cheer up! The two worlds are one, and not far separate.
+Mrs. Prankard, I hear, won't have Emily's name mentioned.
+We here go on the other tack, and the children are all day
+long talking about what mamma did and said, and adventures
+we had together. And why not? The tears
+come sometimes: let them, they do no harm, are a relief
+more than anything, and the time is coming when God will
+wipe away all tears from our eyes.</p>
+
+<p>'I wish them to be Christ's from their youth up. I
+wish them to get a good thorough education, not too
+expensive, to be able to read, write, and spell well. Should
+either of them turn out likely, I might be able to let both,
+or that one have a college education, but I don't want either
+of them to go there if they don't show adaptation for it.</p>
+
+<p>'What I want of you is something money cannot buy,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_243" id="Page_243">[Pg 243]</a></span>
+motherly and fatherly care in Christ for the desolate lads,
+whose whole life in time and eternity too may largely
+depend on how they are trained and treated during the
+next few years. I am not rich, but I can support my boys.
+This Christian care and love, however, is what is not to be
+had for money, so I beg it.</p>
+
+<p>'I had five hours' conversation with one Chinaman at a
+stretch the other day. I think he was not far from the
+kingdom of God at first, and I believe he is nearer now. All
+these things take time, and I am most anxious to be with
+the children much these last days. Oh, it is hard to think
+of them going off over the world in that motherless fashion!
+We were at mamma's grave yesterday for the first time since
+September 21. We sang "There is a land that is fairer
+than day," in Chinese, and also a Chinese hymn we have
+here with a chorus, which says, "We'll soon go and see
+them in our heavenly home," and in English, "There is a
+happy land." The children and I have no reluctance in
+speaking of mamma, and we don't think of her as here or
+buried, but as in a fine place, happy and well.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Here are a few short extracts from the earlier letters:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Cheer up, my dear sonnies! We shall see each other
+some day yet. Tell all your troubles to Jesus, and let Him
+be your friend. I, out here, think often of mamma and her
+nice face, and how good she was to you and to me. You
+will not forget her. She sees you every day, and is so
+pleased when you are good lads. We'll all go some day
+and be with her, won't that be good? Meantime, Jesus is
+taking care of her, and will take care of us.</p>
+
+<p>'Sometimes, when I am writing a letter to you, and
+come to the foot of a page, and want to turn over the leaf,
+I don't take blotting paper and blot it, but kneel down and
+pray while it is drying.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_244" id="Page_244">[Pg 244]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'I am going away, too, in a few days; then I'll have no
+one but Chinese to speak to. Never mind, I'll just tell
+Jesus all my affairs; I cannot go away from Him. He is
+never too busy to talk to me. Just you, too, tell Jesus all
+your troubles. He sees both you and me.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>From the longer letters we select three or four, and
+give them exactly as they were written. From them the
+character of many others, from which only brief extracts
+can be taken, may be judged.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Ch'ao Yang: April 10, 1887.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Sons,&mdash;I am well and thankful for it. I am
+getting on well too, thank God. I have had terrible
+weather lately though. Daily I have my tent&mdash;it is only a
+cloth roof on six bamboo poles&mdash;put up in the market-place.
+We have had three days' wind. Eh, man, the first day the
+dust was terrible. But I had lots of patients and remained
+out all day. At last we had to take down our tent.
+It could not stand. The tent was carried to the inn, but
+we remained with our table till evening. You would
+hardly have known us for dust. But patients came all
+the time. Next day the tent was blown down twice.
+Once a man's head got such a smack with the bamboo
+tent pole, but he said nothing and took it quite pleasantly.
+A peep-show man near us got his show blown down and
+scattered about. He gathered it up and went home to his
+inn.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_245" id="Page_245">[Pg 245]</a></span></p></blockquote>
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 491px;"><a name="p245" id="p245">
+<img src="images/245.jpg" width="491" height="328" alt="JAMES GILMOUR&#39;S TENT" title="" />
+<span class="caption">JAMES GILMOUR&#39;S TENT</span></a>
+</div>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I am so glad that the people like us and trust us and
+come about us for medicines. Women came too. Boys
+came too. Just now the school boys have holiday for the
+fair, and they stand for a long time together looking at me
+doctoring the people. What the boys like to see is a
+glass bottle of eye medicine which I bring out and set up.
+Then I dip a glass tube in and press an india-rubber bulb.
+<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_247" id="Page_247">[Pg 247]</a></span>The air comes out in the water in bubbles and rises up to
+the surface, and the boys are so delighted to see it bubbling.
+They will wait a long time and like to see it ever so often.
+They are sometimes troublesome, then I send them away.
+When they are good I shove the glass tube deep down
+into the bottle, and they are so delighted to see the air
+bubbling up from the bottom.</p>
+
+<p>'When a man comes to have a tooth pulled even the
+men are delighted, and advise him to have it out. They
+want to see the fun. Mothers send their little boys for
+medicine, and I am so pleased with some of the little lads.
+They are so modest and so polite, making a deep bow as
+they go away. Always be modest and polite, my sons, and
+people will love you and treat you well.</p>
+
+<p>'The boys buy a lot of books too, and I preach to them
+earnestly, because in ten years to come they will be men,
+and if they know about Jesus now they may more easily
+become Christians some day soon. You, Jimmie, know
+Jesus; does Willie? Teach him. Mamma is not here to
+teach him, and I am far away. You are his big brother.
+Teach you him like a good laddie as you are.</p>
+
+<p>'The other day when I was preaching a man was
+standing behind me with a little black pig under his arm.
+He wanted to hear me preach, but the pig would not be
+quiet. He held its mouth shut, but the little pig would
+still manage to give a squeak now and again. At last it
+would not be quiet at all, and he had to go away with it.
+I could not help smiling at him. There is an old man
+here in my inn. He is owner of the inn. His son manages
+the inn. The old man is not very old. He is about sixty-five.
+But he used to be a great opium smoker. A year or
+more ago he had a very serious illness and gave up his
+opium, but he had wrecked his health by his smoking.
+He cannot now live many months. He can hardly speak
+plainly now. He comes to see me in my room, and I try<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_248" id="Page_248">[Pg 248]</a></span>
+to tell him about Jesus, hoping that he may be saved. He
+listens, but he is not very bright in his mind. I hope he
+may pray to Jesus.</p>
+
+<p>'The other day I had to pull my own tooth. It was the
+back tooth and had been painful for days. There was no
+one who could do it for me, so I sat down with a little
+Chinese looking-glass before a candle, got a good hold of
+it with the forceps, and after a good deal of wrenching out
+it came. He <i>was</i> a deep-pronged fellow, and he did bleed.
+I was so thankful that God helped me to get it out. I can
+sleep now all right.</p>
+
+<p>'Our Mongol donkeyman wants to be a Christian. I
+hope he is sincere, but he is very slow and dull at learning.
+There are three other men here who are learning about
+Jesus too, but it is too early yet to say much about them.
+A good many people learn some, then stop. But it is late
+and I must go to bed, else I won't be able to preach and
+doctor all day in the market-place at the fair to-morrow.</p>
+
+<p>'Praying that God may bless you, my sons, and sending
+you much love,</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'I am your affectionate Father,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Ta Chêng Tz&#365;: Sept. 3, 1887.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Sons,&mdash;I am well, and thankful for it. The
+three Christians here come daily to evening worship.
+There are here others who want to be Christians, but who
+have not courage enough. One man's wife won't let him
+be a Christian; she says she will kill herself if he does.
+Another man is in the same case. He is a Chinaman, his
+wife is a Mongol. Still another man has a Mongol wife,
+and she kept him back. The other day he came and confessed
+Christianity. His wife does not consent, only says:
+"We'll see." Another man's father hinders his son from
+Christianity. The lad is a very nice lad.</p>
+
+<p>'Yesterday was the day when people make offerings of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_249" id="Page_249">[Pg 249]</a></span>
+food and fruit at the graves. One of the Christians was
+sent to do so. He brought the melon here, and we ate half
+of it with him.</p>
+
+<p>'Still another man is forbidden by his father to be a
+Christian. That is, in all, five men are Christians at heart,
+and read our books and are learning Christianity, but do
+not confess Christ in this one place. Do you know what
+Jesus says about such people (Matt. x. 32-39)? Jesus
+says that, if they obey others rather than Him, they are not
+worthy to be His disciples. I am praying for all these
+people. I ask you, too, to pray for these and all like them,
+that they may be able to confess Christ. It is difficult for
+men in China to be Christians. How different with you!
+We all want you to be Christians. Your father and friends
+all help you to be Christians, and if you are not Christians
+we are all distressed.</p>
+
+<p>'Boys, do be true to Jesus. In your words and deeds
+honour Him. Make <i>His</i> heart glad. Jesus wants your
+love. He loves you and died for you. You cannot but
+love Him if you think how He loves you. Good-bye. Meantime
+I am just going to breakfast, and then for a day
+on the street, trying to tell the people about Jesus. God
+bless you, my dear lads!</p>
+
+<p>'It is now afternoon. I write a few lines. A lad in a
+shop here has a tame dove. He has painted it all over
+different colours. It looks absurd. I don't like to see it
+sitting about the shop. Doves look so happy flying about.
+Mamma, too, liked to see birds on the trees and houses wild,
+not kept in cages.</p>
+
+<p>'I guess you are just about getting your breakfast.
+Here it is about 4 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> With you it should be 8 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span>
+Saturday; I wish I could see you. My love to you, my dear
+sons. May you always, both now and when grown, be
+boys and men that know and love Jesus! I pray for you.
+Your loving father,</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_250" id="Page_250">[Pg 250]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>In August 1884 a third son was given to Mr. and Mrs.
+Gilmour, whom they named Alexander. In 1887 spinal
+trouble developed, and in December of that year he died.
+'Though often ill,' wrote his father when announcing the
+death to the uncle after whom he had been named, 'his life
+was a happy one. It is now happier than ever. Thanks be
+to God that there is, and that we know that there is, a
+bright and happy life beyond. Let us make that the great
+meeting-place for ourselves and our children and friends.
+May it stand before us as a joy! As ever and anon one
+and another goes there, may we feel that we have more
+and more interest there! Let us live looking to the joy set
+before us!' This baby-brother is the Alick referred to in
+the following letter:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Ta Chêng Tz&#365;, Mongolia: February 11, 1888.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Sons,&mdash;I am well, and thankful for it. I got
+here two days ago. I had such a cold time of it on the
+road! I never felt the cold so much before.</p>
+
+<p>'People here are very busy. This is the last day of the
+Chinese year.</p>
+
+<p>'To-morrow is the first day of the Chinese year. Everybody
+is buying all sorts of food, because the shops do not
+open for some days after the new year. They are very
+busy, too, scraping off the old papers at the sides of their
+doors and pasting up new papers. They (the papers) are
+red, and look fine at first with the great black Chinese
+characters written on them. But the sun after a while
+takes the colour out of them.</p>
+
+<p>'They are busy, too, pasting up the new gods in their
+houses. They (the gods) are sheets of paper with pictures
+of gods on them. Every house has a god of the kitchen.
+They send him to heaven, as they think, by burning him.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_251" id="Page_251">[Pg 251]</a></span>
+They burnt the old one last Saturday. They are putting
+up the new one now. They think that when he is burnt
+he goes to heaven and reports to a god what he has seen
+in the house during the year. I ask them if I burnt them
+would they think they were going to heaven? They buy
+sticky sugar-cakes to give him so that he may be pleased,
+and not tell on them for doing evil things. They think,
+too, that the sugar sticks his lips together, so that when he
+wants to tell on them he can't get his mouth open! Isn't
+it all very silly and very sad? The shopkeepers, too, paste
+up a "god of riches," thinking that thus they will become
+rich!</p>
+
+<p>'To-morrow (Sunday) I hope to baptize a man. He is
+a Chinaman. That will make four Christians here. They
+all have faults and weaknesses, and I am not very easy in
+my mind about them. Pray that God may make them
+better and make them grow in grace. Pray, too, that God
+may convert more of the people. Pray, too, that God may
+give us a house of our own to live in. People here are
+afraid to let us have a house. Now that Dr. Roberts is
+coming, we will need a house. He is coming in six or
+seven weeks. Then he stays two months, and goes back
+to Tientsin for a while again. We saw the Christian at
+Tá Ss&#365; Kou as we passed. The Ch'ao Yang man we have
+not seen yet.</p>
+
+<p>'I have made all your letters to me into a book, and
+have them with me. Your letters are nice to read, and
+show great improvement in the writing. I am going to
+keep all your letters this year too and bind them. You
+may like to see them when you grow big. The last letter
+from you is dated October 27.</p>
+
+<p>'My dear sons, I think of you often and pray for you
+much.</p>
+
+<p>'You have a photo of mamma's grave. Little Alick's little
+mound is close to mamma's, on the side nearer little Edie's.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_252" id="Page_252">[Pg 252]</a></span>
+Mamma's and Alick's coffins touch down below. They lie
+together. But mamma and Alick are not there. They are
+in heaven, with its golden streets and its beautiful river,
+and its trees of life, and its beautiful gates, and its good,
+loving, kind people, and Jesus and God. They are having
+such a nice time of it there!</p>
+
+<p>'My boys, don't be afraid of dying. Pray to Jesus, do
+the things He likes, and if you die you will go to Him, to His
+fine place, where you'll have everything that is nice and
+good. I don't know whether you or I will go there first,
+but I hope that by-and-by we'll all be there, mamma and
+Alick and all. I like to think of this. Meantime let us
+be doing for Jesus all we can, telling people about Him
+and trying to persuade them to be His people. Are your
+schoolfellows Jesus' boys? Do you ever tell them of
+Him? Tell them, my dear sons.</p>
+
+<p>'I hope to get letters from you in about a month.</p>
+
+<p>'Good-bye, my dear boys.</p>
+
+<p>'May you be good and diligent, and then you'll be
+happy. Jesus can make you glad.</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Your loving Father,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Mrs. Meech had shown much motherly kindness to her
+little nephew Alexander, and only a few months after he
+had died she herself lost a little son. Mr. Gilmour, on
+hearing the sad tidings, wrote to her as follows:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Mongolia: March 25, 1888.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Mrs. Meech,&mdash;Many congratulations and
+condolences with you. Your little son has gone to Emily.
+She'll look after the little man as you looked after her
+little man. Just fancy! we have family connections in
+heaven not a few, and ever increasing. I hope you are
+now getting better and going on all right.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_253" id="Page_253">[Pg 253]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'I am much cheered by the good news of soul movements
+in the West Mission. May they continue and increase!</p>
+
+<p>'With many prayers for you all, and kept in constant
+remembrance of you all by the date block,</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Yours in loving sympathy,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'May 30, 1888.
+</p>
+
+<p>'I am doctoring a little homeless lad's head here. I put
+on ointment all over it to-day. He cried. I said I had
+medicine that would stop the pain, and brought out six
+cash&mdash;one farthing&mdash;and told him to go and have a bowl
+of buckwheat meal strings. All laughed, he stopped crying,
+and did not seem to feel the pain after that. Most of the
+people in the town are much impressed with the improvement
+in the boy's head. Before he came to me I saw a
+Chinese medicine-man poking at the lad's head with a
+straw. When he came I rubbed on ointment with my
+finger. The bystanders were much pleased to see I was
+not averse to touching the poor dirty lad's sore head. Jesus
+touched a leper, and I like to do things like what Jesus
+would do. That is the right way, boys. Always think
+what Jesus would have done, and do like Him.'<br /><br /></p></blockquote>
+
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Mongolia: Sept. 9, 1888.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Sons,&mdash;I am out on a journey. I knew letters
+were being sent me, and hoped to meet them. A long
+way off I saw a red umbrella, the sun shining through the
+oilcloth. The thought passed through my mind, "Can that
+be the messenger?" But I forgot all about it, reading a
+book as I walked along. All at once I heard, "He's come,"
+and looking up, saw the red umbrella close at hand. It
+<i>was</i> him. The messenger returns to-morrow. I had had
+no letters for eighty days.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_254" id="Page_254">[Pg 254]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'I wrote you last on August 2. Since then several men
+have professed Christ, and one man has been baptized.</p>
+
+<p>'One of the Christians at Ta Chêng Tz&#365; stole my bankbook
+and drew money of mine, amounting to about 3<i>l.</i>
+He says he is penitent, and we have put him on a year's
+probation to see how he does. He is a lazy man. Long
+ago I said, "If you are lazy, some day the devil will make
+you a sinner," and so he did. Had he been a diligent man
+he would not have been poor and would not have stolen.
+Diligence is a good thing, laziness is a bad thing. A
+good Christian cannot be lazy, because he knows Jesus
+does not like lazy people. I may write you again in a few
+days. Hoping next mail to get a letter from you (there
+was none this mail), and asking God to bless you in
+everything, and guide you in all your life,</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'I am your loving Father,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Ch'ao Yang, Mongolia: Saturday, November 17, 1888.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Sons,&mdash;On the street to-day I saw a crowd
+standing. I went up to see what they were looking at,
+and found two Chinese gentlemen showing off a trained
+bird. One of the men stood down on the street. The
+other put three little flags so that they stuck on the wall.
+The bird then flew away, caught up a flag, and came flying
+back to its master in the street, carrying the flag in its bill.
+It looked very clever. Every time the bird brought a flag
+it was rewarded by being fed with some nice food which it
+liked. It was very pretty to see it. But after all it was a
+very trifling employment for two grown gentlemen to be
+engaged in. Even the crowd of ordinary Chinese seemed
+to think so.</p>
+
+<p>'I don't like to see birds in captivity. It is pretty to
+see them wild flying about, and to hear them singing, but<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_255" id="Page_255">[Pg 255]</a></span>
+I pity them in cages, and tied by string as the Chinese are
+fond of doing with them. When I see birds tied I often
+think of mamma who used so much to like to see them
+wild.</p>
+
+<p>'I remember one day in Mongolia mamma stopped me
+from plucking a flower; she said it looked so pretty growing.
+Another time a beetle flew and alighted somewhere;
+mamma said, "It is so glad that it is alive, don't hurt it."</p>
+
+<p>'I am a good deal distressed to see the boys in the
+market-place. They steal just as much as ever they can
+from the sellers of straw and fuel, pluck out handfuls from
+the bundles and run away not at all ashamed. If the
+owner does not chase them they get off with it. If he
+throws down his load and runs after them they drop the
+plunder, the owner picks it up, and no more is said
+about it.</p>
+
+<p>'In summer little naked boys follow people carrying
+fruit in open baskets and steal it as they can: it all
+seems so dishonest, and no one seems to care. On the
+street lots of people will see a thief stealing a man's pipe
+and never say a word, because it is not their business.'</p>
+
+<p>'I often think of you and pray for you. You do not
+forget mamma, I am sure. She is with Jesus. Be you
+His lads, and do your lessons well, and He'll guide you all
+through life. Be diligent and careful lads, and you'll grow
+up useful and honoured men. Constantly tell Jesus all
+your affairs.</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Goodbye meantime, my boys.&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'Much love from your affectionate Father,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'
+</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_256" id="Page_256">[Pg 256]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XI" id="CHAPTER_XI"></a>CHAPTER XI</h2>
+
+<h3>CLOSING LABOURS</h3>
+
+
+<p>James Gilmour remained in Great Britain less than eight
+months. The society of his boys was a great delight to
+him. He rejoiced in renewed intercourse with relatives and
+old friends. His religious convictions and his own spiritual
+life deepened still more. He went to a considerable
+number of meetings to speak on missionary work and
+needs, and he everywhere produced a great impression.</p>
+
+<p>Referring to this visit, and especially to his intercourse
+with the boys, a near relative writes:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>'It was a time full of interest and pleasure. What a
+variety of moods, from the frolicsome to the pathetic, he
+displayed! But evidently his wife's death had laid hold
+upon his very soul, and there seemed so much more of
+sadness and tenderness than on his former visit, when he
+had enjoyed her bright companionship. On one occasion,
+referring to a medical missionary who had brought his
+wife home from China hopelessly ill, and who was expecting
+the end, he said: "Eh, man, he little knows the
+<i>terrible</i> dark valley he has to come through, and if Christ
+is not with him he will be undone!" He spoke the words
+as though he were again going through his own agony, and
+then added: "But if Christ is with him he will come out of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_257" id="Page_257">[Pg 257]</a></span>
+it with victory, and Christ will be dearer. But he has <i>no</i>
+idea what he has to face, though he thinks he has."</p>
+
+<p>'He had looked forward to spending part of his time
+with his sons at Millport, where he had spent June and
+July 1883 with his wife and boys on his former visit. So
+we went there for a month, and they had a good time
+boating, and walking, and reviving old memories of the
+happy home circle. The thought of reunion was always
+made prominent. The boys must ever remember his
+earnest efforts to lead their thoughts heavenward, and
+they do think of heaven as a very real place.</p>
+
+<p>'While at Millport he spent several nights in pasting up
+texts on every place likely to catch the eye; on stones
+and gateways and fences all round the island. He felt he
+must work while time was granted to him. I had noticed
+him making paste, but thought nothing of it. I had heard
+the sound of a softly closing door at midnight, but thought
+it must be fancy. It had gone to my heart to feel his icy
+cold hand when he gave me his morning greeting. I
+noticed the little texts pasted up, but never thought of
+them as his work till the next day, when he began to make
+more paste, and then the whole thing came to me like a
+flash. I begged him with tears not to go out in the cold
+night air, and said that I knew God would rather have him
+stay in his warm comfortable bed and get well and strong.
+He answered so kindly: "Sister, it pains me to grieve you."
+But he finished his work nevertheless.</p>
+
+<p>'He was always wonderfully considerate, and grateful
+for any attention. Sometimes, when he saw me unusually
+tired, he would go and get an extra pillow and make me
+rest on the sofa, or when we came to the table he would<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_258" id="Page_258">[Pg 258]</a></span>
+place me in a comfortable chair and pour out the tea himself,
+or he would say: "Sister, take a cup yourself first, then
+you will be able to help us."</p>
+
+<p>'On the day before he left us to return to China he
+really said his farewell. We had finished dinner, and when
+he went out he stood and looked in through the window at
+the happy faces still around the table. He threw a kiss,
+and then his feelings overcame him, his lip quivered, the
+tears came to his eyes, and he hastened away. Later in
+the day, when I was speaking hopefully of seeing him
+again, he answered: "I shall see your face no more."</p>
+
+<p>'I know he felt very much giving up the comforts of
+civilised life, but he set his face to it. It touched me much
+the last evening he was with us, when, after I had to
+remind him two or three times of some business it was
+needful for him to attend to before he would go, he said:
+"I can hardly drag myself away from this bright cosy
+scene."</p>
+
+<p>'His was a rarely sensitive soul. It pained him to hear
+any one speaking evil of another. I have seen him turn
+deadly pale when he has heard any one impute a wrong
+motive. He longed for more of the spirit of Christ among
+men. How he longed, too, for more workers in the Mission
+field! Many a time he would say, after a walk through
+Hamilton on a Saturday evening: "Just think! In a
+little town like this there are men preaching at every other
+street corner, and I am alone in all of those hundreds of
+square miles in Mongolia! What you people are thinking
+of I cannot imagine!"'</p>
+
+<p>In a correspondence which he conducted with the
+daughter of one of his former professors there is very much<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_259" id="Page_259">[Pg 259]</a></span>
+that reveals how deep and strong his religious life had
+become, and how he had noted the current of renewed
+spirituality which is evident now in all sections of the
+Evangelical Church.</p>
+
+<p>From this correspondence we have been permitted to
+cull some beautiful and helpful passages.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Glasgow: November 18, 1889.
+</p>
+
+<p>'May He Himself lead you into closer and closer
+communion with Him, and give you in very full measure
+His joy and His peace! For myself and for you, I
+pray that we may be more captivated with Him and His
+friendship. You know, I suppose, No. 565, "In the Secret
+of His Presence," in the 750 edition of Sankey. No.
+328, "O Christ, in Thee my soul hath found," is one I
+like too, as being the expression of partly experience and
+partly aspiration. He is truly the true source of true
+satisfaction. May we be led to trust Him more largely in
+all the things of our lives! I am sure, too it will be the
+things where we have trusted Him most and been most
+consecrated in His service that we shall value most when
+we look back on life from the end. May you be largely
+satisfied with His blessing and Himself!'<br /><br /></p></blockquote>
+
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'November 20, 1889.
+</p>
+
+<p>'I wonder if your experience is anything like mine&mdash;that
+I have often got less benefit than I had hoped from
+special withdrawals from common surroundings to get
+more into the presence of the Lord. One or two prominent
+instances of this have happened to me. I am glad
+He can be found anywhere, and that He is easy of access
+always with favourable or unfavourable surroundings.</p>
+
+<p>'About feeling&mdash;never mind that at all. Things are so
+whether we feel them or not. Let us take God at His<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_260" id="Page_260">[Pg 260]</a></span>
+word, and not consider our feelings. God refuses no one
+who comes to Him in sincerity. Let us be sure of this. I
+once heard Spurgeon say a good thing: "When doubts or
+the devil comes and says, 'You are not saved; you are
+not right with God,' I go to Him and say, 'If I never
+came before, I come now; if I never trusted before, I trust
+now.'" That cuts off all doubts about the present as standing
+on the past, and gives a fresh start.</p>
+
+<p>'All over the kingdom there is a hunger and thirst
+among many for a life of greater nearness to God; a feeling
+not only of the need of God being more of a daily, hourly
+reality and factor in our life, but that without Him more
+real and present life is not a satisfactory thing. When
+this feeling takes possession of one, we do not need to give
+up things as denying ourselves for Christ, so much as that
+we are changed in attitude towards many things. We
+drift away from them. Things that were gain to us we
+count loss for Christ. Our aims are different. May our
+lives be more fully taken captive thus! To a life lived
+thus, death is not a breaking off of anything; it is an enlargement
+of sphere.'<br /><br /></p></blockquote>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Hamilton: December 5, 1889.
+</p>
+
+<p>'All I know about the process is just going to God and
+telling what I want, and asking to be allowed to have it.
+"Seek, and ye shall find; ask, and ye shall receive." I know
+no secret but this.... God understands His scholars, and
+knows how to teach each one. Different scholars may
+require different ways. We may trust ourselves in His
+hands, only let us be earnest students. I have at different
+times been quite surprised how a book, or a friend, or a
+remark conveying just the teaching needed at the time has
+been brought into my way. Yes, none teach like Him.'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>December 25, 1889.</i>&mdash;Oh that we may be more completely
+given over and up to Him to be used at His pleasure<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_261" id="Page_261">[Pg 261]</a></span>
+and as He pleases! Oh for more faith in Him! My
+lads are, I think, enjoying themselves; I commit them to
+Him; but eh!'</p>
+
+<p>'<i>January 1, 1890.</i>&mdash;Just returned with my two lads
+after a day spent in London seeing my ship, the "Peshawur".
+The ship is full. My berth is not in a good place&mdash;but it
+is not bad, after all, and it is not for long.... You'll have
+lots of need of wisdom, and Jesus is made unto us wisdom
+as well as other things.... He'll teach you all right.
+Don't let us refrain for fear we make mistakes. The
+greatest mistake we could make would be to do nothing....</p>
+
+<p>'Everyone is amazed to see me look so well. It is
+remarked on all round. I feel remarkably well too....</p>
+
+<p>'May God be pleased to use me in His service!'</p></blockquote>
+
+
+<p>His heart was in Mongolia. At the very earliest
+moment which the medical authorities and the Directors of
+the London Missionary Society would sanction he returned.
+He sailed for China on January 9, 1890. As the
+steamer was running down the English Channel he wrote a
+letter to an old college friend just returning to England
+whom he had not seen for twenty years, and whom he was
+very sorry to miss:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'In answer to yours of November 19 I directed an
+envelope to you long ago. It has lain in my writing-case
+ever since, often seen but always taken precedence of by
+the thing that stepped in before. Now's your turn. I'm
+sorry you'll not see me in England. I sailed yesterday
+My health has been restored, and I am off again.</p>
+
+<p>'You say you want reviving&mdash;Go direct to Jesus and
+ask it straight out, and you'll get it straight away. This
+revived state is not a thing you need to work yourself up<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_262" id="Page_262">[Pg 262]</a></span>
+into, or need others to help you to rise into, or need to
+come to England to have operated upon you&mdash;Jesus can
+effect it anywhere, and does effect it everywhere whenever
+a man or woman, or men and women ask it. Ask and ye
+shall receive.</p>
+
+<p>'My dear brother, I have learned that the source of
+much blessing is just to go to Jesus and tell Him what
+you need. I am delighted to hear you say you need
+blessing, because I know there is plenty and to spare with
+Jesus. Oh for an outpouring on all parts of the L.M.S.
+missions!</p>
+
+<p>'There is so much that I would like to say that it is
+hardly worth while beginning to say anything; so I'll simply
+commend you to Jesus in all His fulness.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>On January 21, 1890, when nearing Port Said, he
+wrote:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'We have excellent company on board. Never had
+such a very pleasant voyage. Some of the First Salooners
+come to our Bible readings. Those who are unfriendly to
+Christianity are careful to give no cause of offence and are
+polite. So far our voyage has been an exquisite picnic.
+Knowing well what is before us, we still rejoice in the
+present Elim and calmly trust for the future. I went on
+board with a "tremendous cold." So did two or three
+others. Mine, as I expected, went with the exposure....
+No one teaches like Him who also was the first of preachers.
+In daily, hourly, humble communication with Him you
+will want for no wisdom and for no guidance and for no
+shepherding. Rejoice in that you have Him to manage
+everything for you.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>He reached Peking on March 14, 1890, and on
+March 24 started again for Mongolia. He entered upon
+his last spell of work with a good heart and with high<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_263" id="Page_263">[Pg 263]</a></span>
+hopes. Dr. Smith was to be his medical colleague.
+While in England Mr. Gilmour had visited Cheshunt
+College, and had there fired the heart of Mr. Parker with
+the desire and purpose of being his colleague. He was
+looking forward to his speedy arrival. During his absence
+in England Dr. Smith had paid one brief visit to Mongolia
+by himself, and another, still briefer, in the company of the
+Rev. T. Bryson of Tientsin. Meanwhile the work had
+been going on slowly and steadily under the care of the
+native helper, Mr. Liu, and of some of the converts. We
+now follow the story of this last year's work as it is told in
+Mr. Gilmour's letters and reports. On May 9, 1890, he
+wrote to the Rev. R. Wardlaw Thompson:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I have been all over the district, spending a month at
+Ch'ao Yang. There we were privileged to baptize four
+adults, one a woman, and one child, all Chinese. Two of
+these were young men who have been under instruction
+for eight or nine months, and are very pleasing cases
+indeed. The other two were a man and his wife, who is
+the first woman who has had courage to be baptized in
+this district. These last are an outcome of the medical
+work. They live in a small hamlet where the first
+beginning of an interest in Christianity took its rise from a
+man who came to me in the market-place with a bad sore in
+his leg, which had been caused by a wound from his own
+harvest sickle. The sore was cured, and friendly relations
+sprung up with the whole hamlet, and I am thankful to
+hear that, though only one family has put away its idols, all
+the neighbours are friendly.</p>
+
+<p>'In Ch'ao Yang there are several inquirers. Some of
+the Christians give great satisfaction, others are not so
+satisfactory. One man, a Christian, tells me that his wife<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_264" id="Page_264">[Pg 264]</a></span>
+was possessed by an evil spirit, and to please her and cure
+her he had to allow the re-establishment of the worship of
+that spirit for her benefit. No sooner was this done than
+the woman was cured! Such things are firmly believed in
+by the Chinese.</p>
+
+<p>'A most pleasing incident in our experience at Ch'ao
+Yang was a visit from a well-to-do farmer who lives some
+twenty li from the town. He has been friendly and an
+inquirer from the first. He has made no profession of
+Christianity, but says he reads his New Testament regularly,
+and prays. He has also taught two men in his
+neighbourhood. The one is a carpenter. The other is a
+farmer. They know the Catechism, observe the Sunday,
+and meet with Mr. Fêng for worship. Both of these men
+we saw, and their story seems true. Fêng came and spent
+a day with us. I asked him why he did not make an open
+profession of Christianity. His reply was that he lives
+with his parents, as all Chinese do, and that he cannot
+arrange his house disregarding them, who with his wife
+and children are still heathen. He has been able only
+partially to do away with idols in his own house. Outside
+too of his own house heathen pressure is so great that, he
+says, were he to join Christianity it would be no use for him
+to live! He says he lacks the courage single-handed to
+meet all the persecution that would descend on him were
+he baptized. Meantime he is instructing those about him
+in the hope, apparently, that were there several together
+they could better stand the trouble. It is an interesting
+case, but not at all satisfactory. My hope about him is
+that, if he keeps conversant with the Word of God, the
+Spirit may give him no rest till he has courage to take his
+stand and make his confession.</p>
+
+<p>'We had a splendid month in the market-place. Chinese
+and Mongols in plenty, both to preach to and to heal. One
+Mongol betrayed a most intimate and full knowledge of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_265" id="Page_265">[Pg 265]</a></span>
+Christianity. The drought gave good opportunity of speaking
+of many things, and in most cases we had respectful
+attention. It was a <i>hard</i> month's work. Seven till noon
+or a little after was our market time; the afternoon private
+patients, the evening inquirers, makes a very long day,
+which begins at daylight and does not end till after the
+second watch of the night has been set. The Chinese
+usually secure a rest just after noon, but frequently just
+then some patient would turn up, and put an end to quiet.
+In most cases the strain is relieved by holidays through
+rain and storm; but even this was wanting this time, so we
+had almost uninterrupted work.</p>
+
+<p>'I am more than ever eager to have the medical work
+given over to a medical man. One day in Ch'ao Yang a
+man came swaggering across the open space in the marketplace.
+People pointed towards him and laughed. He was
+laughable, the ridiculous part of him being a straw hat
+which was an imitation, caricature rather, of a foreigner's
+hat. I could not help laughing. It was no laughing
+matter, though. He was a messenger from the cavalry
+camp just outside the town. He had come to take me to
+treat two soldiers who had received bullet-wounds in an
+encounter with Mongolian brigands. I had never seen a
+bullet-wound in my life, but I knew I could do more for
+the wounded men than any Chinese doctor; so I went. The
+wounds were then forty-eight hours old, and I dressed them
+as best I could, paying a daily visit for about a fortnight.
+Two wounds, though deep, were merely flesh; with these I
+had no difficulty. The third was a bone complication. I
+knew nothing of anatomy, had no books, absolutely nothing
+to consult; what could I do but pray? And the answer was
+startling. The third morning, when in the market-place
+attending to the ordinary patients, but a good deal preoccupied
+over the bone case, which I had determined should
+be finally dealt with that day if possible at all, there tottered<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_266" id="Page_266">[Pg 266]</a></span>
+up to me through the crowd a <i>live skeleton</i>, the outline of
+nearly every bone quite distinct, covered only with yellow
+skin, which hung about in loose folds. I think I see him
+yet&mdash;the chin as distinctively that of a skeleton as if it
+had bleached months on the plain. The man was about
+seventy, wore a pair of trousers, and had a loose garment
+thrown over his shoulders. He came for cough medicine,
+I think; if so, he got it; but I was soon engaged fingering
+and studying the bone I had to see to that afternoon. I
+was deeply thankful, but amidst all my gratitude the thing
+seemed so comical that I could not help smiling, and a
+keen young Chinaman in the crowd remarked, in an under
+tone, "That smile means something." So it did. It meant,
+among other things, that I knew what to do with the
+wounded soldier's damaged bone; and in a short time
+his wound was in a fair way of healing. I was and am
+very thankful; but, after all, I am more impressed than
+ever with the fact that things are badly out of joint when
+there are lots of Christian doctors at home, and abroad
+too, and I, knowledgeless, am left to do the doctoring
+in a large district like this quite beyond the reach of
+medical help, not only for the natives but even for myself
+should I need it.</p>
+
+<p>'A grim commentary on these wounds was the fact that in
+leaving Ch'ao Yang I was to pass through a brigand-infested
+district&mdash;so badly infested that travellers have abandoned
+the road. As saith the Scripture, "The highways were unoccupied,
+and the travellers walked through byways." I
+had avoided this road twice, and was ashamed to avoid it
+again, so we went straight through it. We saw no one to
+harm us, but a week ago it was just as likely that I should
+to-day have been lying on a Chinese kang, trying to dress
+my own wounds, as that I should have been sitting here
+writing to you.</p>
+
+<p>'I am at present waiting for Dr. Smith, whose last word<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_267" id="Page_267">[Pg 267]</a></span>
+to me, dated Tientsin, April 9, was that I should either see
+him or hear from him here between June 6 and 12.</p>
+
+<p>'Yesterday, Sunday, June 8, had a pleasant day. The
+three Christians here have grown. Two of them have been
+through a good deal of trouble and stood it well. The
+farmer, who has been very ill, guessing we would be here,
+came in and spent the day with us. They seem very
+earnest.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The beneficial result of the home visit of 1889 was very
+evident at this time. It had arrested the 'running down,'
+from which he had severely suffered. It had enabled him to
+renew old friendships, and to form new ones. His wholehearted
+devotion to the difficult work of his life and the
+wonderful intensity and depth of his faith had touched the
+hearts of many faithful men and women at home, who
+gladly responded to his oft-repeated request, 'Pray for me
+and for the conversion of the Chinese and the Mongols.' He
+renewed his interest in the broad current of the world's
+life. We have seen how some years previously he gave up
+all reading but the Bible. Now, while he studied the
+Bible with all his old eagerness, he had various newspapers
+sent to him, he rejoiced in the receipt of books sent by
+friends&mdash;especially those bearing upon the culture of the
+soul&mdash;and he kept his eye upon the religious and social
+movements of the day.</p>
+
+<p>The selections from his correspondence which follow
+illustrate these changes in him. He modified his mode of
+life in Mongolia. Having given up vegetarianism on his
+homeward voyage he did not resume it upon his re-entrance
+on Mongol life. He remained a total abstainer, and his
+hatred of opium, whisky, and tobacco continued as strong<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_268" id="Page_268">[Pg 268]</a></span>
+as ever, although he did not now make abstinence from
+the two latter a test of Church membership. He reserved
+more of the Sunday as a day of rest, taking only the
+religious services with the Christians and inquirers, and not,
+as formerly, setting up his tent on the street. The old
+careworn look disappeared, his form regained much of its
+former life and spring, and his face filled out, his smile
+resumed the brightness of old, and the voice came back to
+a good deal of its early clearness. All these evidences of
+a change for the better served to augur many years of
+happy work. In a letter to a friend he playfully alludes
+to the twenty or thirty years of labour yet remaining, and
+he often&mdash;half in jest and half in earnest&mdash;asserted that life
+in the interior was so healthy that he should probably outlive
+his fellow-workers at Tientsin and Peking.</p>
+
+<p>By the mail that conveyed the letter quoted on <a href="#Page_263">page
+263</a> he also wrote to an Edinburgh friend:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Do you know Adolphe Monod's <i>Farewell</i>? It was sent
+to me lately by Rev. C. New, of Hastings, an old Cheshunt
+fellow-student. I have enjoyed it all, but most, I think,
+chapter xii., "Of Things not seen." A volume of sermons,
+entitled <i>The Baptism of the Spirit, and other Sermons</i>, by
+Mr. New, I have enjoyed intensely. To the meek child-like
+spirit desiring the sincere nourishing of the Word
+nothing, I think, could be more helpful.... If ever you
+send a book to the boys, let it be one that will do their
+souls good.</p>
+
+<p>'I may be filling my life too full, but between medical
+work and spiritual work I have barely time to sleep, and I
+find that, for any hope of continuance of work, I must have
+time to sleep. For the last month I have been getting up
+at 4.30 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span>, and our evening worship and after conversation<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_269" id="Page_269">[Pg 269]</a></span>
+was not over till, say, 9 or 9.15 or 9.30, or even, once
+or twice, till 10 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> Then it would take us some time to
+square up the day's affairs, and spread out my bedding.
+In the daytime I used to bolt my door, determined on an
+hour's quiet; but often this was in vain. I would hear
+some poor cultivator come for medicine; he had a long
+way to go home, and I could not but let him in and attend
+to him.</p>
+
+<p>'Yesterday, as no one knew we were here, I escaped at
+5.30 and made for the hot springs, twelve miles away. I
+walked there and back, and in consequence to-day am lame
+on my feet&mdash;badly blistered. I had a grand day&mdash;so quiet.
+Going, I sat down behind a mud wall and read the four
+first chapters of Hebrews. Arrived, I had my bath, then
+got an empty room in an inn, had sleep, dinner, tea, and
+read the rest of Hebrews. I never saw so much in Hebrews
+before.... On the road I had a four-mile conversation
+with a farmer, who finally said he believed Christianity was
+true. We have baptized six in all since I returned, five
+adults and one child&mdash;<i>all Chinese</i>. "Be not weary in well-doing.
+In due time we shall reap, if we faint not." We
+are on God's side. God has need of us. Oh let us be
+such as God can take pleasure in! Faithfulness and love
+to Him are what He wants. Surely we can let Him have
+these two. Oh that it might be that everyone in every
+contact with us might feel the spiritual touch! Would
+not this be ideal Christian life? May He work it in us!</p>
+
+<p>'Have you been to any Salvation Army efforts? I always
+felt better for going, but latterly did not go much&mdash;I could
+not stand the "row." I am eager that you should identify
+yourself with some soul-saving agency. If it really is a
+soul-saving concern, I don't think it matters very much
+what it is.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>On July 21, 1890, he wrote to the same friend:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_270" id="Page_270">[Pg 270]</a></span></p><blockquote><p>'Since July 3 we have had most extraordinary weather
+for this part&mdash;rain and dull; there have been only four or
+five days when I could go on to the street with my tent.
+I am therefore not so busy. In addition, Dr. Smith has
+joined me, and as he does all the indoor medical work, I am
+still less busy, and so I can write you more at leisure than
+usual.</p>
+
+<p>'The rain reached a climax on Saturday night, July 19.
+Till then, roofs and walls held out well. There were leaks
+in places, but nothing serious. We thought it had cleared
+off. Not a bit of it. The wind changed, it is true, but then
+rain came down in torrents, the ceilings&mdash;all reeds and
+paper&mdash;began to give way. Ever and anon splash came
+a bag of water, as the paper burst in different places, and
+Dr. Smith and I had a lively time of it shifting our boxes
+and bedding to dry spots. By dusk it was serious. I was
+just about my wits' end when a Chinaman put his head
+into my room, and said with a grin, half in jest, half in
+earnest, "There is a tent standing idle out in that room,
+why not put it up in your room?" The idea of putting up
+a tent in your bedroom seemed so absurd that we had a
+good laugh over it; but after thinking over it awhile, and
+thinking out how the thing could be done, we actually did
+it. It covered two-thirds of my kang, and a little space
+on the floor where I put my boxes. The inner corner of
+the tent I put up to cover my stock of books and medicines,
+lit my lamp, brewed a pot of tea, and, squatting on
+my feet, called in Dr. Smith. He said I looked "just like
+an opium-smoker." Dr. Smith had a portable iron bedstead.
+On the top he put floor mats and a waterproof,
+and, without undressing, we went to bed. After a little a
+great crash was heard. Some part of the buildings had
+come down. In the rain and dark it was not easy to see
+what it was, but we at last found there had been more
+noise than real damage. We were thankful when day
+dawned.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_271" id="Page_271">[Pg 271]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'The Chinese suffered much more than we did. Such
+a rain happens so seldom&mdash;once in three or four or five
+years&mdash;that houses are not roofed to resist it; the Chinese
+deeming it cheaper to take the wetting than to spend the
+extra money it would take to make the house stand such
+an extra rain.</p>
+
+<p>'In the wet weather I have been going into the
+Chinese Psalms, and have been much struck with the
+happy state of those who "fear the Lord," "trust in the
+Lord," and who, under a variety of expressions, are described
+as being on the Lord's side, and under His
+protection.</p>
+
+<p>'And all these promises we can take for ourselves.
+Did you see in <i>The Christian</i> some time ago a story from
+Annan, of an old woman who was on the point of being
+sold out for not paying her rent? She had no money.
+Her son was in America. A neighbour, thinking it strange
+that her son had not sent her money, asked to see her
+letters. There was one with a Post-office Order for 7<i>l.</i> 10<i>s.</i>
+in it. She had had it for some time, but thought it was only
+a picture. When cashed she was in funds. Wasn't she a
+stupid old woman? To be bankrupt, with an uncashed
+P.O. Order in her possession! How often we are much
+more stupid than she! To be fearful, anxious, troubled,
+cast down, when we have all the promises of God in our
+possession, ready for our use.</p>
+
+<p>'Let us cash our cheques. Nay, we have not only
+God's promises, but God Himself for our portion. Why
+should we be spiritually bankrupt?</p>
+
+<p>'Another thing I notice is the difference subjective
+states make in reading the Psalms. Sometimes I go over
+a Psalm and see little in it. At another time I go over
+the same Psalm and find it full of richness. How important
+it is to have the light of the Holy Spirit in our
+Scripture reading!'<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_272" id="Page_272">[Pg 272]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'<i>July 30.</i>&mdash;The little <i>Wordless Book</i> you sent soon fell
+into the hands of a Chinese convert, who asked to be allowed
+to carry it off. He wants to speak from it. He likes it
+because it gives him <i>carte blanche</i>, and lets him say just
+what he likes....</p>
+
+<p>'How full the Psalms are! These days I am going
+through them in Chinese, as I said; I take one each
+morning and commit some verses of it carefully. Then,
+during the day, as time permits, I read a few more. How
+one the soul of man is! When dull and cold and dead,
+and feeling as if I could not pray, I turn to the Psalms.
+When most in the spirit, the Psalms meet almost all the
+needs of expression. And yet deluded men talk of the
+Bible as the outcome of the Jewish mind! The greatest
+proof of the Divine source of the book is that it fits the
+soul as well as a Chubb's key fits the lock it was made
+for.... Now I am off to the street with my tent.'<br /><br /></p></blockquote>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Mongolia: July 28, 1890.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Meech,&mdash;Dr. Smith came here July 2. The
+rains set in immediately on his arrival, and we <i>have</i> had it
+since. The spiritual rain has not come yet, nor are there
+any signs of it. When it does come may it come like the
+physical rain! Glad to see you have been having some.
+May you have much more! Make the valley full of ditches,
+brother, and then look out for the flood. Do you think
+we'll be able to go up to Him at last and say, "We did our
+part, but you did not do yours, Lord"? Eh, man! Elijah
+called down fire with a short prayer, but his servant
+made six vain journeys to the summit only to return with
+the discouraging news&mdash;nothing. May the good Lord, who
+knows our frame and remembers we are dust, give us a little
+now and again, at any rate, if only to keep us going meantime!
+Eh, man! there will be no lack on His part. He'll<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_273" id="Page_273">[Pg 273]</a></span>
+shine up all right, not only to perform, but to succour His
+servants who trust in Him.'<br /><br /></p></blockquote>
+
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'July 28, 1890.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Owen,&mdash;I know worry should be an unknown
+element in a believer's experience. I am eager to have done
+with it. I thank Him for much of its absence. But dissatisfaction
+with the present state of things is not worry, but
+legitimate soul-longing, and the death of that would be a
+bad thing.</p>
+
+<p>'I can hardly tell how I am; Since Dr. Smith came I
+have taken little note of inward things or outward either.
+It is very pleasant to have him here, and as the best sign
+of digestion is not to know one has a stomach or a digestion,
+is the best sign of spiritual health not to know one has a
+soul at all? I wonder is this so? His presence has made
+a difference. Duty has kept me living quietly in good
+lodgings, with only such work as I can easily do without
+any over-rush, and the prospect of another month like it!
+I fear I am not such company to him as he is to me.</p>
+
+<p>'We have had terrible rains; the rivers were not crossed
+for five or six days, and, even after that, two men were
+swept away on two separate days&mdash;four men, in all, from
+this one town alone.</p>
+
+<p>'I know you pray for us here. Eh, man! if the thing
+would move, if the rain would come! "<i>As the eyes of
+servants</i>," etc. (Psalms cxxiii., cxxvi.). I often read these
+Psalms together. And then I think what would please me
+best as a master would be to see my servant going ahead,
+energetically, and faithfully, and loyally with his work, not
+moping about downcast. Then is not this what God wants
+in us? So here goes cheerily and trustfully.'<br /><br /></p></blockquote>
+
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'August 10, 1890.
+</p>
+
+<p>'I cannot say God gives me all the victories I want,
+but He keeps me in peace and faith, and that is not a little<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_274" id="Page_274">[Pg 274]</a></span>
+thing. My devotional reading lately has taken the form
+of the Chinese Psalms, and Schereschewsky's high Chinese
+notwithstanding (for which may he be forgiven), they are
+very refreshing and strong. How like are the heart-longings
+and soul-breathings of the old Judean hunted
+outlaw&mdash;brigand, if you like to call him so&mdash;to the heart
+and soul feelings of the educated Occidental of the nineteenth
+century! Poor old Moses, another outlaw, what
+a battered old life he led, but what a grand soul, and how
+wonderfully he outlived it all, and was quite hale when
+called to die! How his people troubled him!&mdash;so like the
+Chinese. Fancy Moses going up the mountain to die
+alone. It is so nice to have a later glimpse of him in the
+New Testament alongside of Elijah, who too was once
+under a cloud. God does not keep up things. "As far as
+the east is from the west, so far hath He removed our
+transgressions from us." Love to all.</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Ch'ao Yang, August 19, 1890.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Sons,&mdash;I have just got here after a very hard
+journey of four days. It is summer and the rains are on;
+the roads are very bad.</p>
+
+<p>'Our first adventure was in a deep narrow gully going
+up a mountain. We met a cart coming down. There
+was no room to pass and no room to turn back. What were
+we to do? One of the carts had to be pulled up the bank.
+Neither would go up. Both carters sat and looked at
+each other. Our cart was heavy, the other cart was light.
+After looking at each other awhile the other cart was
+pulled up and our carter helped him down again after we
+had passed.</p>
+
+<p>'Our next adventure was in a river. The leading mule
+sank in a quicksand. The carter, shoes and all, jumped<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_275" id="Page_275">[Pg 275]</a></span>
+into the water; in a few seconds I had stripped all but a
+cinglet and pants, and was in the river too. We got out
+after a little while.</p>
+
+<p>'Next day we stuck in a quagmire. We hitched the
+mules to the tail of the cart, pulled it out, then dug a new
+road in the side of the ravine and got past.</p>
+
+<p>'The third day we upset our cart in a very muddy place
+early in the morning, and got caught in a thunder-shower
+in the afternoon. The fourth day we stuck in a mud-hole
+half a mile from the end of our journey, and when we got
+to our inn found our rooms in possession of a crowd of
+people doing a wedding.</p>
+
+<p>'One thing made the journey very pleasant: it was this.
+Just as we were starting, one of the Christians, a Chinese
+farmer, but a man who is poor and dresses and eats very
+poorly, came and gave me two tiao, about 3<i>s.</i> 2<i>d.</i>, to give
+to God. I was so glad to see him do it, and no doubt God
+was glad too. Then at the end of the journey, when we
+were stuck in the mud-hole and could not get out, up came
+one of the Christians, took off his stockings and shoes,
+went into the mud and helped us out. The country was
+very beautiful all the way&mdash;just at its best.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In a letter to another correspondent he depicts what is
+involved in Chinese travelling during the wet season:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'The last thing we had to do was to make a journey of
+eighty miles. You would soon do that in England. Here,
+in August, it is no easy matter. It is just the time when,
+on account of the rains, no one should travel, and no one
+does travel who can help it. Carts would not go. I had
+to find my way home from a cart inn the night before we
+started along a newly rained-on muddy Chinese street in
+the dark. Next day I had much brightness shed on the
+journey by one of the Chinese Christians&mdash;a poor man with,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_276" id="Page_276">[Pg 276]</a></span>
+oh, so poor a coat&mdash;giving a donation to print Christian
+books. It amounted to about $1.00 (one dollar) in all, but
+it meant a lot of self-denial to him; and as I passed, a little
+later, the drought-parched district where he lived, and looked
+at the poor fields, I wondered where he got the money. I
+suppose God gave him the heart to give it. Starting a
+journey with such a bit of light made it cheery.</p>
+
+<p>'We travelled at those eighty miles four days, and
+rested one Sabbath, five days in all. Within three-quarters
+of a mile of the end of our journey our cart stuck in a mud-hole.
+We had passed, shortly before, the cottage of a Christian,
+and, after we had been some half-hour or more in that
+hole, this Christian suddenly appeared on the scene. He is a
+great fellow for being neat and clean. In a few moments he
+was in the mud, ordering about the carter, shouting at the
+mules, and lifting at the stern of the cart. Even the mules
+felt there was some new factor added to the problem. They
+made a new effort and out the cart came. Would you
+credit it? A cart had been upset there some days before;
+it was said they had lost some thirty shillings in silver. The
+natives, hoping to find the money, literally dug up the highway
+and left a pit there. We did not know this, thought it
+was an ordinary pool, and drove straight into it. The Christian
+touch at the beginning of the journey, and the little
+Christian adventure at the end, made the journey and its
+remembrance quite pleasant.</p>
+
+<p>'I am now reading Moule's <i>Veni Creator</i>, which came
+a few days ago. What helps me most just at present is
+the Psalms. I take a few verses every morning (almost),
+and learn off the Chinese translations of them. I never
+knew there was so much in the Psalms before. I believe
+that even at the end of a long life, this (discovery of more
+and more in God's Word) will hold true of all the Bible, and
+then for the beyond there is the Inexhaustible Himself&mdash;satisfaction
+for the present and plenty for the future.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_277" id="Page_277">[Pg 277]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'The endless sorrows and sufferings of this people here
+come home much to me. I see much of their bodily
+suffering, and in some feeble measure bear their sorrows and
+carry their griefs without being able to relieve them much.
+How dead and dark they are to things spiritual!'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Dr. Smith, who spent some weeks with Mr. Gilmour
+during this summer, has sent the following most interesting
+sketch of his daily life at this period. They were together
+for the most part at Tá Ss&#365; Kou.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'He always got up at daylight, folded up bedding, and
+then began reading. About six a man arrived, selling hot
+millet and bean porridge. He bought two bowls of this
+for early breakfast. He continued reading Chinese, generally
+aloud; and when he came to a difficult word he repeated
+it again and again, in order to impress it upon his
+memory. About eight he had breakfast, consisting of
+Chinese rolls and a cup of cocoa.</p>
+
+<p>'At nine he went to the street with his tent, Mr. Liu,
+the native preacher, accompanying him. One of the inn-servants
+assisted the latter in carrying tent and medicine
+boxes and in erecting same. The tent was erected in
+a broad street at the back of our inn, where a daily
+market was held. The medicine boxes were placed on
+a little table, in front of which stood a wooden form and
+another at the side. The patients were seated on these.
+Any difficult cases were sent to the inn to be treated
+by me. On the table were also a number of copies of
+various tracts and portions of Scripture. Mr. Gilmour
+dispensed medicines, talked and preached as the opportunity
+offered.</p>
+
+<p>'About one he returned to the inn, and had dinner, consisting
+of meat, etc., which was bought at a Chinese cook-shop.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_278" id="Page_278">[Pg 278]</a></span>
+About three we generally took a walk to the country.
+We used to go out to look at the various crops, and
+Mr. Gilmour would chat away to one and another whom we
+met on the road. He was generally recognised, and in the
+most friendly way. I have a very pleasant recollection of
+these times; often our conversation would turn to home, to
+our boys and friends. Sometimes he would tell me about
+his student friends, while at other times he used to tell me
+of his deputation work at home, and about the various
+people he had met there.</p>
+
+<p>'Often a gentleman would come up and ask, "Where are
+you going?" to which Mr. Gilmour would reply, "We are
+cooling ourselves; we are going nowhere." It was always
+a mystery to people what we could possibly mean by taking
+walks to the country. One day two lads followed us for
+some miles across some low hills, anxious to know our business,
+and getting well laughed at by their friends, poor
+fellows, on their return to the town.</p>
+
+<p>'One thing about Mr. Gilmour always impressed me
+deeply&mdash;his wonderful knowledge of the little touches of
+Chinese politeness, and his wonderful power of observation.
+He loved the Chinese&mdash;looked upon them and treated
+them as brothers, and was a man who lived much in prayer;
+and in this lay his great power as a missionary.</p>
+
+<p>'When he met a Mongol he would exchange a few
+words of Mongol with him, and it was wonderful to see
+the man's face light up as he heard his own tongue. All
+the Mongols knew that he could speak their language, and
+as one of the few who did.</p>
+
+<p>'As we returned to the town and were walking along
+the street, many of the passers-by would bow; and here and
+there a shopkeeper would give him a friendly bow. Sometimes
+he would buy a few peaches or apples, and not unfrequently
+he would give a sweetmeat vendor two cash
+for two sweets, handing one to me.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_279" id="Page_279">[Pg 279]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'About half-past four we returned to the inn, and then,
+as a rule, some people would be there waiting to see him.
+Mr. Sun, the box-maker, used often to come to read the
+Scriptures with Mr. Gilmour, and then they would discuss
+various points; Mr. Sun giving his opinion, and then Mr.
+Gilmour putting him right. Sometimes an outsider would
+drop in, and then, not unfrequently, Mr. Sun would talk to
+him about the Gospel.</p>
+
+<p>'About six Mr. Gilmour had some cocoa and bread.
+At the time of the lighting of the candles Mr. Gilmour had
+made it a rule for the Christians to assemble for evening
+prayers, and, accordingly, they all turned up then. A
+Chinese table was placed in the centre of Mr. Gilmour's
+room, and three wooden forms were placed round the table
+for the accommodation of the preacher and the Christians.
+Mr. Gilmour and I used to sit on chairs at the vacant side
+of the table. On the table stood two Chinese candlesticks,
+each surmounted by a Chinese candle. A Chinese
+candle is made from the castor bean, and is fixed to the
+candlestick by running the iron pin on the latter into a
+hollow straw in the end of the candle. Then we also had
+a Chinese oil lamp. The upper vessel is simply a little
+earthenware saucer, containing a little oil, and in it lie some
+threads of cotton (a cotton wick). This is made to project
+over the edge of the saucer and is then lighted. The lower
+part of the lamp is simply an earthenware receptacle, in
+which the oil for replenishing the lamp is kept, and, while
+in use, the little lamp is supported in it. This often used
+to remind me of the parable of the virgins, and in reading
+that parable by the light of such a lamp one is able to
+make it very realistic to Chinamen.</p>
+
+<p>'Our evening worship consisted in first singing a hymn,
+Mr. Gilmour leading. Then Mr. Gilmour offered up a
+short prayer; after which we read a chapter either in the
+Old or New Testament, reading verse about. Each man<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_280" id="Page_280">[Pg 280]</a></span>
+had a copy of the Scriptures. Then Mr. Gilmour gave a
+little address on the chapter; after which we had another
+prayer&mdash;one of the Christians being asked this time. Then
+another hymn and the benediction.</p>
+
+<p>'Usually one or more of the Christians would remain
+chatting with Mr. Gilmour. As soon as they had gone we
+had a cup of cocoa together. Then Mr. Gilmour and I
+used to have evening prayers together. He used to read a
+chapter from a little book by Mr. Moule, and then we both
+prayed.</p>
+
+<p>'After this we used to sit chatting together until bedtime,
+and so ended a day.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In August 1890 Dr. Smith lost his wife, who as Miss
+Philip had become known and beloved by a large number
+of friends of the London Missionary Society, both in Great
+Britain and Australia. He had also become so ill that the
+ensuing weakness, together with the great shock of his
+wife's sudden loss, compelled him, early in 1891, to return
+to England on a visit. Before doing so he was able to
+take Mr. Parker, the young and active colleague appointed
+to assist Mr. Gilmour, out to Mongolia, reaching Tá Ss&#365;
+Kou on December 5. Greatly encouraged by the arrival
+of his young helper, Mr. Gilmour was grievously disappointed
+by the enforced return of Dr. Smith, and the
+indefinite postponement of the hospital scheme that was so
+near to his heart, and upon which he always asserted, in
+his judgment, the ultimate success of the mission depended.
+But discipline of this kind only drove him back more
+entirely upon God. In a letter to Mr. Owen, dated
+December 29, 1890, he writes:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_281" id="Page_281">[Pg 281]</a></span></p><blockquote><p>About myself I have lots to be thankful for. I am
+mostly in the light, sometimes very sweetly. Sometimes,
+though, it is cold and dark; but I just hold on, and it is all
+right. Romans viii. I find good reading in dull spiritual
+weather, and the Psalms too are useful. When I feel I
+cannot make headway in devotion, I open at the Psalms
+and push out in my canoe, and let myself be carried along
+in the stream of devotion which flows through the whole
+book. The current always sets towards God, and in most
+places is strong and deep. These old men&mdash;eh, man! they
+beat us hollow, with all our New Testament and all our
+devotional aids and manuals. And yet I don't know. In
+the old time there were giants&mdash;one here and there. Now
+there are many nameless but efficient men of only ordinary
+stature.</p>
+
+<p>'Brother, let us be faithful. That is what God wants.
+What He needs. What He can use. I was greatly struck
+by one saying of Mrs. Booth's. It will not be so very
+different there (in heaven) to what it is here. I guess she
+is right. I guess there will be differences of occupation
+there as here, and I guess that our life here is a training
+for life and work there. Oh the mystery! How thin a
+wall divides it from us! How well the secret has been
+kept from of old till now! May the richest blessings be on
+you and yours and your work!</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Yours affectionately&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;,<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour</span>.'&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The year 1891 found Mr. Gilmour hard at work as
+usual, in good health and spirits, and with the hope and
+apparently the prospect of many years of service before
+him. And yet, just as the summer was beginning, he
+was called to the presence of the King, and to the perfect
+work and fellowship of 'the Church of the firstborn.'
+Had he been able to choose his fate he would hardly have<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_282" id="Page_282">[Pg 282]</a></span>
+wished it other than it was. His work in Mongolia was
+steadily growing; slowly, it is true, but yet gaining a
+strength and impetus that will abide, and has well begun
+the conquest of Mongolia for Christ. Though practically
+without a medical colleague, and actually without the
+hospital for which he had so toiled and prayed, he was
+cheered and strengthened by the constant presence and
+fellowship of Mr. Parker. His letters are all in a cheery
+and buoyant strain, and, although referring not unfrequently
+to the future life, without a hint or a suspicion
+that he was in any degree conscious of the rapid way in
+which the days of his earthly life were running out. In a
+letter to Mr. Thompson, dated January 7, he says, 'You
+will be glad to hear I am in good health and spirits.'</p>
+
+
+<p>To Mr. Owen he wrote on March 2:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Does God not mean to have a medical man here? I
+wonder! Wondering, I tell Him as I tell you, and try to
+leave it with Him, and in very great part <i>do</i> leave it to
+Him too. It is good to have His calm mercy and help.
+How's your soul, brother? I'll tell you how mine is&mdash;eager
+to experience more of the Almighty power inworking
+inside. Eager to be more transformed. Less conformed
+to the world. Eager to touch God more, and have Him
+touch me more, so that I can feel His touch.</p>
+
+<p>'I am distressed at so few conversions here. But again
+sometimes very fully satisfied in believing I am trying to
+do His will. That makes me calm. I am scared at our
+property venture, but again trust in God, and the fears
+subside. The world to come, too, sometimes looms up
+clear as not far distant, and the light that shines from
+that makes things seem different a good deal.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_283" id="Page_283">[Pg 283]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>From other letters that remain we catch glimpses of
+the course of his action and thought during these last
+weeks. During the year 1869 he met in Edinburgh Mrs.
+Swan, the widow of one of the pioneers of the Mongol
+Mission of 1817 to 1841, and that interview gave the chief
+direction to the work of his life. In March 1891 he heard
+of Mrs. Swan's death, and he wrote to Miss Cullen, her
+niece, the following letter:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'I sent you a post-card acknowledging receipt of your
+kind letter of December 10, saying that Mrs. Swan had
+passed away on November 22. I had not heard, and just
+then I had not time to write. I am now at the east end
+of my district, three days' journey from where the mail
+reached me.</p>
+
+<p>'I am much moved to think that letter to me was her
+last. And there is a fitness that it should be so. "Baptized
+for the dead," as the phrase is. In some sense I am successor
+to her work, and it was not out of keeping that her
+last letter should have been to the field which all along
+had such a large place and keen interest in her heart,
+where so many more good works found a place. I often
+think of all the kindness and friendship I have experienced
+at her hands, both on my visits to Edinburgh and through
+letters. Missionaries miss such lives much when they are
+removed. I need not speak to you, who knew her so well,
+of what a charming hostess she made, and of how, even in
+her old age, all her great and abiding earnestness had running
+through it all so much happy Scotch humour.</p>
+
+<p>'I had no idea Mrs. Swan was so old. Eighty-one, she
+did not look old except about the last time I saw her, and
+then I had no idea her age was so great. She has gone; but
+for many years to come, if I am spared, I shall from time
+to time revisit her in her house in Edinburgh, and see her at<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_284" id="Page_284">[Pg 284]</a></span>
+the table with the quiet Jane moving noiselessly around, or
+see her seated at her desk in the corner, writing letters. Remember
+me very kindly to your father&mdash;fit brother for such
+a sister. Their separation cannot be very long at the
+longest. For that matter of it, those of us who are here
+longest must soon be gone, and when the going comes, or
+looms before us, let us look not at the going, but at the
+being <i>there</i>.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Having paid considerable attention to the work and
+methods of the Salvation Army, the publication of <i>In
+Darkest England</i> interested him greatly, and on March 9
+he sent in a letter the following trenchant criticism, all the
+more noteworthy because of his strong sympathy with much
+in the Army that others find it hard to accept.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Got here Saturday. Had a good Sunday with the
+Christians. To-day it snowed, and thus we have had time
+to put our house in order. I have read Booth's scheme in
+the <i>Review of Reviews</i>. I am greatly puzzled. It is <i>so</i> far
+a departure from Booth's principle of doing spiritual work
+only. It reads well, but Booth must know just as well as
+I do that much of the theory will never work in practice.
+What I dislike most in it is, it is in spiritual things doing
+exactly what it attempts to do in secular things&mdash;namely, it
+threatens to swallow up in a great holy syndicate no end
+of smaller charities which have been and are working
+efficiently. Again, the finally impenitent are to be cast off.
+Yes, that is just the rub. It will leave the good-for-nothings,
+many of them cast out as before. Nor will Booth's
+despotism do in the long run. But I am for the scheme
+and for old Booth too; but, nevertheless, there is both a
+limit and an end to all despotism and despotisms. But I
+am more favourable to the scheme than these words would
+seem to indicate.'</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_285" id="Page_285">[Pg 285]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Mr. Parker, who bids fair to be a successor after Gilmour's
+own heart, in his first report of his experiences in
+Mongolia gave a bright and hopeful view of his colleague.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'On arriving at Tá Ss&#365; Kou we found Gilmour very
+well indeed; looking better than he did when I saw him in
+England. He was jubilant over our coming, and it has
+been a great source of happiness to me to know that God's
+sending me here has up till now given happiness and comfort
+to one of His faithful servants. I have had a slight
+taste of being left alone, and I must confess Gilmour has
+had something to endure during the last few years.</p>
+
+<p>'We are living in hired rooms of an inn. Gilmour is
+not in this courtyard. I have been alone here with my
+Chinese boy for the last five weeks (Dr. Smith being in
+Ch'ao Yang until a few days ago). I have been unable to
+get a proper teacher at present. Gilmour's student has
+been teaching me. He speaks distinctly. With him I
+have made very fair progress. I hope in a few days to
+secure a proper teacher.</p>
+
+<p>'Another thing which has taught me a good amount of
+the Chinese I know is having to give orders to my Chinese
+boy in house-keeping generally. I am thankful to God for
+past experiences in my life, though they were rather rough;
+for here I find they come in very usefully. I had to teach
+my boy how to cook and do things generally. It was
+rather an amusing piece of work, seeing that I knew nothing
+of the language. Each order I gave him was a comedy in
+two or three acts, all played out in dumb show. In telling
+him what I wished purchased I was obliged to imitate
+sounds which are peculiar to certain beasts and birds,
+which when he understood, he announced that fact by
+opening wide his eyes and emitting a loud "Ah!" which
+was generally followed by the name of the thing indicated
+bellowed forth at the top of his voice as if I were deaf.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_286" id="Page_286">[Pg 286]</a></span>
+Also he in turn, when he had anything to tell me, always
+stood in the centre of the room and went through a whole
+performance. On one occasion, when he wished to tell me
+that a certain dog had stolen the day's meat, the performance
+was so amusing that, when he had got through, I asked
+him what he was trying to say, in order that I might once
+more see the fun.</p>
+
+<p>'Forgive me for taking up your time with such frivolous
+things. But I have picked up much of the language in
+that way, although at the cost of being grimed with soot
+and burning my fingers. All that is now past, and the boy
+is very useful, and, although now a heathen, I am hoping that
+by my influence he may be led to know the love of Jesus
+Christ. I am very glad that I came straight out here. I am
+sure I shall learn the language (of the <i>people</i>, perhaps <i>not</i>
+of the <i>books</i>) better than in the frontier cities. I am constantly
+forced to try and speak. Every day I have some
+visitors here whom I must try and entertain. I feel stupid
+at times with them, and perhaps they think I am; but,
+nevertheless, each day's experience is adding to my vocabulary.
+And when so learnt, I know that people will
+understand me when I speak.</p>
+
+<p>'Gilmour is doing a valuable work. Every day he goes
+to the street and sets out his table with his boxes of medicines
+and books. He has three narrow benches, on one of
+which he sits, the other two being for his patients. Of the
+latter he has any amount, coming with all the ills to which
+humanity is heir. It is a busy street, not of the best
+repute, for it is where all the traders in second-hand clothes
+and dealers in marine stores spread out their wares.</p>
+
+<p>'For some weeks I went out at a certain hour to take
+care of Gilmour's stand while he went and got a "refresher"
+in the shape of some indigestible pudding made
+of millet-flour with beans for plums. He generally left me
+with a patient or two requiring some lotion in the eye<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_287" id="Page_287">[Pg 287]</a></span>
+or some wound to dress. Then I, being a new-comer
+and a typical "foreign devil" (being red of hair and in
+complexion), always brought a large following down the
+street with me, and attracted a great crowd round the
+stand. At first it was not pleasant to sit there and be
+stared at without being able to speak to them; but after a
+while I got very interested in the different faces that came
+round. On one occasion I noticed the crowd eagerly discussing
+something among themselves, giving me a scrutinising
+look now and then. Now and again one would turn
+to his fellow and rub his finger across his upper lip as if he
+was feeling for his moustache. I had only been here a
+week or so then, and knew very little of the language; but I
+listened attentively, and at last I heard them speaking the
+Chinese numerals, and then it all dawned upon me that
+they were inquiring about and discussing my age; so I up
+with my fingers indicating the years of my pilgrimage. I
+never saw a crowd so amused. "Ah, ah!" they said, and
+opened their eyes, highly delighted that I was able to tell
+them what they wanted to know. Then I had my turn,
+and, pointing to a man here and there in the crowd, I used
+what little of Chinese I had in guessing their ages.</p>
+
+<p>'But the sights of misery, suffering, and wretchedness
+which gather round Gilmour's stand are simply appalling.
+His work seems to me to come nearest to Christ's own way
+of blessing men. Healing them of their wounds, giving
+comfort in sickness, and at the same time telling them the
+gospel of Eternal Salvation through Jesus Christ. One
+day that I went I found Gilmour tying a bandage on a
+poor beggar's knee. The beggar was a boy about sixteen
+years of age, entirely naked, with the exception of a piece of
+sacking for a loin cloth. He had been creeping about,
+almost frozen with cold, and a dog (who, no doubt, thought
+he was simply an animated bone) had attacked him.</p>
+
+<p>'The people here are desperately poor, and the misery<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_288" id="Page_288">[Pg 288]</a></span>
+and suffering one sees crawling through the streets every
+day is heart-rending. I have not a doubt that I am in a
+real mission field, and thank God that He has given me the
+opportunity to do something towards alleviating some of
+this misery. But what about the work as regards the
+saving of souls and establishing of a Church? I can only
+speak of the work in Tá Ss&#365; Kou. It is in its initiatory
+stage. All the Christians and adherents can sit round the
+four sides of my table. But I am highly pleased with
+them.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The letters of this period have a very tender and sacred
+association for all who received them, since they reached
+England after the telegraphic tidings of James Gilmour's
+death had brought sorrow to his many friends. They
+came, in a sense, like a message from one 'within the
+veil.' Some of these refer to the books he was reading,
+and from which he had derived benefit; some depict phases
+of his experience; some bear directly upon his work and
+its needs; all possess the solemn value and are read in the
+clearer light imparted to them by Death.</p>
+
+<p>The first was written to one of his brothers.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Do you know <i>In the Volume of the Book</i>, by Dr. Pentecost?
+It is A 1. I have just read it. It is not a dear
+book. Read it, man, by all means. It gives zest to the
+old Bible. I am reading through the New Testament at
+about the rate of a gospel a day, or two epistles. Rapid
+reading has advantages. Close study of minute portions
+has other advantages. All sorts of reading are valuable.
+Go for your Bible, brother. There is no end more in it
+than ever you or I have yet seen. I am going for it both in
+Chinese and English, and it pays as nothing else does. In
+Jesus is all <i>fulness</i>. Supply yourself from Him. May the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_289" id="Page_289">[Pg 289]</a></span>
+richest blessings be on you from Him! Heaven's ahead,
+brother. Hurrah!'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The next was to the Edinburgh correspondent from
+whose letters we have previously taken extracts.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'This mail was sent off February 2. It came back
+the same day. The man was scared by robbers. He
+leaves to-morrow. We are well. We are <i>idle</i>. Would
+you believe it? It is Chinese New Year time, and
+I cannot go on the street with my stand. No people:
+soon will be. We are thankful for the rest. It won't
+last long.... Oh, it is good to have Jesus to tell
+all to. May He be more of an intimate friend to you and
+to me! The troubles of this earthly life are not few. How
+many were Paul's! I am reading Farrar's <i>Life and Work
+of Paul</i>. It puts much new light on the epistles. What a
+time the man Paul had of it! Yet he called them "light
+afflictions." How much lighter are ours! And the same
+heaven he looked to is for us&mdash;the same crown&mdash;not to him
+only, but to all who love the appearing of Christ. You
+love Him. Rejoice and be glad. I <i>am</i> so glad that the
+crown is not only for such as Paul, whom we cannot
+hope to imitate, but for those (ii. Timothy iv. 8) who have
+loved His appearing. We <i>do</i> that, don't we? May the
+joy set before us enable us to endure, when endurance is
+needed! May your heart rest in Him! May your soul
+cling to Him! May His light always shine on your path!
+May I always, even in dark days and dark times, have His
+light in my heart and soul! Don't regard me as one
+always on the sunny heights, but as one often cast down,
+often in much feebleness, in much unworthiness, and falling
+so far short of my own ideal. But it is good to think that,
+in Christ, we are perfect, that He makes up all.</p>
+
+<p>'Parker and I read <i>Holy of Holies</i>, when together. It is<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_290" id="Page_290">[Pg 290]</a></span>
+a good book. Meantime, he and I are three days' journey
+separate, and may be so for a month to come yet. I hope
+he likes it. It is a little hard on him, but I had to come
+here on mission business, and, if needed, will return to him
+at any time. Looking again at Heb. vi. 4-6.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>His correspondent had asked him about this passage.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'It is said&mdash;it is impossible to "renew them again to
+repentance." Does it not seem clear that what is described
+cannot be the case of one who has the repentant heart? I
+think so decidedly, and that passage has no bearing on the
+sinner who repents.... No one will come to harm who
+commits himself to His keeping. And no one will lack
+leading who has God for his guide. If I could only hear
+of or from the friends I pray for, that they had given
+themselves over to God's keeping, I would be at rest and
+thankful. You are trusting in Him. You will not be
+ashamed. He will take care to supply every needed
+blessing at the right time and in the right way.</p>
+
+<p>'Some day, I believe we shall stand in Eternity and
+look back on Time. How ashamed we then shall be of
+any want of trust and of any unfaithfulness! May He
+help us to look at things now in <i>that</i> light, and how to do
+as we then shall wish we had done!...</p>
+
+<p>'I would be glad if you would send me half a dozen
+copies of the <i>Wordless Book</i>. Two copies fell into the
+hands of robbers and were thus lost....</p>
+
+<p>'I shall be glad to have the <i>Life of Faith</i>. You might
+mark any passages that strike you.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In a letter to the Rev. J. Paterson, dated April 1,
+he writes:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'It helps me much out here to get the best consecrated
+literature, and to get it early. Men in the most difficult
+and dangerous fields should be the best armed and equipped.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_291" id="Page_291">[Pg 291]</a></span>
+Some of these books open up new treasures to me in God's
+Word. I do not use them in place of God's Word, but as
+openers to the treasures.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In almost the last letter from him received by his
+brother Alexander and dated April 24, 1891, the following
+passage occurs:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'<i>The Practice of the Presence of God</i>, being conversations
+and letters of Brother Lawrence. Please send a copy to
+yourself, John, Matthew, Paterson, Miss Gowan, and ten
+copies to me, charging all costs to me, of course. It is by
+a Roman Catholic: don't imitate his Roman Catholicism,
+but his practice of the presence of God.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In April Mr. Gilmour journeyed to Tientsin, and was
+unanimously elected to preside over the annual meeting of
+the North China District Committee of the London Missionary
+Society as chairman. His last communication to
+the home Society, with the exception of one brief note upon
+a matter of committee business, was a post-card, dated
+April 20, 1891, received in London some weeks after the
+tidings of his death. It runs:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Arrived here yesterday. The world keeps shrinking.
+Left Tá Ss&#365; Kou Monday 8 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span> Tuesday noon dined
+in a border Mongol village, in a Mongol's inn, served by a
+Mongol waiter, in presence of a number of Mongols. Got
+to London Missionary Society's Compound, Tientsin,
+Saturday, 5 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> Our headquarters are just five days
+from the extended railway. Am in A 1 health, everybody
+says so here, and that truly. Meantime am in clover,
+physically and spiritually. With prayers for the home end
+of the London Missionary Society's work.</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Yours truly,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">J. Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_292" id="Page_292">[Pg 292]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Just thirty-one days later he was lying dead in the
+same compound. How the interval passed is told by those
+who enjoyed those closing days of lofty spiritual fellowship.
+Had it been foreseen that the end was so near, the
+fervour and impressiveness and help of his presence could
+hardly have been increased. Before, however, passing to
+the details of this last month, the following letters are
+given <i>in extenso</i> as they form the last lengthy sketches of
+his work drawn by his own hand.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Tientsin, L.M.S.: April 20, 1891.
+</p>
+
+<p>My dear Mrs. Lovett,&mdash;I guess you are at the bottom
+of 10<i>l.</i> from Clapham Congregational Church Working
+Society (Ladies). Ar'n't you? If so, thanks. If not&mdash;I
+was going to say you ought to be&mdash;but my courage fails
+me. Anyhow, you can read and please forward the enclosed
+with my best thanks to the friends. I got here two
+days ago, and am here for a short time. The railway has
+gone out eastwards, is still going, and has now a station
+near me in Mongolia&mdash;near me being five long days'
+journey; but that is near, as near and far go here.</p>
+
+<p>'I have many grateful and many prayerful remembrances
+of England and English friends, and a vivid
+remembrance of your kindness when I was with you. My
+regards to your parents. I hope you and your husband
+and children are all well. I heard of Mr. Lovett being
+in America&mdash;<i>American Pictures</i> on the stocks?</p>
+
+<p>'I had intended to write you a nice letter, but it won't
+come, and the letter must go as it is. Please read into the
+remaining blank sheet all the feelings and good wishes I
+should express and do feel, and next time I write you, may
+it not be in the ebb tide, at the end of a mail.</p>
+
+<p>'Your husband's a Director. I <i>do</i> hope they are sending<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_293" id="Page_293">[Pg 293]</a></span>
+me a doctor. If he can do anything in the matter, I wish
+he would.</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Yours, dried up and feeling dumb,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Enclosed in the above was the following letter, dated
+March 10, and addressed to 'The Clapham Congregational
+Church Ladies' Working Society.'</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Dear Friends,&mdash;Many thanks for your handsome
+donation (10<i>l.</i>), notice of which has reached me last night.
+I am told you want to hear from me. All right. I am
+just back from a month's raid into Ch'ao Yang. Had a fine
+time. Good weather and plenty of work in the marketplace.
+Baptized four adults, three being women&mdash;all
+Chinese. It is the day of small things truly, but I am not
+a little encouraged, over the women especially. That now
+makes four Christian families in Ch'ao Yang or its immediate
+neighbourhood. The two wives baptized this time
+have Christian husbands. It has all along been our prayer
+that the unsaved relatives of the saved might be saved.</p>
+
+<p>'Mrs. Chu's husband was baptized a couple of years
+ago. She consented to his taking their two children to me
+to be baptized, but she herself would have nothing to do
+with Christianity or Christ. This time she got over her
+difficulties. I was much pleased, especially as she had
+annoyed her husband a good deal last year about his
+having been beaten about his Christianity. She also had
+her little child baptized. Pray that God may keep and
+help them in all the many complications that will arise on
+account of their Christianity, living as they do in a composite
+family, the ruling powers of which are heathen.</p>
+
+<p>'Mrs. Ning is a model wife. They are poor. Her
+husband cannot dress in good clothes, but is always as<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_294" id="Page_294">[Pg 294]</a></span>
+neat as a virtuous wife, skilful with her needle, can make
+him. She mends so neatly. I once discarded a vest
+(Chinese) and gave it to her husband. He took it home,
+and later on I saw him swelling about in it quite like a
+neat old gentleman, though I was almost ashamed to give
+it him.</p>
+
+<p>'They have had family worship in their home for a
+year or two&mdash;they say. We went to baptize her. It was
+such a small, poor house, but so very nice inside. Mother
+and grown daughters and little girl, with father and grown
+son, all sleep on a little brick platform, hardly big enough
+for me&mdash;one man. She and the grown daughter support
+the family by needlework&mdash;making horsehair women's
+head fittings, which the father sells, when he has nothing
+more to do.</p>
+
+<p>'The son is epileptic and can earn nothing, and is, in
+addition, a great eater. He is a good man and a Christian.
+As we entered, the son and daughter went out. The
+mother and little daughter were baptized. The father did
+not wish his big daughter baptized. When she is married
+she will get a heathen mother-in-law, who will go for her
+and make her worship idols. So said the father. In a
+few days the father came back, saying that out of fear of
+the coming mother-in-law he had not had his daughter
+baptized, but that his daughter had pressed him so hard
+that she was as formidable as the mother-in-law. The
+daughter says she'll stick to her God and let them stick to
+theirs, and so she was baptized. She has a hot time before
+her. Chinese mothers-in-law are no joke. Pray for the
+lassie that:&mdash;(<i>a</i>) she may be steadfast; (<i>b</i>) she may be
+wise; (<i>c</i>) she may be gentle in her resistance; (<i>d</i>) enabled
+by God to endure; and that the mother-in-law may be
+restrained. God can do all things.</p>
+
+<p>'Here, in Tá Ss&#365; Kou, two of the Christians have wives<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_295" id="Page_295">[Pg 295]</a></span>
+very much opposed to Christianity, and give their husbands
+hot times. Remember the husbands, please, and all such
+in their shoes, in prayer, and may the darkened women
+themselves be enlightened. You have no notion how
+deeply sunk in superstition the women are. Still another
+Christian has a wife whom he has to allow to worship a
+weasel, because the woman shows symptoms of being
+possessed by the beast if she does not worship it!</p>
+
+<p>'The other day a woman came to my stand in the
+market-place, saying that "Mr. Yellow" troubled her.
+"Mr. Yellow" turned out to be the weasel, and she firmly
+believed her sickness was due to the beast.</p>
+
+<p>'We are badly in want of a lady medical man in this
+district. Don't you know of one who would do? Are
+there none of you who could study medicine and go out
+as doctors to some of the many needy places? Much was
+hoped for this district from the late Mrs. Smith, but God
+took her. Any one who comes here should have good
+health, and not fear seclusion from foreign company. I
+would suggest that a couple should come, a medical and
+a non-medical. There is a house which could be got for such
+a couple, only I don't see how they could get on without
+knowing some Chinese. Perhaps some one of the Peking
+or Tientsin ladies already speaking Chinese would volunteer
+to be a medical lady's companion. Would that God
+would stir some of you up! Meantime, thanks for the
+money. Thanks also for the prayers which I take for
+granted you let us have. You might also pray for a
+woman who has a very good, quiet, Christian husband, but
+herself has such a temper that she cannot in decency take
+on a Christian profession. Eh, man! eh, man! it is curious
+that I, a widower, should be left to look after women's
+souls out here, when lots of women are competing for
+men's situations and businesses at home. I guess things<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_296" id="Page_296">[Pg 296]</a></span>
+will come right some day, though I may or may not
+see it.</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Very gratefully,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'Yours sincerely,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'<br />
+</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>On May 8 he sent the following note to Mrs. Williams,
+the wife of the Rev. Mark Williams of the American
+Board. Their Society happened to be holding its annual
+meeting at the same time in Tientsin as the London
+Society. Mr. Gilmour was just entering his fatal illness
+as he penned these lines, the last, we believe, that he
+wrote. They are a beautiful testimony to the strength of
+his affection for the Mongols to whom he and his wife had
+ministered so well long before, and on whose behalf they
+had suffered so much and so deeply. Standing as he was
+on the borderland of the heavenly country, he recalls the
+hard toil of his early days, and he leaves to those who
+must carry on to a successful issue, not only his work, but
+also the great enterprise of winning all China for Jesus
+Christ, this as a last legacy&mdash;the fruit of his prayer, his
+faith, his toil and his utter self-sacrifice&mdash;namely, the
+conviction that the need of China is 'good, honest, quiet,
+earnest, persistent work in old lines and ways.'</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Tientsin: May 8, Friday.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Mrs. Williams,&mdash;Thanks for returning the
+photos. Not having delivered them to you personally, I
+feared that in the present whirl of people and business
+they might have been mislaid, or even not reached you.</p>
+
+<p>'It is a great pleasure to see you here at this time.
+Many memories of past times and days come up. Though
+never again likely to see Kalgan, I often in thought go<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_297" id="Page_297">[Pg 297]</a></span>
+along its narrow, hard streets, and its up and down sideways,
+call in at your house, see all your faces, even that of
+the youthful Stephen, and the studious Etta; and often go
+up over the Pass into the grass land.</p>
+
+<p>'It is like a rest for a little while beside the palms and
+wells of Elim to meet you all here.</p>
+
+<p>'Your peaceful, happy family fills me with gratitude to
+God. May He bless them all (your children), and lead
+them not only into paths of peace and pleasantness, but of
+useful service for Him! You and your husband seem well.
+May many useful years of ripely experienced labour be
+yours!</p>
+
+<p>'Lately, I am being more and more impressed with the
+idea that what is wanted in China is not new "lightning"
+methods so much as good, honest, quiet, earnest, persistent
+work in old lines and ways.</p>
+
+<p>'With many grateful memories of all old-time Kalgan
+kindness, and hoping to see a note from you, or Mr.
+Williams, say once a year or so, and with prayers for you
+and all Kalgan-wards Mongols,</p>
+
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Yours, cheered by the vision of you all,&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;<br />
+'<span class="smcap">James Gilmour.</span>'&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;
+</p></blockquote><p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_298" id="Page_298">[Pg 298]</a></span></p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XII" id="CHAPTER_XII"></a>CHAPTER XII</h2>
+
+<h3>THE LAST DAYS</h3>
+
+
+<p>At Tientsin James Gilmour was the guest of Dr.
+Roberts&mdash;for too brief a time his colleague in Mongolia&mdash;and
+the doctor's sister, who kept house for him. The
+story of the closing days cannot be better told than in
+their words. To Miss Roberts fell the sorrowful task of
+sending the news of their irreparable bereavement to the
+two motherless lads in England.</p>
+
+<blockquote>
+<p style="text-align: right">
+'Tientsin: June 6, 1891.
+</p>
+
+<p>'My dear Willie and Jimmie,&mdash;You will wonder who I
+am that call you by your names and yet have never known
+you.</p>
+
+<p>'But I think, when you hear that your dear father spent
+the last five weeks of his life with my brother, Dr. Roberts,
+and myself, perhaps you will not be sorry to get a few lines
+from an unknown friend. It is now many weeks since we
+received a letter from Mr. Gilmour saying he hoped to be
+able to attend the annual meetings in Tientsin, and who
+would take him in? My brother replied at once, saying
+what a real pleasure it would be if he would stay with us.
+And so he came, and about a fortnight before the time, of
+which we were all the more glad. He looked the very
+picture of health on his arrival, and was in excellent spirits;
+many remarked how very well and strong he looked.</p>
+
+<p>'I remember well the day he arrived, it was a Saturday<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_299" id="Page_299">[Pg 299]</a></span>
+afternoon. I suggested that he should have some dinner
+at once, but, thoughtful-like, as your father always was, he
+said, "No, thank you, I have already had all I want; I shall
+not require anything more till your next ordinary meal."</p>
+
+<p>'By-and-by we showed him his room, "whose windows
+opened to the sun-rising." We had made it as pretty and
+comfortable as we could, and brightened it with freshly
+cut flowers. The next day I noticed he had taken the
+tablecloth off his writing-table, and in the evening he
+handed it to me, saying, if I remember rightly, "Here,
+mademoiselle, is your tablecloth. I am afraid of inking it.
+You had better put it away." I was grieved, and begged
+he would use, and ink it, too, for the matter of that; but
+it was no use, not on any account would he spoil my cloth,
+and therefore would not use it.</p>
+
+<p>'He seemed very happy with us, and I think thoroughly
+appreciated the homelikeness of his surroundings after his
+lonely life in Mongolia, and the dismal rooms of a Chinese
+inn, and it was such a pleasure to minister to his comforts
+in every possible way we could think of.</p>
+
+<p>'He used to spend his days, as a rule, in the following
+way:&mdash;</p>
+
+<p>'After breakfast he would write letters. At 10.45,
+after a cup of cocoa, he would go over to the hospital,
+returning at 1 o'clock to dinner. This over, he would go
+back with my brother to see the in-patients. At 4.30 we
+would all have tea together, after which he would make
+calls, or go for a walk, or talk over committee matters with
+Mr. Lees or Mr. Bryson. Many evenings he would be
+invited out, or would be at a meeting, or would spend it
+quietly at home; and so the time went by till meetings
+began. Then the whole day till 4 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span> was spent in committee,
+and at six Mr. Gilmour had a Bible-class for an
+hour with the Chinese preachers who had come to attend
+some of the meetings.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_300" id="Page_300">[Pg 300]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>'These were nearly over when your father began to
+complain of feeling done up and of having fever. The
+following Sunday he was in bed. This was only eleven
+days before he died. On Monday, however, he was better.
+and up, and was able to be with us all day, and took the
+Communion with us all in the evening. Then we chatted
+together for some time and sang hymns, amongst others,
+"God be with you till we meet again!" No. 494 in Sankey's
+<i>Songs and Solos</i>.</p>
+
+<p>'In this connection let me tell you some of Mr.
+Gilmour's favourite hymns in the book just mentioned.
+Amongst these were Nos. 494, 535, 150, 328. I dare say
+you would like to learn them and sing them for his sake.</p>
+
+<p>'Your dear father was only in bed ten days before the
+end came, and all this time he spoke but little. He was
+too feverish and ill to want to talk or to listen: he just lay
+quietly, bearing his sickness with remarkable patience. One
+day, observing he was a little restless, I went to his bedside
+and asked him if he wanted anything. "No, nothing,"
+was his reply, "only that the Lord would deliver me out of
+this distress."</p>
+
+<p>'The last few days his mind was not clear, but all his
+wanderings were about his work. It was the last day but
+one of his life; he was more restless than usual, trying all
+the time to rouse himself, as if for a journey, when he
+looked up and said, "Where are we going?"</p>
+
+<p>'"To heaven," I answered, "to see the Lord."</p>
+
+<p>'"No," he replied, "that is not the address."</p>
+
+<p>'"Yes it is, Mr. Gilmour," I said again. "We are going
+to heaven; would you not like to go and see the Lord
+Jesus?"</p>
+
+<p>'Then he seemed to take in the meaning of my words,
+and reverently bowed his head in assent, his lips quivered,
+and his eyes filled with tears; and he was quieted, like a
+weary child who has lost his way and finds on inquiry that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_301" id="Page_301">[Pg 301]</a></span>
+only a few more steps and he will be at rest and at
+home.</p>
+
+<p>'The next day, his last, was still more restless. At
+one time he seemed to be addressing an audience and
+earnestly gesticulating with his hands; and, with as much
+force as he could command, he said: "We are not spending
+the time as we should; we ought to be waiting on God in
+prayer for blessing on the work He has given us to do.
+I would like to make a rattling speech&mdash;but I cannot&mdash;I
+am very ill&mdash;and can only say these few words." And
+then he nodded his head and waved his hand, as if in farewell
+to his listeners.</p>
+
+<p>'It was seven o'clock in the evening when my brother
+saw the end was not far off, and at once we sent for all the
+other members of the Mission that all might watch with
+him in this last solemn hour. He was unconscious the
+whole time, and his breathing laboured.</p>
+
+<p>'The two doctors battled for an hour and a half to
+keep off Death's fatal grasp, but to no purpose: the Lord
+wanted His faithful worker, and we could not keep him,
+though we wanted him much, and knew that Willie and
+Jimmie in England needed him more.</p>
+
+<p>'Gradually the breathing became quieter and quieter,
+till at last, about 9.30, he just closed his eyes and "fell
+asleep," with the peace of Heaven resting on his face.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In a letter sent by Dr. Roberts to Dr. Smith, who was
+then in England, a few further particulars are given.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'He preached one Sunday evening a very solemn
+sermon on "Examine yourself," and no one can soon forget
+the way he preached. During the annual meetings he was
+extra busy. Everyone remarked what a good chairman
+he made, and in the devotional meetings from 9 to
+9.30 <span class="smcap">A.M.</span> he was always ready to lead in prayer or speak a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_302" id="Page_302">[Pg 302]</a></span>
+few words. Freshness, to the point, and to the heart&mdash;characterised
+all he did or said. In the evenings he conducted
+services for the native preachers present at the annual
+gathering, and to these meetings he took one foreigner each
+night to assist in the speaking.</p>
+
+<p>'It was at the close of this busy week, when tired out,
+that he got the fever which eventually carried him home.
+The fever was very irregular in type, but after some days
+I felt it was an exceptional type of typhus fever. Great
+weakness of the heart was a characteristic feature all
+through his case, and but for this sad complication I believe
+he would have been alive to-day. Weak action of the
+heart was an old enemy of his. For the first week of his
+illness he did not feel very poorly, and we had many chats
+together, and some prayer and reading of God's Word every
+night nearly. But in the second week his temperature
+went up to 106°, and, though it came down under anti-pyretics,
+he seemed never to regain his former ground.
+His mind became more and more clouded. Parker took
+the night nursing, my sister the day, and I sat with him
+when time allowed. On Thursday, May 21, the day on
+which he died, he was very delirious all day, though he
+knew us all. I did not give up hope till 7 <span class="smcap">P.M.</span>, when his
+heart failed him in spite of active stimulation. It was then
+that we all gathered round his bed. I did my utmost with
+the help of Frazer to avert the sad end; but ere long,
+seeing our efforts were vain, we ceased, and sat in his room
+and saw him gradually and very peacefully pass away, his
+breath getting feebler and feebler till he closed his eyes
+and fell asleep in Jesus.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The funeral took place towards evening on May 23,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_303" id="Page_303">[Pg 303]</a></span>
+1891. It was a lovely afternoon, and the sun shining
+brightly lent additional force to the words of John Bunyan
+which were printed upon the simple sheet containing the
+hymn to be sung at the grave: 'The pilgrim they laid in
+an upper chamber whose window opened towards the Sun-rising.'
+The coffin was borne to the grave by two relays
+of bearers; the first consisted of three European and three
+native preachers; the second, on the one side, of the Rev.
+S. E. Meech, his brother-in-law; the Rev. J. Parker, his colleague,
+and Dr. Roberts; and on the other Liu, his faithful
+Chinese preacher and helper, Chang, the tutor of the
+theological class at Tientsin, and Hsi, his courier, a native
+of Tá Ss&#365; Kou. His last resting-place immediately adjoins
+that of his dearly loved friend, Dr. Mackenzie, and the
+service at the grave was conducted by the Rev. Jonathan
+Lees and the Rev. J. Parker. Chang offered prayer, and a
+farewell hymn was sung.</p>
+
+<table summary="Poem - Sleep on, beloved">
+<tr>
+<td>
+<p>
+Sleep on, beloved, sleep, and take thy rest;<br />
+Lay down thy head upon thy Saviour's breast;<br />
+We love thee well; but Jesus loves thee best&mdash;<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Good night! Good night! Good night!</span><br />
+<br />
+Until the shadows from this earth are cast;<br />
+Until He gathers in His sheaves at last;<br />
+Until the twilight gloom be overpast&mdash;<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Good night! Good night! Good night!</span><br />
+<br />
+Until we meet again before His throne,<br />
+Clothed in the spotless robe He gives His own,<br />
+Until we know even as we are known&mdash;<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Good night! Good night! Good night!</span>
+</p>
+</td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+
+<p>Little Chinese boys who had known and loved Mr.
+Gilmour came forward and threw handfuls of flowers into
+his grave, loving hands laid upon the coffin a wreath of
+white blossoms on behalf of the now orphaned boys far<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_304" id="Page_304">[Pg 304]</a></span>
+away, and the simple but beautiful service was closed by a
+spontaneous act on the part of the Chinese converts present.
+Pressing near the grave of him whose heart loved China
+and the Chinese with a fervour and an enthusiasm that
+may have been equalled, but certainly have never been
+surpassed, they sang in their own tongue the hymn beginning,
+'In the Christian's home in glory.'</p>
+
+<p>The labourer had entered into the rest he had so often
+seen by the eye of faith. 'There remains,' he wrote, less
+than a year before his death, 'a rest. Somewhere ahead.
+Not very far at the longest. Perfect, quiet, full, without
+solitude, isolation, or inability to accomplish; when the
+days of our youth will be more than restored to us; where,
+should mysteries remain, there will be no torment in them.
+And the reunions there! Continuous too, with no feeling
+that the rest of to-day is to-morrow to be ended by a plunge
+again into a world seething with iniquity, and groaning
+with suffering.'</p>
+
+<p>Many pages might be filled with loving eulogies of
+James Gilmour. But the best of all is the simple story of
+his life. Yet two or three references to his work and
+influence must here find a place.</p>
+
+<p>From the pen of Dr. Reynolds comes this weighty
+testimony:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'The end of his career came all too suddenly, and in
+gathering together my impressions of it as a whole, I am
+convinced that I have seldom seen a man so entirely
+possessed by a grand idea, so utterly persuaded that we
+had a debt to pay to the heathen world, so invincibly sure
+that Christian faith and life was the one supreme need of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_305" id="Page_305">[Pg 305]</a></span>
+these regions beyond our circle of light. Few men have
+cast the bread upon greater waters, have sown the seed
+over a wider area, or had to mourn more sadly over those
+heart-breaking months which intervene between the seedtime
+and the harvest. Impartial critics have recognised the
+intense honesty, the shrewd wit, the faculty of vision, the
+power to tell the story of his rare experiences with such
+verisimilitude as to force upon the reader a ready acquiescence
+in every detail of his narrative. But his Christian
+brethren saw a deeper vein than this in Gilmour's achievements.
+He was ablaze from first to last with a passionate
+desire to set forth Christ in His majesty and mercy, in all
+His power to heal and to command. I had unexpected
+opportunities of finding how tender and affectionate his
+nature was; how grateful and enthusiastic his love to his
+Hamilton home, to his father, mother, and wife, and how
+faithful and loyal he was to the society and the brotherhood
+of his Alma Mater.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The Rev. G. Owen, at a memorial service held in Peking
+very shortly after Mr. Gilmour's death, gave a sketch of his
+character and work, and thus summed up his life:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'He spared himself in nothing, but gave himself wholly
+to God. He kept nothing back. All was laid upon the
+altar. I doubt if even St. Paul endured more for Christ
+than did James Gilmour. I doubt, too, if Christ ever
+received from human hands or human heart more loving,
+devoted service.</p>
+
+<p>'If anyone asks, "Would it not have been better if Mr.
+Gilmour had taken more care of himself and lived longer?"
+I would answer: "I don't know. His life was beautiful,
+and I would not alter it if I could. A few years of such<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_306" id="Page_306">[Pg 306]</a></span>
+service as he gave Christ are worth a hundred years of
+humdrum toil. We need the inspiration of such a life as
+his. Heaven, too, is the richer for such a man and such a
+life. The pearly gates opened wide, I have no doubt, to
+receive him. Angels and men gave him glad welcome,
+and what a smile would light up the Saviour's face as He
+received His faithful servant home!"</p>
+
+<p>'And he being dead yet speaketh. He says, "Be
+faithful, work hard, for the night cometh when no man can
+work. Be earnest, for life is brief; be ready, for life is
+uncertain." But why did God call him away in the midst
+of life and work? I don't know. Possibly work here is not
+of such importance as we think. Or there is more important
+service elsewhere waiting for such men as Mr.
+Gilmour. He has been faithful over a few things; he has
+been made ruler over many things, and has entered into
+the joy of his Lord.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>Mr. Parker wrote to the sons of his late colleague on
+June 6, 1891:&mdash;</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'It is sad that my first letter to you should be to tell
+you about your father's death, of which no doubt you have
+heard long ago.... The last photographs of yourselves
+which you sent out he always had where he could see them.
+Whenever he travelled he took them with him. At
+Tientsin during his last illness he had them on a low side
+table, just on a level with his bed, so that as he lay there
+he could see them.... He was very happy, and died
+like a faithful soldier who had finished his work. It is
+sad, dear boys, to lose a father such as he was, but it is a
+great blessing to have had such a father, one so brave, so
+courageous, one who for the sake of Christ suffered bodily
+discomfort and pain, suffered terrible loneliness that he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_307" id="Page_307">[Pg 307]</a></span>
+might win some of God's sinning children back to their
+Father's arms. He lived and suffered for the Mongols,
+and though God denied him the honour of baptizing even
+one of them, yet so faithful was he to his work that he
+toiled on to the very last. "Faithful unto death" are
+words fully exemplified in your father's life.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>In his first letter from Mongolia after his prompt
+return to carry on in a like spirit of faith and devotion the
+work from which Mr. Gilmour had been summoned away
+Mr. Parker depicts the grief of the native Christians on
+learning their loss. 'The sorrow of the converts here (Ch'ao
+Yang) at the news of Gilmour's death was very touching
+Grown-up men burst into tears and sobbed like children
+when they were told he was dead. All along the route where
+Gilmour was such a familiar visitor, in the market-place,
+and at their fairs, the first question they asked as soon as
+they saw me was, "Has Mr. Gilmour come?" And at my
+reply there was always great astonishment, accompanied
+by expressions of sorrow. Every day at evening prayers I
+can hear Gilmour's name mingled with their petitions.
+The Christians here have sent a letter of sympathy to his
+two boys.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'Here in Ch'ao Yang there are any amount of Mongols,
+not nomadic, tent-loving, but settled here, and hence they
+do not have to be sought. Right in the centre of the town
+is an immense Mongol temple with two or three hundred
+priests. Every day I have several of the priests in here,
+and yet I have heard again and again that this mission is
+misplaced. Some such words often pained the heart that
+is now still in death. But this is, and shall be, essentially a
+Mongol mission in this, that as the best efforts of dear<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_308" id="Page_308">[Pg 308]</a></span>
+Gilmour were for making Christ known to the Mongols, my
+best endeavours shall be to this end. But if some hungry
+Chinaman, standing by as I hold out the bread of life to his
+Mongol brother, seeks to eat of it, he shall have it, and be as
+welcome as the other.'</p></blockquote>
+
+<p>The letter to the children referred to in Mr. Parker's
+report is a fitting description of James Gilmour's life, and
+he himself would have desired no other panegyric. It
+came from the hearts of men on whose behalf he had given
+his very best, and it shows how strong a hold he had
+obtained upon their affection.</p>
+
+<blockquote><p>'We respectfully enquire for the peace and happiness
+of your excellencies, our brothers Gilmour, also for the
+peace of your whole school. In the first place Pastor
+Gilmour in his preaching and doctoring at Ch'ao Yang,
+north of the Pass, truly loved others as himself, was considerate
+and humble, and had the likeness of (our) Saviour
+Jesus. Not only the Christians thank him without end,
+but even those outside the Church (the heathen) bless him
+without limit. We, who through Pastor Gilmour have
+obtained the doctrine of the second birth, and received the
+grace of Jesus, had hoped with Mr. Gilmour to have
+assembled on the earth until our heads were white and in
+the future life to have gone with him to heaven. Little
+did we think we should have been so unhappy. He has
+already gone to the Lord. We certainly know he is in the
+presence of the Lord, not only praying for us, but also for
+you our brothers.</p>
+
+<p>'We pray you, when you see this letter, not to grieve
+beyond measure. We hope that you will study with increased
+ardour, so as to obtain the heavenly wisdom, like
+Solomon, and that afterwards you may come to China, to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_309" id="Page_309">[Pg 309]</a></span>
+this Ch'ao Yang, to preach the Gospel widely. As the
+father did, may the sons follow, is our earnest desire.</p>
+
+<p>
+'Signed by the Ch'ao Yang Christians,
+</p>
+
+<p>
+'<span class="smcap">Liu mao lin</span> (preacher).<br />
+<span class="smcap">P'ang tien k'uei.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Wang sheng.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Ning fu tung.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Chang wan ch'uan.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Chang kuei.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Chiang sheng.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Wang hui hsien.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Liu i</span> (your father's servant).<br />
+<span class="smcap">Sung kang.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Ch'u wen yuan.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Chang chen.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Chang mao chi.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Ning kuang chen.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Liu cho.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">T'ien te ch'un.</span><br />
+<span class="smcap">Hu te.</span>'
+</p>
+</blockquote>
+
+<p>Here, then, we leave him. If the story of his life fail to
+touch the heart, to deepen faith, to exalt our estimate of
+renewed human nature, and to revive enthusiasm in work
+for Christ at home and abroad, the fault must be in him
+who has tried to tell it, and to set in order the facts.</p>
+
+<p>God's ways are ofttimes dark. James Gilmour had often
+felt this, and, to those who knew him, it seemed as though
+he were taken just when God's work needed him most,
+when the first-fruits of the coming harvest were being
+gathered, when his knowledge of the Chinese and the
+Mongols, and their knowledge of him and affection for him,
+were beginning to tell. But God knows best, and nothing
+can deprive the Church of Christ of the splendid self-sacrifice,
+of the noble perseverance in the path of duty
+of the bright example of courage, devotion, enthusiasm for
+souls, and patient continuance in well doing shining so
+clearly through all the long, years of toil. Love, self-crucifixion,
+Jesus Christ closely followed in adversity, in
+loneliness, in manifold perils, under almost every conceivable<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_310" id="Page_310">[Pg 310]</a></span>
+form of trial and hindrance and resistance both active
+and passive&mdash;these are the seeds James Gilmour has sown
+so richly on the hard Mongolian Plain, and over its
+Eastern mountains and valleys. 'In due time we shall
+reap if we faint not.' His work goes on. He is now
+doing the Master's bidding in the higher service. There,
+we must fain believe, he is finding full scope for those altogether
+exceptional spiritual affinities, and powers and capacities
+which stand out so conspicuously all through the
+story of his inner life. Upon us who yet remain rests the
+responsibility of carrying forward the work he began, of
+reinforcing the workers, of bearing Mongolia upon our
+prayers until Buddhism shall fade away before the pure
+truth and the perfect love of Jesus Christ, and even the
+hard and unresponsive Mongols come to recognise the
+truths James Gilmour so long and so faithfully tried to
+teach them&mdash;that they need the Great Physician even more
+than they need the earthly doctor, and that He is more
+able and willing to heal the hurt of their souls than the
+earthly physician is to remove the disease of their bodies.</p>
+
+<p>Is not the real lesson of James Gilmour's life twofold? If
+it be looked at from the point of view of results, it should
+give clear and vivid ideas of the unwisdom of being cast
+down by the absence of results in face of the difficulties of
+missionary work in China. It is to be feared that there
+are still large numbers of good Christian people who believe
+that for the conversion of Chinamen and Mongols all that
+is requisite is to put into the hands of the heathen a copy
+of God's Word in their native tongue, and then preach to
+them the good tidings of salvation. No man in this, or in
+past generation, has done this more faithfully than<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_311" id="Page_311">[Pg 311]</a></span>
+James Gilmour. No man ever believed more firmly
+in the truth that it is 'not by might nor by power,'
+but by the direct influence of the Holy Spirit, that the
+intellect and conscience and heart of the heathen are to
+be subdued to the Saviour. No man ever wrestled more
+eagerly and fervently in prayer on behalf of the ignorant
+and sinful, and yet his avowed converts can be numbered
+on the fingers. Does this prove that God is unfaithful?
+Does this tend to show that the enterprise is hopeless?
+Or has God been teaching us, by the life of one of His
+ablest and truest servants, the lesson of patient continuance
+in the path of His commands, whether He blesses or
+whether He withholds? Is He not proclaiming to His
+Church the need of a self-sacrifice <i>in all its members</i> commensurate
+with that displayed by James Gilmour and others
+who like him have not counted their lives dear unto themselves
+in the struggle with heathenism? Some must go in
+the 'forlorn hope.' Some must lay down their lives in preparing
+the highway of our God. 'Herein is the saying true,
+One soweth and another reapeth.' But succeeding toilers in
+the Mongolian field, as the direct result of James Gilmour's
+sowing, will be able in days to come to apply to themselves
+our Lord's words, 'I sent you to reap that whereon ye
+have not laboured:&mdash;others have laboured, and ye are
+entered into their labour.'</p>
+
+<p>If the life of James Gilmour be looked at altogether
+apart from the results that can be entered in tables of
+statistics, how splendidly inspiring it is! Faithful to his
+Master, faithful to his work, although the Master <i>seemed</i>
+to delay the blessing, although the work wore down the
+worker. 'I,' said St. Paul to the thankless Corinthian<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_312" id="Page_312">[Pg 312]</a></span>
+Church, 'will most gladly spend and be spent for your
+souls. If I love you more abundantly, am I loved the
+less? But be it so.' And in the Epistle to the Romans he
+applied to the Jews who were resisting the Gospel the
+ancient words of Isaiah: 'But as to Israel He saith, All
+the day long did I spread out my hands unto a disobedient
+and gainsaying people. I say then, Did God cast off His
+people? God forbid.' Nor will God cast off the Israel of
+China, or the Mongols who gave to the faithful teacher respect,
+attention, and in a way the love of their hearts, but
+who as yet have not surrendered those hearts to their true
+Lord. James Gilmour, in season and out of season,
+in almost constant solitude, in superabounding physical
+labours that often overburdened him, and once nearly
+broke him down, in the long disappointment of the most
+cherished hopes, and under the constant strain of what
+would have crushed any but a giant in faith, lived a life
+which, if it taught no other lesson, was yet well worth
+living to teach this&mdash;that Jesus Christ can and does give
+His servants the victory over apparent non-success, after
+the most vehement and long-sustained effort to secure
+success, and that this is the greatest victory possible to
+renewed and sanctified human nature.</p>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<p class="center">
+PRINTED BY<br />
+SPOTTISWOODE AND CO., NEW STREET SQUARE<br />
+LONDON<br />
+<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_313" id="Page_313">[Pg 313]</a></span>
+</p>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<p class="center">
+CHEAP EDITION.<br />
+<span class="u">Crown 8vo. 2s. 6d. cloth boards.</span><br />
+<br />
+<br /></p>
+<h2><span class="smcap">James Gilmour</span></h2>
+<h3>OF MONGOLIA:</h3>
+<h4><i>HIS DIARIES, LETTERS, AND REPORTS.</i></h4>
+
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 300px;">
+<img src="images/sincerely.jpg" alt="Sincerely yours - James Gilmour" title="" />
+</div>
+
+<p class="center">
+EDITED AND ARRANGED BY</p>
+<h3>RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.</h3>
+<div class="center"><i>Author of 'Norwegian Pictures,' 'The Printed English Bible,'<br />
+'London Pictures,' &amp;c.</i></div>
+
+<hr style="width: 35%;" />
+
+<p class="center">
+<span class="smcap">Published by THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY</span>,<br />
+<span class="smcap">56 Paternoster Row, London</span>.</p>
+<div class="pto">[P.T.O.</div>
+<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_314" id="Page_314">[Pg 314]</a></span></p>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<h2>Press Notices</h2>
+<p class="center">OF</p>
+<h2>THE LIFE OF GILMOUR.</h2>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'The story of James Gilmour will, if we mistake not, take a place
+of its own in modern missionary literature. To a world devoted so
+much to mercenary interests, and a Church too given to take things
+easily, the life is at once a rebuke and an appeal not easily to be
+forgotten.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Christian World.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'We are sure that this work will be read with the deepest interest
+by Churchmen as well as Nonconformists.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Record.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'A notable addition to the number of impressive and fascinating
+missionary books&mdash;a volume fit to stand on the same shelf with the
+biographies of Paton and Mackay.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">British Weekly.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'James Gilmour may appear to some as a hero, to others as a
+deluded enthusiast, but no one who takes up this account of his life
+and work can fail to be fascinated by it.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Manchester Guardian.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Out of sight the most interesting and valuable missionary biography
+of recent years.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Literary World.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Not only deeply interesting as a record of missionary labour, but
+teems with characteristic sketches of Chinese manners, customs, and
+scenery.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Times (Weekly).</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Unlike many missionary records, his letters and journals can be
+read. Indeed, it is difficult to stop reading, once you have begun.'
+<span class="smcap">National Observer.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'For an age which, as the editor remarks, likes "large and quick
+returns" for its investments, the history of a man who had for many
+years to possess his soul in patience has a real and permanent value.'
+<span class="smcap">Daily Telegraph.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'From every point of view the book deserves the highest praise.'
+<span class="smcap">Glasgow Herald.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Not the least interesting portion of the book will be its strange
+pictures of life amid Mongol surroundings.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Liverpool Courier.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_315" id="Page_315">[Pg 315]</a></span></span></p>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<p class="center">
+By JAMES GILMOUR.
+</p>
+<h2>AMONG THE MONGOLS.</h2>
+<p class="center">
+BY THE LATE
+</p>
+<h2>REV. JAMES GILMOUR, M.A.</h2>
+<p class="center">
+With Engravings.&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;2s. 6d. cloth, gilt.
+</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'There has been, if our experience serves us at all, no book quite like this
+since "Robinson Crusoe"; and "Robinson Crusoe" is not better, does not
+tell a story more directly, or produce more instantaneous and final conviction.
+No one who begins this book will leave it till the narrative ends, or doubt for
+an instant, whether he knows Defoe or not, that he has been enchained by
+something separate and distinct in literature, something almost uncanny in
+the way it has gripped him, and made him see for ever a scene he never
+expected to see.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">The Spectator.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Mr. Gilmour tells a story well, and though he tells it quite simply and
+straightforwardly, he never misses the point of it. He writes, moreover,
+after having had exceptional chances of gaining a thorough acquaintance with
+the Mongolian character.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">The Guardian.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'There is a charm in the quiet way in which the modest missionary tells
+of his life in Tartar tents, of the long rides across the grassy plain, and of the
+daily life of the nomads among whom he passed so many years.'
+<span class="smcap">Fortnightly Review.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Mr. Gilmour's volume is one of the most charming books about a strange
+people that we have read for many a day.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Nature.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Mr. Gilmour has lived <i>tête-à-tête</i> with a Buddhist Lama under his own
+movable roof; he has shared the hospitality of the desert caravan; he has
+taken his turn in the night-watch against thieves; and he has dwelt as a
+lodger in their more permanent abodes of trellis-work and felt. As a picture
+of the raw material from which Chinese civilisation has been finally evolved&mdash;the
+primitive stage of Tartar nomad communities&mdash;these sketches possess a
+great sociological value; while from the point of view of the reader for
+amusement alone they are full of liveliness and local colouring.'
+<span class="smcap">Pall Mall Gazette.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Although it appears in unpretentious form, this is a really remarkable
+chronicle of travel and adventure.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">The Globe.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_316" id="Page_316">[Pg 316]</a></span></span></p>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<p class="center">
+By JAMES GILMOUR.<br />
+<br />
+<br />
+Crown 8vo. 5s. cloth.
+</p>
+<h2><span class="smcap">More About the Mongols.</span></h2>
+<p class="center">
+Selected and Arranged from Mr. <span class="smcap">Gilmour's</span> Diaries and Papers</p>
+<h3>By RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.,</h3>
+<p class="center"><i>Author of 'James Gilmour of Mongolia' &amp;c.</i>
+</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'The style of the writer and the novelty of the theme, and the heart which
+so longs for "Mongols" showing itself on many a page, combine to make the
+work intensely interesting, instructive, and impressive.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">The Presbyterian.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'The experiences of a devoted missionary, whose gift of circumstantial
+narrative has not inaptly been likened to Defoe's.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">The Times.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'It is indeed a delightful volume, which will be welcomed by all who
+desire the extension of Christ's kingdom on earth.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">English Churchman.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Extracts from the diaries of one of the most adventurous and self-denying
+of missionaries.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Saturday Review.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Will be welcomed wherever the name of James Gilmour is known.'
+<span class="smcap">The Record.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'A fascinating volume of travels, and a series of observations on men and
+manners which show the stuff of which our British missionaries are made.'
+<span class="smcap">Methodist Times.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Will delight readers of all ages.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Christian World.</span></p>
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<p class="center">
+Crown 8vo. 2s. 6d. cloth, gilt edges.
+</p>
+<h2><span class="smcap">James Gilmour and His Boys.</span></h2>
+<h3>By RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.</h3>
+<p class="center">With Facsimile Letters and many Illustrations.
+</p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'Ought to be in every Sunday School library.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">The Christian.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'It is full of curious passages of adventure; and has a strong religious
+interest which will not fail to give young readers an intelligent appreciation
+of the nature of foreign mission work.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Scotsman.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'It has been skilfully put together and will make an admirable gift-book.'
+<span class="smcap">British Weekly.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'It should find a place in all Christian homes.'
+<span class="smcap">Western Morning News.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'It is one that all boys, and girls too, will delight to read.'
+<span class="smcap">Scottish Leader.</span></p>
+
+<p style="text-indent: 2em;">'A fascinating volume from beginning to end.'&mdash;<span class="smcap">Baptist.</span></p>
+
+<hr style="width: 35%;" />
+
+<p class="center">
+<span class="smcap">Published by THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY</span>,<br />
+
+56 Paternoster Row, London; and Sold by all Booksellers.<br />
+
+<br />
+<i>Spottiswoode &amp; Co. Printers, New-street Square, London.</i>
+</p>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin-top:4em'>*** END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA ***</div>
+<div style='text-align:left'>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+Updated editions will replace the previous one&#8212;the old editions will
+be renamed.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
+law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
+so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
+States without permission and without paying copyright
+royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
+of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
+Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG&#8482;
+concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
+and may not be used if you charge for an eBook, except by following
+the terms of the trademark license, including paying royalties for use
+of the Project Gutenberg trademark. If you do not charge anything for
+copies of this eBook, complying with the trademark license is very
+easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose such as creation
+of derivative works, reports, performances and research. Project
+Gutenberg eBooks may be modified and printed and given away--you may
+do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks not protected
+by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the trademark
+license, especially commercial redistribution.
+</div>
+
+<div style='margin:0.83em 0; font-size:1.1em; text-align:center'>START: FULL LICENSE<br />
+<span style='font-size:smaller'>THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE<br />
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK</span>
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+To protect the Project Gutenberg&#8482; mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase &#8220;Project
+Gutenberg&#8221;), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
+Project Gutenberg&#8482; License available with this file or online at
+www.gutenberg.org/license.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
+destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works in your
+possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
+Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
+by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person
+or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.B. &#8220;Project Gutenberg&#8221; is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works if you follow the terms of this
+agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation (&#8220;the
+Foundation&#8221; or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
+of Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works. Nearly all the individual
+works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
+States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
+United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
+claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
+displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
+all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
+that you will support the Project Gutenberg&#8482; mission of promoting
+free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
+Project Gutenberg&#8482; name associated with the work. You can easily
+comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
+same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg&#8482; License when
+you share it without charge with others.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
+in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
+check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
+agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
+distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
+other Project Gutenberg&#8482; work. The Foundation makes no
+representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
+country other than the United States.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
+immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg&#8482; License must appear
+prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg&#8482; work (any work
+on which the phrase &#8220;Project Gutenberg&#8221; appears, or with which the
+phrase &#8220;Project Gutenberg&#8221; is associated) is accessed, displayed,
+performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
+</div>
+
+<blockquote>
+ <div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+ This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
+ other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
+ whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms
+ of the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online
+ at <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>. If you
+ are not located in the United States, you will have to check the laws
+ of the country where you are located before using this eBook.
+ </div>
+</blockquote>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work is
+derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
+contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
+copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
+the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
+redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase &#8220;Project
+Gutenberg&#8221; associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
+either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
+obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
+additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
+will be linked to the Project Gutenberg&#8482; License for all works
+posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
+beginning of this work.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg&#8482;.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg&#8482; License.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
+any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
+to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg&#8482; work in a format
+other than &#8220;Plain Vanilla ASCII&#8221; or other format used in the official
+version posted on the official Project Gutenberg&#8482; website
+(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
+to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
+of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original &#8220;Plain
+Vanilla ASCII&#8221; or other form. Any alternate format must include the
+full Project Gutenberg&#8482; License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg&#8482; works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
+provided that:
+</div>
+
+<div style='margin-left:0.7em;'>
+ <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
+ &bull; You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg&#8482; works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
+ to the owner of the Project Gutenberg&#8482; trademark, but he has
+ agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
+ Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
+ within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
+ legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
+ payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
+ Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
+ Section 4, &#8220;Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
+ Literary Archive Foundation.&#8221;
+ </div>
+
+ <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
+ &bull; You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+ License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
+ copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
+ all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+ works.
+ </div>
+
+ <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
+ &bull; You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
+ any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
+ receipt of the work.
+ </div>
+
+ <div style='text-indent:-0.7em'>
+ &bull; You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg&#8482; works.
+ </div>
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
+Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work or group of works on different terms than
+are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
+from the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the manager of
+the Project Gutenberg&#8482; trademark. Contact the Foundation as set
+forth in Section 3 below.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.F.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
+Gutenberg&#8482; collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
+contain &#8220;Defects,&#8221; such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
+or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
+intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
+other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
+cannot be read by your equipment.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the &#8220;Right
+of Replacement or Refund&#8221; described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg&#8482; trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg&#8482; electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
+with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
+with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
+lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
+or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
+opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
+the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
+without further opportunities to fix the problem.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you &#8216;AS-IS&#8217;, WITH NO
+OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
+LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
+damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
+violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
+agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
+limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
+unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
+remaining provisions.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works in
+accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
+production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
+including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
+the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
+or any Project Gutenberg&#8482; work, (b) alteration, modification, or
+additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg&#8482; work, and (c) any
+Defect you cause.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg&#8482;
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+Project Gutenberg&#8482; is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
+computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
+exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
+from people in all walks of life.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg&#8482;&#8217;s
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg&#8482; collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg&#8482; and future
+generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
+Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non-profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation&#8217;s EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
+U.S. federal laws and your state&#8217;s laws.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+The Foundation&#8217;s business office is located at 809 North 1500 West,
+Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up
+to date contact information can be found at the Foundation&#8217;s website
+and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+Project Gutenberg&#8482; depends upon and cannot survive without widespread
+public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine-readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
+DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular state
+visit <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org/donate/">www.gutenberg.org/donate</a>.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+Please check the Project Gutenberg web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
+donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; font-size:1.1em; margin:1em 0; font-weight:bold'>
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg&#8482; electronic works
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
+Gutenberg&#8482; concept of a library of electronic works that could be
+freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
+distributed Project Gutenberg&#8482; eBooks with only a loose network of
+volunteer support.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+Project Gutenberg&#8482; eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
+the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
+necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
+edition.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+Most people start at our website which has the main PG search
+facility: <a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a>.
+</div>
+
+<div style='display:block; margin:1em 0'>
+This website includes information about Project Gutenberg&#8482;,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+</div>
+
+</div>
+
+</body>
+</html>
diff --git a/31525-h/images/109.jpg b/31525-h/images/109.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..66099b2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/images/109.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h/images/139.jpg b/31525-h/images/139.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1648c9b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/images/139.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h/images/156.jpg b/31525-h/images/156.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..159d95d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/images/156.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h/images/159.jpg b/31525-h/images/159.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a032040
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/images/159.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h/images/179.jpg b/31525-h/images/179.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b8e6988
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/images/179.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h/images/245.jpg b/31525-h/images/245.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..297829c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/images/245.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h/images/54.jpg b/31525-h/images/54.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f4b10fd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/images/54.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h/images/frontispiece.jpg b/31525-h/images/frontispiece.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..18935c5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/images/frontispiece.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/31525-h/images/sincerely.jpg b/31525-h/images/sincerely.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ecc991c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/31525-h/images/sincerely.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cf803bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #31525 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/31525)
diff --git a/old/31525.txt b/old/31525.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a6b91ca
--- /dev/null
+++ b/old/31525.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,9641 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of James Gilmour of Mongolia, by James Gilmour
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.net
+
+
+Title: James Gilmour of Mongolia
+ His diaries, letters, and reports
+
+Author: James Gilmour
+
+Editor: Richard Lovett
+
+Release Date: March 6, 2010 [EBook #31525]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by Peter Vickers, the Bookworm <bookworm.librivox
+AT gmail.com> and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team
+at http://www.pgdp.net (This book was produced from scanned
+images of public domain material from the Google Print
+project.)
+
+
+
+
+
+Transcriber's Note:
+
+Minor spelling and typographical errors have been corrected without
+note. Some illustrations have been slightly relocated for better flow.
+In some of the Chinese or Mongolian names, the character 'u' with a
+breve appears frequently. This appears in the text as [)u].
+
+
+[Illustration]
+
+
+
+
+JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA
+
+HIS DIARIES LETTERS AND REPORTS
+
+
+EDITED AND ARRANGED BY
+RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.
+AUTHOR OF 'NORWEGIAN PICTURES' ETC
+
+WITH A PORTRAIT, TWO MAPS AND
+FIVE ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+THIRD AND CHEAPER EDITION
+
+LONDON
+THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY
+56 Paternoster Row, 65 St Paul's Churchyard
+1895
+
+
+ O Christ, in Thee my soul hath found,
+ And found in Thee alone,
+ The peace, the joy I sought so long,
+ The bliss till now unknown.
+
+ I sighed for rest and happiness,
+ I yearned for them, not Thee;
+ But while I passed my Saviour by,
+ His love laid hold on me.
+
+ Now none but Christ can satisfy,
+ None other name for me;
+ There's love, and life, and lasting joy,
+ Lord Jesus, found in Thee.
+
+
+
+
+PREFACE
+
+
+This book in its more expensive forms has been before the public for
+nearly two years. It has been very widely read, and it has received
+extraordinary attention from many sections of the press. The author has
+received from all parts of the world most striking testimonies as to the
+way in which this record of James Gilmour's heroic self-sacrifice for
+the Lord Jesus and on behalf of his beloved Mongols for the Master's
+sake has touched the hearts of Christian workers. It has deepened their
+faith, strengthened their zeal, nerved them for whole-hearted
+consecration to the same Master, and cheered many a solitary and lonely
+heart.
+
+Many requests have been received for an edition at a price which will
+place the book within the reach of Sunday School teachers, of those
+Christian workers who have but little to spend upon books, and of the
+elder scholars in our schools. The Committee of the Religious Tract
+Society have gladly met this request at the earliest possible moment.
+
+In this new form their hope and prayer is that James Gilmour, being
+dead, may yet speak to many hearts, arousing them to diligent, and
+faithful, and self-denying service for Jesus Christ.
+
+The book, in this its newest form, is identical in all respects with the
+first and second editions, except that only one portrait is given and
+the appendices are left out.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+ CHAPTER PAGE
+
+ I. EARLY YEARS AND EDUCATION 15
+
+ II. BEGINNING WORK 46
+
+ III. MONGOLIAN APPRENTICESHIP 55
+
+ IV. THE FIRST CAMPAIGN IN MONGOLIA 88
+
+ V. MARRIAGE 98
+
+ VI. 'IN JOURNEYINGS OFTEN, IN PERILS OF RIVERS' 105
+
+ VII. THE VISIT TO ENGLAND IN 1882 134
+
+ VIII. SUNSHINE AND SHADOW 154
+
+ IX. A CHANGE OF FIELD 176
+
+ X. PERSONAL CHARACTERISTICS AS ILLUSTRATED BY
+ LETTERS TO RELATIVES AND FRIENDS 228
+
+ XI. CLOSING LABOURS 256
+
+ XII. THE LAST DAYS 298
+
+
+ LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+ PORTRAIT OF JAMES GILMOUR FROM A PHOTOGRAPH TAKEN
+ AT TIENTSIN ON APRIL 1891 _Frontispiece_
+
+ A MONGOL ENCAMPMENT 109
+
+ A MONGOL CAMEL CART 139
+
+ A CHINESE MULE LITTER 156
+
+ JAMES GILMOUR EQUIPPED FOR HIS WALKING EXPEDITION
+ IN MONGOLIA IN FEBRUARY 1884 159
+
+ JAMES GILMOUR'S TENT 245
+
+
+ MAPS
+
+ 1. MAP ILLUSTRATING JAMES GILMOUR'S JOURNEYS ON THE
+ GREAT PLAIN OF MONGOLIA 54
+
+ 2. MAP ILLUSTRATING JAMES GILMOUR'S LABOURS IN EASTERN
+ MONGOLIA 179
+
+ For readers of _James Gilmour of Mongolia_ not familiar with _Among
+ the Mongols_, a new Edition of that Work has been prepared and
+ published, price Two Shillings and Sixpence.
+
+
+
+
+JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+EARLY YEARS AND EDUCATION
+
+
+James Gilmour, of Mongolia, the son of James Gilmour and Elizabeth
+Pettigrew his wife, was born at Cathkin on Monday, June 12, 1843. He was
+the third in a family of six sons, all but one of whom grew up to
+manhood. His father was in very comfortable circumstances, and
+consequently James Gilmour never had the struggle with poverty through
+which so many of his great countrymen have had to pass. Cathkin, an
+estate of half a dozen farms in the parish of Carmunnock, is only five
+miles from Glasgow, and was owned by Humphrey Ewing Maclae, a retired
+India merchant, who resided in the substantial mansion-house on the
+estate. There were also the houses of a few residents, and a smithy and
+wright's workshops, for the convenience of the surrounding district.
+James Gilmour's father was the occupant of the wright's shop, as his
+father had been before him.
+
+His brother John, one of three who have survived him, has furnished the
+following interesting sketch of the family life in which James Gilmour
+was trained, and to which he owed so much of the charm and power which
+he manifested in later years:--
+
+'Our grandfather, Matthew Gilmour, combined the trades of mason and
+wright, working himself at both as occasion required; and our father,
+James Gilmour, continued the combination in his time in a modified
+degree, gradually discarding the mason trade and developing the
+wright's. Grandmother (father's mother) was a woman of authority, skill,
+and practical usefulness among the little community in which she
+resided. In cases requiring medical treatment, she was always in
+request; and in order to obtain the lymph pure for the vaccination of
+children she would take it herself direct from the cow. She was also a
+neat and skilful needlewoman.
+
+'Matthew Gilmour and his wife were people of strict integrity and
+Christian living. They walked regularly every Sunday the five miles to
+the Congregational Church in Glasgow, though there were several places
+of worship within two miles of their residence. I have often heard the
+old residents of the steep and rough country road they used to take for
+a short cut when nearing home tell how impressed they have been by the
+sight of the worthy couple and their family wending their way along in
+the dark winter Sabbath evenings by the light of a hand-lantern. Our
+parents continued the connection with the same body of worshippers in
+Glasgow as long as they resided in Cathkin, being members of Dr. Ralph
+Wardlaw's church. It was under his earnest eloquence, and by his wise
+pastoral care, we were trained.
+
+'The distance of our home from the place of worship did not admit of our
+attending as children any other than the regular Sabbath services; but
+we were not neglected in this respect at home, so far as it lay in our
+parents' ability to help us. We regularly gathered around our mother's
+knee, reading the impressive little stories found in such illustrated
+booklets as the _Teacher's Offering_, the _Child's Companion_, the
+_Children's Missionary Record_ (Church of Scotland), the _Tract
+Magazine_, and Watts' _Divine Songs for Children_. These readings were
+always accompanied with touching serious comments on them by mother,
+which tended very considerably to impress the lessons contained in them
+on our young hearts. I remember how she used to add: "Wouldn't it be
+fine if some of you, when you grow up, should be able to write such nice
+little stories as these for children, and do some good in the world in
+that way!" I have always had an idea that James' love of contributing
+short articles from China and Mongolia to the children's missionary
+magazines at home was due to these early impressions instilled into his
+mind by his mother. Father, too, on Sabbath evenings, generally placed
+the "big" Bible (Scott and Henry's) on the table, and read aloud the
+comments therein upon some portion of Scripture for our edification and
+entertainment. During the winter week-nights some part of the evening
+was often spent in reading aloud popular books then current, such as
+_Uncle Tom's Cabin_.
+
+'Family worship, morning and evening, was also a most regular and sacred
+observance in our house, and consisted of first, asking a blessing;
+second, singing twelve lines of a psalm or paraphrase, or a hymn from
+Wardlaw's Hymn-book; third, reading a chapter from the Old Testament in
+the mornings, and from the New in the evenings; and fourth, prayer. The
+chapters read were taken day by day in succession, and at the evening
+worship we read two verses each all round. This proved rather a trying
+ordeal for some of the apprentices, one or more of whom we usually had
+boarding with us, or to a new servant-girl, as their education in many
+cases had not been of too liberal a description. But they soon got more
+proficient, and if it led them to nothing higher, it was a good
+educational help. These devotional exercises were not common in the
+district in the mornings, and were apt to be broken in upon by callers
+at the wright's shop; but that was never entertained as an excuse for
+curtailing them. I suppose people in the district got to know of the
+custom, and avoided making their calls at a time when they would have to
+wait some little while for attention. Our parents, however, never
+allowed this practice or their religious inclinations to obtrude on
+their neighbours; all was done most unassumingly and humbly, as a matter
+of everyday course.
+
+'Our maternal grandfather, John Pettigrew by name, was a farmer and
+meal-miller on the estate of Cathkin, and was considered a man of
+sterling worth and integrity. Having had occasion to send his minister,
+the parson of Carmunnock parish, some bags of oatmeal from his mill, the
+minister suspected from some cause or other that he had got short weight
+or measure. The worthy miller was rather nettled at being thus impeached
+by his spiritual overseer, and that same night proceeded to the manse
+with the necessary articles required for determining the accuracy of the
+minister's suspicions. When this was done, it was found there remained
+something to the good, instead of a deficiency; this the miller swung
+over his shoulder in a bag and took back with him to the mill, as a
+lesson to the crestfallen divine to be more careful in future about
+challenging the integrity of his humble parishioner's transactions.
+
+'While James was quite a child the family removed to Glasgow, where our
+father entered into partnership with his brother Alexander as timber
+merchants. During this stay in Glasgow mother's health proved very
+unsatisfactory, and latterly both she and father having been prostrated
+and brought to death's door by a malignant fever, it was decided to
+relinquish the partnership and return to their former place in the
+country. James was five years old at that time. When he was between
+seven and eight he was sent with his older brothers to the new
+Subscription School in Bushyhill, Cambuslang, a distance of two miles.
+Here he remained till he was about twelve, when he and I were sent to
+Gorbals Youths' School in Greenside Street, Glasgow. We had thus five
+miles to go morning and evening, but we had season-tickets for the
+railway part of the distance, viz. between Rutherglen and Glasgow.
+Thomas Neil was master of this school. We were in the private room,
+rather a privileged place, compared with the rest of the school, seeing
+we received the personal attentions of Mr. Neil, and were almost free
+from corporal punishment, which was not by any means the case in the
+public rooms of the school--Mr. Neil being, I was going to say, a
+_terror to evildoers_, but he was in fact a terror to all kinds of
+doers, from the excitability of his temper and general sternness.
+
+'Here James usually kept the first or second place in the class, which
+was a large one; and if he happened to be turned to the bottom (an event
+which occurred pretty often to all the members of the class with Mr.
+Neil), he would determinedly endeavour to stifle a tearful little "cry,"
+thus demonstrating the state of his feelings at being so abased. But he
+never remained long at the bottom; like a cork sunk in water, he would
+rise at the first opportunity to his natural level at the top of the
+class. It was because of his diligence and success in his classes while
+at this school, I suppose, more than from any definite idea of what
+career he might follow in the future, that after leaving he was allowed
+to prosecute his studies at the Glasgow High School, where he gained
+many prizes, and fully justified his parents' decision of allowing him
+to go on with his studies instead of taking him away to a trade. At home
+he prosecuted his studies very untiringly both during session and
+vacation.
+
+'After entering the classes of the Glasgow University he studied in an
+attic room, the window of which overlooked an extensive and beautiful
+stretch of the Vale of Clyde. I remember feeling compassion for him
+sometimes as he sat at this window, knowing what an act of self-denial
+it must have been to one so boisterous and full of fun as he was to see
+us, after our work was over of an evening, having a jolly game at
+rounders, or something of that sort, while he had to sit poring over his
+books.
+
+'James was not a serious, melancholy student; he was indeed the very
+opposite of that when his little intervals of recreation occurred.
+During the day he would be out about the workshop and saw-mill, giving
+each in turn a poking and joking at times very tormenting to the
+recipients. If we had any little infirmity or weakness, he was sure to
+enlarge upon it and make us try to amend it, assuming the _role_ and
+aspect of a drill-sergeant for the time being. He used to have the
+mid-finger of the right hand extended in such a way that he could nip
+and slap you with it very painfully. He used this finger constantly to
+pound and drill his comrades, all being done of course in the height of
+glee, frolic, and good-humour. This finger, no doubt by the unlawful use
+to which he put it, at one time developed a painful tumour, to the
+delight of those who were in the habit of receiving punishment from it.
+James pulled a long face, and acknowledged that it was a punishment sent
+him for using the finger in so mischievous a manner.
+
+'There was a pond or dam in connection with the sawmill. In this James
+was wont to practise the art of swimming. I remember he devised a plan
+of increasing his power of stroke in the water. He made four oval pieces
+of wood rather larger than his hands and feet, tacking straps on one
+side, so that his hands and feet would slip tightly into them. But my
+recollection is that they were soon discarded as an unsuitable addition
+to his natural resources. He was fond of hunting after geological
+specimens, getting the local blacksmith to make him a pocket hammer to
+take with him on his rambles for that purpose. He seldom cared for
+company in these wanderings among the mountains, glens, and woods of his
+native place and country. He would start early in the morning, and
+accomplish feats of walking and climbing during the course of a day.
+Indeed, none of his brothers ever thought of asking James to go with
+them in their little holiday trips, knowing that anything not the
+conception of his own fancy was but very rarely acceptable to him; and
+he was never one who would pander to your gratification merely to please
+you.
+
+'James was fond of boating. Once he hired a small skiff near the
+suspension-bridge at Glasgow Green, and proceeded with it up the river.
+Having gone a good way up, the idea appears to have taken him to
+endeavour to get the whole way to Hamilton, where, father having retired
+from business in 1866, our parents were now residing. This proved to be
+a very arduous task, as in a great many places on that part of the Clyde
+there is not depth of water to carry a boat. He managed, however, to
+accomplish the task by divesting himself of jacket, stockings, and
+shoes, and pulling the boat over all such shallow and rocky places
+(including the weir at Blantyre Mills, where the renowned African
+missionary and explorer, Dr. Livingstone, worked in his boyhood), until
+he reached the bridge on the river between Hamilton and Motherwell, a
+distance of eleven miles or more from Glasgow in a straight line, and
+much more following the numerous bends of the river. Here he made the
+boat secure and proceeded home, a distance of a mile, very tired and
+ravenously hungry. The great drawback to his satisfaction in this feat
+was his fear of the displeasure the boat-owner might feel at his not
+having returned the same night, and the rough usage to which he had
+subjected the boat in hauling it over the rocky places. He was much
+delighted, when he arrived with the boat down the river during the day,
+to find that the man was rather pleased than otherwise at his plucky
+exploit, telling him that he only remembered it being attempted once
+before.
+
+'During part of the time James attended college at Glasgow University,
+the classes were at so early an hour that he could not take advantage of
+the railway, and so had to walk in the whole way. This was an anxious
+time for his mother, who was ever most particular in seeing to the
+household duties herself, and always careful that her children should
+have a substantial breakfast when they went from home. I remember some
+of those winter mornings. Amidst the bustle of making and partaking of
+an early breakfast so as to be on the road in time, mother would press
+him to partake more liberally of something she had thoughtfully prepared
+for him; he would ejaculate: "Can't take it--no time!" and if she still
+insisted he would add in a solemn manner: "_Mother_, what if the door
+should be shut when I get there?" which, being understood by her as a
+scriptural quotation, was sufficient to quench her solicitations.
+
+'To avoid the worry of getting up so early, it was decided after a time
+that he should take advantage of an unlet three or four apartment house
+in a tenement which belonged to father in Cumberland Street, Glasgow. So
+a couple of chairs, table, bed, and some cooking-utensils were got
+together, and James entered into possession, cooking his own breakfast,
+and getting his other meals there or outside as his fancy or inclination
+prompted. Here I think he enjoyed himself very much. He had plenty of
+quiet time for study, and he could roam about the city and suburbs for
+experience, recreation, and instruction, visiting mills and other large
+manufacturing industries as he was inclined.
+
+'After our parents had removed to Hamilton, James took lodgings in
+George Street, a regular students' resort when the old college was in
+the High Street. It is now removed to the magnificent pile of buildings
+at Gilmorehill, in the western district of the city. The site of the old
+one in the High Street which James attended is now occupied by the
+North British and Glasgow and South-Western Railway Companies.'
+
+James Gilmour left England to begin his Mongolian life-work in February
+1870, and then commenced keeping a diary, from which we shall often
+quote, and which he carefully continued amid, oftentimes, circumstances
+of the greatest difficulty until his death. He gives the following
+reasons for this practice at the time when he was living in a Mongol
+tent learning the language, hundreds of miles away from his nearest
+fellow-worker:--
+
+ 'I think it a special duty to my friends, specially my mother, to
+ keep this diary, and to be particular in adding my state of mind in
+ addition to my mere outward circumstances. In my present isolated
+ position, which may be more isolated soon, any accident might
+ happen at any moment, after which I could not send home a letter,
+ and I think that by keeping my diary punctually and fully my
+ friends might have the melancholy satisfaction of following me to
+ the grave, as it were, through my writing.'
+
+In the record of his first outward voyage he included a sketch of his
+early life, which we briefly reproduce here, as the correlative and
+complement of the picture outlined by his brother:--
+
+ 'The earliest that I can remember of my life is the portion that
+ was spent in Glasgow, before I came with my parents out to the
+ country. Of this time I have only a vague recollection. Then
+ followed a number of years not very eventful beyond the general lot
+ of the years of childhood. One circumstance of these years often
+ comes up to my mind. One Sabbath all were at church except the
+ servant, Aggie Leitch, and myself. She took down an old copy of
+ Bunyan's _Pilgrim's Progress_, with rude plates, and by the help
+ of the pictures was explaining the whole book to me. I had not
+ heard any of it before, and was deeply interested. We had just got
+ as far as the terrible doings of Giant Despair and the horrors of
+ Doubting Castle, when all at once, without warning, there came a
+ terrible knock at our front door. I really thought the giant was
+ upon us. It was some wayfaring man asking the way or something, but
+ the terror I felt has made an indelible impression on me.
+
+ 'When of the approved age I went to school, wondering whether I
+ should ever be able to learn and do as others did. I was very
+ nervous and much afraid, and wrought so hard and was so ably
+ superintended by my mother that I made rapid progress, and was put
+ from one class to another with delightful rapidity. I was
+ dreadfully jealous of any one who was a good scholar like myself,
+ and to have any one above me in class annoyed me to such a degree
+ that I could not play cheerfully with him.
+
+ 'The date of my going to college was, I think, the November of the
+ year 1862, so that my first session at Glasgow University was
+ 1862-63. The classes I took were junior Latin and junior Greek. In
+ Latin I got about the twelfth prize, and in Greek I think the
+ third. The summer I spent partly in study, partly in helping my
+ father in his trade of a wright and joiner.
+
+ 'During 1863 and 1864 I lived in Glasgow, and worked very hard,
+ taking the first prize in middle Greek and a prize in senior Latin,
+ as well as a prize for private work in Greek, and another for the
+ same kind of work in Latin. This last I was specially proud of, as
+ in it I beat the two best fellows in the Latin class. Next session
+ (1864-65) I took a prize in senior Greek. I got nothing in the
+ logic, but in moral philosophy in 1865 I was one of those who took
+ an active part in the rebellion against Dr. Fleming, who, though he
+ was entitled to the full retiring pension, preferred to remain on
+ as professor, taking the fees and appointing a student to do the
+ work. We made a stand against this, and were able to bring him out
+ to his work; but it was too much for him, and he died in harness,
+ as he had wished.
+
+ 'In English literature I made no appearance in the pieces noted by
+ the students, but came out second in the competitive examination,
+ which of course astonished a good deal some of the noisy men who
+ had answered so much in the class and yet knew so little. I was
+ really proud of this prize, as I was sure it was honestly won, and
+ as I also felt that from my position in class I failed to get
+ credit for anything like what I knew. This session I went in for
+ the classical and philosophy parts of the degree, and got them. I
+ enjoyed a happy week after it was known that I had passed; and the
+ next thing I had to look forward to was going to the Theological
+ Hall of the Congregational Church of Scotland, which met in
+ Edinburgh in the beginning of May. The session at Edinburgh I
+ enjoyed very much. I had not too much work, and used at odd times
+ to take long walks and go long excursions. I was often on the
+ heights, and about Leith and Portobello.'
+
+The Rev. John Paterson of Airdrie, N.B., Gilmour's most intimate college
+friend at Glasgow, thus records his recollections of what he was in
+those days:--
+
+ 'I first made James Gilmour's acquaintance in the winter session of
+ 1864-5 at Glasgow University. He came to college with the
+ reputation of being a good linguist. This reputation was soon
+ confirmed by distinction in his classes, especially in Latin and
+ Greek. Though his advantages had been superior to most of us, and
+ his mental calibre was of a high order, he was always humble,
+ utterly devoid of pride or vanity. No doubt he was firm as a rock
+ on any question of conviction, but he was tender in the extreme,
+ and full of sympathy with the struggling. He was such a strong man
+ all round that he could afford to give every one justice, and such
+ a gentleman that he could not but be considerate. One day a country
+ student through sheer nervousness missed a class question in the
+ Junior Humanity, though the answer was on his tongue: the answering
+ of such a question would have brought any man to the front, and
+ with a sad heart he told his experience to Gilmour, whose look of
+ sympathy is remembered to this day. He always seemed anxious to be
+ useful, and he succeeded. During our second session, a brother of
+ mine married a cousin of his, and this union led to a closer
+ intimacy between us, and in future sessions we lodged together.
+
+ 'Throughout his college career Gilmour was a very hard-working
+ student; his patience, perseverance, and powers of application were
+ marvellous; and yet, as a rule, he was bright and cheerful, able in
+ a twinkling to throw off the cares of work, and enter with zest
+ into the topics of the day. He had a keen appreciation of the
+ humorous side of things, and his merry laugh did one good.
+ Altogether he was a delightful companion, and was held in universal
+ esteem. One of Gilmour's leading thoughts was unquestionably the
+ unspeakable value of time, and this intensified with years. There
+ was not a shred of indolence in his nature; it may be truthfully
+ said that he never wilfully lost an hour. Even when the college
+ work was uncongenial, he never scamped it, but mastered the
+ subject. He could not brook the idea of skimming a subject merely
+ to pass an examination, and there were few men of his time with
+ such wide and accurate knowledge.
+
+ 'Unlike many of his fellows, he did not relax his energies in
+ summer. During the recess he might have been seen wending his way
+ from the old home at Cathkin to the college library, and returning
+ laden with books. His superior scholarship secured for him
+ excellent certificates and many prizes, both for summer and winter
+ work, and it was noticeable that he shone most in written
+ examinations. On one occasion, in the Moral Philosophy class, which
+ then suffered from the failing health of the professor, the teacher
+ _pro tem._ appended, as a criticism of an essay of Gilmour's on
+ Utilitarianism, the words, "Wants thoroughness." This was a problem
+ to the diligent student, who tackled his critic at the end of the
+ hour, and apparently had the best of the argument; for he told me
+ afterwards that he had puzzled the judge to explain his own
+ verdict. There was a strong vein of combativeness in him; he liked
+ to try his strength, both mentally and physically, with others; and
+ it was no child's play to wrestle with him in either sense, though
+ he never harboured ill-feeling. He had the advantage of being in
+ easy circumstances, but was severely economical, wasting nothing.
+ He had quite a horror of intoxicating drinks. On one occasion,
+ perhaps for reasons of hospitality, some beer had found its way
+ into our room: he quietly lifted the window and poured the
+ dangerous liquid on the street, saying, "Better on God's earth than
+ in His image."
+
+ 'As the close of his career in Glasgow drew near, some of us could
+ see that all through he had been preparing for some great work on
+ which the whole ambition of his life was set. He always shrank
+ from speaking about himself, and in those days was not in the habit
+ of obtruding sacred things on his fellow-students. His views on
+ personal dealing then were changing, and became very decided in
+ after years. Earnest, honest, faithful to his convictions, as a
+ student he endeavoured to influence others for good more by the
+ silent eloquence of a holy life than by definite exhortations, and
+ I feel sure his power over some of us was all the greater on that
+ account. When it became known that Gilmour intended to be a foreign
+ missionary, there was not a little surprise expressed, especially
+ among rival fellow-students--men who had competed with him to their
+ cost. The moral effect of such a distinguished scholar giving his
+ life for Christ among the heathen was very great indeed. To me his
+ resolve to go abroad, though it induced a painful separation,
+ proved an unspeakable blessing. The reserve which had so long
+ prevailed between us on sacred things began to give way, and much
+ of our correspondence during his residence at Cheshunt College was
+ of a religious turn, though still more theological than practical.
+
+ 'The last evening we spent together before he left for China can
+ never be forgotten. We parted on Bothwell Bridge. We had walked
+ from the village without speaking a word, burdened with the sorrow
+ of separation. As we shook hands, he said with intense earnestness,
+ "Paterson, let us keep close to Christ." He knew Him and loved Him
+ much better than I did then; but about nine years ago, after
+ hearing good news from me, he wrote to say that for twelve years he
+ had prayed for me every day, and now praised God for the answer.'
+
+In the diary from which we have already quoted Gilmour thus concludes
+the sketch of his education:--
+
+ 'Near the close of the session of 1867 I opened negotiations with
+ the London Missionary Society, the consequence of which was that I
+ was removed to Cheshunt College in September of that same year.
+ Here (1867-1868) a new experience awaited me--resident college
+ life. At Glasgow we dined out, presented ourselves at classes only,
+ and did with ourselves whatever we liked in the interval. At
+ Cheshunt it was different. All the students live in the buildings
+ of the college, which can accommodate forty. Of course I felt a
+ little strange at first, and even long after had serious doubts as
+ to the settlement of the question, Which is better, life in or out
+ of college? The lectures, as a rule, were all in the forenoon.
+
+ 'The summer vacation I spent in studying for the Soper scholarship,
+ value twenty pounds, which was to be bestowed after examination.
+
+ 'I commenced the 1868 and 1869 session at Cheshunt, very busily,
+ and in addition to the class work and the Soper work, read some
+ books which gave almost a new turn to my mind and my ideas of
+ pastoral or missionary life. These books were James's _Earnest
+ Ministry_, Baxter's _Reformed Pastor_, and some of Bunyan's works,
+ which, through God's blessing, affected me very much for good.
+
+ 'The Soper examination should have come off before Christmas, but
+ it did not, so that I remained over Christmas at Cheshunt, grinding
+ away as hard as I could. I was longing eagerly for the time when
+ the examination would be over, that I might the more earnestly
+ devote myself to the work of preaching and evangelising. Well, the
+ examination came and passed off satisfactorily, and I got the
+ twenty pounds.
+
+ 'Now was the decisive point. Now had I come to another period,
+ when there was an opportunity of going on a new tack; but I found
+ myself tempted to seek after another honour, the first prize in
+ Cheshunt College. In my first session I had got the second only,
+ and now I had an opportunity of trying for the first. It was a
+ temptation indeed, but God triumphed. I looked back on my life, and
+ saw how often I had been tempted on from one thing to another,
+ after I had resolved that I would leave my time more free and at my
+ disposal for God, but always was I tempted on. So now I made a
+ stand, threw ambition to the winds, and set to reading my Bible in
+ good earnest. I made it my chief study during the last three months
+ of my residence at Cheshunt, and I look back upon that period of my
+ stay there as the most profitable I had.
+
+ 'In September, 1869, I entered the missionary seminary at Highgate,
+ and also studied Chinese in London with Professor Summers. I went
+ home again at Christmas, and on returning to London learned that I
+ could go to China as soon as I liked. I said I would go as soon as
+ the necessary arrangements could be made, and February 22, 1870,
+ was fixed upon as the date of my departure.'
+
+In this brief and rapid manner James Gilmour sketched, with not a few
+most characteristic touches, the first twenty-six years of his life. He
+enables us to see the quick, merry, receptive lad, developing, after a
+brilliant collegiate course and a careful training in theology and in
+practical Christian life, into the strong, resolute missionary. No one
+who knew him during this time failed to perceive the force of his
+character and the charm of his personality. The writer first came under
+his influence during his second session at Cheshunt. He was then in the
+prime of his early manhood, in the full possession of physical and
+intellectual vigour, and his soul was aflame with love to the Saviour
+and to the perishing heathen.
+
+He retained, moreover, the love of fun, the high spirits, the keen
+enjoyment of a good joke, and the constant readiness for an argument
+upon any subject under the sun, which had endeared him to his comrades
+in Glasgow. Every Cheshunt man of that day readily recalls, and rejoices
+as he does so, the memory of his good-natured practical joking, of his
+racy and pointed speeches upon all momentous 'house questions,' of his
+power as a reciter, and of his glowing personal piety. To know him even
+slightly was to respect him; and to enter at all into sympathy with him
+was to love him as long as life lasted.
+
+There are many reminiscences of those Cheshunt days, from which we can
+cull only a sufficient number to enable the reader to understand what
+manner of man he then was. These are drawn from the letters of his
+fellow-students, and from their recollections of his sayings and doings.
+'How well,' writes one, 'I remember his coming to Cheshunt! I was
+acting-senior at the opening of that session, and, according to custom
+with the new men, went to his room to shake hands with him. He said,
+"Who are you?" I told him. "What do you want?" I told him I had come
+according to custom to welcome him, and held out my hand, whereupon he
+put his hands behind him and said, "Time eno' to shake hands when we've
+quarrelled. But where do you live?" "Immediately over your head." "Then
+look here," said he, "don't make a row;" and so we parted. Dear old
+fellow! his memory makes life richer.'
+
+Another writes: 'He was a good elocutionist. He was also a keen debater,
+and so fond of argument that he would not hesitate to take opposite
+ground to his own cherished convictions and beliefs, simply for the sake
+of provoking discussion. So earnestly and logically (for he was a good
+dialectician) would he carry on the discussion that it was difficult to
+believe that he did not really hold the opinions for which he so
+pertinaciously contended. Sometimes this habit of mind reacted very
+amusingly upon himself, as the following will show. The subject fixed
+one Friday evening for debate in the discussion class was, "Have animals
+souls?" Though fully accepting the common belief that they have not,
+Gilmour, purely for the sake of argument, took the affirmative, and with
+such enthusiasm pleaded his cause that he brought himself to believe, as
+he told me afterwards, that animals have souls.'
+
+'At no time during his residence at Cheshunt could there have been any
+doubt as to Gilmour's piety or consecration to the great work of his
+future life; but during the second year it must have been manifest to
+all who knew him intimately that there was a deepening and broadening of
+his spiritual life. As I look back over the interval of years I can see
+that it was then he began to reach the high-water mark in Christian life
+and devotion which was so steadily maintained throughout his career in
+China and Mongolia. An apostolic passion for the salvation of his
+fellow-men took hold upon him. He would go out in the evening, mostly
+alone, and conduct short open-air services at Flamstead End, among the
+cottagers near Cheshunt railway station; seize opportunities of speaking
+to labourers working by the roadside or in the field through which he
+might be passing. He became very solicitous for the conversion of
+friends in Scotland, and would come to my study and ask me to kneel
+and pray with him that God's grace might be manifested to them, and that
+His blessing might rest upon letters which he had written and was
+sending to them. The ordinary style of preaching towards which students
+usually aspire lost its attractions for him, and his sermons assumed
+more and more the character of earnest exhortations, and addresses to
+the unconverted. When he knew what was to be his field of labour after
+his college course was over, how solicitous he was to go out fully
+prepared and fitted in spiritual equipment! The needs of the perishing
+heathen were very real and weighed heavily upon his heart, and he was
+very anxious to win volunteers among his college friends for this
+all-important work. How he longed and prayed for China's perishing
+millions only his most intimate friends know.'
+
+The Rev. H. R. Reynolds, D.D., for the past thirty years the honoured
+President of Cheshunt College, has recalled some of his early
+recollections of James Gilmour.
+
+'Though brusque and outspoken in manner, he was in many respects
+reserved and shy, and very slow to show or accept confidence. We all
+felt, however, that underneath a canny demeanour there was burning a
+very intense enthusiasm, and that a character of marked features was
+already formed, and would only develop along certain lines, settled, but
+not as yet fully disclosed to others.
+
+There was not a particle of make-believe in his composition. He shrank
+from praise, and was obviously anxious not to appear more reverential or
+wise or devoted than he knew himself to be. He even used, because it was
+natural to him, a rugged style of expression when speaking of things or
+persons or institutions which for the most part uplift our diction and
+generally induce us to adorn or make careful selection of our
+vocabulary. He rapped out expressions which might have suggested
+carelessness or irreverence or suppressed doubt, but I soon found that
+there was an intense fire of evangelistic zeal and an almost stormy
+enthusiasm for the conversion of souls to Christ.
+
+'Some special services were held at Cheshunt Street Chapel, in which
+Gilmour took part, and the part was at least as demonstrative, perhaps
+more so, except the music, as that of the modern Salvation Army ensign
+or commissioner. He started from the chapel entrance, on the Sunday
+evening, when considerable numbers were as usual parading the country
+street, and bare-headed approached every passer-by with some piquant,
+vigorous inquiry, or message or warning. In the main, his bold summons
+was, "Do you believe on the Lord Jesus Christ?" The entire population in
+the thoroughfare was stirred, and uncomplimentary jeers mingled with
+some awe-struck impressions that were then produced.
+
+'During the year 1869 he had those interviews with the late Mrs. Swan,
+of Edinburgh, which led to his choice by the London Missionary Society,
+at her instance, to reopen the long-suspended mission in Mongolia. For a
+while he remained in Peking preparing himself by familiarity with the
+people, their ideas, their language, and religion, for those almost
+historic bursts into the great desert and across the caravan routes to
+the huge fairs, and the renowned temples, to the living lamas and famous
+shrines of the nomadic Mongols, incessantly acting the part of
+travelling Hakim, itinerant book vendor, and fiery preacher of the
+Gospel of Christ.'
+
+In the year 1869 the policy of the London Missionary Society in the
+education of its students was very different from that which now
+obtains. After a course at a theological college of two, three, or four
+years, according to the literary attainments of the man at the time of
+his acceptance by the Directors, he was sent to the institution at
+Highgate designed to give training suitable for the special requirements
+of the embryo missionaries. In theory this institution was admirable; in
+practice Gilmour and others, much as they esteemed the principal, the
+Rev. J. Wardlaw, found it--or thought they found it--very largely a
+waste of time. The year 1869 saw the beginning of an investigation which
+ended in closing the missionary college at Highgate, and in the steps
+that led to the enquiry Gilmour took a leading part. One of his
+contemporaries at Highgate has thus described his influence upon both
+his fellow-students and the institution to which they belonged.
+
+'I first met Gilmour at Farquhar House, Highgate, the London Missionary
+Society's Institution, where in those days missionary students spent
+their last six months before going to the field. Some spent the time in
+studying the elements of the language of the land to which they were
+going; others attended University College Hospital, for the purpose of
+getting a little medical knowledge; while all tried to make themselves
+acquainted with the history of the people among whom they were to
+labour. Courses of special missionary lectures, which were highly valued
+by the men, were delivered by the Rev. J., afterwards Dr., Wardlaw.
+
+'Some of us were at Highgate a day or two before Gilmour came up from
+Scotland; and as his fame, or rather reports about him, had reached us
+from Cheshunt College, we were all very anxious to meet with him. When
+he did arrive we were, I think, all more or less disappointed, and yet I
+doubt if any of us could have told why, except that he was not the man
+we had pictured from the reports we had heard. When he walked quietly
+into the library I, for one, could hardly believe that the almost
+boyish-looking, open-faced, bright-eyed young man was really Gilmour.
+His dress made him appear even more youthful than he was, while there
+was an aspect of good humour about his face and a glance of his eye
+revealing any amount of fun and frolic. A great writer has said: "Nature
+has written a letter of credit on some men's faces, which is honoured
+almost wherever presented." James Gilmour's was a face on which Nature
+had written no ordinary letter of credit; for there was a sense in which
+one might very truly have said that his "face was his fortune." Honesty,
+good nature, and true manliness were so stamped upon every feature and
+line of it, that you had only to see him to feel that he was one of
+God's noblest works, and to be drawn to the man as by a magnetic
+influence.
+
+'Gilmour was a puzzle to most of our fellow-students, and they could not
+quite make him out. By some he was: regarded as very eccentric, which is
+another way of saying that he preserved a very marked individuality, and
+always had the courage of his convictions. They did not seem to
+understand how so much playfulness and piety, fervour and frolicsomeness
+could dwell in the same person. Long before we parted, however, in
+January, 1870, I feel certain that all had come to have not only a
+profound respect, but also a real heart-love for "dear old Gillie"!
+
+'The night before Gilmour left Highgate for the Christmas vacation we
+were all in his study, when someone, remarking on the risk he was
+running in going home to Scotland by sea, instead of by train, said in a
+jocular way: "Suppose the steamer is wrecked and you get drowned, to
+whom do you leave your books, Gilmour?" "Yes," he said at once, "that is
+well thought of. Come along, you fellows, and pick out the books you
+would like to keep in memory of me, if I never return." Of course we
+only laughed and said it was all a joke; but he said, "It is no joke
+with me, I mean what I say;" and so he did. He was in dead earnest, and
+nothing would satisfy him but that each should pick out the book or
+books he would like to have if he never returned. He then turned to me
+and said: "Now, I leave the rest to your care, and if I never return I
+want all on this shelf sent to my father and mother, and you can do
+anything you like with the rest." Had anyone else acted in that way, we
+should have certainly suspected that he had gone "_queer_"; but it was
+Gilmour, and we all understood the straight, matter-of-fact way in which
+he went about everything he did.
+
+'Through a misunderstanding, as we afterwards discovered, the students
+at Highgate came into collision with the Directors of the Society over
+the studies to be prosecuted. Additional classes were arranged, and
+these some of us declined to attend. This act of rebellion, as it was
+regarded at the Mission House, had to be put down with a firm hand, and
+a special meeting of the Board of Directors was called to deal with us.
+
+'The night before we were to meet the Board we met in Gilmour's study,
+to settle what we were to say to the Directors when we met them. One
+only of our number, when he saw that there was likely to be a rather
+serious interchange of ideas between us and the Directors, caved in
+completely, and would have nothing further to do with our resistance.
+
+'When we met the Board Gilmour made his defence in his frank,
+straightforward way, and, I am afraid, upset some of the Directors very
+much by his plain speaking. They did not know the man, and regarded him
+as one of the ringleaders in rebellion, and, of course, were not in the
+humour to do him justice. But when we met the subcommittee appointed to
+deal with us the misunderstanding came to an end, and they admitted that
+we had been in the right in objecting to the extra classes thus
+imposed.'
+
+During these last months in England James Gilmour paid much earnest heed
+to the culture of his soul. Just before he sailed for China, he set
+forth his inner experience and his keen sense of the difficulties of the
+course upon which he was embarking in the following letter to a Cheshunt
+friend:--
+
+ 'Companions I can scarcely hope to meet, and the feeling of being
+ _alone_ comes over me till I think of Christ and His blessed
+ promise, "Lo, I am with you alway, even to the end of the world."
+ No one who does not go away, leaving all and going alone, can feel
+ the force of this promise; and when I begin to feel my heart
+ threatening to go down, I betake myself to this companionship, and,
+ thank God, I have felt the blessedness of this promise rushing over
+ me repeatedly when I knelt down and spoke to Jesus as a present
+ companion, from whom I am sure to find sympathy. I have felt a
+ tingle of delight thrilling over me as I felt His presence, and
+ thought that wherever I may go He is still with me. I have once or
+ twice lately felt a melting sweetness in the name of Jesus as I
+ spoke to Him and told Him my trouble. Yes, and the trouble went
+ away, and I arose all right. Is it not blessed of Christ to care so
+ much for us poor feeble men, so sinful and so careless about
+ honouring Him? the moment we come to Him He is ready with His
+ consolations for us!
+
+ 'I have been thinking lately over some of the inducements we have
+ to live for Christ, and to confess Him and preach Him before men,
+ not conferring with flesh and blood. Why should we be trammelled by
+ the opinions and customs of men? Why should we care what men say of
+ us? Salvation and damnation are _realities_, Christ is a reality,
+ _Eternity_ is a reality, and we shall soon be there in reality, and
+ time shall soon be finished; and from our stand in eternity we
+ shall look back on what we did in time, and what shall we think of
+ it? Shall we be able to understand why we were afraid to speak to
+ this man or that woman about salvation? Shall we be able to
+ understand how we were ashamed to do what we knew was a Christian
+ duty before one whom we knew to be a mocker at religion? Our
+ cowardice shall seem small to us then. Let us now measure our
+ actions by the standard of that scene, let us now look upon the
+ things of time in the light of eternity, and we shall see them
+ better as they are, and live more as we shall wish then we had
+ done. It is not too late. We can secure yet what remains of our
+ life. The present still is ours. Let us use it. It may be that we
+ can't be great, let us be good; if we can't shine as great lights,
+ let us make our light shine as God has made it to shine. Let us
+ live lives as in the presence of Christ, anxious for His approval,
+ and glad to take the condemnation of the world, and of Christ's
+ professed servants even, if we get the commendation of angels and
+ our Master. The "well done!" is to the faithful servant--to the
+ _faithful_, not the great. Let us watch and pray that we may be
+ faithful. It is a little hard to be this, and to care little for
+ man.
+
+ 'Yesterday afternoon I preached here at home, and took the most
+ earnest sermon I had, "_Behold, I stand at the door and knock_."
+ Well, in doing so, I thought I was acting quite independently of
+ man; and even after I had preached it, thought I would not care for
+ man. But one man praised it, and I felt pleased, and, as might then
+ be expected, felt a little hurt when a friend called this morning
+ and told me that what I gave them yesterday was _no sermon at all_.
+ Now, if I had been regarding Christ alone, I would not have been
+ moved by either the one or the other of these criticisms; and I
+ wish that I could get above this sort of thing, and get beyond the
+ attempt at pleasing men at all. Why should we confer with men?'
+
+James Gilmour was ordained as a missionary to Mongolia in Augustine
+Chapel, Edinburgh, on February 10, 1870, and, in accordance with
+Nonconformist custom, he made a statement about the development of his
+religious life from which we take the following extract:--
+
+ 'My conversion took place after I had begun to attend the Arts
+ course in the University of Glasgow. I had gone to college with no
+ definite aim as to preparing for a profession; an opportunity was
+ offered me of attending classes, and I embraced it gladly,
+ confident that whatever training or knowledge I might there acquire
+ would prove serviceable to me afterwards in some way or other.
+
+ 'After I became satisfied that I had found the "way of life," I
+ decided to tell others of that way, and felt that I lay under
+ responsibility to do what I could to extend Christ's kingdom. Among
+ other plans of usefulness that suggested themselves to me was that
+ of entering the ministry. But, in my opinion, there were two things
+ that everyone who sought the office of the ministry should have,
+ viz., an experimental knowledge of the truth which it is the work
+ of the minister to preach, and a good education to help him to do
+ it; the former I believed I had, the latter I hoped to obtain. So I
+ quietly pursued the college course till I entered on the last
+ session, when, after prayerful consideration and mature
+ deliberation, I thought it my duty to offer myself as a candidate
+ for the ministry.
+
+ 'Having decided as to the capacity in which I should labour in
+ Christ's kingdom, the next thing which occupied my serious
+ attention was the _locality_ where I should labour. Occasionally
+ before I had thought of the relative claims of the home and foreign
+ fields, but during the summer, session in Edinburgh I thought the
+ matter out, and decided for the mission field; even on the low
+ ground of common sense I seemed to be called to be a missionary. Is
+ the kingdom a harvest field? Then I thought it reasonable that I
+ should seek to work where the work was most abundant and the
+ workers fewest. Labourers say they are overtaxed at home; what then
+ must be the case abroad, where there are wide stretching plains
+ already white to harvest, with scarcely here and there a solitary
+ reaper? To me the soul of an Indian seemed as precious as the soul
+ of an Englishman, and the Gospel as much for the Chinese as for the
+ European; and as the band of missionaries was few compared with the
+ company of home ministers, it seemed to me clearly to be my duty to
+ go abroad.
+
+ 'But I go out as a missionary not that I may follow the dictates of
+ common sense, but that I may obey that command of Christ, "_Go into
+ all the world and preach_." He who said "_preach_," said also, "Go
+ ye into and _preach_," and what Christ hath joined together let not
+ man put asunder.
+
+ 'This command seems to me to be strictly a missionary injunction,
+ and, as far as I can see, those to whom it was first delivered
+ regarded it in that light, so that, apart altogether from choice
+ and other lower reasons, my going forth is a matter of obedience to
+ a plain command; and in place of seeking to assign a reason for
+ going abroad, I would prefer to say that I have failed to discover
+ any reason why I should stay at home.'
+
+On February 22, 1870, James Gilmour embarked at Liverpool upon the
+steamship Diomed, and thus fairly started on the work of his life. Among
+his extant correspondence is a long letter which describes the voyage to
+China, and the way in which he utilised the opportunities it afforded
+for trying to do his Master's will.
+
+ 'We sailed from Liverpool, and my father saw me off. The passengers
+ were few--nine or ten. We had a cabin each. There was a Wesleyan
+ medical missionary named Hardey going out to Hankow. We soon drew
+ together. The doctor of the ship was a young fellow from Greenock,
+ and had been at Glasgow College when I was there last. Among the
+ 1,200 we had not stumbled upon each other. The married man was
+ something or other in the Consular service. A young lady passenger
+ was the daughter of a judge in China. A young man was going out to
+ try his fortune in China: his qualifications were some knowledge of
+ tea and a love of drink. Another decent young fellow was going out
+ to China as a tea-taster. Another young fellow was going out to
+ Australia _via_ Singapore. Thus, you see, I was the only parson on
+ board; and as the ship's company was High Church, and I a
+ Dissenter, it may be seen that we did not fit each other exactly.
+ Some of the passengers were so High Church that one of them told me
+ he thought we Dissenters were sunk more deeply in error than the
+ Papists.
+
+ 'The captain was a sensible kind of rough seaman, and I at once
+ volunteered my services as chaplain, and was accepted, though with
+ some caution. He evidently thought me too young to be trusted with
+ a sermon; the Church of England prayers I might read, and he put
+ into my hands a book with a sermon for any Sunday and holy-day in
+ the year. I took the book and said I would look through it. The Bay
+ of Biscay was calm when we crossed it, but on Sunday morning we
+ were tumbling about off the Rock of Lisbon. As I could hardly keep
+ my legs, I did not think we should have had service; but we crowded
+ into the smoking-saloon (we were afraid to venture below, for
+ sickness), and I read prayers. Next Sunday I read a sermon from the
+ book. All the Sundays after that I gave them my own, and, as I was
+ under the impression that they had not heard much plain preaching,
+ did my best to let them hear the gospel pure and simple. I half
+ suspected they did not quite like it. It was hinted to me that they
+ complained of my preaching. The next Sunday came, and, under the
+ impression it might be the last time I would have the opportunity,
+ I made the most earnest and direct appeal to them I possibly could.
+ I was not a little thankful and astonished when, soon after, in
+ place of being asked to shut up, I was thanked for it, and assured
+ it was the best I had given them, and told that it was a waste of,
+ &c., &c., for me to go out as a missionary--I should have stopped
+ at home. After that I had no trouble with the passengers, and we
+ got on well together.
+
+ 'As for the men, from captain to cabin-boy there were about sixty.
+ Among these was one earnest Christian man, a German and a Baptist.
+ He was a quarter-master. He was a little peculiar in appearance,
+ and spoke English not quite smoothly. On one occasion, when some of
+ the passengers were laughing at something he had done and said, the
+ captain happened to pass, and, seeing what was up, remarked that
+ the man was a first-rate fellow--he never caught him idle. If you
+ except this man, the captain, and the boy, the whole ship's
+ company swore like troopers. So universal was the vice that the
+ men, I almost think, were hardly aware that they did swear. I was
+ puzzled. Sometimes when I went out in the morning I would hear a
+ volley of oaths coming from the mouth of a man who had been talking
+ quite seriously with me over-night.
+
+ Few of the men came to the service, and as they would not come to
+ us we went to them. Hardey and I, usually in the evenings,
+ conducted short little services in the forecastle as often as we
+ thought desirable. We were always well received and listened to
+ respectfully. I think I may say safely that all on board had
+ repeated opportunities of hearing the gospel as plainly as I could
+ put it, and a good many had something more than mere opportunities.
+ After it was dark I used to go out and get the men one by one, as
+ they sat in corners during their watch in the night. All they had
+ to do was to be within call when wanted, and many a good long talk
+ I have had with a good many of them. Of course, my object in
+ accosting them was religious conversation, and this I usually
+ succeeded in having; but on many occasions, that we might be quite
+ on a footing of equality, I had in return to listen to their yarns.
+ The man on the look-out was a frequent victim. I was always sure to
+ find a man there, generally alone, and never asleep. The man, also,
+ was changed at regular intervals, so that I knew exactly when I
+ would find a fresh man. When I talked to the look-out man, I used
+ to keep a sharp lookout myself, lest by distracting his attention I
+ should get him into trouble. Many a good hour have I stood at the
+ prow as we passed through the warm Indian Ocean, till my clothes
+ were wet with the dew of night; and then I would find my way down
+ to my cabin about midnight, with my head so full of the
+ ghost-stories I had just heard that I was really afraid I might
+ meet a real ghost coming out of my cabin.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+BEGINNING WORK
+
+
+In 1817 two missionaries, the Rev. E. Stallybrass and the Rev. W. Swan,
+left England to begin Christian work among the Buriats, a Mongolian
+tribe living under Russian authority. At Selenginsk and at Onagen Dome
+they laboured for many years; but in 1841 the Russian Emperor ordered
+them to leave the country. From the command of the autocrat there was no
+appeal, and the mission came to an end. But in the good providence of
+God the two missionaries had translated the whole Bible into Buriat; the
+Old Testament being printed in Siberia in 1840, the New Testament in
+London in 1846. Notwithstanding the suppression of the mission, the Word
+of God in the Mongol tongue continued to circulate among the people.
+
+It was to the reopening and development of this missionary work among
+the Mongol tribes that James Gilmour consecrated his life. He was
+appointed, in the first instance, to the London Mission at Peking, and
+that centre formed his first base of operations. He continued also a
+member of that mission until the close of his life. He reached the
+Chinese capital on May 18, 1870. At once he settled down to hard and
+continuous work at the Chinese language, endeavouring also from the
+first to discover the best means of restarting the Mongol Mission. The
+very full diary which he kept lies before us as we write, and enables us
+to understand the varying progress and hindrance, encouragement and
+despondency of this time.
+
+ '_June 11, 1870._--Mr. Gulick advises me to pay little attention to
+ the Chinese and go in hot and strong for the Mongolian. I am not
+ quite sure that he is not right, after all. However, I mean to
+ stick into the Chinese yet for a time to come with my teacher and
+ to mix among the people as much as I can. I went out to-night and
+ with the gate-keeper and two of his companions had a lot of talk,
+ in which I learned a good lot. I hope to benefit largely by this
+ pleasant mode of study. Perhaps by this means I may be able to do
+ them good. Lord grant it!'
+
+ '_June 12, 1870._--I am to-day twenty-seven years of age, and what
+ have I done? Let the time that is past suffice to have wrought the
+ will of the flesh. The prospect I have before me now is the most
+ inspiriting one any man can have. Health, strength, as much
+ conscious ability as makes one hope to be able to get the language
+ of the people to whom I am sent, a new field of work among men who
+ are decidedly religious and simple-minded, left pretty much to my
+ own ideas as to what is best to be done in the attempted
+ evangelization of Mongolia, friends left in Britain behind me
+ praying for me, comfort and peace here in the prosecution of my
+ present studies, the idea that what I do is for eternity, and that
+ this life is but the short prelude to an eternal state, the thought
+ that after death there shall break on my view a thousand truths
+ that now I long in vain to know--these thoughts and many others
+ make my present life happy, and in a manner careless as to what
+ should come. In time may I be able to do my part as I ought, and
+ may God have great mercy upon me!'
+
+On June 22, 1870, the news of the Tientsin massacre reached Peking. A
+Roman Catholic convent had been destroyed and thirteen French people
+killed. Very great uncertainty prevailed as to whether this indicated a
+further purpose of attacking all missions and all foreigners, and for a
+while things looked very dark. It was a time in which the nerve and
+courage and faith of men were severely tried, and splendidly did Gilmour
+endure the test. While unable to escape wholly from the fears common to
+all, his reply to the counsels of worldly prudence and selfish dread was
+advance in his work. When others were wondering whether they might not
+have to retreat, he, alone, in almost total ignorance of the language,
+entirely unfamiliar with the country, went up to the great Mongolian
+plain, and entered upon the service so close to his heart--personal
+intercourse with and effort for the Mongols.
+
+How trying a season this was his diary reveals. Under date of June 23,
+1870, the day after the first tidings of the outbreak had been received,
+he writes:--
+
+ 'The Roman Catholic missionaries have suffered severely, and the
+ Protestant missionaries are not in a very safe condition. We are
+ living on the slope of a volcano that may put forth its slumbering
+ rage at any moment. For example, people ask why there is no rain,
+ and blame the foreigners for it; and should a famine ensue, we may
+ fare hard for it. Now is the time for trying what stuff a man's
+ religion is made of. We may be all dead men directly; are we afraid
+ to die? Our death might further the cause of Christ more than our
+ life could do. We must die some time or other; now that we have a
+ near view of its possibility, how can we look forward to it? God!
+ do Thou make my faith firm and bright, so that death may seem
+ small and not to be feared. Help me to trust Thee and Christ
+ implicitly, so that with calm mind I may work while Thou dost let
+ me live, and when Thou dost call me home, let me come gladly.'
+
+The further entries in his Diary at this time depict his inner
+experience from day to day:--
+
+ '_July 10._--Rose 6.20. Dull morning, rained a little. Felt
+ uncomfortable at the idea of being killed; felt troubled at the
+ idea of leaving Peking. How am I to pack and carry my goods? Felt
+ troubled at remaining in the midst of a troubled city, with a
+ government weak and stupid. How is my mission to get on beginning
+ thus? O God, let me cast all my care upon Thee, and commit my soul
+ also to Thy safe keeping. Keep me, O God, in perfect peace! Rain
+ made a thin meeting this morning, but all was quiet. In afternoon
+ went with Mr. Edkins to the west; things uncommonly quiet and
+ peaceful.
+
+ '_July 12._--While others are writing to papers and trying to stir
+ up the feelings of the people, so that they may take action in the
+ matter, perhaps I may be able to do some good moving Heaven. My
+ creed leads me to think that prayer is efficacious, and surely a
+ day's asking God to overrule all these events for good is not lost.
+ Still, there is a great feeling that when a man is praying he is
+ doing nothing, and this feeling, I am sure, makes us give undue
+ importance to work, sometimes even to the hurrying over or even to
+ the neglect of prayer.
+
+ '_July 22._--A good deal troubled about the present state of
+ matters. I don't exactly know how to estimate rumours and reports,
+ and this may cause me more uneasiness than there is any need for.
+ Still, I don't know. At times I feel a great revulsion from being
+ killed, at other times I feel as if I could be killed quietly, and
+ not dislike the thing much. Sometimes the tone of those about us is
+ hopeful, and that causes hope also. Sometimes the prospect of a
+ speedy removal, a half flight, comes upon me with great force, and
+ to see all its annoyance, not to speak of the danger, is not
+ pleasant at all. Oh for the simple, childlike faith that can trust
+ all things to God and leave all care upon Him! Ought we not to have
+ it? Is God not the same God now that He was when He delivered His
+ people from Egypt, and His saints from the hands of their enemies,
+ from the mouth of the lions, and the fiery furnace? Cannot God keep
+ us yet--will He not do it? But then comes the thought, perhaps God
+ does not wish us to live, but to die. Often has He allowed His
+ saints to be slain. What then? Well, as the men in the furnace said
+ of God, "Will He care to defend us? if not, be it known unto you we
+ will not yield." I might have died in childhood, in youth, before
+ conversion, and if then, alas! alas! I can remember the time when
+ the pains of hell got such a terrible hold upon me that I would
+ have gladly changed places in the world with anyone who had the
+ hope of salvation. Death, life, prospects, honour, shame, seemed
+ nothing compared with this hope of salvation, which I was then
+ without. "Could I ever be saved?" was the question; "would I ever
+ have the hope that I knew others had?" Had I died in darkness--God
+ be thanked, the light has shined forth, and I have the hope of
+ eternal life. May God make me more Christlike, and give me stronger
+ hope! Well, then, this hope I have; from this fearful pit I have
+ been delivered; in the light I now walk. God I call my Father,
+ Christ my Saviour, heaven my home, earth and the life here the
+ entrance to real life. If there is anything in our faith or in our
+ belief, then heaven is as much better than earth as it is higher
+ than earth, and our souls life is insured from all harm. If a man
+ is insured against all possible harm, why should he be afraid? Not
+ one hair of our head shall perish! O Lord, help me to live this
+ faith and to be in this frame of mind. In this city are many
+ foreigners, who came here to learn the language, &c., and many of
+ them have no great hope of heaven. They seem calm enough, and are
+ no doubt calm enough; shall the courage of the world, shall the
+ courage of scepticism, shall the courage of carelessness be greater
+ and produce better fruit than the courage of the Christian? O Lord,
+ preserve me from the sin of dishonouring Thy name through fear and
+ cowardice! Let us be bold in the Lord!'
+
+By the end of July 1870, Gilmour had reached a fixed resolution to go to
+Mongolia as soon as the necessary arrangements could be made. A severe
+test had been applied to him, and the way in which he met it gives the
+key to the whole of his after life. He used the trial as a help onwards
+in the path of duty, and the chain of events which would have led many
+men to postpone indefinitely the beginning of a new and hard work only
+drove him the more eagerly into new fields. The reasons that influenced
+him are set forth in his official report written many months later.
+
+ 'After the massacre at Tientsin, very grave fears prevailed at
+ Peking; no one could tell how far the ramifications of the plot
+ might extend, and it was impossible to sift the matter. The people
+ openly talked of an extermination, and claimed to have the tacit
+ favour of the Government in this; nay more, the Government itself
+ issued ambiguous, if not insinuating, proclamations, which fomented
+ the excitement of the populace to such an extent that the days were
+ fixed for the "Clearing of Peking." The mob was thoroughly quieted
+ on the first of the days fixed by a twenty hours' pour of
+ tremendous rain, which converted Peking into a muddy, boatless
+ Venice, and kept the people safely at home in their helpless felt
+ shoes, as securely as if their feet had been put into the stocks.
+ This was Friday. Tuesday was the reserve day; Saturday and Sabbath
+ one felt the tide of excitement rising, and on Monday morning the
+ Peking Gazette came out with an Imperial edict that at once allayed
+ the excitement, and assured us that there was no danger for the
+ present.
+
+ 'We had then to draw breath and look about us calmly, and the
+ general conclusion that the "Old Pekingers" came to was that the
+ French would be compelled to resort to force of arms to gain
+ redress. The attitude of the Chinese people and Government made
+ them think so, and so they determined to wait on quietly in Peking
+ till things should get thick, and then it would be time to go
+ south. I think I may safely say that everyone drew out an inventory
+ of his things, and not a few had their most necessary things packed
+ "on the sly," and were ready to start on short notice.
+
+ 'Up to this point I stood quietly aside; but now was my time to
+ reason, and on the data they supplied I reasoned thus: "If I go
+ south, no Mongol can be prevailed on to go with me, and so I am
+ shut out from my work, and that for an indefinite time. If I can
+ get away north, then I can go on with the language, and perhaps
+ come down after the smoke clears away, knowing Mongolian, and
+ having lost no time." I felt a great aversion to travelling so far
+ alone, and with such imperfect knowledge of the language, but as I
+ thought it over from day to day I was more and more convinced that
+ to run the risk of having to go south would be to prove unfaithful
+ to duty, and so I conferred no longer with likings or dislikings,
+ resolved to go should an opportunity offer, and in the meantime
+ worked away at Chinese.
+
+ 'By-and-by a Russian merchant turned up; he was going to Kiachta,
+ so I started with him. I could not go sooner, as it was not safe to
+ travel in the country before the Imperial edict was issued; to wait
+ longer was to run the risk of not going at all.'
+
+
+[Illustration: MAP ILLUSTRATING JAMES GILMOUR'S JOURNEYS ON THE GREAT
+PLAIN OF MONGOLIA]
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+MONGOLIAN APPRENTICESHIP
+
+
+The name Mongolia denotes a vast and almost unknown territory situated
+between China Proper and Siberia, constituting the largest dependency of
+the Chinese Empire. It stretches from the Sea of Japan on the east to
+Turkestan on the west, a distance of nearly 3,000 miles; and from the
+southern boundary of Asiatic Russia to the Great Wall of China, a
+distance of about 900 miles. It consists of high tablelands, lifted up
+considerably above the level of Northern China, and is approached only
+through rugged mountain passes. The central portion of this enormous
+area is called the Desert of Gobi.
+
+A kind of highway for the considerable commercial traffic between China
+and Russia runs through the eastern central part of Mongolia, leaving
+China at the frontier town of Kalgan, and touching Russia at the
+frontier town of Kiachta. Along this route during all but the winter
+months, caravans of camel-carts and ox-carts attended by companies of
+Mongols and Chinese are constantly passing. The staple export from China
+is tea; the chief imports are salt, soda, hides, and timber.
+
+The west and the centre of Mongolia is occupied by nomad Mongols. They
+have clusters of huts and tents in fixed locations which form their
+winter dwellings. But in summer they journey over the great plains in
+search of the best pasturage for their flocks and herds. They are
+consequently exceedingly difficult to reach by any other method than
+that of sharing their roving tent life. In the southeastern district of
+Mongolia there are large numbers of agricultural Mongols who speak both
+Chinese and Mongolian. The towns in this part are almost wholly
+inhabited by Chinese.
+
+The winter in Mongolia is both long and severe; in the summer the heat
+is often very oppressive, and the great Plain is subject to severe
+storms of dust, rain and wind.
+
+Buddhism is all-powerful, and the larger half of the male population are
+lamas or Buddhist priests. 'Meet a Mongol on the road, and the
+probability is that he is saying his prayers and counting his beads as
+he rides along. Ask him where he is going, and on what errand, as the
+custom is, and likely he will tell you he is going to some shrine to
+worship. Follow him to the temple, and there you will find him one of a
+company with dust-marked forehead, moving lips, and the never absent
+beads, going the rounds of the sacred place, prostrating himself at
+every shrine, bowing before every idol, and striking pious attitudes at
+every new object of reverence that meets his eye. Go to Mongolia itself,
+and probably one of the first great sights that meet your eye will be a
+temple of imposing grandeur, resplendent from afar in colours and gold.'
+
+'The Mongol's religion marks out for him certain seemingly indifferent
+actions as good or bad, meritorious or sinful. There is scarcely one
+single step in life, however insignificant, which he can take without
+first consulting his religion through his priest. Not only does his
+religion insist on moulding his soul, and colouring his whole spiritual
+existence, but it determines for him the colour and cut of his coat. It
+would be difficult to find another instance in which any religion has
+grasped a country so universally and completely as Buddhism has
+Mongolia.'[1]
+
+[1] _Among the Mongols_, p. 211.
+
+It was to the herculean task of attempting single-handed to evangelise a
+region and a people like this that James Gilmour addressed himself. His
+early journeys are fully set forth in _Among the Mongols_, and we do not
+propose to repeat them here. Our object rather is to depict, so far as
+possible, the inner life of James Gilmour, and the real nature of the
+work he accomplished. He left Peking on August 5, and reached Kalgan
+four days later. On August 27 he started for his first trip across the
+great plain of Mongolia to Kiachta. A Russian postmaster was to be his
+companion, but, to avoid travelling on Sunday, Gilmour started a day
+ahead, and then waited for the Russian to come up. Here is his first
+view of scenes he was so often in later life to visit.
+
+ '_Sabbath, August 28._--Awoke about 5 A.M. just as it was drawing
+ towards light, and saw that we were right out into the Plain.
+
+ 'I am writing up my diary, with a lot of people looking into my
+ cart. I have just given them a Mongol Catechism, and I hope it may
+ do them good. God, do Thou bless it to them! Would I could speak to
+ them, but I cannot. I am glad to be saved the trouble of travelling
+ to-day. My mind feels at rest for the present. I am looking about
+ me, and having my first look at the life I am likely to lead.
+ There are several more Mongol dwellings within sight, plenty of
+ camels, horses, and oxen. The Mongols have a tent of their own, and
+ the "commandant's" tent has also been put up. A Mongol has just
+ come up and changed his dress, his cloak serving him as a tent
+ meantime. I am hesitating whether to try to read in my cart or go
+ off a little way with my plaid and umbrella.
+
+ 'Had not a very intellectual or spiritual day after all. Went in
+ the afternoon away to the east. Had a good view and a time of
+ devotion at a cairn from which an eagle rose as I approached.
+ Returned to the camp and bought milk and some cheese. Intended to
+ make porridge, but the fire was not good on account of the blowing,
+ so I drank off my milk, ate some bread, and went to sleep.'
+
+The journey across the desert, including a visit to Urga, occupied a
+month. It was full of intense interest for the traveller, and many of
+the most abiding impressions of his life and work were then received.
+His diary reveals the deep yearnings of his heart for the salvation of
+the Mongols. Under the date September 11, 1870, he writes:--
+
+ 'Astir by daybreak. Camels watering; made porridge and tea. This is
+ the Lord's day; help me, O Lord, to be in the spirit, and to be
+ glad and rejoice in the day which Thou hast made! Several huts in
+ sight. When shall I be able to speak to the people? O Lord, suggest
+ by the Spirit how I should come among them, and guide me in gaining
+ the language, and in preparing myself to teach the life and love of
+ Christ Jesus! Oh, let me live for Christ, and feel day by day the
+ blessedness of a will given up to God, and the happiness of a life
+ which has its every circumstance working for my good!'
+
+ His constant rule was to rest from all journeying, so far as
+ possible, on the Sabbath. After another week's experience, on
+ September 18 he thus records his impressions:--
+
+ 'Encamped just over the plain we saw at sunset last night. We are
+ some distance from the real exit, but not far. This is the Lord's
+ day; God help me to be in the spirit notwithstanding all
+ distractions. Oh that God would give me more of His Spirit, more of
+ His felt Presence, more of the spirit and power of prayer, that I
+ may bring down blessings on this poor people of Mongolia! As I look
+ at them and their huts I ask again and again how am I to go among
+ them; in comfort and in a waggon, with all my things about me; or
+ in poverty, reducing myself to their level? If I go among them
+ rich, they will be continually begging, and perhaps regard me more
+ as a source of gifts than anything else. If I go with nothing but
+ the Gospel, there will be nothing to distract their attention from
+ the unspeakable gift.
+
+ '8.15 A.M.-3.15 P.M. Good long walk. Met camels and came upon a
+ cart encampment, estimated at one hundred and seventy. Know where I
+ am on the map. There is a camel encampment where we are. Two huts
+ from which comes fuel. Read to-day in II Chronicles xvi. God never
+ failed those who trusted in Him and appealed to Him. God was
+ displeased with the King of Judah because, after the deliverance
+ from the Lubims, Ethiopians, &c., he trusted to the arm of flesh to
+ deliver him from the Syrians. Do we not in our day rest too much on
+ the arm of flesh? Cannot the same wonders be done now as of old? Do
+ not the eyes of the Lord run to and fro throughout the whole earth,
+ still to show Himself strong on behalf of those who put their trust
+ in Him? Oh that God would give me more practical faith in Him!
+ Where is now the Lord God of Elijah? He is waiting for Elijah to
+ call on Him. God give me some of Elijah's spirit, and let my power
+ be of God, and my hope from Him for the conversion of this people.
+
+ 'It is nothing to the Lord to save by many or by them that have no
+ power. Help me, O God, for I rest on Thee, and in Thy name I go
+ against this multitude!'
+
+Kiachta, on the southern frontier of Siberia, was reached September 28,
+1870, and there Gilmour was at once plunged into a series of troubles.
+The Russian and Chinese authorities would not recognise his passport,
+and he had to wait months before another could be obtained from Peking.
+He found absolutely no sympathy in his work. He knew next to nothing of
+the Mongol language. Yet with robust faith, with whole-hearted courage,
+with a resolution that nothing could daunt, he set to work. A Scotch
+trader, named Grant, was kind to him, and found accommodation for him at
+his house. At first he tried the orthodox plan of getting a Mongol
+teacher to visit and instruct him. Before he secured one he used to
+visit such Mongols as he found in the neighbourhood, trying to acquire a
+vocabulary from them, asking the names of the articles they were using,
+their actions, and all such other matters as he could make them
+understand. But his loneliness, his ignorance of the language, the
+inaction to which he was condemned, partly by his difficulty in getting
+a suitable teacher, and partly by the uncertainty as to whether the
+authorities would allow him to remain, told upon his eager spirit as
+week after week passed by, and he became subject to fits of severe
+depression. Here is a picture of one of these early days. He had been
+trying to talk with a Buriat carpenter, in a place called Kudara, not
+far from Kiachta:--
+
+ 'After getting my quota of words I walked through the town. The
+ main object in it is the church, a large whitewashed structure
+ built by Mr. Grant's father-in-law when he was a rich man. He was
+ made poor, comparatively speaking, in one night by a great fire
+ which burnt up all before it. In addition to the church are some
+ streets of Cossack houses, desolate enough looking, the streets
+ desolate enough at best, but rendered much more so this morning by
+ the snow melting in the sun, which is still high, and manages to
+ thaw away all the snow that falls in places where it shines, though
+ it was frost all day in the shade. Passing the town I made for the
+ river, which rolled on quiet and cold. Passed through large
+ orchards of apple(?) trees; doubled about, went to the extreme
+ west, got on a hill, and came round home again in time for dinner
+ at 4 P.M. I felt very lonely, and not having a teacher I am thrown
+ idle, as it were, a great part of the day after I get my words. It
+ is true I am taking notice of all I see, but it always occurs to me
+ that this is not furthering the Mongolian Mission in any direct
+ way. I often think of what Dr. Alexander said in his charge at my
+ ordination: "_You do not go to discover new countries._" Would I
+ had a teacher, that the language might go on full swing! To-day I
+ felt a good deal like Elijah in the wilderness, when the reaction
+ came on after his slaughter of the priests of Baal. He prayed that
+ he might die. I wonder if I am telling the truth when I say that I
+ felt drawn towards suicide. I take this opportunity of declaring
+ strongly that on all occasions two missionaries should go together.
+ I was not of this opinion a few weeks ago, but I had no idea how
+ weak an individual I am. My eyes have filled with tears frequently
+ these last few days in spite of myself, and I do not wonder in the
+ least that Grant's brother shot himself. _Oh! the intense
+ loneliness of Christ's life_, not a single one understood Him! He
+ bore it. O Jesus, let me follow in Thy steps, and have in me the
+ same Spirit that Thou hadst!
+
+ 'Read papers in the evening (Oct 5). So Jones of Singrauli is dead!
+ I heard him in Exeter Hall, May, a year or two ago, and heard a
+ good deal of him through Dr. Evans, of Chestnut College. I am
+ persuaded he was a missionary among a thousand. When he returned to
+ his station he found that during his absence matters had got out of
+ order a good deal, and he set about putting them right. Now he is
+ dead! How prodigal God seems of His workers--Hartley, Jones, both A
+ 1, both gone. God's ways are not ours. We would have preserved
+ these two at all risk and expense, but God _takes_ them away, and
+ it seems to us as if He were hurting His own cause. God knows best,
+ but to _us_ it is a great mystery.'
+
+Two days later he received a letter telling him of the death of a
+brilliant young Glasgow student, and he enters in his diary comments
+which received only too complete an illustration in his own subsequent
+career:--
+
+ 'Another splendid student going from college to the grave. This is
+ a thing of common occurrence with reference to Glasgow College,
+ and, if I am not mistaken, I have seen it somewhere publicly
+ commented on. Men, poor it may be, strive through college with a
+ mind and determination beyond their circumstances and bodily
+ strength, fight a great battle with poverty and more clever
+ students, resolute to take the first place if possible, and just as
+ the college is finished with them, and sending them forth to the
+ field of life decorated with all the honours it can bestow, the
+ fond Alma Mater has to keep on mourning and drop her tear over an
+ early grave.
+
+ 'Are the young men to blame? Who can be restrained by the
+ cold-blooded calculation of preserving health? "There is my
+ opponent, I'll thrash him if I can; better to toil out my
+ life-blood drop by drop than let it mount to my cheek as a mantle
+ of shame when I find myself defeated when I might have been
+ victorious." Then they conscientiously work themselves to death. If
+ they did not work as hard as they do, and refrain from recreation
+ as they do, they would have in their breasts the uneasy feeling
+ that they have not done as much as they might have done; and what
+ noble nature can be content to live under that accusation written
+ against them by the supreme court in their own breasts?
+
+ 'Several times I have resolved to refrain for health's sake, but in
+ a short time found such an uneasy feeling about not doing as much
+ as I might, that I had to give it up and go at it. I _never_ feel
+ that I have done as much as I might, and when I am doing most I
+ feel best.'
+
+Very dissatisfied with his progress, and stung one day by a remark of
+Grant's to the effect that he did not seem to speak Mongolian readily,
+Gilmour changed his plans. He resolved to go out upon the Plain, and
+persuade some Mongol to allow him to share his tent. On December 13,
+1870, he left Kiachta and journeyed out into Mongolia to the first
+cluster of tents, named Olau Bourgass. There he found a friendly Mongol.
+'Grant's contractor. Found him at his prayers. He motioned me to sit
+down, and when his devotions were finished he gave me a warm welcome. He
+lives alone in his tent, having nothing to care for but the horses for
+the courier service, and a couple of lamas[2] to attend to his wants,
+one of whom goes with the letters when they come. We talked, and I
+learned a great deal, when at last I broke my mind to him, and was glad
+to find that he received it favourably. I settled to remain there during
+the night. Nothing very remarkable happened except that we were invaded
+by a great blustering lama, intoxicated. He came ramping into the tent
+as if he would have knocked everything down. After a time he went away
+and lodged in the next hut. I went to bed about ten and slept well,
+though my feet were cold towards morning.'
+
+[2] A lama is a priest of the lama section of Buddists. More than half
+the population of Mongolia are lamas.
+
+The next three months were passed mainly in this tent. Gilmour used,
+whenever possible, to return to Kiachta to spend the Sunday at Grant's
+house; but by enduring the hardships and suffering all the
+inconveniences of ordinary Mongol life he rapidly acquired the
+colloquial, and he also made an indelible impression upon the minds and
+hearts of the natives, who ever afterwards spoke of him as 'Our
+Gilmour.' He saw Mongol life as it was, free from all the illusion and
+romance sometimes thrown around it. He became intimately acquainted with
+the various Mongol types, and he began to enter into the native habits
+of thought. His diary contains many a scene like the following:--
+
+ 'I gave the lama a book on Saturday, and when I came back on
+ Tuesday I found he had read it through twice. He set upon me with
+ questions, getting me to admit premises, and then reasoned from
+ them. Christ being at the right hand of God was a great point with
+ him. If God has no form, how can anyone be at His right hand? Then,
+ again, if God is everywhere, Christ is everywhere right and left of
+ God, and how can that be?
+
+ 'The omnipresence was a staggerer. Was God in that pot, in the
+ tent, in his boot? Did he tread upon God? Then was God inside the
+ kettle? Did the hot tea not scald Him? Again, if God was inside the
+ kettle, the kettle was living! And so he held it up to the laughing
+ circle as a new species of animal. I asked him if a fly were inside
+ the kettle, would the kettle be alive? "No," he said; "but a fly
+ does not fill the space as God must do." "Well, then," said I, "is
+ my coat alive because I fill it?" This settled the question.'
+
+In March 1871 he visited Selenginsk and Onagen Dome, the scene of the
+labours of Stallybrass and Swan from 1817 to 1841, and then he took a
+run into Siberia, crossing Lake Baikal and visiting Irkutsk. At the
+latter place he reviews the past few months:--
+
+ 'Another week has passed over my head with many hopes and fears.
+ This day, a week ago, I was nearing Ana in doubt as to many things;
+ now I am in Irkutsk, having my path marked with mercies. In many
+ points of my journey I expected difficulties which might have
+ stopped me short in my path, but all these have disappeared, and I
+ am here, having succeeded beyond expectations. One thing is not
+ right: my readiness to forget the ways in which God has helped me.
+ Sometimes for weeks and months I look forward to some crisis which
+ is coming; it comes off well, and in two days I am as if I had
+ forgotten that to which I had looked forward with so much
+ apprehension. In this manner I am not only guilty of ingratitude,
+ but lose much joy and strength of faith and hope. What should make
+ me more happy than the thought of the helps and deliverances that
+ God has vouchsafed me; and in troubles present and to come, what
+ can give me more faith and courage than to remember that out of
+ such troubles I was delivered before?
+
+ 'One thing I sometimes think of. I left Britain with no intention
+ of travelling; I expected to settle down quietly and confine myself
+ to a circle I could impress. This plan has been completely changed
+ and overruled. Two months have I been in Peking; two weeks have I
+ been in Kalgan; a month have I been in the desert; a month have I
+ been in Kudara, a small Russian frontier military post; a month and
+ a half have I been in Kiachta; two months have I been in Mongolia;
+ and now two weeks have I been travelling in Russia. A year and a
+ month have elapsed since I left home, and during that time I have
+ been walking to and fro on the face of the earth, and going up and
+ down in it. In this way I have not found my life at all dull, but
+ very stirring. Indeed, many people would have left home to travel
+ as I have done. I sought it not; it came, and I took it. So as yet
+ I have no hardships to complain of. To see the places and things I
+ have seen--Liverpool, Wales, Rock of Lisbon, Gibraltar, Malta,
+ Egypt, Port Said, Canal, Suez, Red Sea, Cape Gardafui, Indian
+ Ocean, Penang, Straits of Malacca, Singapore, Hong Kong, Shanghai,
+ Tientsin, Peking, Kalgan, Desert, Urga, Kiachta, Russia, Baikal,
+ Irkutsk--only even to see these, men will make long journeys. I
+ have seen them all without seeking them, with the exception of
+ Baikal and Irkutsk. These are all by the way, and I dwell upon them
+ as proofs that God, in sending His servants from home and kindred,
+ often gives them pleasure and worldly enjoyment on the way, which
+ He does not promise, and which they have no right to expect.'
+
+After another but briefer sojourn at Olau Bourgass he set out on his
+return journey, visited Urga, then crossed the great plain on horseback
+in the course of fourteen days, and reached Kalgan on June 11. After a
+rest there he made two excursions into Mongolia, visiting Lama Miao,
+one of the great Mongol religious centres, in the first; and occupying
+some weeks with a further spell of Mongol tent life during the second.
+
+His diary, under date of September 22, 1871, while he was resting at
+Kalgan, thus sums up his experiences:--
+
+ 'I desire to-day to look back on the way by which the Lord has led
+ me for the last year. In September 1870 I was looking out eagerly,
+ anxiously for someone who was going to Russia, that I might go with
+ him. I could find no one. I made it a subject of prayer, and at
+ last, when I was on my knees, in came McCoy to tell me of a Russian
+ who was going up without delay. I saw the Russian, and arranged to
+ go, and started. "While they are speaking I will answer them."
+
+ 'On the journey between Peking and Kalgan I was alone, I may say,
+ and could speak little Chinese, yet I got on very well; and though
+ my money was in a box on the back of a donkey, yet it came in all
+ safe, none lost. In Kalgan I had difficulty at first about finding
+ camels, but at length the Russian postmaster turned out to be going
+ home. The time when was uncertain, quite; his departure depended on
+ the coming of his successor. I prayed about this, and one day was
+ informed that the successor had arrived much sooner than was
+ expected, and that we were to start in a day or two. We did start,
+ and after a prosperous journey arrived safely at Kiachta.
+
+ 'There I found Grant and Hegemann, two Englishmen. I went to live
+ in Grant's country house at Kudara. A difficulty arose about a
+ teacher. I prayed about this, and strolling along came upon a tent
+ in which was a man who was out of employment, and he being
+ educated, I engaged him to be my teacher. In Kiachta, after some
+ delay, I got a teacher, but not to my satisfaction. After I had
+ been with him a time Grant remarked one day that I did not seem to
+ be making much progress in the language. This stung me to the
+ quick, and made me go down into Mongolia. Here I was directed to
+ the tent of Grant's contractor, and with him I made arrangements to
+ live. I thank God for not permitting me to get a good teacher in
+ Kiachta. Had I got a good teacher there, I would simply have
+ remained there, and I am sure would not have learned half as much
+ of the language as I did in the tent at Mongolia, would have got
+ none of the insight I gained into the style of Mongolian life, and
+ would not have got the introduction I had there to numerous
+ Mongols. At the time I was immensely chagrined that I could not get
+ a proper teacher, but now, after the lapse of only a few months, I
+ can see good reason for thanking God for leading me by that way.
+ This should teach me to trust God more than I do when things seem
+ to thwart my purpose.
+
+ 'Again, I was under a great disappointment about the delay that
+ occurred in the sending of my passport from Peking. In consequence
+ of its not coming I was unable to go to Urga with Lobsung and
+ Sherrub in February. I felt it much at the time, but some months
+ after (in June) I learned that these men with whom I wanted to go
+ suffered excessively on the road; so much so that, had I gone with
+ them, I might have got my feet frozen and died with the cold. Here
+ again I have to praise God for not giving me my own way.
+
+ "Thy way, not mine, O Lord;
+ However dark it be."
+
+ 'Then, again, I had long desired to visit the scene of the former
+ Siberian Mission, and through the mercy of Providence I was
+ permitted to do this. My journey back through the desert also was
+ marked by mercies. Truly I may stand and say,
+
+ "When all Thy mercies, O my God,
+ My rising soul surveys,
+ Transported with the view, I'm lost
+ In wonder, love, and praise."'
+
+
+
+After his wanderings even Kalgan was a haven of rest, and he had secured
+there a base of operations. 'Now,' he writes, 'that I have got my study
+window pasted up, and a nice little stove set going, it seems so
+comfortable that it would be snug to stay where I am. But comfort is not
+the missionary's rule. My object in going into Mongolia at this time is
+to have an opportunity of reviewing and extending my knowledge of the
+colloquial, which has become a little rusty consequent upon its disuse
+to a great extent while here, trying to get up the written.'
+
+All who are even superficially acquainted with Chinese matters know how
+difficult it is to acquire the colloquial, and still more the written
+language. Mongolian is not nearly so difficult, but it presents a task
+needing vigour of intellect and strength of will. Both of these Gilmour
+possessed in a measure far above the average.
+
+'In the written,' he states on October 7, 1871, 'I am still far from at
+home. Most of the Bible I can read slowly and at sight. Many words I can
+write. I think I could write a bad letter myself alone. The other day I
+did so. My teacher said it was well written, and said also he rejoiced
+in the progress of his scholar; but I put this down to mere politeness.'
+
+During this visit he stayed in the tent of a Mongol named Mahabul, who
+lived there with his wife and an only son, a lama. They were all much
+addicted to the use of whisky.
+
+ '_October 14, '71._--To-day rose before the sun, read words, wrote
+ at the account of my journey from Urga, went to the mountain for
+ devotion, revisited the silver worker, who is making the bride's
+ ornaments, dined, visited the Norying's lama son, who fell from a
+ horse and broke his leg, had tea, and went to visit tents a mile or
+ two to the south. There found, as master of the tent, a blackman (a
+ layman) I had seen before, and as visitor a lama I had left in
+ Mahabul's tent when I went out. From one thing to another we got to
+ speak of God and His book. At last they asked me to read them a
+ portion. I read in English a few verses, and then gave them the
+ parable of the Prodigal Son in Mongol colloquial. I also gave them
+ a specimen of a sermon, and explained shortly the nature of God,
+ when they all seemed pleased. The lama finished up the thing by
+ saying, "Your outward appearance differs from us, but inwardly you
+ agree with us." Coming home I felt amply repaid for all the
+ uncomfort and solitude, and leading a Mongol life, by the
+ comparative ease with which I can converse with them, and the
+ manner in which they wonder at my proficiency in the colloquial.'
+
+In his official report he rapidly summarises the achievements of the
+last nine months:--
+
+ 'By the middle of February I had a limited knowledge of the
+ colloquial, picked up from listening to and joining in the
+ conversation going on among the inmates of the tent at Olau
+ Bourgass, and those with the numerous visitors who took occasion to
+ call on my lama, who was rather a famous man. At the end of
+ February the lama returned south to Urga, and I went back into
+ Russia, and got a Buriat teacher. This individual, however, turned
+ out so incredibly lazy, and I felt so dull alone in my large
+ comfortable rooms, after the friendly bustle and crowd of the
+ little tent, with its cheery fire, that I could not stand it. So I
+ got my teacher and myself into a tarantass, and went off to visit
+ the scenes of the former mission in Siberia. My teacher proved very
+ useful. He spoke Russian very well, I spoke Mongolian to him, and
+ thus we travelled, the doubtful wonder of all Russians, who could
+ not understand how a man not born a Buriat could get acquainted
+ with that language, and yet know no Russian. After visiting the
+ converts, partly for the sake of diverting the curious eyes of the
+ Russians from the great aim of my journey and partly in the
+ traveller's spirit, I turned westward and crossed the Baikal on the
+ ice, and remained a few days in the capital of Siberia, Irkutsk. On
+ returning to Kiachta I found another teacher, and went out for
+ another month into Mongolia and tent life. All the while that I was
+ in Mongolia I used to return to Kiachta once a week, usually on
+ Saturday, and abide in the land of habitations till Monday.
+
+ 'Early in May I started for the south. I had intended to remain
+ over the summer in Urga, but unexpected difficulties turned up, and
+ led me to decide on going down to Kalgan at once. From Urga to
+ Kalgan (600 miles) was done on horseback, accompanied by a single
+ Mongol; and as we carried no luggage, we had to depend on the
+ hospitality of the Mongols for lodging and cooking, or, as they
+ call the latter, "pot and ladle."
+
+ 'In this way I saw a very great deal of tent life during the twelve
+ or thirteen days the ride lasted. I got into Kalgan just two days
+ before the rainy season came on (June 15), and having, after
+ difficulty, secured a teacher, passed the summer in Kalgan studying
+ the book language and practising writing. In October I went up
+ again to the grassland and spent some weeks revising my knowledge
+ of the colloquial and observing the difference between the northern
+ and southern manner of speaking. I finally left Mongolia in a
+ furious storm on the morning of November 1, and re-entered Peking
+ November 9.'
+
+Gilmour on his return was naturally an object of great interest to all
+the missionary and to some of the official community. He soon settled
+down to the study of Chinese, and to such mission work as he could
+usefully engage in during the winter at Peking. A letter to the writer,
+under date of January 21, 1872, enables us to realise somewhat the life
+of this period:--
+
+ 'My dear Lovett,--Though I acknowledged receipt of your last
+ welcome epistle, I am aware I owe you a return, and here it is ...
+ I have thought that perhaps an account of how a Sabbath goes in
+ Peking might not be uninteresting, and I'll just confine myself to
+ to-day. Well, this morning, on getting up, I found my stove was
+ out. This is a very unusual thing, but it just happens once, say,
+ in three weeks. The thermometer was about 5 deg. The first thing after
+ getting dressed was not to call my servant, as you might suppose,
+ but to go in quest of letters. A mail had come in the night before,
+ but I had returned home too late last night to see it. So I went
+ over to Dr. Dudgeon's house before he was up, prowled about till I
+ found the mail, but there was nothing for me. I returned to my cold
+ room, and was there till the breakfast-bell rang. I board with
+ Edkins, and to go there is a pleasant break in the monotony.
+
+ 'On coming back to my quarters I found the room full of smoke,
+ doors and windows open, my boy on his knees fussing about the
+ stove, and saying, _Moo too poo shing_--"the wood won't do." I saw
+ at once that that would not do for me, so I buttoned up my coat and
+ went out on to the great street for a walk. The street on which we
+ live, the Ha Ta Mun (great street), runs north and south, and a
+ cold wind was blowing down the road, carrying clouds of dust with
+ it. Through the dust, however, were visible the paraphernalia of
+ two funerals, one going north, the other going south. They met just
+ opposite our place. That going south was much the grander of the
+ two, and had a long procession of people carrying emblematical
+ devices, honorific umbrellas, drums, gongs, and musical
+ instruments. Ever and anon a man took quantities of paper discs
+ with square holes cut in the centre and scattered them to the north
+ wind. The papers are supposed to represent cash, and were scrambled
+ for eagerly by the urchins, though they could be valuable only as
+ waste paper. In the procession also was carried the chair in which
+ the deceased used to ride, his mule cart also figured conspicuous,
+ and then came the mourners.
+
+ 'As you know, mourning garb in China is _white_, and I noticed that
+ some of the mourners had adopted a neat device. All Chinamen who
+ can afford to be warm in winter wear robes lined inside with fur. A
+ rich robe is lined with fine material, but the common thing is
+ white lambskin. Well, these fellows simply become turn-coats for
+ the time, and put on their fur robes inside out, and thus were in
+ the fashion. The coffin itself was laid in a magnificent bier
+ towering high, surmounted by a gilt top piece, hung with silks, and
+ borne by forty-eight bearers.
+
+ 'Of course everything has to make way for the funeral. The Peking
+ streets are very wide, and at the same time very narrow. In the
+ centre and high up is a cart road with an up and a down line, along
+ the sides of this are ditches and holes, beyond these ditches and
+ holes is another way more or less passable, and beyond that again
+ the shops. The funeral procession took the crown of the road, crept
+ along at its snail's pace, while the traffic took to the side
+ roads.
+
+ 'After a good long walk among stalls and wheelbarrows I got back to
+ my abode, found a good fire, and that it was high time to go to the
+ Chinese service. I don't understand all I hear, but I understand
+ some, and make a point of hearing one and sometimes two Chinese
+ sermons on the Sabbath. An old Chinaman was preaching, and I could
+ see from the manner of the congregation that he was securing the
+ fixed attention of his hearers. Before the sermon was ended there
+ was a bustle at the door, and in came three Mongols with my Chinese
+ card. They were asked to wait till the service was concluded, then
+ I took them to my quarters and had some conversation with them. One
+ of them had come for the doctor, and wished to get cured of so
+ prosaic a disease as the itch.
+
+ 'Before I was finished with them, my servant came to say that
+ another Mongol had called for me and was waiting for me in
+ Edkins's. When I went over I found an old Mongol, a blackman,
+ fifty-eight years of age. This layman was named Amaesa, and has been
+ in the habit of paying Mr. Edkins visits every winter when he comes
+ down to Peking. Last year he did not come, and we were concluding
+ that he had died. Of course we were glad to see him. I got him into
+ my room and we had quite an afternoon of it. The old man knew a
+ good deal about Christianity, and I gave him what additional
+ instruction I could. Of all the Mongols I have seen he is, perhaps,
+ the most ready to receive instruction.
+
+ 'It was quite late in the afternoon before he left, and I had just
+ time to take a walk at sunset and be back in time for dinner.
+ Immediately after that the people began to assemble for evening
+ service. This is held every Sabbath evening in Mr. Edkins's
+ parlour. Upwards of twenty usually compose the congregation. The
+ missionaries take the service in turn. After service the mass of
+ the congregation separated, but one man came with me to my room,
+ and there we sat talking till midnight, when my visitor rose to
+ depart.
+
+ 'There, you see, I have given you the history of one Sabbath in
+ Peking. It is a pretty fair sample of what goes on here very
+ frequently. However, when I find myself free on the afternoon I
+ accompany Mr. Edkins to some one of the two chapels, which are in
+ distant parts of the city. I do not go so much to hear him preach
+ as to have his conversation on the way there and back, and, as you
+ may suppose, we sometimes stumble upon an argument, and this makes
+ it quite lively.'
+
+The self-denying and arduous labours of his first sojourn in Mongolia
+had given to James Gilmour a knowledge of the language and an
+acquaintance with the nomadic Mongols of the Plain far in excess of that
+possessed by any other European. But even then, as also at a later date,
+the question was raised whether more fruitful work might not be done
+among the agricultural Mongols inhabiting the country to the north-east
+of Peking. Hence, on April 16, 1872, he started on his first journey
+through the district in which in later years the closing labours of his
+life were to be accomplished. He spent thirty-seven days in this
+preliminary tour, and travelled about 1,000 miles.
+
+Gilmour's first estimate of this region as a field of missionary
+enterprise, expressed on April 25, 1872, remained true to the end, even
+though in later years the exceptional difficulties of work among the
+nomads induced him at last, as we shall see, to settle among the
+agricultural Mongols:--
+
+ 'Though I saw a good many Mongol houses, yet I must say, I do not
+ feel much drawn to them in preference to the nomad Mongols. The
+ only possible recommendation I can think of is that, coming among
+ them, I might go and put up for some days at a time in a Chinese
+ inn. This would save me from great trouble in getting
+ introductions, and it might be less expensive. The great objection
+ I have to them is that, though a mission were established among
+ them, it would be more a mission in China than anywhere else. The
+ Mongols in these agricultural villages speak Chinese to a man, and
+ I cannot help feeling that, since there are so many missionaries in
+ Peking speaking the Chinese language, these Mongols fall to them,
+ and not to me.'
+
+Soon after his return from this trip into Eastern Mongolia, Mr. Gilmour
+sent home an elaborate report upon the conditions and prospects of the
+Mongol Mission. He deals with the whole question of the work, showing
+why, in his opinion, the _agricultural_ Mongols should be evangelised by
+Chinese missionaries. Mr. Edkins and others thought that Gilmour should
+undertake that labour, but after having seen more than any missionary of
+both regions and classes of Mongols, on the ground that he was the man
+'who had to go and begin,' he decided for the Plain.
+
+Even at this early date Mr. Gilmour urged repeatedly and strenuously
+upon the Directors the pressing need he felt for a colleague. And thus
+early began the long series of seeming fatalities that prevented him
+from ever receiving this joy and strength. Partly from the needs of the
+Peking Mission, and partly from respect to a notion which the American
+Board of Foreign Missions had that their occupancy of Kalgan, on the
+extreme southern limit, constituted _all_ Mongolia into one of their
+fields of work, the Rev. S. E. Meech, Mr. Gilmour's old college friend,
+who had been designated as his first colleague, was stationed at Peking.
+With reference to this, in closing the report above referred to, Gilmour
+wrote:--
+
+ 'Mr. Meech's perversion from Mongolia to China is much to be
+ deplored. I think it would be wrong in me not to inform you of the
+ true state of matters, and to remind you that it is little short of
+ nonsense to speak of reopening the Mongolian Mission so long as
+ there is only one man in the field. I am fully aware of the
+ difficulty of finding suitable men, and most fully sympathise with
+ you, but don't let us delude ourselves with the idea of Mongol
+ Mission work progressing till another man or two come and put their
+ shoulder to the wheel. All that I can do I am quite willing to do,
+ but my own progress is most seriously hampered because I am alone.'
+
+His whole subsequent life is evidence of the splendid way in which
+Gilmour justified these words, yet perhaps no legitimate blame can be
+laid at the door of the Directors of the London Missionary Society. Both
+the friends and the critics of missions are sometimes more ready to
+tabulate converts than to ponder and estimate aright the difficulties
+and drawbacks of the work. But in any estimate of the comparative
+success and failure of the Mongol Mission it should be borne in mind
+that Gilmour never really had a colleague. He never even had a companion
+for his work on the Plain, except his heroic and devoted wife. And in
+later years circumstances over which the Directors could exercise little
+or no control successively deprived him of the fellowship, after a very
+brief experience, of Dr. Roberts and Dr. Smith.
+
+In the summer of this year, in the company of Mr. Edkins, he visited the
+sacred city of Woo T'ai Shan, a famous place of Mongol pilgrimage.
+
+An amusing illustration of his well-known love of argument occurred on
+this trip. In Mr. Edkins he found a foeman in all respects worthy of
+his dialectic steel. Chinese mules will only travel in single file, even
+where the roads are wide enough to allow of their travelling abreast,
+and as Gilmour's went in front of that ridden by Mr. Edkins, he used to
+ride with his face to the tail of his beast, and thus the more readily
+and continuously conduct the argument then engaging their attention.
+
+In November he tried the experiment of living at the Yellow Temple in
+Peking during the winter, in order that he might meet and converse with
+the numerous Mongols who visit the capital every year. Here he not only
+made new friends, but he also frequently renewed acquaintance with those
+he had met on the Plain. These visited him in his compound, and were
+occasionally a weariness and vexation to him, inasmuch as they very
+frequently severely tried his patience, without affording him the
+comfort of knowing that the good tidings of the 'Jesus book' were
+finding an entrance into their dark minds and hard hearts.
+
+In a letter to an intimate college friend, the Rev. T. T. Matthews of
+Madagascar, which he wrote, November 21, 1872, he vividly describes this
+part of his work, giving some of his typical experiences:--
+
+ 'I am writing in the Yellow Temple, about a mile and a half from
+ Peking, and three or four miles from our mission premises. I have
+ rented a room, brought my Chinaman servant, and live as a Chinaman,
+ all but the clothes and the paganism. The reason of all this is
+ that near here, and in this temple, numerous Mongols put up when
+ they come from Mongolia to Peking. Our premises being three or four
+ miles away, and in a busy part of the town, the Mongols can't
+ easily find our place; so if they can't come to me I just go to
+ them. I came here yesterday, and can't tell yet how I may get on.
+ Mongols are shy in Peking, and even out here a little difficult of
+ access; but I must do what I can, and have patience.
+
+ 'Just now a company of eight or ten have arrived and put up, three
+ or four of them in the same court with me, the others in a place
+ close by. These are likely enough to come to see me; of course I'll
+ go and see them. You in Madagascar, I suppose, can't realise what
+ it is to be a missionary to a people whom you can't approach
+ without difficulty. Here the difficulty does not end; those I can
+ catch don't care one straw for Christianity. They have a system
+ which quite satisfies them, and what more do they want? Such is
+ their feeling, so you see I have got quite plenty to do; a hard
+ enough task, even the human part of it. But don't mistake, I am not
+ bewailing my lot, for that I have neither time nor inclination; I
+ am only telling you about my state.
+
+ 'I don't believe much in people talking about what they mean to do
+ in the future, but perhaps you will permit me to say that I would
+ like to start for Mongolia again in February or March. I have got a
+ sheepskin coat, so need not fear the cold. I perhaps may take with
+ me a stock of made-up medicines for specific diseases which are
+ common, and this may make an introduction in some cases at least.
+ Dr. Dudgeon has on our premises in Peking a hospital well attended
+ by Chinamen, and I go there sometimes and see how he doses them.
+
+ 'Now let me tell you a little about the inner life of Mongols.
+ People travelling through Mongolia wake up in the morning as their
+ camel-cart passes some rural encampment; they rub their eyes and
+ say, "How pleasant it would be to live in Mongolia like these
+ Mongols, free from care and the anxiety of busy life. They have
+ only their sheep, &c., to look after." This reflection is
+ accompanied with a sigh when they reflect on their own hard lot.
+ Now the fact of the matter is, these travellers know nothing about
+ it. They may print as much as they like about the pastoral felicity
+ of the simplicity of Mongol life; it is all humbug. Last night, two
+ Mongols whom I know well, a petty chief named "Myriad Joy" and his
+ scribe named "Mahabul" (I can't translate this last), came into my
+ room, and we had a tea-spree there and then. The two have been for
+ fifteen days in Peking on Government duty, and last night their
+ business was finished, and they were to mount their camels and head
+ north this morning. The chief gets from Peking about 30_l._ a year,
+ the scribe about 4_l._; and when they come thus on duty their
+ allowances, though small, enable them to make a little over and
+ above their salaries. The chief can stand no small amount of
+ Chinese whisky. I suspect he is deep in debt, and am sure that he
+ could pay his debt two or three times over if he only had the money
+ it took to paint his nose. The scribe was one of my teachers in
+ Mongolia. I lived in his house some time, and know only too well
+ about his affairs. He is hopelessly in debt. He had a large family
+ once, but now they are all dead except one married daughter and one
+ lama son about seventeen years of age, and good for nothing. His
+ "old woman," as the Mongol idiom has it, is still alive, and fond
+ of whisky, like her husband. If they had only been teetotalers they
+ might have now been comfortable; such, at least, is my impression.
+ I shall say nothing about what I saw in his tent, and confine
+ myself to last night and this morning.
+
+ 'Drinking my tea last night, Mahabul (the scribe) says to me: "My
+ chief here won't lend me nine shillings to buy a sheepskin coat for
+ my old woman, therefore she must be frozen to death in the winter;
+ my chief won't lend _me_ anything, other people he lends." The
+ chief said nothing for a while; but the scribe went on harping on
+ this string, till at last the chief launched out right and left on
+ his scribe, shouting loud enough for all the compound to hear. The
+ scribe took it coolly, and stopped him, saying: "Enough, enough; it
+ is past, it is past; my old woman can die, all die; no matter."
+ This did not soothe the irate chief at all, and a minute or two
+ later a furious quarrel broke out between them about something
+ else. The storm raged a long time, and in my room too, while they
+ were my guests! After some time the scribe left the room to attend
+ to the camels, when the chief confided to me his opinion of his
+ scribe. Later the chief left the room, and the scribe confided to
+ me his opinion of his chief; and I must say that the two seemed
+ well matched, with very little to choose between. The freedom with
+ which they spoke of each other was partly to be accounted for by
+ the fact that both were more or less drunk.
+
+ 'The chief squared up his accounts with the people about here, and
+ showed me in the scribe's absence a small parcel of silver which he
+ had reserved for use on the road. He showed it me under strict
+ injunctions not to tell the scribe. The scribe had more difficulty
+ in squaring up _his_ account. The last item that stuck in his
+ throat was a little bill his son had left. This son had started a
+ day or two before, and of course the father was responsible for the
+ debt. How he was to pay it he did not know, as he had not a single
+ cash about him. The Chinaman of the place threatened to detain him,
+ and the scribe laughed a bitter laugh at the idea. After a great
+ row they went off to sleep.
+
+ 'This morning early the scribe was at me before I was dressed. It
+ was the small debt again. The Chinaman knew better than to seize
+ the man; that would not have paid; he seized his coat, and actually
+ was detaining that as ransom for a sum equal to fourpence English!
+ He made a direct appeal to me to pay it, and of course I did it;
+ though I was a little disgusted with the man's meanness, as I had
+ given him a present of money amounting to about 1_l._ a few days
+ before. This son of his is a great eyesore to me. He is a young
+ lama, about as wicked a boy as I know. His brothers died of
+ consumption, and this fact enables him to do anything he likes with
+ his parents. If they refuse anything, he has only to feign
+ sickness, and they are in a huge state over him. He is a thoroughly
+ bad lad. Will not work, will not study, will do nothing but make
+ trouble and expense for his parents. Just fancy! His father and
+ mother are poor as church mice; and when his father was coming to
+ Peking the boy must beg to come too, and the father like a fool
+ must take him, and be at great expense for travelling, &c. One
+ thing made me furious. Out of the money I gave him he spent about
+ 4_s._ or more buying his good-for-nothing son an elegant
+ snuff-bottle. In short, the man's folly makes it utterly useless to
+ help him. I once before relieved him from threatened detention for
+ debt for the amount of twopence-halfpenny, just after I had made
+ him a present, and I expect perhaps to have to do so again. What
+ astonishes me is that the Mongols _can_ get into debt so far. I
+ don't believe my Mongol can pass a single man he knows without
+ being in danger of being dunned for some hopeless debt or other.
+ And yet his debt does not seem to distress him. He is most
+ distressed because people will not lend him more money.
+
+ 'The last of the chiefs was rather rich. He is (he says) to have a
+ profitable piece of Government work in hand in spring, and on the
+ strength of that wanted me to lend him now a shoe of silver, about
+ 15_l._, to be repaid to me in spring. Of course I did not. He then,
+ though my guest, kept on saying, "Heart small, heart small," which
+ pretty much amounts to saying, "Coward, coward." He finally took
+ revenge by offering to lend _me_ a shoe of silver in spring, but
+ of course I declined. A pretty pair they are! If what they say be
+ true, in spring they may make a good thing of it; but this has
+ happened to the scribe before, and in two months after he was as
+ poor as ever. In short, they are foolish and thriftless.
+
+ 'While I have been writing this letter I have overheard my Chinese
+ servant saying, in reply to a question from a Chinaman, "There is
+ such a thing as a preaching letter: you can preach by a letter." So
+ I am going now to preach. Don't get weary; stick to it. Don't be
+ lazy, but don't be in a hurry. Slow but sure; stick to it. We have
+ no great effort to make, but rather to stick to it patiently. "_No
+ good work is lost_," Sir William Thomson used to say in his
+ philosophy class, and it is eminently true in our case. (I wish
+ these Chinamen would hold their tongue.) All our good work will be
+ found, there is no doubt about that. All I am afraid of is that our
+ good work will amount to little when it is found. (These Chinamen
+ are a bore.) I sometimes think that if all we say be true, as it
+ is, that men at last shall stand before God--and we shall see them
+ after they know that all we say is true--and they will pitch into
+ us for not pitching into them more savagely; for not, in fact,
+ taking them by the "cuff" of the neck and dragging them into the
+ kingdom of God. I speak now of our countrymen and foreigners. As
+ regards heathen, they too shall stand revealed; and their mud gods
+ also, and rotten superstitions, shall stand revealed: how then
+ shall we feel when they shall look at us and blame us for not
+ waking them up more vigorously? An infidel has said that if he
+ could believe that men's future state depended at all upon what was
+ done in this life, he would let nothing hinder him from being up
+ and at men. He would be content to be counted a madman--anything,
+ if only he could do anything to make men's state better in the
+ world to come. (I wish these Chinamen would shut up; I came here to
+ meet Mongols, and I am like to be flooded out by Chinamen whose
+ language I only half understand.)
+
+ 'Now, _we believe_: how much do we do? Are there not some men whom
+ we might stir up who now escape? Could we do more? Are not souls
+ valuable enough for us to face anything if only we can save some?
+ Let us look to the end, or rather let us look at the present. In
+ the room in which I now write (the Chinamen have gone) is Jesus,
+ where you read this is Jesus: He stands and looks to us. He has
+ given up the clean heaven, and walked here and lived among dirt and
+ poverty, in solitude, misunderstood, without one intelligent
+ friend; He has borne the scorn of men, He has been put to the
+ horrible and shameful death of the cross, _all to save us_ and
+ others. We trust Him, He saves us; and all He asks is that we
+ should tell men about what He has done; and is there one man we
+ meet to whom we shall not speak? shall Christ look to us in vain to
+ declare simply what He has done? Perish the thought! Whatever may
+ be between us and speaking to men, let us go through it. If it be a
+ foreign language, remember Christ lived thirty years in
+ preparation. If it be hardship, cold, poor food, scorn, slight,
+ deaf ears--never mind, go ahead. Christ looks to us to go ahead, or
+ _come_ ahead, for He has gone through it all. Trouble, hardship,
+ trial, suffering,--all will soon pass and be done. And is there a
+ trouble or hardship we have yet surmounted for Christ's sake that
+ does not seem sweet to look back on? Then, come what likes, let us
+ face it; or, if we be overwhelmed, let us be overwhelmed with
+ undaunted faces looking in the right direction. By the mercy of God
+ may we be saved; and if saved how splendid it will be--no trouble,
+ no trial, no indigestible beef and brick-tea: everything _better
+ than_ we could wish it, and complete joy.
+
+ 'All this is not imagination or rhetoric, but _really before_ us;
+ so, by the strength which Christ gives, let us go on to it. Pray
+ for me. I pray for you; and if we don't meet on earth, you know
+ the trysting-place, "_the right-hand side_."'
+
+It can readily be seen that, under conditions of the kind sketched in
+this letter, time was not likely to hang heavily on his hands.
+Interviews like the following were held from time to time, and were not
+only encouraging and hopeful but reacted strongly upon his own heart and
+brain:--
+
+ 'This afternoon (Sabbath, November 24), I met Toobshing Baier in
+ the dispensary of the London Mission Hospital. At first I could not
+ remember the man. The face I knew. After a time his name came out
+ without, I flatter myself, his perceiving that I was fishing for
+ it. He was most anxious to see the doctor's medical instruments and
+ appliances. After he had seen quite a number of these, he came to
+ my room, and we sat down for a talk which lasted nearly from 5 to 7
+ o'clock. He began by reading a part of the rough draft of the new
+ translation of St. Matthew in Mongolian, which happened to be lying
+ on my table. He suggested that in place of "prophet," a word which
+ has been transferred bodily, we should use _juoug beelikty_. He
+ also remarked that our translation of "the foal of an ass" was not
+ the thing, and gave the word he thought was right. He was
+ accompanied by a young lama, who agreed with him in this
+ suggestion. The lama seemed well up, read Mongolian as easily as
+ Toobshing himself, and when Toobshing gave the Thibetan word for
+ _juoug beelikty_, the lama looked over his shoulder, spied a book
+ on a shelf, took it, found the place at once, and showed me the
+ Thibetan and Mongolian side by side.
+
+ 'Shortly after this Toobshing set himself up and proposed questions
+ and cases such as:
+
+ '"Is hell eternal?
+
+ '"Are all the heathen who have not heard the Gospel damned?
+
+ '"If a man lives without sin, is he damned?
+
+ '"If a man disregards Christ, but worships a supreme God in an
+ indefinite way, is he saved or not?
+
+ '"How can Christ save a man?
+
+ '"If a man prays to Christ to save him morn and even, but goes on
+ sinning meantime, how about him?
+
+ '"If a man prays for a thing, does he get it?
+
+ '"Do your unbelieving countrymen in England all go to hell?
+
+ '"Are there prophets now?
+
+ '"Is a new-born child a sinner?
+
+ '"Is one man then punished for another's fault?
+
+ '"Has anybody died, gone to heaven or hell, and come back to
+ report? [A Mongol has!]
+
+ '"Did Buddha live?" and so forth.
+
+ '[Answer, He lived, but did not do what is now said of him.]
+
+ '"If so, how do you know that the account of Christ is not made up
+ in the same way? Could not the disciples conspire to make the
+ Gospels?
+
+ 'To these and all other questions I endeavoured to give proper
+ answers; and this, our most delightful and profitable talk, lasted
+ till there was just time for me to snatch a hasty meal before the
+ usual service at 7.30 P.M.'
+
+Discussions of this nature were calculated to deepen thought and to
+promote heart-searching on the part of the Christian worker. They also
+illustrate some of the special difficulties which missionaries in China
+and India have to meet. With an elaborate religious ritual and
+literature, both Buddhist and Hindu can often, and do often, object
+against Christianity many of those, sometimes obvious, sometimes
+subtle, difficulties which the Gospel of Jesus Christ alone can remove,
+and which it removes by sanctifying and dominating the heart.
+
+In February 1873 Gilmour visited Tientsin for the first time since he
+passed through it on his arrival in China. Here he took part in several
+readings, temperance meetings, and religious services. At one of the
+readings:--
+
+ 'One joke happened. I was asked to give a recitation at a penny
+ reading for sailors. The piece was "The Execution of Montrose." I
+ got up in tragic style, said,
+
+ "Come hither, Evan Cameron,"
+
+ with the appropriate beckoning action, when a sailor in the middle
+ of the audience responded to the call, pressed his way out of the
+ passage, and was making for the platform. I could not stand this,
+ so I uttered a yell, and rushed off to hide myself, and it was some
+ time before the audience and speaker could compose themselves for a
+ fresh start Next day we were told that the unfortunate sailor was
+ beckoned to come hither from all parts of the ship.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+THE FIRST CAMPAIGN IN MONGOLIA
+
+
+In 1873 Gilmour resumed his visits to the Plain and on March 15 he was
+at Kalgan, writing, 'No appearance of getting away to the north. I
+promenade daily the streets and accost Mongols, but with no success as
+to getting camels, or even a horse to hire as far as Mahabul's. A day or
+two later Mahabul arrived in Kalgan on his way to Peking, and by his aid
+Gilmour secured two camels, and on March 24 he started north, reaching
+Mahabul's tent on the 28th. He at once endeavoured to secure the
+services of a Mongol named Lojing, and the usual series of delays and
+vexations occurred.
+
+ 'To-day (March 29) I got impatient and went for a walk. Came back,
+ and Lojing came and said he would go. Felt relieved; he wants me to
+ come back this way, and I consent, though I would rather not. He
+ came back in the afternoon, saying that he could not get off his
+ engagement to read prayers with some other lama for Gichik's
+ soul,[3] so that we cannot start before Thursday at noon. Mahabul's
+ wife gave him some whisky, and he went to the officers and got
+ drunk. He waited for a camel which was offered for sale. The camel
+ came when I was out. He was drunk, did not watch it, so it drifted
+ away before the storm. A boy on horseback was sent after it. When
+ it came it was a perfect object, yet they asked twenty taels for
+ it. He is to go after a camel to-morrow. He was so drunk that,
+ remembering Gichik's fate, I am uneasy to think of his riding my
+ tall camel. O Lord, give me patience!'
+
+[3] The son of the chief referred to on page 80, who had recently been
+killed by a fall from his horse.
+
+This and the three subsequent journeys over the Plain, made in the
+course of 1873, were full of incident illustrative of the difficulties
+of the work, the peculiarities of the people, and the restless energy
+and indomitable perseverance of the missionary. But the limitations of
+space forbid us to linger; we extract a few notes from the diary. It was
+on the second of these journeys, while at Lama Miao, that he witnessed
+the 'Mirth of Hell,' as he calls it, described in _Among the Mongols_,
+Chapter XI.
+
+ '_April 19, 1873._--To-day had more provocation from my Mongol, and
+ my earnest prayer is that I may be able to stand it all, and not
+ get soured in temper and feeling against the Mongols. I must have
+ patience. Some knowledge of camel's flesh also would help me not a
+ little. As it stands, I feel an incompetent "duffer."'
+
+ '_May 6._--Travelled parallel to the road in a stupid manner over
+ hill and dale, because Lojing chose to consider it a nearer way.
+ The way was no nearer at all and much more steep. At last got to a
+ lot of tents down in a hollow, called the "Great Water" (_Ihha
+ Osso_). Had quite a lot of people. One lama the most provoking
+ child (25 years old) I think I ever met. He was a perfect nuisance;
+ even the tone of his voice I could not abide. This individual came
+ to my tent even after I was down in bed. I was glad he was done for
+ once. Next morning he was in my tent before I was up, remarking,
+ "What a great sleeper you are!' Last night he had remarked, "How
+ early you go to bed!" I am afraid he is the most empty, poor fellow
+ I have known.'
+
+ '_May 13._--To-day also occurred another of my lama's conspicuous
+ stupidities; after asking the road to a set of tents where dwelt
+ friends of his own, he suddenly left the road and began the ascent
+ of a steep hill. I asked where he was going. He said to the tents.
+ I followed some distance, and then from the convergence of paths
+ judged that there was no pass where he was going, and accordingly
+ shouted to him to stop. Stop he did, and also looked thunder. I
+ asked him, "Have you travelled this way before?" "No," said he.
+ "Come this way, and follow the road." "You go that road," said he,
+ "I go this road." "Nothing of the kind," said I. "You come here,
+ and we'll get to tents." He came; but then and there began one of
+ his intolerable tirades against me, saying how disobedient I was,
+ and that _this was his own native place_, he knew. What a bad man I
+ was! He had hardly finished his fury when lo, behold, close before
+ us, right in our path, the very tents we were looking for! He is,
+ to use a Mongol idiom, "Stupider than stupid."'
+
+ '_Sept. 12._--We are now in a diphtheria district. I go into it,
+ and hope to remain some time, trusting myself to the hands of God.
+ I am safe enough in His hands. If He can forward mission work more
+ by my death than by my life, His will be done.'
+
+ '_Sept. 18._--To-day let pass me, as all were starting from the
+ temple, about six men and three women without telling them of
+ Jesus.'
+
+At the close of the year Mr. Gilmour sent home another elaborate report,
+a large portion of which appeared in the _Chronicle of the London
+Missionary Society_ for December 1874. We extract here a few paragraphs
+not then printed for obvious reasons. There was still a difficulty with
+the American Board, and there was still in London some inability to
+grasp the exact bearing and the full needs of the situation. The first
+extract is given here simply because it illustrates the noble
+unselfishness of Gilmour's character, and the way in which he
+persistently refused to be stopped by hindrances that would have barred
+the road against most men. He supplied a statement of account showing
+that even with the most rigid economy he had exceeded his allowance by
+110 taels, equivalent to from 25_l._ to 30_l._
+
+ 'This leaves me with a deficit of 110 taels 63 cents, and explains
+ how it is that I ask next year's (1874) grant to be raised to 150
+ taels at least. I had only two courses open to me, either to use up
+ the grants for 1872 and 1873, and stop without accomplishing all I
+ could, or to make full proof of my ministry and exceed the grants.
+ Considering the cause more important than silver, I chose the
+ latter course, and, despite the most rigid economy, exceeded to the
+ above amount. Present circumstances enable me to make up the
+ deficit from my own private purse, and I don't ask to be refunded,
+ but I don't know that I shall be flush of money next year, and _do_
+ ask that the grant may be not less than 150 taels, which is the
+ lowest estimate I can make.
+
+ 'As proof of the reasonableness of my request, and of my anxiety to
+ avoid drawing on the funds of the Society beyond what is absolutely
+ necessary, I may be allowed to state that this year, in addition to
+ making up the lacking 110-63 taels, I walked afoot behind my
+ caravan in the desert for _weeks_, to avoid the expense of
+ purchasing another camel.'
+
+On the question of Christian literature he placed on record some wise
+words, as needful now almost as when he penned them, in order to correct
+the notion that it is enough simply to place into the hands of a heathen
+a copy of the Word of God in his native tongue. The reply of Candace's
+eunuch, 'How can I understand unless someone shall guide me?' meets the
+missionary of to-day, as it met Philip in the days of old. The
+practically unanimous opinion of the Shanghai Conference held in 1890
+shows that the same need is still strongly felt by the missionaries of
+all the societies.
+
+ 'In addition to the Scriptures and the Catechism, I think small
+ simple books containing little portions of Scripture history or
+ little portions of Scripture teaching would be very useful. The
+ Bible is all very well for those who have advanced a little, but
+ there is very little of the narrative portions even--the simplest
+ parts of the whole book--which you can read without encountering
+ terrible names of persons or places, or quotations from the prophet
+ Isaiah or Jeremiah. When a Mongol comes upon these he feels
+ inclined to give up in despair. Even in China my experience has
+ been that people are slow to buy a complete gospel, even at less
+ than the paper on which it is printed costs, while they will buy
+ with avidity very small books at almost their full value.
+
+ 'Chinamen themselves notice this, and when surrounded by a crowd I
+ have heard them remark laughingly, "Small books go quick."
+ Remembering my instructions, which among other things say, "Pause
+ before you translate," I have hitherto refrained, but now have a
+ very small illustrated narrative in the press, another also
+ illustrated in manuscript, and other two not illustrated in
+ contemplation. If I find funds--the Peking branch of the Tract
+ Society is bankrupt just now--and get them out, you shall have
+ specimens. Probably they won't look well, being first attempts, but
+ you need not be ashamed of the Mongol of them, as they have been
+ written under my direction by a "crack" native scholar, and
+ carefully revised by Schereschewsky, who is a general linguist of
+ good ability, and has paid so much attention to Mongolian that he
+ revised the Gospel by Matthew in conjunction with Mr. Edkins, and
+ is at present at work on a Mongol dictionary.'
+
+Medical missions were only in their infancy in 1874, and Gilmour in the
+same report describes what many another has felt. He illustrates also
+one of his fixed principles, viz., always do _something_; and never let
+the work stop simply because you cannot do what is ideally the best.
+
+ 'I know very little about diseases and cures, but the little I _do_
+ know is extremely useful. Almost every Mongol, man and woman and
+ child, has something that wants putting right. To have studied
+ medicine at home would have been a great help, but though I cannot
+ hope now ever to gain a scientific knowledge of the subject, I am
+ glad that in our hospital here I have a good opportunity of
+ learning much from Dr. Dudgeon, and all I can do now is to make the
+ best of this good opportunity. I am told that professional men at
+ home are suspicious of giving a little medical knowledge to young
+ men going out as missionaries. I sided with them till I came here,
+ but here the case is different. At home it is all very well to
+ stand before the fire in your room, within sight of the brass plate
+ on the doctor's door on the opposite side of the street, and talk
+ about the danger of little knowledge; but when you are two weeks'
+ journey from any assistance, and see your fellow-traveller sitting
+ silent and swollen with violent toothache for days together, you
+ fervently wish you had a pair of forceps and the _dangerous_
+ amount of knowledge. And when in remote places you have the choice
+ of burying your servant or stopping his diarrh[oe]a, would you
+ prefer to talk nonsense about professional skill rather than give
+ him a dose of chlorodyne, even though it should be at the risk of
+ administering one drop more or less than a man who writes M.D. to
+ his name would have done?
+
+ 'I speak earnestly and from experience. No one has more detestation
+ than I have for the quack that patters in the presence of trained
+ skill; but from what I have seen and known of mission life, both in
+ myself and others, since coming to North China, I think it is a
+ little less than culpable homicide to deny a little hospital
+ training to men who may have to pass weeks and months of their
+ lives in places where they themselves, or those about them, may
+ sicken and die from curable diseases before the doctor could be
+ summoned, even supposing he could leave his post and come.'
+
+During the summer of 1874 James Gilmour continued his itinerating work
+among the nomads of the Plain. He met with much to discourage him, but
+he steadily enlarged his knowledge of the people and his acquaintance
+with the best methods of work among them. How difficult it was to adapt
+ordinary methods of teaching to their habits may be judged from the
+following sketch:--
+
+ 'My tent is not only my dwelling-house and dispensary, but also my
+ chapel. I always endeavour to instruct the visitors and patients as
+ far as I can. Preaching to Mongols is a little different from
+ preaching at home--a little different from preaching in China even.
+ You can get a congregation of heathen Chinese to listen for, say,
+ twenty minutes, or half an hour, or even longer; but begin to
+ preach to a lot of Mongols, and they begin to talk to each other,
+ or perhaps to ask you questions about your dress and your country.
+
+ 'The nature of their own service is partly to blame for this. When
+ a Mongol sends for a lama or two to read prayers in his tent, the
+ inmates, though present, don't think it necessary to attend much to
+ what is going on. Though they did attend, they would not be able to
+ understand, so talking goes on among them pretty much as usual. If
+ I were to stick myself up and begin, and start off sermonising to
+ them, I would be treated much as they treat their own lamas; so I
+ confine my preaching to conversations and arguments--a style of
+ teaching which I find secures their attention'.
+
+Many, too, are the sketches in his letters and diaries of the men he
+met. They are all drawn with that remarkable and largely unconscious
+power, which he possessed so fully, of being able to see very vividly
+the striking points and details of passing events, and of enabling those
+to whom he wrote, by his aptly chosen words, also to see exactly what
+passed before his eyes. One or two out of many examples must suffice:--
+
+ 'This season (1874) I met a deaf and dumb man. He was uneducated,
+ but of great quickness and intelligence. He could converse easily
+ and readily with his fellow-Mongols by signs, and I could ask many
+ simple questions and understand his answers without trouble. His
+ perception was remarkable. While sitting in the dusk outside my
+ tent, a messenger came from his father's tent to tell him that some
+ of the sheep were missing. A single turn of the hand followed by a
+ glance around, as if searching for something, was all that was
+ required. He had been sitting quietly in the circle, looking at us
+ talking; but the moment the communication was made he uttered an
+ inarticulate sound betraying great excitement, knocked the ashes
+ out of his pipe, stuck it into his boot, threw himself into the
+ saddle, and rode off into the gathering darkness to search for the
+ lost sheep. All agreed that he had an extra share of intelligence,
+ and he was evidently regarded as a capable and useful member of the
+ community.
+
+ 'One of the sad sights seen was that of a sick Chinaman near his
+ end. He was one of a company of four, who went about dressing skins
+ of which the Mongols make garments. He had been an opium taker, and
+ an incurable diarrh[oe]a had seized him. At the time he was lodging
+ with the Mongol for whom the party had come to dress skins; but the
+ Mongol, seeing he would die, and fearing trouble and expense over
+ his death, ordered him off the premises. Borrowing an ox cart, his
+ companions had him conveyed away some five or ten miles, jolted in
+ the rude vehicle and suffering from the blazing sun, to a place
+ where some Chinese acquaintances were digging a well. They had a
+ tent of their own, most likely a poor ragged white cloth affair,
+ open to the winds and pervious to the rain; and in this the poor
+ man hoped he might be permitted to die. It was the dark side of the
+ picture. The glorious summer, the green and flowery plains, the
+ fattening flocks, the herds exulting in the deep pastures, the gay
+ Mongols riding about, the white tents bathed in the sunlight and
+ gleaming from afar. In the midst of all this, a feeble man, far
+ from home and kin, sick unto death, cast forth from his poor
+ lodging, and seeking for a place to lie down and die in. The
+ Mongols are a hospitable race, but pray ye that ye may not get sick
+ on their hands.
+
+ 'On the whole I have been very well received everywhere, and have
+ been treated with great confidence. I have sometimes wondered at
+ the readiness with which they take medicine from the hand of an
+ utter stranger. One reason why they are ready to trust me,
+ doubtless, is that going among them, they can go round my tent and
+ see that there is nothing secret and terrible behind it; they enter
+ it and see all that is in it. They know and see that I am utterly
+ in their power, and, perhaps, reason that I am there with no intent
+ to harm, because if I made trouble I could not move another step
+ without their consent.
+
+ 'In the shape of converts I have seen no result. I have not, as far
+ as I am aware, seen any one who even _wanted_ to be a Christian;
+ but by healing their diseases I have had opportunity to tell many
+ of Jesus, the Great Physician.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+MARRIAGE
+
+
+During the year 1873 James Gilmour devoted much thought to the natural
+and all-important question of marriage. Uncommon as he was, in so many
+ways, it was, perhaps, to be expected that in this great undertaking he
+would depart from ordinary methods. The Rev. S. E. Meech had married, in
+1872, Miss Prankard, of London. After the return of Mr. Edkins to
+England, in May 1873, Mr. Gilmour went to board with Mr. and Mrs. Meech.
+There he saw the portrait of Mrs. Meech's sister, and often heard her
+referred to in conversation. Towards the close of 1873 he took Mrs.
+Meech into his confidence, and asked permission to enter into
+correspondence with her sister. The following most characteristic
+letters show the course of subsequent events:--
+
+
+ 'Peking, January 14, 1874.
+
+ 'My dear Parents,--I have written and proposed to a girl in
+ England. It is true I have never seen her and I know very little
+ about her; but what I do know is good. She is the sister of Mrs.
+ Meech, and is with her mother in London. Her mother supports
+ herself and daughter by keeping a school. One of the hindrances
+ will be perhaps that the mother will not be willing to part with
+ her daughter, as she is, no doubt, the life of the school. I don't
+ know, so I have written and made the offer, and leave them to
+ decide. If she cannot come, then there is no harm done. If she can
+ arrange to come, then my hope is fulfilled. If the young lady says
+ "Yes," she or her friends will no doubt write you, as I have asked
+ them to do.... You may think I am rash in writing to a girl I have
+ never seen. If you say so, I may just say that I have something of
+ the same feeling; but what am I to do? In addition I am very
+ easy-minded over it all, because I have exercised the best of my
+ thoughts on the subject, and put the whole matter into the hands of
+ God, asking Him, if it be best to bring her, if it be not best to
+ keep her away, and He can manage the whole thing well.'
+
+By some mischance this letter was delayed, and Mr. Gilmour's relatives
+were startled, one March day in 1874, by receiving from an entirely
+unknown lady in London a letter, containing the unlooked-for statement:
+'Your son, Mr. Gilmour, of Peking, has asked my daughter to write to
+you, telling you of her decision to join him as his wife. She has wished
+me to write to you for her, and will be pleased to hear from you when
+you feel inclined to write.'
+
+The friendly intercourse that followed soon convinced Mr. Gilmour's
+family, as any knowledge of Emily Prankard herself soon convinced all
+who made her acquaintance, that, however unusual it might appear, this
+was indeed one of the marriages made in heaven. By both parties God's
+blessing and guidance were invoked, upon both His benediction rested,
+and, after a brief separation in this world, they are now both enriched
+with the fuller knowledge and the perfect joy of the life beyond.
+
+No time was lost in the arrangements for Miss Prankard's departures to
+China. In a letter to his mother, dated October 2, 1874, Mr. Gilmour
+writes:--
+
+ 'You have seen Miss Prankard, but you have not told me what you
+ think of her. She was delighted with her visit to Scotland and with
+ you all. You will be glad to hear that I have had some delightful
+ letters from her. I wrote her, and she has written me in the most
+ unrestrained way concerning her spiritual hopes and condition, and
+ though we have never seen each other, yet we know more of each
+ other's inmost life and soul than, I am quite certain, most lovers
+ know of each other even after long personal courtship. It is quite
+ delightful to think that even now we can talk by letter with
+ perfect unreserve, and I tell _you_ this because I know you will be
+ glad to hear it. I knew she was a pious girl, else I would not have
+ asked her to come out to be a missionary's wife, but she turns out
+ better even than I thought, and I am not much afraid as to how we
+ shall get on together.'
+
+In the course of the autumn of 1874 Miss Prankard sailed, and in a
+letter to the writer, December 13, 1874, Gilmour thus refers to the
+close of his unusual but satisfactory courtship:--
+
+ 'I was married last week, Tuesday, December 8!
+
+ 'Mrs. Meech's sister is Mrs. Gilmour. We never saw each other till
+ a week before we were married, and my friends here drew long faces
+ and howled at me for being rash and inconsiderate. What if you
+ don't like each other? How then? It is for life! As if I did not
+ know all this long ago. Well, the time came, the vessel was due at
+ Shanghai, but would not come. Mr. Meech and I went down to Tientsin
+ and waited there a fortnight, but no tidings. At last on the
+ evening of Sabbath, November 29, a steamer's whistle was heard
+ miles away down the river. It was Mr. Meech's turn to preach. After
+ sermon he and I walked away down the river side to see what we
+ could see. After a while a light hove round the last bend, then a
+ green light, then the red light, then came the three lights of the
+ steamer! We listened. It was the high-pressure engine of the steam
+ launch which is used to lighten the deep-sea steamers before coming
+ up the narrow river. Fifteen minutes more and she was at the
+ landing stage. A friend went on board. Miss Prankard was on board
+ the Taku, which was still outside the bar, waiting for water to
+ bring her over and up to the settlement. The lighter was going to
+ unload and start down the river at five A.M., and Meech and I went
+ in her. About eight A.M. we met the steamer coming up, and when she
+ came abreast we saw Miss Prankard on board, but could not get from
+ our vessel to hers. The tide was favourable for running up, and
+ they were afraid to lose a minute, so would not stop the steamer;
+ we did not get on board till we reached the bund at Tientsin about
+ eleven A.M. We started for Peking next day, got there on Thursday,
+ and were married following Tuesday.
+
+ 'Our honeymoon is now almost over. I am to have only a week of it.
+ I hope to start with Meech on a mission trip to the country on
+ Tuesday next.'
+
+Miss Prankard's first view of her future husband was hardly what she
+might have expected. Mr. Meech has also sketched that scene on the
+river.
+
+'The morning was cold, and Gilmour was clad in an old overcoat which had
+seen much service in Siberia, and had a woollen comforter round his
+neck, having more regard to warmth than to appearance. We had to follow
+back to Tientsin, Gilmour being thought by those on board the steamer to
+be the engineer!'
+
+Two letters may be quoted in this connection. The first was to one of
+his most intimate Scotch friends.
+
+
+ 'London Mission, Peking,
+ 'January 31, 1875.
+
+ 'My dear----, Your kind, long, and much-looked-for letter dated May
+ 12, 1873, and August 21, 1874, reached me on January 9, 1875. Many
+ thanks for it, but I think it would be quite as well in future to
+ send me half the quantity in half the time, if you really find you
+ cannot write me oftener. As I was married on December 8, 1874, to
+ Mrs. Meech's sister, that lady, Mrs. Gilmour, had the great
+ pleasure of reading your earnest, long, and reiterated warning to
+ me not to have her. Your warning came too late. Had you posted your
+ letter on May 12, 1873, it might have been in time, as the first
+ letter that opened our acquaintance was written in January 1874. If
+ nothing else will have effect with you, perhaps the thought that
+ you might have saved me from the fate of having an English wife may
+ have some effect in moving you to post your letters early, even
+ though they should not be so long and full.
+
+ 'About my wife: as I want you to know her, I introduce you to her.
+ She is a jolly girl, as much, perhaps more, of a Christian and a
+ Christian missionary than I am. I don't know whether I told you how
+ it came about. I proposed first to a Scotch girl, but found I was
+ too late; I then put myself and the direction of this affair--I
+ mean the finding of a wife--into God's hands, asking Him to look me
+ out one, a good one too, and very soon I found myself in a position
+ to propose to Miss Prankard with all reasonable evidence that she
+ was the right sort of girl, and with some hope that she would not
+ disdain the offer. We had never seen each other, and had never
+ corresponded, but she had heard much about me from people in
+ England who knew me, and I had heard a good deal of her and seen
+ her letters written to her sister and to her sister's husband. The
+ first letter I wrote her was to propose, and the first letter she
+ wrote me was to accept--romantic enough!
+
+ 'I proposed in January, went up to Mongolia in spring, rode about
+ on my camels till July, and came down to Kalgan to find that I was
+ an accepted man! I went to Tientsin to meet her; we arrived here on
+ Thursday, and were married on Tuesday morning. We had a quiet week,
+ then I went to the country on a nine days' tour, and came back two
+ days before Christmas. We have been at home ever since. Such is the
+ romance of a matter-of-fact man.
+
+ 'You will see that the whole thing was gone about simply on the
+ faith principle, and from its success I am inclined to think more
+ and more highly of the plan. Without any gammon, I am much more
+ happy than ever even in my day-dreams I ventured to imagine I might
+ be. It is not only me that my wife pleases, but she has gained
+ golden opinions from most of the people who have met her among my
+ friends and acquaintances in Scotland and China. My parents were
+ scared one day last year by receiving a letter from a lady in
+ England, a lady whose name even they had not known before, stating
+ that her daughter had decided to become _my wife_. Didn't it stir
+ up the old people! They had never heard a word about it! My letter
+ to them, posted at the same time with the proposal, had been
+ delayed in London. The young lady went to Scotland, and was with
+ them two weeks, and came away having made such an impression on
+ them that they wrote me from home to say that "though I had
+ searched the country for a couple of years I could not have made a
+ better choice."
+
+ 'Perhaps I am tiring you, but I want to let you know all about it,
+ and to assure you that you need not be the least shy of me or of my
+ English wife. She is a good lassie, any quantity better than me,
+ and just as handy as a Scotch lass would have been. It was great
+ fun for her to read your tirade about English wives and your
+ warning about her. She is a jolly kind of body, and does not take
+ offence, but I guess if she comes across you she will wake you up a
+ bit.'
+
+The other letter was to Miss Bremner, and referred to the part Gilmour
+was to take in her marriage in 1883 to his brother Alexander:--
+
+ 'Now as to your affair, a much more serious matter. Alex has said
+ something about my part. I want to take part, but only such a small
+ part as will make it true to say, "assisted by the brother of the
+ bridegroom." It is for you and Dr. Macfadyen to say what that
+ _small_ part shall be; all I have to say about it, the smaller the
+ better.
+
+ 'My experiences of the ceremonies of social Christianity have been
+ mixed a little. In England I baptised a child by a wrong name, and
+ had actually to do it again. In China on a similar occasion I began
+ by saying, "Friends, God has given you this child," when the
+ seeming father stopped me, and explained that God had not given
+ them this child, but he himself had picked it up in a field where
+ it had been exposed.
+
+ 'I think I married only one Chinese couple, and to this day I doubt
+ if either the one or the other uttered a syllable where they should
+ have said, "I do." In my own case I think I must have said "I will"
+ in a feeble voice, for my wife when her turn came sung out "I will"
+ in a voice that startled herself and me, and made it ominous how
+ much _will_ she was going to have in the matter. Wishing you all
+ blessings,
+
+ 'Believe me yours truly,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+'IN JOURNEYINGS OFTEN, IN PERILS OF RIVERS'
+
+
+The year following the marriage, owing to the absence of Dr. Dudgeon on
+furlough, was spent almost entirely in Peking. In his absence Mr.
+Gilmour took charge of what may be called the unprofessional work of the
+hospital, the purely medical superintendence being in the hands of Dr.
+Bushell of the British Legation. He varied this work and the routine of
+ordinary mission duties by an occasional trip to other centres where
+fairs were being held, in the company of Mr. Murray, of the National
+Bible Society of Scotland, for the purpose of selling Christian books.
+There was often a very keen friendly rivalry as to which could sell the
+most, and not unfrequently very large quantities of tracts and booklets
+were thus put into circulation.
+
+Early in 1875, with the object of enabling his colleagues and his
+friends among the other missions which have centres in Peking the better
+to realise what life in Mongolia was like, he set up his Mongol tent in
+the compound, and invited them in companies of five or seven to partake
+of a Mongol dinner, cooked in Mongol fashion, and served as on the
+Plain. His diary records that five such entertainments were necessary,
+the utmost limit of the tent accommodation being reached on each
+occasion.
+
+'The guests came,' we are told, 'at the appointed time, and the fire of
+wood was lighted in the middle of the tent. While the guests sat around
+on felt spread upon the ground, Gilmour proceeded to cook the millet and
+the mutton which furnished the feast. When all was ready a blessing was
+asked and the meal was eaten. On one occasion a reverend gentleman was
+called on to ask the blessing, but declined, feeling apparently that
+what he was expected to eat was not of such a quality that he could ask
+a blessing on it. Gilmour used often to refer to this with much
+amusement, though at the time he felt some chagrin.'
+
+In 1876 the Mongolian trips were resumed. No colleague had yet been
+secured for him, and, with a bravery and consecration beyond all praise,
+Mrs. Gilmour accompanied him. This she did not once simply. For the
+first journey the novelty of the experience and the conviction that she
+could at any rate help to preserve her husband from the feeling of utter
+loneliness, which had been so hard to bear in past years, were powerful
+reasons. But she went a second and a third time. She went after the
+novelty had worn off, after she had learned by very stern experience how
+hard and rough the life was, after previous exposure had told but too
+severely upon her physical strength. And thus she deserves the eulogy
+passed upon her by her husband: 'She is a better missionary than I.'
+Comparisons of this kind are obviously out of the question. But it would
+be hard to find a more beautiful illustration of true wifely affection
+than the love for her husband that made her willing to share his Mongol
+tent as readily as the Peking compound. And if James Gilmour
+manifested a Christlike love for the ignorant and stolid Mongols, so
+also did the delicately nurtured and refined lady who, in order to do
+her part in winning them to the Saviour, endured privations, faced
+perils, and bore a daily and hourly series of trials so irksome and so
+repugnant that no motive short of all-absorbing love to Jesus Christ is
+strong enough to account for her endurance.
+
+Here are some pictures of what this life meant to Mrs. Gilmour. The
+first journey which they took together lasted from April 4 until
+September 23, 1876, one hundred and thirty-six days being passed in
+Mongolia itself.
+
+ 'On the evening of April 25 we came upon our servants' tent,
+ already pitched beside some Mongol tents near a stream. Our things
+ were unloaded from the Chinese cart, which soon drove off and left
+ us fairly launched out on the Plain. We had two tents--one for
+ ourselves and one for our servants. They were both alike, made of
+ common blue Chinese cloth outside, and of commoner white Chinese
+ cloth inside. It was originally intended that our tent should be
+ private for our retirement and for Mrs. Gilmour's use; but we soon
+ found that this idea could not be carried out. The Mongols are so
+ much in the habit of going freely into everybody's tent in Mongolia
+ that we found we could not retain our tent to ourselves without
+ running risk of offending them by our seeming haughtiness. That
+ they should think us uncongenial and distant would have been an
+ obstacle to our success among them. So we made a virtue of
+ necessity, and kept open house in the literal sense of the word. At
+ our meals, our devotions, our ablutions, there they were--much
+ amused and interested, of course. It was sometimes annoying to have
+ them so much and so constantly about, but there was no help for it,
+ and soon we began to care little for them, and took their
+ presence not only as a matter of course, but without being
+ disturbed by it.
+
+ 'One advantage of this sort of public life was that Mrs. Gilmour,
+ being almost constantly in the presence of the spoken language,
+ picked it up very accurately and very rapidly. It is hardly
+ possible to conceive a better plan of becoming easily and well
+ acquainted with any language than that of thus living where it is
+ impossible not to hear it in almost constant use.
+
+ 'Another advantage of this sort of public life was that one gained
+ the friendship of the people. This perfect freedom of intercourse
+ pleased them much, and even conciliated those not very friendly
+ inclined. It was quite common to hear visitors remark that, while
+ other foreigners in Mongolia are distant and harsh, these people
+ were gentle and accessible, and that such friendly people did a
+ great deal to remove the unfavourable impressions made by other
+ less considerate travellers.
+
+ 'Our sojourn extended to the end of August, giving us a little over
+ four months at a stretch of tent life. In that time we had
+ experience of many kinds of weather. At first it was cold. Even in
+ May ice was to be seen in the mornings. Then came heat, premature
+ and burning, and all the more trying for ourselves and cattle on
+ account of the lack of rain. Then we had a furious tempest, which
+ raged for about thirty-six hours, overturning our covered cart and
+ threatening to sweep ourselves and our tents away. We had to load
+ down our tent ropes with bags of earth, stones, sod, the bodies of
+ our carts, wheels, boxes, and anything we could find, and even then
+ we had but a precarious existence. Every now and then, by day and
+ by night, there would arise a shout from the one tent or the other,
+ and amid the roar of the wind we heard cries for the hammer and the
+ spare tent pins. We managed to fix ourselves without being blown
+ away, and when the storm was over we patched our riven tents,
+ and were thankful we had weathered it so well. Then came the summer
+ rains--late in season, it is true, but great in strength--pouring
+ and lashing and roaring, the great drops bursting through our rent
+ cloth, broken up into spray and looking like pepper shaken from a
+ box. We had waterproof sheets, but it was next to impossible to
+ keep anything dry. While the rain lasted we sat huddled in our rain
+ cloaks, or, spade in hand, cut new channels for suddenly
+ extemporised streams and pools that grew larger and continued to
+ come closer to our bedding and boxes. As soon as the sun returned,
+ there was a general drying of garments, mattresses, and sheepskin
+ robes. The heat was perhaps the most trying of our meteorological
+ experiences; but even that passed away at last, and before we had
+ left the plains night frost had reappeared, covering the pools
+ about well mouths with thin sheets of ice.
+
+[Illustration: A MONGOL ENCAMPMENT]
+
+ 'Later in the season, one afternoon, the loungers in the tent
+ looked out and remarked, "The Mandarin has come," and gave place to
+ a richly dressed, corpulent Mongol, who entered the tent, followed
+ by one of his servants. Salutations over, he soon showed his
+ colours and unmasked his batteries. He had come to fight, and we
+ both went at it tooth and nail. He had read a good deal, and had
+ come evidently prepared and primed, not in any spirit of
+ unfriendliness, but under the evident conviction that a better case
+ could be made out for Buddhism than for Christianity. The tent was
+ crammed with eager listeners, and we reasoned together from the
+ Creation to the finish, including all manner of side issues and
+ important questions. It was a long time before he could be
+ convinced that our Jesus was not spoken of and made known in the
+ Buddhist classics. When he was at length satisfied (on that point),
+ he wanted to know about the Trinity; how men could get good; how it
+ was right that men should escape punishment due to their misdeeds
+ by praying to Jesus; why God allowed animals, such as starving
+ dogs, to lead a life of suffering; why God did not keep sin from
+ entering the world; how could Jesus come, when it is said He is
+ always with us; and how about the souls who died before Jesus came.
+
+ 'At last the sun got low, and the Mandarin, with many words of
+ friendship, rode away, promising to come another day. But he never
+ came.'
+
+In a later journey they had a very narrow escape from one of the
+frequent perils of this tent life:--
+
+ 'In Mongolia we had one rather serious adventure. The south edge of
+ the Plain is famed for storms, and the night we camped there, just
+ after dark, began one of the fiercest thunderstorms I can remember
+ having seen. The wind roared, the rain dashed, the tent quivered;
+ the thunder rattled with a metallic ring, like shafts of iron
+ dashing against each other, as it darted along a sheet-iron sky;
+ the water rose in the tent till part of our bed was afloat. It was
+ hardly possible to hear each other speak; but amid and above all
+ the din of the tempest rose one sound not to be mistaken, the roar
+ of rushing water. There was a river to right of us, but the sound
+ came more from the left. Venturing out, I found there was a great
+ swift-flowing river on both sides of us; that we could not move
+ from the little piece of elevated land plain on which we had our
+ tent; and that a few inches more water, or an obstacle getting into
+ the path of the upper river, would send the full force of the
+ current down on our tents. Flocks, herds, men are said to be swept
+ away now and again in Mongolia, and for an hour our case seemed
+ doubtful; but about 11 P.M. the storm ceased and the danger was
+ over, and, though we had hardly anything left, we went to sleep,
+ thanking God for His preserving mercy.'
+
+Courageous, undoubtedly, Mrs. Gilmour was; her example of self-sacrifice
+in the Master's cause was lofty in itself, and is stimulating to every
+Christian mind. Yet it is to be greatly feared that the first of these
+journeys aggravated, if it did not actually develope, the disease from
+which she ultimately died. She found the ceaseless round of millet and
+mutton so unpalatable as at the last to be able hardly to eat at all;
+and experience of tent life was needful before she could realise how
+absolutely devoid it was of almost everything that a European lady looks
+upon as essential to daily existence, and thus make adequate preparation
+for the life. Yet, in 1878, she not only accompanied her husband again,
+better equipped by reason of previous experience, but she also took with
+her their infant boy.
+
+The winter of 1876 in Peking was devoted to work more or less directly
+bearing upon the Christian conquest of the nomad tribes.
+
+ 'Since returning from Mongolia I have had here a teacher whom I had
+ come from the plains. I read some Buddhist classics with him, then
+ had him write to my dictation some of the more striking incidents
+ narrated in the Book of Daniel; then finally had him write for me
+ an explanation of the way of salvation through Jesus. The extracts
+ from Daniel were written mostly with the idea of accustoming him to
+ my dictation; but the explanation of Christianity was a tract that
+ I had long wanted to write, in which I sought to make it as plain
+ as possible, not only that Jesus does save, but also that there is
+ no salvation through any other name. The Religious Tract Society
+ has consented to print for me both the extract from Daniel and the
+ explanation of Christianity.'
+
+During 1877 the ever-recurring question, inevitable, perhaps, and yet
+very paralysing to any steady progress, as to whether it was really
+worth while to continue labour in such a sterile field, came up once
+more for discussion. In an elaborate report, designed rather to elicit
+the views of the home authorities than to express his own, dated August
+18, 1877, Mr. Gilmour depicts rapidly and clearly his relations, on the
+one hand, to the workers in the station of the American Board at Kalgan,
+and, on the other, to his colleagues of the North China Committee of the
+London Society. The American Board had sent out another missionary, and
+Mr. Gilmour was at first inclined to the view that, although working
+independently, they might yet act practically as colleagues.
+
+ 'In addition, the new man, Rev. W. P. Sprague, and I one day
+ undertook to climb a mountain together, and, by the time we got
+ half-way up, we discovered that our ideas about working together
+ quite agreed, and that there was a fair and good prospect of our
+ making good harmonious colleagues in one work, though we belonged
+ to different societies and hailed from different nations. Here,
+ then, the thing seemed to be accomplished; here was a colleague
+ ready to my hand, or I to his.'
+
+But Mrs. Gulick, a most energetic and enthusiastic missionary to the
+Mongols, died, her husband was invalided to Japan, and Mr. Sprague found
+himself with the whole mission on his shoulders.
+
+ 'If things are to remain as they are, it amounts pretty much to
+ this, that in the warmer months of the year I can travel through
+ parts of Mongolia teaching the Gospel and dispensing medicines; the
+ rest of the year I can turn my attention to Chinese work in
+ Peking. This is a pleasant enough arrangement for me, but it is not
+ a very vigorous prosecution of the work of the Mongol mission. On
+ the other hand, such is the fewness of people to be reached in
+ Mongolia that it is only by alternating these periods of
+ deprivation with seasons of activity among the Chinese that a man
+ can keep his spirit alive.
+
+ 'As regards the opinion of other members of the Committee here, I
+ have never called for any formal expression of it, nor have they
+ (the members of Committee) ever been invited to discuss the
+ question of the Mongol mission in committee, but I know their
+ individual opinions in an informal way. Messrs. Meech and Barradale
+ don't say much; Mr. Owen thinks we will never do much in Mongolia
+ working upon so distant a base as Peking; Mr. Lees thinks it a pity
+ to take up such a seemingly unproductive field while so many more
+ promising fields call for attention; he moreover thinks that the
+ only way to do much for Mongolia is through China; Dr. Edkins
+ thinks I spend too much time and labour over the Mongols, his idea
+ being seemingly a combination of Mongol and Chinese work, with a
+ preponderating tendency towards Chinese; Dr. Dudgeon has always
+ regarded the Mongol mission as hardly practicable.
+
+ 'On the principle, however, of _Sow beside all waters_, and _Thou
+ knowest not which shall prosper, this or that_, perhaps it is well
+ that the Gospel should be exhibited to the Mongols also, and if
+ anyone is to go to Mongolia, perhaps many people would have more
+ disqualifications than myself.'
+
+In 1877 there was what seemed to be a very hopeful development of
+Christian work in Shantung, and Mr. Gilmour and Mr. Owen visited that
+district and baptized a large number of converts. Still later, Dr.
+Edkins and Mr. Owen, on another visit, baptized some two hundred
+people. With reference to this latter ingathering Mr. Gilmour wrote, 'I
+much regret that we have not some definite system of putting men on a
+period of probation.... About these two hundred I have nothing to say,
+but of the hundred odd Mr. Owen and I baptized in November I have to
+admit that, making all allowances, some of them cause me more anxiety
+than satisfaction.' There was, unfortunately, only too much ground for
+this fear. Ultimately the movement dwindled almost as rapidly as it had
+developed, and with little permanent benefit to the missionary cause.
+Shantung had been devastated by famine, locusts, and cholera.
+Missionaries brought relief to the stricken people, giving both money
+and food. Large numbers were drawn towards the new religion by this
+example of its deeds, and most of the converts had professed
+Christianity in the hope of getting something by its means. But this
+incident brought to a head a divergence of view as to the whole conduct
+of affairs in the Peking mission between the two older missionaries, Dr.
+Edkins and Dr. Dudgeon, and their three younger colleagues, Mr. Gilmour,
+Mr. Owen, and Mr. Meech. Into this strenuous and protracted controversy
+we do not propose to enter. Both parties were actuated by high and
+honourable motives; both were able to express their views pointedly, and
+with all appropriate force. In the end the view advocated by Mr. Gilmour
+triumphed. This was that, so far as possible, no pecuniary inducement
+whatever, either by way of payment for services, or even employment in
+connection with the mission, should be allowed to influence a Chinaman's
+judgment in the acceptance of Christianity. Gilmour could take an active
+part in the discussions only during his winter residence in Peking. But
+the reader who has followed its history so far will be quite prepared to
+learn that he made up for the infrequency of his participation in the
+controversy by the energy which he displayed when he did so. And in
+depicting Gilmour as he was, it is essential that he should be seen when
+opposing no less than, as he much preferred to be in all matters
+affecting the welfare of the mission, in the heartiest concord with his
+colleagues. And yet his keenest opponents would cordially assent to the
+following statement by one who took an active part in all the
+discussions. It is mainly for the purpose of emphasising this testimony
+that the matter is referred to here.
+
+'When in Peking Gilmour took his full share in the debates which were
+constantly arising. Although he could and did argue to the extremest
+point, and very hot and sharp words might be spoken during the
+discussion, he harboured no bitterness of feeling against his opponents.
+After excited argument he would get up and say, "Nevertheless I love
+you." Nor were these empty words. He was kind, and willing to help all,
+and was doing acts of service continually for those who opposed him
+most.'
+
+Towards the close of 1878 the Rev. J. S. Barradale, of the Tientsin
+Mission, died, leaving the Rev. J. Lees alone without a Chinese-speaking
+helper. Mr. Gilmour sympathised deeply with him in his loss, and wrote
+to say that, so long as Mr. Lees was thus left alone, he would be glad
+to make two trips annually to his country stations, either _with_ him or
+_for_ him. Mr. Gilmour's journal of this work is not only a record of
+the willingness with which he added gladly to his own heavy labours in
+order to assist a colleague; but it also gives some most realistic
+pictures of what ordinary life in China is like, and under what
+conditions evangelistic itineration there is carried on. Some of the
+districts visited had just been devastated by a severe famine.
+
+ 'From Tientsin to Hsiao Chang is five days' journey. Three hours
+ out from Tientsin we came upon some dogs feasting on a corpse lying
+ at a cross-road. The dogs belonged to cottagers near, but no
+ attempt was made by the owners to keep them away; no one took the
+ trouble to bury the body or cover it up even. Later on we passed
+ through one famine-devastated district. Half the houses in the
+ villages were unroofed; large tracts of land were untilled; the
+ landscape was almost entirely destitute of animal life; travellers
+ were nowhere to be seen; round the villages the little stacks of
+ straw and fuel were not to be seen; the lanes were silent; no dogs,
+ no cocks and hens, no pigs; no groups of children playing or
+ running after the foreigner as he passed by; and the words of
+ Scripture came to my mind, "the land desolate without inhabitant."
+ We continued to pass these desolations for about sixty English
+ miles. We stopped a night in one of these ruined villages, and Mr.
+ Lees took me round the place to see the nature and extent of the
+ destruction. Closer inspection revealed even more ruin than a mere
+ traveller's passing look would detect; for, evidently, some care
+ had been taken to leave house walls and boundary walls on the
+ street standing, so as to hide some part of the destruction, and
+ thus make things look better than they really were.
+
+ 'Natives of the place gave us numbers, which showed the population
+ was then estimated at not much, if any, more than half the former
+ population. It was expressly stated, however, that the missing half
+ were not regarded as all dead; very many were dead, had died in the
+ place, but many had gone elsewhere--in most cases no one knew
+ where. Of these some few would doubtless return; but it is to be
+ feared that the mortality in a hard year among famine refugees is
+ very large, and of those who left their homes and native places,
+ the few that may eventually return will be very few, I fear.
+
+ 'Doesn't the Bible say that it is a harder fate to die of famine
+ than to die by the sword--to die stricken through for want of the
+ fruits of the earth? But of all those who died in the famine in
+ North China there is one class whose case is perhaps more
+ distressing than ordinary. A large number of people seem to have
+ died just as the harvest--a plentiful one--ripened. Through all
+ these hard dreary months, when, day after day, month after month,
+ they looked for and longed for rain, those I now speak of struggled
+ through, kept up hope, fared hard, hoped eagerly, and at last saw
+ the rain come, saw the crops flourishing, saw them beginning to
+ ripen, congratulated themselves and others on the prospect of
+ abundant food and better days. But they were to see it with their
+ eyes, but not to eat thereof. As far as could be gathered from the
+ natives themselves, the case would seem to be thus.
+
+ 'The great mass of the population was much reduced in bodily
+ strength by the long period of half-starvation they went through;
+ summer and early autumn came with the rains and the attendant ague,
+ which last--the ague--still more reduced the strength of their
+ already emaciated frames. You can imagine them, with lean faces and
+ hungry eyes, tottering about the fields, and counting the days that
+ must yet elapse before the grain would ripen. The rage of hunger
+ was no longer to be borne; they anticipated by a few days the
+ ripening; took the grain, still a little green--perhaps sometimes
+ very green--and put it into the pot. But here again was another
+ difficulty. The fuel used is grain stalks, and the famine deprived
+ them at once of food and fuel. Green grain they might cook, but
+ green-grain stalks would not burn. Fuel was thus deficient; and
+ was it wonderful if, as they stood round the pot, and the fuel was
+ deficient, their patience should fail them and they should fall
+ upon the food half cooked? That was bad enough; but that is not
+ all. The Chinese have nearly as little self-control as children;
+ and is it to be wondered at if, when at last, after long months of
+ the slow torture of unappeased hunger, they found a full meal
+ before them, they should have eaten to the full? When a man
+ emaciated from having gone through a famine, and further enfeebled
+ after repeated prostrations by ague, at length rises up and gorges
+ himself with farinaceous food, half ripe and half cooked, the
+ consequences are not difficult to divine. Diarrh[oe]a and dysentery
+ set in, and became fearfully prevalent--not only prevalent, but
+ peculiarly fatal. To make matters worse, medicines in that part of
+ the country are dear; the people were too poor to get medical help,
+ and great numbers who had lived to see the famine end and
+ prosperity return lived only to see the prosperity, and to die when
+ it touched them. The famine fever in summer seems to have been
+ fearfully prevalent. It is said that in a single courtyard two or
+ three people would be lying about the gate, two or three under the
+ shadow of some house, two or three more inside the house--all
+ stricken down with fever. The air of some villages is said to have
+ been loaded with the effluvia to such an extent that one riding
+ along the street perceptibly discerned the taint in the atmosphere.
+ The fever was deadly too, but evidently not so deadly in proportion
+ as the autumn dysentery. Frequently, when talking to a boy, we
+ would hear he was an orphan, and, on inquiry, he told that his
+ father had died in autumn; frequently, in talking to a woman, we
+ would hear that she was a widow, and, on asking when her husband
+ died, the reply was, "Autumn."
+
+ 'We reached Hsiao Chang in a snowstorm on Saturday afternoon. A few
+ of the people, doubtless, heard of our arrival; but those of the
+ other villages probably did not know we had come; so that our being
+ there, perhaps, did not materially increase the number of the
+ congregation that assembled next day (Sunday). Sunday was a dull,
+ uncomfortable day; the ground covered with snow; the sky still
+ covered with clouds; no sunshine; yet there was a congregation of
+ about one hundred and thirty, of whom eighty (about) would be
+ women, and fifty (about) be men. The next Sabbath, January 26, was
+ still dull; the congregation numbered about two hundred and
+ eighty--men, say, one hundred and thirty; women, say, one hundred
+ and fifty. Mr. Lees took the women into the chapel. I took the men
+ outside in another court, and preached to them from a terrace which
+ gave me a commanding view of my congregation. Mr. Lees had too
+ little ventilation, I had too much of it; but both of our
+ congregations listened well, though there was no sun, though the
+ cold was intense, and though stray flakes of snow wandered slowly
+ down among us as we worshipped. The next Sabbath, February 2, was
+ fine. All except adherents were excluded, and the congregation
+ numbered about eighty men, and one hundred and twenty women. Twelve
+ men and seven women were baptized.
+
+ 'The most novel feature of the work I noticed was the eagerness
+ displayed to learn and sing hymns. Sometimes poor old women, from
+ whom we could not extract much Catechism information about the
+ unity in trinity and other theological mysteries, brightened up
+ their old wrinkled faces when asked if they could sing, and when
+ asked to give us a specimen of their singing, would raise their
+ cracked and quavering voices and go through "There is a happy
+ land," or "The Great Physician," or "Safe in the arms of Jesus," a
+ good deal out of tune here and there, it is true, but on the whole
+ creditably as regards music, and with an apparent earnestness and
+ feeling that was hard to witness with dry eyes. And if the old
+ women sang thus, what of the young people? They seemed to revel in
+ hymns. The old, big, orthodox hymn-book used in our chapels got a
+ good deal of patronage and attention; but their great favourites
+ were those in a small collection of the Sankey revival hymns
+ translated (with a few exceptions) and published by Mr. Lees. These
+ hymns contain good gospel, seem to be easily learned, and are set
+ to tunes which the Chinese seem never to sing themselves tired of.
+ The preachers have mastered a goodly number of them, and teach them
+ to all comers; but, Mr. Lees being a singer, of course, when he
+ arrived, there were high singing festivals, and the practice at
+ evening prayers was sometimes so vigorous and prolonged that the
+ tympanum of one of my ears began to show symptoms of defeat. These
+ hymns I regard as a most powerful auxiliary to the other Gospel
+ agencies at work, and I hope a great deal of good from them.
+
+ 'Every Chinaman wants looking after. Even the best and most
+ trustworthy men are all the better for being well and carefully
+ superintended. In fact, the better a man is, the better he pays for
+ being well looked after. The present state of country mission work
+ in North China calls for careful supervision in an especial degree.
+ Unforeseen circumstances arise that need prompt action where a
+ wrong course of action may be disastrous; something or other
+ happens that dismays the whole of the little Christian community;
+ something or other happens that lifts them up into pride; the
+ Christians are like little islands of Christianity isolated in a
+ vast ocean of heathenism, and the waves seem to threaten to swallow
+ them up. The missionary, simply by going and putting in an
+ appearance, or by giving a little simple advice, or by speaking a
+ few words of encouragement, or by devising a few simple methods, or
+ making a few simple arrangements, can often keep the Church out of
+ moral danger, infuse new hope and courage to the members and
+ preachers, and, under God, put fresh life and vigour into the whole
+ concern. As iron sharpeneth iron, so doth a man the face of his
+ friend; and this is true in an especial degree of a missionary and
+ his preachers and converts.'
+
+In the course of a subsequent tour in the same district, in 1880, he
+gives in his diary a sketch of a sermon preached by Liu, his Chinese
+helper, one which may be taken as a specimen of the best class of
+address given by a converted Chinaman to his fellow-countrymen.
+
+ 'Liu's subject was from Revelation, "Whosoever will, let him take
+ of the water of life freely." He went into an elaborate detail
+ about the use of water, washing, laying the dust in a room being
+ swept out, (a la Bunyan) making a sinking sand hard and good for a
+ cart and man to travel on. Finally, he got to a couple of good
+ stories about a man who got drunk and had his face blackened, so
+ that when he came home his own father did not know him and would
+ not let him in, and when he saw himself accidentally in a mirror he
+ did not know himself. His drunkenness had completely changed his
+ appearance and voice even.
+
+ 'So God made us in His own image, but sin has terribly changed us.
+ Purified by the Holy Ghost we may again be like ourselves and God.
+
+ 'The service lasted about two hours and ten minutes. The story
+ parts of the sermon were very effective.'
+
+A later entry in the diary runs: 'Had service. Preached "Jesus saves,"
+the sermon for the heathen of that name.' One who often heard him preach
+in China gives the following estimate of his power and method in
+delivering his message:--
+
+ 'As a preacher Gilmour was most unconventional. His sermons were
+ direct talks, without any attempt at rhetoric. They were
+ plentifully illustrated, largely from events in his own experience.
+ Laughable allusions or quaint ways of putting things were
+ frequently used. While there was not much attractive in the manner
+ of the preacher, the directness of his remark and his evident
+ earnestness always made his sermons appreciated and enjoyed. The
+ Chinese were always glad to hear him, and words he used to speak
+ are often referred to.'
+
+Writing on one occasion to a friend in England being educated for the
+Christian ministry, who had just taken one of the higher degrees at the
+London University, he said:--
+
+ 'I don't think our work is so much unlike, after all. You witness
+ for Christ, so do I; and though you are in a Christian country and
+ I in a heathen land, human nature is human nature, and not so
+ different as might be supposed. You may, pray you may, see more
+ fruit of your work than I do, but your trials, and difficulties,
+ and temptations will be, no doubt are, pretty much the same as
+ mine. May the Lord help you and bless you now and for ever! I hope
+ He will help you to have ever a heart ready to preach simply the
+ simple Gospel to your hearers, half of whom, perhaps, know almost
+ nothing of salvation, though they have been listening to sermons
+ about it all their lives, and would not know in the least to which
+ hand to turn if they were aroused and became anxious to be saved.
+ I'll give you a text, which I think peculiarly suitable for you,
+ now a graduate. Isaiah 1. 4--"The Lord God hath given me the tongue
+ of the learned, that I should know how to speak a word in season to
+ him that is weary." I like to dwell on this text. Learning should
+ not make deep sermons, hard to be understood; on the contrary, it
+ should be all employed to make the road simple and clear. Forgive
+ me for exhorting you so, but I can't refrain from it when I think
+ of the many learned men I know at home and here who employ their
+ learning in giving learned sermons, _not_ in making the way simple
+ and plain.'
+
+The sermon referred to in the extract quoted above from the diary is
+based on Matt. i. 21. It was never written out; but the notes of it lie
+before us, and we quote them as an illustration of his way of addressing
+both Chinese and English audiences. It may interest the reader to
+endeavour to make out from it the line of thought, and any who may have
+heard him preach or speak will find it easy to recall _how_ he preached
+it.
+
+ 'Matt. i. 21. 'He shall save people from their sins.'
+
+ 'Talk to a man, he admits he is sinner; by-and-by he will break off
+ and become good.
+
+ 'He does not really know what sin is. Egypt!
+
+ 'It is a _disease_; if you get it can you leave it off? Your blood
+ is tainted.
+
+ 'It is a _fire_; once light it, you can't quench it, it smoulders
+ and breaks out afresh.
+
+ 'It is an _evil root_, evil weed, can easy sow, not extirpate.
+
+ 'Sin is like the current above Niagara.
+
+ 'It becomes a _habit_. Indulgence makes habit grow.
+
+ 'It is like a _spider_; one thread after another binds up a fly.
+
+ 'Such is sin--murder, robbery, theft, adultery, uncleanness, lying,
+ covetousness, hatred, anger, malice, want of love to God or man.
+
+ 'Many of these sins you not accused of, but you have sin: sin is
+ fatal, can you free yourself? _Jesus is to do it._
+
+ 'Disease, fire, root, current, habit, fly. _The man cannot free
+ himself: Jesus must set him free._
+
+ 'Not only from _Hell_, but from sin.
+
+ 'Suppose you were freed only from Hell, and transported to Heaven,
+ could you be happy? Who would be your companions?
+
+ 'Ignorant (wicked) man in company of learned (holy).
+
+ '_A Tientsin vagrant_ became chair-bearer; had clothes, etc., but
+ only for a day; he was soon naked again.
+
+ 'Christ does not transport to Heaven only.
+
+ '_Disease._--Not die from it; He cures it.
+
+ '_Fire._--Not consumed by it; He quenches it.
+
+ '_Root_ of evil; He clears from the ground.
+
+ '_Niagara._--He lifts you out of the current on to an island.
+
+ '_Habit._--He sets you free from it.
+
+ '_Spider's fly._--He not only takes from the spider; but He sets it
+ free from the toils.
+
+ '_Jesus gives_ second nature; you are born again.
+
+ 'But upon one _condition_, your consent. The _disease_ is severe:
+ you must obey doctor; if you do not submit to operation; not take
+ bitter drugs; then he does not heal.
+
+ '_Lead_ a man to Peking: not come, not follow: leave him: lead to
+ heaven, paths of holiness not follow, not reach.
+
+ 'Has Christ saved you? If yes, visible to self and others. He is
+ not only an object of respect, admiration: He is the doctor into
+ whose hands you put your soul for treatment.
+
+ '_Two brothers_, Kite, Loe, Pet Dog.
+
+ '_John of Hankow's Liu_, see Chronicle; dead _v._ alive; sick (of
+ fever) _v._ whole. Is it last time? Mongols feel queer.
+
+ '_Missionaries._ Mongol doctor who had not courage to treat
+ himself.
+
+ '_S. S. Teacher_: Paul: be a castaway,
+
+ 'Christ Matt. i. 21-23.
+
+ 'Any religion good enough. No: no religion breaks bondage of sin:
+ go down to death in sin's slavery. Only Jesus can save from sin.
+ _Ask, and He'll do it._'
+
+During the winters in Peking he still used every effort to get at the
+Mongols frequenting the capital.
+
+ 'The Mongols who visit Peking connect themselves with two great
+ centres. "The Outside Lodging," which is about a mile or more north
+ of the north wall of Peking, and is also called the "Halha
+ Lodging," because it is the great resort of the Northern Mongols,
+ and the "Inside Lodging," which is near the inside of the south
+ wall of the Manchu City of Peking, is situated close behind the
+ English Legation, and is also called the "Cold Lodging;" this name
+ being probably due to the fact that in the open space in this
+ "Inside Lodging" a good many Mongols camp out in their tents, in
+ place of hiring courts and rooms from the Chinese. These are the
+ two great _centres_ for Mongols in Peking. Many of them lodge in
+ the immediate neighbourhood, and even those who lodge in other
+ parts of the city frequent these two centres; so that, if any one
+ wants to know whether or not any individual Mongol has come to
+ Peking, he seeks him at one or other of these marts.
+
+ 'In the winter of 1879-80 I set up a book-stall, with a Chinaman to
+ care for it, at the Outside Lodging, going myself, as a rule, every
+ second day. This winter I followed the example of the pedlars, and,
+ hanging two bags of books from my shoulders, hunted the Mongols
+ out, going not only to the trading places, but in and out among the
+ lanes where they lodged, visiting the Outside Lodging first and the
+ Inside Lodging later in the day. The number of Mongols outside the
+ city became latterly so small that it was not visited very often;
+ but during the Chinese eleventh and the first part of the twelfth
+ month, the number of Mongols to be met with at the Inside Lodging
+ was fair, and the number of books disposed of altogether, both
+ outside and inside the city, amounted to seven hundred and
+ fourteen.
+
+ 'In many cases the Mongols, before buying, and not unfrequently
+ after buying, would insist on having the book read, supposing that
+ they got more for their money when they not only had the book, but
+ had me let them hear its contents. Of course I was only too glad to
+ have the opportunity of reading, which readily changed to
+ opportunity for talking; and in this way, from time to time, little
+ groups of Mongols would gather round and listen to short addresses
+ on the main doctrines of Christianity. Several men whom I accosted
+ seemed familiar with the name of Jesus, and had some knowledge of
+ Christianity. Some bought the books eagerly; some not only did not
+ buy themselves, but exhorted others not to buy; some openly spoke
+ against Christianity; but a great many of those who listened to an
+ address or took part in a conversation evinced interest in the
+ subjects spoken of, and remarked that salvation by another bearing
+ our sin was a reasonable doctrine. As the purchasers of these books
+ hailed from all parts of Mongolia, the tracts thus put into their
+ hands will reach to even remote localities in the west, north, and
+ east, and my prayer is that the reading of them may be the
+ beginning of what shall lead to a saving knowledge of the truth in
+ some minds. Hoping for some good result, I had my address stamped
+ on many of the books, to enable such as might wish to learn more to
+ know where to come.
+
+ 'In some cases, Mongols wishing to buy books had no money, but were
+ willing to give goods instead; and thus it happened that I
+ sometimes made my way home at night with a miscellaneous collection
+ of cheese, sour-curd, butter and millet cake and sheep's fat,
+ representing the produce of part of the day's sales.'
+
+A short time before he returned to England on his first furlough he drew
+up a report, in which he places on record some of the results of his ten
+years' experience of Mongol life and habits.
+
+ 'On one occasion I was living some weeks in a Mongol's tent. It was
+ late in the year. Lights were put out soon after dark. The nights
+ were long in reality, and, in such unsatisfactory surroundings as
+ the discomforts of a poor tent and doubtful companions, the nights
+ seemed longer than they were. At sunrise I was only too glad to
+ escape from smoke and everything else to the retirement of the
+ crest of a low ridge of hills near the tent. This, perhaps the most
+ natural thing in the world for a foreigner, was utterly
+ inexplicable to the Mongols. The idea that any man should get out
+ of his bed at sunrise and climb a hill for nothing! He must be up
+ to mischief! He must be secretly taking away the luck of the land!
+ This went on for some time, the Mongols all alive with suspicion,
+ and the unsuspecting foreigner retiring regularly morning after
+ morning, till at length a drunken man blurted out the whole thing,
+ and openly stated the conviction that the inhabitants had arrived
+ at, namely, that this extraordinary morning walk of the foreigner
+ on the hill crest boded no good to the country. To remain among the
+ people I had to give up my morning retirement.
+
+ 'The Mongols are very suspicious of seeing a foreigner writing.
+ What _can_ he be up to? they say among themselves. Is he taking
+ notes of the capabilities of the country? Is he marking out a road
+ map, so that he can return guiding an army? Is he, as a wizard,
+ carrying off the good luck of the country in his note-book? These,
+ and a great many others, are the questions that they ask among
+ themselves and put to the foreigner when they see him writing; and
+ if he desires to conciliate the good-will of the people, and to win
+ their confidence, the missionary must abstain from walking and
+ writing while he is among them.
+
+ 'On another point, too, a missionary must be careful. He must not
+ go about shooting. Killing beasts or birds the Mongols regard as
+ peculiarly sinful, and anyone who wished to teach them religious
+ truth would make the attempt under great disadvantage if he carried
+ and used a gun. This, however, is a prejudice that it is not so
+ difficult to refrain from offending.
+
+ 'The diseases presented for treatment are legion, but the most
+ common cases are skin diseases and diseases of the eye and teeth.
+ Perhaps rheumatism is _the_ disease of Mongolia; but the manner of
+ life and customs of the Mongols are such that it is useless to
+ attempt to cure it. Cure it to-day, it is contracted again
+ to-morrow. Skin diseases present a fair field for a medical
+ missionary. They are so common, and the Mongolian treatment of them
+ is so far removed from common-sense, that anyone with a few
+ medicines and a little intelligence has ample opportunity of
+ benefiting many sufferers. The same may be said of the eye. The
+ glare of the sun on the Plain at all seasons, except when the grass
+ is fresh and green in summer, the blinding sheen from the snowy
+ expanse in winter, and the continual smoke that hangs like a cloud
+ two or three feet above the floor of the tent, all combine to
+ attack the eye. Eye diseases are therefore very common. The lama
+ medicines seem to be able to do nothing for such cases, and a few
+ remedies in a foreigner's hands work cures that seem wonderful to
+ the Mongols.
+
+ 'In many cases, when a Mongol applies to his doctor, he simply
+ extends his hand, and expects that the doctor, by simply feeling
+ his pulse, will be able to tell, not only the disease, but what
+ will cure it. As soon as the doctor has felt the pulse of one
+ hand, the patient at once extends the other hand that the pulse may
+ be felt there also, and great surprise is manifested when a
+ foreigner begins his diagnosis of a case by declining the proffered
+ wrist and asking questions.
+
+ 'The question of "How did you get this disease?" often elicits some
+ curiously superstitious replies. One man lays the blame on the
+ stars and constellations. Another confesses that when he was a lad
+ he was mischievous, and dug holes in the ground or cut shrubs on
+ the hill, and it is not difficult to see how he regards disease as
+ a punishment for digging, since by digging worms are killed; but
+ what cutting wood on a hill can have to do with sin it is harder to
+ see, except it be regarded as stealing the possessions of the
+ spiritual lord of the locality. In consulting a doctor, too, a
+ Mongol seems to lay a deal of stress on the belief that it is his
+ _fate_ to be cured by the medical man in question, and, if he finds
+ relief, often says that his meeting this particular doctor and
+ being cured is the result of prayers made at some previous time.
+
+ 'One difficulty in curing Mongols is that they frequently, when
+ supplied with medicines, depart entirely from the doctor's
+ instructions when they apply them; and a not unfrequent case is
+ that of the patient who, after applying to the foreigner for
+ medicine and getting it, is frightened by his success, or scared by
+ some lying report of his neighbours, or staggered at the fact that
+ the foreigner would not feel his pulse, or feel it at one wrist
+ only, lays aside the medicine carefully and does not use it at all.
+
+ 'In Mongolia, too, a foreigner is often asked to perform absurd,
+ laughable, or impossible cures. One man wants to be made clever,
+ another to be made fat, another to be cured of insanity, another of
+ tobacco, another of whisky, another of hunger, another of tea;
+ another wants to be made strong, so as to conquer in gymnastic
+ exercises; most men want medicine to make their beards grow; while
+ almost every man, woman, and child wants to have his or her skin
+ made as white as that of the foreigner.
+
+ 'When a Mongol is convinced that his case is hopeless he takes it
+ very calmly, and bows to his fate, whether it be death or chronic
+ disease; and Mongol doctors, and Mongol patients too, after a
+ succession of failures, regard the affliction as a thing fated, to
+ be unable to overcome which implies no lack of medical ability on
+ the doctor's part.
+
+ 'Of all the healing appliances in the hands of a foreigner none
+ strikes the fancy of a Mongol so much as the galvanic battery, and
+ it is rather curious that almost every Mongol who sees it and tries
+ its effect exclaims what a capital thing it would be for examining
+ accused persons. It would far surpass whipping, beating, or
+ suspending. Under its torture a guilty man could not but "confess."
+ Some one in England has advocated the use of the galvanic battery
+ in place of the cat in punishing criminals, and it is rather
+ curious to note the coincidence of the English and Mongol mind.
+
+ 'The Mongol doctors are not, it would seem, quite unacquainted with
+ the properties of galvanism. It is said that they are in the habit
+ of prescribing the loadstone ore, reduced to powder, as efficacious
+ when applied to sores, and one man hard of hearing had been
+ recommended by a lama to put a piece of loadstone into each ear and
+ chew a piece of iron in his mouth!
+
+ 'Divination is another point on which Mongols are troublesome. It
+ never for a moment enters their head that a man so intelligent and
+ well fitted out with appliances as a foreigner seems to them to be
+ cannot divine. Accordingly they come to him to divine for them
+ where they should camp to be lucky and get rich, when a man who has
+ gone on a journey will return, why no news has been received from a
+ son or husband who is serving in the army, where they should dig a
+ well so as to get plenty of good water near the surface, whether it
+ would be fortunate for them to venture on some trading speculation,
+ whether they should go on some projected journey, in what direction
+ they should search for lost cattle, or, more frequently than any of
+ the above, they come, men and women, old and young, to have the
+ general luck of their lives examined into. Great is their amazement
+ when the foreigner confesses his ignorance of such art, and greater
+ still is their incredulity.
+
+ 'The great obstacles to success in doctoring the Mongols are
+ two:--First: most of the afflicted Mongols suffer from chronic
+ diseases for which almost nothing can be done. Second: in many
+ cases, where alleviation or cures are effected, they are only of
+ short duration, as no amount of explanation or exhortation seems
+ sufficient to make them aware of the importance of guarding against
+ causes of disease. But, notwithstanding all this, many cures can be
+ effected on favourable subjects, and the fact that the missionary
+ carries medicines with him and attempts to heal, and that without
+ money and without price, aids the missionary cause by bringing him
+ into friendly communication with many who would doubtless hold
+ themselves aloof from any one who approached them in no other
+ character but that of a teacher of Christianity.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+THE VISIT TO ENGLAND IN 1882
+
+
+From 1880 onwards Mrs. Gilmour suffered severely from illness, and
+medical advisers recommended at length the rest and change of a visit to
+England. Mr. Gilmour's furlough was also nearly due. Consequently, in
+the spring of 1882, he and his family returned to England. This visit
+was helpful and memorable in many ways. The rest so thoroughly well
+earned was greatly enjoyed. The return to civilisation, the society of
+loved relatives and friends, the comforts of ordinary English life, and
+the change of thought and occupation which these involved--all reacted
+happily and refreshingly upon both Mr. Gilmour and his wife.
+
+But a sojourn at home is not by any means a season of entire rest for
+the jaded worker. The Churches constantly need the stimulus and
+awakening that are best supplied by the men who have been filling the
+hard places in the field. Gilmour also was so full of enthusiasm for his
+work, and so eager in his desire to benefit the Mongols, that he would
+doubtless have found for himself many opportunities of pleading their
+cause, had not the authorities of the London Missionary Society,
+following their usual custom, furnished him with a long list of
+deputation engagements, Into these he threw himself with an energy that
+very greatly enlarged the circle of his friendship, secured very many
+new supporters for the missionary cause, and obtained for himself, on
+the part of many, a devout, prayerful sympathy for the remainder of his
+earthly service.
+
+He had brought with him a large quantity of manuscript material dealing
+with his twelve years of Mongol life and experience. From this he
+prepared the volume which was published by the Religious Tract Society
+in April 1883, under the title of _Among the Mongols_.
+
+The book was very cordially welcomed by the press, and we single out for
+quotation a portion of one review which stands out pre-eminent not only
+for its literary quality, but also as placing on record the impression
+James Gilmour was able to make upon men entirely ignorant of him and his
+work by the simple narrative of his experiences. It appeared in the
+_Spectator_ for April 28, 1883.
+
+ 'We have a difficulty in passing judgment on this book. It is
+ possible, even probable, that the impression it has made on us is
+ individual to this reviewer, and due to an accident which, with
+ other readers, will not repeat itself. Having time, and an interest
+ in nomads, he read a page or two, and read on, and read on, for
+ five hours, till he had finished the book,--which is much too
+ short,--fascinated, lost, carried out of himself and England. He
+ was in Mongolia, sitting under a blue-cloth tent, with savage dogs
+ howling around, and gazing outside, through the doorless doorway,
+ on a vast panorama of poor tufted grass, stretching away to huge
+ black hills in the distance, and Tartars on camels, Tartars on
+ horses, Tartars on springless, unbreakable ox-carts, hastening up
+ to the encampment; while inside he listened to a quiet Scotchman,
+ resignedly yet clearly explaining everything in a voice---- there
+ was the puzzle. Where in the world had the reviewer heard that
+ voice before, with its patient monotone, as well known as his
+ oldest friend's, its constant digressions and "reflections," its
+ sentences so familiar, yet so new, sentences which, as each topic
+ came up, he could write before they were uttered. "James Gilmour,
+ M.A." Never knew him, or heard of him; yet here was he, talking
+ exactly as some one else had years ago talked a hundred times. So
+ oppressive at last became the will-o'-the-wisp reminiscence, that
+ the reviewer stopped, after an account of the Desert of Gobi, and
+ deliberately read it through again, in search of a clue which might
+ reawaken his memory. It was all in vain, and it was not till
+ another hundred pages had been passed, always under the impression
+ of that bewildering reminiscence, that he exclaimed to himself,
+ "That's it! Robinson Crusoe has turned missionary, lived years in
+ Mongolia, and written a book about it." That is this book. To any
+ one who, perhaps from early neglect, does not perceive this truth,
+ our judgment will seem erroneous; but to any one who does, we may
+ quite fearlessly appeal. The student of _Robinson Crusoe_ never
+ expected that particular pleasure in this life, and he will never
+ have it again; but for this once he has it to the full. Mr. James
+ Gilmour, though a man of whom any country may be proud, is not a
+ deep thinker, and not a bright writer, and not a man with the gift
+ of topographical, or, indeed, any other kind of description. He
+ thinks nothing extraordinary, and has nothing to say quotable.
+ There is a faint, far-off humour in him, humour sternly repressed;
+ but that, so far as we know, is the only quality in his writing
+ which makes him _litterateur_ at all. But Heaven, which has denied
+ him many gifts, has given him one in full measure,--the gift of
+ Defoe, the power of so stating things that the reader not only
+ believes them, but sees them in bodily presence, that he is there
+ wherever the author chooses to place him, under the blue tent,
+ careering over the black ice of Lake Baikal, or hobnobbing in tea
+ with priests as unlike Englishmen as it is possible for human
+ beings to be, yet, such is his art, in nowise unintelligible or
+ strange. It may be, as we have said, that it is an individual
+ impression, but we never read, save once, the kind of book in our
+ lives, did not deem it possible ever again to meet with this
+ special variety of unconscious literary skill. We are aware of a
+ dozen shortcomings, of a hundred points upon which Mr. Gilmour
+ ought to have given light, and has not; but there has been, if our
+ experience serves us at all, no book quite like this book since
+ _Robinson Crusoe_; and _Robinson Crusoe_ is not better, does not
+ tell a story more directly, or produce more instantaneous and final
+ conviction. Heaven help us all, if Mr. Gilmour tells us that he has
+ met any unknown race in Mongolia, say, people with the power of
+ making themselves invisible, for Tyndall will believe him, and
+ Huxley account for them, and the _Illustrated London News_ publish
+ their portraits--in the stage of invisibility. We do not say the
+ book is admirable, or perfect, or anything else superlative; but we
+ do say, and this with sure confidence, that no one who begins it
+ will leave it till the narrative ends, or doubt for an instant,
+ whether he knows Defoe or not, that he has been enchained by
+ something separate and distinct in literature, something almost
+ uncanny in the way it has gripped him, and made him see for ever a
+ scene he never expected to see.
+
+ 'We do not know that we have any more to say about the book. Its
+ merit is that, and no other; and we do not suppose anybody ever
+ proved _Robinson Crusoe's_ value by extracts. But we must say a
+ word or two about the author and his subject. Mr. Gilmour, though a
+ Scotchman, is apparently attached to the London Mission, and seems
+ to have quitted Peking for Mongolia on an impulse to teach Christ
+ to Tartars. He could not ride, he did not know Mongolian, he had an
+ objection to carry arms, and he had no special fitness except his
+ own character, which he knew nothing about, for the work.
+ Nevertheless, he went, and stayed years, living on half-frozen
+ prairies and deserts under open tents, on fat mutton, sheep's tails
+ particularly, tea, and boiled millet, eating only once a day
+ because Mongols do, and in all things, except lying, stealing, and
+ prurient talk, making himself a lama. As he could not ride, he rode
+ for a month over six hundred miles of dangerous desert, where the
+ rats undermine the grass, and at the end found that that difficulty
+ has disappeared for ever. As he could not talk, he "boarded out"
+ with a lama, listened and questioned, and questioned and listened,
+ till he knew Mongolian as Mongols know it, till his ears became so
+ open that he was painfully aware that Mongol conversation, like
+ that of most Asiatics, is choked with _doubles entendres_. As for
+ danger, he had made up his mind not to carry arms, not to be angry
+ with a heathen, happen what might, and--though he does not mention
+ this--not to be afraid of anything whatever, neither dogs nor
+ thieves, nor hunger nor the climate; and he kept those three
+ resolutions. If ever on earth there lived a man who kept the law of
+ Christ, and could give proofs of it, and be absolutely unconscious
+ that he was giving them, it is this man, whom the Mongols he lived
+ among called "our Gilmour." He wanted, naturally enough, sometimes
+ to meditate away from his hosts, and sometimes to take long walks,
+ and sometimes to geologise, but he found all these things roused
+ suspicion--for why should a stranger want to be alone; might it not
+ be "to steal away the luck of the land"?--and as a suspected
+ missionary is a useless missionary, Mr. Gilmour gave them all up,
+ and sat endlessly in tents, among lamas. And he says incidentally
+ that his fault is impatience, a dislike to be kept waiting!'
+
+[Illustration: A MONGOL CAMEL CART
+(_From a Native Sketch_)]
+
+The book met with a ready and wide acceptance. It soon 'found its
+public.' It was only to be expected that many of the friends and
+supporters of the London Missionary Society would welcome it. And there
+are others, like the reviewer, who 'have time and an interest in
+nomads,' who were certain to consult it. But in addition to these
+special classes the book did good service in some cases, by deepening
+the impression already made by other first-rate delineations of
+missionary enterprise and endurance, and in others by creating respect
+for missions and missionaries in minds hitherto strange to that feeling.
+In various editions very many thousands of the book have been sold
+during the nine years which have passed since the publication of the
+first edition.
+
+The success of his book led to the suggestion that he might easily find
+much useful employment for his pen. He did contribute some papers to the
+_Sunday at Home_, _Pall Mall Gazette_, and other publications. But in
+this, as in all other enterprises, loyalty to the great work of his life
+ruled him. He soon came to the conviction that he ought not to take time
+from the work of winning souls, and spend it in writing papers and
+books--and from the moment of that decision he put mere literary work
+resolutely aside.
+
+ 'I feel keenly,' he wrote in 1884, on his return to Peking, 'that
+ there is here more than I can do, and writing must go to the wall.'
+ And as late in his life as 1890 he added, 'I could have made, and
+ could now make, I believe, money by writing, but I do not write. I
+ settle down to teach illiterate Chinamen and Mongols, heal their
+ sores, and present Christ to them.'
+
+Towards the end of 1882 James Gilmour entered upon a long series of
+meetings on behalf of the London Missionary Society, consisting of
+sermons and addresses to Sunday School children on the Sunday, and
+speeches at public meetings during the week. A long series of his
+letters written to his wife between November 1882 and March 1883 is
+still extant, and they form an impressive record of the work considered
+suitable for a wearied missionary at home in search of rest and change.
+He visited Edinburgh, Falkirk, Glasgow, Liverpool, Kilsyth, Hamilton,
+Paisley, Dundee, St Andrews, Arbroath, Lytham, Aberdeen, Montrose,
+Manchester, Hingham, Cambridge, Norfolk, and Southampton. And this list
+exhausts only a portion of his excursions on the effort to stimulate and
+develope the faith and the zeal of the churches at home. His wanderings
+brought him into contact sometimes with relatives, sometimes with old
+college friends, now grave pastors fast hastening towards middle life.
+The meetings he attended always added to the circle of his friends, for
+none could hear his ringing voice, and feel the clasp of his hand, and
+pass under the influence of his ardent enthusiasm on behalf of the great
+enterprise of the modern Christian Church without receiving an
+impression never likely to be effaced.
+
+He in turn experienced a strong and abiding spiritual refreshment from
+this renewal, after twelve years' absence, of touch and fellowship with
+the Christian life of Great Britain. His earnestness deepened, he
+studied with intensest interest movements like the Salvation Army, then
+coming into great prominence, and other agencies for improving the
+religious life of the nation, and he rejoiced in all fellowship with
+other disciples of the Lord Jesus which had for its aim the
+strengthening of the life of faith.
+
+He rejoiced greatly when at infrequent intervals a Sunday came upon
+which he was entirely free from engagements. Such rare occasions he
+utilised very fully for spiritual edification. He was somewhat hampered
+in his possibilities on these days by the fact that his temporary home
+was at Bexley Heath, and his strong Sabbatarian views never permitted
+him to travel by rail or omnibus on the Lord's Day. The following letter
+shows how he passed one of these days.
+
+ 'Yesterday being a fine day I left home at 7.15 A.M., walked to
+ London (twelve miles), got to Spurgeon's at 10.30. Had a permit
+ from a seat-holder, was close to the platform, heard a good earnest
+ sermon, was introduced to Spurgeon in the vestry after service,
+ went home to one of his deacons for dinner, there met an American
+ who had under Mr. Moody been converted from drunkenness to God, and
+ whose craving for drink was as instantaneously and as thoroughly
+ expelled as the devils by Christ of old. After dinner visited
+ Spurgeon's Stockwell Orphanages, then walked to Camberwell and
+ dropped in, in passing, at the Catholic Apostolic Church and heard
+ a sermon from a man who would have described himself as an Apostle,
+ I suppose, and who ridiculed in a gentle and mild way the idea that
+ all men were to be partakers of the Gospel blessings which he
+ seemed to think were the special property of what he called "The
+ Church"; walked on to Lewisham, heard Morlais Jones: and then
+ walked home in the moonlight, arriving here footsore and weary
+ about 10.20 P.M. I enjoyed the day very much, all but the last four
+ or five miles home at night. I am thankful to find myself so
+ strong. I had a warm bath and slept like a top.'
+
+Those who were privileged to entertain James Gilmour, if congenial, and
+the old friends who were fortunate enough to secure him for even a brief
+period, often experienced his power of vivid and entrancing narration.
+His twelve years of service had been very full of varied and uncommon
+experience, and when in the vein he could make the hours pass almost as
+minutes. 'During this furlough,' writes Dr. Reynolds, 'I had several
+opportunities of intercourse with him, and listened to several of his
+addresses on the progress and need of missionary enterprise in the north
+of China and Mongolia, and was profoundly impressed by his earnestness,
+but I was more deeply moved when in quiet _tete-a-tete_ he unveiled some
+of his special experiences. I should like to mention one. He once had
+great hope of the conversion to God of a Mongol, who had given him his
+entire confidence, and who was suffering from cataract in both eyes.
+Gilmour felt that this was a case in which surgical help might restore
+the sufferer to at least partial sight, and he made arrangements that in
+the escort of a Mongol the patient should find his way to the medical
+institution at Peking. He started on the pilgrimage when Gilmour, with
+his brave young wife, were encamped in a great temporary settlement of
+Mongols, who were in a state of considerable fanatical excitement
+against the new faith and its foreign teacher. Gilmour said, "We prayed
+night and day for the success of this experiment, and we arranged to
+cover all expenses connected with the arrangement." Alas! wind laden
+with dust, and blinding heat and other apparent accidents conspired
+against the poor sufferer, and when the necessary time had elapsed after
+the operation and the bandages were removed, the patient was found to
+be _stone blind_. The Mongol companion stirred up the poor fellow's
+suspicion by telling him that he knew why the Missionary had sent him to
+Peking. "I saw," said he, "the jewel of your eye in a bottle on the
+shelf. These Christians can get hundreds of taels for these jewels which
+they take out of our eyes."
+
+'When the blind man was brought back to Gilmour, his companion spread
+his suspicions and exasperating story in the entire district, and the
+fanatical hatred was augmented into seething and murderous passion, and
+our dear friends were in imminent peril for several weeks. If they had
+ventured to escape, it would have been a confession of a vile conspiracy
+with the Peking doctors, and a signal for their massacre. They remained
+to live down the ominous and odious charge, and in continuous effort to
+justify the simplicity of their motives and the purity and beneficence
+of their mission.
+
+'Deeply moved, as I was, by the story of this hairbreadth escape, I
+asked Mrs. Gilmour more about those fearful weeks of suspense, and she
+assured me that they had been perfectly calm, and that they were
+entirely resigned to God's will, whatever it might be.'
+
+'Many other trials of faith and patience were described by Gilmour,
+without one touch of self-approval or self-admiration, and the only
+trouble that haunted him was that the results of his long journeys and
+of his various missionary enterprises had been apparently so few.'
+
+It was certain that James Gilmour's power as a speaker would be utilised
+for the great event of the London Missionary Society's year, the annual
+meeting at Exeter Hall. This fell, in 1883, on May 10, and he was the
+last speaker. This involved waiting about two hours and a half for his
+speech, and corresponding exhaustion on the part of the audience. But
+none who were present will forget the rapid way in which he secured the
+attention of his hearers, and the ease with which he held it to the
+close. He chose to speak of work in China, rather than in Mongolia; the
+recent publication of his book helping among other reasons to determine
+this choice. Part of the speech deserves reproduction here, because it
+outlines very sharply the work that engaged much of his time while
+resident in Peking, and because nowhere else can such a realistic,
+sparkling, and lifelike picture of the preaching work of the Peking
+mission, and consequently more or less of all preaching in great Chinese
+cities, be found.
+
+ 'In Peking we have three chapels. A chapel there is merely a
+ Chinese shop, put into decent repair, and a signboard stuck over
+ the top. The Chinese are very fond of giving themselves very high
+ names. You will come to a man sitting in a little box scarcely big
+ enough for himself to turn round in, and if you read his sign, it
+ is some flowing name about a hall; it may be the "Hall of Continual
+ Virtue," or something of that kind, or the "Hall of the Five
+ Happinesses." So our title above our chapel just runs in the native
+ idiomatic style, and it is the "Gospel Hall.' Inside there is not
+ very much to see. The counter has been cleared away and the
+ shelves, and, in place of the mud, a brick floor has been put down;
+ and then there are forms arranged for the sitters, and there is a
+ low platform for the speaker. I do not know how it happens, but it
+ does happen, that up in the left-hand corner of the chapel--and it
+ is always the left-hand corner--there is a table and two chairs,
+ and on that table there is a teapot and set of cups, because in
+ China everything is done with tea. You must always begin in that
+ way. These chapels are open six days in the week in the afternoon.
+
+ 'Now, supposing you come in at the door, the natural thing for the
+ missionary seems to be just to walk up to this table and sit down,
+ and then the next thing is to get a congregation. Sometimes there
+ is no difficulty about getting it, if it happens to be a fair day
+ or there is a crowd in the streets. They simply pour in: but the
+ tide goes different ways sometimes, and does not pour in always
+ like that. I want to give you just a fair, square, honest idea of
+ what the thing is. Sometimes the congregation will not come in, and
+ sometimes, after a little while, one man looks in at the door and
+ sees a foreigner, and he is off. He has seen quite enough and does
+ not want to see any more; and if you were to ask him what he had
+ seen, he would not say he had seen a foreigner; no, he would say he
+ had seen "a foreign devil." And, friends, you would not be very
+ much astonished that some of those ignorant men coming from the
+ country are alarmed when they see a foreigner, if you could only
+ imagine the terrible lies that they circulate about us there; about
+ how we take out people's hearts for the purposes of magic, and
+ steal people's eyes to make photographic chemicals, and administer
+ medicines to bewitch them generally. I say that, if the first man
+ who comes to a chapel on an afternoon is a man who has heard these
+ things, you cannot be astonished that all you see of that man is
+ his back and his pigtail as he goes away.
+
+ 'Another man sometimes comes--a bolder man, and he comes in, and
+ the most natural thing for him seems to be to walk up to the table
+ and sit down on the other side, and there you and he are a pair.
+ The proper thing is to pour him out a cup of tea: that is
+ etiquette, and the etiquette seems to be that he should not drink
+ it. Sometimes, after the service begins, I see the native preacher
+ come slyly up, as if he did not mean anything at all; and he walks
+ up to the teapot, and lifts the lid quite quietly, and slips that
+ tea back into the pot again, and puts on the lid and warms it up,
+ and it is ready for the next man who comes.
+
+ 'If you get into conversation with one man, the congregation is,
+ for the most part, practically secured, because, though a Chinaman
+ is very much afraid of being spoken to directly by a foreigner,
+ most Chinamen are very curious to overhear any conversation that
+ may be carried on; so if you are speaking to him, in comes another
+ man to listen, and if you can get other men to come in and listen
+ over each other's backs, very soon more come in than the original
+ speaker cares to overhear his private conversation; and when that
+ step is reached, it is time to go to the platform and ask the
+ hearers to sit down and begin the regular service. Sometimes nobody
+ comes in, and then you have to try something else, and that is to
+ go and sit down a little nearer the door, and sometimes, in that
+ way, gradually a few people come in. But then in Peking sometimes
+ there is a great north-west wind blowing; and I think that is about
+ the hardest thing on a man's congregation before he gets it,
+ because, when the weather is unfavourable, there are not many
+ people about, and so we have to adopt another plan. We do not go on
+ to the streets, but inside the chapel the native preacher and I do
+ our best to sing a hymn. I say do our best, because sometimes these
+ native preachers do not succeed in singing very well; however, we
+ succeed in making a noise, and that is the thing that draws. The
+ people look in, and see what they suppose to be a foreigner and a
+ native chanting Buddhist prayers. In they come; they have not seen
+ that before, and they sit down, and, as soon as the hymn is
+ through, we have the opportunity of telling them the contents of
+ the hymn; and there you have your sermon ready to your hand.
+
+ 'But suppose you have got your congregation, it is not all
+ smooth-sailing water. Sometimes there are interruptions. Sometimes,
+ just when you have the ear of your audience, all at once a
+ tremendous row happens just outside the door, and the congregation
+ jump to their feet and rush out to see what is going on. I could
+ have told them if they had only asked me. No doubt, some unwise
+ Chinaman, in place of coming straight in and sitting down, stood on
+ the outskirt of the crowd on tiptoe. A city thief coming along
+ says, "Ah, there is my man," and he walks quietly up to him with a
+ pair of sharp scissors, cuts off his tobacco pouch, and goes off
+ with it. Of course, as soon as the man misses the pouch, his first
+ impulse is to grab his next neighbour; that neighbour remonstrates,
+ and then a fight commences.
+
+ 'Sometimes a funeral passes, and that is almost as serious an
+ interruption as a fight; because, although a Chinaman does not
+ think much about his soul after he dies, he thinks a vast deal
+ about his dead body, and, in order to be perfectly sure that he
+ will not be cheated by the undertaker, he buys his coffin before he
+ is sick, and sees that he has a good bargain. And so, having a good
+ coffin, he wants a good funeral; and it is said some men spend
+ nearly half of their fortune in having a grand procession when they
+ are carried to their grave. When one of these enormous funerals,
+ with a procession sometimes a quarter of a mile long, comes by, it
+ is a very bad job for your congregation. Out they go to have a look
+ at it.
+
+ 'Then the interruption is sometimes another thing, and this last
+ one is a more difficult case to settle. When one of the upper ten
+ thousand in China has a marriage, they want to have a great
+ exhibition; and after they have bought the furniture, they get and
+ hire a great many men, and have them dressed to carry that
+ furniture in procession along the streets and show it to their
+ neighbours. First comes a great wardrobe, and then a little
+ cupboard, a washstand, a square table, and all sorts of furniture.
+ Now when that comes, what are you to do? They have been at the
+ expense of paying for an exhibition for their neighbours to see,
+ and they feel that it would be unneighbourly if they did not step
+ to the door and look out and see the things carried past, and there
+ goes your congregation. Sometimes unusual interruptions happen. I
+ remember once a woman put her head in at the door. Women do not
+ come to these chapels often--I am very glad they do not. That woman
+ put her head in at the door, and I saw danger. She glared round the
+ place, and then she spied one man, and she shouted out something at
+ him: "Come out of that!" and, friends, he came out of that, in a
+ big hurry, too. He disturbed us very considerably. It was not the
+ woman so much as the man--we all pitied him as he went out.
+
+ 'Those audiences are very mixed, and they are very curious to your
+ eyes. Sometimes I see those audiences, most of whom we do not know
+ anything about, listening to what I have to tell them, quite as
+ still as you are now--their pipes out, the smoke cleared away. They
+ lean forward and listen just as still as audiences in this country
+ sometimes listen when the preacher, in an interesting discourse, is
+ coming up to a division of his subject. And, friends, let me tell
+ you what it is that makes them listen best of all--it is the
+ central doctrine of the truth of Christianity. When we come to tell
+ them of how Christ left the surroundings of heaven, and came to
+ spend so many years in such very poor, unsympathetic company on
+ earth (and that is a subject that a missionary sometimes can talk
+ feelingly upon when he has been in a foreign country for some
+ time), when we can tell them that, and then come to the last and
+ greatest part of all: how Christ allowed Himself, for love of man,
+ to be nailed to the cross, and not only that, but kept in Him that
+ gentle spirit that made Him pray for those who were putting Him to
+ death--oh, friends, when we come to that and tell them of it--I
+ know that a Chinaman is degraded, corrupt, sensual, material, but
+ he has a human heart; and when you can get at the heart, it
+ responds to the story of the Cross. We want to do something in
+ drawing the net, and so, on this table in the corner, there is a
+ pile of books, and as it gets towards the time to close, I say to
+ the friends, "Now, you will soon be going away to your evening
+ meal; and as I am a foreigner, probably you have not understood all
+ that I have said;" and then I say, "Now, before you go, there are a
+ number of books upon this table, where you will find the whole of
+ this subject put down in black and white; will you just come up and
+ have a look at the books before you go?" We want, if possible, to
+ establish a point of contact with them, and so to get a little
+ private conversation, as it were. If you ask them to come up and
+ look at a book, and they ask the price of it, you have an
+ opportunity of talking to them, and some of these men not only buy
+ the books, but they read them and come back for others.
+
+ 'Now, how does the matter stand? These heathen have been in our
+ chapel, and we have taken the opportunity of putting some of the
+ truth into their hearts; but I know a good part, much, it may be,
+ of what the man has heard when he goes out--well, it is stolen
+ away, or it is trampled under foot; but some part of it remains.
+
+ 'And now I can come to the practical part. I have not been trying
+ to entertain you, but I have been trying to interest you, and what
+ I want to impress upon you is this: after those men have left the
+ chapel you can do as much for their conversion as we can do in
+ China. I want you to pray for the conversion of these men to whom
+ we in Peking, and others in other parts of the world, are the means
+ of communicating these truths of Christ. I believe it is not only
+ the earnestness of the missionary that is going to produce results,
+ but it is your earnestness here. We are your agents, and I
+ believe, fervently, we shall have results there in direct
+ proportion to the measure of your earnestness here. I believe I am
+ speaking to the right people when I ask you to pray. Unprayed for,
+ I feel very much as if a diver were sent down to the bottom of a
+ river with no air to breathe, or as if a fireman were sent up to a
+ blazing building and held an empty hose; I feel very much as a
+ soldier who is firing blank cartridge at an enemy, and so I ask you
+ earnestly to pray that the Gospel may take saving and working
+ effect on the minds of those men to whose notice it has been
+ introduced by us. Not long ago, at the close of a local
+ anniversary, when we had been having a meeting, as we were going
+ home, three of us got off a tram-car--two ministers of the locality
+ and myself--and, as we were walking along, one said: "Ah, Gilmour,
+ it is all the same over again; it is just the old thing; you
+ missionaries come, and you have an anniversary, and the people's
+ earnestness seems to be stirred up, and you ask their prayers, and
+ it looks as if you would get them, but," he said, "you go away, and
+ the thing passes by and is just left where it was before." I do not
+ think that was quite correct. I think my brother was labouring
+ under a temporary fit of the blues, and I was very glad to find his
+ companion said it was not quite correct. What I want is this, to go
+ back to my work feeling that there are those behind us who are
+ praying earnestly that God's Spirit would work effectually in the
+ hearts of those to whom we have the privilege of preaching. If you
+ pray earnestly you can but work earnestly, and then you will also
+ give earnestly; and I do not think we can be too earnest in the
+ matter for which Christ was so much in earnest that He laid down
+ His own life.'
+
+The month of June and part of July was spent at Millport, a
+watering-place on the west coast of Scotland, near the lovely scenery
+of Arran. On July 4 he ascended Goatfell, and in so doing had an
+adventure which might have had very serious consequences. He started
+late, lost his way, but finally reached the summit at 8.45 P.M., and
+then, as he notes in his diary: 'Fog came on nearly at once with rain
+and thunder. Sat in the lee of a dripping rock on a wet stone and looked
+at a couple of acres of fog and granite boulders. Very dark and cold
+about midnight, the time wore on very slowly, more rain dripping, and
+fog. At 2 o'clock A.M. I began the descent, and in a short while it was
+light enough to see. Came on all right, and saw where I had missed the
+way.... I have not caught cold. I was wet all night, but kept wrapt up
+in my plaid and as warm as I could manage. Next day the minister
+congratulated me on being seen alive after my Goatfell adventure.'
+
+On September 1 the return voyage to China began, and Peking was reached
+on November 14.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+SUNSHINE AND SHADOW
+
+
+In Peking the old familiar round of mission duties recommenced. Gilmour
+after his absence of eighteen months was the same man, and yet not the
+same. He yearned for fruit in the conversion of souls, and he began to
+devote himself with more eager self-denial than ever to the winning of
+Chinamen's hearts for the Saviour. The winter of 1883-1884 was spent in
+Peking, and his diary is full of incidents illustrative of the time and
+effort he gave to dealing with individuals.
+
+In February, 1884, he made one of the most remarkable of his Mongolian
+journeys. He visited the Plain, travelling on foot, and thus subjecting
+himself to risks and hardships of a very serious order. But he had good
+reasons for his method, and he sets them forth with his usual clearness.
+Possibly no other journey of his life more strikingly testifies to his
+strict sense of duty, the unsparing way in which he spent himself in its
+discharge, and his eager desire to win souls.
+
+ 'On this occasion, partly owing to the shortness of the time at my
+ disposal, which made it hardly worth while to set up an
+ establishment, and partly owing to the peculiar season of the year,
+ which would have made it difficult to find pasture for travelling
+ cattle, I determined to go on foot, without medicines, in a
+ strictly spiritual capacity, and not seeking so much to make fresh
+ acquaintances or open up new ground as to revisit familiar
+ localities and see how far former evangelistic attempts had produced
+ any effect. In addition there were some individual Mongols who have
+ been taught a good deal about Christianity, and on whom I wished
+ once more, while there was still opportunity, to press the claims
+ of Christ.
+
+[Illustration: A CHINESE MULE LITTER]
+
+ 'Five cold days in a mule litter brought me to Kalgan, and another
+ day in a cart took me up over the pass and landed me in a Chinese
+ inn on the Mongolian plain. This inn has no separate rooms; the
+ guests all share the ample platform of the kitchen, and sleep on
+ straw mats laid over the brickwork, which is heated by flues
+ leading from fires on which their meals are cooked. The Chinese
+ innkeeper was an old friend of mine, and he permitted me to share
+ his room with him. From this, as a centre, I was able to make
+ expeditions to four Mongolian settlements.
+
+ 'My first visit was made to a lama whom I have known for years, and
+ who has been instructed in Christianity by others, both before and
+ since I made his acquaintance. He is a man of influence, wealth,
+ and leisure, and, though a priest, has a wife and child. I spent
+ almost a whole day with him, and hardly know what to think about
+ him. He seems to admit that there must be a God of the universe,
+ and admits that Christ may be a revelation of Him, but in the same
+ sense in which Buddha was. From one part of his conversation I was
+ almost led to believe that he had been praying to Jesus, but I
+ could get him to make no such admission. I fear that the inquiring
+ spirit of former years has given place to a spirit of indifference.
+ He has everything he wants, he has little or no care, seemingly; he
+ is content to let things drift, and keeps his mind easy. If he were
+ only waked up he might do much for his countrymen.
+
+ 'My second visit was to a temple and cluster of tents, where I
+ found some old acquaintances; was politely received, but nothing
+ more.
+
+ 'My third visit was to another cluster of tents, where I was at
+ once hailed as the doctor, and, _nolens volens_, compelled to
+ examine and prescribe for a number of diseases. Some cures
+ accomplished years before explained the enthusiasm of the friends
+ there, but for spiritual results I looked in vain.
+
+ 'My next expedition was to a place some miles--say eight--away.
+ Some years ago, in stormy weather, Mrs. Gilmour and I, soaked out
+ of our tent, had found shelter in the mud-house of a Mongol, who
+ refused to take anything for the use of his building, remarking
+ that we would be going and coming that way afterwards, and that
+ then we might give him a present of some foreign article or other.
+ I had sent him a few things, but had never since personally visited
+ him, and when I reached the settlement I was grieved to find that
+ the old man was dead. His son, a lad of twenty-three, had succeeded
+ to his estate, and his small official dignity and emoluments, and
+ received me in a most remarkably friendly way. He was just starting
+ from home, but on seeing me gave up all idea of his going away,
+ and, insisting on my staying in his tent for the night, spent the
+ remainder of the day with me.
+
+ 'Next day, slinging on one side a postman's brown bag containing my
+ kit and provisions; on the other an angler's waterproof bag, with
+ books, &c.; and carrying from a stick over my shoulder a Chinaman's
+ sheepskin coat, I left my landlord drinking the two ounces of hot
+ Chinese whisky which formed the invariable introduction to his
+ breakfast turned my face northwards, and started for a twenty-three
+ miles' walk to the settlement which, for some summers in
+ succession, has furnished me with men and oxen for my annual
+ journeys. Now the Mongols are familiar with the
+
+ Russians, who, as tea-agents, reside in Kalgan; they have seen many
+ passing foreign travellers on horses, camels, and in carts; they
+ have seen missionary journeys performed on donkeys and ox-carts;
+ but I think that that morning for the first time had they seen a
+ foreigner, with all his belongings hung about him, tramping the
+ country after the manner of their own begging lamas. There were few
+ people to meet on the road, but those I did meet asked the
+ customary questions in tones of great surprise, received my answers
+ with evident incredulity, and, for the most part rode away
+ muttering to themselves, _You eldib eem_, which may be translated
+ to mean, "Strange affair." My feet, through want of practice, I
+ suppose, soon showed symptoms of thinking this style of travelling
+ as strange as the Mongols did, and were badly blistered long before
+ the journey was over.
+
+[Illustration: JAMES GILMOUR EQUIPPED FOR HIS WALKING EXPEDITION IN
+MONGOLIA IN FEBRUARY 1884]
+
+ 'An occasional rest and a bite of snow varied the painful monotony
+ of the few last long miles; the river was reached at last, and,
+ crossing it, I was soon in front of the cluster of huts I had come
+ to visit, and on looking up I was agreeably astonished to find that
+ the first man to come out to meet me was the mandarin of the
+ district. He was soon joined by others, and, rescued from the dogs,
+ I was escorted to his tent, seated before the fire, and supplied
+ with a cup and full tea-pot. I had intended to drink tea in his
+ tent only for form's sake; but his tea was good, the snow seemed
+ only to have increased my thirst, the man himself was sincerely
+ friendly; under the circumstances my stoicism broke down, and the
+ mandarin's tea-pot was soon all but empty. Meanwhile, his tent had
+ been filling with friends and neighbours, to whom the news of my
+ arrival had spread, and in a little while I had round me a
+ representative from nearly every family in the village. Among the
+ others came my two servants--the priest and the layman who had
+ driven my ox-carts for me. Escorted by these I went to another
+ tent, rested there awhile, and then moved into a mud-built house.
+ The priest I had come to visit was busy lighting a fire which would
+ do nothing but smoke, and the room was soon full. Finding him
+ alone, I told him that I had come to speak to him and my other
+ friends about the salvation of their souls, and was pressing him to
+ accept Christ, when a layman I also knew entered. Without waiting
+ for me to say anything, the priest related the drift of our
+ conversation to the layman, who, tongs in hand, was trying to make
+ the fire blaze. Blaze it would not, but sent forth an increasing
+ volume of smoke, and the layman, invisible to me in the dense
+ cloud, though only about two yards away, spoke up and said that for
+ months he had been a scholar of Jesus, and that if the priest would
+ join him they would become Christians together. Whether the priest
+ would join him or not, his mind was made up, he would trust the
+ Saviour. By this time the cloud had settled down lower still. I was
+ lying flat on the platform, and the two men were crouching on the
+ floor--I could just see dimly the bottom of their skin coats--but
+ the place was beautiful to me as the gate of heaven, and the words
+ of the confession of Christ from out the cloud of smoke were
+ inspiriting to me as if they had been spoken by an angel from out
+ of a cloud of glory.
+
+ 'But neighbours came in, duty called the blackman (layman) away,
+ the evening meal had to be prepared and eaten, and it was not till
+ late at night that I had opportunity for a private talk with him
+ who had confessed Christ; and even then it was not private, because
+ we were within earshot of a family of people in their beds.
+
+ 'Of all the countries I have visited Mongolia is the most sparsely
+ peopled, and yet it is, of all the places I have seen, the most
+ difficult to get private conversation with any one. Everybody, even
+ half-grown children, seems to think he has a perfect right to
+ intrude on any and all conversation. Bar the door and deny
+ admittance, and you would be suspected of hatching a plot. Take a
+ man away for a stroll that you may talk to him in quiet, and you
+ would be suspected of some dangerous enchantment. Remembering that
+ one must always have some definite message or business to perform
+ when he travels, and hoping to be able to do something with this
+ same blackman, I had purposely left, in the Chinese inn, some
+ presents which I could not well carry with me, and after a day's
+ rest the blackman and I started to bring them. That gave us
+ twenty-three miles' private conversation, and a good answer to give
+ to all who demanded, "Where are you going?" "What to do?" He gave
+ me the history of the origin and growth of his belief in Christ. I
+ taught him much he did not know, and at a lonely place we sat down
+ and lifted our voices to heaven in prayer. It was the pleasantest
+ walk I ever had in Mongolia, and at the same time the most painful.
+ My feet broke down altogether. It was evident I could not walk back
+ again the next day, so, acting on my follower's advice, by a great
+ effort I walked into the inn as if my feet were all right; we
+ bargained for a cart and, the Chinaman not suspecting the state of
+ my feet, we got it at a reasonable rate. Mongols and Chinese joined
+ in explaining to me how much time and labour I would have saved if
+ I had hired a cart at first, taken everything with me, and not
+ returned to the inn at all. From their point of view they were
+ right; but the blackman and I looked at the thing from a different
+ standpoint. We had accomplished our purpose, and felt that we could
+ afford to let our neighbours plume themselves on their supposed
+ superior wisdom.
+
+ 'Another day's rest at this place gave me what I much wanted--an
+ opportunity for a long quiet talk with the mandarin of this small
+ tribe. I was especially anxious to explain to him the true nature
+ of Christianity, because the Mongol who professes Christianity
+ lives under his jurisdiction, and I felt sure that a right
+ understanding of the case might be of service in protecting the
+ professor from troubles that are likely to come to him through men
+ misunderstanding his case. The mandarin came. On my last visit I
+ had been the means of curing him of a troublesome complaint over
+ which he had spent much time and money; in addition, I had brought
+ him a present from England. He was perfectly friendly and
+ exceedingly attentive, and at the close of the conversation asked
+ some questions which I thought evinced that he had somewhat entered
+ into the spirit of the conversation. He is a man of few words, but
+ from what he said I hope that he feels something of the truth of
+ Christianity.
+
+ 'My next expedition was to a mandarin of wealth and rank, whose
+ encampment occupies a commanding site on a mountain-side
+ overlooking a large lake. I found him at home, and, as he knows
+ well the main doctrines of Christianity, my main mission to him at
+ this time was to try and rouse him to earnestness of thought and
+ action in regard to his personal relation to Christ. We spent great
+ part of the afternoon in earnest talking, and I was much pleased
+ with the manner in which he, from time to time, explained to
+ another mandarin, who was there as guest, doctrines and facts which
+ were alluded to in our conversation. Next morning he started on a
+ journey connected with the business of his office, and I returned
+ to my friendly quarters where I had left my belongings.
+
+ 'I felt it laid upon me to visit two lamas at a temple some seventy
+ miles from where I was, and started next day. I reached the temple
+ in three days, and found that both the lamas I had come to see were
+ dead. So, as far as they were concerned, I was too late. Both on
+ the road, however, and at the temple itself, I had good
+ opportunities for preaching and teaching. I met some interesting
+ men, and not only in tents where I was entertained as guest, but
+ sometimes out in the open desert, stray travellers would meet me,
+ dismount from their horses, and give me occasion for Christian
+ conversation. Five days completed this round, and after another
+ day's rest I started back for Kalgan, escorted for ten miles by him
+ who had professed Christ. We walked slowly, as we had much to say.
+ Arrived at the parting place, we sat down and prayed together. I
+ then left, and the last I saw of the poor fellow, there he was,
+ sitting in the same place still. I reached Kalgan without
+ adventure, and returned to Peking on March 21, having been away
+ just over a month.'
+
+Possibly the most touching comment upon this extraordinary journey is to
+give some of the brief entries which refer to it in the diary.
+
+ '_February 19, 1884._--Started in a litter for Mongolia. Good talk
+ in inn with innman.'
+
+ '_February 23._--Went to Mr. Williams. My letter had not reached
+ them. No one knew I was coming.'
+
+ '_February 25._--Over the Pass to Barosaij.'
+
+ '_February 26._--Spent the day with Tu Gishuae. Urged on him the
+ internal proof of Christianity--the change of heart.'
+
+ '_February 28._--Shabberti. Boyinto Jaugge has desire to become
+ scholar of Jesus.'
+
+ '_March 1._--Walked here. Feet terribly bad. Snow on the road.
+ Great thirst. Badma Darag met me. Tea in his tent. Boyinto's
+ confession in the smoke of the _baishin_.'[4]
+
+[4] Fire in the centre of the tent.
+
+ '_March 2._--Sabbath. Quiet day. Much talk with all. The Lord
+ opened my lips.'
+
+ '_March 3._--Walked to Barosaij with Boyinto to bring my presents.
+ Talk about Christianity. Prayer in the desert. Feet terribly bad,
+ oh, such pain in walking.'
+
+ '_March 4._--Carted back.'
+
+ '_March 7._--Hara Oss. Walked back here. Called on Tu Lobsung.
+ Talk. He knew the way to heaven, but said, "Tell it to some of the
+ younger ones." "You go first," I replied. "You most need to know."'
+
+ '_March 8._--Terrible feet. Got to Chagan Hauran.'
+
+ '_March 14._--Boyinto accompanied me to Chagan Balgas with his
+ pony. Saw him sitting as long as I was in sight. Feet bad.'
+
+ '_March 21._--Left Pei Kuan at 4 A.M. Dark and snow. Terrible march
+ over slippery stones. Nan Kou at 7 A.M. No donkey on such a snowy
+ day. Hired the next twenty-seven li. Stiff march. Shatto at 11.35.
+ Terrible march to Ching Ho at 3 P.M. Terrible march to Te Sheng
+ Men. Home at 6.10. Prayer Meeting. Thanks be unto God for all His
+ mercies.'
+
+Early in 1885 Mr. Gilmour's heart was rejoiced by the tidings of the
+baptism of Boyinto, the Mongol to whom reference has been repeatedly
+made above. Although Gilmour's was not the hand to administer the rite,
+undoubtedly the conversion was the result of his work. On January 26,
+1885, he received a letter from the Rev. W. P. Sprague, of the American
+Mission at Kalgan, part of which we quote.
+
+
+ 'Kalgan: Jan. 14, 1885.
+
+ 'Dear Brother Gilmour,--I hasten to tell you the very good news.
+ Boyinto of Shabberti was baptized by my hand this day into the
+ Church of Christ, here at Kalgan, in the presence of our assembled
+ church and congregation. I'm sure you will rejoice and thank God
+ more than any of us. And I never saw our Christians so happy to
+ receive any one into the Church. The only thing I regret is that
+ it should not be your hand instead of mine to administer the sacred
+ rite.
+
+ 'I wrote you of his visit to us a month ago, and his application to
+ join the Church here, and our satisfaction with his appearance. He
+ turned up again yesterday morning, and spent all day with us. In
+ the afternoon we had, by previous appointment, a union meeting of
+ upper and lower city congregations, as a continuation of week of
+ prayer meeting, because the interest was so great. Mr. Roberts
+ preached, and in the after part of meeting, when two or three
+ others had risen for prayers, I asked Boyinto if he wanted to ask
+ Christians to pray for him, and he arose and expressed his desires,
+ including wanting to be baptized very plainly. We called church
+ meeting at close of the service, and proceeded to examine him for
+ admission to Church. He answered so well as to please every one,
+ making some happy hits, as when asked what sort of a place heaven
+ was, replied, "I haven't been there--how can I tell?" Then said,
+ "Would any one pray to go there if it were not a good place?" But
+ his straightforward, open simplicity was refreshing. There seemed
+ no reason for thinking he was other than an honest
+ believer--seeking to follow Jesus in all things. The native church
+ members first responded with enthusiasm that he was a most fit
+ candidate for receiving to the Church, and expressed great delight
+ at finding a Mongol who loved and trusted our Saviour. So we felt
+ with Peter, "Can any man forbid water that these should not be
+ baptized?" The others then asked me to baptize him on the morrow,
+ when we were to have another union meeting at our place. And could
+ you have seen his rising and answering my questions, give assent to
+ creed and covenant, and then see him remove his cap and bow his
+ head reverently and receive the water of baptism, your heart would
+ overflow with gratitude and praise to God for this first fruit
+ from Mongolia. After prayer we sang "From Greenland's icy
+ mountains," changed to "From Mongolia, &c," and we felt it as never
+ before.
+
+ 'Though God has thus given us great pleasure in gathering this
+ first fruit, still I feel, and we all feel, that the honour of the
+ work belongs to God, and the reward to you and others.'
+
+During 1884 and 1885 the regular work of the Peking mission occupied
+almost the whole of his time, the Rev. S. E. Meech being in England on
+furlough, and most of his duties therefore falling upon Mr. Gilmour.
+During his stay in England he had attended many of the Salvation Army
+meetings, and had caught much of their spirit. He had also come to the
+conviction that men needed to be dealt with individually rather than in
+the mass. Hence he gave much time to conversation, to teaching single
+persons the Christian catechism and the New Testament, and endeavouring,
+by talking and praying with them, to lead them to a knowledge of the
+truth. From six in the morning until ten at night he was at the service
+of all comers. In the afternoon he attended one or both of the Peking
+chapels, preaching if there were the opportunity, but always eagerly on
+the alert for any individuals showing signs of interest in the Gospel.
+It had been the custom of the missionaries to reserve the Sunday evening
+for an English service, devoted to their own spiritual refreshment.
+This, which was held in the mission compound, he ceased to attend, even
+although his absence sometimes made it impossible to hold the service,
+in order that he might find time to read and talk and pray with his
+Chinese servants. Frequently the meal-time would find him thus engaged,
+but the meal had to wait until his visitor had left, or until the
+interview came to its natural close. He ceased to read all newspapers
+except those distinctively Christian. He found no time for books, as he
+felt that direct work for the Chinese should fill the hours he might
+otherwise devote to reading. He became more wholly than ever the man of
+one book--the Bible--and so absorbed did he grow in this close dealing
+with souls that in the earlier stages of his wife's illness he felt
+constrained to place it before even her wish that he would remain by her
+at periods of severe suffering and weakness.
+
+ '_December 9, 1883._--At chapel met Wang from a place 300 li away
+ down in the country. He had heard a sermon there two or three years
+ before which he remembered, and could quote. I began the service,
+ and brought him up here to my study. We were talking when another
+ man, Jui, came in from 130 li north of Peking. He had to run away
+ from home on account of misconduct. These two kept me till dark.'
+
+In a letter to the Rev. S. E. Meech, dated November 9, 1885, Mr. Gilmour
+refers to a number of these individual cases in which he has been
+interesting himself, and the way in which he has dealt with them. It
+illustrates his method of close and careful dealing with each native.
+
+ 'Ch'ang attends Sunday and Friday services. My opinion about Ch'ang
+ is that he wants mission employ. He has no expectation of that from
+ me, and little from Rees. I think, too, that he does not mean to
+ break with Christianity or with us, and I faintly hope that his
+ experiences with us will do us good, though they have been most
+ painful to us. I think you'll find him much more tractable than he
+ would have been had he not been through these troubles with us.
+
+ 'Hsing has had the devil putting philosophic doubts into him. I
+ have pressed him to pelt the devil with Scripture, as our Master
+ did.
+
+ 'Li, shoemaker, I _do_ like. He cannot stay to Sunday service. I
+ take him before service therefore.
+
+ 'Fu does well. Last Friday he remained after prayer-meeting, and
+ talked till 9.40 about all manner of things secular and sacred. He
+ has most pleasant remembrances of Emily--Emily, too, liked him.
+
+ 'Jui Wu, the powder magazine man, is in a more hopeful case. He may
+ come all right yet.[5]
+
+[5] Fu is now (1892) an evangelist, and Jui Wu a dispenser, in the
+Chi Chou Mission.
+
+ 'Old Tai nearly went, but will now, I think, remain till you come.
+ He wants to tiffin with me on Sundays, and enjoys much four, five,
+ or six small cups of good strong tea with milk and sugar. He is
+ growing in grace.
+
+ 'Young Tai I am detaining after his father goes and reading with
+ him and teaching him. He gives up his trade for the day, and I want
+ to give him a good day.
+
+ 'Chao Erh attends well and is improved in circumstances.
+
+ 'Lu Ss[)u] is in his old trade, and doing well. He comes on Sundays
+ when he comes. He was the man I hoped least of, and as yet he
+ pleases me almost most.
+
+ 'Lama comes to-morrow to finish reconstructing Mongol catechism. I
+ may go on a two months' journey to Mongolia, starting in December.
+ I'll have to see the children to Tientsin in February, and want to
+ meet you.
+
+ 'Hsues as they were.[6]
+
+[6] Father and son; the only native preachers in the West City of
+Peking at that time.
+
+ 'I am very much encouraged and thankful about the little Church. I
+ can honestly say that I have tried to do my best for it during
+ your absence, and God has encouraged me a good deal in it. I have
+ reaped some that you have sown, and have endeavoured to sow
+ something for you to reap when you return.
+
+ 'I sometimes have deep fits of the blues when I think of the
+ children, but their mother was able to trust Jesus with them, and
+ why should not I?
+
+ 'The Mongol work, too, has entered on a new phase, and that opens
+ up a new future for me. It is a formidable affair. I don't think
+ I'll go to Kalgan or that region. I fear no doctor would stay with
+ me there. I may go away North-east. I can hardly tell yet.
+ Meantime, with God's help, I hope to do another month's work in
+ Peking, and then hand the thing over to Rees once for all. Most of
+ my books I'll sell. What use are they to me? I never have time to
+ read them, and am not likely ever to have.'
+
+The letter just quoted was written after the sad event to which we must
+now refer. Towards the close of the summer of 1885 Mr. Gilmour awoke to
+the fact that one of the heaviest sorrows of his life was coming upon
+him. For some years past Mrs. Gilmour had been subject to severe attacks
+of pain. The visit to England and the rest and change of the old home
+life had in a measure restored her. But hardly were they comfortably
+established in their old Peking quarters ere some of her most trying
+symptoms reappeared. With that brave heart and resolute spirit
+characteristic of her whole missionary career, for a time she gave
+herself to the duties of the mission and bore her full share of its
+anxieties and toils. But gradually she was constrained to recognise that
+her active work was over. From the first she had thrown herself
+whole-heartedly into missionary Service. She could converse fluently
+with the Mongols, having acquired their language in the same way as her
+husband, by enduring repeatedly all the privations of life in a Mongol
+tent. She had impressed them by her fondness for animals, by her
+gentleness of spirit, and by her evident interest in all that bore upon
+their own welfare. In Peking she had laboured hard among the women and
+girls, both in the matter of education and also of direct religious
+instruction. A very bitter element in her cup of sorrow was the
+conviction gradually forced upon her that her power to do this work was
+fast slipping away. In a letter to her sister, Mrs. Meech, then in
+England, dated May 2, 1885, she gives the first clear expression to this
+feeling: 'I would have written before, but I have been ill for about six
+weeks; not actually ill, except one week, but not able to do anything
+except the children's lessons and the harmonium on Sundays sometimes.
+All the rest has had to go. I am sorry, but it can't be helped. How long
+it will last I don't know. I can't get stronger, so I must be content to
+be tired. I am nothing more than weak, and a great many people are that.
+There has been a grand revival here. It seemed to pass like a mountain
+torrent, while I had only to look on and see. My only wonder was that
+people had lived so long without the happiness that they might have had
+for the taking. I didn't want to go to the meeting, I felt so weak and
+unable to bear the tension of spiritual excitement. But as it was it
+didn't tire me at all, but made me love a lot of the people. May the
+Chinese feel the flood tide of new life that has come into Peking! And
+they must, there can be nothing to hinder it.'
+
+The reference in the last part of this letter is to a great deepening
+of spiritual life that took place among the missionaries, and also among
+some of the European residents in Peking.
+
+The first explicit reference by Mr. Gilmour to his coming sorrow occurs
+in the Diary; but in his report, sent home a month later, and dated
+August 4, 1885, he wrote: 'Mrs. Gilmour is very ill, and now very weak.
+I fear all hope of her recovery is taken away. Her trouble is a
+run-down, but the serious complication is her lungs. We are at the hills
+in a temple with another family, the Childs. Mrs. Child came out in the
+same ship with Mrs. Gilmour, when, as Miss Prankard, she came first to
+China. Mrs. Child renders invaluable service to the sick one.'
+
+In the Diary the following entries show the course of sorrowful
+events:--
+
+ '_July 4, 1885._--It really dawns upon me to-day in such a way that
+ I can feel it that my wife is likely to die, and I too feel
+ something of how desolate it would be for me with my motherless
+ children sent away from me. Eh, man!'
+
+ '_August 22._--Emily spoke of being sometimes _so_ happy. She is
+ quite aware now she cannot recover.'
+
+ '_September 13_, Sunday, Peking.--Emily saw all the women. She felt
+ very weak to-day. Remarked at 7 P.M.: "Well, Jamie, I am going, I
+ suppose. I'll soon see you there. It won't be long." I said she
+ would not want me much there. She said fondly she would. "I think
+ I'll sit at the gate and look for you coming." Said she has been
+ out for the last time. Asked me not to go to chapel, but went.'
+
+ '_September 17._--To-day, in the morning, I promised Emily that I
+ would remain home from the chapel and give her a holiday. She was
+ _so_ pleased. We had a most enjoyable afternoon. She was so happy.
+ She sat up for an hour or so, and we conversed about all things,
+ the use of the beautiful in creation, &c.'
+
+All the next day Mrs. Gilmour slowly sank, and soon after the midnight
+of September 18 passed peacefully within 'the gate.' The story of the
+closing scene was thus told by her husband:--
+
+
+ 'Peking: Saturday, September 19, 1885.
+
+ 'My dear Meech,--Emily crossed the river last night, or this
+ morning rather at 12.15.
+
+ 'I was called in from the Friday evening prayer meeting just as it
+ was concluding, and found her with laboured breath and fixed eyes.
+ For a time we thought it was all to end at once. After a time she
+ got over it.
+
+ '10 P.M. was a repetition of 8 P.M.'s experience.
+
+ 'At 12 midnight she was labouring much in her breath, coughed a
+ very little cough, and all at once the rapidity of her breath
+ nearly doubled, suddenly her hand fell over powerless, her eyes
+ became fixed, there was some difficult breathing, and with Mrs.
+ Henderson on the one side of the bed, which had been moved when we
+ came from the hills into the sitting-room, she departed.
+
+ 'During these four hours she spoke little; once or twice she called
+ for milk, but for the most part contented herself with assenting or
+ dissenting to and from my remarks and suggestions by moving the
+ head.
+
+ 'At 10.30, seeing me sleepy and desiring to sleep herself, she
+ asked me to go and lie down, but I said I would not do so while she
+ was so ill.
+
+ 'I asked her if she felt all safe in the hands of Jesus. She nodded
+ her assent.
+
+ 'Some month or six weeks ago we two had talked about everything to
+ be done in case of her death, the children, etc., and not only
+ then, but more than once we had talked over spiritual things,
+ because we feared that when the end came she might not be able to
+ speak. I am glad we did so. During these four hours she was either
+ in such great distress, or, when free from distress, was so tired
+ and eager to sleep, that talking was hardly possible.
+
+ 'The "Rest" she so longed for she has now got.
+
+ 'I treasure what she said one day when she had been, I think,
+ reading her wall text, "T_o me to live is Christ, to die is gain_,"
+ when I asked her if _she_ felt it so. She said she did, and often
+ would remark that to go would be far better for her, but she was so
+ eager to get well for my sake and that of the children. For
+ herself, too, she was more and more enchanted with the beauty God
+ had put in the world. On Friday I went in, she waved her hand and
+ said, "What beauty!" It was some flowers on the table. A bunch of
+ grapes, a beauty, filled her mouth with praise to God for all His
+ goodness to her. The post waits. Funeral Monday.
+
+ 'Yours in sorrow,
+ 'J. GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Mrs. Gilmour was buried on September 21. Her faith was clear and strong.
+Uncommon as their courtship had been, the subsequent married life was
+very happy. She was the equal of her husband in missionary zeal and
+enthusiasm, and he himself bears testimony to the unerring skill which
+she possessed in gauging the moral qualities of the Chinese. She gave
+much time and labour to Christian work among the women and girls in
+Peking; and her husband was greatly helped in his work during the nearly
+eleven years of married life by her sound judgment, her strong
+affection, her loving Christian character, and her entire consecration
+to the Lord Jesus Christ.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+A CHANGE OF FIELD
+
+
+During 1885 James Gilmour gradually reached the conclusion that a change
+of field was desirable. He was aware that friends and colleagues more or
+less qualified to form an opinion had urged upon him the advisability of
+labouring in Eastern Mongolia among the agricultural Mongols. No one
+knew so well as himself the advantages and the disadvantages of this
+plan. The reasons that finally led him to a decision were noble and
+characteristic. It was a hard field, and no one else could or would go.
+The Mongols of the Plain were to some extent benefited by the American
+Mission at Kalgan; those dwelling in Eastern Mongolia were without a
+helper. Considerations like these, as he tells us, decided his new
+course of action.
+
+ 'In these circumstances my mind has turned away north-east from
+ Peking, where people are not so scarce, and where the Mongols live
+ as farmers. I have been to that region twice. I knew some people
+ who came from that region. As soon as Mr. Rees returns from Chi
+ Chou I hope to go again. A doctor might be induced to settle
+ somewhere there, and though it would be hard a bit, a family might
+ live there too, which I don't think would be possible on the plain
+ beyond Kalgan.
+
+ 'I am fully aware of the difficulties. They are:--
+
+ '1. I have no proper Chinaman to take with me. More than half the
+ population is Chinese, and I could not do well without a Chinaman.
+
+ '2. It is a new district and will take time to work up.
+
+ '3. It is not easily reached from Peking or anywhere else, and will
+ be a very isolated part.
+
+ '4. It is rather a rough and unsafe district.
+
+ 'I know all these, but feel, in reliance on God, like facing the
+ thing as the best and proper thing to do. There are inns all about,
+ and though for some time a private location may not be secured, we
+ can still go about among the people. My main hope, though, is in
+ settling down somewhere as a head centre, in close contact with the
+ people, so that I earnestly desire that the doctor should come. If
+ he is unmarried I would be glad to see him to-morrow. Could you not
+ get a doctor who would be willing to remain single till a location
+ could be secured? After a location has been secured let him marry
+ if he likes.
+
+ 'I think that the region I have in my mind would make a good centre
+ for a doctor, and that he would have plenty of practice among
+ Mongols and Chinese, especially if he could start a hospital for
+ in-patients.
+
+ 'I am very glad that the Mongolian region around Kalgan has shown
+ signs of bearing fruit. It has strengthened my faith much. I am
+ also glad that God has acknowledged in some degree my work here in
+ Peking, and I feel more hopeful than ever I did. God, too, has cut
+ me adrift from all my fixings, so that I feel quite ready to go
+ anywhere if only He goes with me.'
+
+Mr. Gilmour entered upon this new departure on the understanding that a
+medical colleague should be sent to him at the earliest possible moment.
+This responsibility the London Board assumed and endeavoured to
+discharge. The result was a severe trial to the faith, not only of the
+solitary worker but to all interested--and they were many--in the fate
+of the new mission. As we shall see later on, when a congenial and
+competent medical colleague reached him, and was entering with vigour
+and hope upon the work, Dr. Mackenzie of Tientsin suddenly died, and
+before the immediate and urgent claims of Tientsin the claims of
+Mongolia had to give way. But in estimating the success of both
+missions, that on the Plain, and that in Eastern Mongolia, it must never
+be forgotten that what Gilmour considered _essential_, the presence and
+help of a medical colleague, was never in the Providence of God granted
+to him for any length of time. In the account he gives of his first
+visit to the region as its missionary--he had been twice before on
+visits of inspection--he dwells upon this necessity.
+
+ 'I left Peking December 14, 1885, and re-entered Peking February
+ 16, 1886, so that my absence from here was just two months. The
+ part of Mongolia I went to is situated 800 li, or say 270 English
+ miles, north-east by east of Peking, and, at the usual rate of 90
+ li (or 30 miles) a day, is nine days distant. This is not the part
+ of Mongolia near Kalgan. Kalgan is north-north-west of Peking, five
+ days' journey.
+
+[Illustration: MAP ILLUSTRATING JAMES GILMOUR'S LABOURS IN EASTERN
+MONGOLIA]
+
+ 'Whilst I was considering my plans a Mongol appeared in Peking who
+ was willing to take me to his home, and I went with him, hoping
+ thus to get introduced to a district of country, an introduction
+ being both necessary and helpful. Ta Cheng Tz[)u] is the name of
+ the place where, through his introduction, I was located from
+ December 23, 1885 to February 9, 1886. I had a room in an inn. I
+ spent some days at the home of my Mongol friend and made two
+ journeys to other places, but Ta Cheng Tz[)u] was my headquarters.
+ It is a small market town, with a daily fair. The surrounding
+ neighbourhood is peopled with Mongols and Chinese in about equal
+ proportions. The Mongols are mostly lords of the soil, and style
+ the Chinese slaves, that is in the country. The real trade of the
+ whole locality is in the hands of the Chinese. The Mongols all
+ speak Chinese, and the town resident Mongols have, many of them,
+ forgotten Mongolian, and laugh at themselves as not being able to
+ speak their own language.
+
+ 'The country is like Wales in this respect, that, though Mongolian
+ is the native language, the coming language and the language that
+ is affected and sought after, is Chinese. Well-to-do Mongols have
+ Chinese teachers for their children, and read Chinese well. During
+ my stay there I sold more Chinese than Mongolian books, and talked
+ more Chinese than Mongolian, though my intercourse was largely with
+ Mongols.
+
+ 'Opium is largely grown there, so is tobacco, and large quantities
+ of whisky are manufactured and consumed. It was partly a famine
+ year. At a little distance from Ta Cheng Tz[)u] the harvest had
+ failed, and I think the line of preaching that seemed to impress
+ the hearers most was one that reasoned with them about the growth,
+ manufacture, and use of these three, being so contrary to Heaven's
+ design in giving land and rain to grow food, that it was not to be
+ wondered at if, seeing how the land and rain were perverted, God
+ should send short rations. Evil speaking, vile language, made a
+ fourth subject which naturally came in for notice, and on all these
+ four subjects I scarcely ever spoke without gaining the nearly
+ universal concurrence of my little audiences.
+
+ 'The great theme, however, was Christ, and I think that most men in
+ that little market town, and a great many of those who used to
+ come to the fair, both heard and understood the great gospel truth
+ of salvation in Jesus.
+
+ 'Eager to see some more of the country, and in the hope that I
+ might be able to talk to him on the way, I hired a Mongol to carry
+ my bedding and books, and made a descent on a village thirty miles
+ away. The general cold of the winter was aggravated by a snowstorm
+ which overtook us at the little market town, and I have no words to
+ tell you how the cold felt that day as I paraded that one street. I
+ sold a fair number of books, though my hands were too much benumbed
+ almost to be able to hand the books out. I made some attempts at
+ preaching, but the muscles were also benumbed--that day _was_ a
+ _cold_ day.
+
+ 'I was turned out of two respectable inns at Bull Town because I
+ was a foot traveller, had no cart or animal, that is, and had to
+ put up in a tramps' tavern because I came as a tramp!
+
+ 'Next journey I made I hired a man and a _donkey_. The donkey was
+ my passport to respectability, and I was more comfortable too,
+ being able to take more bedding with me. I was warned against going
+ to Ch'ao Yang, sixty miles, the roads being represented as unsafe;
+ but I went and found no trouble, though there was a severe famine
+ in the district. I spent a day each at two market towns on the way,
+ and two days in Ch'ao Yang itself.
+
+ 'The journey home I made on foot, a donkey driven by a Mongol
+ carrying my bedding and books. I adopted this plan mainly to bring
+ myself into close contact with the Mongol. He proved himself a
+ capital fellow to travel with, but as yet has shown no signs of
+ belief in Christ. As we did long marches my feet suffered badly.'
+
+In a private letter written at this time he enters a little more fully
+into what he had to endure.
+
+ 'I had a good time in Mongolia, but oh! so cold. Some of the days I
+ spent in the markets were so very cold that my muscles seemed
+ benumbed, and speech even was difficult. I met with some spiritual
+ response, though, and with that I can stand cold. Eh! man, I have
+ got thin. I am feeding up at present. I left my medicines, books,
+ &c., there, and walked home here, a donkey carrying my baggage, a
+ distance of about three hundred miles, in seven and a half days, or
+ about forty miles a day, and my feet were really very bad.
+
+ 'At night I used to draw a woollen thread through the blisters. In
+ the morning I "hirpled" a little, but it was soon all right. I
+ walked, not because I had not money to ride, but to get at the
+ Mongol who was with me.'
+
+These graphic pictures enable us to realise how Mr. Gilmour began the
+last great missionary enterprise of his life. He returned to Peking, and
+then had to pass through that severe trial which comes to almost all
+missionaries in the foreign field, which is often one of their heaviest
+crosses. His two eldest boys were sent home for education. They sailed
+from Tientsin March 23, 1886, the diary for that day containing the
+brief but significant reference: 'At 6.45 A.M. came all the friends once
+more, at 7.30 cast off, and the vessel slowly fell out into the middle
+of the river. Oh! the parting!' But at 8.30 on the same morning the
+sorrowful father had started on his solitary return journey to Peking.
+Bereft now of both wife, and boys he was to pass the rest of his career
+in China, except for the brief intervals of residence in Peking, in the
+cheerless, noisy, uncongenial quarters of an ordinary Chinese inn. The
+return of the Rev. S. E. Meech in April 1886 set him entirely free from
+mission work in the capital. He had already acquired the needful
+experience of his new field of labour, and on April 22, 1886, he started
+anew for Eastern Mongolia. It is neither necessary nor desirable to
+enter into any very detailed description of the next three years. In
+many respects day after day was occupied with the round of ever
+recurring and similar duties, but it is desirable to enter, if we can,
+with some minuteness into his inner life, and to lay bare the spiritual
+sources and springs of his outward actions. It is in these, in our
+judgment, that the true beauty, the abiding lesson, and the great
+success of his life consist. And this he has enabled us to do. In a
+private, not an official, letter to the Rev. R. Wardlaw Thompson, the
+Foreign Secretary of the London Missionary Society, he indicates his
+actions and the motives that were impelling him so to act, during the
+summer of 1886. Differences of opinion arose with his fellow
+missionaries as to the wisdom of his methods and the soundness of his
+judgment. Those who differed most strongly from him knew little or
+nothing by personal observation and experience of the conditions of work
+either on the Plain or at Ch'ao Yang. But no question ever did or ever
+could arise as to the absolute consecration of his heart and life to the
+work of winning souls. The truth of the words in one of his official
+reports was manifest to all: 'Man, the fire of God is upon me to go and
+preach.'
+
+ 'The past four and a half months has been a time of no small trial
+ and spiritual tension. Since April 22 I have had no tidings of the
+ outer world. An agent of the Bible Society, who was selling books
+ in the district, was with me for a month, but he had gone out
+ before me, so that when we met he had no news for me, but wanted
+ news from me.
+
+ 'Some men, who gave promise of believing in Jesus, have fallen
+ away, and I have a haunting suspicion that it was one such man who,
+ on the morning of Sunday, June 6, stole my beautiful copy of the
+ revised Bible, leaving me till now with only a New Testament in
+ English. I had much difficulty in procuring that Bible, and wasn't
+ it heartless of a Chinaman to steal it for the leather binding, for
+ which even he could have hardly any use? I said not a single word
+ to anyone in the town about it, as I feared that making trouble
+ over it would hinder me in future, by making innkeepers afraid to
+ receive me, lest they should be held responsible for such losses. I
+ can hardly say though, that, at first at least, I took joyfully the
+ spoiling of my goods. Secret tears testified to my sense of the
+ loss, but falling back on the faith that all things work together
+ for my good, I was comforted, and gave the more earnest heed to the
+ New Testament.
+
+ 'Then the Chinese would ask, "How many people have believed and
+ entered the religion since you left Peking?" and such questions
+ kept before my mind painfully how slowly things move, and drew out
+ my soul in more painful longing for God's blessing in the
+ conversion of men.
+
+ 'In the beginning of July I must have got a touch of the sun.
+ Nearly all that month I was ill, but just then was the great annual
+ fair at Ch'ao Yang, so, ill and all, I had the tent put up daily
+ and dispensed medicines. My assistant, however, had to do most of
+ the preaching; I had not much strength for that. The first three
+ weeks in August I had diarrh[oe]a and dysentery. I was at Ta Cheng
+ Tz[)u]. There was no fair, and but poor market gatherings, but,
+ weather permitting, we put up our tent daily and did good work.
+ Paul says (Gal. iv. 19), "My little children, of whom I am again in
+ travail until Christ be formed in you," and he is right. It is a
+ carrying of men in prayer until the image of Christ is formed in
+ them; and how many of them prove abortions.
+
+ 'One of the converts at Ta Cheng Tz[)u] caused me no little
+ anxiety. I knew that he professed to be impressed last winter. He
+ said he wanted to call on me in my inn and tell me his
+ difficulties. I was eager to get home, but as he said he would have
+ no leisure before a certain date, I waited till then, nearly a
+ week, for almost no other purpose than to see him. He never came,
+ and I trudged back to Peking downcast about him.
+
+ 'This year when we came to Ta Cheng Tz[)u] on our way to Ch'ao
+ Yang, on going to his place for breakfast (he is one of two
+ brothers who own and manage a restaurant, and both of them, and a
+ third brother, are members of a sect which forbids opium, whisky,
+ and tobacco), we were shown into the more private part, and he and
+ his brother and the cook set upon us to inquire more fully about
+ Christianity, how to enter it, etc, etc. This took me by surprise,
+ and made me so glad that my breakfast for the most part remained
+ uneaten, though we had travelled eight hours that morning. In the
+ evening I did not go for a meal, and my assistant on going was met
+ at the door by the inquirers, and so engaged in conversation about
+ Christianity that darkness set in, the cooking range was closed,
+ and the establishment shut for the day before they were finished.
+ My man had no dinner. Next day we went on towards Ch'ao Yang
+ thankful and happy. These restaurant people had a few days before
+ been visited by the Bible Society's agent, and had derived much
+ Christian benefit from his Chinese assistant.
+
+ 'Our interview with the restaurant men was on Monday. In Ch'ao Yang
+ next Sunday, just six days after being, so to speak, on the mount
+ of transfiguration with these Chinamen, on dismissing the few
+ hangers-on that remained at the close of the afternoon preaching,
+ and stepping down from the little vantage-ground from which I had
+ been speaking, one of the audience said he would go home with me to
+ my inn, as he had come with a letter to me from Ta Cheng Tz[)u]
+ from the Bible agent. I went to the inn, read the letter, and found
+ that he and his Chinese helper had differed, and he had come to Ta
+ Cheng Tz[)u] seeking me. He needed and asked my help, so next day I
+ started for Ta Cheng Tz[)u], and on arriving there found that the
+ little place was full of the news of the quarrel between the
+ Christian foreigner and the Christian native. That was bad, but,
+ worse still, on going to the restaurant I found the earnestness of
+ the inquirers gone, and one of them said openly, "If this is the
+ sort of fruit that Christianity bears, what better is it than any
+ other religion?"
+
+ 'In a later visit paid in May they seemed colder still, and the
+ place where I had hoped to gather fruit seemed barren and hopeless.
+
+ 'In August we again visited Ta Cheng Tz[)u]. I was blue. The fever
+ of July, the defection of the Mongol donkey man, who failed to come
+ for us, the diarrh[oe]a, which on the journey changed to dysentery,
+ being baffled in attempting to find suitable quarters in Ta Cheng
+ Tz[)u], and the chilled hearts of the restaurant men, made our
+ entrance not cheerful. On the way my assistant and I had talked
+ over matters, and resolved by prayer and endeavour to see what
+ could be done for the restaurant men. Just ten days after our
+ arrival the eldest brother called on me in my inn and said,
+ "To-night I dismiss my gods, henceforth I am a Christian. I am
+ ready to be baptized any day you may be pleased to name."
+
+ 'I cannot say what a relief these words brought me. There still
+ remained anxieties in his case, but in a day or two things came out
+ all right, and day by day in public in the restaurant he might be
+ seen studying his catechism when unemployed, and speaking for
+ Christianity to all who asked what book that was.
+
+ 'He is a leading spirit, though a poor scholar, and was the deacon
+ or head of the branch of the sect in Ta Cheng Tz[)u], called Tsai
+ li ti. There are some twelve or sixteen members. Most of them
+ joined the sect through his endeavours, and he is eager to rear up
+ Christianity in the same way. You will partly understand now how
+ anxious I am about him. If he goes on all right, we may soon have a
+ little company of believers there. If he falls away--well, all
+ things work together for my good.
+
+ 'One thing that moved these restaurant men towards Christianity was
+ an incident which happened in their establishment last winter. A
+ half-drunk Chinaman reviled me badly one evening at dinner. He laid
+ to my charge many bad and grievous things. Though they were utterly
+ false as regards me, they might be quite true of some other
+ foreigner whom he may have met. It was useless to reason with a
+ drunken man over a case of mistaken identity, so I said nothing,
+ ate my dinner, paid my bill, and went to my inn. The restaurant men
+ were very wroth with the man, they told me afterwards, and felt
+ like "going for" him themselves, and never forgot what they were
+ pleased to call my patience. In God's providence this little
+ incident seems to have been an important factor in impressing them
+ with favourable ideas of Christianity.
+
+ 'Another thing which seems to have impressed them was their seeing
+ me this August, day by day at my post in my tent, carrying on the
+ work, when they knew I was ill, and, according to their ideas,
+ should have been in bed. I was not really so ill as all that, but
+ that was their idea. I would be very glad to have another reviling
+ and another attack of dysentery if the same results would follow.
+
+ 'The profession of the other adherent at Ta Cheng Tz[)u], and the
+ moving of the hearts, seemingly at least, of other two men who
+ live at a distance, and had to leave for home suddenly before
+ receiving full instruction, but of whom I try to have hope, have
+ all moved my heart and seem answers to a great longing I had been
+ crying to God about, namely, that He would give me power to move
+ these heathen. Oh that He would do it!
+
+ 'I have felt it my duty to become a vegetarian on trial. I don't
+ know whether I can carry it out. The Chinese look up so much to
+ this supposed asceticism that I am eager to acquire the influence a
+ successful vegetarianism would give me, and I am trying it in true
+ Chinese style, which forbids eggs, leeks and carrots, &c. As far as
+ I have gone all is well. I am a little afraid that the great
+ appetite it gives may drive me to eat till I become fat. We'll see.
+
+ 'The mothers bringing their babies moves me much. It reminds me of
+ scenes in Peking when another and more skilful hand ministered to
+ their diseases; then the picture of the family surroundings fills
+ itself up, and I have to seek a place where to weep.
+
+ 'Altogether it is a sowing in tears. The district is not an easy
+ one, the life which the work entails is a hard one. There is no
+ hardship or self-denial I am not ready to "go in for," but I want
+ you to understand me and let me have your sympathy.'
+
+This long extract, not too long we venture to think, as enabling us to
+see into the heart of the man, raises several points of great moment.
+Nothing could illustrate better his eagerness to get into close touch
+and perfect sympathy with the people. He had long before adopted the
+native dress of an ordinary shopkeeper or respectable workman. He now
+adapted himself, as far as possible, to the native food. He lived on
+such as the poor eat. Often he would take his bowl of porridge, native
+fashion, in the street, sitting down upon a low stool by the boiler of
+the itinerant restaurant keeper. The vegetarianism referred to was, as
+he indicates, very thoroughgoing and in accord with Chinese ideas.
+
+The great poverty of the people also pressed upon his attention the
+enormous waste induced by whisky drinking, and by the smoking of tobacco
+and opium. The sect Tsai li ti referred to was a small organisation
+among the Chinese for endeavouring to secure entire abstinence from all
+three. It did not seem tolerable to him that the level of Christian
+morality and practice with regard to these things should be lower than
+that of the heathen. Famine often visited those parts, and he came to
+hold the view that men could hardly pray, 'Give us this day our daily
+bread,' with any hope of a favourable answer, or even reasonably expect
+God's blessing upon their tillage of the soil, while they continued to
+use a large part of the grain produced in the manufacture of strong
+drink, and while they continued to set apart large districts for the
+cultivation of tobacco and opium. Hence, at first, he made entire
+abstinence from all three an indispensable requisite for admission into
+the Christian Church.
+
+It was hardly to be expected, perhaps, that his colleagues in the North
+China Mission would be able to see eye to eye with him on these points.
+With regard to opium the opinion as to abstinence is unanimous. With
+regard to the other two, the prevailing opinion was that, however
+desirable entire abstinence may be, it is not authoritatively commanded,
+and ought not to be made an indispensable qualification for baptism.
+
+It seemed to some of them that there was danger of the heathen
+confusing Christianity with their own Tsai li ti. In reply to such a
+suggestion Gilmour wrote: 'My hearers not know the difference between
+Tsai li ti and Christianity! Thanks be to God, this whole town and
+neighbourhood has rung with the truths of Christianity. Children, men,
+shop-boys, and, of all people in the world, a lad gathering grain stumps
+in the fields a long way off--it has been my lot to hear them repeat
+sayings of mine, when they saw me, and did not think I could hear them.'
+
+Into this controversy as a mere discussion we have no desire to enter.
+But to enable the reader to know Mr. Gilmour exactly as he was it
+deserves more than a passing reference. The following may be taken as an
+example of many letters that passed on this subject.
+
+ 'I start perhaps on Tuesday. Pardon me for expressing myself on one
+ matter--the Chinese teetotal business. You and some of my
+ colleagues seem to me as if I could not move you on this question.
+ It is a great grief to me. I think you are not right in your ideas
+ about this. I suppose you can beat me in argument. I am still more
+ than ever convinced that teetotalism is _right_ and _needful_ for
+ the success of native Christian life in China. We have some painful
+ instances here of that among the natives--specially two--one of the
+ two hailing from Tientsin.
+
+ 'I don't know your Tientsin Church history, but if it is anything
+ like ours here you would find men standing nowhere almost as to
+ Christian character, who but for drink and its concomitants might,
+ humanly speaking, have shone. And yet these are men to get whom out
+ of sin Christ died--brethren, for whom Christ died.
+
+ 'Pardon me again when I take a short cut to what I want to say: "_I
+ believe were Christ here now as a missionary amongst us He would
+ be an enthusiastic teetotaller and a non-smoker._"
+
+ 'Tobacco is comparatively a harmless matter, but it is not so
+ unimportant as it seems to us foreigners. Whisky should go, and I
+ feel that the Chinese would be quite ready, if led, to turn both
+ whisky and tobacco out together. They are born brothers in China,
+ _useless_, and _acknowledged_ to be such; harmful as far as they
+ are anything, and comparatively expensive.
+
+ 'I would like to see you start in your church an anti-tobacco and
+ whisky society; voluntary, of course, in a church established as
+ yours on the old lines. Though I stand alone, I believe the flowing
+ tide is with me.
+
+ 'Wishing you many souls in 1887, and eager that no minor difference
+ of opinion should hinder our prayers.
+
+ 'Yours I-hardly-know-how-to-say-what,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+In the _Chinese Recorder_, for which he had been in the habit of writing
+for many years, he published a paper in which he set forth with great
+clearness and fulness his views on this important matter. It deserves a
+place in the story of his life because in it he has sketched, as no one
+else could, himself, and some of his later methods of evangelistic
+address.
+
+ 'In December, 1885, in a district of North China new to me, I found
+ myself preaching to a small crowd of Chinese and Mongols in a small
+ market town. I was in a lane leading on to the main street. At my
+ back was a mud wall, in front and at both sides was the audience,
+ within hearing was the main street, above, a bright sun made the
+ place warm and cheerful. After listening a while the audience
+ wanted to know how good seasons could be secured. To the truths I
+ had been preaching they had listened with respect and fair
+ attention, but at the first opportunity for speaking they wanted to
+ know how to get a good harvest.
+
+ 'At first I paid little attention to this question, but after a
+ little while it was asked again, and that by several men in
+ succession, and I soon found that the people of the place had
+ little room for anything else in their thoughts. There was good
+ reason for it too. Their last harvest had been a poor one.
+ Three-tenths was about the yield. They too with their three-tenths
+ were comparatively well off. Some distance from them the yield had
+ not been more than two-tenths, and a little beyond that again,
+ there were fields which had been sown, but never reaped. There had
+ been nothing to reap. Nothing had grown. I passed some of these
+ fields afterwards and saw them. Was it wonderful then that the main
+ thought in their minds should be the harvest failure, and that they
+ should be mainly anxious to know how to secure a good season next
+ year? Looking at my audience I saw that nine-tenths of them were
+ poorly clad. Nearly one-half of them were quite insufficiently
+ clothed, and many were in garments suited to summer weather only. I
+ was in a sheepskin coat and felt shoes, and even thus was not too
+ warm, and could not help thinking how cold they must be, in their
+ torn clothes and ordinary shoes. In addition to this they seemed
+ hungry. I dare say perhaps one-half of them were in actual
+ suffering from deficiency of food.
+
+ 'Taking these things into consideration, I did not regard their
+ great and often-repeated question, "How about the harvest?" as
+ impertinent, and set myself to answer it. When the question was
+ again asked I replied by asking another, namely, "_Do you think you
+ deserve good harvests?_" This question usually made them stare and
+ ask, "Why should not we deserve good harvests?" and I would reply,
+ "In the first place, because of that _tobacco pipe in your mouth_."
+ A laugh of incredulity would usually pass round the audience, but
+ when done laughing, and asked to consider the folly of spending
+ money buying a pipe and tobacco when the smoker was shivering in
+ his rags, and hungry, and especially when asked what was the good
+ of smoking, they laughed no more. When pressed to say where the
+ tobacco came from, they would admit that the cultivation of tobacco
+ took up no small proportion of their better-class land, and when
+ pressed to say how much land was given up to tobacco cultivation,
+ they would admit, what did not seem to have occurred to them
+ before, that the amount of land given up to tobacco cultivation was
+ very large. How large it was I had no conception till the following
+ summer, when, walking round the suburbs, I would look over the low
+ mud walls of their gardens, and be amazed at the expanse of land
+ covered with the great, broad green leaf of the flourishing tobacco
+ plant.
+
+ 'Putting these things before my audience, they would admit that the
+ cultivation of tobacco was a misuse of a large portion of their
+ better land, that in cultivating and using tobacco they were doing
+ what was wrong, and hindering heaven from feeding them. Heaven had
+ given them good land and good rains for the purpose of growing
+ food. The growth of tobacco was defeating heaven's purpose, and as
+ long as they did so, what face had they to ask for good seasons? To
+ take good land and plant it with tobacco, with what face could they
+ ask heaven to send rain, seeing that if rain came, what grew would
+ not be grain but tobacco, a thing which they themselves to a man
+ admitted was no use at all? And so my audience would admit that as
+ preliminary to getting or even expecting a good harvest was the
+ discontinuance of the use and growth of tobacco.
+
+ 'In the course of a year and a half of outdoor preaching in streets
+ and at fairs, and private conversation with individuals, I never
+ met an audience that defended tobacco as useful, and do not think I
+ met more than three individuals who had anything to say in its
+ defence. Almost everyone, smokers included, admitted its
+ uselessness. Many do not seem to have thought the cultivation and
+ use of it any harm, or having any bearing on the question of food
+ supply and good harvests; they usually regarded it as simply a
+ piece of extravagance on their own part, which had no bearing on
+ anything or anybody beyond themselves. But when pointed out to them
+ they readily admit that tobacco cultivation lessens the production
+ of grain, and as readily admit that the wrongdoing in this misuse
+ of land is likely to further harm the harvest by offending heaven
+ into being unwilling to send rain. I myself never used to look on
+ smoking as any great evil, till led into this district, and thus
+ forced to study the subject. In England I had never seen tobacco
+ grown. A smoker there spends a few coppers, and smokes; what harm
+ does he do? Does not he increase trade and help the revenue? His
+ smoking seems to harm no one but himself. Such were my thoughts.
+ But in this district I see the cultivation of tobacco limiting the
+ supply of grain, thus raising the price of food, and consequently
+ making men go hungry. In addition I see men, women, and sometimes
+ children, in rags and hungry even, with pipes and tobacco, and when
+ they complain of heaven not supplying them with enough food to eat,
+ it would be less than honest not to point out to them that the
+ fault lies not with heaven, but with themselves, and that part at
+ least of the scarcity of grain they experience is due to the
+ cultivation and use of tobacco, which throughout that whole region
+ is very excessive.
+
+ 'I have dwelt thus at length on the tobacco question, not because
+ it is the most important of the three things here spoken of, but
+ because many good brethren have not been able to see with me on
+ this point. They feel, as I used to do before I went to that
+ region, that tobacco smoking is a small affair, not worth raising
+ into prominence or the region of conscience or Christian duty at
+ all. These brethren have not _seen_ how things work. I feel sure
+ that almost any missionary placed as I was would have done exactly
+ what I have done, taken a stand against this excessive growth and
+ more excessive use of tobacco, for, not content with what they
+ grow, they actually import quantities of it. Tobacco is not the
+ greatest cause of poverty and hunger in the district, but it is a
+ much greater factor in poverty than would at first be supposed. But
+ for its use in that district a large number of men, women, and
+ children, who are deficiently clothed and fed, would be warm and
+ sleek. Christ taught men to pray, "Give us this day our daily
+ bread." It must be wrong to make hundreds of men, women, and
+ children go half clad and half fed, simply that eighty or ninety
+ per cent. of the adults of that district may indulge in tobacco, a
+ thing, according to their own admission, utterly without use, and
+ for the continuance of which they can give no reason, further than
+ that they have acquired the habit and find it difficult to give it
+ up.
+
+ 'A more serious question, however, is the whisky. In going into
+ that region I was amazed at the quantity of whisky used. I used to
+ lodge in an inn and take my meals in an eating-house. There, twice
+ a day, I had an opportunity of studying the drinking habits of the
+ country. Almost every man who entered the eating-house first called
+ for a whisky warmer. Supplied with that, he would go out and buy
+ his whisky, coming back he would set it in the charcoal fire to
+ warm, and then slowly drink it from the tiny wine cups common in
+ China, inviting me to join him, and wondering at a man who could
+ evidently afford it, not treating himself to two ounces of whisky,
+ and wondering still more when he learned that I did not use
+ tobacco. It would be an exaggeration, but not a great
+ exaggeration, to say that every man who entered the eating-house
+ began his meal by drinking whisky. In replying to the question put
+ by my street audiences as to how they were to get good harvests, I
+ would ask them, after finishing the tobacco question, "How about
+ your whisky drinking?" Frequently they would anticipate me in this,
+ and say, "If tobacco is wrong, how about whisky?" To convince them
+ of the wrong of whisky was never difficult. To ask good harvests
+ from heaven, then take grain given by heaven for food, and turn it
+ into whisky, they did not need me to tell them this was wrong. And
+ there in that district it is a very crying wrong. The quantity used
+ is immense. Not only does it seem so to me, but natives from other
+ parts of China are struck by the excessive use of it.
+
+ 'The first time I travelled in the district, I was struck by the
+ manner in which they described the size and amount of trade of
+ towns about which I made inquiries. Such and such a place had or
+ had not a distillery and pawnshop. Such and such a town had so many
+ distilleries, and so many pawnshops. One travelling about the
+ country soon notes that nearly every imposing trading establishment
+ with grand premises seen from afar is either a distillery or a
+ pawnshop, or both combined. The bank notes current among the people
+ are issued, at but a small percentage, by distilleries and
+ pawnshops. The first crop to ripen in the district is barley, and
+ that, the natives will tell you, all goes to the distillery. On the
+ road you will meet large carts drawn by six or seven mules. The
+ load is grain, and of these carts a large number are owned by
+ distilleries, and go round the country collecting grain, from which
+ to brew whisky. One of the first things to be heard in the morning
+ after daylight, in a quiet market town, is a peculiar beating of a
+ wooden drum. Ask what it means, and you will be told it is such
+ and such a distillery calling its hands to breakfast. Ask how many
+ hands they have, and you may find that one establishment has some
+ sixty or seventy men who eat their food! The whisky trade is simply
+ enormous. It is out of all proportion to every other trade. The
+ women as a rule do not drink, the men do all the drinking--the
+ males I should say, for not a few boys acquire the habit of taking
+ whisky to their meals long before they can be called men. A very
+ few men do not use whisky at all. The poorer agricultural labourers
+ drink it only when they can get it, and just as much or as little
+ as they can get. Many men take regularly two ounces--Chinese
+ ounces--to each meal. Many take more. Many well-to-do people drink
+ half a catty per day. Others drink a whole catty.[7] Some drink a
+ catty and a half a day. A small proportion of the male population
+ find drinking a greater necessity than eating. These are usually
+ elderly men, but as I write I can think of two men, both young, and
+ both Mongols, one a priest, the other a layman, who have arrived at
+ this advanced stage of whisky drinking.
+
+[7] A Chinese weight equal to one pound and a third.
+
+ 'This excessive use of whisky has impoverished many families, and
+ has demoralised many men. It has caused many quarrels, and given
+ rise to many lawsuits. The evil caused by whisky is apparent to
+ all, but custom requires that friends should be honoured by being
+ offered whisky, business should be transacted over whisky, and the
+ general saying is that without whisky nothing can be done. A
+ farmer, for example, adding a few rooms to his buildings must
+ supply his masons and joiners with whisky. Thus in universal use,
+ the quantity consumed is immense. The quantity of grain used in the
+ distilleries is almost beyond computation, and I don't remember
+ ever meeting a Chinaman who did not admit that to distil whisky was
+ to do evil. They ask me how to get good harvests. I tell them;
+ "Give up abusing the grain you have got, before you ask for more.
+ If heaven sees you taking a large part of your superior land for
+ raising the useless tobacco, and taking a very large proportion of
+ the grain sent you as food, and using it not to eat, nor to feed
+ animals, but distilling it into the hurtful whisky, do you think
+ heaven, seeing all this waste going on, is likely to hear your
+ petitions and increase the supply of what you now waste so large a
+ proportion? If you bought food for your child, and he ate only half
+ and threw the other half to the pig, would you be likely to buy him
+ more just then, even though he might say he was hungry?" This
+ reasoning seems quite satisfactory and convincing to them, and
+ never fails to secure their expressed assent.
+
+ 'As to opium I never find it necessary to say much. All admit it to
+ be only and wholly bad. Yet the quantity grown in the district is
+ immense. In the early spring the very first movement of cultivation
+ is the irrigation and working of the opium land, and at the season
+ nearly all the best land blazes with bloom of the poppy. It is a
+ sight to see the country people going to the markets with the
+ "_milk_" in bowls and basins, and the buyers and sellers of it
+ riding along, each with a weighing-balance stuck in his belt.
+ Government restriction there is none, the duty imposed is not very
+ heavy, and public opinion raises no voice against it. It was
+ originally grown, say the natives, so as to keep money from going
+ out of the district in buying imported opium, but the more it was
+ grown the more it was used, and now the quantity raised and smoked
+ is immense. There is a small proportion of farmers who have good
+ land, suitable for growing opium, but who do not grow it. But these
+ men are few, and as a general rule the very best pieces of land are
+ set apart for the cultivation of opium. The common conscience of
+ the people tells them this is a wrong thing. When therefore they
+ ask how to get a good harvest, they themselves acknowledge that
+ the reply is just, which says, "First leave off the waste of
+ heaven's grace involved in the growth and manufacture of opium,
+ whisky, and tobacco, and then, and not till then, will it be
+ reasonable for you to ask heaven for more bountiful harvests."
+
+ 'In connection with all this, there is another fact that must not
+ be forgotten. Drinkers of whisky, and smokers, especially of opium,
+ the better the year is, the more they indulge. In a poor year they
+ use less whisky and opium; the better the year, and the cheaper
+ tobacco, whisky, and opium are, the more they use, so that in place
+ of making a proper return to heaven for a good year, they only take
+ the opportunity afforded them of running deeper into waste and
+ wrong-doing. Is this the way to get better harvests? Considering
+ the excessive growth and consumption of tobacco and opium, and the
+ excessive manufacture and use of whisky, what could any honest,
+ straightforward man say to the people, when they earnestly asked
+ how they were to get good harvests, but "_Repent, and cease this
+ great waste_"? And thus from no deliberate plan of mine, but from
+ the plain leading of circumstances, it came to pass that I felt
+ compelled to call upon the inhabitants of the district to lay aside
+ the use of not only opium but also of whisky and tobacco, as one of
+ the first steps toward worshipping the true God. Many friends have
+ demurred to my making teetotalism an essential of Christianity, and
+ many more have still more strongly demurred to my taking such a
+ pronounced stand against the use of tobacco. The position of my
+ friends is exactly the position I held myself before going into
+ that region, but after going to that region and seeing just how
+ things were, no other course seemed open to me, but to demand in
+ all who wanted to do right the abandonment of the whole three; and
+ I am convinced that almost any other missionary placed in the same
+ circumstances would have taken the same stand.
+
+ 'This position too commends itself to the native mind, and the
+ native mind, quite apart from me, and before my going into the
+ district, had already risen up in protest against these abuses,
+ and, in some parts of the country there, the Tsai li ti sect boasts
+ not a few members. The main practical doctrine of this sect is,
+ _Yen chiu pu tung_--abstinence from tobacco, whisky, and opium. The
+ very existence of this sect, and its flourishing condition there,
+ is a plain indication of what serious-minded natives felt about the
+ excessive use of these three things. Friends say that I am putting
+ this self-righteousness in place of faith in Christ and the
+ practice of higher duties. I do nothing of the sort. Beginning with
+ the Chinaman where I find him, and answering the questions which he
+ insists on asking first, I appeal to him to give up what he admits
+ to be wrongdoing, sin (_tsao nieh_), as the first step in ceasing
+ to do evil learning to do well, and coming into right relationship
+ with God through Christ. Some friends are much alarmed lest this
+ should lead to self-righteousness. There is no danger of that. The
+ danger lies all the other way. To leave Christians drinking whisky
+ and smoking tobacco in that region, would be to preach forgiveness
+ of sin through Christ to men who were still going on in the
+ practice of what their conscience told them was sin, and all must
+ admit that this would never do. The condition of things in that
+ region is such that I have no hesitation in saying that a man, to
+ be honest in obeying God by refraining from what is wrong, must
+ throw up his connexion with these three things, tobacco, whisky,
+ opium.
+
+ 'In _that region_. It will be noticed that I have carefully
+ confined my remarks to the state of things in _that region_. _That
+ region_ is peculiar in producing within its own bounds almost all
+ that is necessary for life and luxury even. It is peculiar too in
+ having just exactly as many inhabitants as it can support, no more,
+ no less. When the population increases too much it overflows into
+ Manchuria. When the population is less than the full complement, it
+ is instantly replenished by fresh arrivals from the South. The
+ production of tobacco, whisky, and opium, not only reduces a large
+ proportion of the inhabitants from comfort to misery, but also
+ reduces sensibly the number of inhabitants. But for these three
+ things many more men could find a living within the bounds of the
+ district Is not that little district an epitome of the world? Is
+ what is true of that district not true of the whole world? Opium is
+ a bad thing anywhere and everywhere. About that there need be no
+ debate. Whisky and tobacco reduce the comforts and the number of
+ the population there--is their effect not the same on the world in
+ general? Is it not true that but for tobacco and whisky there would
+ be food and clothes for a much larger population? And if so, do not
+ tobacco and whisky take the bread out of men's mouths and the
+ clothes off their backs? And if so, has not every smoker and
+ drinker a part in this sin? Christians pray, "_Give us this day our
+ daily bread._" Does not consistency require them to desist from
+ defeating this prayer by smoking and drinking, and thus reducing
+ the amount of the total production of the necessaries of life?
+
+ 'Tobacco seems harmless. It is less harmful than opium and whisky
+ by a long way. But its production sensibly reduces the supply of
+ grain and cotton, and thus hinders the feeding of the hungry and
+ the clothing the naked. Good earnest Christian men smoke and drink.
+ Evangelists and pastors owned of God in the salvation of souls
+ smoke and see no harm in it. The reason is they have never seen how
+ the thing works, and don't know the harm it does. I feel sure that
+ if they could see with their own eyes men, women, and children,
+ hungry and in rags, when but for tobacco and whisky they might be
+ well fed and well clothed, these same good brethren, whose example
+ is quoted against my position, would be the first and most earnest
+ to say, "I will neither smoke tobacco nor drink whisky while the
+ world stands."'
+
+At a later date, not from any change in his views, but in deference to
+the views of others, with whom he was always anxious to work in harmony,
+he modified his plans so far as not to make the use of whisky and
+tobacco absolute bars to admission into the Christian Church.
+
+His brethren also were opposed to the ascetic mode of life he adopted,
+and the extreme of hardship which he so often and so willingly
+encountered in his work. But he himself often said, and there are many
+references in his diary to the same effect, that the kind of life he was
+living in the interior was quite as healthy, and quite as conducive to
+longevity, as the ordinary and certainly much more comfortable life of a
+missionary at Peking. While it may be true that the exposure and
+sufferings of twenty years had so weakened him as to leave him powerless
+when seized by the last illness, yet the labours of twenty such years
+spent in the service of God and the service of man are surely the seeds
+from which there shall yet spring a rich harvest to the glory of God and
+to the blessing of the dark and degraded Mongols and Chinese.
+
+By the close of 1886 three main centres of work had been selected in the
+new district--Ta Cheng Tz[)u], Ta Ss[)u] Kou, and Ch'ao Yang--all three
+being towns of some importance. Mr. Gilmour used to spend a month or so
+in each town, visiting also the neighbourhood, especially those places
+where fairs were held, and where consequently the people came together
+in large numbers. He had a tent which he used to put up in a main
+thoroughfare, and there he stood from early morn until night healing the
+sick, selling Christian books, talking with inquirers, preaching at
+every opportunity the full and free Gospel of salvation. His constant
+and consistent life of Christlike self-denial in the effort to bless
+them told even more upon the beholders than all these other things
+combined. His correspondence is full of sharp and clear pictures of his
+daily toil, and of his spiritual experiences.
+
+ '_Ch'ao Yang, May 14, 1886._--The people are very poor here. Last
+ year the crops were not good. When the leaves come out on the
+ trees, the poor people break off branches and eat the seeds of the
+ elm-trees. I saw one woman up a high tree, taking down the seeds.
+ She took off half the door, laid it up against the tree, went on
+ the cross-bars like a ladder, and so got up. She threw down the
+ little branches and twigs, and her three children below gathered
+ them up. The elm seeds are just ripe now. They are the size of
+ large fish-scales; when the wind blows they come down like snow.
+
+ 'I met three lamas going to a far-off place to worship. Every two
+ or three steps they lay down flat on the ground, then got up other
+ two or three steps, then prostrated themselves again. They did not
+ know about Jesus saving people, and thought they would save
+ themselves in that way. Poor people! yet they don't like to hear
+ about Jesus saving people. They want the credit of thus saving
+ themselves.
+
+ '_September 3._--At Ta Cheng Tz[)u] we had seven days and seven
+ nights' rain. It was a great flood. The river rose and washed away
+ about a hundred acres of land and forty or fifty houses. For two
+ days the river floated down house-roof timbers, beams, &c. One poor
+ man pulled down his house to save his timbers, and the house fell
+ on him and killed him. It was pitiful to see the river washing away
+ good land, two square yards falling into the roaring flood at a
+ time. The Chinamen did nothing: only stood and looked at it. Lots
+ of walls and many houses fell down. One house in the court next our
+ own fell down one morning after the rain was all over. The people
+ had just time to jump out at the window. No one was hurt. Our room
+ did not leak much, but the outside of the wall towards the street
+ fell down. The inside of the wall still stood, so our room was
+ whole. Chinese walls are all built in two skins. The one may fall
+ and the other stand.
+
+ '_October 25._--God has given the hunger and thirst for souls: will
+ He leave me unsatisfied? No, verily. I am reading at night, before
+ going to bed, the Psalms in a small-print copy of the Revised
+ Bible, holding it at arm's length almost, close up to a Chinese
+ candle, to suit my eyes; for I cannot see small print well now, and
+ I find much strength and courage in the old warrior's words.
+ Verily, the Psalms are inspired. No doubt about that. None that
+ wait on Him will be put to shame. He is here with me.
+
+ '_November 17._--We start about the fifth watch (6 A.M.), get to
+ the fair early, spend the day on the street; it is late before we
+ get quiet, and I fear it is now well on towards the third watch. I
+ am in first-class health, though my feet and socks are in a
+ decidedly bad way. The country is not at all safe, but we have as
+ yet been preserved. Some days ago, two men who slept on the same
+ kang with us, and started a little earlier than we did, were
+ robbed. We overtook the travellers arranging themselves after the
+ interview. I was annoyed at not getting away as soon as they left.
+ God so arranged it, you see.
+
+ 'I have got a step nearer to God lately. It is this: I do not now
+ strive to get near Him; I simply ask Christ to _take me nearer
+ Him_. Why shouldn't I? Does not Christ save men from distance from
+ God and bring us near? _Peace, Blessing, and Power_, by Haslam,
+ sent me by an old college mate in Scotland, was the means used.
+ This chum tried my soul much when I was at home last. I think I was
+ of use to him, and now he has been of much use to me. Let us sow
+ beside all waters.
+
+ 'My attitude now here is that of Psalm cxxiii. 2-4. I feel that God
+ can _perform_ for, by, or rather use me as His instrument in
+ performing, if He has a mind to; so I am looking for His hand,
+ gazing about among the people that come to my stand to see the ones
+ God has sent. I feel as helpless as a Chinese farmer in a drought;
+ but when God opens the heavens, down it will come. Amen.'
+
+Mr. Gilmour returned to Peking on December 13, having been away nearly
+eight months. The tabulated results of this missionary campaign were:
+
+ Patients seen (about) 5,717
+ Hearers preached to 23,755
+ Books sold 3,067
+ Tracts distributed 4,500
+ Miles travelled 1,860
+ Money spent 120.92 taels = (about) 30_l._ to 40_l._
+
+He adds, 'And out of all this there are only two men who have openly
+confessed Christ. In one sense it is a small result; in another sense
+there is much to be grateful for. I have to part with my assistant, and
+am uncertain about whom to take in his place. My travelling arrangements
+have broken down, and I am perplexed in more ways than I have patience
+to write about; but
+
+ Where He may lead I'll follow,
+ In Him my trust repose,
+ And every hour in perfect peace
+ I'll sing, "He knows, He knows."
+
+After a visit to Tientsin and a brief rest in Peking, largely occupied
+with preparations for his next sojourn in Mongolia, he started on
+January 25, 1887. At Ta Cheng Tz[)u] he secured a kind of home, so as
+not to be exposed to all the discomforts and drawbacks of inn life,
+hoping also that a fixed centre might forward the preaching of the
+Gospel. Two rooms were taken for a year. They were situated at the inner
+end of a little trading court, around which were a tin-shop, a
+rope-spinner's room, and a stable. In one corner there was a pigsty.
+'When first I saw it I almost refused to occupy it; but really there is
+no help for it, and finally we took it for a year.' It is always
+difficult to secure premises in a Chinese town, and exceptionally so
+under the limitation of money and of suspicion and dislike to which
+Christian missionaries are always exposed. 'It is only a lodging for
+me,' Mr. Gilmour continues, 'convenient for seeing converts or
+inquirers. The court is much too small, and the place not sanitary. But
+don't be in the least uneasy. My health is quite as safe there as in the
+best premises in Peking. I intend to occupy them for a month at the
+beginning of the Chinese year, and ten or fifteen days in the fourth,
+seventh, and tenth months. I hope also to come to some arrangement for a
+lodging in Ch'ao Yang. In Ta Ss[)u] Kou I am simply in an inn, and pay
+at the usual rate for the nights I am there.'
+
+A letter to his boys, dated March 24, 1887, depicts the kind of scene he
+so often witnessed, and the routine of work which would have proved so
+irksome but for the love and peace with which the Saviour filled his
+soul.
+
+ 'Mai Li Ying Tz[)u] is a very wicked place. There were no less than
+ fourteen large tents set up for gambling, and, in addition, some
+ thirty or forty mat-tents for gambling. I was there three days. The
+ first day people were shy. The second day they were not much
+ afraid. The third day I had quite a lot of patients. We sold a good
+ few books, preached a good deal, and doctored a number of patients.
+ From there we went to Bo-or-Chih, starting in the dark and
+ travelling seventeen English miles before breakfast. After we had
+ travelled ten miles we came to a little town just as people were
+ opening their doors. A seller of _chieh jao_, that sticky stuff,
+ had just set out his wheelbarrow with his pudding. We each bought a
+ great piece, wrapped it in a _chien ping_ (a thin scone), and
+ travelled on, eating it. That was our breakfast. Arrived at
+ Bo-or-Chih, we set up our table at once, and, after preaching for a
+ short time, patients came round us in crowds, and kept us busy till
+ late in the afternoon.
+
+ 'The inn in which I am staying now is owned by two men, brothers,
+ both of whom are opium smokers. The inn has a good trade, but it is
+ all no use: it all goes to opium, and no good comes of it. There
+ are two barbers connected with the place, and they both drink and
+ gamble, so that they are in rags and poverty, though they have a
+ fairly good business. It is so painful to see men degraded thus
+ when, but for drink and gambling, they might be well off.
+
+ '_April 28, 1887._--For the last week I have been very busy at a
+ great temple gathering, which lasted six days. Such crowds of
+ people came, though it was only a country district. It was the
+ great religious event of the year for the neighbourhood, and how do
+ you think they do? They hire a theatrical company to come and act
+ six days in a great mat stage, put up for the occasion in front of
+ the temple. Theatrical exhibitions are the religion of China. These
+ shows are supposed to be in honour of the idols in the temple. The
+ people think the gods will thus be pleased, and give them good
+ seasons, health, etc.
+
+ 'What a crowd of women came to worship at the temple on the great
+ day of the festival! Till noon that day women only were allowed to
+ enter: no men. How the women were dressed--in all the colours of
+ the rainbow, red trousers being especially prominent! How they
+ moved along on their little feet! Walk you along on your heels--as
+ I have seen you do--and that is just how they move.
+
+ 'No end of gamblers came too. There were twenty-six, or so, large
+ tents put up to gamble in, and about as many straw-mat booths, and
+ they all had plenty of trade. Eh, man, it is sad to see the utter
+ worldliness of these Chinese. They soon found me out. I had my tent
+ put up in a quiet place away from the bustle.[8] In front is the
+ great flying sign, "The Jesus Religion Gospel Hall." At the one
+ end, "God the Heavenly Father;" at the other, "Jesus the Saviour."
+ They found me out, not because they wanted to hear me preach, but
+ to get medicine. Oh, the numbers of suffering people I saw and
+ attended to! I used to go out early in the morning, and be there
+ all day, most of the time so busy that there was no time to eat. To
+ get food I had to steal away because everyone would want me just to
+ attend to him or her before I went. When I had attended to that one
+ there was another, and so on. I was able to cure a number of them,
+ and got preaching a good deal too. I sold a number of books. It was
+ the first time that a missionary had ever been there, and it was
+ difficult to make them understand.'
+
+[8] See the illustration on p. 245.
+
+It is, as a rule, by direct dealing with individuals that the best
+results of Christian work in China are obtained, and to this Mr. Gilmour
+was always ready to make everything give way. In season and out of
+season, at any hour of the day or night, he was at the service of
+inquirers. The sight of a seeking face could banish his most exhausting
+feeling of fatigue, and nothing so swiftly dispelled the depression,
+from which he so often and so severely suffered, as the sight of a
+heathen coming to be more perfectly instructed about 'the doctrine.'
+Here are one or two such scenes:--
+
+ 'In the eighth month we had great pleasure in finding Mr. Sun much
+ advanced in knowledge, and confessing his Christianity with great
+ boldness. Before we left he was baptized, and one or two others
+ were coming forward as inquirers--notably one man, who is a member
+ of a sect, was making earnest inquiries. These men seem to be
+ following after righteousness in their own half-instructed fashion.
+ These sects are strong in numbers in some parts of the district,
+ and, if God should give us some of these men as converts, we might
+ hope for rapid progress among their companions. The last that I
+ heard of this man, he was coming to Mr. Sun, asking many questions.
+ He lodged with us one night, and I invited him to breakfast with me
+ in the morning. He was declining on the plea that he was a
+ vegetarian. It was with much satisfaction that I was able to say in
+ reply, "So am I."
+
+ 'The Tsai li ti are strong in Ch'ao Yang. I have been praying and
+ working to gain them for a year and more. One evening a deputation
+ of two men called upon me in my inn, and said they had come
+ representing many who wanted to know about Christianity. They, the
+ Tsai li ti, had been watching me ever since I had come to Ch'ao
+ Yang. They had listened much and often to our preaching, and now
+ they had come to make formal inquiries. I gave them such
+ information as I thought they needed, and we got on well enough
+ till they asked me to refute a slander. The slander was to the
+ effect that in a chapel in Peking, the preacher would, when he
+ finished preaching, get down off the platform and have a smoke! I
+ had to admit that this was no slander, but a true statement. I had
+ a good deal to say in explanation of it; but, alas! the men came no
+ more.'
+
+To form any just estimate of Mr. Gilmour's work in Eastern Mongolia, it
+is needful constantly to bear in mind that it was practically a new
+departure. So far as we know, he is the only missionary in China
+connected with the London Missionary Society who adopted _in toto_ not
+only the native dress, but practically the native food, and, so far as a
+Christian man could, native habits of life. His average expense for food
+during his residence in his district was _threepence a day_. This rate
+of expenditure was, of course, possible only because he adopted
+vegetarianism. His practice acted and reacted upon his thought, and he
+came at this time to hold the view, for and against which a great deal
+may be said, that it was a mistake for Chinese missionaries to live as
+foreigners--that is, to wear foreign dress, arrange their houses and
+furniture as nearly as possible in European style, and eat European
+food. Both on its economical side and also as impressing the mind and
+heart of the Chinese, he believed that his was the more excellent way.
+
+Most of his co-workers at Peking and Tientsin did not agree with him. As
+agreement would have involved, perhaps, following his example, under
+conditions that differed widely from those of Ta Cheng Tz[)u] and Ch'ao
+Yang, this difference of opinion was only what was to be expected. It is
+referred to here only as a well-known fact, and no story of Mr.
+Gilmour's life could be trustworthy which did not represent the decided
+way in which, when he felt that loyalty to his work and loyalty to his
+Master constrained him, he could and did act in direct opposition to the
+wishes and views of brethren whom he fervently loved.
+
+It became needful from time to time for him to justify his actions to
+the home authorities. Not that this was in any way needful from any
+doubt or lack of support on their part. But with regard to methods upon
+which there was marked divergence of view in the missionary committees
+abroad it was needful that a man like Gilmour should put his motives and
+reasons clearly before the governing powers. It is doing him bare
+justice to say that from this task he never shrank. The following
+extracts are from letters to the home officials of the London Missionary
+Society and they enable us to appreciate accurately the standpoint of
+the man whose thought they express. Writing in the light of the
+suggestion that perhaps he was putting a more severe strain upon his
+health than the efficient discharge of his difficult duty demanded, he
+says:--
+
+ 'I feel called to go through all this sort of thing, and feel
+ perfectly secure in God's hands. It is no choosing of mine, but
+ His; and, following His lead, I have as much right to expect
+ special provision to be made for me as the Israelites of old had in
+ the matters of the Red Sea, the manna and water in the desert, the
+ crossing Jordan, and the fall of Jericho.
+
+ 'One thing I am sure of. The thousands here need salvation; God is
+ most anxious to give it to them: where, then, is the hindrance? In
+ them? I hardly think so. In God? No. In me, then! The thing I am
+ praying away at now is that He would remove that hindrance by
+ whatever process necessary. I shall not be astonished if He puts me
+ through some fires or severe operations, nor shall I be sorry if
+ they only end by leaving me a channel through which His saving
+ grace can flow unhindered to these needy people. I dare not tell
+ you how much I pray for.
+
+ 'It is the foreign element in our lives that runs away with the
+ money. The foreign houses, foreign clothes, foreign food, are
+ ruinous. In selecting missionaries, physique able to stand native
+ houses, clothes, and food, should be as much a _sine qua non_ as
+ health to bear the native climate. Native clothes are, I believe,
+ more safe for health than foreign clothes; they are more suited to
+ the climate, more comfortable than foreign clothes, and so dressed,
+ a Chinese house is quite comfortable. In past days I have suffered
+ extreme discomfort by attempting to live in foreign dress in native
+ houses.'
+
+And yet James Gilmour had nothing of the fanatic or bigot about him. At
+the period of his life with which we are now dealing, his severest trial
+was the loneliness due to his having no colleague. Whenever his brethren
+ventured to address remonstrances to him, they were due largely to the
+conviction that entire isolation, such as he had to endure throughout
+his Mongolian career, must tell adversely upon his temperament. But in
+judging the character of the man it only heightens our love and respect
+for him that he did not allow the utter and successive failures of all
+efforts to secure him a colleague to hinder the work. No man more
+readily and more constantly acted upon the principle of doing the next
+best thing. His idea of satisfactory conditions for the work was never
+reached; but this never led him for one day to relax his own efforts or
+to loosen the strong hand of his self-discipline.
+
+To any reader who has carefully followed the previous pages it must have
+become abundantly evident that Mr Gilmour believed in God's present and
+immediate influence in the passing events of daily life, and that the
+right attitude of life is one of absolute dependence upon, and
+submission to, the will of God. His diaries abound with proofs of this.
+He is delayed one morning in starting from his inn, and is annoyed. An
+hour or so later he overtakes the travellers who started earlier, and
+finds them just recovering from the assault of a band of robbers. The
+delay was God's providential care protecting him from robbery. And yet
+no man was ever less under the spell of religious fatalism. All that
+active effort and promptitude of mind and body could effect in the
+service of life he freely and constantly expended in his work. And
+indeed there lies before us a long letter written at Ta Ss[)u] Kou on
+March 15, 1888, asking for an official proclamation from the Chinese
+authorities at Peking affirming 'that Christian worship is an allowed
+thing, and that native Christians are not required to contribute, or are
+exempted from contributing, to idol and heathen ceremonies, such as
+theatricals, or the building and repair of temples.' The proper official
+document was applied for at Peking, and in due time obtained.
+
+On March 24, 1888, James Gilmour was rejoiced by the seeming fulfilment
+of his heart's most eager desire--the arrival at Ta Ss[)u] Kou of a
+fully qualified medical colleague, Dr. Roberts. We have seen how
+repeated had been his entreaties, how earnest his yearnings after this
+essential factor in the success of his mission. For a month he enjoyed
+to the full the uplifting of congenial fellowship and of skilled help.
+Then came a blow, harder almost to endure than the previous solitude.
+
+ 'Two days ago,' he writes under date of April 21, 1888, 'a man
+ pushed himself in among the crowd round my table as I was
+ dispensing medicines in the market-place here, and announced
+ himself as a courier from Tientsin. When asked what his news was,
+ he was silent, so I led him away towards my inn. Oh the way I again
+ asked what his news was. He groaned. I began to get alarmed, and
+ noticed that he carried with him a sword, covered merely with a
+ cloth scabbard. This looked warlike, and I wondered if there could
+ have been another massacre at Tientsin. Coming to a quiet place in
+ the street I _demanded_ his news, when he replied, "_Dr. Mackenzie
+ is dead, after a week's illness._" At the inn we got out our
+ letters from the bundle, and found the news true. In a little Dr.
+ Roberts looked up from a letter he was reading and said he was
+ appointed to the vacancy. _Then_ the full extent of my loss flashed
+ upon me. Mackenzie dead--Roberts to go to Tientsin! One of my
+ closest friends dead--my colleague removed!
+
+ 'Forty-eight hours have elapsed, and I am just coming right again.
+ I have been like a ship suddenly struck in mid-ocean by a mountain
+ sea breaking over it. You know in that case a ship staggers a bit,
+ and takes some time to shake clear and right herself.
+
+ 'As to Mackenzie. His friendship I very keenly appreciated. The
+ week of prayer in January 1887 we spent together in Peking. The
+ week of prayer in January 1888 we spent together in Tientsin. These
+ were seasons of great enjoyment. On parting we spoke of having a
+ week together again in April 1889. That is not to be. The full
+ extent of the loss will take some time to realise.
+
+ 'The prospect of Dr. Roberts settling permanently here in the
+ autumn gave light and brightness to the outlook. My faith is not
+ gone, but it would be untrue to say that I am not walking in the
+ dark. I shall do my best to hold on here single-handed; but I
+ earnestly hope that I am not to be alone much longer. Something
+ must be done. There is a limit to all human endurance.
+
+ 'Amid many storms we are holding on our way, and making progress
+ among the Chinese. Of the Mongols I have nothing cheering to
+ report. They come around and daily hear the Gospel; but, as yet at
+ least, there it ends. I look into their faces to see whom the Lord
+ is going to call, but have not seen him yet apparently. Meantime, I
+ am getting deeper and deeper into Chinese work and connections, and
+ sometimes the thought crosses my mind that my knowledge of
+ Mongolian is not employed to its best advantage here. On the other
+ hand, I see more Mongols here than I could see anywhere on the
+ Plain.'
+
+God's ways of dealing with His work and the workers are often very dim
+and obscure to finite understanding. Humanly speaking, no man in China
+could less easily be spared than Dr. Mackenzie; no man in all that vast
+empire more needed the joy of fellowship than he to whom it had just
+been granted. But the indomitable spirit shines clearly through the
+words of Gilmour: 'It would be untrue to say that I am not walking in
+the dark. I shall do my best to hold on here single-handed.' Seeing
+God's hand, as he did, in these sorrowful events, and believing that Dr.
+Roberts also was following the path of God's will, he turned again to
+his lonely tasks. But it was at a heavy cost. His health was giving way
+faster than he realised. The views of his brethren at Peking, that he
+would break down under the strain of the isolation, were to some extent
+justified. The home authorities did what they could, but nearly a year
+elapsed before Dr. Smith, who was appointed to succeed Dr. Roberts,
+reached Mongolia, and when he did so his first duty he felt was to order
+Mr. Gilmour to visit England for rest and change. But meanwhile he went
+bravely on. Like his Master, 'he endured the contradiction of sinners
+against himself,' and when 'he was reviled, he reviled not again.'
+
+ 'We left Ch'ao Yang,' he writes under date of September 3, 1888,
+ 'August 10, attended markets, got much rained in, and reached Ta
+ Cheng Tz[)u] August 20. There I found that one of the Christians
+ had possessed himself of my bank book and drawn about fifteen taels
+ of my money which I had banked at the grocer's. The delinquent
+ turned up next day, walked in, and hung up his whip as if nothing
+ had happened. At the moment I was dining, and he sat down beside
+ me. I asked him quietly why he had treated me so. He said I might
+ be easy in mind; he had money and cattle he would pay me. "Go,
+ then, and bring me the money; till you do so, don't come to me
+ again." Off he went. Days passed and nothing was done to repair the
+ mischief. Meantime, the scandal was the talk of the small town, and
+ the scornful things said were so keen that Liu, my assistant, got
+ quite wild. He was indignant that I did not go to law with the man,
+ who all the while was swelling about on a donkey bought with the
+ money he stole from me, and using the most defiant and abusive
+ language towards me (not to my face, happily). The roughs of the
+ place began to be insolent, and a drunken man came and made a scene
+ in our quarters. Liu redoubled his attack on me, and even
+ threatened to go home to Shantung if I would do nothing but pray--a
+ course of action on my part which irritated him much. Li San, the
+ head Christian there, joined him in saying I ought to make a show
+ of power. I asked the two to read at their leisure Matt. v. 6, 7.
+ Liu warned me that I was in personal danger. The man was
+ panic-struck and highly nervous. I arranged an expedition to a
+ place some 90 li away, but got rained in and could not go. Finally,
+ the offender sent an embassy desiring peace, and, the day before we
+ left, a respectable deputation of mutual friends, Christian and
+ heathen, found its way one by one to my room, coming thus not to
+ attract attention, and last of all came the thief. According to
+ pre-arrangement I asked him, as he entered, what he had come for.
+ He walked up to the wall, knelt down, and confessed his sin in
+ prayer to God. The end of the matter is, he gives me one donkey and
+ the promise of another, is suspended as to membership for twelve
+ months, and is forbidden the chapel for three months.
+
+ 'I am not bright about Ta Cheng Tz[)u], as you may suppose. Worse
+ than the stealing case is that of the head man, Li San, who says
+ that he was promised employment before he became a Christian! The
+ ten days we passed there we were the song of the drunkard and the
+ jest of the abjects; but the peace of God _passes all
+ understanding_, and that kept my heart and mind. We put a calm
+ front on; put out our stand daily, and carried ourselves as if
+ nothing had happened.
+
+ 'The great thought in my mind these days, and the great object of
+ my life, is to be like Christ. As He was in the world, so are we to
+ be. He was in the world to manifest God; we are in the world to
+ manifest Christ. Is that not so? Iniquities, I must confess,
+ prevail against me; but as contamination of sin flows to us from
+ Adam, does not regenerating power flow into us from Christ? Is it
+ not so?'
+
+Meanwhile work was going steadily forward and some impression was being
+made. He made a flying visit to Tientsin and Peking in the autumn, but
+was soon back at his post. In his report of work for the year he is able
+to point to progress.
+
+ '1888 has been a tumultuous year. In December, at Ch'ao Yang, there
+ was a sudden irruption of men and boys to learn the doctrine.
+ Evening after evening we had from twenty to fifty people in our
+ rooms to evening worship. We hardly knew how to account for it, but
+ did all we could to teach as many as we could. The cold weather
+ finally did much to stop the overcrowding, but there was good
+ interest kept up among many till the end of the year.
+
+ 'The baptisms for the year were, at Ta Cheng Tz[)u], two; Ta Ss[)u]
+ Kou, two; Ch'ao Yang, eight; total, twelve adults, all Chinese.
+
+ 'One man has been put out, so that the numbers stand as follows: Ta
+ Cheng Tz[)u], four; Ta Ss[)u] Kou, three; Ch'ao Yang, nine; total,
+ sixteen, all Chinese.
+
+ 'Three adults, Chinese, were baptized ten days ago, and I hope to
+ baptize two children next Sunday; but we have almost no promising
+ adherents here at present. There are three entire families
+ Christian, with Christian emblems on their door-posts; another
+ family is Christian, but cannot fly the colours on the door-posts
+ because the grandfather who has half the building is a heathen.
+
+ 'In still another family, where only the husband is Christian, they
+ have the Christian colours, but the family is heathen.
+
+ 'My heart is set on reinforcements. Can they not be had? I had
+ hoped Dr. Smith would have spent the winter with me, but he did
+ not. All the grace needed has been given me abundantly, but I don't
+ think there should be any more solitary work. I don't think it
+ pays in any sense.
+
+ 'In addition, it is almost time I had a change. My eyes are bad.
+ Doctors hesitate over my heart, say it is weak, and that its
+ condition would affect seriously an application for life assurance.
+ This winter I have gone in for a cough, which is not a good thing
+ at all, and it would be well for the continuity of the work that
+ there should be a young man on the field.
+
+ 'Don't be alarmed, though, and don't alarm my friends. The above is
+ for your own private information and guidance. I still regard
+ myself as in first-rate health.
+
+ 'I am not satisfied that we seem drifting away from the Mongols. At
+ present, though lots of Mongols are around, our work is all but
+ entirely Chinese. I am still of opinion that our best way to reach
+ them is from a Chinese basis. This may involve a matter of years
+ ahead, and therefore it is that I am eager to see the future of the
+ work provided for by being joined by a younger man or men.
+
+ 'Meantime I am trying to follow very fully and very faithfully the
+ leadings and indications of God. I have had times of sore spiritual
+ conflict and times of much spiritual rest, and my prayer is that
+ you and the Board may in all your arrangements and plans for
+ Mongolia be fully guided by Him. Oh that His full blessing would
+ descend richly on this district!'
+
+Dr. Smith reached Mongolia in March 1889, and for the first time met his
+colleague. He has placed on record for use in this biography his account
+of that first meeting. On reaching Ch'ao Yang, Dr. Smith found that Mr.
+Gilmour was not there. 'I followed the innkeeper,' he writes, 'to see
+the spot where my devoted colleague had spent so many lonely hours. We
+came to a little outhouse, with a kind of little court in front of it,
+not many yards wide. The outer door was locked by means of a padlock;
+but the innkeeper soon found an entrance by simply lifting the door off
+its wooden hinges, and then we were in the anteroom or rather kitchen.
+In it was a built-in cooking-pan, an earthenware bowl, and a wooden
+stick resembling a Scotch porridge-stick; and some brushwood which had
+been brought in to be in readiness when he next arrived at that inn. One
+of the two rooms, which lay on each side of this ante-room, was locked,
+and we could not open it, but through the chinks of the door I could see
+abundant traces of Gilmour. It was specially refreshing to see some
+genuine English on one of the boxes; it was "Ferris, Bourne, & Co.,
+Bristol," the people from whom he used to order his drugs. My servant
+and I decided to take up our quarters in the next room, which was
+evidently the servant's room. We soon managed to make ourselves very
+comfortable, and there was an unspeakable relief in at last being in a
+place which belonged to the London Mission, rented of course. We had to
+spend the Sunday there. Mr. Sun, the box-maker, soon came round, and
+seemed genuinely glad to see me, and offered to make all arrangements
+for the further stage of our journey. We then discharged our carts, and
+I sent with them my letters for home.
+
+'After spending the Sunday in company with the Christians there, we set
+out on the Monday morning with a local carter for Ta Cheng Tz[)u], a
+distance of about twenty-three miles. We crossed a hilly and sparsely
+populated district, reminding me of some of the bleaker scenery in
+Scotland. On reaching the town we at once drove to the new private
+mission premises. It was a little house surrounded by a straw fence.
+Quite a crowd of rough-looking people followed us in. One of the doors
+had been stolen, and altogether it looked so unprotected that I decided
+to take up my quarters in a little Mongol inn, where Mr. Gilmour
+formerly lived. Next day I expected to meet Gilmour, and the two
+Christians there were fully expecting him. In the evening we had quite a
+levee; Li San and the other Christian, whom Gilmour used to call "Long
+Legs," sat drinking tea in my room for some time, and were very
+friendly; they were evidently trying to ingratiate themselves with me; I
+did not then know how disgracefully they had behaved to Gilmour, nor did
+I know the anxious business which was bringing Gilmour there at that
+time.
+
+'Next day or the following, I forget exactly which, I was sitting in my
+room, when a young man arrived, my servant being out at the time. I
+could not make him out at first, not being able to understand what he
+said; but he had such an evident air about him that he had some kind of
+business with me that it at last dawned upon me that he must be Mr.
+Gilmour's servant, and this was at once confirmed on the arrival of Lin
+Seng, my servant. He had been sent on ahead to announce Gilmour's
+arrival. It had been blowing a dust-storm all day, and on that account I
+hardly expected Gilmour, but now there was no doubt.
+
+'About four o'clock that afternoon Gilmour arrived, and I shall never
+forget that first meeting. I had pictured quite a different-looking man
+to myself. I saw a thin man of medium height, with a clean shaven face,
+got up in Chinese dress, much the same as the respectable shop-keepers
+in that part of the country wear. On his head was a cap lined with cat's
+fur. I was struck by the kindly but determined look on his face. He
+greeted me most cordially, and I remember he said, "I am glad to see
+you." He looked worn out and ill. I at once gave him his letters.
+
+'After arranging his things and seeing his men comfortably settled and
+getting over his first interview with the Christians there, he came up
+to my room in order to spend the night with me. We sat to all hours of
+the morning, chatting about things at home, and about his boys, whom I
+had seen before leaving Scotland.
+
+'For the next day he arranged the dreaded interview with Li San down at
+the mission premises. Gilmour warned me that it would be a long-winded
+affair, and wished me not to expect his return for a good number of
+hours. After waiting a long time I went down to see how the interview
+was progressing. Li San and Gilmour were sitting on the kang, in tailor
+fashion on each side of a low table, and Li San was singing hymns; but
+there was a strange look upon his face, as if he did not altogether feel
+like singing. Gilmour said to me in English that they had not come to
+business yet, and Gilmour was determined that Li San was to say the
+first word, so Gilmour invited him to sing hymn after hymn, and then I
+left. The whole idea seemed to be to get money out of Gilmour, and when
+he found that impossible he threatened to come down to Tientsin to
+accuse Gilmour to his missionary colleagues, of having broken his
+promise to give him employment. Gilmour had no recollection of having
+done so; he said to me that possibly one of his previous assistants may
+have on his own responsibility led Li San to form that idea.
+
+'Long Legs was also dogging Gilmour for money, and altogether they
+worried him; but he settled up everything. The premises were resold, and
+as Gilmour put it, "it was the funeral of that little church." They were
+threatening to prevent our leaving the town, as there seemed some doubt
+in Gilmour's mind as to whether we would be able to get a cart; these
+fears were disappointed; Li San got a cart for us.'
+
+Before Dr. Smith had passed many days in the society of Mr. Gilmour it
+became clear to the practised eye of the medical man that his colleague
+had been overstraining his health and strength. Notwithstanding his
+buoyancy and occasional high spirits all through his long years of work,
+James Gilmour had been subject to spells of severe depression. There are
+a very large number of brief entries in his diary to that effect. 'Felt
+blue to-day' is a frequent phrase, followed soon in the great majority
+of instances by words indicating a speedy recovery. Special events, that
+from time to time had a direct adverse influence upon his work,
+developed this state of mind rapidly and profoundly. The inevitable
+recall of Dr. Roberts, already described, is a case in point, and the
+diary at that season contains entries like these:
+
+ '_April 26, 1888._--These last days have been full of blessing and
+ peace in my own soul. I have been able to leave things at Ta Cheng
+ Tz[)u];, and my colleagues all in God's hands.'
+
+ '_May 7._--Downcast day. No one to prayer.'
+
+ '_May 9._--In terrible darkness and tears for two days. Light broke
+ over me at my stand to-day in the thought that Jesus was tempted
+ forty days of the devil after His baptism, and that He felt
+ forsaken on the cross.'
+
+ '_May 27, Sunday._--Service, Romans xii. Present, four Christians.
+ Great depression.'
+
+The most constant force acting in the direction of mental depression was
+what appeared to him like the want of immediate success. He longed with
+an eager and almost painful intensity for signs that Gospel light had
+broken in upon the mental darkness of the men with whom he was in daily
+contact. He yearned for evidence that the love of Christ was winning the
+love of Chinese and Mongol hearts, as a mother yearns over her children.
+Hope deferred as to his medical colleague, ever recurring difficulties
+defeating all his efforts to secure suitable premises for his work,
+failure on the part of natives whom he had begun to trust, and all these
+things over and above the ceaseless strain of his daily toil, are more
+than sufficient to account for the state in which Dr. Smith found him.
+
+To those who knew him best, and who could appraise at their true value
+the toils and trials and disappointments of his daily lot, the wonder
+was not that he broke down; it was rather that physical collapse had not
+overtaken him sooner. There are many kinds of heroism, but it may be
+doubted whether any touches a higher level than that exhibited by this
+patient sower of the seed of life on the sterile field of Mongolia,
+bravely continuing to do so until imperatively urged to cease for a
+season, not by his consciousness of failing power, but by the alarm and
+influence of his medical co-worker.
+
+When the decision was once taken, it was acted upon promptly. March 26,
+1889, was the day, and Peking the place. On April 4 he left Peking, and
+on the 20th he sailed from Shanghai. He arrived in London on May 25.
+
+This visit to England in 1889 was a great refreshment bodily, mental,
+and spiritual, to the overwrought labourer. The voyage itself, enforcing
+rest from all ordinary avocations, by removing Mr. Gilmour from the
+depressing surroundings amid which he had spent so much of the last
+three years, began the restorative process. He was beginning to feel in
+himself great benefit from the change even by the time he reached
+London. But the six years which had passed since he last walked the
+London streets had left their mark upon him. He had drawn to the utmost
+upon his physical and spiritual strength in the service of those for
+whose conversion he lived and toiled. He had been through the deep
+waters of personal affliction when his wife passed into the sinless
+life. The many toils and hardships of the passing years had drawn deep
+furrows upon the cheery face, and the eyes showed evidence of the mental
+and spiritual strain.
+
+So sudden was the resolution to return, and so prompt his action upon
+it, that few knew even of the probability until he was actually here. On
+May 27, 1889, the writer was sitting in his room, overlooking the
+pleasant garden that brightens up the north-eastern corner of St Paul's
+Churchyard, in conversation with a gentleman, when a knock came at the
+door and a head appeared. Not seeing it very clearly, and at the same
+time asking for a minute's delay while the business in hand was
+completed, the head disappeared. As soon as the first visitor departed a
+man entered and stood near the door. I looked at him with the
+conviction that I knew him, and yet could not recall the true mental
+association, when the old smile broke over his face, and he burst into a
+laugh, saying, 'Why, man, you don't know me' 'Yes, I do,' I replied,
+'you're Gilmour; but I thought that at this moment you were in
+Mongolia.' But when I was able to scrutinise him closely I was shocked
+to see how very evident were the signs of stress and strain. It was not
+wholly inexcusable, even in an old friend, to fail to instantly
+recognise in the worn and apparently broken man, thought to be hard at
+work many thousands of miles away, the strong and cheery Gilmour of
+1883.
+
+Carrying him off home, we talked far into the night, not because his
+host thought it a good thing for the invalid, but because he was so full
+of his work and its difficulties and its pressing needs, and what he
+hoped to do on behalf of Mongolia by his visit home, that there seemed
+no possible alternative but to let him talk himself weary. And how
+splendidly he talked! He pictured his life at a Mongol inn. He ranged
+over the whole opium and whisky and tobacco controversy. He gave, with
+all the dramatic effect of which he was so great a master, the story of
+how he forced home upon the Chinese and Mongols, until even _they_
+admitted the force of the reasoning, how natural it was that famine
+should visit them when they gave up their land to opium, and their grain
+to the manufacture of whisky. He gave in rapid dialogue his own
+questions, the native rejoinders, and he so vividly pictured the scene
+that his hearer could fancy himself standing under the tent, surrounded
+by Chinese and Mongols, and assenting, as they did, to the earnest and
+far-reaching conclusions of the speaker.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+PERSONAL CHARACTERISTICS AS ILLUSTRATED BY LETTERS TO RELATIVES AND
+FRIENDS
+
+
+This break in active work affords a convenient occasion for exhibiting
+in a still stronger light, by means of selections from his
+correspondence, some important sides of James Gilmour's character. He
+was a good correspondent and wrote freely to his relatives and friends.
+We have quoted largely hitherto from his official reports and from
+letters that refer to the condition and progress of his life-work. But
+it is in the letters addressed to the circle of relatives and most
+intimate friends that he reveals more fully the deeper side of his life,
+and the strong and tender affection of his nature.
+
+He corresponded regularly with his parents until the earthly tie was
+broken by the death of his mother in 1884 and of his father in 1888. His
+letters to the latter were very beautiful, especially those designed to
+strengthen his faith in the closing years when he had passed the
+eightieth milestone. The tone of the correspondence may be judged from
+the following examples:--
+
+
+ 'Peking: Friday, January 23, 1885.
+
+ 'My dear Father,--So this must in future be the heading of my
+ letters--no longer my dear parents. Mother has gone. Yours of
+ November 21 reached me this afternoon, or evening rather. As I
+ came home from the chapel I found a beggar waiting at the gate. I
+ thought he was going to beg, but he did not. Inside I found the
+ gate-keeper waiting at our house door for a reply note, to say that
+ the letter had been delivered. I went to my study, and was praying
+ for a blessing on the chapel preaching when Emily came. I let her
+ in. She had your letter in her hand. It had come by Russia, and the
+ Russian post sometimes sends over our mail by a Peking beggar,
+ paying him of course.
+
+ 'I have not had time to think yet. On my heels came in men for the
+ prayer-meeting we hold in our house on Friday evening, and till now
+ I have been almost continuously engaged. It is now 10.20 P.M. It so
+ happens that this week I am much behind in my sermon preparation
+ for Sunday, and it also happens that I am going to preach on _whole
+ families_ believing on Christ. What brought this subject to my mind
+ is one of our old Christians who is dying, the only Christian in
+ his whole family. His great grief is that they (his family) remain
+ heathens. In addition, too, a Christian father admitted to a
+ missionary the other day that he had not taught Christ to his
+ daughter who had just died. Preaching on this subject I will have
+ something to say about my own dear, good, anxious mother, and of
+ how she used to say when I was a boy, "_What a terrible thing it
+ will be if I see you shut out of heaven!_" She did not say
+ terrible; "unco" was her word.
+
+ 'I have not yet had time to realise my loss, and cannot think of
+ the Hamilton house as being without her. Eh, man! you know how good
+ a mother she was to us, and I have some idea of what a companion
+ and help she was to you. You two had nearly fifty years together.
+ You must feel lonely without her. Fathers and mothers are thought
+ much of by the Chinese, and you, at my suggestion, were most
+ heartily and feelingly prayed for by the Chinese at our
+ prayer-meeting to-night. You would have felt quite touched could
+ you have heard and understood them.'
+
+There is a special interest attaching to the sentence used frequently by
+his mother. On page 41 he refers to his conversion, but no record
+appears to have been preserved, giving any detail or fixing with any
+exactness the date. But his brothers have a conviction that his constant
+recollection of the oft-repeated and well-remembered words, 'What an
+unco thing it will be if I see you shut out of heaven!' was one of the
+most potent influences in bringing about his conversion. The letters
+immediately following were written during the last two years of his
+father's life.
+
+ 'Let us not be disturbed at all about our not having more
+ communication. I pray often for you and remember you more
+ frequently still, and feel more and more that earth is a shifting
+ scene, that here we have no permanent place, that heaven is our
+ home, that your wife--my dear mother--has gone there, that my wife
+ has gone there and is now in the Golden City, and that, sooner or
+ later, you and I will be there, and that, when there, we'll have
+ plenty of time to sit about and talk all together in a company.
+ Lately I have come to see that we have but to put ourselves into
+ the hands of Jesus and let Him do with us as He likes, and He'll
+ save us _sure and certain_. He can make us willing even to let Him
+ change us and train us.
+
+ 'You are eighty years old. I am proud of you. I like to think of
+ your life. Mother told me, when I was a lad, of some of your early
+ struggles. God has been with you and guided you on through all to a
+ good old age of honour and respect and love. Trust Him and He'll
+ not leave you. Depend upon it, God has something better for us in
+ the world to come than He has ever given us here. And it is not
+ difficult to get it. God wants to give it to us all; offers it to
+ us, and is distressed if we don't take it. We have only to go to
+ Christ and ask Jesus to make it all right for us, and He'll do it.
+ I know you are in earnest. Jesus will turn away no earnest man.'
+
+Mr. Gilmour senior acted as steward of the little store which his son by
+rigid economy was amassing for the benefit of his children. Scotch
+thrift was well exemplified in them both. But in the course of 1887
+James Gilmour became troubled about this accumulation of even that small
+sum which he could call his own. In his lonely introspective Mongolian
+life the possession of money came to wear in his view the aspect of
+distrusting God. At this juncture the London Missionary Society was in a
+somewhat serious state as regards funds. A special appeal had been sent
+out indicating that if additional funds were not forthcoming, some
+fields of work might have to be given up. James Gilmour's response was
+an order to pay over anonymously the sum of 100_l._ to the general funds
+of the Society, and 50_l._ to that set apart for widows and orphans.
+
+
+ 'March 16, 1887.
+
+ 'My dear Father,--Some explanation is due to you of the order to
+ pay the London Missionary Society 100_l._ of my money as a
+ contribution to their funds.
+
+ 'The money that I have in the bank is the result of long and, much
+ of it, of self-denying savings on my part and the part of my late
+ wife--more on hers than mine, perhaps. When she died, and I was
+ going off to this remote and isolated field, it was a comfort to me
+ to think that in the event of my death there was a little sum laid
+ past which would help my sons to get an education. I have added to
+ that sum all I could from my house-furniture sale, &c., and it has
+ reached a good figure--the exact sum I cannot yet tell--I have not
+ yet had your account for 1886.
+
+ 'Some time ago God seemed to say, "_Entrust that money to My
+ keeping!_" and, as days went on, the command seemed to get more
+ loud and be ever present, so much so that finally I could not read
+ my Bible for it or pray. I had no resource left but to obey; I did
+ not like to give it up; but finally it has appeared to me that God
+ is only keeping the funds for the lads and that He will arrange for
+ them to have them all right when they are needed. How He can do
+ this I need not ask. He may, for instance, keep me alive for the
+ sake of the lads. In one sense it seems an unwise thing not to be
+ laying up something for the children's education; but that is only
+ one side of it. God seems to ask me to trust Him with my children,
+ and I trust Him with them. They are far from my care and control,
+ and I know such painful cases of the children of missionaries
+ growing up unbelievers that I dare not do anything that seems to me
+ not to be putting them fully into God's care and up-bringing.
+
+ 'In addition, I am exhorting people here to become Christians, by
+ doing which they throw themselves and their children outside of the
+ community. I tell them to do it, and trust God's protecting them in
+ troubles and helping them in difficulties; and I can hardly do that
+ if I have not faith in God myself for me and mine.
+
+ 'Again, I need God's help and blessing much in my work here, and I
+ do not seem to myself to be able to expect it if I do not trust
+ Him. So please regard the money removed as not lost, only put into
+ a safer bank.'
+
+The following letter, also dealing with money matters from the Christian
+point of view, is so striking in many ways that it has been deemed
+advisable to quote it _in extenso_:--
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang, Mongolia: May 6, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Father,--Enclosed please find some directions about the
+ disposal of my money. These arrangements are so contrary to my
+ previous arrangements that some explanation is due to you and to my
+ brothers. Here they are.
+
+ 'In my mission work out here I am much thrown upon God. The field
+ is a very hard one. The superstitions are like towns walled up to
+ heaven. The power of man avails nothing against them. As far as man
+ is concerned I am almost alone. I turn to God. I hear the words,
+ "Not by might nor by power, but by My Spirit," saith the Lord. I
+ trust Him. I call upon Him. I commune with Him. He comes near me. I
+ ask Him to convert men. There are conversions, a few true, as far
+ as I can judge. But there seems some barrier between God and me to
+ a certain extent. Thinking round to see what it can be, I hear a
+ voice saying, "Can't you trust Me with the money you have laid up
+ for your children?" I think over it I pray over it. I say, "I may
+ die and the boys need the money." God replies, "If you trust Me
+ with it, don't you think I'd give them it as they needed?" I say,
+ "But my father and brothers might not see it so, and might not like
+ the idea of destitute orphan children on their hands." God replies,
+ "With _Me_ for their banker children are not destitute, and if you
+ prefer father and brothers before Me, you are not worthy of Me."
+ Then I say, "What will you have me do?" God says, "Give Me the
+ money; I'll see they have all that is necessary." I dare not
+ disobey. I don't want to disobey. I am so much exercised over the
+ spiritual well-being of the boys, that I gladly do anything that
+ will make them in any sense more specially proteges of God. I am
+ alarmed at the fate of some missionaries' children who have not
+ turned out godly men. Preserve the boys from this!
+
+ 'This is no sudden resolution. I have thought and prayed much over
+ it. I can delay this step no longer without feeling I would be
+ refusing to follow God's guidance. I feel, too, that God has so
+ many ways in which He can bless the lads and me, that in making
+ this arrangement I am running no risk. The only thing I am not
+ quite clear about is the detailed disposition of the money.
+ Meantime, it seems to me that I can best use it for God in this
+ mission here. I mean to bank it in Peking, in the first instance,
+ and use it for renting or buying premises.
+
+ 'As to the general principle of having money for ourselves or
+ children, I do not think God asks us all to put all we may have or
+ get thus in His keeping, or asks me even to put _all_ into His
+ keeping in this especial manner. You know the money was originally
+ saved from the salary given by the mission, and in this sense is
+ peculiar. Money that I had earned by trade, or otherwise come by, I
+ do not think God would ask me to dispose of it so. But His voice
+ seems very plain in this present case.
+
+ 'My salary I shall still have paid to me, and the children's
+ remittances shall come as usual. If I live I guess this will be
+ enough for the education of the lads. If I die, the lads are not
+ destitute. Even in a worldly sense, and quite apart from this sum
+ which I am banking with God, and which I am sure He'll repay with
+ compound interest when needed, if left orphans they would be in
+ some sense provided for by the London Missionary Society, which,
+ though it gives no pensions to any one, yet yearly raises funds and
+ gives money to broken-down old missionaries, widows, and orphans. I
+ don't suppose it is much or enough, but it is something. I say this
+ that you may not be troubled should your faith be weak or waver.
+
+ 'I hope that these arrangements may not seem unwise to you, and
+ will commend themselves to you far enough to have your consent if
+ not your warm approval. For myself I am thankful that God has given
+ me faith enough to trust Him so. It has taken time to come to this.
+ Myself is a small matter--it takes more faith to trust for one's
+ children. Just fancy old Abraham offering his Isaac. Just fancy,
+ God so loved the world that He gave His only Son. Let us respond to
+ God's love.
+
+ 'Your loving son,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+In compliance with his wish a sum amounting to several hundred pounds
+was sent out to Peking and there banked by him. Had not the many
+difficulties which Chinese habits placed in the way prevented the
+completion of negotiations, there is hardly any doubt that James Gilmour
+would have himself spent this money on his own mission-field. He died
+before any of the negotiations for premises which he had commenced
+reached a successful issue. As he had not specified in his will that
+this sum was to be devoted to mission work, the trustees of his boys
+have had no alternative, and have felt it their duty to consider it a
+part of his estate, the income of which should be devoted to the
+education of his sons. But the intention of James Gilmour was clear and
+well known, and it is to be hoped that the interest felt by many friends
+in his life and work will prove strong enough to secure a permanent home
+for the mission as a memorial of its founder, and on the site of his
+glad and self-sacrificing toil.
+
+A year or two later, in a letter to his boys, he seeks to enforce the
+duty of careful, systematic giving to God.
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang: August 19, 1890.
+
+ 'I wonder if you are giving a tenth of all the money you get to
+ God. I think it is a right thing to do and a good thing. Mamma did
+ it: I do it: and God never let us want for money. I would be glad
+ if you would like to do it. But don't do it merely to please me.
+ Don't do it except you can do it gladly. God likes people to do
+ things gladly. I am quite sure you would get blessing by it. Money
+ given to God is never lost. And it is easier to begin the habit now
+ than later.
+
+ 'When you give it to God you can put it into the London Missionary
+ Society box; it would only be fair to give some little part of it
+ at the collection at the church to which you go. You could give
+ some of it for destitute children. It does not matter much where
+ you give it. I think the London Missionary Society has the best
+ claim. Think over it, boys. Jesus died to save us: surely we can
+ show our gratitude by giving Him some of our money?'
+
+Later letters to his father outline for us his religious experience, and
+enable us to realise something of the spiritual experience of these
+years.
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang: March 29, 1887.
+
+ 'I am wondering how you all are. God has been drawing me nearer to
+ Him these last weeks, and I am living in the hope that He will
+ bless me and my work largely some day. There is much ignorance to
+ be removed, much suspicion, much misunderstanding of me as a
+ foreigner, and I am hammering away as hard as I can. There are
+ mountains of difficulty to be removed, but I am trusting in God to
+ remove them, and these last days I have had much peace and joy in
+ my heart thinking of God's love to me and the salvation of Jesus. I
+ have no doubt at all about my being His, and sometimes the great
+ hope is almost too much to realise. But I am often at the same time
+ downcast that I cannot see more people here converted, and I think
+ that, if God has a favour to me and delights in me, He can well
+ move the hearts of these people to believe in His Son, and choose
+ out people to come and help me in my work. I am sometimes lonely
+ here, and wish I had a friend to talk to and tell all my troubles,
+ and then I think that Jesus is such a friend, and so I tell Him all
+ my griefs; but I would like to have a colleague.
+
+ 'I hope, my dear father, that your heart is contented and happy in
+ Jesus. Only let Him arrange all things for you as regards your
+ soul, and He'll do it all right. He can be trusted. Heaven is not
+ far away; we'll soon be there; comfort your heart. Won't it be too
+ blessed to be again with our wives, freed from all that is earthly,
+ and suffering, and surrounded by nothing but what is nice! This is
+ no dream: it is real; it is true; it is kept for us; it will be
+ ours. We'll see it soon; you and I will be there together. It may
+ be some time before we are there together; but years soon pass.
+ Cheer up, my father!
+
+ 'We miss much by not living near to Jesus--taking Him at His word
+ and expecting that He'll do all we need done for us both in saving
+ us and in making our hearts good. Jesus is real and heaven is real,
+ and our share in heaven, if we trust and follow Jesus, is real. You
+ say you are busy: so am I. You have cares: so have I. Go ahead and
+ look after your work and business; but you'll do it all the better
+ that your heart is at peace with God and at rest in Jesus. I find
+ that the closer I am to Jesus the better I can meet and bear all
+ troubles, trials, and difficulties, and you will find the same true
+ if you try.
+
+ 'I feel quite lifted up to-night. I have a room to myself. This is
+ the first time I have had a room to myself since leaving Peking
+ January 25. It is pleasant to be private a little. This room is
+ private to me alone only after (say) 8 P.M., when I am left in
+ peace. I hope to have this room for three weeks.
+
+ 'I am afraid, if you saw the room, you would not think it much of a
+ place. To-night, too, I have a pillow. For over three weeks I have
+ rested my head on some folded-up bag or article of dress: to-night
+ I have a pillow. Christ had not where to lay His head. In all
+ things I am still better off than He was. If I could only see souls
+ saved I would not care for the roughing it.'
+
+In a letter later in the same year to a missionary colleague in a
+distant field Mr. Gilmour unveils still further his religious history:--
+
+
+ 'Mongolia: October 7, 1887.
+
+ 'Yours of May 31 to hand three or four days ago. The China Inland
+ Mission has a lot of good men in it. It does a good work. It is
+ warm-hearted devotion that wins souls and gets God's approval. My
+ experience has been different from yours, happily. All along I have
+ gone on the "headlong for Christ" way of things here, even when
+ preaching to the most intellectual English and American audiences,
+ and they have received me royally. Man, God has waked me up these
+ last years to such an extent that I feel a different man. I
+ sometimes wonder now if I was converted before. I suppose I was,
+ but the life was a cold, dull one. Just the other day Jesus, so to
+ speak, put out His hand and touched me as I was reading a hymn,
+ something about desiring spiritual things and passing by Jesus
+ Himself. I wanted His blessing more than I wanted Him. That is not
+ right. Lately, too, I have become calm. Before I worked, oh so hard
+ and so much, and asked God to bless my work. Now I try to pray more
+ and get more blessing, and then work enough to let the blessing
+ find its way through me to men. And this is the better way. It is
+ the right way. And I work a lot even now. Perhaps as much as
+ before; but I don't worry at the things I cannot overtake. I feel,
+ too, more than I did, that God is guiding me. Oh! sometimes the
+ peace of God flows over me like a river. Then it is so blessed,
+ heaven is real. So is God: so is Jesus. Our lot is a great one.
+
+ 'Try not to fly around so much: take more time with God. Be more in
+ private prayer with Him, and see if He will not give you a greater
+ spiritual blessing for your people. After all, the great want, as I
+ gather from your letters, is the spiritual blessing on the people.
+ Ask it, man, and you'll get it. God's promises are sure. I am
+ trying to combine the China Inland Mission, the Salvation Army, and
+ the L.M.S. I have a great district, and a hard one, all to myself.
+ There is said to be a young doctor on his way out to me. I am
+ writing by this mail for three young laymen. Non-smoking and
+ teetotalism are conditions of Church membership. I have seen no
+ foreigner since January 25, and am not likely to see one till
+ December 5. My mails take an enormous time to reach me, and two
+ sent in June and July from Peking (eight days off) have never come
+ to hand at all. I am baffled, battered and bruised in soul in many
+ ways, but, thank God, holding on and believing that He is going to
+ bless me.
+
+ 'Eh, man, never talk of not going back. Go back, though you can
+ only do half work; go back, and work less and pray more. That is
+ what you need. I have been a vegetarian for over a year. I find
+ fasting helpful to prayer. Two books by Andrew Murray, Wellington,
+ Cape Town--_Abide in Christ, With Christ in the School of
+ Prayer_--have done me much good. May blessings be on your dear wife
+ and children! Yours, hoping to have a good long holiday with you in
+ heaven,
+
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Some years earlier in his career he had written a letter of brotherly
+remonstrance to one who, in a moment of depression and without any
+adequate cause, felt himself slighted. The same spirit breathes through
+both, but is richer and fuller in the later letter. God had been
+teaching James Gilmour in a hard, but a fruitful school.
+
+ 'I know of your zeal in working at home as well as abroad, and I am
+ greatly grieved to find you think you are badly treated. I think it
+ is very unfortunate that any agent should have that feeling about
+ his Society, L.M.S. or other. I am alarmed, too, my dear fellow, to
+ find you express yourself so strongly. It is hardly the thing.
+ Would Christ have said that? I do hope you will pardon my speaking
+ so, but you know sometimes a rash word does more harm than a deed
+ even. And I am anxious that you should have a peaceful mind. _I_
+ know your value, and wish to see you nearly perfect. Let me remind
+ you of a thing we both believe, and a thought I have often been
+ comforted by. Jesus has suffered even more for us than we can ever
+ suffer for Him, and what you do in raising funds and endeavouring
+ is done, not for L.M.S., but for Him, _for Him_, and He sees and
+ knows and won't forget, but sympathises and appreciates, and at the
+ end will speak up straight and open for His true men. I often lug
+ portmanteaus, walk afoot, and, as the Chinese say, "eat
+ bitterness," in China and in England. I am not thanked for it, but
+ He knows. No danger of being overlooked. Now, don't be "huffed" at
+ my lecturing you, and don't think I must think a lot of myself to
+ suppose that I am running up a bill of merit, like a Buddhist, and
+ think I am Jesus's creditor. My dear fellow, you know better than
+ that. I point out to you and remind you of the only way I know to
+ be persistently useful, and at the same time happy.'
+
+But of all the relationships of life--son, brother, friend, ambassador
+for Christ--that which most naturally, most profoundly, and most
+beautifully reveals his very heart is when he writes as the loving
+father to his distant motherless boys. A large number of his letters to
+them have been entrusted to the hands of his biographer. Many of them
+touch upon subjects too sacred for publication. They deal with those
+closest of earthly ties in which not even intimate friends can
+legitimately claim a share. But it was felt that they reveal a side of
+his nature and character that ought not to be entirely hidden in any
+picture of his life. For this reason a somewhat extensive selection has
+been made from this tender and helpful correspondence. When it first
+began the lads were too young to read the letters themselves, but he
+wrote long accounts of his work to be read to them, and it is pleasant
+to see how keen his eye became in noting such things as were likely to
+amuse them and to arrest their attention. Some of the letters are
+written in big letters resembling printed capitals. The brief, childlike
+letters that were sent to him by them were bound up into a paper volume,
+which he carried about with him during his Mongolian wanderings, and in
+looking them over he found an unfailing solace and refreshment. He often
+illustrated his own letters to them by rough but effective sketches of
+persons and things which he saw. The death of their mother had brought
+the lads and their father very near to one another, and although lost to
+sight, they always thought and spoke of the dear one who had gone as
+still of the family, as in perfect happiness, and waiting only God's
+time to reunite them in the happy life of heaven.
+
+When it was decided to entrust them to the care of an uncle in Scotland,
+Mr. Gilmour set out the desires he cherished with regard to their
+training. It is only to be regretted that similar plans are not formed
+and acted upon in the training of all children.
+
+ 'The laddies are here with me now, and I am both father and mother
+ to them. To-night I darned three stockings for them when they went
+ to bed. You see I have been away two months, and in a week or two I
+ may have to part from them for ten years, so I am having a little
+ leisure time with them. I sometimes do feel real bad at the idea of
+ the two orphan lads going away so far; but then the promise of
+ Christ that no one leaves parents or children for His sake, without
+ being repaid manifold, comforts me by making me believe that God
+ will raise up friends to comfort them wherever they may be.
+
+ 'Cheer up! The two worlds are one, and not far separate. Mrs.
+ Prankard, I hear, won't have Emily's name mentioned. We here go on
+ the other tack, and the children are all day long talking about
+ what mamma did and said, and adventures we had together. And why
+ not? The tears come sometimes: let them, they do no harm, are a
+ relief more than anything, and the time is coming when God will
+ wipe away all tears from our eyes.
+
+ 'I wish them to be Christ's from their youth up. I wish them to get
+ a good thorough education, not too expensive, to be able to read,
+ write, and spell well. Should either of them turn out likely, I
+ might be able to let both, or that one have a college education,
+ but I don't want either of them to go there if they don't show
+ adaptation for it.
+
+ 'What I want of you is something money cannot buy, motherly and
+ fatherly care in Christ for the desolate lads, whose whole life in
+ time and eternity too may largely depend on how they are trained
+ and treated during the next few years. I am not rich, but I can
+ support my boys. This Christian care and love, however, is what is
+ not to be had for money, so I beg it.
+
+ 'I had five hours' conversation with one Chinaman at a stretch the
+ other day. I think he was not far from the kingdom of God at first,
+ and I believe he is nearer now. All these things take time, and I
+ am most anxious to be with the children much these last days. Oh,
+ it is hard to think of them going off over the world in that
+ motherless fashion! We were at mamma's grave yesterday for the
+ first time since September 21. We sang "There is a land that is
+ fairer than day," in Chinese, and also a Chinese hymn we have here
+ with a chorus, which says, "We'll soon go and see them in our
+ heavenly home," and in English, "There is a happy land." The
+ children and I have no reluctance in speaking of mamma, and we
+ don't think of her as here or buried, but as in a fine place, happy
+ and well.'
+
+Here are a few short extracts from the earlier letters:--
+
+ 'Cheer up, my dear sonnies! We shall see each other some day yet.
+ Tell all your troubles to Jesus, and let Him be your friend. I, out
+ here, think often of mamma and her nice face, and how good she was
+ to you and to me. You will not forget her. She sees you every day,
+ and is so pleased when you are good lads. We'll all go some day and
+ be with her, won't that be good? Meantime, Jesus is taking care of
+ her, and will take care of us.
+
+ 'Sometimes, when I am writing a letter to you, and come to the foot
+ of a page, and want to turn over the leaf, I don't take blotting
+ paper and blot it, but kneel down and pray while it is drying.
+
+ 'I am going away, too, in a few days; then I'll have no one but
+ Chinese to speak to. Never mind, I'll just tell Jesus all my
+ affairs; I cannot go away from Him. He is never too busy to talk to
+ me. Just you, too, tell Jesus all your troubles. He sees both you
+ and me.'
+
+From the longer letters we select three or four, and give them exactly
+as they were written. From them the character of many others, from which
+only brief extracts can be taken, may be judged.
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang: April 10, 1887.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I am well and thankful for it. I am getting on well
+ too, thank God. I have had terrible weather lately though. Daily I
+ have my tent--it is only a cloth roof on six bamboo poles--put up
+ in the market-place. We have had three days' wind. Eh, man, the
+ first day the dust was terrible. But I had lots of patients and
+ remained out all day. At last we had to take down our tent. It
+ could not stand. The tent was carried to the inn, but we remained
+ with our table till evening. You would hardly have known us for
+ dust. But patients came all the time. Next day the tent was blown
+ down twice. Once a man's head got such a smack with the bamboo tent
+ pole, but he said nothing and took it quite pleasantly. A peep-show
+ man near us got his show blown down and scattered about. He
+ gathered it up and went home to his inn.
+
+[Illustration: JAMES GILMOUR'S TENT]
+
+ 'I am so glad that the people like us and trust us and come about
+ us for medicines. Women came too. Boys came too. Just now the
+ school boys have holiday for the fair, and they stand for a long
+ time together looking at me doctoring the people. What the boys
+ like to see is a glass bottle of eye medicine which I bring out and
+ set up. Then I dip a glass tube in and press an india-rubber
+ bulb. The air comes out in the water in bubbles and rises up to
+ the surface, and the boys are so delighted to see it bubbling. They
+ will wait a long time and like to see it ever so often. They are
+ sometimes troublesome, then I send them away. When they are good I
+ shove the glass tube deep down into the bottle, and they are so
+ delighted to see the air bubbling up from the bottom.
+
+ 'When a man comes to have a tooth pulled even the men are
+ delighted, and advise him to have it out. They want to see the fun.
+ Mothers send their little boys for medicine, and I am so pleased
+ with some of the little lads. They are so modest and so polite,
+ making a deep bow as they go away. Always be modest and polite, my
+ sons, and people will love you and treat you well.
+
+ 'The boys buy a lot of books too, and I preach to them earnestly,
+ because in ten years to come they will be men, and if they know
+ about Jesus now they may more easily become Christians some day
+ soon. You, Jimmie, know Jesus; does Willie? Teach him. Mamma is not
+ here to teach him, and I am far away. You are his big brother.
+ Teach you him like a good laddie as you are.
+
+ 'The other day when I was preaching a man was standing behind me
+ with a little black pig under his arm. He wanted to hear me preach,
+ but the pig would not be quiet. He held its mouth shut, but the
+ little pig would still manage to give a squeak now and again. At
+ last it would not be quiet at all, and he had to go away with it. I
+ could not help smiling at him. There is an old man here in my inn.
+ He is owner of the inn. His son manages the inn. The old man is not
+ very old. He is about sixty-five. But he used to be a great opium
+ smoker. A year or more ago he had a very serious illness and gave
+ up his opium, but he had wrecked his health by his smoking. He
+ cannot now live many months. He can hardly speak plainly now. He
+ comes to see me in my room, and I try to tell him about Jesus,
+ hoping that he may be saved. He listens, but he is not very bright
+ in his mind. I hope he may pray to Jesus.
+
+ 'The other day I had to pull my own tooth. It was the back tooth
+ and had been painful for days. There was no one who could do it for
+ me, so I sat down with a little Chinese looking-glass before a
+ candle, got a good hold of it with the forceps, and after a good
+ deal of wrenching out it came. He _was_ a deep-pronged fellow, and
+ he did bleed. I was so thankful that God helped me to get it out. I
+ can sleep now all right.
+
+ 'Our Mongol donkeyman wants to be a Christian. I hope he is
+ sincere, but he is very slow and dull at learning. There are three
+ other men here who are learning about Jesus too, but it is too
+ early yet to say much about them. A good many people learn some,
+ then stop. But it is late and I must go to bed, else I won't be
+ able to preach and doctor all day in the market-place at the fair
+ to-morrow.
+
+ 'Praying that God may bless you, my sons, and sending you much
+ love,
+
+ 'I am your affectionate Father,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+ 'Ta Cheng Tz[)u]: Sept. 3, 1887.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I am well, and thankful for it. The three
+ Christians here come daily to evening worship. There are here
+ others who want to be Christians, but who have not courage enough.
+ One man's wife won't let him be a Christian; she says she will kill
+ herself if he does. Another man is in the same case. He is a
+ Chinaman, his wife is a Mongol. Still another man has a Mongol
+ wife, and she kept him back. The other day he came and confessed
+ Christianity. His wife does not consent, only says: "We'll see."
+ Another man's father hinders his son from Christianity. The lad is
+ a very nice lad.
+
+ 'Yesterday was the day when people make offerings of food and
+ fruit at the graves. One of the Christians was sent to do so. He
+ brought the melon here, and we ate half of it with him.
+
+ 'Still another man is forbidden by his father to be a Christian.
+ That is, in all, five men are Christians at heart, and read our
+ books and are learning Christianity, but do not confess Christ in
+ this one place. Do you know what Jesus says about such people
+ (Matt. x. 32-39)? Jesus says that, if they obey others rather than
+ Him, they are not worthy to be His disciples. I am praying for all
+ these people. I ask you, too, to pray for these and all like them,
+ that they may be able to confess Christ. It is difficult for men in
+ China to be Christians. How different with you! We all want you to
+ be Christians. Your father and friends all help you to be
+ Christians, and if you are not Christians we are all distressed.
+
+ 'Boys, do be true to Jesus. In your words and deeds honour Him.
+ Make _His_ heart glad. Jesus wants your love. He loves you and died
+ for you. You cannot but love Him if you think how He loves you.
+ Good-bye. Meantime I am just going to breakfast, and then for a day
+ on the street, trying to tell the people about Jesus. God bless
+ you, my dear lads!
+
+ 'It is now afternoon. I write a few lines. A lad in a shop here has
+ a tame dove. He has painted it all over different colours. It looks
+ absurd. I don't like to see it sitting about the shop. Doves look
+ so happy flying about. Mamma, too, liked to see birds on the trees
+ and houses wild, not kept in cages.
+
+ 'I guess you are just about getting your breakfast. Here it is
+ about 4 P.M. With you it should be 8 A.M. Saturday; I wish I could
+ see you. My love to you, my dear sons. May you always, both now and
+ when grown, be boys and men that know and love Jesus! I pray for
+ you. Your loving father,
+
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+In August 1884 a third son was given to Mr. and Mrs. Gilmour, whom they
+named Alexander. In 1887 spinal trouble developed, and in December of
+that year he died. 'Though often ill,' wrote his father when announcing
+the death to the uncle after whom he had been named, 'his life was a
+happy one. It is now happier than ever. Thanks be to God that there is,
+and that we know that there is, a bright and happy life beyond. Let us
+make that the great meeting-place for ourselves and our children and
+friends. May it stand before us as a joy! As ever and anon one and
+another goes there, may we feel that we have more and more interest
+there! Let us live looking to the joy set before us!' This baby-brother
+is the Alick referred to in the following letter:--
+
+
+ 'Ta Cheng Tz[)u], Mongolia: February 11, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I am well, and thankful for it. I got here two days
+ ago. I had such a cold time of it on the road! I never felt the
+ cold so much before.
+
+ 'People here are very busy. This is the last day of the Chinese
+ year.
+
+ 'To-morrow is the first day of the Chinese year. Everybody is
+ buying all sorts of food, because the shops do not open for some
+ days after the new year. They are very busy, too, scraping off the
+ old papers at the sides of their doors and pasting up new papers.
+ They (the papers) are red, and look fine at first with the great
+ black Chinese characters written on them. But the sun after a while
+ takes the colour out of them.
+
+ 'They are busy, too, pasting up the new gods in their houses. They
+ (the gods) are sheets of paper with pictures of gods on them. Every
+ house has a god of the kitchen. They send him to heaven, as they
+ think, by burning him. They burnt the old one last Saturday. They
+ are putting up the new one now. They think that when he is burnt he
+ goes to heaven and reports to a god what he has seen in the house
+ during the year. I ask them if I burnt them would they think they
+ were going to heaven? They buy sticky sugar-cakes to give him so
+ that he may be pleased, and not tell on them for doing evil things.
+ They think, too, that the sugar sticks his lips together, so that
+ when he wants to tell on them he can't get his mouth open! Isn't it
+ all very silly and very sad? The shopkeepers, too, paste up a "god
+ of riches," thinking that thus they will become rich!
+
+ 'To-morrow (Sunday) I hope to baptize a man. He is a Chinaman. That
+ will make four Christians here. They all have faults and
+ weaknesses, and I am not very easy in my mind about them. Pray that
+ God may make them better and make them grow in grace. Pray, too,
+ that God may convert more of the people. Pray, too, that God may
+ give us a house of our own to live in. People here are afraid to
+ let us have a house. Now that Dr. Roberts is coming, we will need a
+ house. He is coming in six or seven weeks. Then he stays two
+ months, and goes back to Tientsin for a while again. We saw the
+ Christian at Ta Ss[)u] Kou as we passed. The Ch'ao Yang man we have
+ not seen yet.
+
+ 'I have made all your letters to me into a book, and have them with
+ me. Your letters are nice to read, and show great improvement in
+ the writing. I am going to keep all your letters this year too and
+ bind them. You may like to see them when you grow big. The last
+ letter from you is dated October 27.
+
+ 'My dear sons, I think of you often and pray for you much.
+
+ 'You have a photo of mamma's grave. Little Alick's little mound is
+ close to mamma's, on the side nearer little Edie's. Mamma's and
+ Alick's coffins touch down below. They lie together. But mamma and
+ Alick are not there. They are in heaven, with its golden streets
+ and its beautiful river, and its trees of life, and its beautiful
+ gates, and its good, loving, kind people, and Jesus and God. They
+ are having such a nice time of it there!
+
+ 'My boys, don't be afraid of dying. Pray to Jesus, do the things He
+ likes, and if you die you will go to Him, to His fine place, where
+ you'll have everything that is nice and good. I don't know whether
+ you or I will go there first, but I hope that by-and-by we'll all
+ be there, mamma and Alick and all. I like to think of this.
+ Meantime let us be doing for Jesus all we can, telling people about
+ Him and trying to persuade them to be His people. Are your
+ schoolfellows Jesus' boys? Do you ever tell them of Him? Tell them,
+ my dear sons.
+
+ 'I hope to get letters from you in about a month.
+
+ 'Good-bye, my dear boys.
+
+ 'May you be good and diligent, and then you'll be happy. Jesus can
+ make you glad.
+
+ 'Your loving Father,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Mrs. Meech had shown much motherly kindness to her little nephew
+Alexander, and only a few months after he had died she herself lost a
+little son. Mr. Gilmour, on hearing the sad tidings, wrote to her as
+follows:--
+
+
+ 'Mongolia: March 25, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Mrs. Meech,--Many congratulations and condolences with
+ you. Your little son has gone to Emily. She'll look after the
+ little man as you looked after her little man. Just fancy! we have
+ family connections in heaven not a few, and ever increasing. I hope
+ you are now getting better and going on all right.
+
+ 'I am much cheered by the good news of soul movements in the West
+ Mission. May they continue and increase!
+
+ 'With many prayers for you all, and kept in constant remembrance of
+ you all by the date block,
+
+ 'Yours in loving sympathy,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+ 'May 30, 1888.
+
+ 'I am doctoring a little homeless lad's head here. I put on
+ ointment all over it to-day. He cried. I said I had medicine that
+ would stop the pain, and brought out six cash--one farthing--and
+ told him to go and have a bowl of buckwheat meal strings. All
+ laughed, he stopped crying, and did not seem to feel the pain after
+ that. Most of the people in the town are much impressed with the
+ improvement in the boy's head. Before he came to me I saw a Chinese
+ medicine-man poking at the lad's head with a straw. When he came I
+ rubbed on ointment with my finger. The bystanders were much pleased
+ to see I was not averse to touching the poor dirty lad's sore head.
+ Jesus touched a leper, and I like to do things like what Jesus
+ would do. That is the right way, boys. Always think what Jesus
+ would have done, and do like Him.'
+
+
+ 'Mongolia: Sept. 9, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I am out on a journey. I knew letters were being
+ sent me, and hoped to meet them. A long way off I saw a red
+ umbrella, the sun shining through the oilcloth. The thought passed
+ through my mind, "Can that be the messenger?" But I forgot all
+ about it, reading a book as I walked along. All at once I heard,
+ "He's come," and looking up, saw the red umbrella close at hand. It
+ _was_ him. The messenger returns to-morrow. I had had no letters
+ for eighty days.
+
+ 'I wrote you last on August 2. Since then several men have
+ professed Christ, and one man has been baptized.
+
+ 'One of the Christians at Ta Cheng Tz[)u] stole my bankbook and
+ drew money of mine, amounting to about 3_l._ He says he is
+ penitent, and we have put him on a year's probation to see how he
+ does. He is a lazy man. Long ago I said, "If you are lazy, some day
+ the devil will make you a sinner," and so he did. Had he been a
+ diligent man he would not have been poor and would not have stolen.
+ Diligence is a good thing, laziness is a bad thing. A good
+ Christian cannot be lazy, because he knows Jesus does not like lazy
+ people. I may write you again in a few days. Hoping next mail to
+ get a letter from you (there was none this mail), and asking God to
+ bless you in everything, and guide you in all your life,
+
+ 'I am your loving Father,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR'
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang, Mongolia: Saturday, November 17, 1888.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--On the street to-day I saw a crowd standing. I went
+ up to see what they were looking at, and found two Chinese
+ gentlemen showing off a trained bird. One of the men stood down on
+ the street. The other put three little flags so that they stuck on
+ the wall. The bird then flew away, caught up a flag, and came
+ flying back to its master in the street, carrying the flag in its
+ bill. It looked very clever. Every time the bird brought a flag it
+ was rewarded by being fed with some nice food which it liked. It
+ was very pretty to see it. But after all it was a very trifling
+ employment for two grown gentlemen to be engaged in. Even the crowd
+ of ordinary Chinese seemed to think so.
+
+ 'I don't like to see birds in captivity. It is pretty to see them
+ wild flying about, and to hear them singing, but I pity them in
+ cages, and tied by string as the Chinese are fond of doing with
+ them. When I see birds tied I often think of mamma who used so much
+ to like to see them wild.
+
+ 'I remember one day in Mongolia mamma stopped me from plucking a
+ flower; she said it looked so pretty growing. Another time a beetle
+ flew and alighted somewhere; mamma said, "It is so glad that it is
+ alive, don't hurt it."
+
+ 'I am a good deal distressed to see the boys in the market-place.
+ They steal just as much as ever they can from the sellers of straw
+ and fuel, pluck out handfuls from the bundles and run away not at
+ all ashamed. If the owner does not chase them they get off with it.
+ If he throws down his load and runs after them they drop the
+ plunder, the owner picks it up, and no more is said about it.
+
+ 'In summer little naked boys follow people carrying fruit in open
+ baskets and steal it as they can: it all seems so dishonest, and no
+ one seems to care. On the street lots of people will see a thief
+ stealing a man's pipe and never say a word, because it is not their
+ business.'
+
+ 'I often think of you and pray for you. You do not forget mamma, I
+ am sure. She is with Jesus. Be you His lads, and do your lessons
+ well, and He'll guide you all through life. Be diligent and careful
+ lads, and you'll grow up useful and honoured men. Constantly tell
+ Jesus all your affairs.
+
+ 'Goodbye meantime, my boys.
+ 'Much love from your affectionate Father,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+CLOSING LABOURS
+
+
+James Gilmour remained in Great Britain less than eight months. The
+society of his boys was a great delight to him. He rejoiced in renewed
+intercourse with relatives and old friends. His religious convictions
+and his own spiritual life deepened still more. He went to a
+considerable number of meetings to speak on missionary work and needs,
+and he everywhere produced a great impression.
+
+Referring to this visit, and especially to his intercourse with the
+boys, a near relative writes:--
+
+'It was a time full of interest and pleasure. What a variety of moods,
+from the frolicsome to the pathetic, he displayed! But evidently his
+wife's death had laid hold upon his very soul, and there seemed so much
+more of sadness and tenderness than on his former visit, when he had
+enjoyed her bright companionship. On one occasion, referring to a
+medical missionary who had brought his wife home from China hopelessly
+ill, and who was expecting the end, he said: "Eh, man, he little knows
+the _terrible_ dark valley he has to come through, and if Christ is not
+with him he will be undone!" He spoke the words as though he were again
+going through his own agony, and then added: "But if Christ is with him
+he will come out of it with victory, and Christ will be dearer. But he
+has _no_ idea what he has to face, though he thinks he has."
+
+'He had looked forward to spending part of his time with his sons at
+Millport, where he had spent June and July 1883 with his wife and boys
+on his former visit. So we went there for a month, and they had a good
+time boating, and walking, and reviving old memories of the happy home
+circle. The thought of reunion was always made prominent. The boys must
+ever remember his earnest efforts to lead their thoughts heavenward, and
+they do think of heaven as a very real place.
+
+'While at Millport he spent several nights in pasting up texts on every
+place likely to catch the eye; on stones and gateways and fences all
+round the island. He felt he must work while time was granted to him. I
+had noticed him making paste, but thought nothing of it. I had heard the
+sound of a softly closing door at midnight, but thought it must be
+fancy. It had gone to my heart to feel his icy cold hand when he gave me
+his morning greeting. I noticed the little texts pasted up, but never
+thought of them as his work till the next day, when he began to make
+more paste, and then the whole thing came to me like a flash. I begged
+him with tears not to go out in the cold night air, and said that I knew
+God would rather have him stay in his warm comfortable bed and get well
+and strong. He answered so kindly: "Sister, it pains me to grieve you."
+But he finished his work nevertheless.
+
+'He was always wonderfully considerate, and grateful for any attention.
+Sometimes, when he saw me unusually tired, he would go and get an extra
+pillow and make me rest on the sofa, or when we came to the table he
+would place me in a comfortable chair and pour out the tea himself, or
+he would say: "Sister, take a cup yourself first, then you will be able
+to help us."
+
+'On the day before he left us to return to China he really said his
+farewell. We had finished dinner, and when he went out he stood and
+looked in through the window at the happy faces still around the table.
+He threw a kiss, and then his feelings overcame him, his lip quivered,
+the tears came to his eyes, and he hastened away. Later in the day, when
+I was speaking hopefully of seeing him again, he answered: "I shall see
+your face no more."
+
+'I know he felt very much giving up the comforts of civilised life, but
+he set his face to it. It touched me much the last evening he was with
+us, when, after I had to remind him two or three times of some business
+it was needful for him to attend to before he would go, he said: "I can
+hardly drag myself away from this bright cosy scene."
+
+'His was a rarely sensitive soul. It pained him to hear any one speaking
+evil of another. I have seen him turn deadly pale when he has heard any
+one impute a wrong motive. He longed for more of the spirit of Christ
+among men. How he longed, too, for more workers in the Mission field!
+Many a time he would say, after a walk through Hamilton on a Saturday
+evening: "Just think! In a little town like this there are men preaching
+at every other street corner, and I am alone in all of those hundreds of
+square miles in Mongolia! What you people are thinking of I cannot
+imagine!"'
+
+In a correspondence which he conducted with the daughter of one of his
+former professors there is very much that reveals how deep and strong
+his religious life had become, and how he had noted the current of
+renewed spirituality which is evident now in all sections of the
+Evangelical Church.
+
+From this correspondence we have been permitted to cull some beautiful
+and helpful passages.
+
+
+ 'Glasgow: November 18, 1889.
+
+ 'May He Himself lead you into closer and closer communion with Him,
+ and give you in very full measure His joy and His peace! For myself
+ and for you, I pray that we may be more captivated with Him and His
+ friendship. You know, I suppose, No. 565, "In the Secret of His
+ Presence," in the 750 edition of Sankey. No. 328, "O Christ, in
+ Thee my soul hath found," is one I like too, as being the
+ expression of partly experience and partly aspiration. He is truly
+ the true source of true satisfaction. May we be led to trust Him
+ more largely in all the things of our lives! I am sure, too it will
+ be the things where we have trusted Him most and been most
+ consecrated in His service that we shall value most when we look
+ back on life from the end. May you be largely satisfied with His
+ blessing and Himself!'
+
+
+ 'November 20, 1889.
+
+ 'I wonder if your experience is anything like mine--that I have
+ often got less benefit than I had hoped from special withdrawals
+ from common surroundings to get more into the presence of the Lord.
+ One or two prominent instances of this have happened to me. I am
+ glad He can be found anywhere, and that He is easy of access always
+ with favourable or unfavourable surroundings.
+
+ 'About feeling--never mind that at all. Things are so whether we
+ feel them or not. Let us take God at His word, and not consider
+ our feelings. God refuses no one who comes to Him in sincerity. Let
+ us be sure of this. I once heard Spurgeon say a good thing: "When
+ doubts or the devil comes and says, 'You are not saved; you are not
+ right with God,' I go to Him and say, 'If I never came before, I
+ come now; if I never trusted before, I trust now.'" That cuts off
+ all doubts about the present as standing on the past, and gives a
+ fresh start.
+
+ 'All over the kingdom there is a hunger and thirst among many for a
+ life of greater nearness to God; a feeling not only of the need of
+ God being more of a daily, hourly reality and factor in our life,
+ but that without Him more real and present life is not a
+ satisfactory thing. When this feeling takes possession of one, we
+ do not need to give up things as denying ourselves for Christ, so
+ much as that we are changed in attitude towards many things. We
+ drift away from them. Things that were gain to us we count loss for
+ Christ. Our aims are different. May our lives be more fully taken
+ captive thus! To a life lived thus, death is not a breaking off of
+ anything; it is an enlargement of sphere.'
+
+
+ 'Hamilton: December 5, 1889.
+
+ 'All I know about the process is just going to God and telling what
+ I want, and asking to be allowed to have it. "Seek, and ye shall
+ find; ask, and ye shall receive." I know no secret but this.... God
+ understands His scholars, and knows how to teach each one.
+ Different scholars may require different ways. We may trust
+ ourselves in His hands, only let us be earnest students. I have at
+ different times been quite surprised how a book, or a friend, or a
+ remark conveying just the teaching needed at the time has been
+ brought into my way. Yes, none teach like Him.'
+
+ '_December 25, 1889._--Oh that we may be more completely given over
+ and up to Him to be used at His pleasure and as He pleases! Oh for
+ more faith in Him! My lads are, I think, enjoying themselves; I
+ commit them to Him; but eh!'
+
+ '_January 1, 1890._--Just returned with my two lads after a day
+ spent in London seeing my ship, the "Peshawur". The ship is full.
+ My berth is not in a good place--but it is not bad, after all, and
+ it is not for long.... You'll have lots of need of wisdom, and
+ Jesus is made unto us wisdom as well as other things.... He'll
+ teach you all right. Don't let us refrain for fear we make
+ mistakes. The greatest mistake we could make would be to do
+ nothing....
+
+ 'Everyone is amazed to see me look so well. It is remarked on all
+ round. I feel remarkably well too....
+
+ 'May God be pleased to use me in His service!'
+
+
+His heart was in Mongolia. At the very earliest moment which the medical
+authorities and the Directors of the London Missionary Society would
+sanction he returned. He sailed for China on January 9, 1890. As the
+steamer was running down the English Channel he wrote a letter to an old
+college friend just returning to England whom he had not seen for twenty
+years, and whom he was very sorry to miss:--
+
+ 'In answer to yours of November 19 I directed an envelope to you
+ long ago. It has lain in my writing-case ever since, often seen but
+ always taken precedence of by the thing that stepped in before.
+ Now's your turn. I'm sorry you'll not see me in England. I sailed
+ yesterday My health has been restored, and I am off again.
+
+ 'You say you want reviving--Go direct to Jesus and ask it straight
+ out, and you'll get it straight away. This revived state is not a
+ thing you need to work yourself up into, or need others to help
+ you to rise into, or need to come to England to have operated upon
+ you--Jesus can effect it anywhere, and does effect it everywhere
+ whenever a man or woman, or men and women ask it. Ask and ye shall
+ receive.
+
+ 'My dear brother, I have learned that the source of much blessing
+ is just to go to Jesus and tell Him what you need. I am delighted
+ to hear you say you need blessing, because I know there is plenty
+ and to spare with Jesus. Oh for an outpouring on all parts of the
+ L.M.S. missions!
+
+ 'There is so much that I would like to say that it is hardly worth
+ while beginning to say anything; so I'll simply commend you to
+ Jesus in all His fulness.'
+
+On January 21, 1890, when nearing Port Said, he wrote:--
+
+ 'We have excellent company on board. Never had such a very pleasant
+ voyage. Some of the First Salooners come to our Bible readings.
+ Those who are unfriendly to Christianity are careful to give no
+ cause of offence and are polite. So far our voyage has been an
+ exquisite picnic. Knowing well what is before us, we still rejoice
+ in the present Elim and calmly trust for the future. I went on
+ board with a "tremendous cold." So did two or three others. Mine,
+ as I expected, went with the exposure.... No one teaches like Him
+ who also was the first of preachers. In daily, hourly, humble
+ communication with Him you will want for no wisdom and for no
+ guidance and for no shepherding. Rejoice in that you have Him to
+ manage everything for you.'
+
+He reached Peking on March 14, 1890, and on March 24 started again for
+Mongolia. He entered upon his last spell of work with a good heart and
+with high hopes. Dr. Smith was to be his medical colleague. While in
+England Mr. Gilmour had visited Cheshunt College, and had there fired
+the heart of Mr. Parker with the desire and purpose of being his
+colleague. He was looking forward to his speedy arrival. During his
+absence in England Dr. Smith had paid one brief visit to Mongolia by
+himself, and another, still briefer, in the company of the Rev. T.
+Bryson of Tientsin. Meanwhile the work had been going on slowly and
+steadily under the care of the native helper, Mr. Liu, and of some of
+the converts. We now follow the story of this last year's work as it is
+told in Mr. Gilmour's letters and reports. On May 9, 1890, he wrote to
+the Rev. R. Wardlaw Thompson:--
+
+ 'I have been all over the district, spending a month at Ch'ao Yang.
+ There we were privileged to baptize four adults, one a woman, and
+ one child, all Chinese. Two of these were young men who have been
+ under instruction for eight or nine months, and are very pleasing
+ cases indeed. The other two were a man and his wife, who is the
+ first woman who has had courage to be baptized in this district.
+ These last are an outcome of the medical work. They live in a small
+ hamlet where the first beginning of an interest in Christianity
+ took its rise from a man who came to me in the market-place with a
+ bad sore in his leg, which had been caused by a wound from his own
+ harvest sickle. The sore was cured, and friendly relations sprung
+ up with the whole hamlet, and I am thankful to hear that, though
+ only one family has put away its idols, all the neighbours are
+ friendly.
+
+ 'In Ch'ao Yang there are several inquirers. Some of the Christians
+ give great satisfaction, others are not so satisfactory. One man, a
+ Christian, tells me that his wife was possessed by an evil spirit,
+ and to please her and cure her he had to allow the re-establishment
+ of the worship of that spirit for her benefit. No sooner was this
+ done than the woman was cured! Such things are firmly believed in
+ by the Chinese.
+
+ 'A most pleasing incident in our experience at Ch'ao Yang was a
+ visit from a well-to-do farmer who lives some twenty li from the
+ town. He has been friendly and an inquirer from the first. He has
+ made no profession of Christianity, but says he reads his New
+ Testament regularly, and prays. He has also taught two men in his
+ neighbourhood. The one is a carpenter. The other is a farmer. They
+ know the Catechism, observe the Sunday, and meet with Mr. Feng for
+ worship. Both of these men we saw, and their story seems true. Feng
+ came and spent a day with us. I asked him why he did not make an
+ open profession of Christianity. His reply was that he lives with
+ his parents, as all Chinese do, and that he cannot arrange his
+ house disregarding them, who with his wife and children are still
+ heathen. He has been able only partially to do away with idols in
+ his own house. Outside too of his own house heathen pressure is so
+ great that, he says, were he to join Christianity it would be no
+ use for him to live! He says he lacks the courage single-handed to
+ meet all the persecution that would descend on him were he
+ baptized. Meantime he is instructing those about him in the hope,
+ apparently, that were there several together they could better
+ stand the trouble. It is an interesting case, but not at all
+ satisfactory. My hope about him is that, if he keeps conversant
+ with the Word of God, the Spirit may give him no rest till he has
+ courage to take his stand and make his confession.
+
+ 'We had a splendid month in the market-place. Chinese and Mongols
+ in plenty, both to preach to and to heal. One Mongol betrayed a
+ most intimate and full knowledge of Christianity. The drought gave
+ good opportunity of speaking of many things, and in most cases we
+ had respectful attention. It was a _hard_ month's work. Seven till
+ noon or a little after was our market time; the afternoon private
+ patients, the evening inquirers, makes a very long day, which
+ begins at daylight and does not end till after the second watch of
+ the night has been set. The Chinese usually secure a rest just
+ after noon, but frequently just then some patient would turn up,
+ and put an end to quiet. In most cases the strain is relieved by
+ holidays through rain and storm; but even this was wanting this
+ time, so we had almost uninterrupted work.
+
+ 'I am more than ever eager to have the medical work given over to a
+ medical man. One day in Ch'ao Yang a man came swaggering across the
+ open space in the marketplace. People pointed towards him and
+ laughed. He was laughable, the ridiculous part of him being a straw
+ hat which was an imitation, caricature rather, of a foreigner's
+ hat. I could not help laughing. It was no laughing matter, though.
+ He was a messenger from the cavalry camp just outside the town. He
+ had come to take me to treat two soldiers who had received
+ bullet-wounds in an encounter with Mongolian brigands. I had never
+ seen a bullet-wound in my life, but I knew I could do more for the
+ wounded men than any Chinese doctor; so I went. The wounds were
+ then forty-eight hours old, and I dressed them as best I could,
+ paying a daily visit for about a fortnight. Two wounds, though
+ deep, were merely flesh; with these I had no difficulty. The third
+ was a bone complication. I knew nothing of anatomy, had no books,
+ absolutely nothing to consult; what could I do but pray? And the
+ answer was startling. The third morning, when in the market-place
+ attending to the ordinary patients, but a good deal preoccupied
+ over the bone case, which I had determined should be finally dealt
+ with that day if possible at all, there tottered up to me through
+ the crowd a _live skeleton_, the outline of nearly every bone quite
+ distinct, covered only with yellow skin, which hung about in loose
+ folds. I think I see him yet--the chin as distinctively that of a
+ skeleton as if it had bleached months on the plain. The man was
+ about seventy, wore a pair of trousers, and had a loose garment
+ thrown over his shoulders. He came for cough medicine, I think; if
+ so, he got it; but I was soon engaged fingering and studying the
+ bone I had to see to that afternoon. I was deeply thankful, but
+ amidst all my gratitude the thing seemed so comical that I could
+ not help smiling, and a keen young Chinaman in the crowd remarked,
+ in an under tone, "That smile means something." So it did. It
+ meant, among other things, that I knew what to do with the wounded
+ soldier's damaged bone; and in a short time his wound was in a fair
+ way of healing. I was and am very thankful; but, after all, I am
+ more impressed than ever with the fact that things are badly out of
+ joint when there are lots of Christian doctors at home, and abroad
+ too, and I, knowledgeless, am left to do the doctoring in a large
+ district like this quite beyond the reach of medical help, not only
+ for the natives but even for myself should I need it.
+
+ 'A grim commentary on these wounds was the fact that in leaving
+ Ch'ao Yang I was to pass through a brigand-infested district--so
+ badly infested that travellers have abandoned the road. As saith
+ the Scripture, "The highways were unoccupied, and the travellers
+ walked through byways." I had avoided this road twice, and was
+ ashamed to avoid it again, so we went straight through it. We saw
+ no one to harm us, but a week ago it was just as likely that I
+ should to-day have been lying on a Chinese kang, trying to dress my
+ own wounds, as that I should have been sitting here writing to you.
+
+ 'I am at present waiting for Dr. Smith, whose last word to me,
+ dated Tientsin, April 9, was that I should either see him or hear
+ from him here between June 6 and 12.
+
+ 'Yesterday, Sunday, June 8, had a pleasant day. The three
+ Christians here have grown. Two of them have been through a good
+ deal of trouble and stood it well. The farmer, who has been very
+ ill, guessing we would be here, came in and spent the day with us.
+ They seem very earnest.'
+
+The beneficial result of the home visit of 1889 was very evident at this
+time. It had arrested the 'running down,' from which he had severely
+suffered. It had enabled him to renew old friendships, and to form new
+ones. His wholehearted devotion to the difficult work of his life and
+the wonderful intensity and depth of his faith had touched the hearts of
+many faithful men and women at home, who gladly responded to his
+oft-repeated request, 'Pray for me and for the conversion of the Chinese
+and the Mongols.' He renewed his interest in the broad current of the
+world's life. We have seen how some years previously he gave up all
+reading but the Bible. Now, while he studied the Bible with all his old
+eagerness, he had various newspapers sent to him, he rejoiced in the
+receipt of books sent by friends--especially those bearing upon the
+culture of the soul--and he kept his eye upon the religious and social
+movements of the day.
+
+The selections from his correspondence which follow illustrate these
+changes in him. He modified his mode of life in Mongolia. Having given
+up vegetarianism on his homeward voyage he did not resume it upon his
+re-entrance on Mongol life. He remained a total abstainer, and his
+hatred of opium, whisky, and tobacco continued as strong as ever,
+although he did not now make abstinence from the two latter a test of
+Church membership. He reserved more of the Sunday as a day of rest,
+taking only the religious services with the Christians and inquirers,
+and not, as formerly, setting up his tent on the street. The old
+careworn look disappeared, his form regained much of its former life and
+spring, and his face filled out, his smile resumed the brightness of
+old, and the voice came back to a good deal of its early clearness. All
+these evidences of a change for the better served to augur many years of
+happy work. In a letter to a friend he playfully alludes to the twenty
+or thirty years of labour yet remaining, and he often--half in jest and
+half in earnest--asserted that life in the interior was so healthy that
+he should probably outlive his fellow-workers at Tientsin and Peking.
+
+By the mail that conveyed the letter quoted on page 263 he also wrote to
+an Edinburgh friend:--
+
+ 'Do you know Adolphe Monod's _Farewell_? It was sent to me lately
+ by Rev. C. New, of Hastings, an old Cheshunt fellow-student. I have
+ enjoyed it all, but most, I think, chapter xii., "Of Things not
+ seen." A volume of sermons, entitled _The Baptism of the Spirit,
+ and other Sermons_, by Mr. New, I have enjoyed intensely. To the
+ meek child-like spirit desiring the sincere nourishing of the Word
+ nothing, I think, could be more helpful.... If ever you send a book
+ to the boys, let it be one that will do their souls good.
+
+ 'I may be filling my life too full, but between medical work and
+ spiritual work I have barely time to sleep, and I find that, for
+ any hope of continuance of work, I must have time to sleep. For the
+ last month I have been getting up at 4.30 A.M., and our evening
+ worship and after conversation was not over till, say, 9 or 9.15
+ or 9.30, or even, once or twice, till 10 P.M. Then it would take us
+ some time to square up the day's affairs, and spread out my
+ bedding. In the daytime I used to bolt my door, determined on an
+ hour's quiet; but often this was in vain. I would hear some poor
+ cultivator come for medicine; he had a long way to go home, and I
+ could not but let him in and attend to him.
+
+ 'Yesterday, as no one knew we were here, I escaped at 5.30 and made
+ for the hot springs, twelve miles away. I walked there and back,
+ and in consequence to-day am lame on my feet--badly blistered. I
+ had a grand day--so quiet. Going, I sat down behind a mud wall and
+ read the four first chapters of Hebrews. Arrived, I had my bath,
+ then got an empty room in an inn, had sleep, dinner, tea, and read
+ the rest of Hebrews. I never saw so much in Hebrews before.... On
+ the road I had a four-mile conversation with a farmer, who finally
+ said he believed Christianity was true. We have baptized six in all
+ since I returned, five adults and one child--_all Chinese_. "Be not
+ weary in well-doing. In due time we shall reap, if we faint not."
+ We are on God's side. God has need of us. Oh let us be such as God
+ can take pleasure in! Faithfulness and love to Him are what He
+ wants. Surely we can let Him have these two. Oh that it might be
+ that everyone in every contact with us might feel the spiritual
+ touch! Would not this be ideal Christian life? May He work it in
+ us!
+
+ 'Have you been to any Salvation Army efforts? I always felt better
+ for going, but latterly did not go much--I could not stand the
+ "row." I am eager that you should identify yourself with some
+ soul-saving agency. If it really is a soul-saving concern, I don't
+ think it matters very much what it is.'
+
+On July 21, 1890, he wrote to the same friend:--
+
+ 'Since July 3 we have had most extraordinary weather for this
+ part--rain and dull; there have been only four or five days when I
+ could go on to the street with my tent. I am therefore not so busy.
+ In addition, Dr. Smith has joined me, and as he does all the indoor
+ medical work, I am still less busy, and so I can write you more at
+ leisure than usual.
+
+ 'The rain reached a climax on Saturday night, July 19. Till then,
+ roofs and walls held out well. There were leaks in places, but
+ nothing serious. We thought it had cleared off. Not a bit of it.
+ The wind changed, it is true, but then rain came down in torrents,
+ the ceilings--all reeds and paper--began to give way. Ever and anon
+ splash came a bag of water, as the paper burst in different places,
+ and Dr. Smith and I had a lively time of it shifting our boxes and
+ bedding to dry spots. By dusk it was serious. I was just about my
+ wits' end when a Chinaman put his head into my room, and said with
+ a grin, half in jest, half in earnest, "There is a tent standing
+ idle out in that room, why not put it up in your room?" The idea of
+ putting up a tent in your bedroom seemed so absurd that we had a
+ good laugh over it; but after thinking over it awhile, and thinking
+ out how the thing could be done, we actually did it. It covered
+ two-thirds of my kang, and a little space on the floor where I put
+ my boxes. The inner corner of the tent I put up to cover my stock
+ of books and medicines, lit my lamp, brewed a pot of tea, and,
+ squatting on my feet, called in Dr. Smith. He said I looked "just
+ like an opium-smoker." Dr. Smith had a portable iron bedstead. On
+ the top he put floor mats and a waterproof, and, without
+ undressing, we went to bed. After a little a great crash was heard.
+ Some part of the buildings had come down. In the rain and dark it
+ was not easy to see what it was, but we at last found there had
+ been more noise than real damage. We were thankful when day
+ dawned.
+
+ 'The Chinese suffered much more than we did. Such a rain happens so
+ seldom--once in three or four or five years--that houses are not
+ roofed to resist it; the Chinese deeming it cheaper to take the
+ wetting than to spend the extra money it would take to make the
+ house stand such an extra rain.
+
+ 'In the wet weather I have been going into the Chinese Psalms, and
+ have been much struck with the happy state of those who "fear the
+ Lord," "trust in the Lord," and who, under a variety of
+ expressions, are described as being on the Lord's side, and under
+ His protection.
+
+ 'And all these promises we can take for ourselves. Did you see in
+ _The Christian_ some time ago a story from Annan, of an old woman
+ who was on the point of being sold out for not paying her rent? She
+ had no money. Her son was in America. A neighbour, thinking it
+ strange that her son had not sent her money, asked to see her
+ letters. There was one with a Post-office Order for 7_l._ 10_s._ in
+ it. She had had it for some time, but thought it was only a
+ picture. When cashed she was in funds. Wasn't she a stupid old
+ woman? To be bankrupt, with an uncashed P.O. Order in her
+ possession! How often we are much more stupid than she! To be
+ fearful, anxious, troubled, cast down, when we have all the
+ promises of God in our possession, ready for our use.
+
+ 'Let us cash our cheques. Nay, we have not only God's promises, but
+ God Himself for our portion. Why should we be spiritually bankrupt?
+
+ 'Another thing I notice is the difference subjective states make in
+ reading the Psalms. Sometimes I go over a Psalm and see little in
+ it. At another time I go over the same Psalm and find it full of
+ richness. How important it is to have the light of the Holy Spirit
+ in our Scripture reading!'
+
+ '_July 30._--The little _Wordless Book_ you sent soon fell into the
+ hands of a Chinese convert, who asked to be allowed to carry it
+ off. He wants to speak from it. He likes it because it gives him
+ _carte blanche_, and lets him say just what he likes....
+
+ 'How full the Psalms are! These days I am going through them in
+ Chinese, as I said; I take one each morning and commit some verses
+ of it carefully. Then, during the day, as time permits, I read a
+ few more. How one the soul of man is! When dull and cold and dead,
+ and feeling as if I could not pray, I turn to the Psalms. When most
+ in the spirit, the Psalms meet almost all the needs of expression.
+ And yet deluded men talk of the Bible as the outcome of the Jewish
+ mind! The greatest proof of the Divine source of the book is that
+ it fits the soul as well as a Chubb's key fits the lock it was made
+ for.... Now I am off to the street with my tent.'
+
+
+ 'Mongolia: July 28, 1890.
+
+ 'My dear Meech,--Dr. Smith came here July 2. The rains set in
+ immediately on his arrival, and we _have_ had it since. The
+ spiritual rain has not come yet, nor are there any signs of it.
+ When it does come may it come like the physical rain! Glad to see
+ you have been having some. May you have much more! Make the valley
+ full of ditches, brother, and then look out for the flood. Do you
+ think we'll be able to go up to Him at last and say, "We did our
+ part, but you did not do yours, Lord"? Eh, man! Elijah called down
+ fire with a short prayer, but his servant made six vain journeys to
+ the summit only to return with the discouraging news--nothing. May
+ the good Lord, who knows our frame and remembers we are dust, give
+ us a little now and again, at any rate, if only to keep us going
+ meantime! Eh, man! there will be no lack on His part. He'll shine
+ up all right, not only to perform, but to succour His servants who
+ trust in Him.'
+
+
+ 'July 28, 1890.
+
+ 'My dear Owen,--I know worry should be an unknown element in a
+ believer's experience. I am eager to have done with it. I thank Him
+ for much of its absence. But dissatisfaction with the present state
+ of things is not worry, but legitimate soul-longing, and the death
+ of that would be a bad thing.
+
+ 'I can hardly tell how I am; Since Dr. Smith came I have taken
+ little note of inward things or outward either. It is very pleasant
+ to have him here, and as the best sign of digestion is not to know
+ one has a stomach or a digestion, is the best sign of spiritual
+ health not to know one has a soul at all? I wonder is this so? His
+ presence has made a difference. Duty has kept me living quietly in
+ good lodgings, with only such work as I can easily do without any
+ over-rush, and the prospect of another month like it! I fear I am
+ not such company to him as he is to me.
+
+ 'We have had terrible rains; the rivers were not crossed for five
+ or six days, and, even after that, two men were swept away on two
+ separate days--four men, in all, from this one town alone.
+
+ 'I know you pray for us here. Eh, man! if the thing would move, if
+ the rain would come! "_As the eyes of servants_," etc. (Psalms
+ cxxiii., cxxvi.). I often read these Psalms together. And then I
+ think what would please me best as a master would be to see my
+ servant going ahead, energetically, and faithfully, and loyally
+ with his work, not moping about downcast. Then is not this what God
+ wants in us? So here goes cheerily and trustfully.'
+
+
+ 'August 10, 1890.
+
+ 'I cannot say God gives me all the victories I want, but He keeps
+ me in peace and faith, and that is not a little thing. My
+ devotional reading lately has taken the form of the Chinese Psalms,
+ and Schereschewsky's high Chinese notwithstanding (for which may he
+ be forgiven), they are very refreshing and strong. How like are the
+ heart-longings and soul-breathings of the old Judean hunted
+ outlaw--brigand, if you like to call him so--to the heart and soul
+ feelings of the educated Occidental of the nineteenth century! Poor
+ old Moses, another outlaw, what a battered old life he led, but
+ what a grand soul, and how wonderfully he outlived it all, and was
+ quite hale when called to die! How his people troubled him!--so
+ like the Chinese. Fancy Moses going up the mountain to die alone.
+ It is so nice to have a later glimpse of him in the New Testament
+ alongside of Elijah, who too was once under a cloud. God does not
+ keep up things. "As far as the east is from the west, so far hath
+ He removed our transgressions from us." Love to all.
+
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+ 'Ch'ao Yang, August 19, 1890.
+
+ 'My dear Sons,--I have just got here after a very hard journey of
+ four days. It is summer and the rains are on; the roads are very
+ bad.
+
+ 'Our first adventure was in a deep narrow gully going up a
+ mountain. We met a cart coming down. There was no room to pass and
+ no room to turn back. What were we to do? One of the carts had to
+ be pulled up the bank. Neither would go up. Both carters sat and
+ looked at each other. Our cart was heavy, the other cart was light.
+ After looking at each other awhile the other cart was pulled up and
+ our carter helped him down again after we had passed.
+
+ 'Our next adventure was in a river. The leading mule sank in a
+ quicksand. The carter, shoes and all, jumped into the water; in a
+ few seconds I had stripped all but a cinglet and pants, and was in
+ the river too. We got out after a little while.
+
+ 'Next day we stuck in a quagmire. We hitched the mules to the tail
+ of the cart, pulled it out, then dug a new road in the side of the
+ ravine and got past.
+
+ 'The third day we upset our cart in a very muddy place early in the
+ morning, and got caught in a thunder-shower in the afternoon. The
+ fourth day we stuck in a mud-hole half a mile from the end of our
+ journey, and when we got to our inn found our rooms in possession
+ of a crowd of people doing a wedding.
+
+ 'One thing made the journey very pleasant: it was this. Just as we
+ were starting, one of the Christians, a Chinese farmer, but a man
+ who is poor and dresses and eats very poorly, came and gave me two
+ tiao, about 3_s._ 2_d._, to give to God. I was so glad to see him
+ do it, and no doubt God was glad too. Then at the end of the
+ journey, when we were stuck in the mud-hole and could not get out,
+ up came one of the Christians, took off his stockings and shoes,
+ went into the mud and helped us out. The country was very beautiful
+ all the way--just at its best.'
+
+In a letter to another correspondent he depicts what is involved in
+Chinese travelling during the wet season:--
+
+ 'The last thing we had to do was to make a journey of eighty miles.
+ You would soon do that in England. Here, in August, it is no easy
+ matter. It is just the time when, on account of the rains, no one
+ should travel, and no one does travel who can help it. Carts would
+ not go. I had to find my way home from a cart inn the night before
+ we started along a newly rained-on muddy Chinese street in the
+ dark. Next day I had much brightness shed on the journey by one of
+ the Chinese Christians--a poor man with, oh, so poor a
+ coat--giving a donation to print Christian books. It amounted to
+ about $1.00 (one dollar) in all, but it meant a lot of self-denial
+ to him; and as I passed, a little later, the drought-parched
+ district where he lived, and looked at the poor fields, I wondered
+ where he got the money. I suppose God gave him the heart to give
+ it. Starting a journey with such a bit of light made it cheery.
+
+ 'We travelled at those eighty miles four days, and rested one
+ Sabbath, five days in all. Within three-quarters of a mile of the
+ end of our journey our cart stuck in a mud-hole. We had passed,
+ shortly before, the cottage of a Christian, and, after we had been
+ some half-hour or more in that hole, this Christian suddenly
+ appeared on the scene. He is a great fellow for being neat and
+ clean. In a few moments he was in the mud, ordering about the
+ carter, shouting at the mules, and lifting at the stern of the
+ cart. Even the mules felt there was some new factor added to the
+ problem. They made a new effort and out the cart came. Would you
+ credit it? A cart had been upset there some days before; it was
+ said they had lost some thirty shillings in silver. The natives,
+ hoping to find the money, literally dug up the highway and left a
+ pit there. We did not know this, thought it was an ordinary pool,
+ and drove straight into it. The Christian touch at the beginning of
+ the journey, and the little Christian adventure at the end, made
+ the journey and its remembrance quite pleasant.
+
+ 'I am now reading Moule's _Veni Creator_, which came a few days
+ ago. What helps me most just at present is the Psalms. I take a few
+ verses every morning (almost), and learn off the Chinese
+ translations of them. I never knew there was so much in the Psalms
+ before. I believe that even at the end of a long life, this
+ (discovery of more and more in God's Word) will hold true of all
+ the Bible, and then for the beyond there is the Inexhaustible
+ Himself--satisfaction for the present and plenty for the future.
+
+ 'The endless sorrows and sufferings of this people here come home
+ much to me. I see much of their bodily suffering, and in some
+ feeble measure bear their sorrows and carry their griefs without
+ being able to relieve them much. How dead and dark they are to
+ things spiritual!'
+
+Dr. Smith, who spent some weeks with Mr. Gilmour during this summer, has
+sent the following most interesting sketch of his daily life at this
+period. They were together for the most part at Ta Ss[)u] Kou.
+
+ 'He always got up at daylight, folded up bedding, and then began
+ reading. About six a man arrived, selling hot millet and bean
+ porridge. He bought two bowls of this for early breakfast. He
+ continued reading Chinese, generally aloud; and when he came to a
+ difficult word he repeated it again and again, in order to impress
+ it upon his memory. About eight he had breakfast, consisting of
+ Chinese rolls and a cup of cocoa.
+
+ 'At nine he went to the street with his tent, Mr. Liu, the native
+ preacher, accompanying him. One of the inn-servants assisted the
+ latter in carrying tent and medicine boxes and in erecting same.
+ The tent was erected in a broad street at the back of our inn,
+ where a daily market was held. The medicine boxes were placed on a
+ little table, in front of which stood a wooden form and another at
+ the side. The patients were seated on these. Any difficult cases
+ were sent to the inn to be treated by me. On the table were also a
+ number of copies of various tracts and portions of Scripture. Mr.
+ Gilmour dispensed medicines, talked and preached as the opportunity
+ offered.
+
+ 'About one he returned to the inn, and had dinner, consisting of
+ meat, etc., which was bought at a Chinese cook-shop. About three
+ we generally took a walk to the country. We used to go out to look
+ at the various crops, and Mr. Gilmour would chat away to one and
+ another whom we met on the road. He was generally recognised, and
+ in the most friendly way. I have a very pleasant recollection of
+ these times; often our conversation would turn to home, to our boys
+ and friends. Sometimes he would tell me about his student friends,
+ while at other times he used to tell me of his deputation work at
+ home, and about the various people he had met there.
+
+ 'Often a gentleman would come up and ask, "Where are you going?" to
+ which Mr. Gilmour would reply, "We are cooling ourselves; we are
+ going nowhere." It was always a mystery to people what we could
+ possibly mean by taking walks to the country. One day two lads
+ followed us for some miles across some low hills, anxious to know
+ our business, and getting well laughed at by their friends, poor
+ fellows, on their return to the town.
+
+ 'One thing about Mr. Gilmour always impressed me deeply--his
+ wonderful knowledge of the little touches of Chinese politeness,
+ and his wonderful power of observation. He loved the
+ Chinese--looked upon them and treated them as brothers, and was a
+ man who lived much in prayer; and in this lay his great power as a
+ missionary.
+
+ 'When he met a Mongol he would exchange a few words of Mongol with
+ him, and it was wonderful to see the man's face light up as he
+ heard his own tongue. All the Mongols knew that he could speak
+ their language, and as one of the few who did.
+
+ 'As we returned to the town and were walking along the street, many
+ of the passers-by would bow; and here and there a shopkeeper would
+ give him a friendly bow. Sometimes he would buy a few peaches or
+ apples, and not unfrequently he would give a sweetmeat vendor two
+ cash for two sweets, handing one to me.
+
+ 'About half-past four we returned to the inn, and then, as a rule,
+ some people would be there waiting to see him. Mr. Sun, the
+ box-maker, used often to come to read the Scriptures with Mr.
+ Gilmour, and then they would discuss various points; Mr. Sun giving
+ his opinion, and then Mr. Gilmour putting him right. Sometimes an
+ outsider would drop in, and then, not unfrequently, Mr. Sun would
+ talk to him about the Gospel.
+
+ 'About six Mr. Gilmour had some cocoa and bread. At the time of the
+ lighting of the candles Mr. Gilmour had made it a rule for the
+ Christians to assemble for evening prayers, and, accordingly, they
+ all turned up then. A Chinese table was placed in the centre of Mr.
+ Gilmour's room, and three wooden forms were placed round the table
+ for the accommodation of the preacher and the Christians. Mr.
+ Gilmour and I used to sit on chairs at the vacant side of the
+ table. On the table stood two Chinese candlesticks, each surmounted
+ by a Chinese candle. A Chinese candle is made from the castor bean,
+ and is fixed to the candlestick by running the iron pin on the
+ latter into a hollow straw in the end of the candle. Then we also
+ had a Chinese oil lamp. The upper vessel is simply a little
+ earthenware saucer, containing a little oil, and in it lie some
+ threads of cotton (a cotton wick). This is made to project over the
+ edge of the saucer and is then lighted. The lower part of the lamp
+ is simply an earthenware receptacle, in which the oil for
+ replenishing the lamp is kept, and, while in use, the little lamp
+ is supported in it. This often used to remind me of the parable of
+ the virgins, and in reading that parable by the light of such a
+ lamp one is able to make it very realistic to Chinamen.
+
+ 'Our evening worship consisted in first singing a hymn, Mr. Gilmour
+ leading. Then Mr. Gilmour offered up a short prayer; after which we
+ read a chapter either in the Old or New Testament, reading verse
+ about. Each man had a copy of the Scriptures. Then Mr. Gilmour
+ gave a little address on the chapter; after which we had another
+ prayer--one of the Christians being asked this time. Then another
+ hymn and the benediction.
+
+ 'Usually one or more of the Christians would remain chatting with
+ Mr. Gilmour. As soon as they had gone we had a cup of cocoa
+ together. Then Mr. Gilmour and I used to have evening prayers
+ together. He used to read a chapter from a little book by Mr.
+ Moule, and then we both prayed.
+
+ 'After this we used to sit chatting together until bedtime, and so
+ ended a day.'
+
+In August 1890 Dr. Smith lost his wife, who as Miss Philip had become
+known and beloved by a large number of friends of the London Missionary
+Society, both in Great Britain and Australia. He had also become so ill
+that the ensuing weakness, together with the great shock of his wife's
+sudden loss, compelled him, early in 1891, to return to England on a
+visit. Before doing so he was able to take Mr. Parker, the young and
+active colleague appointed to assist Mr. Gilmour, out to Mongolia,
+reaching Ta Ss[)u] Kou on December 5. Greatly encouraged by the arrival
+of his young helper, Mr. Gilmour was grievously disappointed by the
+enforced return of Dr. Smith, and the indefinite postponement of the
+hospital scheme that was so near to his heart, and upon which he always
+asserted, in his judgment, the ultimate success of the mission depended.
+But discipline of this kind only drove him back more entirely upon God.
+In a letter to Mr. Owen, dated December 29, 1890, he writes:--
+
+ About myself I have lots to be thankful for. I am mostly in the
+ light, sometimes very sweetly. Sometimes, though, it is cold and
+ dark; but I just hold on, and it is all right. Romans viii. I find
+ good reading in dull spiritual weather, and the Psalms too are
+ useful. When I feel I cannot make headway in devotion, I open at
+ the Psalms and push out in my canoe, and let myself be carried
+ along in the stream of devotion which flows through the whole book.
+ The current always sets towards God, and in most places is strong
+ and deep. These old men--eh, man! they beat us hollow, with all our
+ New Testament and all our devotional aids and manuals. And yet I
+ don't know. In the old time there were giants--one here and there.
+ Now there are many nameless but efficient men of only ordinary
+ stature.
+
+ 'Brother, let us be faithful. That is what God wants. What He
+ needs. What He can use. I was greatly struck by one saying of Mrs.
+ Booth's. It will not be so very different there (in heaven) to what
+ it is here. I guess she is right. I guess there will be differences
+ of occupation there as here, and I guess that our life here is a
+ training for life and work there. Oh the mystery! How thin a wall
+ divides it from us! How well the secret has been kept from of old
+ till now! May the richest blessings be on you and yours and your
+ work!
+
+ 'Yours affectionately,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+The year 1891 found Mr. Gilmour hard at work as usual, in good health
+and spirits, and with the hope and apparently the prospect of many years
+of service before him. And yet, just as the summer was beginning, he was
+called to the presence of the King, and to the perfect work and
+fellowship of 'the Church of the firstborn.' Had he been able to choose
+his fate he would hardly have wished it other than it was. His work in
+Mongolia was steadily growing; slowly, it is true, but yet gaining a
+strength and impetus that will abide, and has well begun the conquest of
+Mongolia for Christ. Though practically without a medical colleague, and
+actually without the hospital for which he had so toiled and prayed, he
+was cheered and strengthened by the constant presence and fellowship of
+Mr. Parker. His letters are all in a cheery and buoyant strain, and,
+although referring not unfrequently to the future life, without a hint
+or a suspicion that he was in any degree conscious of the rapid way in
+which the days of his earthly life were running out. In a letter to Mr.
+Thompson, dated January 7, he says, 'You will be glad to hear I am in
+good health and spirits.'
+
+
+To Mr. Owen he wrote on March 2:--
+
+ 'Does God not mean to have a medical man here? I wonder! Wondering,
+ I tell Him as I tell you, and try to leave it with Him, and in very
+ great part _do_ leave it to Him too. It is good to have His calm
+ mercy and help. How's your soul, brother? I'll tell you how mine
+ is--eager to experience more of the Almighty power inworking
+ inside. Eager to be more transformed. Less conformed to the world.
+ Eager to touch God more, and have Him touch me more, so that I can
+ feel His touch.
+
+ 'I am distressed at so few conversions here. But again sometimes
+ very fully satisfied in believing I am trying to do His will. That
+ makes me calm. I am scared at our property venture, but again trust
+ in God, and the fears subside. The world to come, too, sometimes
+ looms up clear as not far distant, and the light that shines from
+ that makes things seem different a good deal.'
+
+From other letters that remain we catch glimpses of the course of his
+action and thought during these last weeks. During the year 1869 he met
+in Edinburgh Mrs. Swan, the widow of one of the pioneers of the Mongol
+Mission of 1817 to 1841, and that interview gave the chief direction to
+the work of his life. In March 1891 he heard of Mrs. Swan's death, and
+he wrote to Miss Cullen, her niece, the following letter:--
+
+ 'I sent you a post-card acknowledging receipt of your kind letter
+ of December 10, saying that Mrs. Swan had passed away on November
+ 22. I had not heard, and just then I had not time to write. I am
+ now at the east end of my district, three days' journey from where
+ the mail reached me.
+
+ 'I am much moved to think that letter to me was her last. And there
+ is a fitness that it should be so. "Baptized for the dead," as the
+ phrase is. In some sense I am successor to her work, and it was not
+ out of keeping that her last letter should have been to the field
+ which all along had such a large place and keen interest in her
+ heart, where so many more good works found a place. I often think
+ of all the kindness and friendship I have experienced at her hands,
+ both on my visits to Edinburgh and through letters. Missionaries
+ miss such lives much when they are removed. I need not speak to
+ you, who knew her so well, of what a charming hostess she made, and
+ of how, even in her old age, all her great and abiding earnestness
+ had running through it all so much happy Scotch humour.
+
+ 'I had no idea Mrs. Swan was so old. Eighty-one, she did not look
+ old except about the last time I saw her, and then I had no idea
+ her age was so great. She has gone; but for many years to come, if
+ I am spared, I shall from time to time revisit her in her house in
+ Edinburgh, and see her at the table with the quiet Jane moving
+ noiselessly around, or see her seated at her desk in the corner,
+ writing letters. Remember me very kindly to your father--fit
+ brother for such a sister. Their separation cannot be very long at
+ the longest. For that matter of it, those of us who are here
+ longest must soon be gone, and when the going comes, or looms
+ before us, let us look not at the going, but at the being _there_.'
+
+Having paid considerable attention to the work and methods of the
+Salvation Army, the publication of _In Darkest England_ interested him
+greatly, and on March 9 he sent in a letter the following trenchant
+criticism, all the more noteworthy because of his strong sympathy with
+much in the Army that others find it hard to accept.
+
+ 'Got here Saturday. Had a good Sunday with the Christians. To-day
+ it snowed, and thus we have had time to put our house in order. I
+ have read Booth's scheme in the _Review of Reviews_. I am greatly
+ puzzled. It is _so_ far a departure from Booth's principle of doing
+ spiritual work only. It reads well, but Booth must know just as
+ well as I do that much of the theory will never work in practice.
+ What I dislike most in it is, it is in spiritual things doing
+ exactly what it attempts to do in secular things--namely, it
+ threatens to swallow up in a great holy syndicate no end of smaller
+ charities which have been and are working efficiently. Again, the
+ finally impenitent are to be cast off. Yes, that is just the rub.
+ It will leave the good-for-nothings, many of them cast out as
+ before. Nor will Booth's despotism do in the long run. But I am for
+ the scheme and for old Booth too; but, nevertheless, there is both
+ a limit and an end to all despotism and despotisms. But I am more
+ favourable to the scheme than these words would seem to indicate.'
+
+Mr. Parker, who bids fair to be a successor after Gilmour's own heart,
+in his first report of his experiences in Mongolia gave a bright and
+hopeful view of his colleague.
+
+ 'On arriving at Ta Ss[)u] Kou we found Gilmour very well indeed;
+ looking better than he did when I saw him in England. He was
+ jubilant over our coming, and it has been a great source of
+ happiness to me to know that God's sending me here has up till now
+ given happiness and comfort to one of His faithful servants. I have
+ had a slight taste of being left alone, and I must confess Gilmour
+ has had something to endure during the last few years.
+
+ 'We are living in hired rooms of an inn. Gilmour is not in this
+ courtyard. I have been alone here with my Chinese boy for the last
+ five weeks (Dr. Smith being in Ch'ao Yang until a few days ago). I
+ have been unable to get a proper teacher at present. Gilmour's
+ student has been teaching me. He speaks distinctly. With him I have
+ made very fair progress. I hope in a few days to secure a proper
+ teacher.
+
+ 'Another thing which has taught me a good amount of the Chinese I
+ know is having to give orders to my Chinese boy in house-keeping
+ generally. I am thankful to God for past experiences in my life,
+ though they were rather rough; for here I find they come in very
+ usefully. I had to teach my boy how to cook and do things
+ generally. It was rather an amusing piece of work, seeing that I
+ knew nothing of the language. Each order I gave him was a comedy in
+ two or three acts, all played out in dumb show. In telling him what
+ I wished purchased I was obliged to imitate sounds which are
+ peculiar to certain beasts and birds, which when he understood, he
+ announced that fact by opening wide his eyes and emitting a loud
+ "Ah!" which was generally followed by the name of the thing
+ indicated bellowed forth at the top of his voice as if I were
+ deaf. Also he in turn, when he had anything to tell me, always
+ stood in the centre of the room and went through a whole
+ performance. On one occasion, when he wished to tell me that a
+ certain dog had stolen the day's meat, the performance was so
+ amusing that, when he had got through, I asked him what he was
+ trying to say, in order that I might once more see the fun.
+
+ 'Forgive me for taking up your time with such frivolous things. But
+ I have picked up much of the language in that way, although at the
+ cost of being grimed with soot and burning my fingers. All that is
+ now past, and the boy is very useful, and, although now a heathen,
+ I am hoping that by my influence he may be led to know the love of
+ Jesus Christ. I am very glad that I came straight out here. I am
+ sure I shall learn the language (of the _people_, perhaps _not_ of
+ the _books_) better than in the frontier cities. I am constantly
+ forced to try and speak. Every day I have some visitors here whom I
+ must try and entertain. I feel stupid at times with them, and
+ perhaps they think I am; but, nevertheless, each day's experience
+ is adding to my vocabulary. And when so learnt, I know that people
+ will understand me when I speak.
+
+ 'Gilmour is doing a valuable work. Every day he goes to the street
+ and sets out his table with his boxes of medicines and books. He
+ has three narrow benches, on one of which he sits, the other two
+ being for his patients. Of the latter he has any amount, coming
+ with all the ills to which humanity is heir. It is a busy street,
+ not of the best repute, for it is where all the traders in
+ second-hand clothes and dealers in marine stores spread out their
+ wares.
+
+ 'For some weeks I went out at a certain hour to take care of
+ Gilmour's stand while he went and got a "refresher" in the shape of
+ some indigestible pudding made of millet-flour with beans for
+ plums. He generally left me with a patient or two requiring some
+ lotion in the eye or some wound to dress. Then I, being a
+ new-comer and a typical "foreign devil" (being red of hair and in
+ complexion), always brought a large following down the street with
+ me, and attracted a great crowd round the stand. At first it was
+ not pleasant to sit there and be stared at without being able to
+ speak to them; but after a while I got very interested in the
+ different faces that came round. On one occasion I noticed the
+ crowd eagerly discussing something among themselves, giving me a
+ scrutinising look now and then. Now and again one would turn to his
+ fellow and rub his finger across his upper lip as if he was feeling
+ for his moustache. I had only been here a week or so then, and knew
+ very little of the language; but I listened attentively, and at
+ last I heard them speaking the Chinese numerals, and then it all
+ dawned upon me that they were inquiring about and discussing my
+ age; so I up with my fingers indicating the years of my pilgrimage.
+ I never saw a crowd so amused. "Ah, ah!" they said, and opened
+ their eyes, highly delighted that I was able to tell them what they
+ wanted to know. Then I had my turn, and, pointing to a man here and
+ there in the crowd, I used what little of Chinese I had in guessing
+ their ages.
+
+ 'But the sights of misery, suffering, and wretchedness which gather
+ round Gilmour's stand are simply appalling. His work seems to me to
+ come nearest to Christ's own way of blessing men. Healing them of
+ their wounds, giving comfort in sickness, and at the same time
+ telling them the gospel of Eternal Salvation through Jesus Christ.
+ One day that I went I found Gilmour tying a bandage on a poor
+ beggar's knee. The beggar was a boy about sixteen years of age,
+ entirely naked, with the exception of a piece of sacking for a loin
+ cloth. He had been creeping about, almost frozen with cold, and a
+ dog (who, no doubt, thought he was simply an animated bone) had
+ attacked him.
+
+ 'The people here are desperately poor, and the misery and
+ suffering one sees crawling through the streets every day is
+ heart-rending. I have not a doubt that I am in a real mission
+ field, and thank God that He has given me the opportunity to do
+ something towards alleviating some of this misery. But what about
+ the work as regards the saving of souls and establishing of a
+ Church? I can only speak of the work in Ta Ss[)u] Kou. It is in its
+ initiatory stage. All the Christians and adherents can sit round
+ the four sides of my table. But I am highly pleased with them.'
+
+The letters of this period have a very tender and sacred association for
+all who received them, since they reached England after the telegraphic
+tidings of James Gilmour's death had brought sorrow to his many friends.
+They came, in a sense, like a message from one 'within the veil.' Some
+of these refer to the books he was reading, and from which he had
+derived benefit; some depict phases of his experience; some bear
+directly upon his work and its needs; all possess the solemn value and
+are read in the clearer light imparted to them by Death.
+
+The first was written to one of his brothers.
+
+ 'Do you know _In the Volume of the Book_, by Dr. Pentecost? It is A
+ 1. I have just read it. It is not a dear book. Read it, man, by all
+ means. It gives zest to the old Bible. I am reading through the New
+ Testament at about the rate of a gospel a day, or two epistles.
+ Rapid reading has advantages. Close study of minute portions has
+ other advantages. All sorts of reading are valuable. Go for your
+ Bible, brother. There is no end more in it than ever you or I have
+ yet seen. I am going for it both in Chinese and English, and it
+ pays as nothing else does. In Jesus is all _fulness_. Supply
+ yourself from Him. May the richest blessings be on you from Him!
+ Heaven's ahead, brother. Hurrah!'
+
+The next was to the Edinburgh correspondent from whose letters we have
+previously taken extracts.
+
+ 'This mail was sent off February 2. It came back the same day. The
+ man was scared by robbers. He leaves to-morrow. We are well. We are
+ _idle_. Would you believe it? It is Chinese New Year time, and I
+ cannot go on the street with my stand. No people: soon will be. We
+ are thankful for the rest. It won't last long.... Oh, it is good to
+ have Jesus to tell all to. May He be more of an intimate friend to
+ you and to me! The troubles of this earthly life are not few. How
+ many were Paul's! I am reading Farrar's _Life and Work of Paul_. It
+ puts much new light on the epistles. What a time the man Paul had
+ of it! Yet he called them "light afflictions." How much lighter are
+ ours! And the same heaven he looked to is for us--the same
+ crown--not to him only, but to all who love the appearing of
+ Christ. You love Him. Rejoice and be glad. I _am_ so glad that the
+ crown is not only for such as Paul, whom we cannot hope to imitate,
+ but for those (ii. Timothy iv. 8) who have loved His appearing. We
+ _do_ that, don't we? May the joy set before us enable us to endure,
+ when endurance is needed! May your heart rest in Him! May your soul
+ cling to Him! May His light always shine on your path! May I
+ always, even in dark days and dark times, have His light in my
+ heart and soul! Don't regard me as one always on the sunny heights,
+ but as one often cast down, often in much feebleness, in much
+ unworthiness, and falling so far short of my own ideal. But it is
+ good to think that, in Christ, we are perfect, that He makes up
+ all.
+
+ 'Parker and I read _Holy of Holies_, when together. It is a good
+ book. Meantime, he and I are three days' journey separate, and may
+ be so for a month to come yet. I hope he likes it. It is a little
+ hard on him, but I had to come here on mission business, and, if
+ needed, will return to him at any time. Looking again at Heb. vi.
+ 4-6.'
+
+His correspondent had asked him about this passage.
+
+ 'It is said--it is impossible to "renew them again to repentance."
+ Does it not seem clear that what is described cannot be the case of
+ one who has the repentant heart? I think so decidedly, and that
+ passage has no bearing on the sinner who repents.... No one will
+ come to harm who commits himself to His keeping. And no one will
+ lack leading who has God for his guide. If I could only hear of or
+ from the friends I pray for, that they had given themselves over to
+ God's keeping, I would be at rest and thankful. You are trusting in
+ Him. You will not be ashamed. He will take care to supply every
+ needed blessing at the right time and in the right way.
+
+ 'Some day, I believe we shall stand in Eternity and look back on
+ Time. How ashamed we then shall be of any want of trust and of any
+ unfaithfulness! May He help us to look at things now in _that_
+ light, and how to do as we then shall wish we had done!...
+
+ 'I would be glad if you would send me half a dozen copies of the
+ _Wordless Book_. Two copies fell into the hands of robbers and were
+ thus lost....
+
+ 'I shall be glad to have the _Life of Faith_. You might mark any
+ passages that strike you.'
+
+In a letter to the Rev. J. Paterson, dated April 1, he writes:--
+
+ 'It helps me much out here to get the best consecrated literature,
+ and to get it early. Men in the most difficult and dangerous fields
+ should be the best armed and equipped. Some of these books open up
+ new treasures to me in God's Word. I do not use them in place of
+ God's Word, but as openers to the treasures.'
+
+In almost the last letter from him received by his brother Alexander and
+dated April 24, 1891, the following passage occurs:--
+
+ '_The Practice of the Presence of God_, being conversations and
+ letters of Brother Lawrence. Please send a copy to yourself, John,
+ Matthew, Paterson, Miss Gowan, and ten copies to me, charging all
+ costs to me, of course. It is by a Roman Catholic: don't imitate
+ his Roman Catholicism, but his practice of the presence of God.'
+
+In April Mr. Gilmour journeyed to Tientsin, and was unanimously elected
+to preside over the annual meeting of the North China District Committee
+of the London Missionary Society as chairman. His last communication to
+the home Society, with the exception of one brief note upon a matter of
+committee business, was a post-card, dated April 20, 1891, received in
+London some weeks after the tidings of his death. It runs:--
+
+ 'Arrived here yesterday. The world keeps shrinking. Left Ta Ss[)u]
+ Kou Monday 8 A.M. Tuesday noon dined in a border Mongol village, in
+ a Mongol's inn, served by a Mongol waiter, in presence of a number
+ of Mongols. Got to London Missionary Society's Compound, Tientsin,
+ Saturday, 5 P.M. Our headquarters are just five days from the
+ extended railway. Am in A 1 health, everybody says so here, and
+ that truly. Meantime am in clover, physically and spiritually. With
+ prayers for the home end of the London Missionary Society's work.
+
+ 'Yours truly,
+ 'J. GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Just thirty-one days later he was lying dead in the same compound. How
+the interval passed is told by those who enjoyed those closing days of
+lofty spiritual fellowship. Had it been foreseen that the end was so
+near, the fervour and impressiveness and help of his presence could
+hardly have been increased. Before, however, passing to the details of
+this last month, the following letters are given _in extenso_ as they
+form the last lengthy sketches of his work drawn by his own hand.
+
+
+ 'Tientsin, L.M.S.: April 20, 1891.
+
+ My dear Mrs. Lovett,--I guess you are at the bottom of 10_l._ from
+ Clapham Congregational Church Working Society (Ladies). Ar'n't you?
+ If so, thanks. If not--I was going to say you ought to be--but my
+ courage fails me. Anyhow, you can read and please forward the
+ enclosed with my best thanks to the friends. I got here two days
+ ago, and am here for a short time. The railway has gone out
+ eastwards, is still going, and has now a station near me in
+ Mongolia--near me being five long days' journey; but that is near,
+ as near and far go here.
+
+ 'I have many grateful and many prayerful remembrances of England
+ and English friends, and a vivid remembrance of your kindness when
+ I was with you. My regards to your parents. I hope you and your
+ husband and children are all well. I heard of Mr. Lovett being in
+ America--_American Pictures_ on the stocks?
+
+ 'I had intended to write you a nice letter, but it won't come, and
+ the letter must go as it is. Please read into the remaining blank
+ sheet all the feelings and good wishes I should express and do
+ feel, and next time I write you, may it not be in the ebb tide, at
+ the end of a mail.
+
+ 'Your husband's a Director. I _do_ hope they are sending me a
+ doctor. If he can do anything in the matter, I wish he would.
+
+ 'Yours, dried up and feeling dumb,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+Enclosed in the above was the following letter, dated March 10, and
+addressed to 'The Clapham Congregational Church Ladies' Working
+Society.'
+
+ 'Dear Friends,--Many thanks for your handsome donation (10_l._),
+ notice of which has reached me last night. I am told you want to
+ hear from me. All right. I am just back from a month's raid into
+ Ch'ao Yang. Had a fine time. Good weather and plenty of work in the
+ marketplace. Baptized four adults, three being women--all Chinese.
+ It is the day of small things truly, but I am not a little
+ encouraged, over the women especially. That now makes four
+ Christian families in Ch'ao Yang or its immediate neighbourhood.
+ The two wives baptized this time have Christian husbands. It has
+ all along been our prayer that the unsaved relatives of the saved
+ might be saved.
+
+ 'Mrs. Chu's husband was baptized a couple of years ago. She
+ consented to his taking their two children to me to be baptized,
+ but she herself would have nothing to do with Christianity or
+ Christ. This time she got over her difficulties. I was much
+ pleased, especially as she had annoyed her husband a good deal last
+ year about his having been beaten about his Christianity. She also
+ had her little child baptized. Pray that God may keep and help them
+ in all the many complications that will arise on account of their
+ Christianity, living as they do in a composite family, the ruling
+ powers of which are heathen.
+
+ 'Mrs. Ning is a model wife. They are poor. Her husband cannot dress
+ in good clothes, but is always as neat as a virtuous wife, skilful
+ with her needle, can make him. She mends so neatly. I once
+ discarded a vest (Chinese) and gave it to her husband. He took it
+ home, and later on I saw him swelling about in it quite like a neat
+ old gentleman, though I was almost ashamed to give it him.
+
+ 'They have had family worship in their home for a year or two--they
+ say. We went to baptize her. It was such a small, poor house, but
+ so very nice inside. Mother and grown daughters and little girl,
+ with father and grown son, all sleep on a little brick platform,
+ hardly big enough for me--one man. She and the grown daughter
+ support the family by needlework--making horsehair women's head
+ fittings, which the father sells, when he has nothing more to do.
+
+ 'The son is epileptic and can earn nothing, and is, in addition, a
+ great eater. He is a good man and a Christian. As we entered, the
+ son and daughter went out. The mother and little daughter were
+ baptized. The father did not wish his big daughter baptized. When
+ she is married she will get a heathen mother-in-law, who will go
+ for her and make her worship idols. So said the father. In a few
+ days the father came back, saying that out of fear of the coming
+ mother-in-law he had not had his daughter baptized, but that his
+ daughter had pressed him so hard that she was as formidable as the
+ mother-in-law. The daughter says she'll stick to her God and let
+ them stick to theirs, and so she was baptized. She has a hot time
+ before her. Chinese mothers-in-law are no joke. Pray for the lassie
+ that:--(_a_) she may be steadfast; (_b_) she may be wise; (_c_) she
+ may be gentle in her resistance; (_d_) enabled by God to endure;
+ and that the mother-in-law may be restrained. God can do all
+ things.
+
+ 'Here, in Ta Ss[)u] Kou, two of the Christians have wives very
+ much opposed to Christianity, and give their husbands hot times.
+ Remember the husbands, please, and all such in their shoes, in
+ prayer, and may the darkened women themselves be enlightened. You
+ have no notion how deeply sunk in superstition the women are. Still
+ another Christian has a wife whom he has to allow to worship a
+ weasel, because the woman shows symptoms of being possessed by the
+ beast if she does not worship it!
+
+ 'The other day a woman came to my stand in the market-place, saying
+ that "Mr. Yellow" troubled her. "Mr. Yellow" turned out to be the
+ weasel, and she firmly believed her sickness was due to the beast.
+
+ 'We are badly in want of a lady medical man in this district. Don't
+ you know of one who would do? Are there none of you who could study
+ medicine and go out as doctors to some of the many needy places?
+ Much was hoped for this district from the late Mrs. Smith, but God
+ took her. Any one who comes here should have good health, and not
+ fear seclusion from foreign company. I would suggest that a couple
+ should come, a medical and a non-medical. There is a house which
+ could be got for such a couple, only I don't see how they could get
+ on without knowing some Chinese. Perhaps some one of the Peking or
+ Tientsin ladies already speaking Chinese would volunteer to be a
+ medical lady's companion. Would that God would stir some of you up!
+ Meantime, thanks for the money. Thanks also for the prayers which I
+ take for granted you let us have. You might also pray for a woman
+ who has a very good, quiet, Christian husband, but herself has such
+ a temper that she cannot in decency take on a Christian profession.
+ Eh, man! eh, man! it is curious that I, a widower, should be left
+ to look after women's souls out here, when lots of women are
+ competing for men's situations and businesses at home. I guess
+ things will come right some day, though I may or may not see it.
+
+ 'Very gratefully,
+ 'Yours sincerely,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+On May 8 he sent the following note to Mrs. Williams, the wife of the
+Rev. Mark Williams of the American Board. Their Society happened to be
+holding its annual meeting at the same time in Tientsin as the London
+Society. Mr. Gilmour was just entering his fatal illness as he penned
+these lines, the last, we believe, that he wrote. They are a beautiful
+testimony to the strength of his affection for the Mongols to whom he
+and his wife had ministered so well long before, and on whose behalf
+they had suffered so much and so deeply. Standing as he was on the
+borderland of the heavenly country, he recalls the hard toil of his
+early days, and he leaves to those who must carry on to a successful
+issue, not only his work, but also the great enterprise of winning all
+China for Jesus Christ, this as a last legacy--the fruit of his prayer,
+his faith, his toil and his utter self-sacrifice--namely, the conviction
+that the need of China is 'good, honest, quiet, earnest, persistent work
+in old lines and ways.'
+
+
+ 'Tientsin: May 8, Friday.
+
+ 'My dear Mrs. Williams,--Thanks for returning the photos. Not
+ having delivered them to you personally, I feared that in the
+ present whirl of people and business they might have been mislaid,
+ or even not reached you.
+
+ 'It is a great pleasure to see you here at this time. Many memories
+ of past times and days come up. Though never again likely to see
+ Kalgan, I often in thought go along its narrow, hard streets, and
+ its up and down sideways, call in at your house, see all your
+ faces, even that of the youthful Stephen, and the studious Etta;
+ and often go up over the Pass into the grass land.
+
+ 'It is like a rest for a little while beside the palms and wells of
+ Elim to meet you all here.
+
+ 'Your peaceful, happy family fills me with gratitude to God. May He
+ bless them all (your children), and lead them not only into paths
+ of peace and pleasantness, but of useful service for Him! You and
+ your husband seem well. May many useful years of ripely experienced
+ labour be yours!
+
+ 'Lately, I am being more and more impressed with the idea that what
+ is wanted in China is not new "lightning" methods so much as good,
+ honest, quiet, earnest, persistent work in old lines and ways.
+
+ 'With many grateful memories of all old-time Kalgan kindness, and
+ hoping to see a note from you, or Mr. Williams, say once a year or
+ so, and with prayers for you and all Kalgan-wards Mongols,
+
+ 'Yours, cheered by the vision of you all,
+ 'JAMES GILMOUR.'
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+THE LAST DAYS
+
+
+At Tientsin James Gilmour was the guest of Dr. Roberts--for too brief a
+time his colleague in Mongolia--and the doctor's sister, who kept house
+for him. The story of the closing days cannot be better told than in
+their words. To Miss Roberts fell the sorrowful task of sending the news
+of their irreparable bereavement to the two motherless lads in England.
+
+
+ 'Tientsin: June 6, 1891.
+
+ 'My dear Willie and Jimmie,--You will wonder who I am that call you
+ by your names and yet have never known you.
+
+ 'But I think, when you hear that your dear father spent the last
+ five weeks of his life with my brother, Dr. Roberts, and myself,
+ perhaps you will not be sorry to get a few lines from an unknown
+ friend. It is now many weeks since we received a letter from Mr.
+ Gilmour saying he hoped to be able to attend the annual meetings in
+ Tientsin, and who would take him in? My brother replied at once,
+ saying what a real pleasure it would be if he would stay with us.
+ And so he came, and about a fortnight before the time, of which we
+ were all the more glad. He looked the very picture of health on his
+ arrival, and was in excellent spirits; many remarked how very well
+ and strong he looked.
+
+ 'I remember well the day he arrived, it was a Saturday afternoon.
+ I suggested that he should have some dinner at once, but,
+ thoughtful-like, as your father always was, he said, "No, thank
+ you, I have already had all I want; I shall not require anything
+ more till your next ordinary meal."
+
+ 'By-and-by we showed him his room, "whose windows opened to the
+ sun-rising." We had made it as pretty and comfortable as we could,
+ and brightened it with freshly cut flowers. The next day I noticed
+ he had taken the tablecloth off his writing-table, and in the
+ evening he handed it to me, saying, if I remember rightly, "Here,
+ mademoiselle, is your tablecloth. I am afraid of inking it. You had
+ better put it away." I was grieved, and begged he would use, and
+ ink it, too, for the matter of that; but it was no use, not on any
+ account would he spoil my cloth, and therefore would not use it.
+
+ 'He seemed very happy with us, and I think thoroughly appreciated
+ the homelikeness of his surroundings after his lonely life in
+ Mongolia, and the dismal rooms of a Chinese inn, and it was such a
+ pleasure to minister to his comforts in every possible way we could
+ think of.
+
+ 'He used to spend his days, as a rule, in the following way:--
+
+ 'After breakfast he would write letters. At 10.45, after a cup of
+ cocoa, he would go over to the hospital, returning at 1 o'clock to
+ dinner. This over, he would go back with my brother to see the
+ in-patients. At 4.30 we would all have tea together, after which he
+ would make calls, or go for a walk, or talk over committee matters
+ with Mr. Lees or Mr. Bryson. Many evenings he would be invited out,
+ or would be at a meeting, or would spend it quietly at home; and so
+ the time went by till meetings began. Then the whole day till 4
+ P.M. was spent in committee, and at six Mr. Gilmour had a
+ Bible-class for an hour with the Chinese preachers who had come to
+ attend some of the meetings.
+
+ 'These were nearly over when your father began to complain of
+ feeling done up and of having fever. The following Sunday he was in
+ bed. This was only eleven days before he died. On Monday, however,
+ he was better. and up, and was able to be with us all day, and took
+ the Communion with us all in the evening. Then we chatted together
+ for some time and sang hymns, amongst others, "God be with you till
+ we meet again!" No. 494 in Sankey's _Songs and Solos_.
+
+ 'In this connection let me tell you some of Mr. Gilmour's favourite
+ hymns in the book just mentioned. Amongst these were Nos. 494, 535,
+ 150, 328. I dare say you would like to learn them and sing them for
+ his sake.
+
+ 'Your dear father was only in bed ten days before the end came, and
+ all this time he spoke but little. He was too feverish and ill to
+ want to talk or to listen: he just lay quietly, bearing his
+ sickness with remarkable patience. One day, observing he was a
+ little restless, I went to his bedside and asked him if he wanted
+ anything. "No, nothing," was his reply, "only that the Lord would
+ deliver me out of this distress."
+
+ 'The last few days his mind was not clear, but all his wanderings
+ were about his work. It was the last day but one of his life; he
+ was more restless than usual, trying all the time to rouse himself,
+ as if for a journey, when he looked up and said, "Where are we
+ going?"
+
+ '"To heaven," I answered, "to see the Lord."
+
+ '"No," he replied, "that is not the address."
+
+ '"Yes it is, Mr. Gilmour," I said again. "We are going to heaven;
+ would you not like to go and see the Lord Jesus?"
+
+ 'Then he seemed to take in the meaning of my words, and reverently
+ bowed his head in assent, his lips quivered, and his eyes filled
+ with tears; and he was quieted, like a weary child who has lost his
+ way and finds on inquiry that only a few more steps and he will be
+ at rest and at home.
+
+ 'The next day, his last, was still more restless. At one time he
+ seemed to be addressing an audience and earnestly gesticulating
+ with his hands; and, with as much force as he could command, he
+ said: "We are not spending the time as we should; we ought to be
+ waiting on God in prayer for blessing on the work He has given us
+ to do. I would like to make a rattling speech--but I cannot--I am
+ very ill--and can only say these few words." And then he nodded his
+ head and waved his hand, as if in farewell to his listeners.
+
+ 'It was seven o'clock in the evening when my brother saw the end
+ was not far off, and at once we sent for all the other members of
+ the Mission that all might watch with him in this last solemn hour.
+ He was unconscious the whole time, and his breathing laboured.
+
+ 'The two doctors battled for an hour and a half to keep off Death's
+ fatal grasp, but to no purpose: the Lord wanted His faithful
+ worker, and we could not keep him, though we wanted him much, and
+ knew that Willie and Jimmie in England needed him more.
+
+ 'Gradually the breathing became quieter and quieter, till at last,
+ about 9.30, he just closed his eyes and "fell asleep," with the
+ peace of Heaven resting on his face.'
+
+In a letter sent by Dr. Roberts to Dr. Smith, who was then in England, a
+few further particulars are given.
+
+ 'He preached one Sunday evening a very solemn sermon on "Examine
+ yourself," and no one can soon forget the way he preached. During
+ the annual meetings he was extra busy. Everyone remarked what a
+ good chairman he made, and in the devotional meetings from 9 to
+ 9.30 A.M. he was always ready to lead in prayer or speak a few
+ words. Freshness, to the point, and to the heart--characterised all
+ he did or said. In the evenings he conducted services for the
+ native preachers present at the annual gathering, and to these
+ meetings he took one foreigner each night to assist in the
+ speaking.
+
+ 'It was at the close of this busy week, when tired out, that he got
+ the fever which eventually carried him home. The fever was very
+ irregular in type, but after some days I felt it was an exceptional
+ type of typhus fever. Great weakness of the heart was a
+ characteristic feature all through his case, and but for this sad
+ complication I believe he would have been alive to-day. Weak action
+ of the heart was an old enemy of his. For the first week of his
+ illness he did not feel very poorly, and we had many chats
+ together, and some prayer and reading of God's Word every night
+ nearly. But in the second week his temperature went up to 106 deg.,
+ and, though it came down under anti-pyretics, he seemed never to
+ regain his former ground. His mind became more and more clouded.
+ Parker took the night nursing, my sister the day, and I sat with
+ him when time allowed. On Thursday, May 21, the day on which he
+ died, he was very delirious all day, though he knew us all. I did
+ not give up hope till 7 P.M., when his heart failed him in spite of
+ active stimulation. It was then that we all gathered round his bed.
+ I did my utmost with the help of Frazer to avert the sad end; but
+ ere long, seeing our efforts were vain, we ceased, and sat in his
+ room and saw him gradually and very peacefully pass away, his
+ breath getting feebler and feebler till he closed his eyes and fell
+ asleep in Jesus.'
+
+The funeral took place towards evening on May 23, 1891. It was a lovely
+afternoon, and the sun shining brightly lent additional force to the
+words of John Bunyan which were printed upon the simple sheet containing
+the hymn to be sung at the grave: 'The pilgrim they laid in an upper
+chamber whose window opened towards the Sun-rising.' The coffin was
+borne to the grave by two relays of bearers; the first consisted of
+three European and three native preachers; the second, on the one side,
+of the Rev. S. E. Meech, his brother-in-law; the Rev. J. Parker, his
+colleague, and Dr. Roberts; and on the other Liu, his faithful Chinese
+preacher and helper, Chang, the tutor of the theological class at
+Tientsin, and Hsi, his courier, a native of Ta Ss[)u] Kou. His last
+resting-place immediately adjoins that of his dearly loved friend, Dr.
+Mackenzie, and the service at the grave was conducted by the Rev.
+Jonathan Lees and the Rev. J. Parker. Chang offered prayer, and a
+farewell hymn was sung.
+
+ Sleep on, beloved, sleep, and take thy rest;
+ Lay down thy head upon thy Saviour's breast;
+ We love thee well; but Jesus loves thee best--
+ Good night! Good night! Good night!
+
+ Until the shadows from this earth are cast;
+ Until He gathers in His sheaves at last;
+ Until the twilight gloom be overpast--
+ Good night! Good night! Good night!
+
+ Until we meet again before His throne,
+ Clothed in the spotless robe He gives His own,
+ Until we know even as we are known--
+ Good night! Good night! Good night!
+
+Little Chinese boys who had known and loved Mr. Gilmour came forward and
+threw handfuls of flowers into his grave, loving hands laid upon the
+coffin a wreath of white blossoms on behalf of the now orphaned boys
+far away, and the simple but beautiful service was closed by a
+spontaneous act on the part of the Chinese converts present. Pressing
+near the grave of him whose heart loved China and the Chinese with a
+fervour and an enthusiasm that may have been equalled, but certainly
+have never been surpassed, they sang in their own tongue the hymn
+beginning, 'In the Christian's home in glory.'
+
+The labourer had entered into the rest he had so often seen by the eye
+of faith. 'There remains,' he wrote, less than a year before his death,
+'a rest. Somewhere ahead. Not very far at the longest. Perfect, quiet,
+full, without solitude, isolation, or inability to accomplish; when the
+days of our youth will be more than restored to us; where, should
+mysteries remain, there will be no torment in them. And the reunions
+there! Continuous too, with no feeling that the rest of to-day is
+to-morrow to be ended by a plunge again into a world seething with
+iniquity, and groaning with suffering.'
+
+Many pages might be filled with loving eulogies of James Gilmour. But
+the best of all is the simple story of his life. Yet two or three
+references to his work and influence must here find a place.
+
+From the pen of Dr. Reynolds comes this weighty testimony:--
+
+ 'The end of his career came all too suddenly, and in gathering
+ together my impressions of it as a whole, I am convinced that I
+ have seldom seen a man so entirely possessed by a grand idea, so
+ utterly persuaded that we had a debt to pay to the heathen world,
+ so invincibly sure that Christian faith and life was the one
+ supreme need of these regions beyond our circle of light. Few men
+ have cast the bread upon greater waters, have sown the seed over a
+ wider area, or had to mourn more sadly over those heart-breaking
+ months which intervene between the seedtime and the harvest.
+ Impartial critics have recognised the intense honesty, the shrewd
+ wit, the faculty of vision, the power to tell the story of his rare
+ experiences with such verisimilitude as to force upon the reader a
+ ready acquiescence in every detail of his narrative. But his
+ Christian brethren saw a deeper vein than this in Gilmour's
+ achievements. He was ablaze from first to last with a passionate
+ desire to set forth Christ in His majesty and mercy, in all His
+ power to heal and to command. I had unexpected opportunities of
+ finding how tender and affectionate his nature was; how grateful
+ and enthusiastic his love to his Hamilton home, to his father,
+ mother, and wife, and how faithful and loyal he was to the society
+ and the brotherhood of his Alma Mater.'
+
+The Rev. G. Owen, at a memorial service held in Peking very shortly
+after Mr. Gilmour's death, gave a sketch of his character and work, and
+thus summed up his life:--
+
+ 'He spared himself in nothing, but gave himself wholly to God. He
+ kept nothing back. All was laid upon the altar. I doubt if even St.
+ Paul endured more for Christ than did James Gilmour. I doubt, too,
+ if Christ ever received from human hands or human heart more
+ loving, devoted service.
+
+ 'If anyone asks, "Would it not have been better if Mr. Gilmour had
+ taken more care of himself and lived longer?" I would answer: "I
+ don't know. His life was beautiful, and I would not alter it if I
+ could. A few years of such service as he gave Christ are worth a
+ hundred years of humdrum toil. We need the inspiration of such a
+ life as his. Heaven, too, is the richer for such a man and such a
+ life. The pearly gates opened wide, I have no doubt, to receive
+ him. Angels and men gave him glad welcome, and what a smile would
+ light up the Saviour's face as He received His faithful servant
+ home!"
+
+ 'And he being dead yet speaketh. He says, "Be faithful, work hard,
+ for the night cometh when no man can work. Be earnest, for life is
+ brief; be ready, for life is uncertain." But why did God call him
+ away in the midst of life and work? I don't know. Possibly work
+ here is not of such importance as we think. Or there is more
+ important service elsewhere waiting for such men as Mr. Gilmour. He
+ has been faithful over a few things; he has been made ruler over
+ many things, and has entered into the joy of his Lord.'
+
+Mr. Parker wrote to the sons of his late colleague on June 6, 1891:--
+
+ 'It is sad that my first letter to you should be to tell you about
+ your father's death, of which no doubt you have heard long ago....
+ The last photographs of yourselves which you sent out he always had
+ where he could see them. Whenever he travelled he took them with
+ him. At Tientsin during his last illness he had them on a low side
+ table, just on a level with his bed, so that as he lay there he
+ could see them.... He was very happy, and died like a faithful
+ soldier who had finished his work. It is sad, dear boys, to lose a
+ father such as he was, but it is a great blessing to have had such
+ a father, one so brave, so courageous, one who for the sake of
+ Christ suffered bodily discomfort and pain, suffered terrible
+ loneliness that he might win some of God's sinning children back
+ to their Father's arms. He lived and suffered for the Mongols, and
+ though God denied him the honour of baptizing even one of them, yet
+ so faithful was he to his work that he toiled on to the very last.
+ "Faithful unto death" are words fully exemplified in your father's
+ life.'
+
+In his first letter from Mongolia after his prompt return to carry on in
+a like spirit of faith and devotion the work from which Mr. Gilmour had
+been summoned away Mr. Parker depicts the grief of the native Christians
+on learning their loss. 'The sorrow of the converts here (Ch'ao Yang) at
+the news of Gilmour's death was very touching Grown-up men burst into
+tears and sobbed like children when they were told he was dead. All
+along the route where Gilmour was such a familiar visitor, in the
+market-place, and at their fairs, the first question they asked as soon
+as they saw me was, "Has Mr. Gilmour come?" And at my reply there was
+always great astonishment, accompanied by expressions of sorrow. Every
+day at evening prayers I can hear Gilmour's name mingled with their
+petitions. The Christians here have sent a letter of sympathy to his two
+boys.
+
+ 'Here in Ch'ao Yang there are any amount of Mongols, not nomadic,
+ tent-loving, but settled here, and hence they do not have to be
+ sought. Right in the centre of the town is an immense Mongol temple
+ with two or three hundred priests. Every day I have several of the
+ priests in here, and yet I have heard again and again that this
+ mission is misplaced. Some such words often pained the heart that
+ is now still in death. But this is, and shall be, essentially a
+ Mongol mission in this, that as the best efforts of dear Gilmour
+ were for making Christ known to the Mongols, my best endeavours
+ shall be to this end. But if some hungry Chinaman, standing by as I
+ hold out the bread of life to his Mongol brother, seeks to eat of
+ it, he shall have it, and be as welcome as the other.'
+
+The letter to the children referred to in Mr. Parker's report is a
+fitting description of James Gilmour's life, and he himself would have
+desired no other panegyric. It came from the hearts of men on whose
+behalf he had given his very best, and it shows how strong a hold he had
+obtained upon their affection.
+
+ 'We respectfully enquire for the peace and happiness of your
+ excellencies, our brothers Gilmour, also for the peace of your
+ whole school. In the first place Pastor Gilmour in his preaching
+ and doctoring at Ch'ao Yang, north of the Pass, truly loved others
+ as himself, was considerate and humble, and had the likeness of
+ (our) Saviour Jesus. Not only the Christians thank him without end,
+ but even those outside the Church (the heathen) bless him without
+ limit. We, who through Pastor Gilmour have obtained the doctrine of
+ the second birth, and received the grace of Jesus, had hoped with
+ Mr. Gilmour to have assembled on the earth until our heads were
+ white and in the future life to have gone with him to heaven.
+ Little did we think we should have been so unhappy. He has already
+ gone to the Lord. We certainly know he is in the presence of the
+ Lord, not only praying for us, but also for you our brothers.
+
+ 'We pray you, when you see this letter, not to grieve beyond
+ measure. We hope that you will study with increased ardour, so as
+ to obtain the heavenly wisdom, like Solomon, and that afterwards
+ you may come to China, to this Ch'ao Yang, to preach the Gospel
+ widely. As the father did, may the sons follow, is our earnest
+ desire.
+
+ 'Signed by the Ch'ao Yang Christians,
+
+ 'LIU MAO LIN (preacher).
+ P'ANG TIEN K'UEI.
+ WANG SHENG.
+ NING FU TUNG.
+ CHANG WAN CH'UAN.
+ CHANG KUEI.
+ CHIANG SHENG.
+ WANG HUI HSIEN.
+ LIU I (your father's servant).
+ SUNG KANG.
+ CH'U WEN YUAN.
+ CHANG CHEN.
+ CHANG MAO CHI.
+ NING KUANG CHEN.
+ LIU CHO.
+ T'IEN TE CH'UN.
+ HU TE.'
+
+
+Here, then, we leave him. If the story of his life fail to touch the
+heart, to deepen faith, to exalt our estimate of renewed human nature,
+and to revive enthusiasm in work for Christ at home and abroad, the
+fault must be in him who has tried to tell it, and to set in order the
+facts.
+
+God's ways are ofttimes dark. James Gilmour had often felt this, and, to
+those who knew him, it seemed as though he were taken just when God's
+work needed him most, when the first-fruits of the coming harvest were
+being gathered, when his knowledge of the Chinese and the Mongols, and
+their knowledge of him and affection for him, were beginning to tell.
+But God knows best, and nothing can deprive the Church of Christ of the
+splendid self-sacrifice, of the noble perseverance in the path of duty
+of the bright example of courage, devotion, enthusiasm for souls, and
+patient continuance in well doing shining so clearly through all the
+long, years of toil. Love, self-crucifixion, Jesus Christ closely
+followed in adversity, in loneliness, in manifold perils, under almost
+every conceivable form of trial and hindrance and resistance both
+active and passive--these are the seeds James Gilmour has sown so richly
+on the hard Mongolian Plain, and over its Eastern mountains and valleys.
+'In due time we shall reap if we faint not.' His work goes on. He is now
+doing the Master's bidding in the higher service. There, we must fain
+believe, he is finding full scope for those altogether exceptional
+spiritual affinities, and powers and capacities which stand out so
+conspicuously all through the story of his inner life. Upon us who yet
+remain rests the responsibility of carrying forward the work he began,
+of reinforcing the workers, of bearing Mongolia upon our prayers until
+Buddhism shall fade away before the pure truth and the perfect love of
+Jesus Christ, and even the hard and unresponsive Mongols come to
+recognise the truths James Gilmour so long and so faithfully tried to
+teach them--that they need the Great Physician even more than they need
+the earthly doctor, and that He is more able and willing to heal the
+hurt of their souls than the earthly physician is to remove the disease
+of their bodies.
+
+Is not the real lesson of James Gilmour's life twofold? If it be looked
+at from the point of view of results, it should give clear and vivid
+ideas of the unwisdom of being cast down by the absence of results in
+face of the difficulties of missionary work in China. It is to be feared
+that there are still large numbers of good Christian people who believe
+that for the conversion of Chinamen and Mongols all that is requisite is
+to put into the hands of the heathen a copy of God's Word in their
+native tongue, and then preach to them the good tidings of salvation. No
+man in this, or in past generation, has done this more faithfully than
+James Gilmour. No man ever believed more firmly in the truth that it is
+'not by might nor by power,' but by the direct influence of the Holy
+Spirit, that the intellect and conscience and heart of the heathen are
+to be subdued to the Saviour. No man ever wrestled more eagerly and
+fervently in prayer on behalf of the ignorant and sinful, and yet his
+avowed converts can be numbered on the fingers. Does this prove that God
+is unfaithful? Does this tend to show that the enterprise is hopeless?
+Or has God been teaching us, by the life of one of His ablest and truest
+servants, the lesson of patient continuance in the path of His commands,
+whether He blesses or whether He withholds? Is He not proclaiming to His
+Church the need of a self-sacrifice _in all its members_ commensurate
+with that displayed by James Gilmour and others who like him have not
+counted their lives dear unto themselves in the struggle with
+heathenism? Some must go in the 'forlorn hope.' Some must lay down their
+lives in preparing the highway of our God. 'Herein is the saying true,
+One soweth and another reapeth.' But succeeding toilers in the Mongolian
+field, as the direct result of James Gilmour's sowing, will be able in
+days to come to apply to themselves our Lord's words, 'I sent you to
+reap that whereon ye have not laboured:--others have laboured, and ye
+are entered into their labour.'
+
+If the life of James Gilmour be looked at altogether apart from the
+results that can be entered in tables of statistics, how splendidly
+inspiring it is! Faithful to his Master, faithful to his work, although
+the Master _seemed_ to delay the blessing, although the work wore down
+the worker. 'I,' said St. Paul to the thankless Corinthian Church,
+'will most gladly spend and be spent for your souls. If I love you more
+abundantly, am I loved the less? But be it so.' And in the Epistle to
+the Romans he applied to the Jews who were resisting the Gospel the
+ancient words of Isaiah: 'But as to Israel He saith, All the day long
+did I spread out my hands unto a disobedient and gainsaying people. I
+say then, Did God cast off His people? God forbid.' Nor will God cast
+off the Israel of China, or the Mongols who gave to the faithful teacher
+respect, attention, and in a way the love of their hearts, but who as
+yet have not surrendered those hearts to their true Lord. James Gilmour,
+in season and out of season, in almost constant solitude, in
+superabounding physical labours that often overburdened him, and once
+nearly broke him down, in the long disappointment of the most cherished
+hopes, and under the constant strain of what would have crushed any but
+a giant in faith, lived a life which, if it taught no other lesson, was
+yet well worth living to teach this--that Jesus Christ can and does give
+His servants the victory over apparent non-success, after the most
+vehement and long-sustained effort to secure success, and that this is
+the greatest victory possible to renewed and sanctified human nature.
+
+
+ PRINTED BY
+ SPOTTISWOODE AND CO., NEW STREET SQUARE
+ LONDON
+
+
+ CHEAP EDITION.
+
+ Crown 8vo. 2s. 6d. cloth boards.
+
+
+ JAMES GILMOUR
+ OF MONGOLIA:
+
+ _HIS DIARIES, LETTERS, AND REPORTS._
+
+
+[Illustration: Sincerely yours James Gilmour]
+
+
+ EDITED AND ARRANGED BY
+ RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.
+
+ _Author of 'Norwegian Pictures,' 'The Printed English Bible,'
+ 'London Pictures,' &c._
+
+
+ PUBLISHED BY THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY,
+ 56 PATERNOSTER ROW, LONDON.
+
+ [P.T.O.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ Press Notices
+
+ OF
+
+ THE LIFE OF GILMOUR.
+
+'The story of James Gilmour will, if we mistake not, take a place of its
+own in modern missionary literature. To a world devoted so much to
+mercenary interests, and a Church too given to take things easily, the
+life is at once a rebuke and an appeal not easily to be
+forgotten.'--CHRISTIAN WORLD.
+
+'We are sure that this work will be read with the deepest interest by
+Churchmen as well as Nonconformists.'--RECORD.
+
+'A notable addition to the number of impressive and fascinating
+missionary books--a volume fit to stand on the same shelf with the
+biographies of Paton and Mackay.'--BRITISH WEEKLY.
+
+'James Gilmour may appear to some as a hero, to others as a deluded
+enthusiast, but no one who takes up this account of his life and work
+can fail to be fascinated by it.'--MANCHESTER GUARDIAN.
+
+'Out of sight the most interesting and valuable missionary biography of
+recent years.'--LITERARY WORLD.
+
+'Not only deeply interesting as a record of missionary labour, but teems
+with characteristic sketches of Chinese manners, customs, and
+scenery.'--TIMES (WEEKLY).
+
+'Unlike many missionary records, his letters and journals can be read.
+Indeed, it is difficult to stop reading, once you have begun.' NATIONAL
+OBSERVER.
+
+'For an age which, as the editor remarks, likes "large and quick
+returns" for its investments, the history of a man who had for many
+years to possess his soul in patience has a real and permanent value.'
+DAILY TELEGRAPH.
+
+'From every point of view the book deserves the highest praise.' GLASGOW
+HERALD.
+
+'Not the least interesting portion of the book will be its strange
+pictures of life amid Mongol surroundings.'--LIVERPOOL COURIER.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ By JAMES GILMOUR.
+
+ AMONG THE MONGOLS.
+
+ BY THE LATE
+ REV. JAMES GILMOUR, M.A.
+
+ With Engravings. 2s. 6d. cloth, gilt.
+
+'There has been, if our experience serves us at all, no book quite like
+this since "Robinson Crusoe"; and "Robinson Crusoe" is not better, does
+not tell a story more directly, or produce more instantaneous and final
+conviction. No one who begins this book will leave it till the narrative
+ends, or doubt for an instant, whether he knows Defoe or not, that he
+has been enchained by something separate and distinct in literature,
+something almost uncanny in the way it has gripped him, and made him see
+for ever a scene he never expected to see.'--THE SPECTATOR.
+
+'Mr. Gilmour tells a story well, and though he tells it quite simply and
+straightforwardly, he never misses the point of it. He writes, moreover,
+after having had exceptional chances of gaining a thorough acquaintance
+with the Mongolian character.'--THE GUARDIAN.
+
+'There is a charm in the quiet way in which the modest missionary tells
+of his life in Tartar tents, of the long rides across the grassy plain,
+and of the daily life of the nomads among whom he passed so many years.'
+FORTNIGHTLY REVIEW.
+
+'Mr. Gilmour's volume is one of the most charming books about a strange
+people that we have read for many a day.'--NATURE.
+
+'Mr. Gilmour has lived _tete-a-tete_ with a Buddhist Lama under his own
+movable roof; he has shared the hospitality of the desert caravan; he
+has taken his turn in the night-watch against thieves; and he has dwelt
+as a lodger in their more permanent abodes of trellis-work and felt. As
+a picture of the raw material from which Chinese civilisation has been
+finally evolved--the primitive stage of Tartar nomad communities--these
+sketches possess a great sociological value; while from the point of
+view of the reader for amusement alone they are full of liveliness and
+local colouring.' PALL MALL GAZETTE.
+
+'Although it appears in unpretentious form, this is a really remarkable
+chronicle of travel and adventure.'--THE GLOBE.
+
+
+ By JAMES GILMOUR.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+
+ Crown 8vo. 5s. cloth.
+
+ MORE ABOUT THE MONGOLS.
+
+ Selected and Arranged from Mr. GILMOUR'S Diaries and Papers
+ By RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.,
+ _Author of 'James Gilmour of Mongolia' &c._
+
+'The style of the writer and the novelty of the theme, and the heart
+which so longs for "Mongols" showing itself on many a page, combine to
+make the work intensely interesting, instructive, and impressive.'--THE
+PRESBYTERIAN.
+
+'The experiences of a devoted missionary, whose gift of circumstantial
+narrative has not inaptly been likened to Defoe's.'--THE TIMES.
+
+'It is indeed a delightful volume, which will be welcomed by all who
+desire the extension of Christ's kingdom on earth.'--ENGLISH CHURCHMAN.
+
+'Extracts from the diaries of one of the most adventurous and
+self-denying of missionaries.'--SATURDAY REVIEW.
+
+'Will be welcomed wherever the name of James Gilmour is known.' THE
+RECORD.
+
+'A fascinating volume of travels, and a series of observations on men
+and manners which show the stuff of which our British missionaries are
+made.' METHODIST TIMES.
+
+'Will delight readers of all ages.'--CHRISTIAN WORLD.
+
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ Crown 8vo. 2s. 6d. cloth, gilt edges.
+
+ JAMES GILMOUR AND HIS BOYS.
+
+ By RICHARD LOVETT, M.A.
+
+ With Facsimile Letters and many Illustrations.
+
+'Ought to be in every Sunday School library.'--THE CHRISTIAN.
+
+'It is full of curious passages of adventure; and has a strong religious
+interest which will not fail to give young readers an intelligent
+appreciation of the nature of foreign mission work.'--SCOTSMAN.
+
+'It has been skilfully put together and will make an admirable
+gift-book.' BRITISH WEEKLY.
+
+'It should find a place in all Christian homes.' WESTERN MORNING NEWS.
+
+'It is one that all boys, and girls too, will delight to read.' SCOTTISH
+LEADER.
+
+'A fascinating volume from beginning to end.'--BAPTIST.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+ PUBLISHED BY THE RELIGIOUS TRACT SOCIETY,
+ 56 Paternoster Row, London; and Sold by all Booksellers.
+
+ _Spottiswoode & Co. Printers, New-street Square, London._
+
+
+
+
+
+End of Project Gutenberg's James Gilmour of Mongolia, by James Gilmour
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK JAMES GILMOUR OF MONGOLIA ***
+
+***** This file should be named 31525.txt or 31525.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/3/1/5/2/31525/
+
+Produced by Peter Vickers, the Bookworm <bookworm.librivox
+AT gmail.com> and the Online Distributed Proofreading Team
+at http://www.pgdp.net (This book was produced from scanned
+images of public domain material from the Google Print
+project.)
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.net/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.net
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.net),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.net
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.